Quarterlytics / Financial Services / Insurance - Life / Lincoln National Corporation

Lincoln National Corporation

lnc · NYSE Financial Services
Claim this profile
Ticker lnc
Exchange NYSE
Sector Financial Services
Industry Insurance - Life
Employees 5001-10,000
← All annual reports
FY2010 Annual Report · Lincoln National Corporation
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Lincoln National Corporation

2 0 1 0   A N N U A L   R E P O R T   T O   S H A R E H O L D E R S

 
2010 Annual Letter to Shareholders 

To Our Shareholders: 

The Year in Review 

We are pleased to report below the progress that Lincoln National Corporation (“Lincoln”) made this past year in strengthening 
our foundation to support accelerated growth and improved earnings.  In terms of shareholder value, we saw our stock price rise 
by 12%, announced a dividend increase from one cent to five cents per share per quarter and repurchased $73 million of 
outstanding equity. 

A snapshot of our 2010 results underscores the strength of our franchise: 

(cid:2)  Net income of $980 million, up from a loss of $485 million in 2009; 
(cid:2) 
Income from operations of $1.0 billion, up 10% over 2009*; 
(cid:2)  Operating revenues of $10.6 billion, up 9% over 2009*; 
(cid:2) 
$20.9 billion of consolidated deposits, up 6% over 2009; 
(cid:2) 
$6.3 billion of consolidated net flows; down 14% from 2009; and 
(cid:2)  A total of $157.3 billion in consolidated assets under management, up 11% over 2009. 

Given our momentum and the quality of our execution, along with the expectation that capital markets and the domestic economy 
will continue to improve, we are confident that the outlook for Lincoln is positive and robust. 

2010 Focus and Priorities 

Lincoln serves growing markets through four complementary businesses that require a deep level of expertise to appropriately 
manage the risk that we assume on behalf of our clients.  Throughout 2010, we focused on executing aggressive growth plans for 
each business, made targeted investments in systems, distribution and product design, and enhanced our risk management 
capabilities.  Importantly, we remained consistent in our approach to product management, distribution support and service – a 
consistency that is recognized, valued and rewarded by our distribution partners and other stakeholders. 

We also completed a number of actions to enhance the company’s capital and liquidity structure to support our strong credit and 
financial strength ratings and provide sufficient financial flexibility to invest in the future.  We repurchased the $950 million of our 
Series B preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury as part of our participation in the Capital Purchase Program less than a year 
after entering the program, extended important bank facilities and established long-term reserve financing agreements to support 
our retail life business.  Finally, we increased our investments in talent and brand to ensure that we remain competitive, connected 
and relevant to our workforce, to our distribution partners and to our clients. 

Retirement Solutions Highlights 

We saw solid demand for individual annuities in 2010 and benefited from having multiple solutions available on most of our major 
distribution partner platforms.  We updated pricing on certain products this past year to balance competitive positioning with 
sound financial and risk management discipline, and launched a combination fixed annuity long-term care solution to capitalize on 
the growing preference for flexible financial solutions.  We continued to adhere to our disciplined approach to the annuity 
marketplace by maintaining a consistent presence and leveraging the combination of strong distribution and quality products.  

In 2010, we continued to invest in the expansion of our Defined Contribution business.  Building on our reputation in the 403(b) 
healthcare market, Lincoln is firmly focused on those Defined Contribution market segments with the fastest growth potential:  
healthcare 403(b); corporate middle market 401(k); and the small employer 401(k) markets.  Although net flows in this business 
tend to be uneven over the course of a year, we were pleased with the growth we experienced in deposits, account values, revenues 
and income.  

Insurance Solutions Highlights 

Lincoln produced solid year-over-year sales growth of 4% in its individual life insurance business in 2010, driven in part by strong 
sales in MoneyGuard®, our flexible universal life (“UL”) long-term care product, which provides multiple options for funding 
retirement needs.  Flexibility was also the impetus behind the launch of Lincoln DurationGuarantee® UL, our new limited coverage, 
guaranteed UL product that combines the flexibility and guarantees of UL with the affordability of term insurance.  Confirming 
our size and reputation in this business, at year end, Lincoln was the top provider of individual life insurance through more than a 
dozen major distribution firms, and, according to rankings based on Life Insurance and Market Research Association (“LIMRA”) 

  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
year-to-date sales data as of December 31, 2010, we remained the #3 provider of life insurance overall and #1 provider of UL 
insurance. 

Our Group Protection business is an important growth business for Lincoln, and we are well-positioned to grow in both the 
traditional markets as well as the expanding voluntary market.  During the year, we added distribution capabilities and launched a 
new group accident insurance coverage product to take advantage of market opportunities.  Results in 2010 were muted due to 
higher than expected disability loss ratios, which we believe are related to many employees delaying the filing of disability claims 
during the worst of the recession.  We took a number of steps in 2010 to better manage through this period of elevated loss ratios 
and we are confident that these moves will help to improve loss ratios over time.  We have a long history of success in this 
business and the talent necessary to manage this business over the long term. 

Wholesale and Retail Distribution Highlights 

Lincoln Financial Distributors is one of the largest wholesale distribution organizations in the industry, but the heart of our strategy 
is improving productivity, deepening our strategic partnerships and expanding the number of advisors recommending Lincoln 
solutions to their clients.  In 2010, we saw a 7% increase in wholesaler productivity and a 4% increase in the number of advisors to 
more than 57,000 who now recommend Lincoln products.  In addition, over the past two years, our strategic efforts to expand 
shelf space, launch new products and increase cross selling have contributed to a 16% increase in total sales.  We believe 
disciplined execution of this strategy over time will continue to generate meaningful top- and bottom-line growth for Lincoln. 

A key measure of success for Lincoln Financial Network (“LFN”), our retail sales and fee-based financial advisory services 
platform, is its ability to attract and retain seasoned advisors.  In 2010, the total number of LFN advisors grew by more than 300 to 
approximately 8,000.  Our experience shows that consumers remain risk-averse and are increasingly looking for professional advice 
and security, a trend that will benefit large, independent broker-dealers like LFN. 

Our Investment Portfolio, Capital and Liquidity Positions 

Our insurance affiliate investment portfolios are well-diversified across asset classes, sectors and issuers with a focus on high 
quality investments in stable market sectors.  Asset quality improved significantly throughout 2010 as measured by realized losses 
and our unrealized gain position, and the average credit quality of our portfolios today is “A,” with new purchases biased toward 
higher quality securities.  With strong asset-liability management and risk controls in place, we believe the investment portfolio is 
well-positioned heading into 2011. 

Lincoln ended the year with a risk-based capital (“RBC”) ratio** – an important measure of an insurance company’s capital 
position – of 491%, and approximately $700 million in cash at the holding company, both historically high levels for our company. 

Industry and Market Outlook 

The improving external environment, including favorable equity markets and rising interest rates, provides helpful tailwinds for our 
businesses.  Our experience shows that consumers are more focused than ever on growing and protecting their savings, and 
increasingly seeking out guaranteed solutions to fund a portion of their retirements.  Moreover, according to U.S. Census data, the 
older age segments of the population, who are a major market for our solutions, are growing faster than the overall population.  
These trends are catalysts for accelerated growth over the next decade. 

The industry is grappling with change in the shape of regulatory reform, which may result in the need to hold higher levels of 
capital reserves, proposed changes to U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) for life insurers and potential 
changes to tax policy.  We believe it is our responsibility to participate in the public dialogue surrounding these issues to raise 
awareness of the implications for our clients and shareholders.  Strong, balanced public policy is the best outcome for Lincoln, for 
the industry and for the country. 

Our Workplace Experience 

Our ability to successfully capitalize on market trends and deliver consistent results is due in large part to the quality and 
professionalism of our employees.  In 2010, we expanded our wellness offerings and tools, including an enhanced care 
management program for employees with chronic health conditions, to help employees follow healthier lifestyles.  We raised the 
bar on our diversity and inclusion efforts through a new cross-functional Diversity Council and expanded the number of 
development opportunities available to employees through our internal training program called LEAD.  In addition, we confirmed 
the high levels of engagement our employees have for our company through an enterprise-wide survey where we outperformed 
industry benchmarks for employee advocacy, passion and sense of purpose in their work.  Career development opportunities, 
meaningful and challenging work and a culture that rewards performance are all part of delivering a satisfying employee experience 
that reflects our shared belief in serving our clients with confidence, optimism and integrity. 

  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate and Social Responsibility 

In 2010, the Lincoln Financial Foundation contributed nearly $10 million to support nonprofit organizations in the communities 
where our employees live and work, with a focus on supporting education and workforce development, providing for basic needs 
and increasing access to the arts.  The Lincoln Foundation also contributed $970,000 to United Way agencies, and our employees 
donated nearly $900,000 to the United Way as well through workplace campaigns. 

Lincoln remains committed to supporting volunteerism in three ways:  participation on nonprofit boards; activities such as drives 
for local charities, including food banks and blood banks; and through LIVE, Lincoln Invests in Volunteer Experiences, which 
awarded $31,500 to nonprofits in 2010 in recognition of employees donating 50 hours of personal volunteer time. 

A Consistent Market Leader 

Lincoln ended the year with a healthy financial foundation, and we thank the Board of Directors for its leadership through the 
challenges and opportunities of the past year.  Our company is well-positioned to produce sustainable, profitable growth by 
leveraging our strengths as a consistent market leader in both product design and distribution.  The external environment is 
generating tailwinds for our businesses, including an improving economy and favorable consumer demographics and demand.  
And although some headwinds remain, we are confident that we have all of the pieces in place to execute our growth strategies and 
enhance value creation for our policyholders, employees and shareholders in 2011. 

Thank you for your trust and support. 

Sincerely, 

Dennis R. Glass   
President and CEO 

March 28, 2011 

William H. Cunningham 
Chairman of the Board 

* A reconciliation of operating revenues to revenues and income from operations to net income appears in Note 23 in the 
accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements presented in “Item 8.  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” 

** The inclusion of RBC measures is intended solely for the information of investors and is not intended for the purpose of 
ranking any insurance company or for use in connection with any marketing, advertising or promotional activities. 

Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language 

Statements in this letter that are not historical facts are forward-looking statements.  Actual results may differ materially from those 
projected in the forward-looking statements.  See “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” beginning on page 43 
and “Risk Factors” beginning on page 23. 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
[This page intentionally left blank] 

  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
UNITED STATES  
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION  
WASHINGTON, D. C. 20549   
FORM 10-K   

(Mark One)  
(cid:2)(cid:2) 

Annual Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934   
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2010   

OR 

(cid:3) 

Transition Report Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934   
For the transition period from                      to                     .  

Commission File Number 1-6028   
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION  
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)   

Indiana 
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization) 

35-1140070 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 

150 N. Radnor Chester Road, Suite A305, Radnor, Pennsylvania 
(Address of principal executive offices) 

19087 
(Zip Code) 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (484) 583-1400   

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: 

Title of each class 

Common Stock 
$3.00 Cumulative Convertible Preferred Stock, Series A 
6.75% Capital Securities 
Warrants, each to purchase one share of common stock 

Name of each exchange on which registered 
New York and Chicago 
New York and Chicago 
New York 
New York 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  

Yes  (cid:2)    No  (cid:3) 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  

Yes  (cid:3)    No  (cid:2) 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities 

Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), 
and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes  (cid:2)    No  (cid:3)  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every 
Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the 
preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).  Yes  (cid:2)    No  (cid:3)   

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§ 229.405 of this chapter) is 

not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements 
incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  (cid:2)  

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller 
reporting company.  See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of 
the Exchange Act.  Large accelerated filer  (cid:2)    Accelerated filer  (cid:3)(cid:4)Non-accelerated filer  (Do not check if a smaller reporting 
company)  (cid:3)   Smaller reporting company  (cid:3) 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).  Yes  (cid:3)    No  (cid:2)  
The aggregate market value of the shares of the registrant’s common stock held by non-affiliates (based upon the closing price 

of these shares on the New York Stock Exchange) as of the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal 
quarter was $7.7 billion. 

As of February 18, 2011, 315,798,959 shares of common stock of the registrant were outstanding.  

Selected portions of the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Shareholders, scheduled for May 26, 2011, have been 

incorporated by reference into Part III of this Form 10-K.  

Documents Incorporated by Reference:   

  
  
 
 
  
 
                          
                         
 
 
 
 
  
                           
                                                               
   
 
 
 
  
  
 
   
 
  
  
  
                          
 
 
 
 
 
[This page intentionally left blank] 

  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Lincoln National Corporation 

Table of Contents 

PART I 

Page   

Item   

1. 

Business  

   Overview  
   Business Segments and Other Operations 

  Retirement Solutions 

  Retirement Solutions – Annuities 
  Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution 

  Insurance Solutions 

Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 
Insurance Solutions – Group Protection 

   Other Operations 

   Reinsurance 
   Reserves 
   Investments 
   Ratings 
   Regulatory 
   Employees 
   Available Information 

1A.  Risk Factors 

1B.  Unresolved Staff Comments 

2. 

3. 

4. 

Properties 

Legal Proceedings 

Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders 

Executive Officers of the Registrant 

PART II 

5.  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases 

of Equity Securities  

6. 

Selected Financial Data 

7.  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations 

   Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language 
   Introduction 
       Executive Summary 
      Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates 
      Acquisitions and Dispositions 
   Results of Consolidated Operations 
   Results of Retirement Solutions  
      Retirement Solutions – Annuities 
       Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution 
   Results of Insurance Solutions 
       Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 
       Insurance Solutions – Group Protection 

i 

1 
1 
3 
3 
3 
7 
9 
9 
13 
14 
14 
15 
15 
16 
17 
23 
23 

23 

38 

38 

39 

39 

39 

40 

41 

42 
43 
44 
44 
49 
66 
67 
72 
73 
81 
89 
89 
98 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
Item   

  Results of Other Operations  
  Realized Gain (Loss) 
  Consolidated Investments  
  Reinsurance 
   Review of Consolidated Financial Condition 
       Liquidity and Capital Resources 
  Other Matters 

    Other Factors Affecting Our Business 
    Recent Accounting Pronouncements 

7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk 

8. 

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data  

9.  Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure 

9A.  Controls and Procedures 

9B.  Other Information 

10.  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance 

11.  Executive Compensation 

PART III 

12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder 

Matters 

13.  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence 

14.  Principal Accounting Fees and Services 

PART IV 

15.  Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules 

Signatures 

Index to Financial Statement Schedules  

Index to Exhibits  

 Page  
101 
105 
111 
134 
135 
135 
144 
144 
144 

144 

153 

255 

255 

255 

255 

256 

256 

257 

257 

258 

259 

FS-1 

E-1 

ii 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
PART I 

The “Business” section and other parts of this Form 10-K contain forward-looking statements that involve inherent risks and 
uncertainties.  Statements that are not historical facts, including statements about our beliefs and expectations, and containing 
words such as “believes,” “estimates,” “anticipates,” “expects” or similar words are forward-looking statements.  Our actual results 
may differ materially from the projected results discussed in the forward-looking statements.  Factors that could cause such 
differences include, but are not limited to, those discussed in “Item 1A. Risk Factors” and in the “Forward-Looking Statements – 
Cautionary Language” in “Part II – Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of 
Operations” (“MD&A”) of the Form 10-K.  Our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes to the 
consolidated financial statements (“Notes”) are presented in “Part II – Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” 

Item 1.  Business  

OVERVIEW  

Lincoln National Corporation (“LNC,” which also may be referred to as “Lincoln,” “we,” “our” or “us”) is a holding company, 
which operates multiple insurance and retirement businesses through subsidiary companies.  Through our business segments, we 
sell a wide range of wealth protection, accumulation and retirement income products and solutions.  These products include fixed 
and indexed annuities, variable annuities, universal life insurance (“UL”), variable universal life insurance (“VUL”), linked-benefit 
UL, term life insurance, mutual funds, employer-sponsored defined contribution (“DC”) plans and group life, disability and dental.  
LNC was organized under the laws of the state of Indiana in 1968.  We currently maintain our principal executive offices in 
Radnor, Pennsylvania.  “Lincoln Financial Group” is the marketing name for LNC and its subsidiary companies.  As of 
December 31, 2010, LNC had consolidated assets of $193.8 billion and consolidated stockholders’ equity of $12.8 billion. 

We provide products and services in two operating businesses and report results through four segments as follows: 

Business 
Retirement Solutions 

  Corresponding Segments 
  Annuities 
  Defined Contribution 

Insurance Solutions 

  Life Insurance 
  Group Protection 

We also have Other Operations, which includes the financial data for operations that are not directly related to the business 
segments.   

As a result of entering agreements of sale for Lincoln National (UK) plc (“Lincoln UK”) and Delaware Management Holdings, Inc. 
(“Delaware”) during 2009, we have reported the results of these businesses as discontinued operations on our Consolidated 
Statements of Income (Loss) for all periods presented and the assets and liabilities, prior to the sale, as held for sale on our 
Consolidated Balance Sheets.  For further information, see “Acquisitions and Dispositions” below. 

The results of Lincoln Financial Network (“LFN”) and Lincoln Financial Distributors (“LFD”), our retail and wholesale 
distributors, respectively, are included in the segments for which they distribute products.  LFD distributes our individual products 
and services, DC plans and corporate-owned UL and VUL (“COLI”) and bank-owned UL and VUL (“BOLI”) products and 
services.  The distribution occurs primarily through consultants, brokers, planners, agents, financial advisors, third party 
administrators (“TPAs”) and other intermediaries.  Insurance Solutions – Group Protection distributes its products and services 
primarily through employee benefit brokers, TPAs and other employee benefit firms.  As of December 31, 2010, LFD had 
approximately 550 internal and external wholesalers (including sales managers).  As of December 31, 2010, LFN offered LNC and 
non-proprietary products and advisory services through a national network of approximately 8,000 active producers who placed 
business with us within the last twelve months.   

Financial information in the tables that follow is presented in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the 
United States of America (“GAAP”), unless otherwise indicated.  We provide revenues, income (loss) from operations and assets 
attributable to each of our business segments and Other Operations, as well as revenues derived inside and outside the U.S. for the 
last three fiscal years, in Note 23. 

1 

  
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
Revenues by segment (in millions) were as follows:  

Revenues 
Operating revenues: 
   Retirement Solutions: 
      Annuities 
      Defined Contribution 
         Total Retirement Solutions 
   Insurance Solutions: 
      Life Insurance 
      Group Protection 
         Total Insurance Solutions 
   Other Operations 

Excluded realized gain (loss), pre-tax 
Amortization of deferred gains from reserve changes on business  
   sold through reinsurance, pre-tax  
Amortization of deferred front-end loads ("DFEL") associated with 
   benefit ratio unlocking, pre-tax  
      Total revenues 

Acquisitions and Dispositions 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 2,654    $ 
 988   
 3,642   

 2,301    $ 
 926   
 3,227   

 2,438 
 932 
 3,370 

 4,590   
 1,831   
 6,421   
 487   

 (146)  

 4,295   
 1,713   
 6,008   
 465   

 (1,200)  

 4,261 
 1,640 
 5,901 
 532 

 (573)

 3   

 3   

 3 

 -    
 10,407    $ 

$ 

 (4)  
 8,499    $ 

 (9)
 9,224 

On August 18, 2009, we entered into a purchase and sale agreement with Macquarie Bank Limited (“MBL”), pursuant to which we 
agreed to sell to MBL all of the outstanding capital stock of Delaware, our former subsidiary, which provided investment products 
and services to individuals and institutions.  This transaction closed on January 4, 2010, with net of tax proceeds of approximately 
$405 million. 

In addition, certain of our subsidiaries, including The Lincoln National Life Insurance Company (“LNL”), our primary insurance 
subsidiary, entered into investment advisory agreements with Delaware dated January 4, 2010, pursuant to which Delaware will 
continue to manage the majority of the general account insurance assets of the subsidiaries.  The investment advisory agreements 
will have 10-year terms, and we may terminate them without cause, subject to a purchase price adjustment of up to $75 million in 
the event that all of the agreements with our subsidiaries are terminated.  The amount of the potential adjustment declines on a pro 
rata basis over the 10-year term of the advisory agreements.    

On October 1, 2009, we completed the sale of the capital stock of Lincoln UK to SLF of Canada UK Limited for net of tax 
proceeds of $325 million.  We retained Lincoln UK’s pension plan assets and liabilities.  The former Lincoln UK segment primarily 
focused on providing life and retirement income products in the United Kingdom. 

On January 8, 2009, the Office of Thrift Supervision (“OTS”) approved our application to become a savings and loan holding 
company and our acquisition of Newton County Loan & Savings, FSB (“NCLS”), a federally regulated savings bank located in 
Indiana.  We closed on our purchase of NCLS on January 15, 2009.  We have contributed $25 million to the capital of NCLS since 
acquiring it in 2009.   

On November 12, 2007, Lincoln Financial Media Company (“LFMC”), our wholly-owned subsidiary, entered into two stock 
purchase agreements with Raycom Holdings, LLC (“Raycom”).  Pursuant to one of the agreements, LFMC agreed to sell to 
Raycom all of the outstanding capital stock of three of LFMC’s wholly-owned subsidiaries:  WBTV, Inc., the owner and operator 
of television station WBTV, Charlotte, North Carolina; WCSC, Inc., the owner and operator of television station WCSC, 
Charleston, South Carolina; and WWBT, Inc., the owner and operator of television station WWBT, Richmond, Virginia.  The 
transaction closed on March 31, 2008, and LFMC received proceeds of $546 million.  Pursuant to the other agreement, LFMC 
agreed to sell to Raycom all of the outstanding capital stock of Lincoln Financial Sports, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of LFMC.  
This transaction closed on November 30, 2007, and LFMC received $42 million of proceeds.  

2 

  
 
 
                             
                              
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
 
    
  
    
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
On November 12, 2007, LFMC also entered into a stock purchase agreement with Greater Media, Inc., to sell all of the 
outstanding capital stock of LFMC of North Carolina, the owner and operator of radio stations WBT(AM), Charlotte, North 
Carolina; WBT-FM, Chester, South Carolina; and WLNK(FM), Charlotte, North Carolina.  This transaction closed on January 31, 
2008, and LFMC received proceeds of $100 million.  More information on these LFMC transactions can be found in our Form 8-
K filed on November 14, 2007, and in Note 3. 

On April 3, 2006, we completed our merger with Jefferson-Pilot Corporation (“Jefferson-Pilot”), pursuant to which Jefferson-Pilot 
merged into one of our wholly-owned subsidiaries.  Prior to the merger, Jefferson-Pilot, through its subsidiaries, offered full lines 
of individual life, annuity and investment products, and group life insurance products, disability income and dental contracts, and it 
operated television and radio stations and a sports broadcasting network.   

For further information about acquisitions and divestitures, see Note 3.  

BUSINESS SEGMENTS AND OTHER OPERATIONS 

RETIREMENT SOLUTIONS 

Overview 

The Retirement Solutions business, with principal operations in Radnor, Pennsylvania; Fort Wayne, Indiana; Hartford, 
Connecticut; and Greensboro, North Carolina and additional operations in Concord, New Hampshire and Arlington Heights, 
Illinois, provides its products through two segments:  Annuities and Defined Contribution.  The Retirement Solutions – Annuities 
segment provides tax-deferred investment growth and lifetime income opportunities for its clients by offering individual fixed 
annuities, including indexed annuities, and variable annuities.  The Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution segment provides 
employer-sponsored variable and fixed annuities, defined benefit, individual retirement accounts and mutual-fund based programs 
in the retirement plan marketplaces.  Products for both segments are distributed through a wide range of intermediaries including 
both affiliated and unaffiliated channels of advisors, consultants, brokers, banks and wirehouses. 

Overview 

Retirement Solutions – Annuities 

The Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment provides tax-deferred investment growth and lifetime income opportunities for its 
clients by offering fixed and variable annuities.  The Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment offers non-qualified and qualified 
fixed and variable annuities to individuals.  The “fixed” and “variable” classification describes whether we or the contract holders 
bear the investment risk of the assets supporting the contract.  This also determines the manner in which we earn investment 
margin profits from these products, either as investment spreads for fixed products or as asset-based fees charged to variable 
products.  

Annuities have several features that are attractive to customers.  First, they provide tax-deferred growth on the underlying principal, 
thereby deferring the tax consequences of the growth in value until withdrawals are made from the accumulation values, often at 
lower tax rates occurring during retirement.  Second, annuities are unique in that contract holders can select a variety of payout 
alternatives to help provide an income flow for life.  Many annuity contracts include guarantee features (living and death benefits) 
that are not found in any other investment vehicle and, we believe, make annuities attractive especially in times of economic 
uncertainty. 

Products  

In general, an annuity is a contract between an insurance company and an individual or group in which the insurance company, 
after receipt of one or more premium payments, agrees to pay an amount of money either in one lump sum or on a periodic basis 
(i.e., annually, semi-annually, quarterly or monthly), beginning on a certain date and continuing for a period of time as specified in 
the contract or as requested.  Periodic payments can begin within 12 months after the premium is received (referred to as an 
immediate annuity) or at a future date in time (referred to as a deferred annuity).  This retirement vehicle helps protect an 
individual from outliving his or her money and can be either a fixed annuity or a variable annuity.  

3 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment’s deposits (in millions) were as follows: 

Deposits 
Variable portion of variable annuity 
Fixed portion of variable annuity 
   Total variable annuity 
Fixed indexed annuity 
Other fixed annuity 
      Total annuity deposits 

Variable Annuities  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 5,099    $ 
 3,167   
 8,266   
 2,027   
 374   
 10,667    $ 

 4,007    $ 
 3,194   
 7,201   
 2,182   
 979   
 10,362    $ 

 6,690    
 3,433    
 10,123   
 1,078    
 529    
 11,730   

A variable annuity provides the contract holder the ability to direct the investment of premium deposits into one or more sub-
accounts offered through the product (“variable portion”) or into a fixed account with a guaranteed return (“fixed portion”).  The 
value of the variable portion of the contract holder’s account varies with the performance of the underlying sub-accounts chosen 
by the contract holder.  The underlying assets of the sub-accounts are managed within a special insurance series of mutual funds.  
The contract holder’s return is tied to the performance of the segregated assets underlying the variable annuity (i.e., the contract 
holder bears the investment risk associated with these investments).  The value of the fixed portion is guaranteed by us and 
recorded in our general account liabilities.  Variable annuity account values were $68.4 billion, $59.4 billion and $44.5 billion for the 
years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, including the fixed portion of variable accounts of $3.5 billion, $4.0 
billion and $3.6 billion, for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  

We charge mortality and expense assessments and administrative fees on variable annuity accounts to cover insurance and 
administrative expenses.  These assessments are built into accumulation unit values, which when multiplied by the number of units 
owned for any sub-account equals the contract holder’s account value for that sub-account.  The fees that we earn from these 
contracts are reported as insurance fees on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  In addition, for some contracts, we 
collect surrender charges that range from 0% to 10% of withdrawals when contract holders surrender their contracts during the 
surrender charge period, which is generally higher during the early years of a contract.   

We offer A-share, B-share, C-share, L-share and bonus variable annuities, although not with every annuity product.  The 
differences in these relate to the sales charge and fee structure associated with the contract.   

(cid:2)  An A-share has a front-end sales charge and no back-end contingent deferred sales charge, also known as a surrender charge.  
The net premium (premium less front-end charge) is invested in the contract, resulting in full liquidity and lower mortality and 
expense assessments over the long term than those in other share classes.  A-share account values for the years ended 
December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, were $11.1 billion, $8.6 billion and $5.7 billion, respectively. 

(cid:2)  A B-share has a seven year surrender charge that attaches to each deposit and is only paid if the account is surrendered or 

withdrawals are in excess of contractual free withdrawals within the contract’s specified surrender charge period.  The entire 
premium is invested in the contract, but it offers limited liquidity during the surrender charge period. B-share account values 
for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, were $30.0 billion, $26.6 billion and $21.1 billion, respectively. 
(cid:2)  A C-share has no front-end sales charge or back-end surrender charge.  Accordingly, it offers maximum liquidity but mortality 
and expense assessments are higher than those for A-share or B-share.  A persistency credit is applied beginning in year eight 
so that the total charge to the customer is consistent with B-share levels after that time.  C-share account values for the years 
ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, were $2.3 billion, $2.1 billion and $1.7 billion, respectively. 

(cid:2)  An L-share has a four to five year surrender charge that attaches to each deposit and is only paid if the account is surrendered 
or withdrawals are in excess of contractual free withdrawals within the contract’s specified surrender charge period.  The 
differences between the L-share and the B-share are the length of the surrender charge period and the fee structure.  L-shares 
have a shorter surrender charge period, so for the added liquidity, mortality and expense assessments are higher.  We offer L-
share annuity products with persistency credits that are applied in all years after a specified contract duration so that the total 
charge to the customer is consistent with B-share levels.  L-share account values for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 
and 2008, were $19.3 billion, $16.4 billion and $11.5 billion, respectively. 

(cid:2)  A bonus annuity is a variable annuity contract that offers a bonus credit to a contract based on a specified percentage (typically 
ranging from 2% to 5%) of each deposit.  The entire premium plus the bonus are invested in the sub-accounts supporting the 
contract.  It has a seven to nine year surrender charge.  The expenses are higher than those for a B-share.  We offer bonus 
annuity products with persistency credits that are applied in all years after a specified contract duration so that the total charge 
to the customer is consistent with B-share levels.  Bonus annuity account values for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 
and 2008, were $5.7 billion, $5.6 billion and $4.6 billion, respectively.  

4 

  
 
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
We offer guaranteed benefit riders with certain of our variable annuity products, such as a guaranteed death benefit (“GDB”), a 
guaranteed withdrawal benefit (“GWB”), a guaranteed income benefit (“GIB”) and a combination of such benefits.  Most of our 
variable annuity products also offer the choice of a fixed option that provides for guaranteed interest credited to the account value.    

Approximately 93%, 92% and 91% of variable annuity separate account values had a GDB rider as of December 31, 2010, 2009 
and 2008, respectively.  The GDB features offered in 2010 included those where we contractually guarantee to the contract holder 
that upon death, we will return no less than: the current contract value; the total deposits made to the contract, adjusted to reflect 
any partial withdrawals; the highest contract value on a specified anniversary date adjusted to reflect any partial withdrawals 
following the contract anniversary; or the current contract value plus a specified percentage of contract earnings, not to exceed a 
covered earnings limit. 

Approximately 20%, 23% and 26% of variable annuity account values as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, had a 
Lincoln SmartSecurity® Advantage rider.  The Lincoln SmartSecurity® Advantage one-year benefit is a GWB rider that offers the 
contract holder a guarantee equal to the initial deposit (or contract value, if elected after issue), adjusted for any subsequent 
purchase payments or withdrawals.  Lincoln SmartSecurity® Advantage one-year allows an owner to step up the guarantee amount 
automatically on the benefit anniversary to the current contract value if the contract value is greater than the guarantee amount at 
the time of step up.  To receive the full amount of the guarantee, annual withdrawals are limited to 5% of the guaranteed amount.  
Withdrawals will continue until the longer of when the guarantee is equal to zero or for the rest of the owner’s life (“single life 
version”) or the life of the owner or owner’s spouse (“joint life version”) as long as withdrawals begin after attained age 65 and are 
limited to 5% of the guaranteed amount.  Withdrawals in excess of the applicable maximum in any contract year are assessed any 
applicable surrender charges, and the guaranteed amount is recalculated.  

In 2010, we offered other product riders including the Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage, Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage 2.0 
and Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage Plus, which are hybrid benefit riders combining aspects of GWB and GIB.  These benefit 
riders allow the contract holder the ability to take income at a maximum rate of 4% or 5% of the guaranteed amount when they are 
above the lifetime income age or income through i4LIFE® Advantage with the GIB.  Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage, Lincoln 
Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage 2.0 and Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage Plus provide higher income if the contract holder delays 
withdrawals, including both a 5% enhancement to the guaranteed amount each year a withdrawal is not taken for a specified period 
of time and an annual step-up of the guaranteed amount to the current contract value.  The Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage Plus 
provides an additional benefit, which is a return of principal at the end of the seventh year if the customer has not taken any 
withdrawals.  Contract holders under Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage, Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage 2.0 and Lincoln Lifetime 
IncomeSM Advantage Plus are subject to restrictions on the allocation of their account value within the various investment choices.  
Approximately 24%, 17% and 8% of variable annuity account values as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, had a 
Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage, Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage 2.0 or Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSM Advantage Plus rider.   

We also offered the i4LIFE® Advantage and 4LATER® Advantage.  The i4LIFE® Advantage rider, on which we have received a 
U.S. patent, allows variable annuity contract holders access and control during the income distribution phase of their contract.  
This added flexibility allows the contract holder to access the account value for transfers, additional withdrawals and other service 
features like portfolio rebalancing.  Approximately 12%, 11% and 11% of variable annuity account values as of December 31, 
2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, have elected an i4LIFE® Advantage feature.  In general, GIB is an optional feature available 
with i4LIFE® Advantage that guarantees regular income payments will not fall below the greater of a minimum income floor set at 
benefit issue, or 75% of the highest income payment on a specified anniversary date (reduced for any subsequent withdrawals).  
Approximately 95%, 94% and 92% of i4LIFE® Advantage account values elected the GIB feature as of December 31, 2010, 2009 
and 2008, respectively.  4LATER® Advantage provides a minimum income base used to determine the GIB floor when a client 
begins income payments under i4LIFE® Advantage.  The income base is equal to the initial deposit, or contract value, if elected 
after issue, and increases by 15% every three years, subject to a 200% cap.  The owner may step up the income base to the current 
contract value on or after the third anniversary of rider election or of the most recent step-up, which also resets the 200% cap.    

We design and actively manage the features and structure of our guaranteed benefit riders to maintain a competitive suite of 
products consistent with profitability and risk management goals.  To mitigate the increased risks associated with guaranteed 
benefits, we developed a dynamic hedging program.  The customized dynamic hedging program uses equity and interest rate 
futures positions, interest rate and variance swaps, as well as equity-based options depending upon the risks underlying the 
guarantees.  Our program is designed to offset both positive and negative changes in the carrying value of the guarantees.  
However, while we actively manage these hedge positions, the hedge positions may not be effective to exactly offset the changes in 
the carrying value of the guarantees due to, among other things, the time lag between changes in their values and corresponding 
changes in the hedge positions, high levels of volatility in the equity markets, contract holder behavior, management decisions not 
to fully hedge every risk and divergence between the performance of the underlying funds and hedging indices, which is referred to 
as basis risk.  For more information on our hedging program, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Derivatives” and 
“Realized Gain (Loss)” in the MD&A.  For information regarding risks related to guaranteed benefits, see “Item 1A. Risk Factors – 
Changes in the equity markets, interest rates and/or volatility affect the profitability of our products with guaranteed benefits; 
therefore, such changes may have a material adverse effect on our business and profitability.” 

5 

  
 
 
  
 
 
 
Fixed Annuities  

A fixed annuity preserves the principal value of the contract while guaranteeing a minimum interest rate to be credited to the 
accumulation value.  We offer single and flexible premium fixed deferred annuities to the individual annuities market.  Single 
premium fixed deferred annuities are contracts that allow only a single premium to be paid.  Flexible premium fixed deferred 
annuities are contracts that allow multiple premium payments on either a scheduled or non-scheduled basis.  Our fixed annuities 
include both traditional fixed-rate and fixed indexed annuities.  With fixed deferred annuities, the contract holder has the right to 
surrender the contract and receive the current accumulation value less any applicable surrender charge and, if applicable, a market 
value adjustment (“MVA”).  Depending on market conditions, MVAs can, for some products, be less than zero, which means the 
MVA results in an increase to the amount received by the contract holder. 

Fixed indexed annuities allow the contract holder to elect an interest rate linked to the performance of the Standard & Poor’s 
(“S&P”) 500 Index® (“S&P 500”).  The indexed interest rate is guaranteed never to be less than zero.  Our fixed indexed annuities 
provide contract holders a choice of a traditional fixed-rate account and one or more different indexed accounts.  A contract 
holder may elect to change allocations at renewal dates, either annually or biannually.  At each renewal date, we have the 
opportunity to re-price the indexed component (i.e. reset the caps, spreads or participation rates), subject to guarantees. 

Fixed annuity contracts are general account obligations.  We bear the investment risk for fixed annuity contracts.  To protect from 
premature withdrawals, we impose surrender charges.  Surrender charges are typically applicable during the early years of the 
annuity contract, with a declining level of surrender charges over time.  We expect to earn a spread between what we earn on the 
underlying general account investments supporting the fixed annuity product line and what we credit to our fixed annuity contract 
holders’ accounts.  In addition, with respect to fixed indexed annuities, we purchase options that are highly correlated to the 
indexed account allocation decisions of our contract holders, such that we are closely hedged with respect to indexed interest for 
the current reset period.  For more information on our hedging program for fixed indexed annuities, see “Critical Accounting 
Policies and Estimates – Derivatives” and “Realized Gain (Loss)” in the MD&A. 

Individual fixed annuity account values were $17.4 billion, $15.9 billion and $14.0 billion as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, 
respectively.  Approximately $13.3 billion of individual fixed annuity account values as of December 31, 2010, were still within the 
surrender charge period.   

Our fixed annuity product offerings as of December 31, 2010, consisted of traditional fixed-rate and fixed indexed deferred 
annuities, as well as fixed-rate immediate annuities with various payment options, including lifetime incomes.  In addition to 
traditional fixed-rate immediate annuities, we offered the Lincoln SmartIncomeSM Inflation Annuity which provides lifetime income 
with annual adjustments to keep pace with inflation.  It uses a patent-pending design to preserve access to remaining principal, also 
adjusted annually for inflation, for premature death or unexpected needs.  The traditional fixed-rate deferred annuity products 
include Lincoln ClassicSM (Single and Flexible Premium), Lincoln SelectSM, Lincoln Smart Course®, Lincoln MYGuaranteeSM Plus and 
Lincoln GrowSmartSM Fixed Annuity.  The fixed indexed deferred annuity products include Lincoln OptiPoint®, Lincoln OptiChoiceSM 
and Lincoln New Directions®.  The fixed indexed annuities offer one or more of the following indexed accounts: 

(cid:2)  The Performance Triggered Indexed Account pays a specified rate, declared at the beginning of the indexed term, if the S&P 
500 value at the end of the indexed term is the same or greater than the S&P 500 value at the beginning of the indexed term; 
(cid:2)  The Point to Point Indexed Account compares the value of the S&P 500 at the end of the indexed term to the S&P 500 value 
at the beginning of the term.  If the S&P 500 at the end of the indexed term is higher than the S&P 500 value at the beginning 
of the term, then the percentage change, up to the declared indexed interest cap, is credited to the indexed account;   

(cid:2)  The Monthly Cap Indexed Account reflects the monthly changes in the S&P 500 value over the course of the indexed term.  

Each month, the percentage change in the S&P 500 value is calculated, subject to a monthly indexed cap that is declared at the 
beginning of the indexed term.  At the end of the indexed term, all of the monthly change percentages are summed to 
determine the rate of indexed interest that will be credited to the account; and 

(cid:2)  The Monthly Average Indexed Account compares the average monthly value of the S&P 500 to the S&P 500 value at the 
beginning of the term.  The average of the S&P 500 values at the end of each of the twelve months in the indexed term is 
calculated.  The percentage change of the average S&P 500 value to the starting S&P 500 value is calculated.  From that 
amount, the indexed interest spread, which is declared at the beginning of the indexed term, is subtracted.  The resulting rate is 
used to calculate the indexed interest that will be credited to the account.     

If the S&P 500 values produce a negative indexed interest rate, no indexed interest is credited to the indexed account. 

6 

  
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
In November of 2010, we launched the Lincoln Long-Term CareSM Advantage fixed annuity.  This product combines the features of a 
single premium fixed annuity with a long-term care rider.  It allows a contract holder the protection of principal, while providing a 
way to manage the potential impact of long-term care expenses.  The long-term care rider provides the contract holder with the 
potential to receive long-term care benefits equal to the premium payment plus an additional amount equal to one or two times the 
premium payment.  In addition, the contract holder has the opportunity to increase the long-term care benefits if there are gains 
in the contract.   

Available with certain of our fixed indexed annuities, Lincoln Living IncomeSM Advantage provides the contract holder a guaranteed 
lifetime withdrawal benefit.  Withdrawals in excess of the free amount are assessed any applicable surrender charges, and the 
guaranteed withdrawal amount is recalculated.  

Many of our fixed annuities have an MVA.  If a contract with an MVA is surrendered during the surrender charge period, both a 
surrender charge and an MVA may be applied.  The MVA feature increases or decreases the contract value of the annuity based on 
a decrease or increase in interest rates.  Individual fixed annuities with an MVA feature constituted 61%, 55% and 46% of total 
fixed annuity account values as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.   

Distribution  

The Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment distributes its individual fixed and variable annuity products through LFD.  LFD’s 
distribution channels give the Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment access to its target markets.  LFD distributes the 
segment’s products to a large number of financial intermediaries, including LFN.  The financial intermediaries include 
wire/regional firms, independent financial planners, financial institutions and managing general agents. 

Competition  

The annuities market is very competitive and consists of many companies, with no one company dominating the market for all 
products.  The Annuities segment competes with numerous other financial services companies.  The main factors upon which 
entities in this market compete are distribution channel access and the quality of wholesalers, investment performance, cost, 
product features, speed to market, brand recognition, financial strength ratings, crediting rates and client service. 

Overview 

Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution  

The Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution segment provides employers with retirement plan products and services, 
primarily in the defined contribution retirement plan marketplaces.  While our focus is employer-sponsored defined contribution 
plans, we also serve the defined benefit plan and individual retirement account (IRA) markets.  We provide a variety of plan 
investment vehicles, including individual and group variable annuities, group fixed annuities and mutual fund-based programs.  We 
also offer a broad array of plan services including plan recordkeeping, compliance testing, participant education and other related 
services.   

DC plans are a popular employee benefit offered by many employers across a wide spectrum of industries and by employers large 
and small.  Some plans include employer matching of employee contributions, which can increase participation by employees.  
Growth in the number of DC plans has occurred as these plans have been used as replacements for frozen or eliminated defined 
benefit retirement plans.  In general, DC plans offer tax-deferred contributions and investment growth, thereby deferring the tax 
consequences of both the contributions and investment growth until withdrawals are made from the accumulated values, often at 
lower tax rates occurring during retirement.  The types of DC plans on which the Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution 
segment primarily focuses are Internal Revenue Code section 403(b) plans and section 401(k) plans. 

Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution’s 403(b) assets accounted for 58% of total assets under management in this segment 
as of December 31, 2010.  The mid to large market 401(k) business accounted for 17% and the small market 401(k) business 
accounted for 15% of this segment’s assets as of December 31, 2010 for this segment.   

Products and Services 

The Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution segment currently brings four primary offerings to the employer-sponsored 
market:  LINCOLN DIRECTORSM group variable annuity, LINCOLN ALLIANCE® program, Lincoln SmartFuture® program 
and Multi-Fund® variable annuity.   

7 

  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution segment’s deposits (in millions) were as follows: 

Deposits 
Variable portion of variable annuity 
Fixed portion of variable annuity 

   Total variable annuity 
Fixed annuity 
Mutual fund 
      Total annuity and mutual fund deposits 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 1,614    $ 
 315   

 1,929   
 1,017   
 2,355   
 5,301    $ 

 1,586    $ 
 331   

 1,917   
 1,011   
 2,024   
 4,952    $ 

 2,170 
 369 

 2,539 
 812 
 2,196 
 5,547 

LINCOLN DIRECTORSM and Multi-Fund® products are variable annuities.  LINCOLN ALLIANCE® and Lincoln SmartFuture® 
programs are mutual fund-based programs.  This suite of products and programs primarily covers the 403(b) and 401(k) 
marketplace.  These 403(b) and 401(k) plans are tax-deferred, DC plans offered to employees of an entity to enable them to save 
for retirement.  The 403(b) plans are available to employees of educational institutions, not-for-profit healthcare organizations and 
certain other not-for-profit entities; and 401(k) plans are generally available to employees of for-profit entities.  The investment 
options for our annuities encompass the spectrum of asset classes with varying levels of risk and include both equity and fixed 
income.  Healthcare clients accounted for 45%, 43% and 45% of account values for these products as of December 31, 2010, 2009 
and 2008, respectively. 

LINCOLN DIRECTORSM group variable annuity is a 401(k) DC retirement plan solution available to small businesses, typically 
those that have DC plans with less than $3 million in account values.  The LINCOLN DIRECTORSM product offers participants a 
broad array of investment options from several fund families and a fixed account.  In 2009, we updated our LINCOLN 
DIRECTORSM product, which now offers more than 90 investment options and will be positioned as our primary product in the 
small 401(k) plan marketplace.  This product includes fiduciary support for plan sponsors, accumulation strategies and tools for 
plan participants and offers our patented distribution option, i4LIFE® Advantage.  LINCOLN DIRECTORSM group variable 
annuity has the option of being serviced through a TPA or fully serviced by Lincoln.  As of December 31, 2010, approximately 
93% of LINCOLN DIRECTORSM clients were serviced through TPAs.  The Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution 
segment earns revenue through asset charges, investment management fees, surrender charges and recordkeeping fees from this 
product.  We also receive fees from the underlying mutual funds companies for the services we provide and we also earn 
investment margins on assets in the fixed account.  Account values for LINCOLN DIRECTORSM group variable annuity were 
$6.4 billion, $5.9 billion and $4.9 billion as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. 

The LINCOLN ALLIANCE® program is a DC retirement plan solution aimed at mid to large employers, typically those that 
have DC plans with $15 million or more in account value.  The target market is primarily for-profit corporations, educational 
institutions and healthcare providers.  The program bundles our traditional fixed annuity products with the employer’s choice of 
mutual funds, along with recordkeeping, plan compliance services and customized employee education services.  Included in the 
product offering is the LIFESPAN® learning program, which provides participants with educational materials and one-on-one 
guidance for retirement planning.  The program allows the use of any mutual fund.  We earn fees for our recordkeeping and 
educational services and the services we provide to mutual fund accounts.  We also earn investment margins on fixed annuities.  
The mutual funds associated with this program are not included in the separate accounts reported on our Consolidated Balance 
Sheets, as we do not have any ownership interest in them.  LINCOLN ALLIANCE® program account values were $15.9 billion, 
$13.4 billion and $9.4 billion as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. 

The Lincoln SmartFuture® program is a DC retirement plan solution aimed at small to mid employers, typically those that have DC 
plans with between $3 million and $15 million in account value.  The target market is primarily for-profit corporations, educational 
institutions and healthcare providers.  The Lincoln SmartFuture® program was introduced in 2008 and is built on the LINCOLN 
ALLIANCE® platform.  Like LINCOLN ALLIANCE®, the program bundles our traditional fixed annuity products with retail 
mutual funds, recordkeeping, plan compliance services and employee education services using the LIFESPAN® learning program, 
which is described further above.  However, the Lincoln SmartFuture® program allows the employer to choose from a list of 
approximately 150 retail mutual funds chosen by us, which consists of a broad range of low-cost funds.  Services for this program 
are typically not customized for each employer.  We earn fees for our recordkeeping and educational services and the services we 
provide to mutual fund accounts.  We also earn investment margins on fixed annuities.  The retail mutual funds associated with 
this program are not included in the separate accounts reported on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, as we do not have any 
ownership interest in them.  Lincoln SmartFuture® program account values were $319 million, $223 million and $104 million as of 
December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. 

8 

  
 
 
                                     
  
                                     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
Multi-Fund® Variable Annuity is a DC retirement plan solution with full-bundled administrative services and high quality 
investment choices marketed to small- to mid-sized healthcare, education, governmental and not-for-profit plans.  The product can 
be sold either to the employer through the Multi-Fund® group variable annuity contract or directly to the individual through the 
Multi-Fund® Select variable annuity contract.  We earn mortality and expense charges, investment income on the fixed account and 
surrender charges from this product.  We also receive fees for services that we provide to funds in the underlying separate 
accounts.  The Multi-Fund® variable annuity is currently available in all states except New York.  Account values for the Multi-
Fund® variable annuity were $11.4 billion, $10.9 billion and $9.7 billion as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. 

Also within this segment, we have created the Lincoln Unifier® service offering to further assist employers in meeting the 
administrative challenges of bringing retirement plans into compliance with the new 403(b) regulations.  Lincoln Unifier® includes 
common remitter administration, compliance monitoring and proactive transaction monitoring.   

During the third quarter of 2010, we partnered with a leading provider of retirement recordkeeping services to enhance our 
retirement plan offerings.  Through this partnership, we expect to reduce our current recordkeeping platforms from five to one 
over the next several years.  

Distribution  

DC products are primarily distributed by LFD.  Wholesalers and managers distribute these products through advisors, consultants, 
banks, wirehouses, TPAs and individual planners.  During 2010, LFD expanded its distribution of DC products by increasing 
wholesalers and managers from 44 to 49, increasing relationship management expertise and growing the number of broker dealer 
relationships.    

The Multi-Fund® program is sold primarily by affiliated advisors.  The LINCOLN ALLIANCE® program and the Lincoln 
SmartFuture® program are sold primarily through consultants and affiliated advisors.  LINCOLN DIRECTORSM group variable 
annuity is sold in the small marketplace by intermediaries, including TPAs, planners and wirehouses. 

Competition  

The DC marketplace is very competitive and is comprised of many providers, with no one company dominating the market for all 
products.  As stated above, we compete in the small, mid and large markets.  We compete with numerous other financial services 
companies.  The main factors upon which entities in this market compete are distribution channel access and the quality of 
wholesalers, investment performance, cost, product features, speed to market, brand recognition, financial strength ratings, 
crediting rates, client service and client compliance and fiduciary services. 

INSURANCE SOLUTIONS 

The Insurance Solutions business provides its products through two segments:  Life Insurance and Group Protection.  The 
Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment offers wealth protection and transfer opportunities through term insurance, a linked-
benefit product and both single and survivorship versions of UL and VUL, including COLI and BOLI products.  The Insurance 
Solutions – Group Protection segment offers group life, disability and dental insurance primarily in the small- to mid-sized 
employer marketplace for their eligible employees. 

Overview 

Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 

The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment, with principal operations in Greensboro, North Carolina and Hartford, 
Connecticut and additional operations in Concord, New Hampshire and Fort Wayne, Indiana, focuses on the creation and 
protection of wealth for its clients through the manufacturing of life insurance products.  The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 
segment offers wealth protection and transfer opportunities through term insurance, a linked-benefit product (which is a UL policy 
linked with riders that provide for long-term care costs) and both single and survivorship versions of UL and VUL, including 
COLI and BOLI products.  

The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment primarily targets the affluent to high net worth markets, defined as households 
with at least $250,000 of financial assets.  For those individual policies we sold in 2010, the average face amount (excluding term 
and MoneyGuard® products) was $1 million and average first year premiums paid were approximately $50,000.   

The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment also offers COLI and BOLI products and services to small- to mid-sized banks 
and mid- to large-sized corporations, mostly through executive benefit brokers. 

9 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
Products  

The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment sells primarily interest/market-sensitive products (UL and VUL), including 
COLI and BOLI products, and term products.  The segment’s sales (in millions) were as follows: 

Sales by Product  
UL:  
   Excluding MoneyGuard®  
   MoneyGuard®  
      Total UL  
VUL  
COLI and BOLI  
Term  
         Total sales  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 $ 

 353 
 108    
 461   
 43    
 63    
 70    
 637    $ 

 397    $ 
 67   
 464   
 36   
 51   
 59   
 610    $ 

 525 
 50    
 575   
 54   
 84   
 28   
 741   

UL and VUL sales (including COLI and BOLI), represent first year commissionable premiums plus 5% of excess premiums 
received, including an adjustment for internal replacements of approximately 50% of commissionable premiums; term sales 
represent 100% of first year paid premiums; and linked-benefit sales represent 15% of premium deposits. 

The segment generally has higher sales in the second half of the year than in the first half of the year.  Approximately 44%, 44% 
and 46% of total sales were in the first half of 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. 

Life policies’ account values (in millions) were as follows:  

Account Values  
UL and interest-sensitive whole life (1) 
VUL (2) 
   Total account values  

As of December 31, 
2009  

2010  

2008  

$ 

$ 

 28,477 
 5,108   
 33,585 

 $ 

 $ 

 27,276    $ 
 4,468   
 31,744    $ 

 27,502 
 4,251   
 31,753 

Includes MoneyGuard® and the fixed portion of VUL. 

(1) 
(2)  Excludes the fixed portion of VUL. 

Mortality margins, morbidity margins (for linked-benefit products), investment margins (through spreads or fees), net expense 
charges (expense charges assessed to the contract holder less expenses incurred to manage the business) and surrender fees drive 
life insurance profits.  Mortality margins, morbidity margins, and some expense assessments are a function of the rates priced into 
the product and level of insurance in force (less reserves previously set aside to fund benefits).  Insurance in force, in turn, is driven 
by sales, persistency and mortality experience.  

Similar to the annuity product classifications described above, life products can be classified as “fixed” or “variable” contracts.  
This classification describes whether we or the contract holders bear the investment risk of the assets supporting the policy.  This 
also determines the manner in which we earn investment margin profits from these products, either as investment spreads for fixed 
products or as asset-based fees charged to variable products.  

We offer four categories of life insurance products consisting of:  

Interest-sensitive Life Insurance (Primarily UL) 

Interest-sensitive life insurance products provide life insurance with account (cash) values that earn rates of return based on 
company-declared interest rates.  Contract holder account values are invested in our general account investment portfolio, so we 
bear the risk of investment performance.  Some of our UL contracts include secondary guarantees, which are explained more fully 
below. 

10 

  
 
 
 
                             
  
                             
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
                             
  
                             
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
In a UL contract, contract holders have flexibility in the timing and amount of premium payments and the amount of death 
benefit, provided there is sufficient account value to cover all policy charges for mortality and expenses for the coming period.  
Under certain contract holder options and market conditions, the death benefit amount may increase or decrease.  Premiums 
received on a UL product, net of expense loads and charges, are added to the contract holder’s account value.  The client has 
access to their account value (or a portion thereof), less surrender charges and policy loan payoffs, through contractual liquidity 
features such as loans, partial withdrawals and full surrenders.  Loans and withdrawals reduce the death benefit amount payable and 
are limited to certain contractual maximums (some of which are required under state law), and interest is charged on all loans.  Our 
UL contracts assess surrender charges against the policies’ account values for full or partial face amount surrenders that occur 
during the contractual surrender charge period.  Depending on the product selected, surrender charge periods can range from 0 to 
20 years.  

We also offer a fixed indexed UL product that functions similarly to a traditional UL policy, with the added flexibility of allowing 
contract holders to have portions of their account value earn interest credits linked to the performance of the S&P 500.  The 
indexed interest rate is guaranteed never to be less than 1%.  Our fixed indexed UL policy provides contract holders a choice of a 
traditional fixed rate account and several different indexed accounts.  A contract holder may elect to change allocations annually for 
amounts in the indexed accounts and quarterly for new premiums into the policy.  Prior to each new allocation, we have the 
opportunity to re-price the indexed components, subject to minimum guarantees. 

As mentioned previously, we offer survivorship versions of our individual UL products.  These products insure two lives with a 
single policy and pay death benefits upon the second death. 

Sales results are heavily influenced by the series of UL products with secondary guarantees.  A UL policy with a secondary 
guarantee can stay in force, even if the base policy account value is zero, as long as secondary guarantee requirements have been 
met.  The secondary guarantee requirement is based on the evaluation of a reference value within the policy, calculated in a manner 
similar to the base policy account value, but using different assumptions as to expense charges, cost of insurance (“COI”) charges 
and credited interest.  The assumptions for the secondary guarantee requirement are listed in the contract.  As long as the contract 
holder funds the policy to a level that keeps this calculated reference value positive, the death benefit will be guaranteed.  The 
reference value has no actual monetary value to the contract holder; it is only a calculated value used to determine whether or not 
the policy will lapse should the base policy account value be less than zero.   

Unlike other GDB designs, our secondary guarantee benefits maintain the flexibility of a traditional UL policy, which allows a 
contract holder to take loans or withdrawals.  Although loans and withdrawals are likely to shorten the time period of the 
guaranteed death benefit, the guarantee is not automatically or completely forfeited, as is sometimes the case with other death 
benefit guarantee designs.  The length of the guarantee may be increased at any time through additional excess premium deposits.  
Secondary guarantee UL face amount in force was $112.0 billion, $110.4 billion and $99.0 billion or 20%, 20% and 18% of total life 
policies’ in-force face amount as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  For information on the reserving 
requirements for this business, see “Regulatory” below and “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 
– Income (Loss) from Operations – Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain” in the MD&A. 

We manage investment margins (i.e., the difference between the amount the portfolio earns compared to the amount that is 
credited to the customer) by seeking to maximize current yields, in line with asset/liability and risk management targets, while 
crediting a competitive rate to the customer.  Crediting rates are typically subject to guaranteed minimums specified in the 
underlying life insurance contract. 

Linked-benefit Life Products 

Linked-benefit life products combine UL with long-term care insurance through the use of riders.  The first rider allows the 
contract holder to accelerate death benefits on a tax-free basis in the event of a qualified long-term care need.  The second rider 
extends the long-term care insurance benefits for an additional period of time if the death benefit is fully depleted for the purposes 
of long-term care.  The policy also provides a death benefit, the value of which is excluded from federal income tax, to the contract 
holder’s beneficiary if the contract holder does not accelerate the entire amount of the death benefit as long-term care benefits 
during his or her life.  Linked-benefit life products generate earnings through investment, mortality and morbidity margins.  
MoneyGuard® products are linked-benefit life products. 

VUL 

VUL products are UL products that provide a return on account values linked to an underlying investment portfolio of sub-
accounts offered through the product.  The value of the contract holder’s account varies with the performance of the sub-accounts 
chosen by the contract holder.  The underlying assets of the sub-accounts are managed within a special insurance series of mutual 
funds.  Premiums, net of expense loads and charges for mortality and expenses, received on VUL products are invested according 
to the contract holder’s investment option selection.  As the return on the investment portfolio increases or decreases, the account 
value of the VUL policy will increase or decrease.  As with fixed UL products, contract holders have access, within contractual 

11 

  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
maximums, to account values through loans, withdrawals and surrenders.  Surrender charges are assessed during the surrender 
charge period, ranging from 0 to 20 years depending on the product.  The investment choices we offer in VUL products are the 
same, in most cases, as the investment choices offered in our individual variable annuity contracts.  

In addition, VUL products offer a fixed account option that is managed by us.  Investment risk is borne by the customer on all but 
the fixed account option.  We charge fees for mortality costs and administrative expenses as well as asset-based investment 
management fees.   

We also offer survivorship versions of our individual VUL products.  These products insure two lives with a single policy and pay 
death benefits upon the second death.  

We also offer single life and survivorship versions of our VUL products with secondary guarantees.  These products combine the 
lapse protection elements of UL with the upside potential of a traditional VUL product, giving clients the flexibility to choose the 
appropriate balance between protection and market risk that meets their individual needs.  The combined single life and 
survivorship face amount in force of these products was $5.7 billion, $5.3 billion and $4.9 billion or 1% of total life policies’ in-
force face amount as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. 

Term Life Insurance 

Term life insurance provides a fixed death benefit for a scheduled period of time.  It usually does not offer cash values.  Scheduled 
policy premiums are required to be paid at least annually.   

Distribution  

The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment’s products are sold through LFD.  LFD provides the Insurance Solutions – Life 
Insurance segment with access to financial intermediaries in the following primary distribution channels:  wire/regional firms; 
independent planner firms (including LFN); financial institutions; and managing general agents/independent marketing 
organizations.  LFD distributes COLI and BOLI products primarily to 16 intermediaries who specialize in the executive benefits 
market and are serviced through a network of internal and external sales professionals   

Competition  

The life insurance industry is very competitive and consists of many companies with no one company dominating the market for 
all products.  As of the end of 2009, the latest year for which data is available, there were 946 life insurance companies in the U.S. 
and U.S. territories, according to the American Council of Life Insurers.  

The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment competes on product design and customer service.  The Insurance Solutions – 
Life Insurance segment designs products specifically for the high net worth and affluent markets.  In addition to the growth 
opportunity offered by its target market, our product breadth, design innovation, competitiveness, speed to market, customer 
service, underwriting and risk management and extensive distribution network all contribute to the strength of the Insurance 
Solutions – Life Insurance segment.  On average, the development of products takes approximately six months.  The Insurance 
Solutions – Life Insurance segment implemented several major product upgrades and/or new features, including important UL, 
VUL, linked-benefit and term product enhancements in 2010.  With respect to customer service, management tracks the speed, 
accuracy and responsiveness of service to customers’ calls and transaction requests.  Further, the Insurance Solutions – Life 
Insurance segment tracks the turnaround time and quality for various client services such as processing of applications.  

Underwriting  

In the context of life insurance, underwriting is the process of evaluating medical and non-medical information about an individual 
and determining the effect these factors statistically have on mortality.  This process of evaluation is often referred to as risk 
classification.  Of course, no one can accurately predict how long any individual will live, but certain risk factors can affect life 
expectancy and are evaluated during the underwriting process.  

Claims Administration  

Claims services are delivered to customers from the Greensboro, North Carolina and Concord, New Hampshire home offices.  
Claims examiners are assigned to each claim notification based on coverage amount, type of claim and the experience of the 
examiner.  Claims meeting certain criteria are referred to senior claim examiners.  A formal quality assurance program is carried out 
to ensure the consistency and effectiveness of claims examining activities.  A network of in-house legal counsel, compliance 
officers, medical personnel and an anti-fraud investigative unit also support claim examiners.  A special team of claims examiners, 
in conjunction with claims management, focus on more complex claims matters such as long-term care claims, claims incurred 
during the contestable period, beneficiary disputes, litigated claims and the few invalid claims that are encountered.  

12 

  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
The Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment maintains a centralized claim service center in order to minimize the volume of 
clerical and repetitive administrative demands on its claims examiners while providing convenient service to policy owners and 
beneficiaries.   

Overview 

Insurance Solutions – Group Protection 

The Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment based in Omaha, Nebraska offers group non-medical insurance products, 
principally term life, disability and dental, to the employer marketplace through various forms of contributory and noncontributory 
plans.  Most of the segment’s group contracts are sold to employers with fewer than 500 employees.   

The segment’s insurance premiums (in millions) by product line were as follows: 

 For the Years Ended December 31, 
2009  

2008  

2010  

Insurance Premiums by Product Line 
Life 
Disability 
Dental 
   Total non-medical 
Medical 
      Total insurance premiums 

Products 

Group Life Insurance  

$ 

$ 

 639     $ 
 727    
 167    
 1,533   
 149    
 1,682    $ 

 584    $ 
 692   
 149   
 1,425   
 154   
 1,579    $ 

 541    
 672    
 150    
 1,363   
 154    
 1,517   

We offer employer-sponsored group term life insurance products including basic, optional and voluntary term life insurance to 
employees and their dependents.  Additional benefits may be provided in the event of a covered individual’s accidental death or 
dismemberment.   

Group Disability Insurance  

We offer short- and long-term employer-sponsored group disability insurance, which protects an employee against loss of wages 
due to illness or injury.  Short-term disability generally provides benefits for up to 26 weeks following a short waiting period, 
ranging from 1 to 30 days.  Long-term disability provides benefits following a longer waiting period, usually between 30 and 180 
days and provides benefits for a longer period, at least 2 years and typically extending to normal (Social Security) retirement age.    

Group Dental 

We offer employer-sponsored group dental insurance, which covers a portion of the cost of eligible dental procedures for 
employees and their dependents.  Products offered include indemnity coverage, which does not distinguish benefits based on a 
dental provider’s participation in a network arrangement, and a Preferred Provider Organization (“PPO”) product that does reflect 
the dental provider’s participation in the PPO network arrangement, including agreement with network fee schedules. 

Group Medical 

We manage employer-sponsored benefits designed to supplement a company’s major medical plan by reimbursing executives and 
eligible dependents for health care expenses not covered by the basic plan.  Along with medical expense reimbursement, EXEC-U-
CARE® plans include Accidental Death and Dismemberment coverage, EXEC-U-CARE CONCIERGE® health care assistance 
and TravelConnectSM travel assistance services. 

Distribution 

The segment’s products are marketed primarily through a national distribution system, including approximately 160 managers and 
marketing representatives.  The managers and marketing representatives develop business through employee benefit brokers, TPAs 
and other employee benefit firms. 

13 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Competition 

The group protection marketplace is very competitive.  Principal competitive factors include particular product features, price, 
quality of customer service and claims management, technological capabilities, financial strength and claims-paying ratings.  In the 
group insurance market, the Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment competes with a limited number of major 
companies and selected other companies that focus on these products.   

Underwriting 

The Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment’s underwriters evaluate the risk characteristics of each employee group.  
Generally, the relevant characteristics evaluated include employee census information (such as age, gender, income and 
occupation), employer industry classification, geographic location, benefit design elements and other factors.  The segment 
employs detailed underwriting policies, guidelines and procedures designed to assist the underwriter to properly assess and quantify 
risks.  The segment uses technology to efficiently review, price and issue smaller cases, utilizing its underwriting staff on larger, 
more complex cases.  Individual underwriting techniques (including evaluation of individual medical history information) may be 
used on certain covered individuals selecting larger benefit amounts.  For voluntary and other forms of employee paid coverages, 
minimum participation requirements are used to obtain a better spread of risk and minimize the risk of anti-selection. 

Claims Administration 

Claims for the Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment are managed by a staff of experienced claim specialists.  Disability 
claims management is especially important to segment results, as results depend on both the incidence and the length of approved 
disability claims.  The segment employs nurses and rehabilitation specialists to help evaluate medical conditions and develop return 
to work plans.  Independent medical reviews are routinely performed by external medical professionals to further evaluate 
conditions as part of the claim management process.  

OTHER OPERATIONS 

Other Operations includes the financial data for operations that are not directly related to the business segments.  Other 
Operations also includes investments related to the excess capital in our insurance subsidiaries; investments in media properties 
and other corporate investments; benefit plan net liability; the unamortized deferred gain on indemnity reinsurance related to the 
sale of reinsurance to Swiss Re in 2001; the results of certain disability income business due to the rescission of a reinsurance 
agreement with Swiss Re; our run-off Institutional Pension business in the form of group annuity and insured funding-type of 
contracts with assets under management of approximately $1.9 billion as of December 31, 2010; and debt.  We are actively 
managing our remaining radio station clusters to maximize performance and future value. 

Revenues (in millions) from Other Operations were as follows: 

Operating Revenues 
Insurance premiums 
Net investment income 
Amortization of deferred gain on business 
   sold through reinsurance 
Media revenues (net) 
Other revenues and fees 
     Total operating revenues 

   For the Years Ended December 31, 
   2008  
   2009  
   2010  

$ 

 2     $ 

 4     $ 

 326   

 307    

 72   
 75   
 12   
 487    $ 

 73    
 68    
 13    
 465     $ 

$ 

 4    
 358    

 74    
 85    
 11    
 532    

REINSURANCE 

We follow the industry practice of reinsuring a portion of our life insurance and annuity risks with unaffiliated reinsurers.  In a 
reinsurance transaction, a reinsurer agrees to indemnify another insurer for part or all of its liability under a policy or policies it has 
issued for an agreed upon premium.  We use reinsurance to protect our insurance subsidiaries against the severity of losses on 
individual claims and unusually serious occurrences in which a number of claims produce an aggregate extraordinary loss.  We also 
use reinsurance to improve our results by leveraging favorable reinsurance pricing.  Although reinsurance does not discharge the 
insurance subsidiaries from their primary liabilities to their contract holders for losses insured under the insurance policies, it does 
make the assuming reinsurer liable to the insurance subsidiaries for the reinsured portion of the risk.  Because we bear the risk of 
nonpayment by one or more of our reinsurers, we primarily cede reinsurance to well-capitalized, highly rated reinsurers. 

14 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                        
  
                        
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
   
We reinsure approximately 40% to 45% of the mortality risk on newly issued non-term life insurance contracts and approximately 
35% of total mortality risk including term insurance contracts.  As of December 31, 2010 our policy for this program was to retain 
no more than $10 million on a single insured life issued on fixed, VUL and term life insurance contracts.  The retention per single 
insured life for COLI remained at $2 million.   

Effective January 1, 2011, our maximum corporate retention on UL, VUL and term insurance contracts increased to $20 million 
for new business.  This change has no impact on our reinsurance structure at this time.   

Portions of our deferred annuity business have been reinsured on a modified coinsurance (“Modco”) basis with other companies 
to limit our exposure to interest rate risks.  In a Modco program, the reinsurer shares proportionally in all financial terms of the 
reinsured policies (i.e. premiums, expenses, claims, etc.) based on their respective quota share of the risk. 

In addition, we acquire other reinsurance to cover products other than as discussed above with retentions and limits that 
management believes are appropriate for the circumstances. 

We obtain reinsurance from a diverse group of reinsurers and we monitor concentration and financial strength ratings of our 
principal reinsurers.  Swiss Re represents our largest reinsurance exposure.  As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the amounts 
recoverable from reinsurers were $6.5 billion and $6.4 billion, respectively, of which $3.0 billion was recoverable from Swiss Re, 
related to the sale of our reinsurance business to Swiss Re, for both periods. 

We also utilize intercompany reinsurance agreements to manage our statutory capital position as well as our hedge program for 
variable annuity guarantees.  These intercompany agreements do not have an effect on our consolidated financial statements. 

For more information regarding reinsurance, see “Reinsurance” in the MD&A and Note 9.  For risks involving reinsurance, see 
“Item 1A. Risk Factors – We face a risk of non-collectibility of reinsurance, which could materially affect our results of 
operations.”  

RESERVES  

The applicable insurance laws under which insurance companies operate require that they report, as liabilities, policy reserves to 
meet future obligations on their outstanding policies.  These reserves are the amounts that, with the additional premiums to be 
received and interest thereon compounded annually at certain assumed rates, are calculated to be sufficient to meet the various 
policy and contract obligations as they mature.  These laws specify that the reserves shall not be less than reserves calculated using 
certain specified mortality and morbidity tables, interest rates and methods of valuation.  

For more information on reserves, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Derivatives” and “Critical Accounting 
Policies and Estimates – Future Contract Benefits and Other Contract Holder Obligations” in the MD&A. 

See “Regulatory” below for information on permitted practices and proposed regulations that may impact the amount of statutory 
reserves necessary to support our current insurance liabilities.  

For risks related to reserves, see “Item 1A. Risk Factors – Changes in interest rates and sustained low interest rates may cause 
interest rate spreads to decrease and changes in interest rates may also result in increased contract withdrawals.”  

INVESTMENTS  

An important component of our financial results is the return on invested assets.  Our investment strategy is to balance the need 
for current income with prudent risk management, with an emphasis on generating sufficient current income to meet our 
obligations.  This approach requires the evaluation of risk and expected return of each asset class utilized, while still meeting our 
income objectives.  This approach also permits us to be more effective in our asset-liability management because decisions can be 
made based upon both the economic and current investment income considerations affecting assets and liabilities.  Investments by 
our insurance subsidiaries must comply with the insurance laws and regulations of the states of domicile.  

We do not use derivatives for speculative purposes.  Derivatives are used for hedging purposes and income generation.  Hedging 
strategies are employed for a number of reasons including, but not limited to, hedging certain portions of our exposure to changes 
in our GDB, GWB and GIB liabilities, interest rate fluctuations, the widening of bond yield spreads over comparable maturity U.S. 
Government obligations and credit, foreign exchange and equity risks.  Income generation strategies include credit default swaps 
through replication synthetic asset transactions.  These derivatives synthetically create exposure in the general account to corporate 
debt, similar to investing in the credit markets.   

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, our most significant investments in one issuer were our investments in securities issued by the 
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation with a fair value of $5.0 billion and $4.8 billion, or 6% of our invested assets portfolio, 
15 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
respectively, and our investments in securities issued by Fannie Mae with a fair value of $2.9 billion and $3.0 billion, or 3% and 4% 
of our invested assets portfolio, respectively.   

As of December 31, 2010, our most significant investments in one industry were our investment securities in the electric industry 
with a fair value of $6.7 billion, or 8% of our invested assets portfolio, and our investment securities in the collateralized mortgage 
obligation (“CMO”) industry with a fair value of $6.5 billion, or 8% of our invested assets portfolio.  As of December 31, 2009, 
our most significant investment in one industry was our investment securities in the CMO industry with a fair value of $6.9 billion, 
or 9% of the invested assets portfolio.   

For additional information on our investments, including carrying values by category, quality ratings and net investment income, 
see “Consolidated Investments” in the MD&A, as well as Notes 1 and 5. 

RATINGS  

The Nationally Recognized Statistical Ratings Organizations rate the financial strength of our principal insurance subsidiaries and 
the debt of LNC.  Ratings are not recommendations to buy our securities.  

Rating agencies rate insurance companies based on financial strength and the ability to pay claims, factors more relevant to contract 
holders than investors.  We believe that the ratings assigned by nationally recognized, independent rating agencies are material to 
our operations.  There may be other rating agencies that also rate our securities, which we do not disclose in our reports.  

Insurer Financial Strength Ratings  

The insurer financial strength rating scales of A.M. Best, Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”), Moody’s Investors Service (“Moody’s”) and S&P 
are characterized as follows:  

(cid:2)  A.M. Best – A++ to S   
(cid:2)  Fitch – AAA to C   
(cid:2)  Moody’s – Aaa to C 
(cid:2) 
S&P – AAA to R  

As of February 18, 2011, the financial strength ratings of our principal insurance subsidiaries, as published by the principal rating 
agencies that rate our securities, or us, were as follows:  

Insurer Financial Strength Ratings 
LNL 

Lincoln Life & Annuity Co. of New York ("LLANY") 

First Penn-Pacific Life Insurance Co. ("FPP") 

A.M. Best 

Fitch 

   Moody's 

S&P 

A+ 

A+ 

(2nd of 16)     (5th of 21) 

A2 
   (6th of 21) 

AA- 
   (4th of 21) 

A+ 

A+ 

(2nd of 16)     (5th of 21) 

A2 
   (6th of 21) 

AA- 
   (4th of 21) 

A+ 

A+ 

(2nd of 16)     (5th of 21) 

A2 
   (6th of 21) 

A+ 
   (5th of 21) 

A downgrade of the financial strength rating of one of our principal insurance subsidiaries could affect our competitive position in 
the insurance industry and make it more difficult for us to market our products, as potential customers may select companies with 
higher financial strength ratings.  

Debt Ratings  

The long-term credit rating scales of A.M. Best, Fitch, Moody’s and S&P are characterized as follows:  

(cid:2)  A.M. Best – aaa to d 
(cid:2)  Fitch – AAA to D  
(cid:2)  Moody’s – Aaa to C   
(cid:2) 
S&P – AAA to D  

16 

  
 
 
 
 
   
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
As of February 18, 2011, our long-term credit ratings, as published by the principal rating agencies that rate our long-term credit, 
were as follows: 

A.M. Best 
a- 
(7th of 22) 

Fitch 
   BBB+ 
   (9th of 21) 

   Moody's 

Baa2 
   (9th of 21) 

S&P 
A- 
   (7th of 21) 

The short-term credit rating scales of A.M. Best, Fitch, Moody’s and S&P are characterized as follows:  

(cid:2)  A.M. Best – AMB-1+ to d   
(cid:2)  Fitch – F1+ to D   
(cid:2)  Moody’s – P-1 to NP   
(cid:2) 
S&P – A-1+ to D  

As of February 18, 2011, our short-term credit ratings, as published by the principal rating agencies that rate our short-term credit, 
were as follows: 

A.M. Best 
AMB-1 
(2nd of 6) 

Fitch 
F-2 
   (2nd of 8) 

   Moody's 

P-2 
   (2nd of 3) 

S&P 
A-2 
   (2nd of 8) 

A downgrade of our debt ratings could affect our ability to raise additional debt with terms and conditions similar to our current 
debt, and accordingly, likely increase our cost of capital.  In addition, a downgrade of these ratings could make it more difficult to 
raise capital to refinance any maturing debt obligations, to support business growth at our insurance subsidiaries and to maintain or 
improve the current financial strength ratings of our principal insurance subsidiaries described above.  

All ratings are on outlook stable.  All of our ratings are subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the rating agencies, and 
therefore, no assurance can be given that our principal insurance subsidiaries or LNC can maintain these ratings.  Each rating 
should be evaluated independently of any other rating. 

Insurance Regulation  

REGULATORY 

Our insurance subsidiaries, like other insurance companies, are subject to regulation and supervision by the states, territories and 
countries in which they are licensed to do business.  The extent of such regulation varies, but generally has its source in statutes 
that delegate regulatory, supervisory and administrative authority to supervisory agencies.  In the U.S., this power is vested in state 
insurance departments.  

In supervising and regulating insurance companies, state insurance departments, charged primarily with protecting contract holders 
and the public rather than investors, enjoy broad authority and discretion in applying applicable insurance laws and regulation for 
that purpose.  Our principal insurance subsidiaries, LNL, LLANY and FPP, are domiciled in the states of Indiana, New York and 
Indiana, respectively. 

The insurance departments of the domiciliary states exercise principal regulatory jurisdiction over our insurance subsidiaries.  The 
extent of regulation by the states varies, but in general, most jurisdictions have laws and regulations governing standards of 
solvency, adequacy of reserves, reinsurance, capital adequacy, licensing of companies and agents to transact business, prescribing 
and approving policy forms, regulating premium rates for some lines of business, prescribing the form and content of financial 
statements and reports, regulating the type and amount of investments permitted and standards of business conduct.   Insurance 
company regulation is discussed further under “Insurance Holding Company Regulation” and “Restrictions on Subsidiaries’ 
Dividends and Other Payments.” 

As part of their regulatory oversight process, state insurance departments conduct periodic, generally once every three to five years, 
examinations of the books, records, accounts, and business practices of insurers domiciled in their states.  During the three-year 
period ended December 31, 2010, we have not received any material adverse findings resulting from state insurance department 
examinations of our insurance subsidiaries conducted during this three-year period. 

State insurance laws and regulations require our U.S. insurance companies to file financial statements with state insurance 
departments everywhere they do business, and the operations of our U.S. insurance companies and accounts are subject to 
examination by those departments at any time.  Our U.S. insurance companies prepare statutory financial statements in accordance 

17 

  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
with accounting practices and procedures prescribed or permitted by these departments.  The National Association of Insurance 
Commissioners (“NAIC”) has approved a series of statutory accounting principles that have been adopted, in some cases with 
minor modifications, by virtually all state insurance departments.  

The NAIC allows our U.S. insurance subsidiaries to include certain deferred tax assets in our statutory capital and surplus, but we 
are not able to consider the benefit from this when calculating available dividends. 

Statutory reserves established for variable annuity contracts and riders are sensitive to changes in the equity markets and are 
affected by the level of account values relative to the level of any guarantees, product design and reinsurance arrangements.  As a 
result, the relationship between reserve changes and equity market performance is non-linear during any given reporting period. 

For more information on statutory reserving and our use of captive reinsurance structures, see “Review of Consolidated Financial 
Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources” in the MD&A. 

Insurance Holding Company Regulation  

LNC and its primary insurance subsidiaries are subject to regulation pursuant to the insurance holding company laws of the states 
of Indiana and New York.  These insurance holding company laws generally require an insurance holding company and insurers 
that are members of such insurance holding company’s system to register with the insurance department authorities, to file with it 
certain reports disclosing information, including their capital structure, ownership, management, financial condition, and certain 
inter-company transactions, including material transfers of assets and inter-company business agreements and to report material 
changes in that information.  These laws also require that inter-company transactions be fair and reasonable and, under certain 
circumstances, prior approval of the insurance departments must be received before entering into an inter-company transaction.  
Further, these laws require that an insurer’s contract holders’ surplus following any dividends or distributions to shareholder 
affiliates is reasonable in relation to the insurer’s outstanding liabilities and adequate for its financial needs.  

In general, under state holding company regulations, no person may acquire, directly or indirectly, a controlling interest in our 
capital stock unless such person, corporation or other entity has obtained prior approval from the applicable insurance 
commissioner for such acquisition of control.  Pursuant to such laws, in general, any person acquiring, controlling or holding the 
power to vote, directly or indirectly, 10% or more of the voting securities of an insurance company, is presumed to have “control” 
of such company.  This presumption may be rebutted by a showing that control does not exist in fact.  The insurance 
commissioner, however, may find that “control” exists in circumstances in which a person owns or controls a smaller amount of 
voting securities.  To obtain approval from the insurance commissioner of any acquisition of control of an insurance company, the 
proposed acquirer must file with the applicable commissioner an application containing information regarding:  the identity and 
background of the acquirer and its affiliates; the nature, source and amount of funds to be used to carry out the acquisition; the 
financial statements of the acquirer and its affiliates; any potential plans for disposition of the securities or business of the insurer; 
the number and type of securities to be acquired; any contracts with respect to the securities to be acquired; any agreements with 
broker-dealers; and other matters.  

Other jurisdictions in which our insurance subsidiaries are licensed to transact business may have similar or additional requirements 
for prior approval of any acquisition of control of an insurance or reinsurance company licensed or authorized to transact business 
in those jurisdictions.  Additional requirements in those jurisdictions may include re-licensing or subsequent approval for renewal 
of existing licenses upon an acquisition of control.  As further described below, laws that govern the holding company structure 
also govern payment of dividends to us by our insurance subsidiaries.  

Restrictions on Subsidiaries’ Dividends and Other Payments  

We are a holding company that transacts substantially all of our business directly and indirectly through subsidiaries.  Our primary 
assets are the stock of our operating subsidiaries.  Our ability to meet our obligations on our outstanding debt and to pay dividends 
and our general and administrative expenses depends on the surplus and earnings of our subsidiaries and the ability of our 
subsidiaries to pay dividends or to advance or repay funds to us.  

Our insurance subsidiaries are subject to certain insurance department regulatory restrictions as to the transfer of funds and 
payment of dividends to the holding company.  Under Indiana laws and regulations, our Indiana insurance subsidiaries, including 
our primary insurance subsidiary, LNL, may pay dividends to LNC without prior approval of the Indiana Insurance Commissioner 
(the “Commissioner”), only from unassigned surplus or must receive prior approval of the Commissioner to pay a dividend if such 
dividend, along with all other dividends paid within the preceding 12 consecutive months, would exceed the statutory limitation.  
The current statutory limitation is the greater of 10% of the insurer’s contract holders’ surplus, as shown on its last annual 
statement on file with the Commissioner or the insurer’s statutory net gain from operations for the previous 12 months, but in no 
event to exceed statutory unassigned surplus.  As discussed above, we may not consider the benefit from the statutory accounting 
principles relating to our insurance subsidiaries’ deferred tax assets in calculating available dividends.  Indiana law gives the 
Commissioner broad discretion to disapprove requests for dividends in excess of these limits.  New York, the state of domicile of 
18 

  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
our other major insurance subsidiary, LLANY, has similar restrictions, except that in New York it is the lesser of 10% of surplus to 
contract holders as of the immediately preceding calendar year or net gain from operations for the immediately preceding calendar 
year, not including realized capital gains. 

Indiana law also provides that following the payment of any dividend, the insurer’s contract holders’ surplus must be reasonable in 
relation to its outstanding liabilities and adequate for its financial needs, and permits the Commissioner to bring an action to 
rescind a dividend which violates these standards.  In the event that the Commissioner determines that the contract holders’ 
surplus of one subsidiary is inadequate, the Commissioner could use his or her broad discretionary authority to seek to require us 
to apply payments received from another subsidiary for the benefit of that insurance subsidiary.  For information regarding 
dividends paid to us during 2010 from our insurance subsidiaries, see “Review of Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and 
Capital Resources – Sources of Liquidity and Cash Flow” in the MD&A.  

Risk-Based Capital (“RBC”) 

The NAIC has adopted RBC requirements for life insurance companies to evaluate the adequacy of statutory capital and surplus in 
relation to investment and insurance risks.  The requirements provide a means of measuring the minimum amount of statutory 
surplus appropriate for an insurance company to support its overall business operations based on its size and risk profile.  There 
are five major risks involved in determining the requirements: 

Category 

  Name 

Description 

Asset risk - affiliates 
Asset risk - others 
Insurance risk 

Interest rate risk, health credit  
   risk and market risk 

Business risk 

C-0 
C-1 
C-2 

C-3 

C-4 

   Risk of assets' default for certain affiliated investments 
   Risk of assets' default of principal and interest or fluctuation in fair value 
   Risk of underestimating liabilities from business already written or  

inadequately pricing business to be written in the future 

   Risk of losses due to changes in interest rate levels, risk that health benefits  
   prepaid to providers become the obligation of the health insurer once again  
   and risk of loss due to changes in market levels associated with variable  
   products with guarantees 
   Risk of general business 

A company’s risk-based statutory surplus is calculated by applying factors and performing calculations relating to various asset, 
premium, claim, expense and reserve items.  Regulators can then measure adequacy of a company’s statutory surplus by comparing 
it to the RBC determined by the formula.  Under RBC requirements, regulatory compliance is determined by the ratio of a 
company’s total adjusted capital, as defined by the NAIC, to its company action level of RBC (known as the RBC ratio), also as 
defined by the NAIC.  Accordingly, factors that have an impact on the total adjusted capital of our insurance subsidiaries, such as 
the permitted practices discussed above, will also affect their RBC levels. 

Four levels of regulatory attention may be triggered if the RBC ratio is insufficient:  

(cid:2) 

(cid:2) 

(cid:2) 

(cid:2) 

“Company action level” – If the RBC ratio is between 75% and 100%, then the insurer must submit a plan to the regulator 
detailing corrective action it proposes to undertake;   
“Regulatory action level” – If the RBC ratio is between 50% and 75%, then the insurer must submit a plan, but a regulator 
may also issue a corrective order requiring the insurer to comply within a specified period;  
“Authorized control level” – If the RBC ratio is between 35% and 50%, then the regulatory response is the same as at the 
“Regulatory action level,” but in addition, the regulator may take action to rehabilitate or liquidate the insurer; and  
“Mandatory control level” – If the RBC ratio is less than 35%, then the regulator must rehabilitate or liquidate the insurer.  

As of December 31, 2010, the RBC ratios of LNL, LLANY and FPP reported to their respective states of domicile and the NAIC 
all exceeded the “company action level.”  We believe that we will be able to maintain the RBC ratios of our insurance subsidiaries 
in excess of “company action level” through prudent underwriting, claims handling, investing and capital management.  However, 
no assurances can be given that developments affecting the insurance subsidiaries, many of which could be outside of our control, 
will not cause the RBC ratios to fall below our targeted levels.  These developments may include, but may not be limited to:  
changes to the manner in which the RBC ratio is calculated; new regulatory requirements for calculating reserves, such as principles 
based reserving; economic conditions leading to higher levels of impairments of securities in our insurance subsidiaries’ general 
accounts; and an inability to finance life reserves including the issuing of letters of credit supporting captive reinsurance structures.  

See “Item 1A. Risk Factors – A decrease in the capital and surplus of our insurance subsidiaries may result in a downgrade to our 
credit and insurer financial strength ratings.” 

19 

  
 
 
   
  
 
  
 
 
 
     
 
  
  
 
 
  
     
 
  
     
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
Privacy Regulations 

In the course of our business, we collect and maintain personal data from our customers including personally identifiable non-
public financial and health information, which subjects us to regulation under federal and state privacy laws.  These laws require 
that we institute certain policies and procedures in our business to safeguard this information from improper use or disclosure.  If 
the federal or state regulators establish further regulations for addressing customer privacy, we may need to amend our policies and 
adapt our internal procedures. 

Federal Initiatives 

The U.S. federal government does not directly regulate the insurance industry; however, federal initiatives from time to time can 
impact the insurance industry.   

Health Care Reform Legislation 

In March 2010, the President signed into law the Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act which was subsequently amended by 
the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act.  This legislation includes a number of provisions that provide for new or 
increased taxes to help finance the cost of these reforms, substantive changes to existing health care laws and the addition of new 
health care and related laws, each of which could potentially impact some of our lines of businesses.   

Financial Reform Legislation 

In July 2010, the President signed into law the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, H.R. 4173, (“Dodd-
Frank Act”), wide ranging legislation that includes a number of reforms of the financial services industry and financial products.  
Many of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act require substantial regulatory work prior to implementation, and we cannot predict 
at this time all of the ways or the extent to which financial markets in general, or our business, financial condition and results of 
operations, may be affected following its full implementation.   

Some requirements of the Dodd-Frank Act apply to us as a result of our status as a thrift holding company.  The Dodd-Frank Act 
eliminates the OTS and reallocates the supervisory and regulatory authority over (i) federally chartered thrifts to the Office of the 
Comptroller of the Currency and (ii) thrift holding companies to the Federal Reserve Board.  Enactment of this provision ensures 
that we and NCLS will each have a new regulator and may be subject to additional and/or enhanced regulation, including new 
capital and leverage requirements.  We will also be subject to the provisions of the “Volcker Rule,” which restricts, subject to 
exceptions for various permitted activities, proprietary trading and certain investment activities by holding companies containing an 
insured depository institution.  Although we presently believe that the Volcker Rule will not require significant change in our 
investment and trading activities, rulemaking is not scheduled to be completed until late 2011, and the ultimate outcome of the 
rulemaking process cannot be predicted. 

The Dodd-Frank Act also mandates a new regulatory framework for over-the-counter derivatives transactions.  Subject to 
applicable insurance laws, we use derivatives for a number of reasons including, but not limited to, hedging certain portions of our 
exposure to changes in our GDB, GWB and GIB liabilities, interest rate fluctuations, the widening of bond yield spreads over 
comparable maturity U.S. Government obligations, credit, foreign exchange and equity risks.  The new regulatory scheme will 
impose clearing and centralized execution requirements on a wide range of derivatives transactions that are currently conducted 
over-the-counter, with the likely result that costs and margin requirements will increase for market participants across the board.  
As rulemaking on the Dodd-Frank derivatives provisions is still in progress, it is premature to determine the extent to which our 
derivatives costs and strategies may change, and the extent to which those changes may ultimately affect the range of products we 
offer to our customers.   

In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act requires new regulations governing broker-dealers and investment advisers.  In particular, the 
fiduciary standard rulemaking could potentially have broad implications for how our products are designed and sold in the future.  
In January 2011, the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) released a study on the obligations and standards of 
conduct of financial professionals, as required under the Dodd-Frank Act.  The SEC staff recommended establishing a uniform 
fiduciary standard for investment advisers and broker-dealers when providing investment advice about securities, including 
guidance for principal trading and definitions of the duties of loyalty and care owed to retail customers that would be consistent 
with the standard that currently applies to investment advisers.  A more uniform fiduciary standard could potentially affect our 
business in areas including, but not limited to:  design and availability of proprietary products; commission-based compensation 
arrangements; advertising and other communications; use of finders or solicitors of clients (i.e., business contacts who provide 
referrals); and continuing education requirements for advisors. 

Additional provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act include, among other things, the creation of a new Federal Insurance Office within 
the U.S. Department of the Treasury ( “U.S. Treasury”) to gather information regarding the insurance industry; the creation of a 
resolution authority to unwind failing institutions, funded on a post-event basis; the creation of a new Consumer Financial 

20 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Protection Bureau to protect consumers of certain financial products; and changes to executive compensation and certain 
corporate governance rules.  Given the current state of the rulemaking and implementation process, the ultimate impact on our 
business is undeterminable at this time. 

Department of Labor Regulation 

In October 2010, the U.S. Department of Labor (“DOL”) issued a proposed regulation that would, if finalized in current form, 
substantially expand the range of activities that would be considered to be fiduciary investment advice under the Employee 
Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (“ERISA”) and the Internal Revenue Code.  If finalized as proposed, the investment-
related information and support that our advisors and employees could provide to plan sponsors, participants and IRA holders on 
a non-fiduciary basis could be substantially limited beyond what is allowed under current law.  This could have a material impact on 
the level and type of services we can provide as well as the nature and amount of compensation and fees us and our advisors and 
employees may receive for investment-related services.  This proposal has generated substantial public comment and as a result, it 
is likely that any final regulation will be different from the proposal.  What the differences will be, as well as the timing of any final 
regulation, are unknown at this time.  We do not expect the DOL to issue a final regulation in 2011. 

Stimulus Legislation 

In reaction to the recession, credit market illiquidity and global financial crisis experienced during the latter part of 2008 and into 
2009, Congress enacted the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (“EESA”) on October 3, 2008, and the American 
Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (“ARRA”), which was signed into law on February 17, 2009, in an effort to restore 
liquidity to the U.S. credit markets and to stimulate the U.S. economy.  The ARRA and the Troubled Asset Relief Program 
(“TARP”) authorized the purchase of “troubled assets” from financial institutions, including insurance companies.  Pursuant to the 
authority granted under the TARP, the U.S. Treasury also adopted the Capital Purchase Program (“CPP”).     

TARP CPP 

On July 10, 2009, we issued, in a private placement, $950 million of Series B preferred stock and a warrant for 13,049,451 shares of 
our common stock with an exercise price of $10.92 per share to the U.S. Treasury under the CPP.  On June 30, 2010, we redeemed 
in full the Series B preferred stock from the U.S. Treasury.  Prior to the redemption of the Series B preferred stock, we were 
subject to certain restrictions applicable under the CPP, including limits on incentive compensation for certain executives and 
employees.  See “Review of Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources – Sources of Liquidity and Cash 
Flow – Financing Activities” for more information about our preferred stock redemption.    

Federal Tax Legislation 

In May 2003, the Jobs and Growth Tax Relief Reconciliation Act of 2003 (“JGTRRA”) was enacted.  Individual taxpayers are the 
principal beneficiaries of JGTRRA, which accelerated certain of the income tax rate reductions enacted originally under the 
Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act of 2001 ( “EGTRRA”), as well as reduced the long-term capital gains and 
dividend tax rates to 15%.  On May 17, 2006, the Tax Increase Prevention and Reconciliation Act of 2006 (“TIPRA”) was signed 
into law.  TIPRA extended the lower capital gains and dividends rates through the end of 2010.  EGTRRA also included 
provisions that eliminated the estate tax for a single year in 2010, while also replacing the step-up in basis rule applicable to 
property held in a decedent’s estate with a modified carryover basis rule.  The Tax Relief, Unemployment Insurance 
Reauthorization and Job Creation Act of 2010 extended for two years through 2012 all of the lower individual tax rates and set the 
estate tax rate at 35% with a personal exemption of $5 million for the next two years.  Should these provisions not be extended 
beyond 2012, the higher marginal tax rates on individuals could have a positive impact upon the sale of insurance and annuity 
products.  

On February 14, 2011, the Obama Administration submitted to Congress its fiscal year 2012 budget proposal.  Included therein are 
policy and tax recommendations that could have an effect upon our company and our products.  Many of these recommendations 
were originally proposed in last year’s budget submission to Congress.  Included among the various proposed policy 
recommendations are modifications to the dividends received deduction for life insurance company separate accounts.  If these 
proposed changes were enacted into law or, if applicable, changed administratively through the tax regulation process, they could 
have an adverse effect upon the Company’s profitability.  The budget also proposes changes to the tax laws that would affect 
purchasers of products offered and sold through our various business lines, including such items as expanding the pro-rata 
disallowance for COLI, the creation of an auto-enrollment IRA program for small employers and encouraging increased use of 
qualified plans through tax credits to defray start up costs.  Some of these proposed changes, should they become law, would have 
the potential to improve the attractiveness of our products to consumers and enhance our sales.  Other provisions could have the 
opposite effect.  The submission of the Administration’s budget to Congress begins the Congressional Budget process.  Any 
changes to the tax law will require legislation, which may or may not incorporate provisions found in the budget proposal, to move 
through both houses of Congress before being signed into law by the President. 

21 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
Patriot Act 

The USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (“Patriot Act”) contains anti-money laundering and financial transparency laws and mandates the 
implementation of various new regulations applicable to broker-dealers and other financial services companies, including insurance 
companies.  The Patriot Act seeks to promote cooperation among financial institutions, regulators and law enforcement entities in 
identifying parties that may be involved in terrorism or money laundering.  Anti-money laundering laws outside of the U.S. contain 
provisions that may be different, conflicting or more rigorous.  The increased obligations of financial institutions to identify their 
customers, watch for and report suspicious transactions, respond to requests for information by regulatory authorities and law 
enforcement agencies, and share information with other financial institutions require the implementation and maintenance of 
internal practices, procedures and controls.  

Employee Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) Considerations 

ERISA is a comprehensive federal statute that applies to U.S. employee benefit plans sponsored by private employers and labor 
unions.  Plans subject to ERISA include pension and profit sharing plans and welfare plans, including health, life and disability 
plans.  ERISA provisions include reporting and disclosure rules, standards of conduct that apply to plan fiduciaries and 
prohibitions on transactions known as “prohibited transactions,” such as conflict-of-interest transactions and certain transactions 
between a benefit plan and a party in interest.  ERISA also provides for a scheme of civil and criminal penalties and enforcement.  
Our insurance, asset management, plan administrative services and other businesses provide services to employee benefit plans 
subject to ERISA, including services where we may act as an ERISA fiduciary.  In addition to ERISA regulation of businesses 
providing products and services to ERISA plans, we become subject to ERISA’s prohibited transaction rules for transactions with 
those plans, which may affect our ability to enter transactions, or the terms on which transactions may be entered, with those plans, 
even in businesses unrelated to those giving rise to party in interest status.  

Broker-Dealer, Securities and Savings and Loan Regulation 

In addition to being registered under the Securities Act of 1933, some of our separate accounts as well as mutual funds that we 
sponsor are registered as investment companies under the Investment Company Act of 1940, and the shares of certain of these 
entities are qualified for sale in some or all states and the District of Columbia.  We also have several subsidiaries that are registered 
as broker-dealers under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (“Exchange Act”) and are subject to federal and state regulation, 
including but not limited to the Financial Industry Regulation Authority’s (“FINRA”) net capital rules.  In addition, we have several 
subsidiaries that are investment advisors registered under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940.  Agents and employees registered 
or associated with any of our broker-dealer subsidiaries are subject to the Exchange Act and to examination requirements and 
regulation by the SEC, FINRA and state securities commissioners.  Regulation also extends to various LNC entities that employ or 
control those individuals.  The SEC and other governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations, as well as state securities 
commissions in the U.S., have the power to conduct administrative proceedings that can result in censure, fines, the issuance of 
cease-and-desist orders or suspension and termination or limitation of the activities of the regulated entity or its employees.  

Our U.S. banking operations are subject to federal and state regulation.  As a result of its ownership of NCLS, LNC is considered 
to be a savings and loan holding company and, along with NCLS, is subject to supervision, regulation and examination by the OTS 
of the U.S. Treasury, or going forward by the Federal Reserve Board or the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency, as 
appropriate.  Federal and state banking laws generally provide that no person may acquire control of LNC, and gain indirect 
control of NCLS, without prior regulatory approval.  “Control” will be deemed to exist in the case of any person having the power 
to vote 25% or more of any class of “voting securities,” having the power to control the election of a majority of the Board or if 
the applicable regulatory authority determines that such person has the power to directly or indirectly exercise a controlling 
influence over the management or policies of the holding company or thrift. 

Environmental Considerations  

Federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations apply to our ownership and operation of real property.  Inherent in 
owning and operating real property are the risk of hidden environmental liabilities and the costs of any required clean-up.  Under 
the laws of certain states, contamination of a property may give rise to a lien on the property to secure recovery of the costs of 
clean-up, which could adversely affect our commercial mortgage lending.  In several states, this lien has priority over the lien of an 
existing mortgage against such property.  In addition, in some states and under the federal Comprehensive Environmental 
Response, Compensation, and Liability Act of 1980 (“CERCLA”), we may be liable, as an “owner” or “operator,” for costs of 
cleaning-up releases or threatened releases of hazardous substances at a property mortgaged to us.  We also risk environmental 
liability when we foreclose on a property mortgaged to us.  Federal legislation provides for a safe harbor from CERCLA liability 
for secured lenders that foreclose and sell the mortgaged real estate, provided that certain requirements are met.  However, there 
are circumstances in which actions taken could still expose us to CERCLA liability.  Application of various other federal and state 
environmental laws could also result in the imposition of liability on us for costs associated with environmental hazards.  

22 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
We routinely conduct environmental assessments for real estate we acquire for investment and before taking title through 
foreclosure to real property collateralizing mortgages that we hold.  Although unexpected environmental liabilities can always arise, 
based on these environmental assessments and compliance with our internal procedures, we believe that any costs associated with 
compliance with environmental laws and regulations or any clean-up of properties would not have a material adverse effect on our 
results of operations.  

Intellectual Property 

We rely on a combination of copyright, trademark, patent and trade secret laws to establish and protect our intellectual property.  
We have implemented a patent strategy designed to protect innovative aspects of our products and processes which we believe 
distinguish us from competitors.  We currently own four issued U.S. patents and have additional patent applications pending in the 
U.S. Patent and Trademark Office.  We intend to continue to file patent applications as we develop new products, technologies and 
patentable enhancements.   

We regard our patents as valuable assets and intend to vigorously protect them against infringement.  However, complex legal and 
factual determinations and evolving laws make patent protection uncertain, and while we believe our patents provide us with a 
competitive advantage, we cannot be certain that patents will be issued from any of our pending patent applications or that any 
issued patents will have sufficient breadth to offer meaningful protection.  In addition, our issued patents may be successfully 
challenged, invalidated, circumvented or found unenforceable so that our patent rights would not create an effective competitive 
barrier.   

Finally, we have an extensive portfolio of trademarks and service marks that we consider important in the marketing of our 
products and services, including, among others, the trademarks of the Lincoln National and Lincoln Financial names, the Lincoln 
silhouette logo and the combination of these marks.  Trademark registrations may be renewed indefinitely subject to continued use 
and registration requirements.  We regard our trademarks as valuable assets in marketing our products and services and intend to 
protect them against infringement and dilution. 

EMPLOYEES 

As of December 31, 2010, we had a total of 8,270 employees.  In addition, we had a total of 1,230 planners and agents who had 
active sales contracts with one of our insurance subsidiaries.  None of our employees are represented by a labor union, and we are 
not a party to any collective bargaining agreements.  We consider our employee relations to be good.  

AVAILABLE INFORMATION  

We file annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other documents with the SEC under the Exchange Act.  The 
public may read and copy any materials that we file with the SEC at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, 
Washington, DC 20549.  The public may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 
1-800-SEC-0330.  Also, the SEC maintains an Internet website that contains reports, proxy and information statements and other 
information regarding issuers, including LNC, that file electronically with the SEC.  The public can obtain any documents that we 
file with the SEC at http://www.sec.gov.  

We also make available, free of charge, on or through our Internet website http://www.lincolnfinancial.com, our Annual Report 
on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or 
furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such 
material with, or furnish it to, the SEC.   

The information on the website listed above is not, and should not, be considered part of this annual report on Form 10-K and is 
not incorporated by reference in this document.  This website is, and is only intended to be, an inactive textual reference. 

Item 1A.  Risk Factors 

You should carefully consider the risks described below before investing in our securities.  The risks and uncertainties described 
below are not the only ones facing our company.  Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we currently 
deem immaterial may also impair our business operations.  If any of these risks actually occur, our business, financial condition and 
results of operations could be materially affected.  In that case, the value of our securities could decline substantially. 

23 

  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
Adverse capital and credit market conditions may affect our ability to meet liquidity needs, access to capital and cost of 
capital. 

We need liquidity to pay our operating expenses, interest on our debt and dividends on our capital stock, to maintain our securities 
lending activities and to replace certain maturing liabilities.  Without sufficient liquidity, we will be forced to curtail our operations, 
and our business will suffer.  As a holding company with no direct operations, our principal asset is the capital stock of our 
insurance subsidiaries.  Our ability to meet our obligations for payment of interest and principal on outstanding debt obligations 
and to pay dividends to shareholders and corporate expenses depends significantly upon the surplus and earnings of our 
subsidiaries and the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends or to advance or repay funds to us.  Payments of dividends and 
advances or repayment of funds to us by our insurance subsidiaries are restricted by the applicable laws and regulations of their 
respective jurisdictions, including laws establishing minimum solvency and liquidity thresholds.  Changes in these laws could 
constrain the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends or to advance or repay funds to us in sufficient amounts and at times 
necessary to meet our debt obligations and corporate expenses.  For our insurance and other subsidiaries, the principal sources of 
our liquidity are insurance premiums and fees, annuity considerations and cash flow from our investment portfolio and assets, 
consisting mainly of cash or assets that are readily convertible into cash.  At the holding company level, sources of liquidity in 
normal markets also include a variety of short-term liquid investments and short- and long-term instruments, including credit 
facilities, commercial paper and medium- and long-term debt. 

In the event that current resources do not satisfy our needs, we may have to seek additional financing.  The availability of 
additional financing will depend on a variety of factors such as market conditions, the general availability of credit, the volume of 
trading activities, the overall availability of credit to the financial services industry, our credit ratings and credit capacity, as well as 
the possibility that customers or lenders could develop a negative perception of our long- or short-term financial prospects if we 
incur large investment losses or if the level of our business activity decreases due to a market downturn.  Similarly, our access to 
funds may be impaired if regulatory authorities or rating agencies take negative actions against us.  See “Item 1. Business – Ratings” 
for a complete description of our ratings.  Our internal sources of liquidity may prove to be insufficient, and in such case, we may 
not be able to successfully obtain additional financing on favorable terms, or at all. 

Disruptions, uncertainty or volatility in the capital and credit markets may also limit our access to capital required to operate our 
business, most significantly our insurance operations.  Such market conditions may limit our ability to replace, in a timely manner, 
maturing liabilities; satisfy statutory capital requirements; generate fee income and market-related revenue to meet liquidity needs; 
and access the capital necessary to grow our business.  As such, we may be forced to delay raising capital, issue shorter term 
securities than we prefer or bear an unattractive cost of capital which could decrease our profitability and significantly reduce our 
financial flexibility.  Our results of operations, financial condition, cash flows and statutory capital position could be materially 
adversely affected by disruptions in the financial markets. 

Difficult conditions in the global capital markets and the economy generally may materially adversely affect our 
business and results of operations. 

Our results of operations are materially affected by conditions in the global capital markets and the economy generally, both in the 
U.S. and elsewhere around the world.  Concerns over unemployment, the availability and cost of credit, the U.S. mortgage market 
and a declining real estate market in the U.S. have contributed to increased volatility and diminished expectations for the economy 
and the markets going forward.  These events and the reemergence of market upheavals may have an adverse effect on us, in part 
because we have a large investment portfolio and are also dependent upon customer behavior.  Our revenues are likely to decline 
in such circumstances and our profit margins could erode.  In addition, in the event of extreme prolonged market events, such as 
the global credit crisis that occurred during 2008 and 2009, we could incur significant losses.  For example, for the year ended 
December 31, 2009, our earnings were unfavorably affected by realized investment losses and impairments of intangible assets of 
$1.1 billion.  Even in the absence of a market downturn, we are exposed to substantial risk of loss due to market volatility. 

Factors such as consumer spending, business investment, government spending, the volatility and strength of the capital markets 
and inflation all affect the business and economic environment and, ultimately, the amount and profitability of our business.  In an 
economic downturn characterized by higher unemployment, lower family income, lower corporate earnings, lower business 
investment and lower consumer spending, the demand for our financial and insurance products could be adversely affected.  In 
addition, we may experience an elevated incidence of claims and lapses or surrenders of policies.  Our contract holders may choose 
to defer paying insurance premiums or stop paying insurance premiums altogether.  Adverse changes in the economy could affect 
earnings negatively and could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.  

24 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
If our businesses do not perform well and/or their estimated fair values decline or the price of our common stock does 
not increase, we may be required to recognize an impairment of our goodwill or to establish a valuation allowance 
against the deferred income tax asset, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and 
financial condition. 

Goodwill represents the excess of the acquisition price incurred to acquire subsidiaries and other businesses over the fair value of 
their net assets as of the date of acquisition.  As of December 31, 2010, we had a total of $3.0 billion of goodwill on our 
Consolidated Balance Sheets, of which $2.2 billion related to our Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment and $440 million 
related to our Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment.  We test goodwill at least annually for indications of value impairment 
with consideration given to financial performance, merger and acquisitions and other relevant factors.  In addition, certain events, 
including a significant and adverse change in legal factors, accounting standards or the business climate, an adverse action or 
assessment by a regulator or unanticipated competition, would cause us to review the carrying amounts of goodwill for impairment.  
Impairment testing is performed based upon estimates of the fair value of the “reporting unit” to which the goodwill relates.  The 
reporting unit is the operating segment or a business one level below that operating segment if discrete financial information is 
prepared and regularly reviewed by management at that level.  If the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill is lower than 
its carrying amount, goodwill is impaired and written down to its fair value, and a charge is reported in impairment of intangibles 
on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).   

Subsequent reviews of goodwill could result in impairment of goodwill during 2011, and such write downs could have a material 
adverse effect on our net income and book value, but will not affect the statutory capital of our insurance subsidiaries.  For more 
information on goodwill, see Note 10 and “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” in 
the MD&A. 

Deferred income tax represents the tax effect of the differences between the book and tax basis of assets and liabilities.  Deferred 
tax assets are assessed periodically by management to determine if they are realizable.  As of December 31, 2010, we had a deferred 
tax asset of $2.5 billion.  Factors in management’s determination include the performance of the business, including the ability to 
generate capital gains from a variety of sources and tax planning strategies.  If, based on available information, it is more likely than 
not that the deferred income tax asset will not be realized, then a valuation allowance must be established with a corresponding 
charge to net income.  Such valuation allowance could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial 
position, but will not affect the statutory capital of our insurance subsidiaries. 

Because we are a holding company with no direct operations, the inability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends to us in 
sufficient amounts would harm our ability to meet our obligations. 

We are a holding company and we have no direct operations.  Our principal asset is the capital stock of our insurance subsidiaries. 

At the holding company level, sources of liquidity in normal markets include a variety of short- and long-term instruments, 
including credit facilities, commercial paper and medium- and long-term debt.  However, our ability to meet our obligations for 
payment of interest and principal on outstanding debt obligations and to pay dividends to shareholders, repurchase our securities 
and pay corporate expenses depends primarily on the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends or to advance or repay funds to 
us.  Under Indiana laws and regulations, our Indiana insurance subsidiaries, including LNL, our primary insurance subsidiary, may 
pay dividends to us without prior approval of the Commissioner up to a certain threshold, or must receive prior approval of the 
Commissioner to pay a dividend if such dividend, along with all other dividends paid within the preceding 12 consecutive months 
exceed the statutory limitation.  The current Indiana statutory limitation is the greater of 10% of the insurer’s contract holders’ 
surplus, as shown on its last annual statement on file with the Commissioner or the insurer’s statutory net gain from operations for 
the prior calendar year. 

In addition, payments of dividends and advances or repayment of funds to us by our insurance subsidiaries are restricted by the 
applicable laws of their respective jurisdictions requiring that our insurance subsidiaries hold a specified amount of minimum 
reserves in order to meet future obligations on their outstanding policies.  These regulations specify that the minimum reserves 
shall be calculated to be sufficient to meet future obligations, after giving consideration to future required premiums to be received, 
and are based on certain specified mortality and morbidity tables, interest rates and methods of valuation, which are subject to 
change.  In order to meet their claims-paying obligations, our insurance subsidiaries regularly monitor their reserves to ensure we 
hold sufficient amounts to cover actual or expected contract and claims payments.  At times, we may determine that reserves in 
excess of the minimum may be needed to ensure sufficiency. 

Changes in these laws can constrain the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends or to advance or repay funds to us in sufficient 
amounts and at times necessary to meet our debt obligations and corporate expenses.  For example, in September of 2008, the 
NAIC adopted a new statutory reserving standard for variable annuities known as VACARVM, which was effective as of 
December 31, 2009.  This reserving requirement replaced the previous statutory reserving practices for variable annuities with 
guaranteed benefits, and any change in reserving practices has the potential to increase or decrease statutory reserves from 

25 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
previous levels.  Requiring our insurance subsidiaries to hold additional reserves has the potential to constrain their ability to pay 
dividends to the holding company. 

The earnings of our insurance subsidiaries impact contract holders’ surplus.  Principal sources of earnings are insurance premiums 
and fees, annuity considerations and income from our investment portfolio and assets, consisting mainly of cash or assets that are 
readily convertible into cash.  Lower earnings constrain the growth in our insurance subsidiaries’ capital, and therefore, can 
constrain the payment of dividends and advances or repayment of funds to us. 

In addition, the amount of surplus that our insurance subsidiaries could pay as dividends is constrained by the amount of surplus 
they hold to maintain their financial strength ratings, to provide an additional layer of margin for risk protection and for future 
investment in our businesses.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, we believe that our insurance subsidiaries have sufficient liquidity to 
meet their contract holder obligations and maintain their operations. 

The difficulties faced by other financial institutions could adversely affect us. 

We have exposure to many different industries and counterparties, and routinely execute transactions with counterparties in the 
financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, investment banks and other institutions.  Many of 
these transactions expose us to credit risk in the event of default of our counterparty.  In addition, with respect to secured 
transactions, our credit risk may be exacerbated when the collateral held by us cannot be realized upon or is liquidated at prices not 
sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan or derivative exposure due to it.  We also may have exposure to these financial 
institutions in the form of unsecured debt instruments, derivative transactions and/or equity investments.  There can be no 
assurance that any such losses or impairments to the carrying value of these assets would not materially and adversely affect our 
business and results of operations. 

Our participation in a securities lending program and a reverse repurchase program subjects us to potential liquidity 
and other risks. 

We participate in a securities lending program for our general account whereby fixed income securities are loaned by our agent 
bank to third parties, primarily major brokerage firms and commercial banks.  The borrowers of our securities provide us with 
collateral, typically in cash, which we separately maintain.  We invest such cash collateral in other securities, primarily in commercial 
paper and money market or other short term funds.  Securities with a fair value of $199 million were on loan under the program as 
of December 31, 2010.  Securities loaned under such transactions may be sold or repledged by the transferee.  We were liable for 
cash collateral under our control of $192 million as of December 31, 2010. 

We participate in a reverse repurchase program for our general account whereby we sell fixed income securities to third parties, 
primarily major brokerage firms, with a concurrent agreement to repurchase those same securities at a determined future date.  The 
borrowers of our securities provide us with cash collateral which is typically invested in fixed maturity securities.  The fair value of 
securities pledged under reverse repurchase agreements was $294 million as of December 31, 2010. 

As of December 31, 2010, substantially all of the securities on loan under the program could be returned to us by the borrowers at 
any time.  Collateral received under the reverse repurchase program cannot be returned prior to maturity; however, market 
conditions on the repurchase date may limit our ability to enter into new agreements.  The return of loaned securities or our 
inability to enter into new reverse repurchase agreements would require us to return the cash collateral associated with such 
securities.  In addition, in some cases, the maturity of the securities held as invested collateral (i.e., securities that we have 
purchased with cash received from the third parties) may exceed the term of the related securities and the market value may fall 
below the amount of cash received as collateral and invested.  If we are required to return significant amounts of cash collateral on 
short notice and we are forced to sell securities to meet the return obligation, we may have difficulty selling such collateral that is 
invested in securities in a timely manner, and we may be forced to sell securities in a volatile or illiquid market for less than we 
otherwise would have been able to realize under normal market conditions, or both.  In addition, under stressful capital market and 
economic conditions, liquidity broadly deteriorates, which may further restrict our ability to sell securities. 

Our reserves for future policy benefits and claims related to our current and future business as well as businesses we 
may acquire in the future may prove to be inadequate. 

We establish and carry, as a liability, reserves based on estimates of how much we will need to pay for future benefits and claims.  
For our insurance products, we calculate these reserves based on many assumptions and estimates, including, but not limited to, 
estimated premiums we will receive over the assumed life of the policy, the timing of the event covered by the insurance policy, the 
lapse rate of the policies, the amount of benefits or claims to be paid and the investment returns on the assets we purchase with the 
premiums we receive. 

The sensitivity of our statutory reserves and surplus established for our variable annuity base contracts and riders to changes in the 
equity markets will vary depending on the magnitude of the decline.  The sensitivity will be affected by the level of account values 
26 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
relative to the level of guaranteed amounts, product design and reinsurance.  Statutory reserves for variable annuities depend upon 
the cumulative equity market impacts on the business in force, and therefore, result in non-linear relationships with respect to the 
level of equity market performance within any reporting period. 

The assumptions and estimates we use in connection with establishing and carrying our reserves are inherently uncertain.  
Accordingly, we cannot determine with precision the ultimate amount or the timing of the payment of actual benefits and claims or 
whether the assets supporting the policy liabilities will grow to the level we assume prior to payment of benefits or claims.  If our 
actual experience is different from our assumptions or estimates, our reserves may prove to be inadequate in relation to our 
estimated future benefits and claims. 

We completed a conversion of our actuarial valuation systems to a uniform valuation platform during 2010 for certain blocks of 
our Retirement Solutions business, which resulted in an after-tax unfavorable prospective unlocking of $16 million.  We are in the 
process of completing a similar conversion for our Insurance Solutions – Life segment and also have other blocks of Retirement 
Solutions business that we intend to convert in 2011.  The completion of these conversions could have a financial effect.  For 
further information about the results of the conversion completed during 2010, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – 
DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” in the MD&A. 

Because the equity markets and other factors impact the profitability and expected profitability of many of our products, 
changes in equity markets and other factors may significantly affect our business and profitability. 

The fee revenue that we earn on equity-based variable annuities and VUL insurance policies is based upon account values.  Because 
strong equity markets result in higher account values, strong equity markets positively affect our net income through increased fee 
revenue.  Conversely, a weakening of the equity markets results in lower fee income and may have a material adverse effect on our 
results of operations and capital resources. 

The increased fee revenue resulting from strong equity markets increases the expected gross profits (“EGPs) from variable 
insurance products as do better than expected lapses, mortality rates and expenses.  As a result, higher EGPs may result in lower 
net amortized costs related to deferred acquisition costs (“DAC”), deferred sales inducements (“DSI”), value of business acquired 
(“VOBA”), DFEL and changes in future contract benefits.  However, a decrease in the equity markets, as well as worse than 
expected increases in lapses, mortality rates and expenses, depending upon their significance, may result in higher net amortized 
costs associated with DAC, DSI, VOBA, DFEL and changes in future contract benefits and may have a material adverse effect on 
our results of operations and capital resources.  For example, in the fourth quarter of 2008, the last time that we reset our baseline 
of account values from which EGPs are projected, which we refer to as our “reversion to the mean” (“RTM”) process, we had a 
cumulative unfavorable prospective unlocking of $223 million, after-tax.  If unfavorable economic conditions return, additional 
unlocking of our RTM assumptions could be possible in future periods.  However, if we were to have unlocked our RTM 
assumption in the corridor as of December 31, 2010, we would have recorded a favorable prospective unlocking of approximately 
$375 million, pre-tax, for our Retirement Solutions business, and approximately $15 million, pre-tax, for our Insurance Solutions 
business, as a result of improved market conditions since our last unlock of RTM in the fourth quarter of 2008.  For further 
information about our RTM process, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” in the 
MD&A. 

Changes in the equity markets, interest rates and/or volatility affect the profitability of our products with guaranteed 
benefits; therefore, such changes may have a material adverse effect on our business and profitability. 

Certain of our variable annuity products include guaranteed benefit riders.  These include GDB, GWB and GIB riders.  Our GWB, 
GIB and 4LATER® (a form of GIB rider) features have elements of both insurance benefits accounted for under the Financial 
Services – Insurance – Claim Costs and Liabilities for Future Policy Benefits Subtopic of the Financial Accounting Standards 
Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards CodificationTM (“ASC”) (“benefit reserves”) and embedded derivatives accounted for under the 
Derivatives and Hedging and the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topics of the FASB ASC (“embedded derivative 
reserves”). The benefit reserves resulting from a benefit ratio unlocking component are calculated in a manner consistent with our 
GDB, as described below.  We calculate the value of the embedded derivative reserve and the benefit reserves based on the specific 
characteristics of each guaranteed living benefit feature.  The amount of reserves related to GDB for variable annuities is tied to the 
difference between the value of the underlying accounts and the GDB, calculated using a benefit ratio approach.  The GDB 
reserves take into account the present value of total expected GDB payments, the present value of total expected GDB 
assessments over the life of the contract, claims paid to date and assessments to date.  Reserves for our GIB and certain GWB with 
lifetime benefits are based on a combination of fair value of the underlying benefit and a benefit ratio approach that is based on the 
projected future payments in excess of projected future account values.  The benefit ratio approach takes into account the present 
value of total expected GIB payments, the present value of total expected GIB assessments over the life of the contract, claims 
paid to date and assessments to date.  The amount of reserves related to those GWB that do not have lifetime benefits is based on 
the fair value of the underlying benefit. 

27 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Both the level of expected payments and expected total assessments used in calculating the benefit ratio are affected by the equity 
markets.  The liabilities related to fair value are impacted by changes in equity markets, interest rates and volatility.  Accordingly, 
strong equity markets will decrease the amount of reserves that we must carry, and strong equity markets, increases in interest rates 
and decreases in volatility will generally decrease the reserves calculated using fair value.  Conversely, a decrease in the equity 
markets will increase the expected future payments used in the benefit ratio approach, which has the effect of increasing the 
amount of reserves.  Also, a decrease in the equity market along with a decrease in interest rates and an increase in volatility will 
generally result in an increase in the reserves calculated using fair value, which are the conditions we have experienced recently. 

Increases in reserves would result in a charge to our earnings in the quarter in which the increase occurs.  Therefore, we maintain a 
customized dynamic hedge program that is designed to mitigate the risks associated with income volatility around the change in 
reserves on guaranteed benefits.  However, the hedge positions may not be effective to exactly offset the changes in the carrying 
value of the guarantees due to, among other things, the time lag between changes in their values and corresponding changes in the 
hedge positions, high levels of volatility in the equity markets and derivatives markets, extreme swings in interest rates, contract 
holder behavior different than expected, a strategic decision to under- or over-hedge in reaction to extreme market conditions or 
inconsistencies between economic and statutory reserving guidelines and divergence between the performance of the underlying 
funds and hedging indices.  For example, for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, we experienced a breakage on 
our guaranteed living benefits net derivatives results of $(109) million, $(137) million and $176 million, respectively, pre-tax and 
before the associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL and changes in other contract holder funds and funds 
withheld reinsurance liabilities.  Breakage is defined as the difference between the change in the value of the liabilities, excluding 
the amount related to the non-performance risk component, and the change in the fair value of the derivatives.  Breakage can be 
positive or negative.  The non-performance risk factor is required under the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of 
the FASB ASC, which requires us to consider our own credit standing, which is not hedged, in the valuation of certain of these 
liabilities.  A decrease in our own credit spread could cause the value of these liabilities to increase, resulting in a reduction to net 
income.  Conversely, an increase in our own credit spread could cause the value of these liabilities to decrease, resulting in an 
increase to net income. 

In addition, we remain liable for the guaranteed benefits in the event that derivative counterparties are unable or unwilling to pay, 
and we are also subject to the risk that the cost of hedging these guaranteed benefits increases, resulting in a reduction to net 
income.  These, individually or collectively, may have a material adverse effect on net income, financial condition or liquidity. 

Changes in interest rates and sustained low interest rates may cause interest rate spreads to decrease and changes in 
interest rates may also result in increased contract withdrawals. 

Interest rate fluctuations could negatively affect our profitability.  Changes in interest rates may reduce both our profitability from 
spread businesses and our return on invested capital.  Some of our products, principally fixed annuities, interest-sensitive whole 
life, UL and the fixed portion of VUL, have interest rate guarantees that expose us to the risk that changes in interest rates will 
reduce our spread, or the difference between the amounts that we are required to pay under the contracts and the amounts we are 
able to earn on our general account investments intended to support our obligations under the contracts.  Declines in our spread or 
instances where the returns on our general account investments are not enough to support the interest rate guarantees on these 
products could have a material adverse effect on our businesses or results of operations. 

In periods of increasing interest rates, we may not be able to replace the assets in our general account with higher yielding assets 
needed to fund the higher crediting rates necessary to keep our interest-sensitive products competitive.  We therefore may have to 
accept a lower spread and thus lower profitability or face a decline in sales and greater loss of existing contracts and related assets.  
Increases in interest rates may cause increased surrenders and withdrawals of insurance products.  In periods of increasing interest 
rates, policy loans and surrenders and withdrawals of life insurance policies and annuity contracts may increase as contract holders 
seek to buy products with perceived higher returns.  This process may lead to a flow of cash out of our businesses.  These outflows 
may require investment assets to be sold at a time when the prices of those assets are lower because of the increase in market 
interest rates, which may result in realized investment losses.  A sudden demand among consumers to change product types or 
withdraw funds could lead us to sell assets at a loss to meet the demand for funds. 

In periods of declining interest rates, we may have to reinvest the cash we receive as interest or return of principal on our 
investments in lower yielding instruments than currently available, without taking on additional investment risk.  Moreover, 
borrowers may prepay fixed-income securities, commercial mortgages and mortgage-backed securities in our general account in 
order to borrow at lower market rates, which exacerbates this risk.  Because we are entitled to reset the interest rates on our fixed 
rate annuities only at limited, pre-established intervals, and since many of our contracts have guaranteed minimum interest or 
crediting rates, our spreads could decrease and potentially become negative.   

Currently, new money rates continue to be at low levels.  If interests rates were to remain low over a sustained period of time, this 
would put additional pressure on our spreads, potentially resulting in unlocking of our DAC asset and increases in reserves.  We 
would expect the effect to be most pronounced in our Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment.  For additional information 
on interest rate risks, see “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Interest Rate Risk.” 

28 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our requirements to post collateral or make payments related to declines in market value of specified assets may 
adversely affect our liquidity and expose us to counterparty credit risk. 

Many of our transactions with financial and other institutions, including settling futures positions, specify the circumstances under 
which the parties are required to post collateral.  The amount of collateral we may be required to post under these agreements may 
increase under certain circumstances, which could adversely affect our liquidity.  In addition, under the terms of some of our 
transactions, we may be required to make payments to our counterparties related to any decline in the market value of the specified 
assets. 

Losses due to defaults by others could reduce our profitability or negatively affect the value of our investments. 

Third parties that owe us money, securities or other assets may not pay or perform their obligations.  These parties include the 
issuers whose securities we hold, borrowers under the mortgage loans we make, customers, trading counterparties, counterparties 
under swaps and other derivative contracts, reinsurers and other financial intermediaries.  These parties may default on their 
obligations to us due to bankruptcy, lack of liquidity, downturns in the economy or real estate values, operational failure, corporate 
governance issues or other reasons.  A further downturn in the U.S. and other economies could result in increased impairments. 

Defaults on our mortgage loans and write downs of mortgage equity may adversely affect our profitability. 

Our mortgage loans face default risk and are principally collateralized by commercial properties.  Mortgage loans are stated on our 
balance sheet at unpaid principal balance, adjusted for any unamortized premium or discount, deferred fees or expenses, and are 
net of valuation allowances.  We establish valuation allowances for estimated impairments as of the balance sheet date based on 
information, such as the market value of the underlying real estate securing the loan, any third party guarantees on the loan balance 
or any cross collateral agreements and their impact on expected recovery rates.  As of December 31, 2010, there were nine 
impaired mortgage loans, or less than 1% of total mortgage loans, and eight mortgage loans that were two or more payments 
delinquent.  The performance of our mortgage loan investments, however, may fluctuate in the future.  In addition, some of our 
mortgage loan investments have balloon payment maturities.  An increase in the default rate of our mortgage loan investments 
could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. 

Further, any geographic or sector exposure in our mortgage loans may have adverse effects on our investment portfolios and 
consequently on our consolidated results of operations or financial condition.  While we seek to mitigate this risk by having a 
broadly diversified portfolio, events or developments that have a negative effect on any particular geographic region or sector may 
have a greater adverse effect on the investment portfolios to the extent that the portfolios are exposed. 

For information about our risk of write downs of mortgage equity, see “Consolidated Investments – Standby Real Estate Equity 
Commitments” and “Review of Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources – Uses of Capital” in the 
MD&A. 

Our investments are reflected within our consolidated financial statements utilizing different accounting bases, and, 
accordingly, there may be significant differences between cost and fair value that are not recorded in our consolidated 
financial statements. 

Our principal investments are in fixed maturity and equity securities, mortgage loans on real estate, policy loans, short-term 
investments, derivative instruments, limited partnerships and other invested assets.  The carrying value of such investments is as 
follows: 

(cid:2)  Fixed maturity and equity securities are classified as available-for-sale (“AFS”), except for those designated as trading securities, 
and are reported at their estimated fair value.  The difference between the estimated fair value and amortized cost of such 
securities (i.e., unrealized investment gains and losses) is recorded as a separate component of other comprehensive income 
(loss) (“OCI”), net of adjustments to DAC, contract holder related amounts and deferred income taxes; 

(cid:2)  Fixed maturity and equity securities designated as trading securities, which in certain cases support reinsurance arrangements, 
are recorded at fair value with subsequent changes in fair value recognized in realized loss.  However, offsetting the changes to 
fair value of the trading securities are corresponding changes in the fair value of the embedded derivative liability associated 
with the underlying reinsurance arrangement.  In other words, the investment results for the trading securities, including gains 
and losses from sales, are passed directly to the reinsurers through the contractual terms of the reinsurance arrangements.  
However, there are trading securities associated with the disability income business for which the reinsurance agreement with 
Swiss Re was rescinded, and therefore, we now retain the gains and losses on those securities; 
Short-term investments include investments with remaining maturities of one year or less, but greater than three months, at 
the time of acquisition and are stated at amortized cost, which approximates fair value; 

(cid:2) 

(cid:2)  Mortgage loans on real estate are carried at unpaid principal balances, adjusted for any unamortized premiums or discounts 

and deferred fees or expenses, net of valuation allowances; 

29 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(cid:2)  Policy loans are carried at unpaid principal balances; 
(cid:2)  Real estate joint ventures and other limited partnership interests are carried using the equity method of accounting; and 
(cid:2)  Other invested assets consist principally of derivatives with positive fair values.  Derivatives are carried at fair value with 

changes in fair value reflected in income from non-qualifying derivatives and derivatives in fair value hedging relationships.  
Derivatives in cash flow hedging relationships are reflected as a separate component of other comprehensive income or loss. 

Investments not carried at fair value on our consolidated financial statements, principally, mortgage loans, policy loans and real 
estate, may have fair values which are substantially higher or lower than the carrying value reflected on our consolidated financial 
statements.  In addition, unrealized losses are not reflected in net income unless we realize the losses by either selling the security at 
below amortized cost or determine that the decline in fair value is deemed to be other-than-temporary (i.e., impaired).  Each of 
such asset classes is regularly evaluated for impairment under the accounting guidance appropriate to the respective asset class. 

Our valuation of fixed maturity, equity and trading securities may include methodologies, estimations and assumptions 
which are subject to differing interpretations and could result in changes to investment valuations that may materially 
adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition. 

Fixed maturity, equity and trading securities and short-term investments, which are reported at fair value on our Consolidated 
Balance Sheets, represented the majority of our total cash and invested assets.  Pursuant to the Fair Value Measurements and 
Disclosures Topics of the FASB ASC, we have categorized these securities into a three-level hierarchy, based on the priority of the 
inputs to the respective valuation technique.  The fair value hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices in active markets 
for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (Level 3). 

The determination of fair values in the absence of quoted market prices is based on valuation methodologies, securities we deem to 
be comparable and assumptions deemed appropriate given the circumstances.  The fair value estimates are made at a specific point 
in time, based on available market information and judgments about financial instruments, including estimates of the timing and 
amounts of expected future cash flows and the credit standing of the issuer or counterparty.  Factors considered in estimating fair 
value include coupon rate, maturity, estimated duration, call provisions, sinking fund requirements, credit rating, industry sector of 
the issuer and quoted market prices of comparable securities.  The use of different methodologies and assumptions may have a 
material effect on the estimated fair value amounts. 

During periods of market disruption, including periods of significantly increasing/decreasing or high/low interest rates, rapidly 
widening credit spreads or illiquidity, it may be difficult to value certain of our securities if trading becomes less frequent and/or 
market data becomes less observable.  There may be certain asset classes that were in active markets with significant observable 
data that become illiquid due to the current financial environment.  In such cases, more securities may fall to Level 3 and thus 
require more subjectivity and management judgment.  As such, valuations may include inputs and assumptions that are less 
observable or require greater estimation, as well as valuation methods which are more sophisticated or require greater estimation, 
thereby resulting in values which may be less than the value at which the investments may be ultimately sold.  Further, rapidly 
changing and unprecedented credit and equity market conditions could materially impact the valuation of securities as reported 
within our consolidated financial statements and the period-to-period changes in value could vary significantly.  Decreases in value 
may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition. 

Some of our investments are relatively illiquid and are in asset classes that have been experiencing significant market 
valuation fluctuations. 

We hold certain investments that may lack liquidity, such as privately placed fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans, policy loans 
and other limited partnership interests.  These asset classes represented 22% of the carrying value of our total cash and invested 
assets as of December 31, 2010.   

If we require significant amounts of cash on short notice in excess of normal cash requirements or are required to post or return 
collateral in connection with our investment portfolio, derivatives transactions or securities lending activities, we may have 
difficulty selling these investments in a timely manner, be forced to sell them for less than we otherwise would have been able to 
realize, or both. 

The reported value of our relatively illiquid types of investments, our investments in the asset classes described in the paragraph 
above and, at times, our high quality, generally liquid asset classes, do not necessarily reflect the lowest current market price for the 
asset.  If we were forced to sell certain of our assets in the current market, there can be no assurance that we would be able to sell 
them for the prices at which we have recorded them and we might be forced to sell them at significantly lower prices. 

We invest a portion of our invested assets in investment funds, many of which make private equity investments.  The amount and 
timing of income from such investment funds tends to be uneven as a result of the performance of the underlying investments, 
including private equity investments.  The timing of distributions from the funds, which depends on particular events relating to 

30 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
the underlying investments, as well as the funds’ schedules for making distributions and their needs for cash, can be difficult to 
predict.  As a result, the amount of income that we record from these investments can vary substantially from quarter to quarter.  
Recent equity and credit market volatility may reduce investment income for these types of investments. 

In addition, other external factors may cause a drop in value of investments, such as ratings downgrades on asset classes.  For 
example, Congress has proposed legislation to amend the U.S. Bankruptcy Code to permit bankruptcy courts to modify mortgages 
on primary residences, including an ability to reduce outstanding mortgage balances.  Such actions by bankruptcy courts may 
impact the ratings and valuation of our residential mortgage-backed investment securities. 

The determination of the amount of allowances and impairments taken on our investments is highly subjective and 
could materially impact our results of operations or financial position. 

The determination of the amount of allowances and impairments varies by investment type and is based upon our periodic 
evaluation and assessment of known and inherent risks associated with the respective asset class.  Such evaluations and assessments 
are revised as conditions change and new information becomes available.  Management updates its evaluations regularly and 
reflects changes in allowances and impairments in operations as such evaluations are revised.  There can be no assurance that our 
management has accurately assessed the level of impairments taken and allowances reflected in our financial statements.  
Furthermore, additional impairments may need to be taken or allowances provided for in the future.  Historical trends may not be 
indicative of future impairments or allowances. 

We adopted updates to the Investments – Debt and Equity Securities Topic of the FASB ASC for our debt securities effective 
January 1, 2009.  This adoption required that an other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) loss be separated into the amount 
representing the decrease in cash flows expected to be collected, or “credit loss,” which is recognized in earnings, and the amount 
related to all other factors, or “noncredit loss,” which is recognized in OCI.  In addition, the requirement for management to assert 
that it has the intent and ability to hold an impaired security until recovery was replaced by the requirement for management to 
assert if it either has the intent to sell the debt security or if it is more likely than not the entity will be required to sell the debt 
security before recovery of its amortized cost basis.   

We regularly review our AFS securities for declines in fair value that we determine to be other-than-temporary.  For an equity 
security, if we do not have the ability and intent to hold the security for a sufficient period of time to allow for a recovery in value, 
we conclude that an OTTI has occurred, and the amortized cost of the equity security is written down to the current fair value, 
with a corresponding change to realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  When assessing our ability 
and intent to hold the equity security to recovery, we consider, among other things, the severity and duration of the decline in fair 
value of the equity security as well as the cause of decline, a fundamental analysis of the liquidity, business prospects and overall 
financial condition of the issuer. 

For a debt security, if we intend to sell a security or it is more likely than not we will be required to sell a debt security before 
recovery of its amortized cost basis and the fair value of the debt security is below amortized cost, we conclude than an OTTI has 
occurred and the amortized cost is written down to current fair value, with a corresponding charge to realized loss on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income.  If we do not intend to sell a debt security or it is not more likely than not we will be required 
to sell a debt security before recovery of its amortized cost basis but the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected is 
less than the amortized cost of the debt security (referred to as the credit loss), we conclude that an OTTI has occurred and the 
amortized cost is written down to the estimated recovery value with a corresponding charge to realized loss on our Consolidated 
Statements of Income (Loss), as this is also deemed the credit portion of the OTTI.  The remainder of the decline to fair value is 
recorded in OCI to unrealized OTTI on AFS securities on our Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity, as this is 
considered a noncredit (i.e., recoverable) impairment.  Net OTTI recognized in net income (loss) was $152 million, $392 million 
and $851 million, pre-tax, for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  The portion of OTTI recognized 
in OCI for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, was $88 million and $275 million, pre-tax, respectively. 

Related to our unrealized losses, we establish deferred tax assets for the tax benefit we may receive in the event that losses are 
realized.  The realization of significant realized losses could result in an inability to recover the tax benefits and may result in the 
establishment of valuation allowances against our deferred tax assets.  Realized losses or impairments may have a material adverse 
impact on our results of operations and financial position. 

31 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We will be required to pay interest on our capital securities with proceeds from the issuance of qualifying securities if we 
fail to achieve capital adequacy or net income and stockholders’ equity levels. 

As of December 31, 2010, we had approximately $1.5 billion in principal amount of capital securities outstanding.  All of the 
capital securities contain covenants that require us to make interest payments in accordance with an alternative coupon satisfaction 
mechanism (“ACSM”) if we determine that one of the following triggers exists as of the 30th day prior to an interest payment date, 
or the “determination date”: 

1.  LNL’s RBC ratio is less than 175% (based on the most recent annual financial statement filed with the State of Indiana); or 

2.  (i) The sum of our consolidated net income for the four trailing fiscal quarters ending on the quarter that is two quarters prior to 
the most recently completed quarter prior to the determination date is zero or negative, and (ii) our consolidated stockholders’ 
equity (excluding accumulated OCI and any increase in stockholders’ equity resulting from the issuance of preferred stock during a 
quarter), or “adjusted stockholders’ equity,” as of (x) the most recently completed quarter and (y) the end of the quarter that is two 
quarters before the most recently completed quarter, has declined by 10% or more as compared to the quarter that is ten fiscal 
quarters prior to the last completed quarter, or the “benchmark quarter.” 

The ACSM would generally require us to use commercially reasonable efforts to satisfy our obligation to pay interest in full on the 
capital securities with the net proceeds from sales of our common stock and warrants to purchase our common stock with an 
exercise price greater than the market price.  We would have to utilize the ACSM until the trigger events above no longer existed, 
and, in the case of test 2 above, our adjusted stockholders’ equity amount increased or declined by less than 10% as compared to 
the adjusted stockholders’ equity at the end of the benchmark quarter for each interest payment date as to which interest payment 
restrictions were imposed by test 2 above. 

If we were required to utilize the ACSM and were successful in selling sufficient shares of common stock or warrants to satisfy the 
interest payment, we would dilute the current holders of our common stock.  Furthermore, while a trigger event is occurring and if 
we do not pay accrued interest in full, we may not, among other things, pay dividends on or repurchase our capital stock.  Our 
failure to pay interest pursuant to the ACSM will not result in an event of default with respect to the capital securities, nor will a 
nonpayment of interest, unless it lasts for ten consecutive years, although such breaches may result in monetary damages to the 
holders of the capital securities. 

The calculations of RBC, net income (loss) and adjusted stockholders’ equity are subject to adjustments and the capital securities 
are subject to additional terms and conditions as further described in supplemental indentures filed as exhibits to our Forms 8-K 
filed on March 13, 2007, May 17, 2006, and April 20, 2006. 

A decrease in the capital and surplus of our insurance subsidiaries may result in a downgrade to our credit and insurer 
financial strength ratings. 

In any particular year, statutory surplus amounts and RBC ratios may increase or decrease depending on a variety of factors, 
including the amount of statutory income or losses generated by our insurance subsidiaries (which itself is sensitive to equity 
market and credit market conditions), the amount of additional capital our insurance subsidiaries must hold to support business 
growth, changes in reserving requirements, such as VACARVM and principles based reserving, our inability to secure capital 
market solutions to provide reserve relief, such as issuing letters of credit to support captive reinsurance structures, changes in 
equity market levels, the value of certain fixed-income and equity securities in our investment portfolio, the value of certain 
derivative instruments that do not get hedge accounting, changes in interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates, as well as 
changes to the NAIC RBC formulas. The RBC ratio is also affected by the product mix of the in-force book of business (i.e., the 
amount of business without guarantees is not subject to the same level of reserves as the business with guarantees).  Most of these 
factors are outside of our control.  Our credit and insurer financial strength ratings are significantly influenced by the statutory 
surplus amounts and RBC ratios of our insurance company subsidiaries.  The RBC ratio of LNL is an important factor in the 
determination of the credit and financial strength ratings of LNC and its subsidiaries.  In addition, rating agencies may implement 
changes to their internal models that have the effect of increasing or decreasing the amount of statutory capital we must hold in 
order to maintain our current ratings.  In addition, in extreme scenarios of equity market declines, the amount of additional 
statutory reserves that we are required to hold for our variable annuity guarantees may increase at a rate greater than the rate of 
change of the markets.  Increases in reserves reduce the statutory surplus used in calculating our RBC ratios.  To the extent that 
our statutory capital resources are deemed to be insufficient to maintain a particular rating by one or more rating agencies, we may 
seek to raise additional capital through public or private equity or debt financing, which may be on terms not as favorable as in the 
past.  Alternatively, if we were not to raise additional capital in such a scenario, either at our discretion or because we were unable 
to do so, our financial strength and credit ratings might be downgraded by one or more rating agencies.  For more information on 
risks regarding our ratings, see “A downgrade in our financial strength or credit ratings could limit our ability to market products, 
increase the number or value of policies being surrendered and/or hurt our relationships with creditors” below. 

32 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
A downgrade in our financial strength or credit ratings could limit our ability to market products, increase the number 
or value of policies being surrendered and/or hurt our relationships with creditors. 

Nationally recognized rating agencies rate the financial strength of our principal insurance subsidiaries and rate our debt.  Ratings 
are not recommendations to buy our securities.  Each of the rating agencies reviews its ratings periodically, and our current ratings 
may not be maintained in the future.  During 2010, A.M. Best, Fitch and Moody’s each revised their outlook for the U.S. life 
insurance sector to stable, with the exception of S&P, who maintained their outlook at stable.  

Our financial strength ratings, which are intended to measure our ability to meet contract holder obligations, are an important 
factor affecting public confidence in most of our products and, as a result, our competitiveness.  A downgrade of the financial 
strength rating of one of our principal insurance subsidiaries could affect our competitive position in the insurance industry by 
making it more difficult for us to market our products as potential customers may select companies with higher financial strength 
ratings and by leading to increased withdrawals by current customers seeking companies with higher financial strength ratings.  
This could lead to a decrease in fees as net outflows of assets increase, and therefore, result in lower fee income.  Furthermore, 
sales of assets to meet customer withdrawal demands could also result in losses, depending on market conditions.  The interest 
rates we pay on our borrowings are largely dependent on our credit ratings.  A downgrade of our debt ratings could affect our 
ability to raise additional debt, including bank lines of credit, with terms and conditions similar to our current debt, and 
accordingly, likely increase our cost of capital. 

All of our ratings and ratings of our principal insurance subsidiaries are subject to revision or withdrawal at any time by the rating 
agencies, and therefore, no assurance can be given that our principal insurance subsidiaries or we can maintain these ratings.  See 
“Item 1. Business – Ratings” for a complete description of our ratings.  

Certain blocks of our insurance business purchased from third-party insurers under indemnity reinsurance agreements 
may require us to place assets in trust, secure letters of credit or return the business, if the financial strength ratings 
and/or capital ratios of certain insurance subsidiaries are not maintained at specified levels. 

Under certain indemnity reinsurance agreements, one of our insurance subsidiaries, LLANY, provides 100% indemnity reinsurance 
for the business assumed, however, the third-party insurer, or the “cedent,” remains primarily liable on the underlying insurance 
business.  Under these types of agreements, as of December 31, 2010, we held statutory reserves of approximately $3.2 billion.  
These indemnity reinsurance arrangements require that our subsidiary, as the reinsurer, maintain certain insurer financial strength 
ratings and capital ratios.  If these ratings or capital ratios are not maintained, depending upon the reinsurance agreement, the 
cedent may recapture the business, or require us to place assets in trust or provide letters of credit at least equal to the relevant 
statutory reserves.  Under the largest indemnity reinsurance arrangement, we held approximately $2.1 billion of statutory reserves 
as of December 31, 2010.  LLANY must maintain an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B+, an S&P financial strength 
rating of at least BB+ and a Moody’s financial strength rating of at least Ba1, as well as maintain a RBC ratio of at least 160% or an 
S&P capital adequacy ratio of 100%, or the cedent may recapture the business.  Under two other arrangements, by which we 
established approximately $1.0 billion of statutory reserves, LLANY must maintain an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least 
B++, an S&P financial strength rating of at least BBB- and a Moody’s financial strength rating of at least Baa3.  One of these 
arrangements also requires LLANY to maintain an RBC ratio of at least 185% or an S&P capital adequacy ratio of 115%.  Each of 
these arrangements may require LLANY to place assets in trust equal to the relevant statutory reserves.  As of December 31, 2010, 
LLANY’s RBC ratio exceeded the required ratio.  See “Item 1. Business – Ratings” for a complete description of our ratings.   

If the cedent recaptured the business, LLANY would be required to release reserves and transfer assets to the cedent.  Such a 
recapture could adversely impact our future profits.  Alternatively, if LLANY established a security trust for the cedent, the ability 
to transfer assets out of the trust could be severely restricted, thus negatively impacting our liquidity. 

Our businesses are heavily regulated and changes in regulation may affect our insurance subsidiary capital requirements 
or reduce our profitability. 

Our insurance subsidiaries are subject to extensive supervision and regulation in the states in which we do business.  The 
supervision and regulation relate to numerous aspects of our business and financial condition.  The primary purpose of the 
supervision and regulation is the protection of our insurance contract holders, and not our investors.  The extent of regulation 
varies, but generally is governed by state statutes.  These statutes delegate regulatory, supervisory and administrative authority to 
state insurance departments.  This system of supervision and regulation covers, among other things: 

(cid:2) 
Standards of minimum capital requirements and solvency, including RBC measurements; 
(cid:2)  Restrictions of certain transactions between our insurance subsidiaries and their affiliates; 
(cid:2)  Restrictions on the nature, quality and concentration of investments; 
(cid:2)  Restrictions on the types of terms and conditions that we can include in the insurance policies offered by our primary 

insurance operations; 

33 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(cid:2)  Limitations on the amount of dividends that insurance subsidiaries can pay; 
(cid:2)  The existence and licensing status of the company under circumstances where it is not writing new or renewal business; 
(cid:2)  Certain required methods of accounting; 
(cid:2)  Reserves for unearned premiums, losses and other purposes; and 
(cid:2)  Assignment of residual market business and potential assessments for the provision of funds necessary for the settlement of 

covered claims under certain policies provided by impaired, insolvent or failed insurance companies. 

We may be unable to maintain all required licenses and approvals and our business may not fully comply with the wide variety of 
applicable laws and regulations or the relevant authority’s interpretation of the laws and regulations, which may change from time 
to time.  Also, regulatory authorities have relatively broad discretion to grant, renew or revoke licenses and approvals.  If we do not 
have the requisite licenses and approvals or do not comply with applicable regulatory requirements, the insurance regulatory 
authorities could preclude or temporarily suspend us from carrying on some or all of our activities or impose substantial fines.  
Further, insurance regulatory authorities have relatively broad discretion to issue orders of supervision, which permit such 
authorities to supervise the business and operations of an insurance company.  As of December 31, 2010, no state insurance 
regulatory authority had imposed on us any substantial fines or revoked or suspended any of our licenses to conduct insurance 
business in any state or issued an order of supervision with respect to our insurance subsidiaries, which would have a material 
adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition.   

In addition, Lincoln Financial Advisors, Lincoln Financial Securities and LFD, as well as our variable annuities and variable life 
insurance products, are subject to regulation and supervision by the SEC and FINRA.  LNC, as a savings and loan holding 
company, and NCLS are subject to regulation and supervision by the OTS.  As a savings and loan holding company, we are also 
subject to the requirement that our activities be financially-related activities as defined by federal law (which includes insurance 
activities).  These laws and regulations generally grant supervisory agencies and self-regulatory organizations broad administrative 
powers, including the power to limit or restrict the subsidiaries from carrying on their businesses in the event that they fail to 
comply with such laws and regulations. 

Recently, there has been an increase in potential federal initiatives that would affect the financial services industry.   On July 21, 
2010, President Obama signed into law the Dodd-Frank Act, a wide-ranging Act that includes a number of reforms of the financial 
services industry and financial products.  The Dodd-Frank Act includes, among other things, changes to the rules governing 
derivatives; restrictions on proprietary trading by certain entities; the imposition of capital and leverage requirements on bank and 
savings and loan holding companies; a study by the SEC of the rules governing broker-dealers and investment advisers with respect 
to individual investors and investment advice, followed potentially by rulemaking; the creation of a new Federal Insurance Office 
within the U.S. Treasury to gather information regarding the insurance industry; the creation of a resolution authority to unwind 
failing institutions, funded on a post-event basis; the creation of a new Consumer Financial Protection Bureau to protect 
consumers of certain financial products; and changes to executive compensation and certain corporate governance rules, among 
other things.   The Dodd-Frank Act also eliminates the OTS and reallocates the supervisory and regulatory authority over federally 
chartered thrifts to the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and over thrift holding companies to the Federal Reserve Board.  
Enactment of this provision ensures that we and NCLS will each have a new regulator and may be subject to additional regulations.  
Many of the provisions of this legislation require substantial regulatory work prior to implementation and although we do not 
expect the Dodd-Frank Act or the rules to be promulgated thereunder to have a material adverse effect on our results of 
operations, liquidity or capital resources, the ultimate impact of any of these provisions on our results of operations, liquidity or 
capital resources is currently indeterminable. 

Many of the foregoing regulatory or governmental bodies have the authority to review our products and business practices and 
those of our agents and employees.  In recent years, there has been increased scrutiny of our businesses by these bodies, which has 
included more extensive examinations, regular sweep inquiries and more detailed review of disclosure documents.  These 
regulatory or governmental bodies may bring regulatory or other legal actions against us if, in their view, our practices, or those of 
our agents or employees, are improper.  These actions can result in substantial fines, penalties or prohibitions or restrictions on our 
business activities and could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition. 

Attempts to mitigate the impact of Regulation XXX and Actuarial Guideline 38 may fail in whole or in part resulting in 
an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. 

The Model Regulation entitled “Valuation of Life Insurance Policies,” commonly known as “Regulation XXX” or “XXX,” 
requires insurers to establish additional statutory reserves for term life insurance policies with long-term premium guarantees and 
UL policies with secondary guarantees.  In addition, Actuarial Guideline 38 (“AG38”) clarifies the application of XXX with respect 
to certain UL insurance policies with secondary guarantees.  Virtually all of our newly issued term and the great majority of our 
newly issued UL insurance products are now affected by XXX and AG38.  The application of both AG38 and XXX involve 
numerous interpretations.  At times, there may be differences of opinion between management and state insurance departments 
regarding the application of these and other actuarial standards.  Such differences of opinion may lead to a state insurance regulator 
requiring greater reserves to support insurance liabilities than management estimated. 

34 

  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
We also have implemented reinsurance and capital management actions to mitigate the capital impact of XXX and AG38, 
including the use of letters of credit to support the reinsurance provided by captive reinsurance subsidiaries.  In addition, although 
formal details have not been provided, we anticipate the rating agencies may require a portion of these letters of credit to be 
included in our leverage calculations, which would pressure our leverage ratios and potentially our ratings.  Therefore, we cannot 
provide assurance that there will not be regulatory, rating agency or other challenges to the actions we have taken to date.  The 
result of those potential challenges could require us to increase statutory reserves or incur higher operating and/or tax costs. 

We also cannot provide assurance that we will be able to continue to implement actions to mitigate the impact of XXX or AG38 
on future sales of term and UL insurance products.  If we are unable to continue to implement those actions, we may incur higher 
operating costs and lower returns on products sold than we currently anticipate or reduce our sales of these products. 

For further discussion see “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance – Income (Loss) from 
Operations – Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain.”  

Changes in accounting standards issued by the FASB or other standard-setting bodies may adversely affect our financial 
statements. 

Our financial statements are prepared in accordance with GAAP as identified in the FASB ASC.  From time to time, we are 
required to adopt new or revised accounting standards or guidance that are incorporated into the FASB ASC.  It is possible that 
future accounting standards we are required to adopt could change the current accounting treatment that we apply to our 
consolidated financial statements and that such changes could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results 
of operations. 

For example, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2010-26, “Accounting for Costs Associated with 
Acquiring or Renewing Insurance Contracts” (“ASU 2010-26”), which clarifies the types of costs that insurance companies may 
capitalize and amortize over the life of the business.  ASU 2010-26 significantly reduces the amount of acquisition cost that we will 
be able to defer in connection with sales of our insurance products.  Although this will not affect the ultimate profitability of our 
products, we expect it could materially alter the pattern of our earnings.  In addition, the final guidance permits companies to apply 
the guidance retrospectively with a cumulative effect adjustment to the balance sheet.  As of December 31, 2010, our DAC asset 
was $7.6 billion, pre-tax, or $4.9 billion, after-tax.  If we applied the guidance retrospectively, we would write-down a portion of 
our existing DAC asset that we determined did not qualify as a deferred expense.  The amount of the write-down, if any, would 
reduce the amount of future amortization expense.  This guidance is effective for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after 
December 15, 2011.  The ultimate impact to our consolidated financial position and results of operations is currently being 
evaluated.  

In addition, the FASB is working on several projects with the International Accounting Standards Board, which could result in 
significant changes as GAAP converges with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”), including how we account for 
our insurance contracts and financial instruments and how our financial statements are presented.  Furthermore, the SEC is 
considering whether and how to incorporate IFRS into the U.S. financial reporting system.  The accounting changes being 
proposed by the FASB will be a complete change to how we account for and report significant areas of our business, such as 
insurance contracts and DAC.  The effective dates and transition methods are not known; however, issuers may be required to or 
may choose to adopt the new standards retrospectively.  In this case, the issuer will report results under the new accounting 
method as of the effective date, as well as for all periods presented.  The changes to GAAP and ultimate conversion to IFRS will 
impose special demands on issuers in the areas of governance, employee training, internal controls, contract fulfillment and 
disclosure and will likely affect how we manage our business, as it will likely affect other business processes such as design of 
compensation plans, product design, etc. 

Legal and regulatory actions are inherent in our businesses and could result in financial losses or harm our businesses. 

We are, and in the future may be, subject to legal actions in the ordinary course of our insurance and investment management 
operations, both domestically and internationally.  Pending legal actions include proceedings relating to aspects of our businesses 
and operations that are specific to us and proceedings that are typical of the businesses in which we operate.  Some of these 
proceedings have been brought on behalf of various alleged classes of complainants.  In certain of these matters, the plaintiffs are 
seeking large and/or indeterminate amounts, including punitive or exemplary damages.  Substantial legal liability in these or future 
legal or regulatory actions could have a material financial effect or cause significant harm to our reputation, which in turn could 
materially harm our business prospects.  For more information on pending material legal proceedings, see Note 14.  

Changes in U.S. federal income tax law could increase our tax costs and make the products that we sell less desirable. 

Changes to the Internal Revenue Code, administrative rulings or court decisions could increase our effective tax rate, make our 
products less desirable and lower our net income.  For example, on February 14, 2011, the Obama Administration released its fiscal 
year 2012 budget proposal including proposals which, if enacted, would affect the taxation of life insurance companies and certain 
35 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
life insurance products.  If enacted into law, the statutory changes contemplated by the Administration’s revenue proposals would, 
among other things, change the method used to determine the amount of dividend income received by a life insurance company on 
assets held in separate accounts used to support products, including variable life insurance and variable annuity contracts, that are 
eligible for the dividend received deduction.  The dividend received deduction reduces the amount of dividend income subject to 
tax and is a significant component of the difference between our actual tax expense and expected amount determined using the 
federal statutory tax rate of 35%.  Our income tax provision for the year ended December 31, 2010, included a separate account 
dividend received deduction benefit of $94 million.  In addition, the proposals would affect the treatment of COLI policies by 
limiting the availability of certain interest deductions for companies that purchase those policies.  If proposals of this type were 
enacted, our sale of COLI, variable annuities and variable life products could be adversely affected and our actual tax expense 
could increase, reducing earnings. 

Our enterprise risk management policies and procedures may leave us exposed to unidentified or unanticipated risk, 
which could negatively affect our businesses or result in losses. 

We have devoted significant resources to develop our enterprise risk management policies and procedures and expect to continue 
to do so in the future.  Nonetheless, our policies and procedures to identify, monitor and manage risks may not be fully effective.  
Many of our methods of managing risk and exposures are based upon our use of observed historical market behavior or statistics 
based on historical models.  As a result, these methods may not predict future exposures, which could be significantly greater than 
the historical measures indicate, such as the risk of pandemics causing a large number of deaths.  Other risk management methods 
depend upon the evaluation of information regarding markets, clients, catastrophe occurrence or other matters that is publicly 
available or otherwise accessible to us, which may not always be accurate, complete, up-to-date or properly evaluated.  Management 
of operational, legal and regulatory risks requires, among other things, policies and procedures to record properly and verify a large 
number of transactions and events, and these policies and procedures may not be fully effective. 

We face a risk of non-collectibility of reinsurance, which could materially affect our results of operations. 

We follow the insurance practice of reinsuring with other insurance and reinsurance companies a portion of the risks under the 
policies written by our insurance subsidiaries (known as “ceding”).  As of December 31, 2010, we ceded $337.8 billion of life 
insurance in force to reinsurers for reinsurance protection.  Although reinsurance does not discharge our subsidiaries from their 
primary obligation to pay contract holders for losses insured under the policies we issue, reinsurance does make the assuming 
reinsurer liable to the insurance subsidiaries for the reinsured portion of the risk.  As of December 31, 2010, we had $6.5 billion of 
reinsurance receivables from reinsurers for paid and unpaid losses, for which they are obligated to reimburse us under our 
reinsurance contracts.  Of this amount, $3.0 billion related to the sale of our reinsurance business to Swiss Re in 2001 through an 
indemnity reinsurance agreement.  Swiss Re has funded a trust to support this business.  The balance in the trust changes as a result 
of ongoing reinsurance activity and was $1.7 billion as of December 31, 2010.  As a result of Swiss Re’s S&P financial strength 
rating dropping below AA-, Swiss Re was required to fund an additional trust to support this business of approximately $1.5 billion 
as of December 31, 2010, which was established during the fourth quarter of 2009.  Furthermore, approximately $1.1 billion of the 
Swiss Re treaties are funds withheld structures where we have a right of offset on assets backing the reinsurance receivables. 

The balance of the reinsurance is due from a diverse group of reinsurers.  The collectibility of reinsurance is largely a function of 
the solvency of the individual reinsurers.  We perform annual credit reviews on our reinsurers, focusing on, among other things, 
financial capacity, stability, trends and commitment to the reinsurance business.  We also require assets in trust, letters of credit or 
other acceptable collateral to support balances due from reinsurers not authorized to transact business in the applicable 
jurisdictions.  Despite these measures, a reinsurer’s insolvency, inability or unwillingness to make payments under the terms of a 
reinsurance contract, especially Swiss Re, could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition. 

Significant adverse mortality experience may result in the loss of, or higher prices for, reinsurance. 

We reinsure a significant amount of the mortality risk on fully underwritten, newly issued, individual life insurance contracts.  We 
regularly review retention limits for continued appropriateness and they may be changed in the future.  If we were to experience 
adverse mortality or morbidity experience, a significant portion of that would be reimbursed by our reinsurers.  Prolonged or 
severe adverse mortality or morbidity experience could result in increased reinsurance costs, and ultimately, reinsurers not willing to 
offer coverage.  If we are unable to maintain our current level of reinsurance or purchase new reinsurance protection in amounts 
that we consider sufficient, we would either have to be willing to accept an increase in our net exposures or revise our pricing to 
reflect higher reinsurance premiums.  If this were to occur, we may be exposed to reduced profitability and cash flow strain or we 
may not be able to price new business at competitive rates. 

Catastrophes may adversely impact liabilities for contract holder claims and the availability of reinsurance. 

Our insurance operations are exposed to the risk of catastrophic mortality, such as a pandemic, an act of terrorism, natural disaster 
or other event that causes a large number of deaths or injuries.  Significant influenza pandemics have occurred three times in the 
last century, but the likelihood, timing or severity of a future pandemic cannot be predicted.  Additionally, the impact of climate 

36 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
change could cause changes in weather patterns, resulting in more severe and more frequent natural disasters such as forest fires, 
hurricanes, tornados, floods and storm surges.  In our group insurance operations, a localized event that affects the workplace of 
one or more of our group insurance customers could cause a significant loss due to mortality or morbidity claims.  These events 
could cause a material adverse effect on our results of operations in any period and, depending on their severity, could also 
materially and adversely affect our financial condition. 

The extent of losses from a catastrophe is a function of both the total amount of insured exposure in the area affected by the event 
and the severity of the event.  Pandemics, natural disasters and man-made catastrophes, including terrorism, may produce 
significant damage in larger areas, especially those that are heavily populated.  Claims resulting from natural or man-made 
catastrophic events could cause substantial volatility in our financial results for any fiscal quarter or year and could materially reduce 
our profitability or harm our financial condition.  Also, catastrophic events could harm the financial condition of our reinsurers and 
thereby increase the probability of default on reinsurance recoveries.  Accordingly, our ability to write new business could also be 
affected. 

Consistent with industry practice and accounting standards, we establish liabilities for claims arising from a catastrophe only after 
assessing the probable losses arising from the event.  We cannot be certain that the liabilities we have established or applicable 
reinsurance will be adequate to cover actual claim liabilities, and a catastrophic event or multiple catastrophic events could have a 
material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. 

Competition for our employees is intense, and we may not be able to attract and retain the highly skilled people we need 
to support our business. 

Our success depends, in large part, on our ability to attract and retain key people.  Intense competition exists for the key employees 
with demonstrated ability, and we may be unable to hire or retain such employees.  The unexpected loss of services of one or more 
of our key personnel could have a material adverse effect on our operations due to their skills, knowledge of our business, their 
years of industry experience and the potential difficulty of promptly finding qualified replacement employees.  We compete with 
other financial institutions primarily on the basis of our products, compensation, support services and financial position.  Sales in 
our businesses and our results of operations and financial condition could be materially adversely affected if we are unsuccessful in 
attracting and retaining key employees, including financial advisors, wholesalers and other employees, as well as independent 
distributors of our products. 

Our sales representatives are not captive and may sell products of our competitors. 

We sell our annuity and life insurance products through independent sales representatives.  These representatives are not captive, 
which means they may also sell our competitors’ products.  If our competitors offer products that are more attractive than ours, or 
pay higher commission rates to the sales representatives than we do, these representatives may concentrate their efforts in selling 
our competitors’ products instead of ours. 

We may not be able to protect our intellectual property and may be subject to infringement claims. 

We rely on a combination of contractual rights and copyright, trademark, patent and trade secret laws to establish and protect our 
intellectual property.  Although we use a broad range of measures to protect our intellectual property rights, third parties may 
infringe or misappropriate our intellectual property.  We may have to litigate to enforce and protect our copyrights, trademarks, 
patents, trade secrets and know-how or to determine their scope, validity or enforceability, which represents a diversion of 
resources that may be significant in amount and may not prove successful.  Additionally, complex legal and factual determinations 
and evolving laws and court interpretations make the scope of protection afforded our intellectual property uncertain, particularly 
in relation to our patents.  While we believe our patents provide us with a competitive advantage, we cannot be certain that any 
issued patents will be interpreted with sufficient breadth to offer meaningful protection.  In addition, our issued patents may be 
successfully challenged, invalidated, circumvented or found unenforceable so that our patent rights would not create an effective 
competitive barrier.  The loss of intellectual property protection or the inability to secure or enforce the protection of our 
intellectual property assets could have a material adverse effect on our business and our ability to compete. 

We also may be subject to costly litigation in the event that another party alleges our operations or activities infringe upon another 
party’s intellectual property rights.  Third parties may have, or may eventually be issued, patents that could be infringed by our 
products, methods, processes or services.  Any party that holds such a patent could make a claim of infringement against us.  We 
may also be subject to claims by third parties for breach of copyright, trademark, trade secret or license usage rights.  Any such 
claims and any resulting litigation could result in significant liability for damages.  If we were found to have infringed a third-party 
patent or other intellectual property rights, we could incur substantial liability, and in some circumstances could be enjoined from 
providing certain products or services to our customers or utilizing and benefiting from certain methods, processes, copyrights, 
trademarks, trade secrets or licenses, or alternatively could be required to enter into costly licensing arrangements with third parties, 
all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. 

37 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Intense competition could negatively affect our ability to maintain or increase our profitability. 

Our businesses are intensely competitive.  We compete based on a number of factors, including name recognition, service, the 
quality of investment advice, investment performance, product features, price, perceived financial strength and claims-paying and 
credit ratings.  Our competitors include insurers, broker-dealers, financial advisors, asset managers and other financial institutions.  
A number of our business units face competitors that have greater market share, offer a broader range of products or have higher 
financial strength or credit ratings than we do. 

In recent years, there has been substantial consolidation and convergence among companies in the financial services industry 
resulting in increased competition from large, well-capitalized financial services firms.  Many of these firms also have been able to 
increase their distribution systems through mergers or contractual arrangements.  Furthermore, larger competitors may have lower 
operating costs and an ability to absorb greater risk while maintaining their financial strength ratings, thereby allowing them to 
price their products more competitively.  We expect consolidation to continue and perhaps accelerate in the future, thereby 
increasing competitive pressure on us. 

Anti-takeover provisions could delay, deter or prevent our change in control, even if the change in control would be 
beneficial to LNC shareholders. 

We are an Indiana corporation subject to Indiana state law.  Certain provisions of Indiana law could interfere with or restrict 
takeover bids or other change in control events affecting us.  Also, provisions in our articles of incorporation, bylaws and other 
agreements to which we are a party could delay, deter or prevent our change in control, even if a change in control would be 
beneficial to shareholders.  In addition, under Indiana law, directors may, in considering the best interests of a corporation, 
consider the effects of any action on shareholders, employees, suppliers and customers of the corporation and the communities in 
which offices and other facilities are located, and other factors the directors consider pertinent.  One statutory provision prohibits, 
except under specified circumstances, LNC from engaging in any business combination with any shareholder who owns 10% or 
more of our common stock (which shareholder, under the statute, would be considered an “interested shareholder”) for a period 
of five years following the time that such shareholder became an interested shareholder, unless such business combination is 
approved by the board of directors prior to such person becoming an interested shareholder.  In addition, our articles of 
incorporation contain a provision requiring holders of at least three-fourths of our voting shares then outstanding and entitled to 
vote at an election of directors, voting together, to approve a transaction with an interested shareholder rather than the simple 
majority required under Indiana law. 

In addition to the anti-takeover provisions of Indiana law, there are other factors that may delay, deter or prevent our change in 
control.  As an insurance holding company, we are regulated as an insurance holding company and are subject to the insurance 
holding company acts of the states in which our insurance company subsidiaries are domiciled.  The insurance holding company 
acts and regulations restrict the ability of any person to obtain control of an insurance company without prior regulatory approval.  
Under those statutes and regulations, without such approval (or an exemption), no person may acquire any voting security of a 
domestic insurance company, or an insurance holding company which controls an insurance company, or merge with such a 
holding company, if as a result of such transaction such person would “control” the insurance holding company or insurance 
company.  “Control” is generally defined as the direct or indirect power to direct or cause the direction of the management and 
policies of a person and is presumed to exist if a person directly or indirectly owns or controls 10% or more of the voting securities 
of another person.  Similarly, as a result of our ownership of NCLS, LNC is considered to be a savings and loan holding company.  
Federal banking laws generally provide that no person may acquire control of LNC, and gain indirect control of NCLS without 
prior regulatory approval.  Generally, beneficial ownership of 10% or more of the voting securities of LNC would be presumed to 
constitute control. 

Item 1B.  Unresolved Staff Comments 

None. 

Item 2.  Properties 

As of December 31, 2010, LNC and our subsidiaries owned or leased approximately 3.5 million square feet of office space.  We 
leased 0.1 million square feet of office space in Philadelphia, Pennsylvania for LFN.  We leased 0.2 million square feet of office 
space in Radnor, Pennsylvania for our corporate center and for LFD.  We owned or leased 0.8 million square feet of office space in 
Fort Wayne, Indiana, primarily for our Retirement Solutions – Annuities and Retirements Solutions – Defined Contribution 
segments.  We owned or leased 0.8 million square feet of office space in Greensboro, North Carolina, primarily for our Insurance 
Solutions – Life Insurance segment.  We owned or leased 0.3 million square feet of office space in Omaha, Nebraska, primarily for 
our Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment.  An additional 1.3 million square feet of office space is owned or leased in 
other U.S. cities for branch offices.  As provided in Note 14, the rental expense on operating leases for office space and equipment 
was $46 million for 2010.  This discussion regarding properties does not include information on investment properties. 

38 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Item 3.  Legal Proceedings 

For information regarding legal proceedings, see “Regulatory and Litigation Matters” in Note 14, which is incorporated herein by 
reference.  

Item 4.  Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders 

During the fourth quarter of 2010, no matters were submitted to security holders for a vote. 

Executive Officers of the Registrant 

Executive Officers of the Registrant as of February 20, 2011, were as follows: 

Name 

   Age (1)    

Position with LNC and Business Experience During the Past Five Years 

Dennis R. Glass 

61   

Lisa M. Buckingham 

45   

Charles C. Cornelio 

51   

Frederick J. Crawford 

47   

Robert W. Dineen 

61   

Randal J. Freitag 

48   

Wilford H. Fuller 

40   

Nicole S. Jones 

40   

Mark E. Konen 

51   

President, Chief Executive Officer and Director (since July 2007).  President, Chief Operating 
Officer and Director (April 2006 - July 2007).  President and Chief Executive Officer, Jefferson-
Pilot (2004 - April 2006).  President and Chief Operating Officer, Jefferson-Pilot (2001 - April 
2006). 

Senior Vice President, Chief Human Resources Officer (since December 2008).  Senior Vice 
President, Global Talent, Thomson Reuters, a provider of information and services for 
businesses and professionals (April 2008 - November 2008).  Senior Vice President, Human 
Resources, Thomson Corporation (2002 - April 2008). 

President, Defined Contribution (since December 2009).  Executive Vice President, Chief 
Administrative Officer (November 2008 - December 2009).  Senior Vice President, Shared 
Services and Chief Information Officer (April 2006 - November 2008).  Executive Vice 
President, Technology and Insurance Services, Jefferson-Pilot (2004 - April 2006).  Senior Vice 
President, Jefferson-Pilot (1997 - 2004). 

Executive Vice President and Head of Corporate Development and Investments (since January 
2011).  Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (since November 2008).  Senior 
Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (2005 - November 2008).  Vice President and 
Treasurer (2001 - 2004). 

President, Lincoln Financial Network, and CEO, Lincoln Financial Advisors (2) (since 2002).  
Senior Vice President, Managed Asset Group, Merrill Lynch & Co., a diversified financial 
services company (2001 - 2002). 

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (since January 2011).  Senior Vice 
President, Chief Risk Officer (2007 - December 2010).  Senior Vice President, Chief Risk Officer 
and Treasurer (2007 - October 2009).  Senior Vice President, Product Risk and Profitability and 
Actuary (2004 - 2007). 

President and CEO, Lincoln Financial Distributors (2) (since February 2009).  Head, 
Distribution, Global Wealth Management, Merrill Lynch & Co., a diversified financial services 
company (2007 - 2009).  Head, Distribution, Managed Solutions Group, Merrill Lynch & Co. 
(2005 - 2007).  National Sales Manager, Merrill Lynch & Co. (2000 - 2005). 

Senior Vice President, General Counsel (since May 2010).  Deputy General Counsel, Corporate 
Secretary and Chief Counsel, CIGNA Corporation, a global health services company (September 
2006 - May 2010).  Chief Counsel, Securities, International Paper, a global manufacturer of paper 
products (February 2006 - September 2006).  Vice President, Corporate and Securities, MCI 
Corporation, a telecommunications company (2003 - 2006). 

President, Insurance and Retirement Solutions (since July 2008 and February 2009 respectively).  
President, Individual Markets (April 2006 - July 2008).  Executive Vice President, Life and 
Annuity Manufacturing, Jefferson-Pilot (2004 - April 2006).  Executive Vice President, 
Product/Financial Management, Jefferson-Pilot (2002 - 2004). 

(1)  Age shown is based on the officer’s age as of February 20, 2011. 
(2)  Denotes an affiliate of LNC.  

39 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
PART II 

Item 5.  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity 
Securities  

(a)  Stock Market and Dividend Information  

Our common stock is traded on the New York and Chicago stock exchanges under the symbol LNC.  As of January 29, 2011, the 
number of shareholders of record of our common stock was 10,608.  The dividend on our common stock is declared each quarter 
by our Board of Directors if we are eligible to pay dividends and the Board determines that we will pay dividends.  In determining 
dividends, the Board takes into consideration items such as our financial condition, including current and expected earnings, 
projected cash flows and anticipated financing needs.  For potential restrictions on our ability to pay dividends, see “Review of 
Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources” in “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of 
Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Note 21 in the accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements 
presented in “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data,” as well as in “Part I – Item 1. Business – Regulatory – 
Insurance Regulation – Restriction on Subsidiaries’ Dividends and Other Payments.”  The following presents the high and low 
prices for our common stock on the New York Stock Exchange during the periods indicated and the dividends declared per share 
during such periods: 

2010  
High 
Low 
Dividend declared 

2009  
High 
Low 
Dividend declared 

(b)  Not Applicable  

1st Qtr 

2nd Qtr 

3rd Qtr 

4th Qtr 

$ 

$ 

 30.74    $
 22.52   
 0.010   

 33.55    $
 23.86   
 0.010   

 26.83    $
 20.65   
 0.010   

 29.12   
 23.17   
 0.050   

 25.59    $
 4.90   
 0.010   

 19.99    $
 5.52   
 0.010   

 27.82    $
 14.34   
 0.010   

 28.10   
 21.99   
 0.010   

(c)  Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities  

The following summarizes purchases of equity securities by the issuer during the quarter ended December 31, 2010 (dollars in 
millions, except per share data):  

(a) Total  
Number  
 of Shares  
 (or Units)  
   Purchased (1) 

(b) Average    

  Price Paid 
per Share 
(or Unit) 

(c) Total Number  
of Shares (or Units)  
Purchased as Part of  
Publicly Announced  
  Plans or Programs (2) 

   (d) Approximate Dollar 
Value of Shares (or   
   Units) that May Yet Be 
   Purchased Under the  
   Plans or Programs (3) 

 2,096    $

 715,250   

 333,803 

 24.21   

 24.00   

 23.60   

 - 

$ 

 715,100   

 333,189   

 1,140 

 1,122 

 1,115 

Period 
10/1/10 - 10/31/10 

11/1/10 - 11/30/10 

12/1/10 - 12/31/10 

(1)  Of the total number of shares purchased, no shares were received in connection with the exercise of stock options and related 

taxes and 2,860 shares were withheld for taxes on the vesting of restricted stock.  For the quarter ended December 31, 2010, 
there were 1,048,289 shares purchased as part of publicly announced plans or programs.   

(2)  On February 23, 2007, our Board approved a $2.0 billion increase to our securities repurchase authorization, bringing the total 
authorization at that time to $2.6 billion.  As of December 31, 2010, our security repurchase authorization was $1.1 billion.  
The security repurchase authorization does not have an expiration date.  The amount and timing of share repurchase depends 
on key capital ratios, rating agency expectations, the generation of free cash flow and an evaluation of the costs and benefits 
associated with alternative uses of capital.  The shares repurchased in connection with the awards described in Note 20 in the 
accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements presented in “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary 
Data” are not included in our security repurchase.  

(3)  As of the last day of the applicable month. 

40 

 
  
  
 
                    
 
 
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
                   
  
  
    
  
 
                 
  
  
  
 
                 
  
 
 
                 
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
(d)  Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans 

For information on securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans, see “Part III – Item 12. Security 
Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters,” which is incorporated herein by 
reference.  

Item 6.  Selected Financial Data 

The following selected financial data (in millions, except per share data) should be read in conjunction with “Item 7. Management’s 
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and the accompanying notes to the consolidated 
financial statements presented in “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”  Some previously reported amounts 
have been reclassified to conform to the presentation as of and for the year ended December 31, 2010.  

Total revenues  
Income (loss) from continuing operations  
Net income (loss)  
Per share data: (1)(2) 
   Income (loss) from continuing   
      operations - basic  
   Income (loss) from continuing   
      operations - diluted  
   Net income (loss) - basic  
   Net income (loss) - diluted  
   Common stock dividends  

Assets  
Long-term debt  
Stockholders' equity  
Per common share data: (1) 
   Stockholders' equity, including   
      accumulated other comprehensive  
      income (loss) (3) 
   Stockholders' equity, excluding   
      accumulated other comprehensive  
      income (loss) (3) 
   Market value of common stock  

$

2010  
 10,407    $
 951   
 980   

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2007  
2008  
2009  

 8,499    $
 (415)  
 (485)  

 9,224    $ 
 (10)  
 57   

 9,614    $
 1,199   
 1,215   

2006  

 8,002 
 1,199 
 1,316 

$

 2.53    $

 (1.60)   $

 (0.04)   $ 

 4.44    $

 4.75 

 2.45   
 2.62   
 2.54   
 0.080   

 (1.60)  
 (1.85)  
 (1.85)  
 0.040   

 (0.04)  
 0.22   
 0.22   
 1.455   

 4.37   
 4.50   
 4.43   
 1.600   

 4.68 
 5.21 
 5.13 
 1.535 

2010  

2009  

As of December 31, 
2008  
$  193,824    $  177,433    $  163,136    $   191,435    $  178,495 
 3,458 
 12,201 

 5,050   
 11,700   

 4,618   
 11,718   

 5,399   
 12,806   

 4,731   
 7,977   

2007  

2006  

$

 40.54    $

 36.02    $

 31.15    $ 

 44.32    $

 44.21 

 38.17   
 27.81   

 36.89   
 24.88   

 42.09   
 18.84   

 43.46   
 58.22   

 41.99 
 66.40 

(1)   Per share amounts were affected by the issuance of 112.3 million shares for the acquisition of Jefferson-Pilot in 2006 and the 
retirement of 1.1 million, less than 1 million, 9.3 million, 15.4 million and 16.9 million shares of common stock during the 
years ended December 31, 2010, 2009, 2008, 2007 and 2006, respectively. 

(2)  For discussion of the reduction of net income (loss) available to common stockholders see Note 15 in the accompanying notes 

to the consolidated financial statements presented in “Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”  

(3)  Per share amounts are calculated under the assumption that our Series A preferred stock has been converted to common 

stock, but exclude Series B preferred stock balances as it was non-convertible. 

41 

 
 
 
 
                          
                           
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
                          
                           
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Item 7.  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations 

The following Management’s Discussion and Analysis (“MD&A”) is intended to help the reader understand the financial condition 
as of December 31, 2010, compared with December 31, 2009, and the results of operations in 2010 and 2009, compared with the 
immediately preceding year of Lincoln National Corporation and its consolidated subsidiaries.  Unless otherwise stated or the 
context otherwise requires, “LNC,” “Lincoln,” “Company,” “we,” “our” or “us” refers to Lincoln National Corporation and its 
consolidated subsidiaries.  The MD&A is provided as a supplement to, and should be read in conjunction with our consolidated 
financial statements and the accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements (“Notes”) presented in “Part II – Item 8. 
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data,” as well as “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors” above. 

In this report, in addition to providing consolidated revenues and net income (loss), we also provide segment operating revenues 
and income (loss) from operations because we believe they are meaningful measures of revenues and the profitability of our 
operating segments.  Income (loss) from operations is net income recorded in accordance with United States of America generally 
accepted accounting principles (“GAAP”) excluding the after-tax effects of the following items, as applicable: 

(cid:2)  Realized gains and losses associated with the following (“excluded realized gain (loss)”):  

Sales or disposals of securities;  
Impairments of securities; 

(cid:5) 
(cid:5) 
(cid:5)  Change in the fair value of derivative investments, embedded derivatives within certain reinsurance arrangements and our 

trading securities; 

(cid:5)  Change in the fair value of the derivatives we own to hedge our guaranteed death benefit (“GDB”) riders within our 

variable annuities, which is referred to as “GDB derivatives results”;  

(cid:5)  Change in the fair value of the embedded derivatives of our guaranteed living benefit (“GLB”) riders within our variable 
annuities accounted for under the Derivatives and Hedging and the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topics of 
the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards CodificationTM (“ASC”) (“embedded derivative 
reserves”), net of the change in the fair value of the derivatives we own to hedge the changes in the embedded derivative 
reserves, the net of which is referred to as “GLB net derivative results”; and 

(cid:5)  Changes in the fair value of the embedded derivative liabilities related to index call options we may purchase in the future 
to hedge contract holder index allocations applicable to future reset periods for our indexed annuity products accounted 
for under the Derivatives and Hedging and the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topics of the FASB ASC 
(“indexed annuity forward-starting option”). 

(cid:2)  Change in reserves accounted for under the Financial Services – Insurance – Claim Costs and Liabilities for Future Policy 
Benefits Subtopic of the FASB ASC resulting from benefit ratio unlocking on our GDB and GLB riders (“benefit ratio 
unlocking”); 
Income (loss) from the initial adoption of new accounting standards; 
Income (loss) from reserve changes (net of related amortization) on business sold through reinsurance; 

(cid:2) 
(cid:2) 
(cid:2)  Gain (loss) on early extinguishment of debt; 
(cid:2)  Losses from the impairment of intangible assets; and 
(cid:2) 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations. 

Income (loss) from operations available to common stockholders is net income (loss) available to common stockholders (used in 
the calculation of earnings (loss) per share) in accordance with GAAP, excluding the after-tax effects of the items above and the 
acceleration of our Series B preferred stock discount as a result of redemption prior to five years from the date of issuance.   

Operating revenues represent GAAP revenues excluding the pre-tax effects of the following items, as applicable: 

(cid:2)  Excluded realized gain (loss); 
(cid:2)  Amortization of deferred front-end loads (“DFEL”) arising from changes in GDB and GLB benefit ratio unlocking; 
(cid:2)  Amortization of deferred gains arising from the reserve changes on business sold through reinsurance; and 
(cid:2)  Revenue adjustments from the initial adoption of new accounting standards. 

Operating revenues and income (loss) from operations are the financial performance measures we use to evaluate and assess the 
results of our segments.  Accordingly, we report operating revenues and income (loss) from operations by segment in Note 23.  
Our management believes that operating revenues and income (loss) from operations explain the results of our ongoing businesses 
in a manner that allows for a better understanding of the underlying trends in our current businesses because the excluded items 
are unpredictable and not necessarily indicative of current operating fundamentals or future performance of the business segments, 
and, in many instances, decisions regarding these items do not necessarily relate to the operations of the individual segments.  In 
addition, we believe that our definitions of operating revenues and income (loss) from operations will provide investors with a 
more valuable measure of our performance because it better reveals trends in our business.   

42 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We use our prevailing corporate federal income tax rate of 35% while taking into account any permanent differences for events 
recognized differently in our financial statements and federal income tax returns when reconciling our non-GAAP measures to the 
most comparable GAAP measure.  Operating revenues and income (loss) from operations do not replace revenues and net income 
as the GAAP measures of our consolidated results of operations. 

Certain reclassifications have been made to prior periods’ financial information.   

FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS – CAUTIONARY LANGUAGE 

Certain statements made in this report and in other written or oral statements made by us or on our behalf are “forward-looking 
statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 (“PSLRA”).  A forward-looking statement 
is a statement that is not a historical fact and, without limitation, includes any statement that may predict, forecast, indicate or imply 
future results, performance or achievements, and may contain words like:  “believe,” “anticipate,” “expect,” “estimate,” “project,” 
“will,” “shall” and other words or phrases with similar meaning in connection with a discussion of future operating or financial 
performance.  In particular, these include statements relating to future actions, trends in our businesses, prospective services or 
products, future performance or financial results and the outcome of contingencies, such as legal proceedings.  We claim the 
protection afforded by the safe harbor for forward-looking statements provided by the PSLRA.  

Forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to differ materially from the results 
contained in the forward-looking statements.  Risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to vary materially, some of 
which are described within the forward-looking statements, include, among others:   

(cid:2)  Deterioration in general economic and business conditions that may affect account values, investment results, guaranteed 

benefit liabilities, premium levels, claims experience and the level of pension benefit costs, funding and investment results;  
(cid:2)  Economic declines and credit market illiquidity could cause us to realize additional impairments on investments and certain 
intangible assets, including goodwill and a valuation allowance against deferred tax assets, which may reduce future earnings 
and/or affect our financial condition and ability to raise additional capital or refinance existing debt as it matures;  
(cid:2)  Because of our holding company structure, the inability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends to the holding company in 

sufficient amounts could harm the holding company’s ability to meet its obligations; 

(cid:2)  Legislative, regulatory or tax changes, both domestic and foreign, that affect the cost of, or demand for, our subsidiaries’ 
products, the required amount of reserves and/or surplus, or otherwise affect our ability to conduct business, including 
changes to statutory reserves and/or risk-based capital (“RBC”) requirements related to secondary guarantees under universal 
life and variable annuity products such as Actuarial Guideline 43 (“AG43,” also known as Commissioners Annuity Reserve 
Valuation Method for Variable Annuities or “VACARVM”); restrictions on revenue sharing and 12b-1 payments; and the 
potential for U.S. Federal tax reform; 

(cid:2)  Uncertainty about the effect of rules and regulations to be promulgated under the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and 
Consumer Protection Act (“Dodd-Frank Act”) on us and the economy and the financial services sector in particular; 
(cid:2)  The initiation of legal or regulatory proceedings against us, and the outcome of any legal or regulatory proceedings, such as:  
adverse actions related to present or past business practices common in businesses in which we compete; adverse decisions in 
significant actions including, but not limited to, actions brought by federal and state authorities and extra-contractual and class 
action damage cases; new decisions that result in changes in law; and unexpected trial court rulings; 

(cid:2)  Changes in or sustained low interest rates causing reductions of investment income, estimated gross profits relating to our 
variable annuity and universal life products, margins of our subsidiaries’ fixed annuity and life insurance businesses and 
demand for their products;  

(cid:2)  A decline in the equity markets causing a reduction in the sales of our subsidiaries’ products, a reduction of asset-based fees 
that our subsidiaries charge on various investment and insurance products, an acceleration of amortization of deferred 
acquisition costs (“DAC”), value of business acquired (“VOBA”), deferred sales inducements (“DSI”) and DFEL and an 
increase in liabilities related to guaranteed benefit features of our subsidiaries’ variable annuity products; 
Ineffectiveness of our various hedging strategies used to offset the effect of changes in the value of liabilities due to changes in 
the level and volatility of the equity markets and interest rates; 

(cid:2) 

(cid:2)  A deviation in actual experience regarding future persistency, mortality, morbidity, interest rates or equity market returns from 

the assumptions used in pricing our subsidiaries’ products, in establishing related insurance reserves and in elevated 
impairments on investments and amortization of intangible assets that may cause an increase in reserves and/or a reduction in 
assets, resulting in a corresponding decrease in net income;  

(cid:2)  Changes in GAAP, including moving to International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”), as well as the methodologies, 

estimations and assumptions thereunder, that may result in unanticipated changes to our net income; 

(cid:2)  Lowering of one or more of our debt ratings issued by nationally recognized statistical rating organizations and the adverse 

effect such action may have on our ability to raise capital and on our liquidity and financial condition; 

(cid:2)  Lowering of one or more of the insurer financial strength ratings of our insurance subsidiaries and the adverse effect such 
action may have on the premium writings, policy retention, profitability of our insurance subsidiaries and liquidity; 

43 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
(cid:2) 

Significant credit, accounting, fraud or corporate governance issues that may adversely affect the value of certain investments 
in our portfolios requiring that we realize losses on such investments; 

(cid:2)  The effect of acquisitions and divestitures, restructurings, product withdrawals and other unusual items, including our ability to 

integrate acquisitions and to obtain the anticipated results and synergies from acquisitions; 

(cid:2)  The adequacy and collectibility of reinsurance that we have purchased; 
(cid:2)  Acts of terrorism, a pandemic, war or other man-made and natural catastrophes that may adversely affect our businesses and 

the cost and availability of reinsurance; 

(cid:2)  Competitive conditions, including pricing pressures, new product offerings and the emergence of new competitors, that may 

affect the level of premiums and fees that our subsidiaries can charge for their products; 

(cid:2)  The unknown effect on our subsidiaries’ businesses resulting from changes in the demographics of their client base, as aging 

baby-boomers move from the asset-accumulation stage to the asset-distribution stage of life; and 

(cid:2)  Loss of key management, financial planners or wholesalers. 

The risks included here are not exhaustive.  Other sections of this report, our quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on 
Form 8-K and other documents filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) include additional factors that could 
affect our businesses and financial performance, including “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors,” “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative and 
Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” and the risk discussions included in this section under “Critical Accounting Policies 
and Estimates,” “Consolidated Investments” and “Reinsurance,” which are incorporated herein by reference.  Moreover, we 
operate in a rapidly changing and competitive environment.  New risk factors emerge from time to time, and it is not possible for 
management to predict all such risk factors.  

Further, it is not possible to assess the effect of all risk factors on our businesses or the extent to which any factor, or combination 
of factors, may cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements.  Given these risks 
and uncertainties, investors should not place undue reliance on forward-looking statements as a prediction of actual results.  In 
addition, we disclaim any obligation to update any forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances that occur after 
the date of this report.   

INTRODUCTION 

Executive Summary  

We are a holding company that operates multiple insurance and retirement businesses through subsidiary companies.  Through our 
business segments, we sell a wide range of wealth protection, accumulation and retirement income products and solutions.  These 
products include fixed and indexed annuities, variable annuities, universal life insurance (“UL”), variable universal life insurance 
(“VUL”), linked-benefit UL, term life insurance, mutual funds and group life, disability and dental. 

We provide products and services in two operating businesses and report results through four business segments as follows: 

Business 
Retirement Solutions 

  Corresponding Segments 
  Annuities 
  Defined Contribution 

Insurance Solutions 

  Life Insurance 
  Group Protection 

Our individual products and services and defined contribution plans are distributed primarily through consultants, brokers, 
planners, agents and other intermediaries with sales and marketing support provided by approximately 500 wholesalers within 
Lincoln Financial Distributors (“LFD”), our wholesaling distributor.  Our retail distributor, Lincoln Financial Network, offers 
proprietary and non-proprietary products and advisory services through a national network of approximately 8,000 active 
producers who placed business with us within the last twelve months.  Our Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment 
distributes its products and services primarily through employee benefit brokers, third party administrators and other employee 
benefit firms with sales support provided by its group and retirement sales specialists.   

These operating businesses and their segments are described in “Part I – Item 1. Business” above. 

We also have Other Operations, which includes the financial data for operations that are not directly related to the business 
segments.  Other Operations also includes investments related to the excess capital in our insurance subsidiaries; investments in 
media properties and other corporate investments; benefit plan net liability; the unamortized deferred gain on indemnity 
reinsurance related to the sale of reinsurance to Swiss Re in 2001; the results of certain disability income business due to the 
rescission of a reinsurance agreement with Swiss Re; our run-off Institutional Pension business; and debt costs. 

44 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
Our former Lincoln UK and Investment Management segments are reported in discontinued operations for all periods presented.  
See “Acquisitions and Dispositions” and Note 3 for more information.  

For information on how we derive our revenues, see the discussion in results of operations by segment below. 

Current Market Conditions 

Although economic conditions have improved, the following concerns are still weighing on the U.S. economy: 

(cid:2)  Persistent high unemployment; and 
(cid:2) 

Slow U.S. housing market. 

The National Bureau of Economic Research, a panel of economists charged with officially designating business cycles, announced 
on September 20, 2010, that the recession that began in December 2007 ended in June 2009, lasting 18 months.  However, we are 
still in the midst of a somewhat fragile recovery. 

In the face of these economic challenges, we continue to focus on building our businesses through these difficult markets and 
beyond by developing and introducing high quality products, expanding distribution in new and existing key accounts and channels 
and targeting market segments that have high growth potential while maintaining a disciplined approach to managing our expenses.   

Significant Operational Matters  

Adequacy of Our Liquidity and Capital Positions 

During 2010, as a result of the improvements in the economy and capital markets, as well as the strength of our business model 
and our capital position, we took the following measures to address matters that we believed had been depressing our stock price, 
provide returns to our stockholders and/or manage our liquidity and capital positions:  

(cid:2)  We funded, on June 30, 2010, the $950 million repurchase of our Series B preferred stock that we had issued to the U.S. 

Department of the Treasury (“U.S. Treasury”) as part of our participation in the Capital Purchase Program (“CPP”) with net 
proceeds of approximately $368 million from a common stock offering, proceeds from a $250 million five-year senior notes 
offering and cash held at our holding company that was attributable primarily to proceeds from the sale of Delaware 
Management Holdings, Inc. (“Delaware”); 

(cid:2)  We secured $2 billion of bank credit facilities in the second quarter of 2010, to address the upcoming maturity of credit 

facilities in the first quarter of 2011 related to letters of credit (“LOCs”) supporting our life insurance business that could have 
remained outstanding until the first quarter of 2012; 

(cid:2)  We completed a 30-year senior notes offering of $500 million, the proceeds of which were used in the third quarter of 2010 as 

part of a long-term financing solution supporting UL business with secondary guarantees; 

(cid:2)  We paid $48 million to repurchase 2,899,159 warrants (each representing the right to purchase one share of our common 

stock) held by the U.S. Treasury during the U.S. Treasury’s public auction of our warrants during the third quarter of 2010, 
which were subsequently canceled;    

(cid:2)  We increased the dividend on our common stock during the fourth quarter of 2010 from $0.01 to $0.05 per share;  
(cid:2)  We also announced a plan to repurchase up to $125 million of common stock under our security repurchase authorization and 

completed $25 million of stock repurchases during the fourth quarter of 2010; 

(cid:2)  We redeemed all of our outstanding 6.75% Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debentures, Series F due 2052 (the “junior 

subordinated debentures”), which were held by Lincoln National Capital VI, during the fourth quarter of 2010; and   
(cid:2)  Effective December 31, 2010, we financed, for up to 30 years, reserves supporting our life insurance business, replacing the 

use of $500 million in LOCs. 

Certain of these matters are discussed in more detail in “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance – 
Income (Loss) from Operations – Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain” and “Review of Consolidated Financial 
Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources – Financing Activities” below. 

During May and June of 2010, Moody’s Investors Service (“Moody’s”), Fitch Ratings (“Fitch”) and A.M. Best Co. (“A.M. Best”) all 
improved their outlook on our company to stable from negative, and Standard & Poor’s (“S&P”) outlook remained stable.  For 
more information about ratings, see “Part I – Item 1. Business – Ratings.” 

45 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses 

Because the profitability of our fixed annuity, UL, VUL and defined contribution insurance business depends in part on interest 
rate spreads, interest rate fluctuations could negatively affect our profitability.  Changes in interest rates may reduce both our 
profitability from spread businesses and our return on invested capital.  Some of our products, principally our fixed annuities, UL 
and VUL, have interest rate guarantees that expose us to the risk that changes in interest rates or prolonged low interest rates will 
reduce our spread, or the difference between the interest that we are required to credit to contracts and the yields that we are able 
to earn on our general account investments supporting our obligations under the contracts.  Although we have been proactive in 
our investment strategies, product designs, crediting rate strategies and overall asset-liability practices to mitigate the risk of 
unfavorable consequences in this type of environment, declines in our spread, or instances where the returns on our general 
account investments are not enough to support the interest rate guarantees on these products, could have an adverse effect on 
some of our businesses or results of operations.  During the third quarter of 2010, our Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 
segment lowered the new money investment yield assumption to reflect the then current new money rates and to approximate the 
forward curve for interest rates relevant at such time.  The result was a drop in the current new money investment rate followed by 
a gradual annual recovery over eight years to a rate of 6.31%, 54 basis points below our previous ultimate long-term assumption of 
6.85%.  As a result of this assumption revision, we recorded a $114 million, after-tax, unfavorable prospective unlocking within our 
Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment. 

Given the level of interest rates as of the end of 2010, and assuming interest rates remain constant through 2012, our execution of 
reverse treasury locks to hedge interest rate exposure (discussed in “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life 
Insurance”) and the effect of crediting rate actions that we have taken, we estimate that spread compression will have a minimal 
effect on earnings in 2011 and would unfavorably affect earnings by approximately $20 million during 2012 primarily in Insurance 
Solutions – Life Insurance.  We discuss the earnings effect of interest rates in “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative 
Disclosures About Market Risk – Interest Rate Risk – Interest Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Falling Rates” and “Part 
I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – Changes in interest rates and sustained low interest rates may cause interest rate spreads to decrease 
and changes in interest rates may also result in increased contract withdrawals.”  

Elevated Loss Ratios on Group Business 

During 2010, our non-medical loss ratio was 76.2%, which is above what we experienced last year and above our long-term 
expectation of 71% to 74%.  The primary driver of the elevated loss ratios was unfavorably high disability incidence, which 
affected our long-term disability, short-term disability and life waiver of premium products.  The unfavorable claims incidence 
experience was spread across all industry sectors, and particularly in the financial, wholesale and retail sectors, which we expect will 
continue in the short term.   

We expect loss ratios to recover over time, but they are likely to remain above our long-term expectation well into 2011.  
Management compares trends in actual loss ratios to pricing expectations because group-underwriting risks change over time.  We 
expect normal fluctuations in our composite non-medical loss ratios of this segment, as claims experience is inherently uncertain.  
We are taking actions to manage the effects of our loss ratio results, such as implementing price adjustments on our product lines 
to better reflect our experience going forward.  In addition, we have been focusing on managing the higher volume of incidence 
through enhanced claims risk management, including contracting additional resources to help reduce caseloads and improve claim 
recovery experience so that incidence volumes do not detract from our claim termination efforts.  We are also employing new tools 
to identify and support claimants who will return to work. 

Earnings from Account Values 

Our asset-gathering segments – Retirement Solutions – Annuities and Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution – are the most 
sensitive to the equity markets, as well as, to a lesser extent, our Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment.  We discuss the 
earnings effect of the equity markets on account values and the related asset-based earnings below in “Part II – Item 7A. 
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Equity Market Risk – Effect of Equity Market Sensitivity.”  From 
December 31, 2009, to December 31, 2010, our account values were up $15.9 billion driven primarily by an increase in equity 
markets during 2010 and positive net flows.   

Variable Annuity Hedge Program Results 

We offer variable annuity products with living benefit guarantees.  As described below in “Critical Accounting Policies and 
Estimates – Derivatives – Guaranteed Living Benefits,” we use derivative instruments to hedge our exposure to the risks and 
earnings volatility that result from the GLB embedded derivatives in certain of our variable annuity products.  The change in fair 
value of these instruments tends to move in the opposite direction of the change in embedded derivative reserves.  These results 
are excluded from the Retirement Solutions – Annuities and Defined Contribution segments’ operating revenues and income from 
operations.  See “Realized Gain (Loss) – Operating Realized Gain (Loss) – GLB” below for information on our methodology for 

46 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
calculating the non-performance risk (“NPR”), which affects the discount rate used in the calculation of the GLB embedded 
derivative reserve.  

The variable annuity hedge program ended 2010 with assets over $1.0 billion, which were in excess of the estimated liability of 
approximately $450 million as of December 31, 2010.   

We also offer variable products with death benefit guarantees.  As described below in “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates 
– Future Contract Benefits and Other Contract Holder Obligations – Guaranteed Death Benefits,” we use derivative instruments 
to attempt to hedge the income statement effect in the opposite direction of the GDB benefit ratio unlocking for movements in 
equity markets.  These results are excluded from income (loss) from operations. 

Credit Losses, Impairments and Unrealized Losses  

Related to our investments in fixed income and equity securities, we experienced net realized losses that reduced net income by $84 
million for 2010 and included credit-related write-downs of securities for other-than-temporary impairments (“OTTI”) of $99 
million.  Although economic conditions have improved, we expect a continuation of some level of OTTI.  If we were to 
experience another period of weakness in the economic environment like we did in late 2008 and early 2009, it could lead to 
increased credit defaults, resulting in additional write-downs of securities for OTTI.   

Increased liquidity in several market segments and improved credit fundamentals (i.e., market improvement and narrowing credit 
spreads) as of December 31, 2010, compared to December 31, 2009, have resulted in the $1.3 billion decrease in gross unrealized 
losses on the available-for-sale (“AFS”) fixed maturity securities in our general account as of December 31, 2010.   

Industry Trends 

We continue to be influenced by a variety of trends that affect the industry.  

Financial Environment 

The level of long-term interest rates and the shape of the yield curve can have a negative effect on the demand for and the 
profitability of spread-based products such as fixed annuities and UL.  A flat or inverted yield curve and low long-term interest 
rates will be a concern if new money rates on corporate bonds are lower than our overall life insurer investment portfolio yields.  
Equity market performance can also affect the profitability of life insurers, as product demand and fee revenue from variable 
annuities and fee revenue from pension products tied to separate account balances often reflect equity market performance.  A 
steady economy is important as it provides for continuing demand for insurance and investment-type products.  Insurance 
premium growth, with respect to group life and disability products, for example, is closely tied to employers’ total payroll growth.  
Additionally, the potential market for these products is expanded by new business creation.   

Demographics 

In the coming decade, a key driver shaping the actions of the insurance industry will be the escalation of income protection and 
wealth accumulation goals and needs of the retiring baby-boomers.  As a result of increasing longevity, retirees will need to 
accumulate sufficient savings to finance retirements that may span 30 or more years.  Helping the baby-boomers to accumulate 
assets for retirement and subsequently to convert these assets into retirement income represents an opportunity for the insurance 
industry.  

Insurers are well positioned to address the baby-boomers’ rapidly increasing need for savings tools and for income protection.  We 
believe that, among insurers, those with strong brands, high financial strength ratings and broad distribution, are best positioned to 
capitalize on the opportunity to offer income protection products to baby-boomers.  

Moreover, the insurance industry’s products, and the needs they are designed to address, are complex.  We believe that individuals 
approaching retirement age will need to seek information to plan for and manage their retirements.  In the workplace, as employees 
take greater responsibility for their benefit options and retirement planning, they will need information about their possible 
individual needs.  One of the challenges for the insurance industry will be the delivery of this information in a cost effective 
manner.  

47 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Competitive Pressures 

The insurance industry remains highly competitive.  The product development and product life cycles have shortened in many 
product segments, leading to more intense competition with respect to product features.  Larger companies have the ability to 
invest in brand equity, product development, technology and risk management, which are among the fundamentals for sustained 
profitable growth in the life insurance industry.  In addition, several of the industry’s products can be quite homogeneous and 
subject to intense price competition.  Sufficient scale, financial strength and financial flexibility are becoming prerequisites for 
sustainable growth in the life insurance industry.  Larger market participants tend to have the capacity to invest in additional 
distribution capability and the information technology needed to offer the superior customer service demanded by an increasingly 
sophisticated industry client base.  

Regulatory Changes 

The insurance industry is regulated at the state level, with some products and services also subject to federal regulation.  As life 
insurers introduce new and often more complex products, regulators refine capital requirements and introduce new reserving 
standards for the life insurance industry.  Regulations recently adopted or currently under review, such as the Dodd-Frank Act, can 
potentially affect the capital requirements of the industry and result in increased regulation and oversight for the industry.  In 
addition, changes in GAAP, including moving to IFRS, as well as the methodologies, estimations and assumptions thereunder, may 
result in unanticipated changes to our net income.  See “Part I – Item 1. Business – Regulatory” for a discussion of the potential 
effects of regulatory changes on our industry. 

Issues and Outlook 

Going into 2011, significant issues include:  

(cid:2)  Decrease of interest rates; 
(cid:2)  Continuation of unfavorable non-medical loss ratios in our Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment, attributable 

primarily to unfavorable disability incidence, which affected our main products (long-term disability, short-term disability and 
life waiver of premium); 
Implementation of new accounting requirements in 2012 that could have a significant effect on our earnings and/or business 
model; 

(cid:2) 

(cid:2)  Continuing focus by the government on tax, financial and health care reform including potential changes in the dividends-

received deduction (“DRD”) calculations, which may affect the value and profitability of our products and overall earnings; 

(cid:2)  Achieving continued sales success with our portfolio of products, including marketplace acceptance of new product 

introductions, as well as retaining management and wholesaler talent to maintain our competitive position;  

(cid:2)  Potential unstable credit markets that can affect our financing alternatives, spreads and other-than-temporary securities 

impairments; 

(cid:2)  Potential volatile equity markets that have a significant effect on our hedge program performance and revenues; and 
(cid:2)  Continuation of economic challenges. 

In the face of these issues and potential issues, we expect to focus on the following throughout 2011: 

(cid:2)  Taking appropriate crediting rate actions; 
(cid:2)  Managing the effects of our loss ratio results, including focusing on the increase in incidence through claims risk management; 
(cid:2)  Continuing to explore additional financing strategies addressing the statutory reserve strain related to our secondary guarantee 

(cid:2) 

UL products in order to manage our capital position effectively in accordance with our pricing guidelines; 
Increasing our product development activities together with identifying future product development initiatives, with a focus on 
further reducing risk related to guaranteed benefit riders available with certain variable annuity contracts; 

(cid:2)  Evaluating opportunities for strategic investments in our businesses to grow revenues and further spur productivity, 

particularly in Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution and Insurance Solutions – Group Protection, with technology 
upgrades and new products for the voluntary market and an expanded distribution focus for our group business;  

(cid:2)  Managing our expenses aggressively through process improvement initiatives combined with continued financial discipline and 

execution excellence throughout our operations;  

(cid:2)  Closely monitoring ongoing changes in the legal and regulatory environment; and 
(cid:2)  Closely monitoring our capital and liquidity positions taking into account the fragile economic recovery and changing statutory 

accounting and reserving practices. 

For additional factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. 
Risk Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above.  

48 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates 

We have identified the accounting policies below as critical to the understanding of our results of operations and our financial 
position.  In applying these critical accounting policies in preparing our financial statements, management must use critical 
assumptions, estimates and judgments concerning future results or other developments, including the likelihood, timing or amount 
of one or more future events.  Actual results may differ from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.  On an 
ongoing basis, we evaluate our assumptions, estimates and judgments based upon historical experience and various other 
information that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances.  For a detailed discussion of other significant accounting 
policies, see Note 1.  

DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 

Accounting for intangible assets requires numerous assumptions, such as estimates of expected future profitability for our 
operations and our ability to retain existing blocks of life and annuity business in force.  Our accounting policies for DAC, VOBA, 
DSI and DFEL affect the Retirement Solutions – Annuities, Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution, Insurance Solutions – 
Life Insurance and Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segments.   

Deferrable acquisition costs for variable annuity and deferred fixed annuity contracts and UL and VUL policies are amortized over 
the lives of the contracts in relation to the incidence of estimated gross profits (“EGPs”) derived from the contracts.  Broker 
commissions or broker-dealer expenses, which vary with and are related to sales of mutual fund products, respectively, are 
expensed as incurred.  For our traditional products, we amortized deferrable acquisition costs either on a straight-line basis or as a 
level percent of premium of the related contracts, depending on the block of business.   

EGPs vary based on a number of sources including policy persistency, mortality, fee income, investment margins, expense margins 
and realized gains and losses on investments, including assumptions about the expected level of credit-related losses.  Each of these 
sources of profit is, in turn, driven by other factors.  For example, assets under management and the spread between earned and 
credited rates drive investment margins; net amount at risk (“NAR”) drives the level of cost of insurance (“COI”) charges and 
reinsurance premiums.  The level of separate account assets under management is driven by changes in the financial markets 
(equity and bond markets, hereafter referred to collectively as “equity markets”) and net flows.  Realized gains and losses on 
investments include amounts resulting from differences in the actual level of impairments and the levels assumed in calculating 
EGPs. 

Deferrable acquisition costs are those costs that vary with and are related primarily to new or renewal business.  These costs 
include commissions, general and administrative expenses and taxes, licenses and fees that are primarily related to new business 
volume.  For example, salaries of certain employees involved in the underwriting and policy issue functions and medical and 
inspection fees that are primarily related to new business volume are considered deferrable acquisition costs.  During the twelve 
months ended December 31, 2010, our deferrable general and administrative expenses were approximately $475 million.  However, 
we classify expenses associated with the new business functions that do not vary with, or primarily relate to, the securing of new or 
renewal policies as non-deferrable acquisition costs.  Non-deferrable acquisition costs are often developmental in nature, including 
training and recruiting, home office sales administration, marketing communications and product development.  In addition, 
acquisition costs that generally vary in relation to the level of premiums or in force, such as trail commissions, are recurring in 
nature, or tend to be incurred in a level amount from period to period are also considered non-deferrable.  Acquisition expenses 
identified as non-deferrable are charged to expenses in the period incurred.  Deferred expenses are recorded as an asset on our 
Consolidated Balance Sheets as DAC for products we sold during a period or VOBA for books of business we acquired during a 
period.  In addition, we defer costs associated with DSI and revenues associated with DFEL.  DSI is included within other assets 
on our Consolidated Balance Sheets and, when amortized, increases interest credited and reduces income.  DFEL is a liability 
included within other contract holder funds on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, and when amortized, increases insurance fees on 
our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  For a discussion of the periods over which we amortize our DAC, VOBA, DSI 
and DFEL see “DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” in Note 1.  

49 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL balances (in millions) by business segment as of December 31, 2010, were as follows: 

Retirement Solutions 
    Defined 

Annuities    Contribution     Insurance 

Insurance Solutions 
   Group 
Life 
   Protection     Total 

DAC and VOBA 
Gross 
Unrealized (gain) loss 

   Carrying value 

DSI 
Gross 
Unrealized (gain) loss 
   Carrying value 

DFEL 
Gross 
Unrealized (gain) loss 

   Carrying value 

$ 

 2,730      $ 
 (479)         

 517      $ 
 (157)    

 6,831    $ 
 (687)  

 175    $ 
 -   

 10,253 
 (1,323)

$ 

 2,251      $ 

 360      $ 

 6,144    $ 

 175    $ 

 8,930 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 325      $ 
 (41)         
 284      $ 

 227      $ 
 (5)         

 222      $ 

 2      $ 
 -     
 2      $ 

 -    $ 
 -   
 -    $ 

 -    $ 
 -   
 -    $ 

 327 
 (41)
 286 

 -      $ 
 -     

 1,451    $ 
 (171)  

 -    $ 
 -   

 1,678 
 (176)

 -      $ 

 1,280    $ 

 -    $ 

 1,502 

AFS securities and certain derivatives are stated at fair value with unrealized gains and losses included within accumulated other 
comprehensive income (loss), net of associated DAC, VOBA, DSI, other contract holder funds and deferred income taxes.  The 
unrealized balances in the table above represent the DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL balances for these effects of unrealized gains 
and losses on AFS securities and certain derivatives as of the end-of-period. 

Unlocking 

On a quarterly basis, we may record an adjustment to the amounts included within our Consolidated Balance Sheets for DAC, 
VOBA, DSI and DFEL with an offsetting benefit or charge to revenue or expense for the effect of the difference between future 
EGPs used in the prior quarter and the emergence of actual and updated future EGPs in the current quarter (“retrospective 
unlocking”).  In addition, in the third quarter of each year, we conduct our annual comprehensive review of the assumptions and 
the projection models used for our estimates of future gross profits underlying the amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
and the calculations of the embedded derivatives and reserves for life insurance and annuity products with living benefit and death 
benefit guarantees.  These assumptions include investment margins, mortality, retention, rider utilization and maintenance expenses 
(costs associated with maintaining records relating to insurance and individual and group annuity contracts and with the processing 
of premium collections, deposits, withdrawals and commissions).  Based on our review, the cumulative balances of DAC, VOBA, 
DSI and DFEL, included on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, are adjusted with an offsetting benefit or charge to revenue or 
amortization expense to reflect such change (“prospective unlocking – assumption changes”).  We may have prospective unlocking 
in other quarters as we become aware of information that warrants updating prospective assumptions outside of our annual 
comprehensive review.  We may also identify and implement actuarial modeling refinements (“prospective unlocking – model 
refinements”) that result in increases or decreases to the carrying values of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL, embedded derivatives and 
reserves for life insurance and annuity products with living benefit and death benefit guarantees.  The primary distinction between 
retrospective and prospective unlocking is that retrospective unlocking is driven by the difference between actual gross profits 
compared to EGPs each period, while prospective unlocking is driven by changes in assumptions or projection models related to 
our expectations of future EGPs. 

In discussing our results of operations below in this MD&A, we refer to favorable and unfavorable unlocking.  With respect to 
DAC, VOBA and DSI, favorable unlocking refers to a decrease in the amortization expense in the period, whereas unfavorable 
unlocking refers to an increase in the amortization expense in the period.  With respect to DFEL, favorable unlocking refers to an 
increase in the amortization income in the period, whereas unfavorable unlocking refers to a decrease in the amortization income 
in the period.  With respect to the calculations of the embedded derivatives and reserves for life insurance and annuity products 
with living benefit and death benefit guarantees, favorable unlocking refers to a decrease in reserves in the period, whereas 
unfavorable unlocking refers to an increase in reserves in the period.   

We amortize DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL in proportion to our EGPs for interest-sensitive products.  When actual gross profits 
are higher in the period than expected, we recognize more amortization than planned.  When actual gross profits are lower in the 
period than expected, we recognize less amortization than planned.  In a calendar year where the gross profits for a certain group 
of policies, or “cohorts,” are negative, our actuarial process limits, or floors, the amortization expense offset to zero.    

50 

  
 
 
                      
    
     
  
                       
    
    
     
  
                       
  
  
      
  
       
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
         
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
         
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
For illustrative purposes, the following presents the hypothetical effects to EGPs and DAC (1) amortization attributable to changes 
in assumptions from those our model projections assume (i.e., prospective unlocking), assuming all other factors remain constant: 

Actual Experience Differs 
   From Those Our Model 
   Projections Assume 
Higher equity markets 

  Hypothetical     
Impact to 
 Net Income 
 for EGPs 
Favorable 

   Hypothetical    
Impact to  
 Net Income    
for DAC (1) 
   Amortization  
Favorable  

   Description of Expected Impact 

Increase to fee income and decrease to changes in 
   reserves. 

Lower equity markets 

  Unfavorable 

   Unfavorable      Decrease to fee income and increase to changes in 

Higher investment margins 

Favorable 

Favorable  

   reserves. 

Increase to interest rate spread on our fixed product 
   line, including fixed portion of variable. 

Lower investment margins 

  Unfavorable 

   Unfavorable      Decrease to interest rate spread on our fixed product 

   line, including fixed portion of variable. 

Higher credit losses 

  Unfavorable 

   Unfavorable      Decrease to realized gains on investments. 

Lower credit losses 

Favorable 

Favorable  

Increase to realized gains on investments. 

Higher lapses 

  Unfavorable 

   Unfavorable      Decrease to fee income, partially offset by decrease to 

Lower lapses 

Favorable 

Favorable  

   benefits due to shorter contract life. 

Increase to fee income, partially offset by increase to 
   benefits due to longer contract life. 

Higher death claims 

  Unfavorable 

   Unfavorable      Decrease to fee income and increase to changes in 

Lower death claims 

Favorable 

Favorable  

   reserves due to shorter contract life. 

Increase to fee income and decrease to changes in 
   reserves due to longer contract life. 

(1)  DAC refers to the associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL and changes in future contract benefits. 

51 

  
 
 
     
 
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
        
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
     
 
  
  
   
  
     
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
     
 
  
  
   
  
     
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
     
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
     
 
  
  
   
  
     
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
     
 
 
  
   
  
 
Details underlying the increase (decrease) to income from continuing operations from prospective unlocking (in millions) were as 
follows: 

Insurance fees: 
  Retirement Solutions - Annuities 
   Insurance Solutions - Life Insurance 
      Total insurance fees 
Realized gain (loss): 
  Indexed annuity forward-starting option 
   GLB 
      Total realized gain (loss) 
         Total revenues 
Interest credited: 
   Retirement Solutions - Annuities 
      Total interest credited 
Benefits: 
   Retirement Solutions - Annuities 
   Insurance Solutions - Life Insurance 
      Total benefits 
Underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses: 
   Retirement Solutions - Annuities 
   Retirement Solutions - Defined Contribution 
   Insurance Solutions - Life Insurance 
      Total underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses 
         Total benefits and expenses  
            Income (loss) from continuing operations before taxes 
            Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
               Income (loss) from continuing operations 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 1     $ 
 -    
 1    

 3    $ 
 20   
 23   

 2    
 33    
 35    
 36    

 3    
 3    

 (3)   
 155    
 152    

 -   
 (173)  
 (173)  
 (150)  

 -    
 -    

 7   
 (3)   
 4   

 (32)   
 (8)   
 (26)   
 (66)   
 89    
 (53)   
 (18)   
 (35)    $ 

 10   
 (8)   
 33   
 35   
 39   
 (189)  
 (65)  
 (124)   $ 

$ 

 25   
 (13)  
 12   

 -   
 118   
 118   
 130   

 37   
 37   

 8   
 84   
 92   

 303   
 39   
 (15)  
 327   
 456   
 (326)  
 (114)  
 (212)  

The table above includes the effect of completing the planned conversion of our actuarial valuation systems to a uniform platform 
for certain blocks of our Retirement Solutions business.  This conversion was intended to harmonize methods and processes and 
upgrade a critical platform for our financial reporting and analysis capabilities for these blocks of business.  As part of the 
conversion process for these blocks of business, we harmonized assumptions and methods of calculations that existed between 
similar blocks of business within our actuarial models.  During 2010, we recorded after-tax unfavorable prospective unlocking of 
$20 million and favorable prospective unlocking of $4 million for Retirement Solutions – Annuities and Retirement Solutions – 
Defined Contribution, respectively, as a result of completing the planned conversion for certain blocks of business.  We are in the 
process of completing a similar conversion for our Insurance Solutions – Life segment and also have other blocks of Retirement 
Solutions business that we intend to convert in 2011.  Although we expect some differences to emerge as a result of this exercise, 
based upon the current status of these efforts, we are not able to provide an estimate or range of the effects to our results of 
operations until completion of the conversion. 

Reversion to the Mean 

Because equity market movements have a significant effect on the value of variable annuity and VUL products and the fees earned 
on these accounts, EGPs could increase or decrease with movements in the equity markets; therefore, significant and sustained 
changes in equity markets have had and could in the future have an effect on DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL amortization for our 
variable annuity, annuity-based 401(k) business and VUL business.  

As equity markets do not move in a systematic manner, we reset the baseline of account values from which EGPs are projected, 
which we refer to as our “reversion to the mean” (“RTM”) process.  Under our RTM process, on each valuation date, future EGPs 
are projected using stochastic modeling of a large number of future equity market scenarios in conjunction with best estimates of 
lapse rates, interest rate spreads and mortality to develop a statistical distribution of the present value of future EGPs for our 
variable annuity, annuity-based 401(k) and VUL blocks of business.  Because future equity market returns are unpredictable, the 

52 

  
 
 
                                
  
                                
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
underlying premise of this process is that best estimate projections of future EGPs need not be affected by random short-term and 
insignificant deviations from expectations in equity market returns.  However, long-term or significant deviations from expected 
equity market returns require a change to best estimate projections of EGPs and prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, 
DFEL and changes in future contract benefits.  The statistical distribution is designed to identify when the equity market return 
deviations from expected returns have become significant enough to warrant a change of the future equity return EGP assumption.   

The stochastic modeling performed for our variable annuity blocks of business as described above is used to develop a range of 
reasonably possible future EGPs.  We compare the range of the present value of the future EGPs from the stochastic modeling to 
that used in our amortization model.  A set of intervals around the mean of these scenarios is utilized to calculate two separate 
statistical ranges of reasonably possible EGPs.  These intervals are then compared again to the present value of the EGPs used in 
the amortization model.  If the present value of EGP assumptions utilized for amortization were to exceed the margin of the 
reasonable range of statistically calculated EGPs, a revision of the EGPs used to calculate amortization would occur.  If a revision 
is deemed necessary, future EGPs would be re-projected using the current account values at the end of the period during which the 
revision occurred along with a revised long-term annual equity market gross return assumption such that the re-projected EGPs 
would be our best estimate of EGPs. 

Notwithstanding these intervals, if a severe decline or advance in equity markets were to occur or should other circumstances, 
including contract holder behavior, suggest that the present value of future EGPs no longer represents our best estimate, we could 
determine that a revision of the EGPs is necessary.   

Our practice is not necessarily to unlock immediately after exceeding the first of the two statistical ranges, but, rather, if we stay 
between the first and second statistical range for several quarters, we would likely unlock.  Additionally, if we exceed the ranges as a 
result of a short-term market reaction, we would not necessarily unlock.  However, if the second statistical range is exceeded for 
more than one quarter, it is likely that we would unlock.  While this approach reduces adjustments to DAC, VOBA, DSI and 
DFEL due to short-term equity market fluctuations, significant changes in the equity markets that extend beyond one or two 
quarters could result in a significant favorable or unfavorable unlocking.  

Our long-term separate account growth assumption rate is 9%, which is used in the determination of DAC, VOBA, DSI and 
DFEL amortization for the variable component of our variable annuity and VUL products, as this component is related primarily 
to underlying investments in equity funds within the separate accounts.  This variable appreciation rate is before the deduction of 
our contract fees.  The actual variable appreciation rate in 2008 was significantly lower than the assumed rate with October of 2008 
representing the worst returns in 21 years.  The negative returns in the fourth quarter of 2008 resulted in the piercing of the outer 
corridor in our Retirement Solutions businesses and our Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment.  Although the piercing of 
the outer corridor does not automatically result in a resetting of our RTM assumption, we determined that the significance of  
unfavorable equity markets experienced during 2008 and the recessionary economic environment required a prospective unlocking 
related to RTM in the fourth quarter of 2008.  If unfavorable economic conditions return, additional unlocking of our RTM 
assumptions could be possible in future periods.  However, if we were to have unlocked our RTM assumption in the corridor as of 
December 31, 2010, we would have recorded a favorable prospective unlocking of approximately $375 million, pre-tax, for our 
Retirement Solutions business, and approximately $15 million, pre-tax, for our Insurance Solutions business, as a result of 
improved market conditions since our last unlock of RTM in the fourth quarter of 2008.  Our fourth quarter of 2008 prospective 
unlocking, which related to RTM and the effect of the volatile capital market conditions on our annuity reserves, reduced income 
(loss) from continuing operations by $223 million. 

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets  

Goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives are not amortized, but are subject to impairment tests conducted at least 
annually as of October 1.  Intangibles that do not have indefinite lives are amortized over their estimated useful lives.  We are 
required to perform a two-step test in our evaluation of the carrying value of goodwill for each of our reporting units, and the 
results of one test on one reporting unit cannot subsidize the results of another reporting unit.  In Step 1 of the evaluation, the fair 
value of each reporting unit is determined and compared to the carrying value of the reporting unit.  If the fair value is greater than 
the carrying value, then the carrying value of the reporting unit is deemed to be recoverable, and Step 2 is not required.  If the fair 
value estimate is less than the carrying value, it is an indicator that impairment may exist, and Step 2 is required.  In Step 2, the 
reporting unit’s goodwill implied fair value is determined.  The reporting unit’s fair value as determined in Step 1 is assigned to all 
of its net assets (recognized and unrecognized) as if the reporting unit were acquired in a business combination as of the date of the 
impairment test.  If the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill is lower than its carrying amount, goodwill is impaired 
and written down to its fair value.  Refer to Note 10 of our consolidated financial statements for goodwill and specifically 
identifiable intangible assets by segment.   

53 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The fair values of our insurance and annuities businesses are comprised of two components:  the value of new business and the 
value of in-force business.  Factors could cause us to believe our estimated fair value of the total business may be lower than the 
carrying value and trigger a Step 1 test, but may not require a Step 2 test if the fair value of the reporting unit is greater than its 
carrying value.  We may also conduct a Step 2 test, but it may not result in goodwill impairment because the implied fair value of 
goodwill may exceed our carrying amount of goodwill.  The value of our goodwill asset is supported by our value of new business, 
which is not affected by the same factors as our value of in-force business.   

The implied fair value of goodwill is most sensitive to new business production levels and discount rates.  Factors that could affect 
production levels include mix of new business, customer acceptance of our products and distribution strength.  Recent declines in 
interest rates have applied downward pressure to the interest rate inputs used in the discount rate calculation.  Spread compression 
and related effects to profitability caused by lower interest rates affect the valuation of in-force business much more significantly 
than the valuation of new business.  The effect of interest rate movements on the value of new business is primarily related to the 
discount rate.   

We performed a Step 1 analysis on all of our reporting units including:  Retirement Solutions – Annuities, Retirement Solutions – 
Defined Contribution, Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance, Insurance Solutions – Group Protection and Media.  All of our 
reporting units passed the Step 1 analysis, and although Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance carrying value of the net assets was 
within the estimated fair value range as presented in the table below, we deemed it necessary to validate the carrying value of 
goodwill through a Step 2 analysis.  Our estimated fair value for Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance declined from prior 
valuations primarily due to updating our projected interest rate assumptions, which was an expected consequence.  As discussed 
above, the result of reducing our interest rate assumptions primarily affected the value of in-force business.  

Our Step 1 analysis as of October 1, 2010, for Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance utilized primarily a discounted cash flow 
valuation technique (“income approach”), although limited available market data was also considered.  In determining the 
estimated fair value of this reporting unit, we considered discounted cash flow calculations, the level of our own share price and 
assumptions that market participants would make in valuing this reporting unit.  This analysis required us to make judgments about 
revenues, earnings projections, capital market assumptions and discount rates.   

The key assumptions used in the analysis to determine the fair value of the Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance reporting unit as 
of October 1, 2010, included:   

(cid:2)  New business for 10 years and run-off of cash flows on in-force and new business for the duration of the business; 
(cid:2)  Expense synergies assumption of 25% that would be expected to be realized in a market-participant transaction similar to prior 

market observable transactions and our prior experience; 

(cid:2)  Updated interest rate assumptions reflecting the low-interest rate environment; and 
(cid:2)  Discount rates ranging from 9.0% to 10.5% that were based on the weighted average cost of capital for this reporting unit 

adjusted for the risk factors associated with the operations.   

For our other reporting units, we performed a Step 1 analysis that included a roll-forward of the estimated fair value of the 
reporting units from prior discounted cash flow valuations and other valuation assessments.  In this roll-forward, we identified the 
significant assumptions that affected the estimated fair value, evaluated how the assumptions had changed since the prior 
evaluation and quantified the approximate effect to the estimated fair value.  The key valuation drivers that were evaluated 
included:  sales projections, changes in interest rates, changes in equity markets and growth of business in force and account values.  
We also updated our estimates of discount rates based upon current market observable inputs.  We used discount rates of 10% for 
Insurance Solutions – Group Protection and 12.5% for Retirement Solutions – Annuities and Retirement Solutions – Defined 
Contribution based upon the weighted average cost of capital adjusted for risks associated with their operations.  These discount 
rates reflected improvement since October 1, 2009, due primarily to significantly lower debt costs and lower equity risk premiums 
used as inputs into the discount rate calculations. 

54 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following table presents the results of our Step 1 analyses by reporting unit.  To illustrate the effects that changes in valuation 
assumptions could have on our estimated fair values of our reporting units, we have also included some hypothetical valuation 
sensitivities to implied fair value (in millions, except where otherwise noted):  

Goodwill, carrying value as of October 1, 2010  

Retirement    
Solutions - 
Annuities 
 $ 

 440     $ 

Insurance Solutions 
   Group 
Life 
   Insurance     Protection        Media 

       Other 
  Operations - 

 2,188     $ 

 274       $ 

 97  

Net assets, including goodwill, as of October 1, 2010:  
   Carrying value of net assets, including goodwill (1) 
   Estimated fair value of net assets, including goodwill (in billions) (1) 
Hypothetical estimated reduction in implied fair value attributable to:  
   100 basis point increase in discount rate (2) 
   10% decline in forecasted sales and related expenses  
   10% decline in equity markets  
   10% decline in broadcast cash flow  

 $ 

 2,910     $ 

 8,422     $ 

 1,146       $ 

5.1 - 5.9    

8.1 - 8.8     

1.2 - 1.4       

 300       
 67       
 200   
N/A   

 900  (3)   
 225       
 20       
    N/A        

 200         
 100         
N/A         
N/A         

 180  
 0.2  

 27  
N/A  
N/A  
 26  

(1)  Excludes unrealized balances included in accumulated other comprehensive income as of October 1, 2010. 
(2)  Excludes any effect to investment yields that could offset some or all of this effect. 
(3)  Approximately $300 million relates to valuation of in-force business and $600 million relates to valuation of new business. 

While threats to future profitability can theoretically cause an increase to the discount rate, a drop in the risk-free interest rates will 
also lower the cost of capital used in calculating the discount rate applied to the business.  Our sensitivity disclosures include 
estimated effects that changes in valuation assumptions could have on our estimate of our reporting units’ fair value.   

In our Step 2 analysis of Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance, we estimated the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill, 
including assigning the reporting unit’s fair value determined in Step 1 to all of its net assets (recognized and unrecognized) as if the 
reporting unit were acquired in a business combination as of October 1, 2010, and determined there was no impairment due to the 
implied fair value of goodwill being in excess of the carrying value of goodwill.  In the Step 2 analysis, we validated that the lower 
interest yield assumptions primarily affected the fair value of in-force business and had little effect to our fair value estimate for 
new business, which supports our goodwill asset.   

Our stock price was unfavorably affected by economic market conditions and continues to be lower than our book value; however, 
we currently believe that our stock price is not representative of the underlying fair value of our reporting units due primarily to the 
following:   

(cid:2)  We believe our stock price continues to be weighed down by concerns about the economic recovery and other concerns about 
the global economy, the risk of an extended period of low interest rates and the resulting effect that it could have on the 
earnings and profitability of financial services companies, such as ours; however, we believe that our disclosures, including 
those in “Part II – Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Interest Rate Risk – Interest Rate 
Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Falling Rates,” demonstrate that the effect of a low interest rate environment on the 
Company is manageable (see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – Changes in interest rates and sustained low interest rates may 
cause interest rate spreads to decrease and changes in interest rates may also result in increased contract withdrawals” for 
additional information on interest rates);  

(cid:2)  We believe our stock price continues to be weighed down by our sensitivity to volatile equity markets primarily related to our 
variable annuities business; however, we believe the effect of equity market volatility on the Company remains manageable as 
was demonstrated during the recession;  

(cid:2)  We have experienced improving credit and financial strength ratings since October 1, 2009; 
(cid:2)  We have produced solid sales production results over the past several quarters, and we do not expect future sales will 

deteriorate materially since our annual evaluation, indicating that the strength of our distribution franchise remains strong; 

(cid:2)  We have not experienced higher impairments on invested assets than assumed in our projections; and 
(cid:2)  The key assumptions used in our estimates of fair value of our reporting units continue to be adequate.  

55 

  
 
 
                           
 
                   
   
  
                   
   
 
                      
    
    
  
    
  
         
  
  
    
       
       
           
  
    
  
         
          
            
  
    
    
    
   
     
 
 
 
 
 
Our stock price trading below book value requires us to evaluate and reassess each reporting period whether or not there is an 
indicator that would require us to perform an impairment test.  For this reason, we will continue to monitor the current market 
conditions, and, if they deteriorate, we may need to perform interim goodwill impairment tests in addition to our annual test as of 
October 1, 2011.  Subsequent reviews of goodwill could result in impairment of goodwill during 2011.  Factors that could result in 
impairment include, but are not limited to, the following: 

(cid:2)  Prolonged period of our book value significantly exceeding our market capitalization without evidence of factors that explain 

why the lower market capitalization is not representative of the underlying fair value of our reporting units; 
Sales production that fails to meet our sales plan and also results in a lower expectation for future sales levels; 

(cid:2) 
(cid:2)  Valuations of mergers or acquisitions of companies or blocks of business that would provide relevant market-based inputs for 
our impairment assessment that could support different conclusions regarding the estimated fair value of our reporting units;  

(cid:2)  Higher than expected impairments of invested assets; 
(cid:2)  Prolonged inability to execute future reinsurance transactions for our life insurance business resulting in higher capital 

requirements; 

(cid:2)  Deterioration in key assumptions used in our income approach estimates of fair value, such as higher discount rates from 

higher stock market volatility or widening credit spreads; and 

(cid:2)  Lower earnings projections due to spread compression, lower account values from unfavorable equity markets, which would 

reduce future earnings expectations. 

We performed an interim test of goodwill impairment as of March 31, 2009, in response to the capital markets crisis experienced in 
early 2009.  All of our reporting units passed the Step 1 analysis, except for Retirement Solutions – Annuities, which required the 
completion of a Step 2 analysis.  In our Step 2 analysis, we estimated the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill.  We 
assigned the reporting unit’s fair value determined in Step 1 to all of its net assets (recognized and unrecognized) as if the reporting 
unit were acquired in a business combination as of March 31, 2009.  Based upon our Step 2 analysis, we recorded a goodwill 
impairment of $600 million for Retirement Solutions – Annuities that was attributable primarily to higher discount rates related to 
higher debt costs and equity market volatility, deterioration in equity market levels that affected our variable account values and 
lower annuity sales. 

We also completed a Step 2 analysis for Media as of October 1, 2009, as a result of continued deterioration in the radio market.  
We have recorded several impairments over the past three years due to declining forecasts for advertising revenues.  Consequently, 
we recorded goodwill impairment and Federal Communications Commission (“FCC”) license intangible impairment for Media as 
follows: 

(cid:2) 
(cid:2) 
(cid:2) 

$79 million of goodwill impairment and $30 million of FCC license impairment during the fourth quarter of 2009; 
$81 million of goodwill impairment and $77 million of FCC license impairment during the fourth quarter of 2008; and 
$83 million of goodwill impairment and $56 million of FCC license impairment during the second quarter of 2008. 

Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities 

We have investments in two credit-linked notes (“CLNs”) that are deemed to be variable interest entities (“VIEs”).  Effective 
January 1, 2010, in accordance with new accounting guidance (see Note 2), we determined that we are the primary beneficiary of 
these VIEs.  As such, we reflected the financial condition and results of operations of these VIEs in our consolidated financial 
statements and recorded a cumulative effect adjustment of $169 million, after-tax, to the beginning balance of retained earnings as 
of January 1, 2010.   

We use assumptions, estimates and judgments similar to those used for our investments and derivatives in determining the results 
of operations and financial position of these VIEs.  In addition, we use judgments in concluding whether we are the primary 
beneficiary of these VIEs.  Specifically, judgment is required in situations where our economic interest in the VIE is significantly 
greater than our stated power to direct the activities that most significantly affect the economic performance of the VIE. 
See Note 4 for more detail regarding the consolidation of these VIEs. 

Investments 

Our primary investments are in fixed maturity securities, including corporate and government bonds, asset and mortgage-backed 
securities and redeemable preferred stock, and equity securities, mortgage loans and policy loans.  Our fixed maturity and equity 
securities that are classified as available-for-sale are carried at fair value with the difference from amortized cost included in 
stockholders’ equity as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income.  The difference is net of related DAC, VOBA, 
DSI and DFEL and amounts that would be credited to contract holders, if realized, and taxes.  We also have trading securities that 
consist of fixed maturity and equity securities in designated portfolios, some of which support modified coinsurance and 
coinsurance with funds withheld reinsurance arrangements. 

56 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment Valuation  

Fixed maturity, equity, trading securities and short-term investments, which are reported at fair value on the Consolidated Balance 
Sheets, represented the majority of our total cash and invested assets.  Our measurement of fair value is based on assumptions used 
by market participants in pricing the asset or liability, which may include inherent risk, restrictions on the sale or use of an asset or 
non-performance risk, which would include our own credit risk.  Our estimate of an exchange price is the price in an orderly 
transaction between market participants to sell the asset or transfer the liability (“exit price”) in the principal market, or the most 
advantageous market in the absence of a principal market, for that asset or liability, as opposed to the price that would be paid to 
acquire the asset or receive a liability (“entry price”).  Pursuant to the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB 
ASC, we categorize our financial instruments carried at fair value into a three-level fair value hierarchy, based on the priority of 
inputs to the respective valuation technique.  The three-level hierarchy for fair value measurement is defined as follows: 

(cid:2)  Level 1 – inputs to the valuation methodology are quoted prices available in active markets for identical investments as of the 

reporting date, except for large holdings subject to “blockage discounts” that are excluded;  

(cid:2)  Level 2 – inputs to the valuation methodology are other than quoted prices in active markets, which are either directly or 

indirectly observable as of the reporting date, and fair value can be determined through the use of models or other valuation 
methodologies; and 

(cid:2)  Level 3 – inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable inputs in situations where there is little or no market activity 

for the asset or liability, we make estimates and assumptions related to the pricing of the asset or liability, including 
assumptions regarding risk. 

The following summarizes our investments carried at fair value by pricing source and the Fair Value Measurements and 
Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC hierarchy level (in millions): 

Priced by third party pricing services  
Priced by independent broker quotations  
Priced by matrices  
Priced by other methods (1) 
   Total  

As of December 31, 2010 

Level 1 

   Level 2 

   Level 3 

   Total 

$ 

$ 

 277    $ 
 -    
 -    
 -    
 277    $ 

 59,759    $ 
 -    
 8,334   
 -    
 68,093    $ 

 -     $ 

 2,572   
 -    
 1,541   
 4,113    $ 

 60,036   
 2,572   
 8,334   
 1,541   
 72,483   

Percent of total  

0%   

94%  

6%   

100%  

(1)  Represents primarily securities for which pricing models were used to compute the fair values.  

The Level 1 securities primarily consist of certain U.S. Treasury and agency fixed maturity securities and exchange-traded common 
stock.   

The Level 2 assets include fixed maturity securities priced principally through independent pricing services including most U.S.  
Treasury and agency securities as well as the majority of U.S. and foreign corporate securities, residential mortgage-backed 
securities, commercial mortgage-backed securities, state and political subdivision securities, foreign government securities, and 
asset-backed securities as well as equity securities, including non-redeemable preferred stock, priced by independent pricing 
services.  Management reviews the valuation methodologies used by the pricing services on an ongoing basis and ensures that any 
valuation methodologies are justified.   

Level 3 assets include fixed maturity securities priced principally through independent broker quotes or market standard valuation 
methodologies.  This level consists of less liquid fixed maturity securities with very limited trading activity or where less price 
transparency exists around the inputs to the valuation methodologies including:  U.S. and foreign corporate securities (including 
below investment grade private placements); residential mortgage-backed securities; asset-backed securities; and other fixed 
maturity securities such as structured securities.  Equity securities classified as Level 3 securities consist principally of common 
stock of privately held companies and non-redeemable preferred stock where there has been very limited trading activity or where 
less price transparency exists around the inputs to the valuation.  For the categories and associated fair value of our available-for-
sale fixed maturity securities classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, see Notes 1 
and 22.  

Our investment securities are valued using market inputs, including benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer 
spreads, two-sided markets, benchmark securities, bids, offers and reference data.  In addition, market indicators and industry and 
economic events are monitored, and further market data is acquired if certain triggers are met.  Credit risk is also incorporated and 

57 

  
 
 
 
  
 
                     
  
                     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
considered in the valuation of our investment securities as we incorporate the issuer’s credit rating and a risk premium, if 
warranted, due to the issuer’s industry and the security’s time to maturity.  The credit rating is based upon internal and external 
analysis of the issuer’s financial strength.  For certain security types, additional inputs may be used, or some of the inputs described 
above may not be applicable.  For broker-quoted only securities, quotes from market makers or broker-dealers are obtained from 
sources recognized to be market participants.  In order to validate the pricing information and broker/dealer quotes, we employ, 
where possible, procedures that include comparisons with similar observable positions, comparisons with subsequent sales, 
discussions with senior business leaders and brokers as well as observations of general market movements for those asset classes.  
The broker/dealer quotes are non-binding.  Our broker-quoted only securities are generally classified as Level 3 of the fair value 
hierarchy.  It is possible that different valuation techniques and models, other than those described above, could produce materially 
different estimates of fair values. 

Changes in our investments carried at fair value and classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy result from changes in 
market conditions, as well as changes in our portfolio mix and increases and decreases in fair values as a result of those 
classifications.  During 2010, there were no material changes in investments classified as Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.  For 
further detail, see Note 22.   

See “Consolidated Investments” below for a summary of our investments in available-for-sale securities backed by pools of 
residential mortgages. 

We adopted updates to the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC, effective January 1, 2009.  The 
FASB provided additional guidance on estimating fair value when the volume and level of activity for an asset or liability have 
significantly decreased in relation to normal market activity for the asset or liability and additional guidance on circumstances that 
may indicate that a transaction is not orderly. 

This guidance does not change the objective of a fair value measurement.  That is, even when there has been a significant decrease 
in market activity for a security, the fair value objective remains the same.  Fair value is the price that would be received to sell the 
security in an orderly transaction (i.e., not a forced liquidation or distressed sale), between market participants at the measurement 
date in the current inactive market (i.e., an “exit price” notion).  

The FASB provided additional guidance on estimating fair value when the volume and level of activity for an asset or liability have 
significantly decreased in relation to normal market activity for the asset or liability.  The FASB also provided additional guidance 
on circumstances that may indicate that a transaction is not orderly.  Specifically, the guidance provided factors that indicate that a 
market is not active, including: 

(cid:2)  Few recent transactions based on volume and level of activity in the market, therefore there is not sufficient frequency and 

volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis; 

(cid:2)  Price quotations are not based on current information; 
(cid:2)  Price quotations vary substantially either over time or among market makers; 
(cid:2) 

Indexes that previously were highly correlated with the fair values of the asset are demonstrably uncorrelated with recent fair 
values; 

(cid:2)  Abnormal, or significant increases in, liquidity risk premiums or implied yields for quoted prices when compared with 

reasonable estimates using realistic assumptions of credit and other nonperformance risk for the asset class; 

(cid:2)  Abnormally wide bid-ask spread or significant increases in the bid-ask spread; and 
(cid:2)  Little information is released publicly. 

After evaluating all factors and considering the significance and relevance of each factor, the reporting entity shall use its judgment 
in determining whether there has been a significant decrease in the volume and level of activity for the asset when the market for 
that asset is not active.  The factors should be considered in relation to the normal market activity for the asset.  As of December 
31, 2010, we evaluated the markets that our securities trade in and concluded that none were inactive.  We will continue to re-
evaluate this conclusion, as needed, based on market conditions.   

We use an internationally recognized pricing service as our primary pricing source, and we generally do not obtain multiple prices 
for our financial instruments.  We generally use prices from the pricing service rather than broker quotes as we have 
documentation from the pricing service on the observable market inputs that they use to determine the prices in contrast to the 
broker quotes where we have limited information on the pricing inputs. 

Our primary third party pricing service has policies and processes to ensure that they are using objectively verifiable observable 
market data.  The pricing service regularly reviews the evaluation inputs for securities covered, including broker quotes, executed 
trades and credit information, as applicable.  If the pricing service determines it does not have sufficient objectively verifiable 
information about a security’s valuation, they discontinue providing a valuation for the security.  The pricing service regularly 
publishes and updates a summary of inputs used in their valuations by major security type.  In addition, we have policies and 

58 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
procedures in place to review the process that is utilized by the third party pricing service and the output that is provided to ensure 
we are in agreement with the output provided by the pricing service.  On a periodic basis, we test the pricing for a sample of 
securities to evaluate the inputs and assumptions used by the pricing service.  In addition, we perform a check on prices provided 
by our primary pricing service to ensure that they are not stale or unreasonable by reviewing the prices for unusual changes from 
period to period based on certain parameters or for lack of change from one period to the next.  If such anomalies in the pricing 
are observed, we verify the price provided by our pricing service with another pricing source.   

As of December 31, 2010, we only obtained multiple prices for 41 available-for-sale and trading securities.  These multiple prices 
were primarily related to instances where the vendor was providing a price for the first time and we also received a broker quote.  
In these instances, we used the price from the pricing service due to the higher reliability as discussed above.   

For certain available-for-sale and trading securities, such as synthetic convertibles, index-linked certificates of deposit and 
collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”), we obtain a broker quote when sufficient information, such as security structure or other 
market information, is not available to produce an evaluation.  For broker-quoted only securities, quotes from market makers or 
broker-dealers are obtained from sources recognized to be market participants.  In order to validate the pricing information and 
broker-dealer quotes, we employ, where possible, procedures that include comparisons with similar observable positions, 
comparisons with subsequent sales, discussions with senior business leaders and brokers and observations of general market 
movements for those security classes.  For those securities trading in less liquid or illiquid markets with limited or no pricing 
information, we use unobservable inputs in order to measure the fair value of these securities.  In cases where this information is 
not available, such as for privately placed securities, fair value is estimated using an internal pricing matrix.  This matrix relies on 
management’s judgment concerning the discount rate used in calculating expected future cash flows, credit quality, industry sector 
performance and expected maturity. 

Broker-quoted securities are adjusted based solely on receipt of updated quotes from market makers or broker-dealers recognized 
as market participants.  Generally, the price for a security on this list is based on a quote from a single broker or market maker.  As 
of December 31, 2010, we used broker quotes for 137 securities as our final price source, representing less than 3% of total 
securities owned.  

Valuation of Alternative Investments 

Recognition of investment income on alternative investments is delayed due to the availability of the related financial statements, 
which are generally obtained from the partnerships’ general partners, as our venture capital, real estate and oil and gas portfolios are 
generally reported to us on a three-month delay, and our hedge funds are reported to us on a one-month delay.  In addition, the 
effect of audit adjustments related to completion of calendar-year financial statement audits of the investees are typically received 
during the first or second quarter of each calendar year.  Accordingly, our investment income from alternative investments for any 
calendar year period may not include the complete effect of the change in the underlying net assets for the partnership for that 
calendar year period.   

Annually, typically during the first or second quarter, we obtain audited financial statements for our alternative investment 
partnerships for the preceding calendar year and recognize adjustments to the extent that the audited equity of the investee differs 
from the equity used for reporting in prior quarters.  Recorded audit adjustments affect our investment income on alternative 
investments in the period that the adjustments are recorded.   

Write-Downs for OTTI and Allowance for Losses 

We adopted updates to the Investments – Debt and Equity Securities Topic of the FASB ASC for our debt securities effective 
January 1, 2009, which replaced the requirement for management to assert that it has the intent and ability to hold an impaired 
security until recovery with the requirement for management to assert if it either has the intent to sell the security or if it is more 
likely than not that the entity will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis.  Under this new 
accounting guidance, if management intends to sell the debt security or it is more likely than not the entity will be required to sell 
the debt security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, an OTTI shall be recognized in earnings equal to the entire difference 
between the debt security’s amortized cost basis and its fair value as of the balance sheet date.  If management does not intend to 
sell the debt security and it is not more likely than not the entity will be required to sell the debt security before recovery of its 
amortized cost basis, but the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected is less than the amortized cost basis of the 
debt security (referred to as the credit loss), an OTTI is considered to have occurred.  In this instance, the total OTTI must be 
bifurcated into the amount related to the credit loss, which is recognized in earnings, with the remaining amount of the total OTTI 
attributed to other factors (referred to as the noncredit portion) recognized as a separate component in other comprehensive 
income (loss) (“OCI”).  

As a result of the adoption, we recorded a cumulative effect adjustment, resulting in an increase of $102 million to our January 1, 
2009, opening balance of retained earnings with a corresponding decrease to accumulated OCI, to reclassify the noncredit portion 
of previously other-than-temporarily impaired debt securities.  In addition, the amortized cost basis of debt securities for which a 

59 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
noncredit OTTI loss was previously recognized was increased by $199 million, or the amount of the cumulative effect adjustment, 
pre-DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and tax.  The fair value of our debt securities did not change as a result of the adoption.   

We regularly review our AFS securities for declines in fair value that we determine to be other-than-temporary.  For an equity 
security, if we do not have the ability and intent to hold the security for a sufficient period of time to allow for a recovery in value, 
we conclude that an OTTI has occurred, and the amortized cost of the equity security is written down to the current fair value, 
with a corresponding charge to realized loss on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  When assessing our ability and 
intent to hold the equity security to recovery, we consider, among other things, the severity and duration of the decline in fair value 
of the equity security as well as the cause of the decline, a fundamental analysis of the liquidity, business prospects and overall 
financial condition of the issuer.   

For a debt security, if we intend to sell a security or it is more likely than not we will be required to sell a debt security before 
recovery of its amortized cost basis and the fair value of the debt security is below amortized cost, we conclude that an OTTI has 
occurred and the amortized cost is written down to current fair value, with a corresponding charge to realized loss on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  If we do not intend to sell a debt security or it is not more likely than not we will be 
required to sell a debt security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, but the present value of the cash flows expected to be 
collected is less than the amortized cost of the debt security (referred to as the credit loss), we conclude that an OTTI has occurred, 
and the amortized cost is written down to the estimated recovery value with a corresponding charge to realized loss on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), as this amount is deemed the credit portion of the OTTI.  The remainder of the 
decline to fair value is recorded in OCI – unrealized OTTI on AFS securities on our Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ 
Equity, as this amount is considered a noncredit (i.e., recoverable) impairment.   

When determining our intention regarding the sale of a security, we evaluate facts and circumstances such as, but not limited to, 
decisions to reposition our security portfolio, sales of securities to meet cash flow needs and sales of securities to capitalize on 
favorable pricing.  The credit loss on a security is based upon our estimate of the decrease in expected cash flows or our best 
estimate of credit deterioration.   

We recognized an OTTI loss of $156 million during 2010, of which $99 million was recognized in net income (loss) on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) related to credit losses and $57 million was recognized in OCI on our Consolidated 
Statements of Stockholders’ Equity related to noncredit losses, respectively.  For additional details, see “Consolidated Investments” 
below and Notes 2 and 5. 

For certain securitized fixed maturity securities with contractual cash flows, including asset-backed securities, we use our best 
estimate of cash flows for the life of the security to determine whether there is an OTTI of the security.  In addition, we review for 
other indicators of impairment as required by the Investments – Debt and Equity Securities Topic of the FASB ASC. 

Based on our evaluation of securities with an unrealized loss as of December 31, 2010, we do not believe that any additional OTTI, 
other than those already reflected in the financial statements, are necessary.  As of December 31, 2010, there were available-for-sale 
securities with gross unrealized losses totaling $1.4 billion, pre-tax, and prior to the effect of DAC, VOBA, DSI and other contract 
holder funds.  

As the discussion above indicates, there are risks and uncertainties associated with determining whether declines in the fair value of 
investments are other-than-temporary.  These include subsequent significant changes in general overall economic conditions, as 
well as specific business conditions affecting particular issuers, future financial market effects such as interest rate spreads, stability 
of foreign governments and economies, future rating agency actions and significant accounting, fraud or corporate governance 
issues that may adversely affect certain investments.  In addition, there are often significant estimates and assumptions that we use 
to estimate the fair values of securities, including projections of expected future cash flows and pricing of private securities.  We 
continually monitor developments and update underlying assumptions and financial models based upon new information.  

Write-downs and allowances for losses on select mortgage loans, real estate and other investments are established when the 
underlying value of the property is deemed to be less than the carrying value.  All mortgage loans that are impaired have an 
established allowance for credit loss.  Changing economic conditions affect our valuation of mortgage loans.  Increasing vacancies, 
declining rents and the like are incorporated into the discounted cash flow analysis that we perform for monitored loans and may 
contribute to the establishment of (or an increase in) an allowance for credit losses.  In addition, we continue to monitor the entire 
commercial mortgage loan portfolio to identify risk.  Areas of current emphasis are the hotel mortgage loan portfolio and retail, 
office and industrial properties that have deteriorating credits or have experienced debt coverage reduction.  Where warranted, we 
have established or increased loss reserves based upon this analysis.  

Derivatives  

We use derivative instruments to manage a variety of equity market and interest rate risks that are inherent in many of our life 
insurance and annuity products.  Assessing the effectiveness of these hedging programs and evaluating the carrying values of the 

60 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
related derivatives often involve a variety of assumptions and estimates.  We use derivatives to hedge equity market risks, interest 
rate risk and foreign currency exposures that are embedded in our annuity and life insurance product liabilities or investment 
portfolios.  Derivatives held as of December 31, 2010, contain industry standard terms.  Our accounting policies for derivatives 
and the potential effect on interest spreads in a falling rate environment are discussed in “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative and 
Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk,” Note 1 and Note 6.  

We measure our derivative instruments at fair value, which fluctuates from period to period due to the volatility of the inputs some 
of which are significantly affected by economic conditions.  The effect to revenue is reported in realized gain (loss) and such 
amount along with the associated federal income taxes is excluded from income (loss) from operations of our segments.  
Subsequent to the adoption of the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC, we did not make any 
material changes to valuation techniques or models used to determine the fair value of the liabilities we carry at fair value.  As part 
of our on-going valuation process, we assess the reasonableness of all our valuation techniques or models and make adjustments as 
necessary. 

Our insurance liabilities that contain embedded derivatives are valued based on a stochastic projection of scenarios of the 
embedded derivative fees, benefits and expenses.  The scenario assumptions, at each valuation date, are those we view to be 
appropriate for a hypothetical market participant and include assumptions for capital markets, actuarial lapse, benefit utilization, 
mortality, risk margin, administrative expenses and a margin for profit.  In addition, an NPR component is determined at each 
valuation date that reflects our risk of not fulfilling the obligations of the underlying liability.  The spread for the NPR is added to 
the discount rates used in determining the fair value from the net cash flows.  We believe these assumptions are consistent with 
those that would be used by a market participant; however, as the related markets develop we will continue to reassess our 
assumptions.  It is possible that different valuation techniques and assumptions could produce a materially different estimate of fair 
value.   

The following summarizes the percentages of our future contract benefits (embedded derivatives) carried at fair value on a 
recurring basis by the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC hierarchy levels: 

As of December 31, 2010 

Level 1 

   Level 2 

   Level 3 

      Total 
Fair 
      Value 

Future contract benefits (embedded derivatives) 

0%   

0%   

100%        

100%     

Changes of our future contract benefits carried at fair value and classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy result from 
changes in market conditions, as well as changes in mix and increases and decreases in fair values as a result of those classifications.  
During 2010, there were no material changes in future contract benefits classified as Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.  For more 
information, see Notes 1 and 22.   

Guaranteed Living Benefits 

We have a dynamic hedging strategy designed to mitigate selected risk and income statement volatility caused by changes in the 
equity markets, interest rates and market implied volatilities associated with the Lincoln SmartSecurity® Advantage guaranteed 
withdrawal benefit (“GWB”) feature and our i4LIFE® Advantage and 4LATER® Advantage guaranteed income benefit (“GIB”) 
features that are available in our variable annuity products.  We modified our hedging strategy during the fourth quarter of 2009 in 
anticipation of the adoption of VACARVM as of December 31, 2009.  We have certain GLB variable annuity products with GWB 
and GIB features that are embedded derivatives.  Certain features of these guarantees, notably our GIB, 4LATER® and Lincoln 
Lifetime IncomeSMAdvantage features, have elements of both insurance benefits accounted for under the Financial Services – 
Insurance – Claim Costs and Liabilities for Future Policy Benefits Subtopic of the FASB ASC (“benefit reserves”) and embedded 
derivative reserves.  We calculate the value of the embedded derivative reserve and the benefit reserve based on the specific 
characteristics of each GLB feature.  In addition to mitigating selected risk and income statement volatility, the hedge program is 
also focused on a long-term goal of accumulating assets that could be used to pay claims under these benefits, recognizing that 
such claims are likely to begin no earlier than approximately a decade in the future.  

If we were to experience unfavorable capital markets as we did late in 2008, then we would expect greater liabilities associated with 
the contractual guarantees.  However, the relationship between the components of the guarantees, namely, the embedded 
derivative reserves and the benefit reserves, is not linear.  As the exposure to net amount at risk increases, the relative portion of 
the projected benefits that is accounted for as benefit reserves increases relative to the portion that is accounted for as embedded 
derivative reserves. 

The hedging strategy is designed such that changes in the value of the hedge contracts move in the opposite direction of changes in 
GLB embedded derivative reserves.  This dynamic hedging strategy utilizes options on U.S.-based equity indices, futures on U.S.-

61 

  
 
 
 
 
 
                    
    
                    
     
  
     
  
     
    
                    
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
    
                    
    
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
based and international equity indices and variance swaps on U.S.-based equity indices, as well as interest rate futures and swaps.  
The notional amounts of the underlying hedge instruments are such that the magnitude of the change in the value of the hedge 
instruments due to changes in equity markets, interest rates and implied volatilities is designed to offset the magnitude of the 
change in the fair value of the GLB guarantees caused by those same factors.  As of December 31, 2010, the fair values of the 
embedded derivative reserves, before adjustment for the required NPR factors, for the GWB feature, the i4LIFE® Advantage 
GIB feature and the 4LATER® Advantage GIB feature were $134 million, $123 million and $132 million, respectively.  See 
“Realized Gain (Loss) – Operating Realized Gain (Loss) – GLB” for information on how we determine our NPR. 

As part of our current hedging program, equity market, interest rate and market implied volatility conditions are monitored on a 
daily basis.  We rebalance our hedge positions based upon changes in these factors as needed.  While we actively manage our hedge 
positions, these positions may not completely offset changes in the fair value embedded derivative reserve caused by movements in 
these factors due to, among other things, differences in timing between when a market exposure changes and corresponding 
changes to the hedge positions, extreme swings in the equity markets, interest rates and market implied volatilities, realized market 
volatility, contract holder behavior, divergence between the performance of the underlying funds and the hedging indices, 
divergence between the actual and expected performance of the hedge instruments or our ability to purchase hedging instruments 
at prices consistent with our desired risk and return trade-off.  This hedging strategy is managed on a combined basis with the 
hedge for our GDB features.    

For more information on our GDB hedging strategy, see the discussion in “Future Contract Benefits and Other Contract Holder 
Obligations” below. 

As of December 31, 2010, the fair value of our derivative assets, which hedge both our GLB and GDB features, and including 
margins generated by futures contracts, was $1.0 billion.  As of December 31, 2010, the sum of all GLB liabilities at fair value, 
excluding the NPR adjustment, and GDB reserves was $457 million, comprised of $413 million for GLB liabilities and $44 million 
for the GDB reserves.  The fair value of the hedge assets exceeded the estimated liabilities by $544 million.  However, the 
relationship of hedge assets to the liabilities for the guarantees may vary in any given reporting period due to market conditions, 
hedge performance and/or changes to the hedging strategy. 

Approximately 44% of our variable annuity account values contain a GWB rider as of December 31, 2010.  Declines in the equity 
markets increase our exposure to potential benefits under the GWB contracts, leading to an increase in our existing liability for 
those benefits.  For example, a GWB contract is “in the money” if the contract holder’s account balance falls below the guaranteed 
amount.  As of December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2009, 35% and 53% respectively, of all GWB in-force contracts were “in 
the money,” and our exposure to the guaranteed amounts, after reinsurance, as of December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2009, 
was $1.1 billion and $2.1 billion, respectively.  Our exposure before reinsurance for these same periods was $1.2 billion and $2.4 
billion, respectively.  However, the only way the GWB contract holder can monetize the excess of the guaranteed amount over the 
account value of the contract is upon death or through a series of withdrawals that do not exceed a specific percentage per year of 
the guaranteed amount.  If, after the series of withdrawals, the account value is exhausted, the contract holder will receive a series 
of annuity payments equal to the remaining guaranteed amount, and, for our lifetime GWB products, the annuity payments can 
continue beyond the guaranteed amount.  The account value can also fluctuate with equity market returns on a daily basis resulting 
in increases or decreases in the excess of the guaranteed amount over account value. 

As a result of these factors, the ultimate amount to be paid by us related to GWB guarantees is uncertain and could be significantly 
more or less than $1.1 billion, net of reinsurance.  Our fair value estimates of the GWB liabilities, which are based on detailed 
models of future cash flows under a wide range of market-consistent scenarios, reflect a more comprehensive view of the related 
factors and represent our best estimate of the present value of these potential liabilities.  The market-consistent scenarios used 
in the determination of the fair value of the GWB liabilities are similar to those used by an investment bank to value derivatives for 
which the pricing is not transparent and the aftermarket is nonexistent or illiquid.  In our calculation, risk-neutral Monte Carlo 
simulations resulting in over 10 million scenarios are utilized to value the entire block of guarantees.  The market-consistent 
scenario assumptions, at each valuation date, are those we view to be appropriate for a hypothetical market participant.  The 
market consistent inputs include assumptions for the capital markets (e.g., implied volatilities, correlation among indices, risk-free 
swap curve, etc.), policyholder behavior (e.g., policy lapse, benefit utilization, mortality, etc.), risk margins, administrative expenses 
and a margin for profit.  We believe these assumptions are consistent with those that would be used by a market participant; 
however, as the related markets develop, we will continue to reassess our assumptions. It is possible that different valuation 
techniques and assumptions could produce a materially different estimate of fair value.   

For information on our GLB and GDB hedging results, see our discussion in “Realized Gain (Loss)” below.  

The following table presents our estimates of the potential instantaneous effect to realized gain (loss), which could result from 
sudden changes that may occur in equity markets, interest rates and implied market volatilities (in millions) at the levels indicated in 
the table and excludes the net cost of operating the hedging program.  The amounts represent the estimated difference between the 
change in the portion of GLB reserves that is calculated on a fair value basis and the change in the value of the underlying hedge 
instruments after the amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL and taxes.  These effects do not include any estimate of 

62 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
retrospective or prospective unlocking that could occur, nor do they estimate any change in the NPR component of the GLB 
reserve or any estimate of effects to our GLB benefit ratio unlocking.  These estimates are based upon the recorded reserves as of 
January 13, 2011, and the related hedge instruments in place as of that date.  The effects presented in the table below are not 
representative of the aggregate impacts that could result if a combination of such changes to equity market returns, interest rates 
and implied volatilities occurred. 

Equity Market Return 
Hypothetical impact to net income 

Interest Rates 
Hypothetical impact to net income 

Implied Volatilities 
Hypothetical impact to net income 

In-Force Sensitivities 

-20% 

-10% 

-5% 

5% 

$ 

 (41)    $ 

 (9)   $ 

 (2)      $ 

 (3)     

-50 bps 

-25 bps 

 (6)    $ 

  +25 bps       +50 bps 
 (2)      $ 

 (2)   $ 

 (7)     

-4% 

-2% 

2% 

4% 

 (9)    $ 

 (4)   $ 

 -       $ 

 -      

$ 

$ 

The following table shows the effect (dollars in millions) of indicated changes in instantaneous shifts in equity market returns, 
interest rate scenarios and market implied volatilities: 

Assumptions of Changes In 

  Hypothetical   
   Impact to 

Scenario 1 
Scenario 2 
Scenario 3 

Equity 
Market 
Return 

   Interest 

Rate 
   Yields 

-5%   
-10%   
-20%   

    -12.5 bps  
    -25.0 bps  
    -50.0 bps  

Net 

   Market 
   Implied 
   Volatilities        Income 
+1%      $ 
+2%        
+4%        

 (4)     
 (19)     
 (87)     

The actual effects of the results illustrated in the two tables above could vary significantly depending on a variety of factors, many 
of which are out of our control, and consideration should be given to the following: 

(cid:2)  The analysis is only valid as of January 13, 2011, due to changing market conditions, contract holder activity, hedge positions 

and other factors; 

(cid:2)  The analysis assumes instantaneous shifts in the capital market factors and no ability to rebalance hedge positions prior to the 

market changes; 

(cid:2)  The analysis assumes constant exchange rates and implied dividend yields; 
(cid:2)  Assumptions regarding shifts in the market factors, such as assuming parallel shifts in interest rate and implied volatility term 

(cid:2) 

structures, may be overly simplistic and not indicative of actual market behavior in stress scenarios; 
It is very unlikely that one capital market sector (e.g., equity markets) will sustain such a large instantaneous movement without 
affecting other capital market sectors; and 

(cid:2)  The analysis assumes that there is no tracking or basis risk between the funds and/or indices affecting the GLBs and the 

instruments utilized to hedge these exposures.   

S&P 500 Index® (“S&P 500”) Benefits 

We also have in place a hedging program for our indexed annuities and indexed UL.  These contracts permit the holder to elect a 
fixed interest rate return or a return where interest credited to the contracts is linked to the performance of the S&P 500.  Contract 
holders may elect to rebalance among the various accounts within the product at renewal dates, either annually or biannually.  At 
the end of each 1-year or 2-year indexed term we have the opportunity to re-price the indexed component by establishing different 
caps, spreads or specified rates, subject to contractual guarantees.  We purchase options that are highly correlated to the portfolio 
allocation decisions of our contract holders, such that we are economically hedged with respect to equity returns for the current 
reset period.  The mark-to-market of the options held generally offsets the change in value of the embedded derivative within the 
indexed annuity, both of which are recorded as a component of realized loss on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).   
The Derivatives and Hedging and the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topics of the FASB ASC require that we calculate 
fair values of index options we may purchase in the future to hedge contract holder index allocations in future reset periods.  These 
fair values represent an estimate of the cost of the options we will purchase in the future, discounted back to the date of the 
balance sheet, using current market indicators of volatility and interest rates.  Changes in the fair values of these liabilities are 
included as a component of realized loss on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  For information on our S&P 500 
benefits hedging results, see our discussion in “Realized Loss” below.  

63 

  
 
 
                 
    
  
 
    
    
  
    
  
 
    
    
 
 
                    
                    
  
                    
  
  
  
                    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
Future Contract Benefits and Other Contract Holder Obligations  

Reserves 

Reserves are the amounts that, with the additional premiums to be received and interest thereon compounded annually at certain 
assumed rates, are calculated to be sufficient to meet the various policy and contract obligations as they mature.  Establishing 
adequate reserves for our obligations to contract holders requires assumptions to be made regarding mortality and morbidity.  The 
applicable insurance laws under which insurance companies operate require that they report, as liabilities, policy reserves to meet 
future obligations on their outstanding contracts.  These laws specify that the reserves shall not be less than reserves calculated 
using certain specified mortality and morbidity tables, interest rates, and methods of valuation. 

The reserves reported in our financial statements contained herein are calculated in accordance with GAAP and differ from those 
specified by the laws of the various states and carried in the statutory financial statements of the life insurance subsidiaries.  These 
differences arise from the use of mortality and morbidity tables, interest, persistency and other assumptions that we believe to be 
more representative of the expected experience for these contracts than those required for statutory accounting purposes and from 
differences in actuarial reserving methods.   

The assumptions on which reserves are based are intended to represent an estimation of experience for the period that policy 
benefits are payable.  If actual experience is better than or equal to the assumptions, then reserves should be adequate to provide 
for future benefits and expenses.  If experience is worse than the assumptions, additional reserves may be required.  This would 
result in a charge to our net income during the period the increase in reserves occurred.  The key experience assumptions include 
mortality rates, policy persistency and interest rates.  We periodically review our experience and update our policy reserves for new 
issues and reserve for all claims incurred, as we believe appropriate. 

Guaranteed Death Benefits 

The reserves related to the GDB features available in our variable annuity products are based on the application of a “benefit ratio” 
(the present value of total expected benefit payments over the life of the contract divided by the present value of total expected 
assessments over the life of the contract) to total variable annuity assessments received in the period.  The level and direction of 
the change in reserves will vary over time based on the emergence of the benefit ratio and the level of assessments associated with 
the variable annuity.   

We utilize a delta hedging strategy for variable annuity products with a GDB feature, which uses futures on U.S.-based equity 
market indices to hedge against movements in equity markets.  The hedging strategy is designed such that changes in the value of 
the hedge contracts move in the opposite direction of equity market driven changes in the reserve for GDB contracts subject to 
the hedging strategy.  Because the GDB reserves are based upon projected long-term equity market return assumptions, and 
because the value of the hedging contracts will reflect current capital market conditions, the quarterly changes in values for the 
GDB reserves and the hedging contracts may not exactly offset each other.  Despite these short-term fluctuations in values, we 
intend to continue to hedge our long-term GDB exposure in order to mitigate the risk associated with falling equity markets.  
Account balances covered in this hedging program represent approximately 94% of total account balances for variable annuities 
with a guaranteed death benefit other than account value at time of death.  As of December 31, 2010, the GDB reserves were $44 
million. 

For information on our GDB hedging results, see our discussion in “Realized Gain (Loss)” below.  

UL and VUL Products with Secondary Guarantees 

We issue UL and VUL contracts where we contractually guarantee to the contract holder a secondary guarantee.  The policy can 
remain in force, even if the base policy account value is zero, as long as contractual secondary guarantee requirements have been 
met.  The reserves related to UL and VUL products with secondary guarantees are based on the application of a benefit ratio the 
same as our GDB features, which are discussed above.  The level and direction of the change in reserves will vary over time based 
on the emergence of the benefit ratio and the level of assessments associated with the contracts.  For example, our change in 
secondary guarantee reserves, excluding unlocking, increased 27% from 2009 to 2010 due primarily to growth in our business.  For 
more discussion, see “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance.”  

Deferred Gain on Sale of the Reinsurance Segment  

In 2001, we sold our reinsurance operation to Swiss Re Life & Health America Inc. (“Swiss Re”).  The transaction involved a series 
of indemnity reinsurance transactions combined with the sale of certain stock companies that comprised our reinsurance operation.  
The gain related to the indemnity reinsurance transactions was recorded as a deferred gain in the liability section of our 
Consolidated Balance Sheets.  The deferred gain is being amortized into income at the rate that earnings on the reinsured business 
are expected to emerge, over a period of 15 years.  In addition, because we have not been relieved of our legal liabilities to the 

64 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
underlying ceding companies with respect to the portion of the business indemnity reinsured by Swiss Re, the reserves for the 
underlying reinsurance contracts as well as a corresponding reinsurance recoverable from Swiss Re will continue to be carried on 
our Consolidated Balance Sheets during the run-off period of the underlying reinsurance business.  This is particularly relevant in 
the case of the exited personal accident reinsurance lines of business where the underlying reserves are based upon various 
estimates that are subject to considerable uncertainty. 

Because of ongoing uncertainty related to the personal accident business, the reserves related to these exited business lines carried 
on our Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2010, may ultimately prove to be either excessive or deficient.  For 
instance, in the event that future developments indicate that these reserves should be increased, we would record a current period 
non-cash charge to record the increase in reserves.  Because Swiss Re is responsible for paying the underlying claims to the ceding 
companies, we would record a corresponding increase in reinsurance recoverable from Swiss Re.  However, we would not take the 
full benefit in earnings for the recording of the increase in the reinsurance recoverable in the period of the change.  Rather, we 
would increase the deferred gain recognized upon the closing of the indemnity reinsurance transaction with Swiss Re and would 
report a cumulative amortization “catch-up” adjustment to the deferred gain balance as increased earnings recognized in the period 
of change.  Any amount of additional increase to the deferred gain above the cumulative amortization “catch-up” adjustment must 
continue to be deferred and will be amortized into income in future periods over the remaining period of expected run-off of the 
underlying business.  No cash would be transferred between Swiss Re and us as a result of these developments.  

Pension and Other Postretirement Benefit Plans  

Pursuant to the accounting rules for our obligations to employees under our various pension and other postretirement benefit 
plans, we are required to make a number of assumptions to estimate related liabilities and expenses.  Our most significant 
assumptions are those for the weighted-average discount rate on our benefit obligation liability and expected return on plan assets.  
The discount rate assumptions are determined using an analysis of current market information and the projected benefit flows 
associated with these plans.  The expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is initially established at the beginning of the plan 
year based on historical and projected future rates of return and is the average rate of earnings expected on the funds invested or to 
be invested in the plan.  See Note 1 and Note 18 for more information on our accounting for employee benefit plans.  

The following presents our estimates of the hypothetical effect to net income (in millions) for the year ended December 31, 2010, 
associated with sensitivities related to these significant assumptions: 

The Effect of Changes in the Rate of Return on Plan Assets 
Increase (decrease) by 100 basis points 

The Effect of Changes in the Discount Rate on Plan Benefit Obligations 
Increase (decrease) by 100 basis points 

The Effect of Changes in the Discount Rate on Net Periodic Benefit Expense 
Increase (decrease) by 100 basis points 

     U.S. 
     Other  
      Post- 

      U.S. 
       Pension       retirement 
      Benefits 
      Plans 

$ 

 5      $ 

 74        

 5        

 - 

 9 

 1 

Due to the equity market recovery experienced during 2010 and decline in interest rates, partially offset by a decrease in our 
discount rate assumption on benefit obligations for 2011, we expect the U.S. net periodic pension benefit expense in 2011 will be 
lower than what was experienced in 2010.  To illustrate the potential effect, the following provides our actual expense for 2009 and 
2010 and our current assumption for expense (in millions) for 2011 by segment: 

2010 
2011 
   Expected decrease from 2010 

2009 

$ 

$ 

Retirement Solutions 
    Defined 

Insurance Solutions 
   Group 
    Other 
Life  
   Protection     Operations     Total 

Annuities    Contribution   Insurance 
$ 

 4       $ 
 1          
 (3)      $ 

 2       $ 
 1      
 (1)      $ 

 6     $ 
 1    
 (5)    $ 

 1       $ 
 -          
 (1)      $ 

 1      $ 
 -     
 (1)     $ 

 11       $ 

 7       $ 

 12     $ 

 7       $ 

 1      $ 

65 

 14 
 3 

 (11)

 38 

  
 
 
 
  
 
 
                    
    
          
          
  
     
          
                    
    
          
          
  
     
          
                 
    
          
          
  
    
                 
    
          
          
  
    
                 
    
          
          
  
    
     
      
  
     
          
  
     
          
  
 
 
                   
   
      
  
       
  
                 
 
  
   
       
  
                 
  
  
  
  
 
We retained the Lincoln UK pension plan after the sale of this business, and we expect our related pension expense for 2011 to be 
approximately $1 million when assuming an average exchange rate of 1.55 pounds sterling to U.S. dollars, which will be reflected 
within Other Operations. 

See “Review of Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources – Uses of Capital – Pension Contributions” 
below for a discussion of our required future contributions to our pension plans. 

Contingencies 

Management establishes separate reserves for each contingent matter when it is deemed probable and can be reasonably estimated.  
The outcomes of contingencies, which relate to corporate litigation and regulatory matters, are inherently difficult to predict, and 
the reserves that have been established for the estimated settlement are subject to significant changes.  It is possible that the 
ultimate cost to LNC, including the tax-deductibility of payments, could exceed the reserve by an amount that would have a 
material adverse effect on our consolidated results of operations or cash flows in a particular quarterly or annual period.  See Note 
14 for more information on our contingencies. 

Stock-Based Incentive Compensation 

Determining the fair value of stock options at the grant date requires judgment, including estimates for the average risk-free 
interest rate, expected volatility, expected exercise behavior, expected dividend yield and expected forfeitures.  If any of those 
assumptions differ significantly from actual, stock-based compensation expense could be affected, which could have a material 
effect on our consolidated results of operations in a particular quarterly or annual period.  See Note 20 for more information on 
our stock-based incentive compensation plans. 

Income Taxes  

Management uses certain assumptions and estimates in determining the income taxes payable or refundable for the current year, 
the deferred income tax liabilities and assets for items recognized differently in its financial statements from amounts shown on its 
income tax returns, and the federal income tax expense.  Determining these amounts requires analysis and interpretation of current 
tax laws and regulations.  Management exercises considerable judgment in evaluating the amount and timing of recognition of the 
resulting income tax liabilities and assets.  These judgments and estimates are re-evaluated on a continual basis as regulatory and 
business factors change.  Legislative changes to the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, modification or new regulations, 
administrative rulings, or court decisions could increase our effective tax rate. 

The application of GAAP requires us to evaluate the recoverability of our deferred tax assets and establish a valuation allowance, if 
necessary, to reduce our deferred tax asset to an amount that is more likely than not to be realizable.  Considerable judgment and 
the use of estimates are required in determining whether a valuation allowance is necessary, and if so, the amount of such valuation 
allowance.  In evaluating the need for a valuation allowance, we consider many factors, including:  the nature and character of the 
deferred tax assets and liabilities; taxable income in prior carryback years; future reversals of existing temporary differences; the 
length of time carryovers can be utilized; and any tax planning strategies we would employ to avoid a tax benefit from expiring 
unused.  Although realization is not assured, management believes it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets, including 
our capital loss deferred tax asset, will be realized.  For additional information on our income taxes, see Note 7. 

Acquisitions and Dispositions 

As of August 18, 2009, LNC and its wholly owned subsidiary, Lincoln National Investment Companies, entered into a Purchase 
and Sale Agreement with Macquarie Bank Limited (“MBL”), pursuant to which we agreed to sell to MBL all of the outstanding 
capital stock of Delaware, our former subsidiary, which provides investment products and services to individuals and institutions.  
This transaction closed on January 4, 2010, and we received net of tax proceeds at closing of approximately $405 million.    

On October 1, 2009, we completed the previously announced sale of the capital stock of Lincoln National (UK) plc to SLF of 
Canada UK Limited for net of tax proceeds of $325 million.  We retained Lincoln UK’s pension plan assets and liabilities.  The 
results of Lincoln National (UK) plc and its subsidiaries comprised the former Lincoln UK segment.  The Lincoln UK segment 
primarily focused on providing life and retirement income products in the U.K.   

Accordingly, we have reported the results of these businesses as discontinued operations on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income (Loss) and the assets and liabilities, prior to the sale, as held for sale on our Consolidated Balance Sheets for all periods 
presented.    

For information about acquisitions and divestitures, see “Part I – Item 1. Business – Acquisitions and Dispositions” and Note 3. 

66 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Details underlying the consolidated results, deposits, net flows and account values (in millions) were as follows:  

RESULTS OF CONSOLIDATED OPERATIONS 

Revenues 
Insurance premiums 
Insurance fees 
Net investment income 
Realized gain (loss): 
   Total OTTI losses on securities 
   Portion of loss recognized in OCI 
      Net OTTI losses on securities recognized 
         in earnings 
      Realized gain (loss), excluding OTTI 
         losses on securities 
            Total realized gain (loss) 
Amortization of deferred gain on business  
   sold through reinsurance 
Other revenues and fees 
      Total revenues 
Benefits and Expenses 
Interest credited 
Benefits 
Underwriting, acquisition, insurance and  
   other expenses 
Interest and debt expense 
Impairment of intangibles  
      Total benefits and expenses 
         Income (loss) from continuing operations 
            before taxes 
         Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
            Income (loss) from continuing operations 
            Income (loss) from discontinued  
              operations, net of federal income taxes 
                  Net income (loss) 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 2,176    $ 
 3,234   
 4,541   

 2,064     $ 
 2,922    
 4,178    

 2,018   
 3,067   
 4,130   

 (240)  
 88   

 (667)   
 275    

 (851)  
 -   

5%  
11%  
9%  

64%  
-68%  

 (152)  

 (392)   

 (851)  

61%  

 75   
 (77)  

 (754)   
 (1,146)   

 75   
 458   
 10,407   

 2,485   
 3,330   

 3,067   
 291   
 -    
 9,173   

 1,234   
 283   
 951   

 76    
 405    
 8,499    

 2,463    
 2,836    

 2,794    
 197    
 730    
 9,020    

 (521)   
 (106)   
 (415)   

 316   
 (535)  

 76   
 468   
 9,224   

 2,502   
 3,059   

 3,138   
 281   
 381   
 9,361   

 (137)  
 (127)  
 (10)  

 29   
 980    $ 

 (70)   
 (485)    $ 

$ 

 67   
 57   

110%  
93%  

-1%  
13%  
22%  

1%  
17%  

10%  
48%  
-100%  
2%  

NM  
NM  
NM  

141%  
NM  

2%
-5%
1%

22%
NM

54%

NM
NM

0%
-13%
-8%

-2%
-7%

-11%
-30%
92%
-4%

NM
17%
NM

NM
NM

67 

  
 
 
 
                            
                       
  
  
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
Revenues 
Operating revenues: 
   Retirement Solutions: 
      Annuities 
      Defined Contribution 
         Total Retirement Solutions 
   Insurance Solutions: 
      Life Insurance 
      Group Protection 
         Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
Excluded realized gain (loss), pre-tax  
Amortization of deferred gain arising from 
   reserve changes on business sold through  
   reinsurance, pre-tax 
Amortization of DFEL associated with 
   benefit ratio unlocking, pre-tax  
      Total revenues 

Net Income (Loss)  
Income (loss) from operations: 
   Retirement Solutions: 
      Annuities 
      Defined Contribution 
         Total Retirement Solutions 
   Insurance Solutions: 
      Life Insurance 
      Group Protection 
         Total Insurance Solutions 
   Other Operations 
Excluded realized gain (loss), after-tax  
Gain (loss) on early extinguishment of debt, after-tax 
Income (expense) from reserve changes (net of  
   related amortization) on business sold through 
   reinsurance, after-tax 
Impairment of intangibles, after-tax  
Benefit ratio unlocking, after-tax 
      Income (loss) from continuing 
         operations, after-tax 
      Income (loss) from discontinued 
         operations, after-tax 
            Net income (loss)  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 2,654    $ 
 988   
 3,642   

 2,301    $ 
 926    
 3,227   

 2,438    
 932    
 3,370    

 4,590   
 1,831   
 6,421   
 487   
 (146)  

 4,295   
 1,713   
 6,008   
 465    
 (1,200)  

 4,261    
 1,640    
 5,901    
 532    
 (573)   

15%  
7%  
13%  

7%  
7%  
7%  
5%  
88%  

 3    

 3    

 3    

0%  

 -    
 10,407    $ 

$ 

 (4)   
 8,499    $ 

 (9)   
 9,224    

100%  
22%  

-6%
-1%
-4%

1%
4%
2%
-13%
NM

0%

56%
-8%

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 484    $ 
 154   
 638   

 353     $ 
 133    
 486    

 513   
 72   
 585   
 (186)  
 (95)  
 (3)   

 2    
 -    
 10   

 569    
 124    
 693    
 (237)  
 (780)  
 42    

 2    
 (710)  
 89    

 193    
 123    
 316    

 541    
 104    
 645    
 (183)   
 (373)   
 -    

 2    
 (297)   
 (120)   

37%  
16%  
31%  

-10%  
-42%  
-16%  
22%  
88%  
NM  

0%  
100%  
-89%  

 951   

 (415)  

 (10)   

NM  

 29   
 980    $ 

 (70)  
 (485)   $ 

$ 

 67    
 57    

141%  
NM  

83%
8%
54%

5%
19%
7%
-30%
NM
NM

0%
NM
174%

NM

NM
NM

68 

  
 
 
                              
                              
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                              
                              
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 10,667    $ 
 5,301   
 4,934   
 20,902    $ 

 10,362    $ 
 4,952    
 4,451    
 19,765    $ 

 11,730   
 5,547   
 4,493   
 21,770   

 3,555    $ 
 (291)  
 3,057   
 6,321    $ 

 3,893     $ 
 995    
 2,421    
 7,309     $ 

 4,090   
 781   
 2,822   
 7,693   

3%
7%
11%
6%

-9%
NM
26%
-14%

-12%
-11%
-1%
-9%

-5%
27%
-14%
-5%

As of December 31, 
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2008  

2010  

2009  

$ 

 84,848    $ 
 38,824   
 33,585   

 57,455 
 28,878 
 31,753 
$   157,257    $   141,327    $   118,086 

 74,281    $ 
 35,302   
 31,744   

14%
10%
6%
11%

29%
22%
0%
20%

Deposits 
Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
Insurance Solutions - Life Insurance 
      Total deposits 

Net Flows 
Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
Insurance Solutions - Life Insurance 
      Total net flows 

Account Values 
Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
Insurance Solutions - Life Insurance 
      Total account values 

Comparison of 2010 to 2009 

Net income increased due primarily to the following:  

(cid:2) 

Impairment of goodwill in 2009 of $600 million for Retirement Solutions – Annuities due to continued market volatility, the 
corresponding increase in discount rates and lower annuity sales, and impairment of goodwill and our FCC license intangible 
assets in 2009 of $109 million related to our remaining radio clusters attributable primarily to declining results and forecasted 
advertising revenues:  
(cid:5) 

See “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” above for additional 
information on our goodwill impairment; and 

(cid:5)  These non-cash impairments did not affect our liquidity nor subsequent liquidity; 

(cid:2)  Higher net investment income and relatively flat interest credited, excluding unlocking and the effect of the rescission of the 
reinsurance agreement with Swiss Re in 2009 on interest credited (discussed in “Results of Other Operations” and Note 14 
below), driven primarily by: 
(cid:5)  Higher average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, attributable primarily to 

positive net flows, partially offset by transfers from fixed to variable since the third quarter of 2009;  

(cid:5)  More favorable investment income on alternative investments and surplus and higher prepayment and bond makewhole 
premiums (see “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” and “Consolidated Investments – Commercial 
Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for more information);  

(cid:5)  Higher invested assets driven primarily by favorable net flows on fixed account values, including the fixed portion of 

variable; and 

(cid:5)  Actions implemented to reduce interest crediting rates and holding lower cash balances in 2010 that resulted in our 

portfolio yields not declining as much as our crediting rates;  

(cid:2)  The overall unfavorable GLB net derivatives results, excluding unlocking, during 2009 due primarily to increases in interest 
rates and our over-hedged position for a period of time in 2009 (see “Realized Gain (Loss)” below for more information on 
our GLB liability and derivative performance);  

(cid:2)  Higher earnings from our variable annuity and mutual fund (within our Defined Contribution segment) products as a result of 

increases in the equity markets; 

(cid:2)  A decrease in realized losses on our AFS securities attributable primarily to lower OTTI due to overall improvement in the 

credit markets;  

69 

  
 
 
           
           
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                       
                       
  
  
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
 
   
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
(cid:2) 

Income from discontinued operations of $29 million during 2010 as compared to a loss from discontinued operations of $70 
million during 2009 related to our former Lincoln UK and Investment Management segments (see “Acquisitions and 
Dispositions” above and Note 3 for more information on our discontinued operations); 

(cid:2)  The $64 million unfavorable effect from the rescission in the first quarter of 2009 of the reinsurance agreement on certain 
disability income business sold to Swiss Re and unfavorable adjustments of $33 million in the fourth quarter of 2009 to 
increase reserves as a result of our review of the adequacy of reserves supporting this business and to write off certain 
receivables related to the rescission, as discussed in “Results of Other Operations” and Note 14 below; 

(cid:2)  A $35 million unfavorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and reserves for life insurance and annuity 
products with living benefit and death benefit guarantees during 2010 compared to a $124 million unfavorable prospective 
unlocking during 2009 (see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for more 
information): 
(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2010 was due to a $7 million favorable unlocking from model refinements 
and a $42 million unfavorable unlocking from assumption changes due primarily to lower investment margins than our 
model projections assumed and adjustments to secondary guarantee life insurance product reserves, attributable primarily 
to lowering our new money investment yield assumption to reflect the current new money rates and to approximate the 
forward curve for interest rates, as this effect alone represented $114 million unfavorable unlocking within our Life 
Insurance segment (see “Introduction – Executive Summary – Significant Operational Matters – Interest Rate Risk on 
Fixed Insurance Businesses” above for more information) and refinements associated with our planned actuarial 
conversion process where we harmonized assumptions and methods of calculations that existed between similar blocks of 
business within our actuarial models that resulted in lower lapses than our model projections assumed, partially offset by 
including an estimate in our models for rider fees related to our annuity products with living benefit guarantees; and   

(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due to a $6 million unfavorable unlocking from model 

refinements and a $118 million unfavorable unlocking from assumption changes due primarily to modifying the valuation 
of variable annuity products that have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves, modifying our 
fund assumptions, higher maintenance expenses and lower investment spreads than our model projections assumed;  

(cid:2)  The overall unfavorable GDB derivative results, excluding unlocking, during 2009 due primarily to sporadic large movements 
in rates and equities that caused non-linear changes in the liability relative to the derivatives utilized in the hedge program and 
by other items (see “Realized Gain (Loss)” below for more information on our GDB derivatives results);  

(cid:2)  A $65 million favorable retrospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and the reserves for life insurance and annuity 
products with living benefit and death benefit guarantees during 2010, partially offset by a higher DAC, VOBA, DSI and 
DFEL amortization rate, net of interest, excluding unlocking, during 2010, compared to a $36 million unfavorable 
retrospective unlocking during 2009: 
(cid:5)  The favorable retrospective unlocking during 2010 was due primarily to higher equity markets and expense assessments 

and lower lapses than our model projections assumed;  

(cid:5)  The higher amortization rate was due primarily to negative gross profits in total for certain cohorts in 2009 for Retirement 
Solutions – Annuities and the reduction of projected EGPs for Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance, discussed below; 
and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to the overall performance of our GLB derivative 
program (see “Realized Gain (Loss)” below for more information on our GLB derivative performance), partially offset by 
lower lapses and higher equity markets than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:2)  More favorable realized gains related to certain derivative instruments and trading securities during 2010 attributable primarily 
to spreads narrowing on corporate credit default swaps, which affected the derivative instruments related to our consolidated 
VIEs and our credit default swaps, and gains on our trading securities due to the decline in interest rates. 

70 

  
 
The increase in net income was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Higher benefits, excluding the effects of the rescission of the reinsurance agreement with Swiss Re in the 2009 (discussed in 
“Results of Other Operations” and Note 14 below), due primarily to unfavorable mortality and an increase in secondary 
guarantee life insurance product reserves from continued growth in the business in our Life Insurance segment and 
unfavorable claims incidence and termination experience in the long-term disability product line and adverse mortality and 
morbidity experience on our group life business within our Group Protection segment; 

(cid:2)  Higher underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses, excluding amortization of DAC and VOBA, due primarily to: 

Settlement of Transamerica litigation matter (see Note 14 for more information); 

(cid:5) 
(cid:5)  Higher account value-based trail commissions driven by the effect of favorable equity markets on account values and 

positive net flows;  

(cid:5)  An increase in expenses associated with reserve financing supporting our secondary guarantee UL and term business due 
primarily to higher pricing that has occurred in reaction to the unfavorable market conditions experienced during the 
recession and our continued efforts to reduce the strain of these statutory reserves (see “Results of Insurance Solutions – 
Life Insurance – Income (Loss) from Operations – Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain” below for more 
information); and 
Investments in strategic initiatives related to updating information technology and expanding distribution during 2010; 
partially offset by 

(cid:5)  Restructuring charges related to expense reduction initiatives in 2009, and lower expenses attributable to our U.S. pension 

(cid:5) 

plans in 2010 as compared to the corresponding period in 2009;  

(cid:2)  A $42 million gain associated with the early extinguishment of long-term debt as compared to a $3 million loss in 2010;  
(cid:2)  More favorable tax return true-ups recorded in 2009 than in 2010; and 
(cid:2)  Higher interest and debt expense as a result of higher average balances of outstanding debt in 2010. 

Comparison of 2009 to 2008 

Net income decreased due primarily to the following:  

(cid:2) 

Impairment of goodwill in 2009 of $600 million for Retirement Solutions – Annuities due to continued market volatility, the 
corresponding increase in discount rates and lower annuity sales, and impairment of goodwill and our FCC license intangible 
assets in 2009 of $109 million related to our remaining radio clusters during 2009 attributable primarily to declining results and 
forecasted advertising revenues, compared to a $297 million impairment of goodwill and our FCC license intangible assets 
during 2008 attributable to declines in advertising revenues for the entire radio market and impairment of our Lincoln UK 
goodwill due to deterioration in the market:  
(cid:5) 

See “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” above for additional 
information on our goodwill impairment; and 

(cid:5)  These non-cash impairments did not affect our liquidity; 

(cid:2)  The overall unfavorable GLB net derivatives results, excluding unlocking, during 2009, which was due to a reduction in the 
NPR component of the liability that is not included in the hedge program attributable to a narrowing of credit spreads, 
compared to favorable GLB net derivatives results during 2008 as the NPR adjustment was favorable attributable primarily to 
widening credit spreads that more than offset the unfavorable GLB hedge program performance due to extreme market 
conditions (see “Realized Loss” below for more information on our GLB liability and derivative performance);  

(cid:2)  A loss from discontinued operations of $70 million during 2009 as compared to income from discontinued operations of $67 

million during 2008 related to our former Lincoln UK and Investment Management segments (see “Acquisitions and 
Dispositions” above and Note 3 for more information on our discontinued operations); 

(cid:2)  Lower earnings from our variable annuity and mutual fund (within our Defined Contribution segment) products as a result of 

declines in the equity markets; 

(cid:2)  The $64 million unfavorable effect from the rescission of the reinsurance agreement on certain disability income business sold 
to Swiss Re in the first quarter of 2009 and unfavorable adjustments of $33 million in the fourth quarter of 2009 to increase 
reserves as a result of our review of the adequacy of reserves supporting this business and to write off certain receivables 
related to the rescission, as discussed in “Results of Other Operations” and Note 14 below; and 

(cid:2)  The overall unfavorable GDB derivatives results, excluding unlocking, during 2009 due primarily to more favorable equity 

market performance. 

71 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
The decrease in net income was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  A decrease in realized losses on our AFS securities attributable primarily to lower OTTI;  
(cid:2)  A $124 million unfavorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and reserves for life insurance and annuity 
products with living benefit and death benefit guarantees during 2009 compared to a $212 million unfavorable prospective 
unlocking during 2008 (see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for more 
information): 
(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due to a $6 million unfavorable unlocking from model 

refinements and a $118 million unfavorable unlocking from assumption changes due primarily to modifying the valuation 
of variable annuity products that have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves, modifying our 
fund assumptions, higher maintenance expenses and lower investment spreads than our model projections assumed in 
2009; and   

(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2008 was due to a $34 million unfavorable unlocking from model 

refinements and a $178 million unfavorable unlocking from assumption changes due primarily to significantly unfavorable 
equity markets in 2008;  

(cid:2)  A $36 million unfavorable retrospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and the reserves for life insurance and 
annuity products with living benefit and death benefit guarantees during 2009 compared to a $111 million unfavorable 
retrospective unlocking during 2008: 
(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to the overall performance of our GLB derivative 
program (see “Realized Gain (Loss)” below for more information on our GLB derivative performance), partially offset by 
lower lapses and higher equity markets than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2008 was due primarily to lower equity markets and premiums received, 

and higher death claims and expected GDB claims than our model projections assumed; 

(cid:2)  A $42 million gain in 2009 associated with the early extinguishment of long-term debt; 
(cid:2)  Higher net investment income and relatively flat interest credited, excluding unlocking, driven primarily by: 

(cid:5)  Higher average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, attributable primarily to 

positive net flows; and 

(cid:5)  Higher invested assets as a result of issuances of common stock, preferred stock and debt; partially offset by   
(cid:5)  Less favorable investment income on alternative investments due primarily to a deterioration of the capital markets (see 
“Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” below for additional information on our alternative investments); 
and 

(cid:5)  Holding higher cash balances during the recent volatile markets that reduced our portfolio yields for 2009; 

(cid:2)  A reduction in federal income tax expense due primarily to the release of a state income tax liability and favorable tax return 

true-ups driven by the separate account DRD, foreign tax credit adjustments and other items;  

(cid:2)  Lower broker-dealer expenses due primarily to lower sales of non-proprietary products, lower interest and debt expense as a 
result of a decline in interest rates and average balances of outstanding debt in 2009, lower merger expenses as many of our 
integration efforts related to our acquisition of Jefferson-Pilot have been completed and the implementation of several expense 
initiatives, partially offset by restructuring charges related to many of these initiatives and higher incentive compensation 
accruals as a result of higher earnings and production performance relative to planned goals; and 

(cid:2)  The $16 million effect of the initial adoption of the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC on 

January 1, 2008. 

The foregoing items are discussed in further detail in results of operations by segment discussions and “Realized Gain (Loss)” 
below.  In addition, for a discussion of the earnings effect of the equity markets, see “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative and 
Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Equity Market Risk – Effect of Equity Market Sensitivity.” 

RESULTS OF RETIREMENT SOLUTIONS 

The Retirement Solutions business provides its products through two segments:  Annuities and Defined Contribution.  The 
Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment provides tax-deferred investment growth and lifetime income opportunities for its 
clients by offering individual fixed annuities, including indexed annuities, and variable annuities.  The Retirement Solutions – 
Defined Contribution segment provides employer-sponsored variable and fixed annuities, defined benefit, individual retirement 
accounts and mutual-fund based programs in the retirement plan marketplaces.  

For factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk 
Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above. 

72 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Retirement Solutions – Annuities 

Income (Loss) from Operations 

Details underlying the results for Retirement Solutions – Annuities (in millions) were as follows: 

Operating Revenues  
Insurance premiums (1) 
Insurance fees  
Net investment income  
Operating realized gain (loss)  
Other revenues and fees (2) 
      Total operating revenues  
Operating Expenses  
Interest credited  
Benefits  
Underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other  
   expenses  
      Total operating expenses  
Income (loss) from operations before taxes  
Federal income tax expense (benefit)  
         Income (loss) from operations  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 53    $ 

 1,098   
 1,119   
 69   
 315   
 2,654   

 726   
 174   

 89     $ 
 841   
 1,037   
 54    
 280   
 2,301   

 682   
 242   

 1,168   
 2,068   
 586   
 102   
 484    $ 

 983   
 1,907   
 394   
 41    
 353    $ 

$ 

 136    
 972    
 972    
 38    
 320    
 2,438    

 704    
 215    

 1,381    
 2,300    
 138    
 (55)   
 193    

-40%  
31%  
8%  
28%  
13%  
15%  

6%  
-28%  

19%  
8%  
49%  
149%  
37%  

-35%
-13%
7%
42%
-13%
-6%

-3%
13%

-29%
-17%
186%
175%
83%

(1) 

Includes primarily our single premium immediate annuities, which have a corresponding offset in benefits for changes in 
reserves. 

(2)  Consists primarily of fees attributable to broker-dealer services that are subject to market volatility. 

Comparison of 2010 to 2009 

Income from operations for this segment increased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  Higher insurance fees driven primarily by higher average daily variable account values due to more favorable equity markets; 
(cid:2)  Higher net investment income, partially offset by higher interest credited, excluding unlocking, driven primarily by:  

(cid:5)  Higher average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, attributable primarily to 

positive net flows, partially offset by transfers from fixed to variable since the fourth quarter of 2009;  

(cid:5)  More favorable investment income on alternative investments within our surplus portfolio and higher prepayment and 

bond makewhole premiums (see “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” and  “Consolidated Investments 
– Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for more information); and 

(cid:5)  Holding lower cash balances during 2010 that resulted in our portfolio yields not declining as much as our crediting rates 

(see discussion in “Additional Information” below); 

(cid:2)  A $21 million favorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and reserves for our guarantee riders during 2010 
compared to a $10 million unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 (see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – 
DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for more information): 
(cid:5)  The favorable prospective unlocking during 2010 was due to assumption changes attributable primarily to including an 
estimate in our models for rider fees related to our annuity products with living benefit guarantees and lower lapses than 
our model projections assumed, net of a $20 million unfavorable unlocking for the effect of completing the planned 
conversion of our actuarial valuation systems to a uniform platform for certain blocks of business (see discussion in 
“Additional Information” below); and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due to assumption changes attributable primarily to higher 

maintenance expenses partially offset by higher expense assessments than our model projections assumed and modifying 
the valuation of variable annuity products that have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves; 

73 

  
 
 
 
 
                          
                          
 
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
(cid:2)  An $81 million favorable retrospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and reserves for our guarantee riders during 
2010, partially offset by a higher DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL amortization rate, net of interest, excluding unlocking, during 
2010, compared to a $29 million favorable retrospective unlocking during 2009: 
(cid:5)  The favorable retrospective unlocking during 2010 was due primarily to higher equity markets and expense assessments 

and lower lapses than our model projections assumed; 

(cid:5)  The higher amortization rate during 2010 was due primarily to negative gross profits in total for certain cohorts in 2009 

(discussed below); and 

(cid:5)  The favorable retrospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to lower lapses and higher equity markets than our 

model projections assumed; and 

(cid:2)  Lower benefits from a decrease in the change in GDB reserves due to a decrease in our expected GDB benefit payments 
attributable primarily to the increase in account values above guaranteed levels due to the more favorable equity markets.  

The increase in income from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Higher underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses, excluding amortization of DAC and VOBA, due primarily to: 
(cid:5)  Higher account value-based trail commissions driven by the effect of favorable equity markets on account values and 

positive net flows; and 

(cid:5)  An increase in the allocation of overhead costs to this segment, discussed in “Additional Information” below; and 

(cid:2)  More favorable tax return true-ups recorded in 2009 than in 2010. 

Comparison of 2009 to 2008 

Income from operations for this segment increased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  A $10 million unfavorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and reserves for our guarantee riders during 
2009 compared to a $210 million unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2008 (see “Critical Accounting Policies and 
Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for more information): 
(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due to assumption changes attributable primarily to higher 

maintenance expenses partially offset by higher expense assessments than our model projections assumed and modifying 
the valuation of variable annuity products that have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves; 
and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2008 was due primarily to significantly unfavorable equity markets; 

(cid:2)  Higher net investment income, partially offset by higher interest credited, excluding unlocking, driven primarily by:  

(cid:5)  Higher average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, attributable primarily to 

positive net flows; 

(cid:5)  Crediting rate actions implemented since the third quarter of 2008 that reduced interest crediting rates; and 
(cid:5)  More favorable investment income on alternative investments within our surplus portfolio (see “Consolidated 

Investments – Alternative Investments” below for more information); partially offset by 

(cid:5)  Holding higher cash balances during the recent volatile markets that reduced our portfolio yields for 2009 (see discussion 

in “Additional Information” below); and 

(cid:2)  A higher DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL amortization rate, net of interest, excluding unlocking, during 2009, partially offset by 
a $29 million favorable retrospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and reserves for our guarantee riders during 
2009, compared to a $50 million unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2008: 
(cid:5)  The higher amortization rate during 2009 was due primarily to the reduction of projected EGPs for this segment 

(discussed in “Additional Information” below); 

(cid:5)  The favorable retrospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to lower lapses and higher equity markets than our 

model projections assumed; and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2008 was due primarily to lower equity markets than our model 

projections assumed. 

74 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
The increase in income from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  An increase in federal income tax expense due primarily to an increase in earnings, partially offset by more favorable tax return 

true-ups driven by the separate account DRD, foreign tax credit adjustments and other items in 2009; 

(cid:2)  Lower insurance fees driven primarily by lower average daily variable account values due to unfavorable equity markets; 
(cid:2)  Higher benefits due primarily to an increase in the growth in benefit reserves from higher expected GDB benefit payments;  
(cid:2)  Higher underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses, excluding amortization of DAC and VOBA, due primarily to: 
(cid:5)  Higher account value-based trail commissions driven by positive net flows, partially offset by the effect of unfavorable 

equity markets on account values;  

(cid:5)  Higher incentive compensation accruals as a result of higher earnings and production performance relative to planned 

goals; and  

(cid:5)  Higher expenses attributable to our U.S. pension plans; and 

(cid:2)  A less favorable net broker-dealer margin attributable primarily to lower sales of non-proprietary products. 

Additional Information 

During 2010, we completed the planned conversion of our actuarial valuation systems to a uniform platform for certain blocks of 
business, which we deemed to be the most significant.  As a result, we recorded prospective unlocking during 2010 related to the 
conversion, as discussed in “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” above.  We have other 
blocks of business that we intend to convert in 2011.  Although we expect some differences to emerge as a result of the planned 
conversion of the other blocks of business, based upon the current status of these efforts, we are not able to provide an estimate or 
range of the effects to our results of operations until completion of the conversion. 

Prior to the second quarter of 2009, the equity markets unfavorably impacted our average variable account values and the resulting 
fees earned on these accounts.  Additionally, weaker credit fundamentals negatively impacted our investment margins and increased 
our realized losses on investments, including OTTI.  As a result, we recorded prospective unlocking during the fourth quarter of 
2008 related to our RTM process, as discussed in “Critical Accounting Policies – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL.”  This RTM 
unlocking that occurred at an equity market trough had the effect of lowering the projected EGPs for this segment, thereby 
increasing our rate of amortization, which results in higher DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL amortization and lower earnings for this 
segment. 

Fixed annuity deposits moderated beginning in the fourth quarter of 2009 and throughout 2010, as customers shifted deposits back 
into variable annuity products as equity markets improved, and we expect this trend will continue in 2011 with improving 
economic conditions. 

We allocated more overhead costs to this segment during 2010, as the disposal of our Lincoln UK and Investment Management 
businesses resulted in a reallocation of overhead expenses to our remaining businesses.  Additionally, we made strategic 
investments during 2010 that resulted in higher expenses, and we expect this trend to continue in 2011.  

During the volatile markets experienced in late 2008 and early 2009, we implemented a short-term liquidity strategy of maintaining 
higher cash balances that reduced our portfolio yields by 20 basis points during 2009.  As we progressed through 2009, we reduced 
these excess cash balances, thereby increasing our portfolio yields.    

We experienced a favorable decline in expenses attributable to our U.S. pension plans during 2010 when compared to 2009, and 
this trend will continue in 2011.  For additional information, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Pension and Other 
Postretirement Benefit Plans.” 

New deposits are an important component of net flows and key to our efforts to grow our business.  Although deposits do not 
significantly affect current period income from operations, they are an important indicator of future profitability.   

The other component of net flows relates to the retention of the business.  An important measure of retention is the lapse rate, 
which compares the amount of withdrawals to the average account values.  The overall lapse rate for our annuity products was 7%, 
8% and 9% for 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  

See Note 11 below for information on contractual guarantees to contract holders related to GDB features for our Retirement 
Solutions business. 

75 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our fixed annuity business includes products with discretionary crediting rates that are reset on an annual basis and are not subject 
to surrender charges.  Our ability to retain annual reset annuities will be subject to current competitive conditions at the time 
interest rates for these products reset.  We expect to manage the effects of spreads on near-term income from operations through 
portfolio management and, to a lesser extent, crediting rate actions, which assumes no significant changes in net flows into or out 
of our fixed accounts or other changes that may cause interest rate spreads to differ from our expectations.  For information on 
interest rate spreads and the interest rate risk due to falling interest rates, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – Changes in interest 
rates and sustained low interest rates may cause interest rate spreads to decrease and changes in interest rates may also result in 
increased contract withdrawals” and “Part II – Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Interest 
Rate Risk – Interest Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Falling Rates.” 

We provide information about this segment’s operating revenue and operating expense line items, the period in which amounts are 
recognized, key drivers of changes and historical details underlying the line items and their associated drivers below.  For detail on 
the operating realized gain (loss), see “Realized Gain (Loss)” below. 

Insurance Fees 

Details underlying insurance fees, account values and net flows (in millions) were as follows: 

Insurance Fees 
Mortality, expense and other assessments 
Surrender charges 
DFEL: 
   Deferrals 
   Amortization, net of interest: 
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes 
      Retrospective unlocking 
      Amortization, net of interest, excluding  
         unlocking 
            Total insurance fees 

Account Values 
Variable portion of variable annuities 
Fixed portion of variable annuities 
   Total variable annuities 
Fixed annuities, including indexed 
Fixed annuities ceded to reinsurers 
   Total fixed annuities 
      Total account values 

Averages 
Daily variable account values, excluding  
   the fixed portion of variable 

Daily S&P 500 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 1,113    $ 
 37    

 860    $ 
 36   

 935   
 45   

29%  
3%

-8%
-20%

 (75)   

 (56)  

 (50)  

-34%  

-12%

 1    
 (1)   

 3   
 2   

 25   
 7    

 23    
 1,098    $ 

 (4)  
 841    $ 

 10   
 972   

-67%  
NM  

NM  
31%  

-88%
-71%

NM
-13%

As of December 31, 
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2008  

2010  

2009  

 64,858    $ 
 3,532   
 68,390   
 17,420   
 (962)   
 16,458   
 84,848    $ 

 55,368    $ 
 3,999   
 59,367   
 15,941   
 (1,027)  
 14,914   
 74,281    $ 

 40,925   
 3,617   
 44,542   
 14,038   
 (1,125)  
 12,913   
 57,455   

17%  
-12%  
15%  
9%  
6%  
10%  
14%  

35%
11%
33%
14%
9%
15%
29%

$ 

$ 

$ 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 58,188    $ 

 46,551    $ 

 52,111   

    1,138.78   

 947.53   

    1,220.72 

25%   

20%  

-11%

-22%

76 

  
 
 
 
 
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                       
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
Net Flows on Account Values 
Variable portion of variable annuity deposits 
Variable portion of variable annuity withdrawals 
   Variable portion of variable annuity net flows 
Fixed portion of variable annuity deposits 
Fixed portion of variable annuity withdrawals 
   Fixed portion of variable annuity net flows 
      Total variable annuity deposits 
      Total variable annuity withdrawals 
         Total variable annuity net flows 
Fixed indexed annuity deposits 
Fixed indexed annuity withdrawals 
   Fixed indexed annuity net flows 
Other fixed annuity deposits 
Other fixed annuity withdrawals 
   Other fixed annuity net flows 
            Total annuity deposits 
            Total annuity withdrawals 
               Total annuity net flows 

Other Changes to Account Values 
Change in market value on variable, excluding the 
   fixed portion of variable 
Transfers to the variable portion of variable  
   annuity products from the fixed portion of  
   variable annuity products 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 5,099    $ 
 (5,092)  
 7    
 3,167   
 (389)  
 2,778   
 8,266   
 (5,481)  
 2,785   
 2,027   
 (532)  
 1,495   
 374   
 (1,099)  
 (725)  
 10,667   
 (7,112)  
 3,555    $ 

 4,007     $ 
 (4,034)   
 (27)   
 3,194    
 (493)   
 2,701    
 7,201    
 (4,527)   
 2,674    
 2,182    
 (636)   
 1,546    
 979    
 (1,306)   
 (327)   
 10,362    
 (6,469)   
 3,893     $ 

 6,690   
 (4,813)  
 1,877   
 3,433   
 (549)  
 2,884   
 10,123   
 (5,362)  
 4,761   
 1,078   
 (441)  
 637   
 529   
 (1,837)  
 (1,308)  
 11,730   
 (7,640)  
 4,090   

27%
-26%
126%
-1%
21%
3%
15%
-21%
4%
-7%
16%
-3%
-62%
16%
NM
3%
-10%
-9%

-40%
16%
NM
-7%
10%
-6%
-29%
16%
-44%
102%
-44%
143%
85%
29%
75%
-12%
15%
-5%

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2010  

      2009  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 6,087    $ 

 11,995     $   (22,187)  

-49%  

154%

 3,396   

 2,475    

 2,798   

37%  

-12%

We charge contract holders mortality and expense assessments on variable annuity accounts to cover insurance and administrative 
expenses.  These assessments are a function of the rates priced into the product and the average daily variable account values.  
Average daily account values are driven by net flows and the equity markets.  In addition, for our fixed annuity contracts and for 
some variable contracts, we collect surrender charges when contract holders surrender their contracts during their surrender charge 
periods to protect us from premature withdrawals.  Insurance fees include charges on both our variable and fixed annuity products, 
but exclude the attributed fees on our GLB products; see “Realized Gain (Loss) – Operating Realized Gain (Loss) – GLB” below 
for discussion of these attributed fees. 

77 

  
 
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
 
Net Investment Income and Interest Credited 

Details underlying net investment income, interest credited (in millions) and our interest rate spread were as follows: 

Net Investment Income  
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real   
   estate and other, net of investment expenses  
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment and  
    bond makewhole premiums (1) 
Alternative investments (2) 
Surplus investments (3) 
Broker-dealer  
      Total net investment income  

Interest Credited  
Amount provided to contract holders  
DSI deferrals  
   Interest credited before DSI amortization  
DSI amortization:  
   Prospective unlocking - assumption changes  
   Retrospective unlocking  
   Amortization, excluding unlocking  
      Total interest credited  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 1,002    $ 

 955     $ 

 901   

5%

6%

 23   
 1    
 93   
 -    
 1,119    $ 

 5    
 -    
 77    
 -    
 1,037     $ 

 739    $ 
 (65)  
 674   

 3    
 (7)   
 56   
 726    $ 

 730     $ 
 (75)   
 655    

 -    
 (5)   
 32    
 682     $ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 3   
 (2)  
 67   
 3   
 972   

 733   
 (95)  
 638   

 37   
 7   
 22   
 704   

NM  
NM  
21%  
NM  
8%  

1%  
13%  
3%  

NM  
-40%  
75%  
6%  

67%
100%
15%
-100%
7%

0%
21%
3%

-100%
NM
45%
-3%

(1)  See “Consolidated Investments – Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for 

additional information. 

(2)  See “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” below for additional information. 
(3)  Represents net investment income on the required statutory surplus for this segment and includes the effect of investment 
income on alternative investments for such assets that are held in the portfolios supporting statutory surplus versus the 
portfolios supporting product liabilities. 

Interest Rate Spread 
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real 
   estate and other, net of investment expenses 
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment and 
   bond make whole premiums 
Alternative investments 
   Net investment income yield on reserves 

   Interest rate credited to contract holders 
      Interest rate spread 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

Basis Point Change 
Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

5.50%  

5.50%   

5.79%  

 -   

0.13%  
0.01%  
5.64%  

3.52%  
2.12%  

0.03%   
0.00%   
5.53%   

3.77%   
1.76%   

0.02%  
-0.01%  
5.80%  

3.84%  
1.96%  

 10   
 1   
 11   

 (25)  
 36   

 (29)

 1 
 1 
 (27)

 (7)
 (20)

Note:  The yields, rates and spreads above are calculated using whole dollars instead of dollars rounded to millions. 

78 

  
 
 
 
                             
                        
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                    
  
  
 
  
  
 
                      
  
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Other Information 
Average invested assets on reserves 
Average fixed account values, including the 
   fixed portion of variable 
Transfers to the fixed portion of variable  
   annuity products from the variable portion of  
   variable annuity products 
Net flows for fixed annuities, including the  
   fixed portion of variable 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 18,248    $ 

 17,363    $ 

 15,784   

5%  

 20,029   

 18,249   

 17,263   

10%  

 (3,396)  

 (2,475)  

 (2,798)  

-37%  

 3,548   

 3,920   

 2,213   

-9%  

10%

6%

12%

77%

A portion of our investment income earned is credited to the contract holders of our fixed annuity products, including the fixed 
portion of variable annuity contracts.  We expect to earn a spread between what we earn on the underlying general account 
investments supporting the fixed annuity product line, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, and what we credit 
to our fixed annuity contract holders’ accounts, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts.  The interest rate spread 
for this segment represents the excess of the yield on invested assets on reserves over the average crediting rate.  The yield on 
invested assets on reserves is calculated as net investment income, excluding the amounts attributable to our surplus investments, 
reverse repurchase agreement interest expense, inter-segment cash management program interest expense and interest on collateral 
divided by average invested assets on reserves.  The average invested assets on reserves is calculated based upon total invested 
assets, excluding hedge derivatives and collateral.  The average crediting rate is calculated as interest credited before DSI 
amortization, plus the immediate annuity reserve change (included within benefits) divided by the average fixed account values, 
including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, net of coinsured account values.  Fixed account values reinsured under 
modified coinsurance agreements are included in account values for this calculation.  Changes in commercial mortgage loan 
prepayments and bond makewhole premiums, investment income on alternative investments and surplus investment income can 
vary significantly from period to period due to a number of factors and, therefore, may contribute to investment income results 
that are not indicative of the underlying trends. 

Benefits 

Benefits for this segment include changes in reserves of immediate annuity account values driven by premiums, changes in GDB 
and GLB benefit reserves and our expected costs associated with purchases of derivatives used to hedge our GDB benefit ratio 
unlocking. 

79 

  
 
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance and Other Expenses  

Details underlying underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses (in millions) were as follows: 

Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance and  
   Other Expenses  
Commissions:  
   Deferrable  
   Non-deferrable  
General and administrative expenses  
Inter-segment reimbursement associated with reserve   
   financing and LOC expenses (1) 
Taxes, licenses and fees  
      Total expenses incurred, excluding   
         broker-dealer  
DAC deferrals  
            Total pre-broker-dealer expenses incurred,  
               excluding amortization, net of interest  
DAC and VOBA amortization, net of interest:  
   Prospective unlocking - assumption changes  
   Prospective unlocking - model refinements  
   Retrospective unlocking   
   Amortization, net of interest, excluding  
      unlocking  
Broker-dealer expenses incurred  
                  Total underwriting, acquisition,   
                  insurance and other expenses  

DAC Deferrals  
As a percentage of sales/deposits  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 474    $ 
 223   
 337   

 463     $ 
 165    
 317    

 (1)   
 20   

 1    
 20    

 495    
 151    
 330    

 -    
 26    

 1,053   
 (624)  

 966    
 (624)  

 1,002    
 (686)   

2%
35%
6%  

NM  
0%  

9%  
0%  

 429   

 342    

 316    

25%  

 (41)  
 9    
 (84)  

 535   
 320   

 10    
 -    
 (19)  

 360    
 290    

 303    
 -    
 88    

 343    
 331    

NM  
NM  
NM  

49%  
10%  

-6%
9%
-4%

NM
-23%

-4%
9%

8%

-97%
NM
NM

5%
-12%

$ 

 1,168    $ 

 983     $ 

 1,381    

19%  

-29%

5.8%   

6.0%   

5.8%   

(1)  Represents reimbursements to Retirement Solutions – Annuities from the Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment for 
reserve financing, net of expenses incurred by Retirement Solutions – Annuities for its use of LOCs.  The inter-segment 
amounts are not reported on our Consolidated Statements of Income. 

Commissions and other costs that vary with and are related primarily to the production of new business are deferred to the extent 
recoverable and are amortized over the lives of the contracts in relation to EGPs.  Certain of our commissions, such as trail 
commissions that are based on account values, are expensed as incurred rather than deferred and amortized. 

Broker-dealer expenses that vary with and are related to sales are expensed as incurred and not deferred and amortized.  
Fluctuations in these expenses correspond with fluctuations in other revenues and fees. 

The increase in amortization, net of interest, excluding unlocking, when comparing 2010 to 2009, was due to a higher amortization 
rate from the reduction of projected EGPs for this segment being applied to the higher actual gross profits during 2010 (discussed 
above in “Additional Information”).  

During 2009, we had more unfavorable hedge program performance and securities impairments than our model projections 
assumed, which resulted in negative gross profits in total for certain cohorts.  As a result, the amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI 
and DFEL for those cohorts during 2010 was significantly higher than it was in the previous year. 

80 

  
 
 
 
                                 
                            
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
Income (Loss) from Operations 

Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution 

Details underlying the results for Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution (in millions) were as follows: 

Operating Revenues  
Insurance fees  
Net investment income  
Other revenues and fees (1) 
      Total operating revenues  
Operating Expenses  
Interest credited  
Benefits  
Underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other   
   expenses  
      Total operating expenses  
Income (loss) from operations before taxes  
Federal income tax expense (benefit)  
         Income (loss) from operations  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 201    $ 
 769   
 18   
 988   

 183    $ 
 732   
 11   
 926   

 440   
 2   

 445   
 (3)   

 332    
 774    
 214    
 60    
 154     $ 

 301   
 743   
 183   
 50   
 133    $ 

 222    
 695    
 15    
 932    

 430    
 9    

 341    
 780    
 152    
 29    
 123    

10%  
5%  
64%  
7%  

-1%  
167%  

10%  
4%  
17%  
20%  
16%  

-18%
5%
-27%
-1%

3%
NM

-12%
-5%
20%
72%
8%

(1)  Consists primarily of mutual fund account program fees for mid-to-large employers. 

Comparison of 2010 to 2009 

Income from operations for this segment increased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  Higher net investment income and relatively flat interest credited driven primarily by:  

(cid:5)  Higher average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, attributable primarily to 

transfers from variable to fixed since the fourth quarter of 2009; 

(cid:5)  Crediting rate actions implemented after the fourth quarter of 2009 that reduced interest crediting rates; 
(cid:5)  More favorable investment income on alternative investments within our surplus portfolio and higher prepayment and 

bond makewhole premiums (see “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” and  “Consolidated Investments 
– Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for more information); and 

(cid:5)  Holding lower cash balances during 2010 that resulted in our portfolio yields not declining as much as our crediting rates 

(see discussion in “Additional Information” below);  

(cid:2)  Higher insurance fees driven primarily by higher average daily variable account values due to higher equity markets, partially 

offset by an overall shift in business mix toward products with lower expense assessment rates;  

(cid:2)  A lower DAC, VOBA and DSI amortization rate, net of interest and excluding unlocking, during 2010 partially offset by a $3 
million unfavorable retrospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA and DSI, compared to a $1 million unfavorable retrospective 
unlocking during 2009: 
(cid:5)  The lower amortization rate during 2010 was due primarily to an overall shift in business mix towards products with lower 

deferrable expense rates for this segment; 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2010 was due primarily to higher lapses than our model projections 

assumed, partially offset by higher equity markets than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to higher lapses and maintenance expenses and 

lower equity markets than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:2)  A $5 million favorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI during 2010 compared to a $5 million favorable 

prospective unlocking during 2009 (see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for 
more information): 
(cid:5)  The favorable prospective unlocking during 2010 was due primarily to the effect of completing the planned conversion of 

our actuarial valuation systems to a uniform platform for certain blocks of business (see discussion in “Additional 
Information” below); and 

81 

  
 
 
 
 
                          
                          
 
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
(cid:5)  The favorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due to assumption changes attributable primarily to a 

compensation-related change in our wholesaling distribution organization that lowered deferrals as a percentage of total 
expenses incurred and lower maintenance expenses than our model projections assumed. 

The increase in income from operations was partially offset by higher underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses, 
excluding unlocking, due primarily to:  

(cid:2) 

Investments in strategic initiatives related to updating information technology and expanding distribution in 2010, as discussed 
in “Additional Information” below; and 

(cid:2)  Higher account value-based trail commissions driven by the effect of higher equity markets on account values. 

Comparison of 2009 to 2008 

Income from operations for this segment increased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  A $5 million favorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA and DSI during 2009 compared to a $26 million unfavorable 
prospective unlocking during 2008 (see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for 
more information): 
(cid:5)  The favorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due to assumption changes attributable primarily to a 

compensation-related change in our wholesaling distribution organization that lowered deferrals as a percentage of total 
expenses incurred and lower maintenance expenses than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2008 was due primarily to significantly unfavorable equity markets; 

(cid:2)  Higher net investment income, partially offset by higher interest credited, driven primarily by:  

(cid:5)  Higher average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, attributable primarily to 

transfers from variable to fixed since the third quarter of 2008; 

(cid:5)  Crediting rate actions implemented during the third quarter of 2009 that reduced interest crediting rates; and 
(cid:5)  More favorable investment income on surplus and alternative investments due to the improvement in the capital markets 

(see “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” below for additional information); partially offset by 

(cid:5)  Holding higher cash balances during the recent volatile markets that reduced our portfolio yields for 2009 (see discussion 

in “Additional Information” below);  

(cid:2)  A $1 million unfavorable retrospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA and DSI during 2009 compared to a $9 million unfavorable 

retrospective unlocking during 2008: 
(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to higher lapses and maintenance expenses and 

lower equity markets than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2008 was due primarily to higher lapses, maintenance expenses and future 

GDB claims than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:2)  Lower benefits from a decrease in the change in GDB reserves due to a decrease in our expected GDB benefit payments 

attributable primarily to the increase in account values due to the improvement in the equity markets in 2009. 

The increase in income from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Lower insurance fees driven primarily by lower average daily variable account values resulting from the unfavorable equity 

markets and an overall shift in business mix toward products with lower expense assessment rates;  

(cid:2)  A reduction in federal income tax expense in 2008 due primarily to favorable tax return true-ups driven by the separate 

account DRD and other items; and  

(cid:2)  Higher underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses, excluding unlocking, due primarily to higher expenses 

attributable to our U.S. pension plans and higher incentive compensation accruals as a result of higher earnings and production 
performance relative to planned goals. 

82 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Additional Information 

During 2010, we completed the planned conversion of our actuarial valuation systems to a uniform platform for certain blocks of 
business, which we deemed to be the most significant.  As a result, we recorded prospective unlocking during 2010 related to the 
conversion, as discussed in “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL.”  We have other blocks 
of business that we intend to convert in 2011.  Although we expect some differences to emerge as a result of the planned 
conversion of the other blocks of business, based upon the current status of these efforts, we are not able to provide an estimate or 
range of the effects to our results of operations until completion of the conversion. 

During 2010, we partnered with a leading provider of retirement recordkeeping services to enhance our retirement plan offerings.  
We expect to continue making strategic investments during 2011 to improve our infrastructure and product offerings that will also 
result in higher expenses.  In addition, we allocated more overhead costs to this segment during 2010, as the disposal of our 
Lincoln UK and Investment Management businesses resulted in a reallocation of overhead expenses to our remaining businesses.   

We experienced a favorable decline in expenses attributable to our U.S. pension plans during 2010 when compared to 2009, and 
this trend will continue in 2011.  For additional information, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Pension and Other 
Postretirement Benefit Plans.” 

During the volatile markets experienced in late 2008 and early 2009, we implemented a short-term liquidity strategy of maintaining 
higher cash balances that reduced our portfolio yields by 13 basis points during 2009.  As we progressed through 2009, we reduced 
these excess cash balances, thereby increasing our portfolio yields.    

New deposits are an important component of net flows and key to our efforts to grow our business.  Although deposits do not 
significantly affect current period income from operations, they are an important indicator of future profitability.   

The other component of net flows relates to the retention of the business.  An important measure of retention is the lapse rate, 
which compares the amount of withdrawals to the average account values.  The overall lapse rate for our annuity and mutual 
fund products was 14%, 12% and 13% for 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Our lapse rate is negatively affected by the 
continued net outflows from our oldest blocks of annuities business (as presented on our Account Value Roll Forward table below 
as “Total Multi-Fund® and Other Variable Annuities”), which are also our higher margin product lines in this segment, due to the 
fact that they are mature blocks with much of the account values out of their surrender charge period.  The proportion of these 
products to our total account values was 42%, 45% and 50% for 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  Due to this expected overall 
shift in business mix toward products with lower returns, a significant increase in new deposit production will be necessary to 
maintain earnings at current levels. 

Our net flows were negative for the year ended December 31, 2010, due primarily to the lapse of certain large cases during the 
second half of 2010 with total account values of approximately $800 million. 

See Note 11 for information on contractual guarantees to contract holders related to GDB features for our Retirement Solutions 
business. 

Our fixed annuity business includes products with discretionary and index-based crediting rates that are reset on a quarterly basis.  
Our ability to retain quarterly reset annuities will be subject to current competitive conditions at the time interest rates for these 
products reset.  We expect to manage the effects of spreads on near-term income from operations through portfolio management 
and, to a lesser extent, crediting rate actions, which assumes no significant changes in net flows into or out of our fixed accounts or 
other changes that may cause interest rate spreads to differ from our expectations.  For information on interest rate spreads and 
the interest rate risk due to falling interest rates, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – Changes in interest rates and sustained low 
interest rates may cause interest rate spreads to decrease and changes in interest rates may also result in increased contract 
withdrawals” and “Part II – Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Interest Rate Risk – Interest 
Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Falling Rates.”  

We provide information about this segment’s operating revenue and operating expense line items, the period in which amounts are 
recognized, key drivers of changes and historical details underlying the line items and their associated drivers below.   

83 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Insurance Fees 

Details underlying insurance fees, account values and net flows (in millions) were as follows: 

Insurance Fees 
Annuity expense assessments 
Mutual fund fees 
   Total expense assessments 
Surrender charges 
      Total insurance fees 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 172    $ 
 26   
 198   
 3   
 201    $ 

 157    $ 
 22    
 179   
 4    
 183    $ 

 197    
 19    
 216    
 6    
 222    

10%
18%
11%
-25%
10%  

-20%
16%
-17%
-33%
-18%

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

Averages 
Daily variable annuity account values, excluding the 
   fixed portion of variable 

$ 

 12,930    $ 

 11,315    $ 

 14,935 

Daily S&P 500 

    1,138.78   

 947.53   

    1,220.72     

14%  

20%  

-24%

-22%

Account Values  
Variable portion of variable annuities  
Fixed portion of variable annuities  
   Total variable annuities  
Fixed annuities  
      Total annuities  
Mutual funds (1) 
         Total annuities and mutual funds  

As of December 31, 
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2008  

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 13,927    $ 
 6,150 
 20,077 
 6,629   
 26,706   
 12,118   
 38,824    $ 

 12,953    $ 
 6,107 
 19,060 
 6,139   
 25,199   
 10,103   
 35,302    $ 

 10,588 
 6,037  
 16,625 
 5,601  
 22,226 
 6,652  
 28,878 

8%
1%
5%
8%
6%
20%
10%

22%
1%
15%
10%
13%
52%
22%

(1) 

Includes mutual fund account values and other third-party trustee-held assets.  These items are not included in the separate 
accounts reported on our Consolidated Balance Sheets as we do not have any ownership interest in them. 

84 

  
 
 
 
                          
                     
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                     
                     
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
    
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
  
  
  
 
                        
                        
  
  
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
    
    
 
  
    
    
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
Account Value Roll Forward – By Product  
Total Micro – Small Segment:  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Gross deposits   
Withdrawals and deaths  
   Net flows  
Transfers between fixed and variable accounts  
Inter-product transfer (1) 
Investment increase and change in market value  
      Balance as of end-of-year  

Total Mid – Large Segment:  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Gross deposits  
Withdrawals and deaths  
   Net flows  
Transfers between fixed and variable accounts  
Inter-product transfer (1) 
Other (2) 
Investment increase and change in market value  
      Balance as of end-of-year  

Total Multi-Fund® and Other Variable Annuities:  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Gross deposits  
Withdrawals and deaths  
   Net flows  
Transfers between fixed and variable accounts  
Inter-segment transfer  
Investment increase and change in market value  
      Balance as of end-of-year  

Total Annuities and Mutual Funds:  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Gross deposits  
Withdrawals and deaths  
   Net flows  
Transfers between fixed and variable accounts  
Inter-segment transfer  
Other (2) 
Investment increase and change in market value  
      Balance as of end-of-year (3) 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 5,863    $ 
 1,242   
 (1,377)   
 (135)  
 4    
 -    
 664   
 6,396    $ 

 4,888    $ 
 1,157   
 (1,273)  
 (116)  
 (2)  
 -   
 1,093   
 5,863    $ 

 13,653    $ 
 3,308   
 (2,558)   
 750   
 16    
 -    
 186   
 1,602   
 16,207    $ 

 9,540    $ 
 2,954   
 (1,110)  
 1,844   
 12   
 -    
 -    
 2,257   
 13,653    $ 

 15,786    $ 
 751   
 (1,657)   
 (906)   
 -    
 -    
 1,341   
 16,221    $ 

 14,450    $ 
 841   
 (1,574)  
 (733)  
 (1)  
 -   
 2,070   
 15,786    $ 

 35,302    $ 
 5,301   
 (5,592)   
 (291)   
 20    
 -    
 186   
 3,607   
 38,824    $ 

 28,878    $ 
 4,952   
 (3,957)  
 995   
 9   
 -   
 -   
 5,420   
 35,302    $ 

 7,798   
 1,531   
 (1,740)  
 (209)  
 (8)   
 (653)  
 (2,040)  
 4,888   

 9,463   
 2,933   
 (871)  
 2,062   
 (55)  
 653   
 -    
 (2,583)  
 9,540   

 18,797   
 1,083   
 (2,155)  
 (1,072)  
 (2)   
 295   
 (3,568)  
 14,450   

 36,058   
 5,547   
 (4,766)  
 781   
 (65)  
 295   
 -    
 (8,191)  
 28,878   

20%  
7%  
-8%  
-16%  
300%  
NM  
-39%  
9%  

43%  
12%  
NM  
-59%  
33%  
NM  
NM  
-29%  
19%  

9%  
-11%  
-5%  
-24%  
100%  
NM  
-35%  
3%  

22%  
7%  
-41%  
NM  
122%  
NM  
NM  
-33%  
10%  

-37%
-24%
27%
44%
75%
100%
154%
20%

1%
1%
-27%
-11%
122%
-100%
NM
187%
43%

-23%
-22%
27%
32%
50%
-100%
158%
9%

-20%
-11%
17%
27%
114%
-100%
NM
166%
22%

(1)  On September 30, 2008, there was a transfer relating to the Lincoln Employee 401(k) Plan from LINCOLN DIRECTORSM to 

LINCOLN ALLIANCE®. 

(2)  Represents LINCOLN ALLIANCE® program assets held by a third-party trustee that were not previously included in the 
account value roll forward.  Effective January 1, 2010, all such LINCOLN ALLIANCE® program activity was included in 
the account value roll forward. 
Includes mutual fund account values and other third-party trustee-held assets as mentioned in footnote two.  These items are 
not included in the separate accounts reported on our Consolidated Balance Sheets as we do not have any ownership interest 
in them. 

(3) 

85 

  
 
 
                        
                        
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Net Flows on Account Values 
Variable portion of variable annuity deposits 
Variable portion of variable annuity withdrawals 
   Variable portion of variable annuity net flows 
Fixed portion of variable annuity deposits 
Fixed portion of variable annuity withdrawals 
   Fixed portion of variable annuity net flows 
      Total variable annuity deposits 
      Total variable annuity withdrawals 
        Total variable annuity net flows 
Fixed annuity deposits 
Fixed annuity withdrawals 
   Fixed annuity net flows 
         Total annuity deposits 
         Total annuity withdrawals 
            Total annuity net flows 
Mutual fund deposits 
Mutual fund withdrawals 
   Mutual fund net flows 
               Total annuity and mutual fund deposits 
               Total annuity and mutual fund  
                  withdrawals 
                     Total annuity and mutual fund  
                        net flows 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 1,614    $ 
 (2,158)  
 (544)  
 315   
 (669)  
 (354)  
 1,929   
 (2,827)  
 (898)  
 1,017   
 (1,010)  
 7   
 2,946   
 (3,837)  
 (891)  
 2,355   
 (1,755)  
 600   
 5,301   

 1,586    $ 
 (1,888)  
 (302)  
 331   
 (737)  
 (406)  
 1,917   
 (2,625)  
 (708)  
 1,011   
 (667)  
 344   
 2,928   
 (3,292)  
 (364)  
 2,024   
 (665)  
 1,359   
 4,952   

 2,170    
 (2,708)   
 (538)   
 369    
 (991)   
 (622)   
 2,539    
 (3,699)   
 (1,160)   
 812    
 (557)   
 255    
 3,351    
 (4,256)   
 (905)   
 2,196    
 (510)   
 1,686    
 5,547    

2%
-14%
-80%
-5%
9%
13%
1%
-8%
-27%
1%
-51%
-98%
1%
-17%
NM
16%
NM
-56%
7%

 (5,592)  

 (3,957)  

 (4,766)  

-41%

$ 

 (291)   $ 

 995    $ 

 781    

NM

-27%
30%
44%
-10%
26%
35%
-24%
29%
39%
25%
-20%
35%
-13%
23%
60%
-8%
-30%
-19%
-11%

17%

27%

Other Changes to Account Values 
Change in market value on variable, excluding the 
   fixed portion of variable 
Transfers to the variable portion of variable  
   annuity products from the fixed portion of  
   variable annuity products 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

  Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 1,687    $ 

 2,843    $ 

 (5,942)  

-41%  

148%

 (169)   

 (176)  

 (461)  

4%  

62%

We charge expense assessments to cover insurance and administrative expenses.  Expense assessments are generally equal to a 
percentage of the daily variable account values.  Average daily account values are driven by net flows and the equity markets.  Our 
expense assessments include fees we earn for the services that we provide to our mutual fund programs.  In addition, for both our 
fixed and variable annuity contracts, we collect surrender charges when contract holders surrender their contracts during the 
surrender charge periods to protect us from premature withdrawals.  

Our net flows were negative for the year ended December 31, 2010, due primarily to the lapse of certain large cases during the 
second half of 2010 with total account values of approximately $800 million. 

86 

  
 
                                     
                                     
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
                      
                      
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
 
  
    
  
    
 
    
 
  
    
  
    
 
    
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
Net Investment Income and Interest Credited 

Details underlying net investment income, interest credited (in millions) and our interest rate spread were as follows: 

Net Investment Income  
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real  
   estate and other, net of investment expenses  
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment and   
   bond makewhole premiums (1) 
Alternative investments (2) 
Surplus investments (3) 
      Total net investment income  

Interest Credited  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 705    $ 

 681     $ 

 655    

4%

4%

 9   
 3   
 52   
 769    $ 

 5    
 1    
 45    
 732     $ 

 7    
 (6)   
 39    
 695    

80%  
200%  
16%  
5%  

-29%
117%
15%
5%

 440    $ 

 445     $ 

 430    

-1%  

3%

$ 

$ 

(1)  See “Consolidated Investments – Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for 

additional information. 

(2)  See “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” below for additional information. 
(3)  Represents net investment income on the required statutory surplus for this segment and includes the effect of investment 
income on alternative investments for such assets that are held in the portfolios supporting statutory surplus versus the 
portfolios supporting product liabilities. 

Interest Rate Spread 
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real 
   estate and other, net of investment expenses 
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment and 
   bond makewhole premiums 
Alternative investments 
   Net investment income yield on reserves 
   Interest rate credited to contract holders 
      Interest rate spread 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

Basis Point Change 
Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

5.70%  

5.76%   

5.89%  

 (6)  

 (13)

0.08%  
0.02%  
5.80%  
3.49%  
2.31%  

0.04%   
0.01%   
5.81%   
3.70%   
2.11%   

0.06%  
-0.05%  
5.90%  
3.79%  
2.11%  

 4   
 1   
 (1)  
 (21)  
 20   

 (2)
 6 
 (9)
 (9)
- 

Note:  The yields, rates and spreads above are calculated using whole dollars instead of dollars rounded to millions. 

Other Information 
Average invested assets on reserves 
Average fixed account values, including the 
   fixed portion of variable 
Transfers to the fixed portion of variable  
   annuity products from the variable portion of  
   variable annuity products 
Net flows for fixed annuities, including the  
   fixed portion of variable 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 12,360    $ 

 11,815    $ 

 11,113    

 12,580   

 12,024   

 11,330    

5%  

5%  

6%

6%

 169   

 176    

 461    

-4%  

-62%

 (347)  

 (62)  

 (367)   

NM  

83%

87 

  
 
 
 
                             
                        
  
  
  
  
     
 
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
     
 
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
     
 
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
                        
     
 
     
  
    
  
  
 
 
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
                           
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
                       
                            
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
A portion of our investment income earned is credited to the contract holders of our fixed annuity products, including the fixed 
portion of variable annuity contracts.  We expect to earn a spread between what we earn on the underlying general account 
investments supporting the fixed annuity product line, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts, and what we credit 
to our fixed annuity contract holders’ accounts, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts.  The interest rate spread 
for this segment represents the excess of the yield on invested assets on reserves over the average crediting rate.  The yield on 
invested assets on reserves is calculated as net investment income, excluding the amounts attributable to our surplus investments, 
reverse repurchase agreement interest expense, inter-segment cash management program interest expense and interest on collateral, 
divided by average invested assets on reserves.  The average invested assets on reserves are calculated based upon total invested 
assets, excluding hedge derivatives.  The average crediting rate is calculated as interest credited before DSI amortization, divided by 
the average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable annuity contracts.  Commercial mortgage loan 
prepayments and bond makewhole premiums, investment income on alternative investments and surplus investment income can 
vary significantly from period to period due to a number of factors and, therefore, may contribute to investment income results 
that are not indicative of the underlying trends. 

Benefits 

Benefits for this segment include changes in GDB and GLB benefit reserves and our expected costs associated with purchases of 
derivatives used to hedge our GDB benefit ratio unlocking.  

Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance and Other Expenses  

Details underlying underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses (in millions) were as follows: 

Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance and 
   Other Expenses 
Commissions: 
   Deferrable 
   Non-deferrable 
General and administrative expenses 
Taxes, licenses and fees 
      Total expenses incurred 
DAC deferrals 
         Total expenses recognized before  
            amortization 
DAC and VOBA amortization, net of interest: 
   Prospective unlocking - assumption changes 
   Prospective unlocking - model refinements 
   Retrospective unlocking 
   Amortization, net of interest, excluding  
      unlocking 
               Total underwriting, acquisition, insurance 
                  and other expenses 

DAC Deferrals 
As a percentage of annuity sales/deposits 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 27     $ 
 38    
 242   
 13    
 320   
 (67)   

 28    $ 
 36   
 221   
 12   
 297   
 (69)  

 37   
 35   
 220   
 13   
 305   
 (94)  

-4%
6%
10%  
8%  
8%  
3%  

-24%
3%
0%
-8%
-3%
27%

 253   

 228   

 211   

11%  

8%

 (16)   
 8    
 4    

 83    

 (8)   
 -    
 2   

 79   

 39   
 -    
 14   

 77   

-100%  
NM  
100%  

NM
NM
-86%

5%  

3%

$ 

 332    $ 

 301    $ 

 341   

10%  

-12%

2.3%   

2.4%   

2.8%   

Commissions and other costs that vary with and are related primarily to the sale of annuity contracts are deferred to the extent 
recoverable and are amortized over the lives of the contracts in relation to EGPs.  Certain of our commissions, such as trail 
commissions that are based on account values, are expensed as incurred rather than deferred and amortized.  We do not pay 
commissions on sales of our mutual fund products, and distribution expenses associated with the sale of these mutual fund 
products are expensed as incurred. 

88 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
RESULTS OF INSURANCE SOLUTIONS 

The Insurance Solutions business provides its products through two segments:  Life Insurance and Group Protection.  The 
Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment offers wealth protection and transfer opportunities through term insurance, a linked-
benefit product (which is a UL policy linked with riders that provide for long-term care costs) and both single and survivorship 
versions of UL and VUL, including corporate-owned UL and VUL (“COLI”) and bank-owned UL and VUL (“BOLI”) products.  
The Insurance Solutions – Group Protection segment offers group life, disability and dental insurance to employers. 

For factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk 
Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above. 

Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 

Income (Loss) from Operations 

Details underlying the results for Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance (in millions) were as follows: 

Operating Revenues 
Insurance premiums 
Insurance fees 
Net investment income 
Other revenues and fees 
      Total operating revenues 
Operating Expenses 
Interest credited 
Benefits 
Underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other 
   expenses 
      Total operating expenses 
Income (loss) from operations before taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
         Income (loss) from operations 

Comparison of 2010 to 2009 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 439    $ 

 392    $ 

 1,934   
 2,186   
 31   
 4,590   

 1,198   
 1,735   

 1,901   
 1,975   
 27    
 4,295   

 1,184   
 1,374   

 908   
 3,841   
 749   
 236   
 513    $ 

 923   
 3,481   
 814   
 245   
 569    $ 

$ 

 360    
 1,880    
 1,988    
 33    
 4,261    

 1,202    
 1,372    

 879    
 3,453    
 808    
 267    
 541    

12%  
2%  
11%  
15%  
7%  

1%  
26%  

-2%  
10%  
-8%  
-4%  
-10%  

9%
1%
-1%
-18%
1%

-1%
0%

5%
1%
1%
-8%
5%

Income from operations for this segment decreased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  An $83 million unfavorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DFEL and secondary guarantee life insurance product 
reserves during 2010 compared to a $7 million unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 (see “Critical Accounting 
Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for more information):  
(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2010 was due to a $101 million unfavorable unlocking from assumption 
changes due primarily to adjustments to secondary guarantee life insurance product reserves and lower investment 
margins, attributable primarily to lowering our new money investment yield assumption to reflect the then current new 
money rates and to approximate the forward curve for interest rates relevant at such time, as this effect alone represented 
$114 million unfavorable unlocking (see “Additional Information” below), partially offset by lower death claims and lapses 
than our model projections assumed, net of an $18 million favorable unlocking from model refinements; and 
(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due to assumption changes attributable primarily to lower 

investment margins and higher expenses, death claims and lapses than our model projections assumed; 

(cid:2)  An increase in benefits, excluding unlocking, attributable primarily to: 

(cid:5)  Higher death claims;  
(cid:5)  An increase in traditional product reserves due to the harmonization of certain processes; and  
(cid:5)  An increase in secondary guarantee life insurance product reserves from continued growth in the business; 

(cid:2)  The inter-company reinsurance arrangement effective December 31, 2009, discussed below, which resulted in a reduction in 

net investment income and an increase in underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses; 

(cid:2)  More favorable tax return true-ups recorded in 2009 than in 2010; and 

89 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                         
                              
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
(cid:2)  A higher DAC, VOBA and DFEL amortization rate, net of interest, excluding unlocking, during 2010, partially offset by a $3 
million unfavorable retrospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA and DFEL during 2010, compared to an $18 million unfavorable 
retrospective unlocking during 2009: 
(cid:5)  The higher amortization rate during 2010 was due primarily to the reduction of projected EGPs for this segment 

(discussed in “Additional Information” below); 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2010 was due primarily to lower premiums received and higher death 
claims than our model projections assumed, partially offset by lower lapses and expenses than our model projections 
assumed; and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable retrospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to lower premiums received and investment 

income on alternative investments and prepayment and bond makewhole premiums than our model projections assumed, 
partially offset by lower death claims and lapses than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:2)  An increase in expenses associated with reserve financing supporting our secondary guarantee UL and term business due 

primarily to higher pricing that has occurred in reaction to the unfavorable market conditions experienced during the recession 
and our continued efforts to reduce the strain of these statutory reserves (see “Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain” 
below for more information). 

The decrease in income from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Higher net investment income and relatively flat interest credited attributable primarily to: 

(cid:5)  More favorable investment income on surplus and alternative investments and higher prepayment and bond makewhole 
premiums (see “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” and “Consolidated Investments – Commercial 
Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for more information); 

(cid:5)  Growth in business in force; and 
(cid:5)  Actions implemented to reduce interest crediting rates, discussed in “Additional Information” below. 

Comparison of 2009 to 2008 

Income from operations for this segment increased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  A $7 million unfavorable prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DFEL and secondary guarantee life insurance product 
reserves during 2009 compared to a $53 million unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2008 (see “Critical Accounting 
Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” for more information): 
(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2009 was due primarily to lower investment margins and higher expenses, 

death claims and lapses than our model projections assumed; and 

(cid:5)  The unfavorable prospective unlocking during 2008 was due to a $34 million unfavorable unlocking from model 

refinements and a $19 million unfavorable unlocking from assumption changes due primarily to the effect of significantly 
unfavorable equity markets on our VUL block of business, partially offset by adjustments to secondary guarantee life 
insurance product reserves; 
(cid:2)  Growth in business in force; and 
(cid:2)  A reduction in federal income tax expense due primarily to favorable tax return true-ups in the first quarter of 2009. 

The increase in income from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Lower net investment income due primarily to unfavorable results from our alternative investments (see “Consolidated 

Investments – Alternative Investments” below for more information); 

(cid:2)  The inter-company reinsurance arrangement effective December 31, 2008, discussed below, which resulted in a reduction in 

net investment income and an increase in underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses; and 

(cid:2)  The transfer of a closed block of life insurance policies to a third party, discussed below, which resulted in reductions in 

insurance fees, net investment income, interest credited, benefits and underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses. 

We provide information about this segment’s operating revenue and operating expense line items, the period in which amounts are 
recognized, key drivers of changes and historical details underlying the line items and their associated drivers below. 

90 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain 

Our insurance subsidiaries have statutory surplus and RBC levels above current regulatory required levels.  Products containing 
secondary guarantees require reserves calculated under Actuarial Guideline 38, or The Application of the Valuation of Life 
Insurance Policies Model Regulation (“AG38”).  Our insurance subsidiaries are employing strategies to reduce the strain of 
increasing AG38 and Valuation of Life Insurance Policies Model Regulation (“XXX”) statutory reserves associated with secondary 
guarantee UL and term products.  As discussed further below, we have been successful in executing reinsurance solutions to 
release capital to Other Operations.  We expect to regularly execute transactions designed to release capital as we continue to sell 
products that are subject to these reserving requirements.  We also plan to refinance prior transactions with long-term structured 
solutions.  Recently, we introduced new secondary guarantee UL products that are more capital efficient, reducing our dependency 
on such reinsurance solutions.  

Included in the LOCs issued as of December 31, 2010, as discussed in Note 13 and reported in the credit facilities table below in 
“Review of Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources – Financing Activities,” was approximately $1.9 
billion of LOCs available to support inter-company reinsurance arrangements, of which approximately $1.1 billion was available for 
UL business with secondary guarantees and approximately $800 million was available for term business.  LOCs and related capital 
market alternatives lower the capital effect of secondary guarantee UL products.  An inability to obtain the necessary LOC capacity 
or other capital market alternatives could affect our returns on our in-force secondary guarantee UL business.  However, we 
believe that our insurance subsidiaries have sufficient capital to support the increase in statutory reserves if such structures are not 
available.  See “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – Attempts to mitigate the impact of Regulation XXX and Actuarial Guideline 38 
may fail in whole or in part resulting in an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations” for further 
information on XXX reserves.  Our expenses associated with reserve financing are separately reflected in the underwriting, 
acquisition, insurance and other expenses table below.  We expect these expenses will approximately double in 2011 as compared 
to the level we experienced in 2010 as a result of higher pricing that has occurred in reaction to the unfavorable market conditions 
experienced during the recession and our expectation to execute additional reserve financing arrangements. 

Effective December 31, 2010, we completed a private placement transaction with a non-affiliated entity that replaced the use of 
$500 million in LOCs supporting UL business with secondary guarantees with a 30-year structured solution.  Additionally, during 
the second quarter of 2010, we replaced credit facilities that were to mature in the first quarter of 2011 and completed a $500 
million 30-year senior notes offering, the proceeds of which were used to execute a long-term structured solution supporting UL 
business with secondary guarantees that was effective July 1, 2010.   

As of December 31, 2010, we released approximately $230 million of capital that had previously supported statutory reserves 
related to our term products as a result of executing on an inter-company reinsurance arrangement.  This reduction in capital 
lowered the level of invested assets required to support the reserves of this business, which we transferred to Other Operations 
where we maintain capital not allocated to our businesses.  The cost of the LOCs supporting this business together with the effect 
of lower net investment income associated with assets shifting from backing reserves in this segment to surplus in Other 
Operations will reduce this segment’s quarterly income from operations by approximately $3 million; $2 million of which is a shift 
to Other Operations due to the transfer of invested assets. 

As of December 31, 2009, we released approximately $400 million of capital that had previously supported statutory reserves 
related to our term products as a result of executing on an LOC transaction with a third party to support an inter-company  
reinsurance arrangement.  As part of this transaction, we entered into a $550 million 10-year LOC facility related to this business.  
For more information on this transaction, see “Review of Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources – 
Financing Activities.”  This reduction in capital lowered the level of invested assets required to support the reserves of this 
business.  The cost of the LOC together with the effect of lower net investment income associated with assets shifting from 
backing reserves in this segment to surplus in Other Operations has reduced this segment’s quarterly income from operations by 
approximately $7 million; $4 million of which is a shift to Other Operations due to the transfer of invested assets. 

As of December 31, 2008, we released approximately $240 million of capital that had previously supported statutory reserves 
related to our UL products with secondary guarantees as a result of executing on an inter-company reinsurance arrangement.  This 
reduction in capital lowered the level of invested assets required to support the reserves of this business.  These invested assets 
were transferred to Other Operations to our surplus portfolio as excess capital, which caused an approximate $4 million per 
quarter ongoing reduction in this segment’s net investment income. 

Additional Information 

We are in the process of completing a conversion of our actuarial valuation systems to a uniform valuation platform for a 
significant portion of this segment’s blocks of business as discussed in “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, 
DSI and DFEL” above.  Although we expect some differences to emerge as a result of this exercise, based upon the current status 
of these efforts, we are not able to provide an estimate or range of the effects to our results of operations until completion of the 
conversion.   

91 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
We allocated more overhead costs to this segment during 2010, as the disposal of our Lincoln UK and Investment Management 
businesses resulted in a reallocation of overhead expenses to our remaining businesses.  Additionally, we made strategic 
investments during 2010 that resulted in higher expenses, and we expect this trend will continue in 2011. 

We experienced a favorable decline in expenses attributable to our U.S. pension plans during 2010 when compared to 2009, and 
this trend will continue in 2011.  For additional information, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Pension and Other 
Postretirement Benefit Plans.” 

Effective March 31, 2009, we transferred a closed block of business consisting of certain UL and VUL insurance products to a 
third party.  During the fourth quarter of 2009, one of our insurance subsidiaries executed a separate agreement whereby we 
assumed the mortality risk associated with this business on a yearly-renewable basis.  These transactions caused an approximate $6 
million per quarter ongoing reduction in this segment’s income from operations as a result of reductions in insurance fees and net 
investment income, partially offset by reductions in interest credited and benefits.  The assumption of the mortality risk associated 
with this business on a yearly-renewable basis resulted in an approximate $13 million per quarter ongoing increase in insurance 
premiums offset by an increase in benefits.  The unfavorable effect to this segment’s income from operations was partially offset 
by an approximate $2 million per quarter ongoing increase to income from operations in Other Operations, as a result of having 
higher net investment income due to the transfer of invested assets from Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance.  The transfer of 
invested assets from this segment was attributable to a reduction in capital as a result of the transfer of this business to a third 
party.  These transactions caused a net $4 million per quarter ongoing reduction to our consolidated net income.  Effective April 1, 
2010, the agreement to assume the mortality risk associated with this business on a yearly-renewable basis was terminated and 
replaced with an inter-company reinsurance agreement that effectively resulted in no change to the effect to income from 
operations discussed above and removed any effects to insurance premiums and benefits.  

On January 1, 2011, we implemented a 65 basis point decrease in crediting rates on most interest-sensitive products not already at 
contractual guarantees, which is expected to reduce overall crediting rates by approximately 7 basis points.  On January 1, 2010, we 
implemented a 20 basis point decrease in crediting rates on most interest-sensitive products not already at contractual guarantees, 
which reduced overall crediting rates by approximately 3 basis points.  On March 1, 2009, we implemented a 15 basis point 
decrease in crediting rates on most interest-sensitive products not already at contractual guarantees, which reduced overall crediting 
rates by approximately 5 basis points.  On June 1, 2008, we implemented a 10 basis point decrease in crediting rates on most 
interest-sensitive products not already at contractual guarantees, which reduced overall crediting rates by approximately 5 basis 
points. 

We expect to manage the effects of spreads on near-term income from operations through portfolio management and, to a lesser 
extent, crediting rate actions, which assumes no significant changes in net flows into or out of our fixed accounts or other changes 
that may cause interest rate spreads to differ from our expectations.  During the fourth quarter of 2010, we locked in Treasury rates 
by executing reverse treasury locks on $1.0 billion of assets backing our secondary guarantee business at rates in excess of those 
required by product pricing.  These locks will mature over 2012 to 2016.  As mentioned above, during the third quarter of 2010, we 
lowered our new money investment yield assumption to reflect the then current new money rates and to approximate the forward 
curve for interest rates relevant at such time.  The result was a drop in the current new money investment rate followed by a 
gradual annual recovery over eight years to a rate of 6.31%, 54 basis points below our previous ultimate long-term assumption of 
6.85%.  As a result of this assumption revision, we recorded a $114 million, after-tax, unfavorable prospective unlocking.  This also 
had the effect of lowering the projected EGPs for this segment, thereby increasing our rate of amortization, which results in higher 
DAC, VOBA and DFEL amortization and lower earnings for this segment.  For information on interest rate spreads and the 
interest rate risk due to falling interest rates, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – Changes in interest rates and sustained low 
interest rates may cause interest rate spreads to decrease and changes in interest rates may also result in increased contract 
withdrawals” and “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Interest Rate Risk – Interest 
Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Falling Rates.”  

Sales are not recorded as a component of revenues (other than for traditional products) and do not have a significant effect on 
current quarter income from operations but are indicators of future profitability.  Generally, we have higher sales during the second 
half of the year with the fourth quarter being our strongest. 

Insurance Premiums 

Insurance premiums relate to traditional products and are a function of the rates priced into the product and the level of insurance 
in force.  Insurance in force, in turn, is driven by sales, persistency and mortality experience.  

92 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Insurance Fees 

Details underlying insurance fees, sales, net flows, account values and in-force face amount (in millions) were as follows: 

Insurance Fees 
Mortality assessments 
Expense assessments 
Surrender charges 
DFEL: 
   Deferrals 
   Amortization, net of interest: 
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes 
      Prospective unlocking - model refinements 
      Retrospective unlocking 
      Amortization, net of interest, excluding  
         unlocking 
            Total insurance fees 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 1,287    $ 
 844   
 100   

 1,299    $ 
 759   
 112   

 1,321    
 707    
 69    

-1%
11%
-11%

-2%
7%
62%

 (472)  

 (439)  

 (379)   

-8%  

-16%

 56   
 (56)  
 24   

 20    
 -    
 15    

 12    
 (25)   
 35    

 151   
 1,934    $ 

 135   
 1,901    $ 

 140    
 1,880    

$ 

180%  
NM  
60%  

12%  
2%  

67%
100%
-57%

-4%
1%

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

Sales by Product  
UL:  
   Excluding MoneyGuard® 
   MoneyGuard® 
      Total UL  
VUL  
COLI and BOLI  
Term  
         Total sales  

Net Flows  
Deposits  
Withdrawals and deaths  
   Net flows  

Contract holder assessments  

Account Values  
UL (1) 
VUL (1) 
Interest-sensitive whole life  
   Total account values  

In-Force Face Amount  
UL and other (1) 
Term insurance (2) 
   Total in-force face amount  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 $ 

 353 
 108    
 461   
 43   
 63   
 70   
 637    $ 

 397    $ 
 67    
 464   
 36    
 51    
 59    
 610    $ 

 525  
 50    
 575    
 54    
 84    
 28    
 741    

 4,934    $ 
 (1,877) 
 3,057    $ 

 4,451    $ 
 (2,030)  
 2,421    $ 

 4,493    
 (1,671)
 2,822    

 3,119    $ 

 2,996    $ 

 2,791    

-11%  
61%  
-1%  
19%  
24%  
19%  
4%  

11%
8%
26%

4%

-24%
34%
-19%
-33%
-39%
111%
-18%

-1%
-21%
-14%

7%

As of December 31, 
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2008  

2010  

2009  

 26,199 
 5,108   
 2,278   
 33,585 

 $ 

 $ 

 24,994    $ 
 4,468   
 2,282   
 31,744    $ 

 25,199 
 4,251    
 2,303    
 31,753 

$   297,837 
    265,154   
$   562,991 

 $   291,879    $   310,198  
    248,726   
    235,023    
 $   540,605    $   545,221  

93 

5%
14%
0%
6%

2%
7%
4%

-1%
5%
-1%
0%

-6%
6%
-1%

  
 
 
 
                            
                       
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
                             
                             
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
    
  
 
 
                             
                        
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
   
  
   
  
   
 
 
(1)  Effective with the March 31, 2009, transfer of certain life insurance policies to a third party, UL and VUL account values were 
reduced by $938 million and $640 million, respectively, and UL and other face amount in force was reduced by $20.9 billion. 
(2)  Excludes $19.8 billion of face amount in force associated with our assumption of the mortality risk effective October 1, 2009, 

on the block of business mentioned in footnote one above. 

Insurance fees relate only to interest-sensitive products and include mortality assessments, expense assessments (net of deferrals 
and amortization related to DFEL) and surrender charges.  Mortality and expense assessments are deducted from our contract 
holders’ account values.  These amounts are a function of the rates priced into the product and premiums received, face amount in 
force and account values.  Insurance in force, in turn, is driven by sales, persistency and mortality experience.  In-force growth 
should be considered independently with respect to term products versus UL and other products, as term products have a lower 
profitability relative to face amount compared to interest-sensitive and other products. 

Sales in the table above and as discussed above were reported as follows: 

(cid:2)  UL (excluding linked-benefit products) and VUL (including COLI and BOLI) – first year commissionable premiums plus 5% 
of excess premiums received, including an adjustment for internal replacements of approximately 50% of commissionable 
premiums; 

(cid:2)  MoneyGuard® (our linked-benefit product) – 15% of premium deposits; and 
(cid:2)  Term – 100% of first year paid premiums. 

UL and VUL products with secondary guarantees represented approximately 40% of interest-sensitive life insurance in force as of 
December 31, 2010, and approximately 52% of sales for 2010.  Actuarial Guideline 37, or Variable Life Reserves for Guaranteed 
Minimum Death Benefits, and AG38 impose additional statutory reserve requirements for these products. 

Net Investment Income and Interest Credited 

Details underlying net investment income, interest credited (in millions) and our interest rate spread were as follows: 

Net Investment Income  
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real  
   estate and other, net of investment expenses  
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment and  
   bond makewhole premiums (1) 
Alternative investments (2) 
Surplus investments (3) 
   Total net investment income  

Interest Credited  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 2,004    $ 

 1,942     $ 

 1,902   

3%

 30   
 49   
 103   
 2,186    $ 

 12    
 (69)   
 90    
 1,975     $ 

 16   
 (11)  
 81   
 1,988   

 1,198    $ 

 1,184     $ 

 1,202   

$ 

$ 

150%  
171%  
14%  
11%  

1%  

2%

-25%
NM
11%
-1%

-1%

(1)  See “Consolidated Investments – Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for 

additional information. 

(2)  See “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” below for additional information. 
(3)  Represents net investment income on the required statutory surplus for this segment and includes the effect of investment 
income on alternative investments for such assets that are held in the portfolios supporting statutory surplus versus the 
portfolios supporting product liabilities. 

94 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                             
                             
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Interest Rate Yields and Spread 
Attributable to interest-sensitive products: 
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real 
   estate and other, net of investment expenses 
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment and 
   bond makewhole premiums 
Alternative investments 
   Net investment income yield on reserves 
Interest rate credited to contract holders 
      Interest rate spread 

Attributable to traditional products: 
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real 
   estate and other, net of investment expenses 
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment  
   and bond makewhole premiums 
Alternative investments 
   Net investment income yield on reserves 

Averages  
Attributable to interest-sensitive products:  
Invested assets on reserves (1) 
Account values - universal and whole life (1) 

Attributable to traditional products:  
Invested assets on reserves  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

   Basis Point Change 

5.87%  

5.93%  

5.91%  

0.09%  
0.17%  
6.13%  
4.16%  
1.97%  

0.04%  
-0.25%  
5.72%  
4.23%  
1.49%  

0.05%  
-0.03%  
5.93%  
4.33%  
1.60%  

6.12%  

5.99%  

6.13%  

0.07%  
0.02%  
6.21%  

0.01%  
0.00%  
6.00%  

0.03%  
-0.03%  
6.13%  

 (6)  

 5   
 42   
 41   
 (7)  
 48   

 13   

 6   
 2   
 21   

 2 

 (1)
 (22)
 (21)
 (10)
 (11)

 (14)

 (2)
 3 
 (13)

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 29,391    $ 
 28,465   

 27,824    $ 
 27,674   

 27,003   
 27,286   

6%  
3%  

3%
1%

 4,465   

 4,896   

 5,058   

-9%  

-3%

(1)  We experienced declines in our average invested assets on reserves and account values attributable to interest-sensitive 

products subsequent to the transfer of certain life insurance policies to a third party, which reduced these balances by $927 
million and $938 million, respectively, on March 31, 2009. 

A portion of the investment income earned for this segment is credited to contract holder accounts.  Invested assets will typically 
grow at a faster rate than account values because of the AG38 reserve requirements, which cause statutory reserves to grow at a 
faster rate than account values.  Invested assets are based upon the statutory reserve liabilities and are therefore affected by various 
reserve adjustments, including capital transactions providing relief from AG38 reserve requirements, which leads to a transfer of 
invested assets from this segment to Other Operations for use in other corporate purposes.  We expect to earn a spread between 
what we earn on the underlying general account investments and what we credit to our contract holders’ accounts.  The interest 
rate spread for this segment represents the excess of the yield on invested assets on reserves over the average crediting rate on 
interest-sensitive products.  The yield on invested assets on reserves is calculated as net investment income, excluding amounts 
attributable to our surplus investments and reverse repurchase agreement interest expense, divided by average invested assets on 
reserves.  In addition, we exclude the effect of earnings from affordable housing tax credit securities, which is reflected as a 
reduction to federal income tax expense, from our spread calculations.  We use our investment income to offset the earnings effect 
of the associated build of our policy reserves for traditional products.  Commercial mortgage loan prepayments and bond 
makewhole premiums and investment income on alternative investments can vary significantly from period to period due to a 
number of factors, and, therefore, may contribute to investment income results that are not indicative of the underlying trends.   

See “Additional Information” above for a discussion of how we manage our spread compression risk, including locking in high-
yielding assets during 2010 to support our business. 

95 

  
 
 
                            
  
  
  
  
  
                           
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
   
  
  
 
                             
                             
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
Benefits 

Details underlying benefits (dollars in millions) were as follows: 

   For the Years Ended December 31,     Change Over Prior Year 
2008  

2009  

2009  

2010  

2010  

Benefits  
Death claims direct and assumed  
Death claims ceded  
Reserves released on death  
   Net death benefits  
Change in secondary guarantee life insurance  
   product reserves:  
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes  
      Prospective unlocking - model refinements  
      Change in reserves, excluding unlocking  
Other benefits (1) 
         Total benefits  

Death claims per $1,000 of inforce  

$ 

$ 

 2,538    $ 
 (1,154)   
 (433)   
 951   

 2,260    $ 
 (993)  
 (394)  
 873   

 2,177   
 (966)  
 (360)  
 851   

 84    
 71    
 306   
 323   
 1,735    $ 

 (3)  
 -   
 249   
 255   
 1,374    $ 

 1.72   

 1.63   

 8    
 76   
 155   
 282   
 1,372   

 1.58   

12%  
-16%  
-10%  
9%  

NM  
NM  
23%  
27%  
26%  

6%  

4%
-3%
-9%
3%

NM
-100%
61%
-10%
0%

3%

(1) 

Includes primarily traditional product changes in reserves and dividends. 

Benefits for this segment includes claims incurred during the period in excess of the associated reserves for its interest-sensitive 
and traditional products.  In addition, benefits includes the change in secondary guarantee life insurance product reserves.  The 
reserve for secondary guarantees is affected by changes in expected future trends of expense assessments causing unlocking 
adjustments to this liability similar to DAC, VOBA and DFEL. 

96 

  
 
 
 
                             
                        
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
   
 
  
  
   
  
  
   
 
  
  
   
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance and Other Expenses 

Details underlying underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses (in millions) were as follows: 

Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance and 
   Other Expenses 
Commissions 
General and administrative expenses 
Expenses associated with reserve financing 
Taxes, licenses and fees 
   Total expenses incurred 
DAC and VOBA deferrals 
      Total expenses recognized before amortization 
DAC and VOBA amortization, net of interest: 
   Prospective unlocking - assumption changes 
   Prospective unlocking - model refinements 
   Retrospective unlocking 
   Amortization, net of interest, excluding  
      unlocking 
Other intangible amortization 
         Total underwriting, acquisition, insurance 
            and other expenses 

DAC and VOBA Deferrals 
As a percentage of sales 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 664    $ 
 451   
 37    
 129   
 1,281   
 (915)   
 366   

 676    $ 
 451   
 6   
 115   
 1,248   
 (900)  
 348   

 795   
 422   
 4   
 119   
 1,340   
 (1,016)  
 324   

 129   
 (155)   
 28    

 536   
 4    

 33   
 -    
 42   

 496   
 4   

 34   
 (49)  
 71   

 495   
 4   

-2%
0%  
NM  
12%  
3%  
-2%  
5%  

291%  
NM  
-33%  

8%  
0%  

$ 

 908    $ 

 923    $ 

 879   

-2%  

143.6%   

147.5%   

137.1%   

-15%
7%
50%
-3%
-7%
11%
7%

-3%
100%
-41%

0%
0%

5%

Commissions and other general and administrative expenses that vary with and are related primarily to the production of new 
business are deferred to the extent recoverable and for our interest-sensitive products are generally amortized over the lives of the 
contracts in relation to EGPs.  For our traditional products, DAC and VOBA are amortized on either a straight-line basis or as a 
level percent of premium of the related contracts, depending on the block of business. 

When comparing DAC and VOBA deferrals as a percentage of sales for 2010 and 2009, the decrease is primarily a result of 
incurred deferrable commissions declining at a rate higher than sales attributable primarily to changes in sales mix. 

When comparing DAC and VOBA deferrals as a percentage of sales for 2009 and 2008, the increase is a result of incurred 
deferrable general and administrative expenses declining at a rate lower than sales. 

97 

  
 
 
 
                            
                      
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
 
    
 
  
  
  
     
  
    
 
    
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
   
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
Insurance Solutions – Group Protection 

Income (Loss) from Operations 

Details underlying the results for Insurance Solutions – Group Protection (in millions) were as follows: 

Operating Revenues 
Insurance premiums 
Net investment income 
Other revenues and fees 
      Total operating revenues 
Operating Expenses 
Interest credited 
Benefits 
Underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other 
   expenses 
      Total operating expenses 
Income (loss) from operations before taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
         Income (loss) from operations 

   For the Years Ended December 31, 
   2008  
   2009  
   2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 1,682    $ 
 141   
 8   
 1,831   

 1,579    $ 
 127   
 7   
 1,713   

 1   
 1,298   

 2   
 1,117   

 422    
 1,721   
 110    
 38    
 72     $ 

 403   
 1,522   
 191   
 67   
 124    $ 

$ 

 1,517   
 117   
 6    
 1,640   

 2    
 1,107   

 371   
 1,480   
 160   
 56    
 104   

7%  
11%  
14%  
7%  

-50%  
16%  

5%  
13%  
-42%  
-43%  
-42%  

4%
9%
17%
4%

0%
1%

9%
3%
19%
20%
19%

 For the Years Ended December 31,     Change Over Prior Year 
2008  

2009  

2009  

2010  

2010  

Income (Loss) from Operations by Product Line 
Life 
Disability 
Dental 
   Total non-medical 
Medical 
      Income (loss) from operations 

$ 

$ 

Comparison of 2010 to 2009 

 37    $ 
 34   
 (4)   
 67   
 5    
 72    $ 

 42     $ 
 79    
 (2)   
 119    
 5    
 124     $ 

 34   
 64   
 2   
 100   
 4   
 104   

-12%
-57%
-100%
-44%
0%
-42%

24%
23%
NM
19%
25%
19%

Income from operations for this segment decreased due to significantly unfavorable total non-medical loss ratio experience of 
76.2% during 2010 that was above the high end of our historical expected range of 71% to 74% attributable primarily to 
unfavorable claims incidence and, to a lesser extent, termination experience on our long-term disability business and adverse 
mortality and morbidity experience on our life business.  

The decrease in income from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Growth in insurance premiums driven by normal, organic business growth in our non-medical products and strong case 

persistency; and 

(cid:2)  Higher net investment income driven by an increase in business and more favorable investment income on alternative 
investments within our surplus portfolio (see “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” below for more 
information). 

98 

  
 
 
 
 
                         
                         
 
 
  
  
    
 
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
Comparison of 2009 to 2008 

Income from operations for this segment increased due to the following: 

(cid:2)  More favorable total non-medical loss ratio experience, slightly below the low end of our expected range; 
(cid:2)  Growth in insurance premiums driven by normal, organic business growth in our non-medical products; and 
(cid:2)  Higher net investment income driven by an increase in business and more favorable investment income on alternative 
investments within our surplus portfolio (see “Consolidated Investments – Alternative Investments” below for more 
information).  

The increase in income from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Higher underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses due primarily to the following:  

(cid:5)  Higher expenses attributable to our U.S. pension plans (see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Pension and 

Other Postretirement Benefit Plans” for more information); and 

(cid:5)  Higher incentive compensation accruals as a result of higher earnings and production performance relative to planned 

goals; partially offset by 

(cid:5)  Higher costs of investments in strategic initiatives associated with realigning our marketing and distribution structure in 

2008. 

Additional Information 

During 2010, our non-medical loss ratio was 76.2%, above what we experienced last year and above our long-term expectation of 
71% to 74%.  During 2010, we experienced significantly unfavorable long-term disability loss ratios due primarily to unfavorable 
incidence and, to a lesser extent, termination experience.  The unfavorable claims incidence experience was spread across all 
industry sectors, and particularly in the financial, wholesale and retail sectors, which we expect will continue at least in the short 
term.  Also, during 2010, we experienced significantly unfavorable life loss ratios due primarily to adverse mortality experience and 
adverse morbidity experience for life waiver of premium.  In addition, we increased experience-rated refund reserves on one large 
case during the third quarter of 2010 as a result of adverse claims experience, which decreased income from operations by $2 
million.  During 2009, we experienced exceptional short- and long-term disability loss ratios due primarily to favorable claims 
incidence and termination experience.  In addition, we experienced favorable life loss ratios during 2009 due primarily to favorable 
mortality and life waiver experience.   

We expect loss ratios to recover over time, but they are likely to remain above our long-term expectation well into 2011.  For every 
one percent increase in the loss ratio above our expectation, we would expect an approximate annual $10 million to $12 million 
decrease to income from operations.  Management compares trends in actual loss ratios to pricing expectations because group-
underwriting risks change over time.  We expect normal fluctuations in our composite non-medical loss ratios of this segment, as 
claims experience is inherently uncertain.  We are taking actions to manage the effects of our loss ratio results, such as 
implementing price adjustments on our product lines upon renewal to better reflect our experience going forward.  In addition, we 
have been focusing on managing the higher volume of incidence through claims risk management, including contracting additional 
resources to help reduce caseloads and improve claim recovery experience so that incidence volumes do not detract from our claim 
termination efforts.  We are also employing new tools to identify and support claimants who will return to work.   

We reviewed the discount rate assumptions associated with our long-term disability claim reserves during the third quarter of 2010, 
which resulted in lowering the discount rate by 25 basis points and decreasing income from operations by $2 million.  For more 
information on the effects of current interest rates on our long-term disability claim reserves, see “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative 
and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk – Interest Rate Risk – Interest Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Falling 
Rates.” 

We are evaluating the potential effects that health care reform may have on the value and profitability of this segment’s products 
and income from operations. 

We allocated more overhead costs to this segment during 2010, as the disposal of our Lincoln UK and Investment Management 
businesses resulted in a reallocation of overhead expenses to our remaining businesses.  Additionally, we made strategic 
investments during 2010 that resulted in higher expenses, and we expect this trend will continue in 2011.  

We experienced a favorable decline in expenses attributable to our U.S. pension plans during 2010 when compared to 2009, and 
this trend will continue in 2011.  For additional information, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Pension and Other 
Postretirement Benefit Plans.” 

99 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales relate to long-duration contracts sold to new contract holders and new programs sold to existing contract holders.  We 
believe that the trend in sales is an important indicator of development of business in force over time.   

We provide information about this segment’s operating revenue and operating expense line items, the period in which amounts are 
recognized, key drivers of changes and historical details underlying the line items and their associated drivers below. 

Insurance Premiums 

Details underlying insurance premiums (in millions) were as follows: 

 For the Years Ended December 31,     Change Over Prior Year 
2008  

2009  

2009  

2010  

2010  

Insurance Premiums by Product Line 
Life 
Disability 
Dental 
   Total non-medical 
Medical 
      Total insurance premiums 

Sales 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 639    $ 
 727   
 167   
 1,533   
 149   
 1,682    $ 

 584    $ 
 692   
 149   
 1,425   
 154   
 1,579    $ 

 541   
 672   
 150   
 1,363   
 154   
 1,517   

9%
5%
12%
8%
-3%
7%

8%
3%
-1%
5%
0%
4%

 353    $ 

 361    $ 

 316   

-2%  

14%

Our cost of insurance and policy administration charges are embedded in the premiums charged to our customers.  The premiums 
are a function of the rates priced into the product and our business in force.  Business in force, in turn, is driven by sales and 
persistency experience.  Sales in the table above are the combined annualized premiums for our life, disability and dental products.   

The business represented as “medical” consists primarily of our non-core EXEC-U-CARE® product.  This product provides an 
insured medical expense reimbursement vehicle to executives for non-covered health plan costs.  This product produces significant 
revenues and benefits expenses for this segment but only a limited amount of income.  Discontinuance of this product would 
significantly affect segment revenues, but not income (loss) from operations. 

Net Investment Income 

We use our investment income to offset the earnings effect of the associated build of our policy reserves, which are a function of 
our insurance premiums and the yields on our invested assets. 

Benefits and Interest Credited 

Details underlying benefits and interest credited (in millions) and loss ratios by product line were as follows: 

 For the Years Ended December 31,     Change Over Prior Year 
2008  

2009  

2009  

2010  

2010  

Benefits and Interest Credited by Product Line 
Life 
Disability 
Dental 
   Total non-medical 
Medical 
      Total benefits and interest credited 
Loss Ratios by Product Line 
Life 
Disability 
Dental 
   Total non-medical 
Medical 

$ 

$ 

 484    $ 
 548   
 136   
 1,168   
 131   
 1,299    $ 

 420    $ 
 443   
 121   
 984   
 135   
 1,119    $ 

75.8%   
75.4%   
81.5%   
76.2%   
87.6%   

72.0%  
64.0%   
81.7%   
69.1%   
87.9%   

 401   
 456   
 117   
 974   
 135   
 1,109   

73.9%   
67.9%   
78.3%   
71.4%   
87.6%   

Note:  Loss ratios presented above are calculated using whole dollars instead of dollars rounded to millions. 

100 

15%
24%
12%
19%
-3%
16%

5%
-3%
3%
1%
0%
1%

  
 
 
 
 
 
                       
                       
  
  
  
  
     
  
   
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                            
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                       
                       
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance and Other Expenses  

Details underlying underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses (in millions) were as follows: 

 For the Years Ended December 31,     Change Over Prior Year 
2008  

2009  

2009  

2010  

2010  

Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance  
   and Other Expenses 
Commissions 
General and administrative expenses 
Taxes, licenses and fees 
   Total expenses incurred 
DAC deferrals 
      Total expenses recognized before  
         amortization 
DAC and VOBA amortization, net of interest 
            Total underwriting, acquisition,  
               insurance and other expenses 

DAC Deferrals 
As a percentage of insurance premiums 

$ 

 190    $ 
 208   
 39   
 437   
 (61)  

 176     $ 
 204    
 36    
 416    
 (59)   

 376   
 46   

 357    
 46    

 168   
 186   
 39   
 393   
 (58)  

 335   
 36   

$ 

 422    $ 

 403     $ 

 371   

3.6%   

3.7%   

3.8%   

8%
2%  
8%  
5%  
-3%  

5%  
0%  

5%  

5%
10%
-8%
6%
-2%

7%
28%

9%

Expenses, excluding broker commissions, that vary with and are related primarily to the production of new business are deferred to 
the extent recoverable and are amortized on either a straight-line basis or as a level percent of premium of the related contracts 
depending on the block of business.  Broker commissions, which vary with and are related to paid premiums, are expensed as 
incurred.  The level of expenses is an important driver of profitability for this segment as group insurance contracts are offered 
within an environment that competes on the basis of price and service. 

RESULTS OF OTHER OPERATIONS 

Other Operations includes investments related to the excess capital in our insurance subsidiaries; investments in media properties 
and other corporate investments; benefit plan net liability; the unamortized deferred gain on indemnity reinsurance related to the 
sale of reinsurance to Swiss Re in 2001; the results of certain disability income business due to the rescission of a reinsurance 
agreement with Swiss Re; the Institutional Pension business, which is a closed-block of pension business, the majority of which 
was sold on a group annuity basis, and is currently in run-off; and debt costs.  We are actively managing our remaining radio station 
clusters to maximize performance and future value. 

For factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk 
Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above. 

101 

  
 
 
 
                                
                           
  
  
  
  
     
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
     
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
Income (Loss) from Operations 

Details underlying the results for Other Operations (in millions) were as follows: 

Operating Revenues 
Insurance premiums 
Net investment income 
Amortization of deferred gain on business 
   sold through reinsurance 
Media revenues (net) 
Other revenues and fees 
      Total operating revenues 
Operating Expenses 
Interest credited 
Benefits 
Media expenses 
Other expenses 
Interest and debt expense 
      Total operating expenses 
Income (loss) from operations before taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
         Income (loss) from operations 

Comparison of 2010 to 2009 

   For the Years Ended December 31, 
   2008  
   2009  
   2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 2     $ 

 4     $ 

 326   

 307    

 72   
 75   
 12   
 487   

 120   
 139   
 59   
 176   
 286   
 780   
 (293)  
 (107)  
 (186)   $ 

 73    
 68    
 13    
 465    

 148    
 258    
 53    
 125    
 261    
 845    
 (380)  
 (143)  
 (237)   $ 

$ 

 4    
 358    

 74    
 85    
 11    
 532    

 171    
 113    
 60    
 179    
 281    
 804    
 (272)   
 (89)   
 (183)   

-50%  
6%  

-1%  
10%  
-8%  
5%  

-19%  
-46%  
11%  
41%  
10%  
-8%  
23%  
25%  
22%  

0%
-14%

-1%
-20%
18%
-13%

-13%
128%
-12%
-30%
-7%
5%
-40%
-61%
-30%

Loss from operations for this segment decreased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  The $64 million unfavorable effect in the first quarter of 2009 of the rescission of the reinsurance agreement on certain 

disability income business sold to Swiss Re as discussed in “Reinsurance” below, which resulted in pre-tax increases in benefits 
of $78 million, interest credited of $15 million and other expenses of $5 million, partially offset by a $34 million tax benefit, 
and unfavorable results of our run-off disability income business due primarily to an increase in reserves as a result of our 
review of the adequacy of reserves supporting this business and the write-off of certain receivables related to the rescission in 
the fourth quarter of 2009 of $33 million; and 

(cid:2)  Higher net investment income related primarily to higher invested assets driven by distributable earnings received from our 

insurance segments, issuances of common stock and preferred stock and proceeds from the sale of Lincoln UK and Delaware, 
partially offset by redemption of our Series B preferred stock and repurchase and cancellation of associated common stock 
warrants. 

The decrease in loss from operations was partially offset by the following:  

Settlement of Transamerica litigation matter (see Note 14 for more information); 

(cid:2)  Higher other expenses due primarily to:  

(cid:5) 
(cid:5)  More favorable state income tax true-ups in 2009; and 
(cid:5)  Higher branding expenses in 2010; partially offset by 
(cid:5)  Restructuring charges for expense initiatives in 2009; and 
(cid:5)  Higher merger-related expenses in 2009; 

(cid:2)  Higher interest and debt expense as a result of higher average balances of outstanding debt in 2010; and 
(cid:2)  Unfavorable tax return true-ups recorded in the third quarter of 2010.  

102 

  
 
 
 
                              
                         
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
Comparison of 2009 to 2008 

Loss from operations for this segment increased due primarily to the following: 

(cid:2)  The unfavorable effects of the Swiss Re rescission in 2009, discussed above;  
(cid:2)  Lower net investment income related to our short-term liquidity strategy during the recent volatile markets that has reduced 
our portfolio yield and lower dividend income from our holdings of Bank of America common stock due to dividend rate 
cuts, partially offset by higher invested assets driven by distributable earnings received from our insurance segments, issuances 
of common stock, preferred stock and debt, and proceeds from the sale of Lincoln UK, partially offset by transfers to other 
segments for OTTI; and 

(cid:2)  Lower media earnings related primarily to the general weakening of the U.S. economy causing substantial declines in revenues 

throughout the radio market. 

The increase in loss from operations was partially offset by the following: 

(cid:2)  Lower other expenses attributable primarily to: 

(cid:5)  Higher merger-related expenses in 2008 as a result of higher system integration work related to our administrative systems 

and relocation costs associated with the move of our corporate office; 

(cid:5)  Favorable state income tax true-ups in 2009; and 
(cid:5)  Lower branding expenses in 2009 due to cost save initiatives; partially offset by  
(cid:5)  Restructuring charges of $22 million in 2009 related to expense reduction initiatives that are discussed further below;  
(cid:2)  Lower interest and debt expenses as a result of a decline in interest rates that affect our variable rate borrowings and lower 

average balances of outstanding debt in 2009; and 

(cid:2)  More favorable tax items that affected the effective tax rate related primarily to changes in tax preferred investments. 

We provide information about Other Operations’ operating revenue and operating expense line items, the period in which 
amounts are recognized, key drivers of changes and historical details underlying the line items and their associated drivers below. 

Net Investment Income and Interest Credited  

We utilize an internal formula to determine the amount of capital that is allocated to our business segments.  Investment income 
on capital in excess of the calculated amounts is reported in Other Operations.  If regulations require increases in our insurance 
segments’ statutory reserves and surplus, the amount of capital retained by Other Operations would decrease and net investment 
income would be negatively affected.  In addition, as discussed below in “Review of Consolidated Financial Condition –  
Alternative Sources of Liquidity,” we maintain an inter-segment cash management program where certain subsidiaries can borrow 
from or lend money to the holding company to meet short-term borrowing needs.  The inter-segment cash management program 
affects net investment income for Other Operations, as all inter-segment eliminations are reported within Other Operations.   

Write-downs for OTTI decrease the recorded value of our invested assets owned by our business segments.  These write-downs 
are not included in the income from operations of our operating segments.  When impairment occurs, assets are transferred to the 
business segments’ portfolios and will reduce the future net investment income for Other Operations, but should not have an 
effect on a consolidated basis unless the impairments are related to defaulted securities.  Statutory reserve adjustments for our 
business segments can also cause allocations of invested assets between the affected segments and Other Operations. 

The majority of our interest credited relates to our reinsurance operations sold to Swiss Re in 2001.  A substantial amount of the 
business was sold through indemnity reinsurance transactions, which is still recorded in our consolidated financial statements.  The 
interest credited corresponds to investment income earnings on the assets we continue to hold for this business.  There is no effect 
to income or loss in Other Operations or on a consolidated basis for these amounts because interest earned on the blocks that 
continue to be reinsured is passed through to Swiss Re in the form of interest credited. 

Benefits 

Benefits are recognized when incurred for Institutional Pension products and disability income business. 

103 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Expenses 

Details underlying other expenses (in millions) were as follows: 

Other Expenses  
General and administrative expenses:  
   Legal  
   Branding  
   Retirement Income Security Ventures  
   Other (1) 
      Total general and administrative expenses  
Merger-related expenses (2) 
Restructuring charges (recoveries) for expense  
   initiatives (3) 
Taxes, licenses and fees   
Inter-segment reimbursement associated with reserve  
   financing and LOC expenses (4) 
         Total other expenses  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 80    $ 
 27   
 11   
 56   
 174   
 9    

 14     $ 
 18    
 9    
 52    
 93    
 17    

 (1)   
 (4)   

 34    
 (19)  

 9   
 33   
 11   
 60   
 113   
 52   

 8   
 7   

 (2)   
 176    $ 

 -    
 125     $ 

 (1)  
 179   

$ 

NM  
50%  
22%  
8%  
87%  
-47%

NM
79%  

NM  
41%  

56%
-45%
-18%
-13%
-18%
-67%

NM
NM

100%
-30%

(1) 

(2) 

(3) 

Includes expenses that are corporate in nature including charitable contributions, amortization of media intangible assets with 
a definite life, other expenses not allocated to our business segments and inter-segment expense eliminations.  
Includes the result of actions undertaken by us to eliminate duplicate operations and functions as a result of the Jefferson-Pilot 
merger along with costs related to the implementation of our new unified product portfolio and other initiatives.  These 
actions were completed during 2010.  Our cumulative integration expense was approximately $225 million, pre-tax, which 
excluded amounts capitalized or recorded as goodwill. 
Includes expenses associated with a restructuring plan implemented starting in December 2008 in response to the economic 
downturn and sustained market volatility, which focused on reducing expenses.  These actions were completed during 2009.  
Our cumulative pre-tax charges amounted to $41 million for severance, benefits and related costs associated with the plan for 
workforce reduction and other restructuring actions.   

(4)  Consists of reimbursements to Other Operations from the Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment for the use of 

proceeds from certain issuances of senior notes that were used as long-term structured solutions, net of expenses incurred by 
Other Operations for its use of LOCs.  The inter-segment amounts are not reported on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income. 

Interest and Debt Expense 

Our current level of interest expense may not be indicative of the future due to, among other things, the timing of the use of cash, 
the availability of funds from our inter-company cash management program and the future cost of capital.  For additional 
information on our financing activities, see “Review of Consolidated Financial Condition – Liquidity and Capital Resources – 
Sources of Liquidity and Cash Flow – Financing Activities” below. 

104 

  
 
 
 
                  
                
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
Details underlying realized gain (loss), after-DAC (1) (in millions) were as follows:  

REALIZED GAIN (LOSS) 

Pre-Tax 
Operating realized gain (loss): 
   Indexed annuity net derivatives results 
   GLB 
      Total operating realized gain (loss) 
Realized gain (loss) related to certain investments 
Realized gain (loss) related to certain derivative 
   investments, including those associated with 
   our consolidated VIEs, and trading securities 
GLB net derivatives results 
GDB derivatives results 
Indexed annuity forward-starting option 
Realized gain (loss) on sale of  
   subsidiaries/businesses 
      Total excluded realized gain (loss) 
         Total realized gain (loss) 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 1    $ 
 68   
 69   
 (180)       

 75  
 (7) 
 (52) 
 18   

 -     $ 

 54    
 54    
 (538)  

 36    
 (502)  
 (201)  
 4    

 -  
 (146)
 (77)

 $ 

 1    
 (1,200)  
 (1,146)   $ 

$ 

 -    
 38    
 38    
 (928)   

 (109)   
 399    
 58    
 7    

 -    
 (573)   
 (535)   

NM  
26%  
28%  
67%  

108%  
99%  
74%  
NM  

-100%  
88%  
93%  

NM
42%
42%
42%

133%
NM
NM
-43%

NM
NM
NM

(1)  DAC refers to the associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL and changes in other contract holder funds and 

funds withheld reinsurance liabilities. 

For factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk 
Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above. 

For information on our counterparty exposure see “Part II – Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market 
Risk.”  

Comparison of 2010 to 2009 

We had lower realized losses in 2010 as compared to 2009 due primarily to: 

(cid:2)  More favorable hedge program performance; 
(cid:2)  The decline in OTTI attributable primarily to general improvement in the credit markets; 
(cid:2)  Gains on derivative instruments related to our consolidated VIEs and our credit default swaps; and 
(cid:2)  An increase in the value of our trading securities.  

Our GLB net derivatives results and GDB derivative results during 2010 were more favorable compared to 2009.  The GLB net 
derivatives results during 2010 were relatively flat.  The unfavorable GLB net derivatives results during 2009 were attributable 
primarily to the NPR component of the liability being unfavorable in 2009 attributable to a narrowing of credit spreads and a 
reduction in the overall level of the liability before the application of the NPR to the discount rate.  See “GLB Net Derivatives 
Results” below for a discussion of how our NPR adjustment is determined.  The unfavorable GDB derivative results during 2010 
and 2009 were driven primarily by sporadic large movements in equities that caused non-linear changes in the liability relative to 
the derivatives utilized in the hedge program and by other items. 

During 2010, we had changes in GLB reserves reflecting primarily updates to our prospective lapse assumption, which was 
significantly offset by a decision to shift the mapping of approximately 5% of variable annuity account values to blended equity and 
fixed maturity hedging indices, whereas previously we had been mapped almost exclusively to equity.  Our associated prospective 
DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL unlocking in 2010 partially offset the GLB reserve prospective unlocking.  During 2009, we had 
unfavorable prospective unlocking of assumptions associated with the GLB reserves related primarily to modifying the valuation of 
variable annuity products that have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves and modifying our fund 
assumptions with regard to our hedged indices. 

105 

  
 
 
 
                            
  
  
  
  
    
 
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
   
  
   
  
  
       
   
  
   
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The favorable realized gain related to certain derivative investments and trading securities during 2010 was attributable primarily to 
spreads narrowing on corporate credit default swaps, which affected the derivative instruments related to our consolidated VIEs 
and our credit default swaps, and gains on our trading securities due to the decline in interest rates. 

For information regarding realized gains (losses) related to certain investments, see “Consolidated Investments – Realized Gain 
(Loss) Related to Certain Investments” below. 

Comparison of 2009 to 2008 

GLB net derivatives results declined due primarily to the NPR component of the liability being unfavorable in 2009 attributable to 
a narrowing of credit spreads and a reduction in the overall level of the liability before the application of the NPR to the discount 
rate.  See “GLB Net Derivatives Results” below for a discussion of how our NPR adjustment is determined.  This decline was 
partially offset by significantly more favorable GLB hedge program performance in 2009 relative to 2008.  In 2008, the result was 
largely driven by extremely volatile capital markets.  At the end of the second quarter of 2009, we made a strategic decision to 
reduce our interest rate coverage as we prepared for the adoption of VACARVM, which was effective for statutory accounting on 
December 31, 2009.  The reduced coverage on rates resulted in favorable performance for the second half of 2009; however, this 
strategic risk position was mitigated on December 31, 2009.  

The 2009 unfavorable prospective unlocking for assumption changes related primarily to modifying the valuation of variable 
annuity products that have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves and modifying our fund 
assumptions with regard to our hedged indices.  The 2008 favorable unlocking for assumption changes related primarily to 
assumptions associated with the GLB reserves reflecting primarily updates to implied ultimate volatility. 

The 2008 unfavorable prospective DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL unlocking related to the GLB reserves reflecting the effect of 
incorporating the change in EGPs resulting from the change in assumptions for the reserves discussed above into the DAC, 
VOBA, DSI and DFEL models. 

The unfavorable decline in GDB derivative results was attributable primarily to the favorable equity markets in 2009 as compared 
to unfavorable in 2008.  

The decline in the realized loss related to certain investments was attributable primarily to the lower OTTI due to general 
improvement in the credit markets and the change in the accounting for impairments under the Investments – Debt and Equity 
Securities Topic of the FASB ASC that was effective for impairments recorded after January 1, 2009.  For a further explanation of 
this change, see Note 2.  For more information on realized losses on certain investments, see “Consolidated Investments – 
Realized Loss Related to Investments” below. 

The gain on certain derivative investments, including those associated with our consolidated VIEs, and trading securities during 
2009 was due primarily to the rescission of the Swiss Re indemnity reinsurance agreement covering certain disability income 
business, whereby we released the embedded derivative liability related to the funds withheld nature of the reinsurance agreement.  
Prior to the rescission of the Swiss Re indemnity reinsurance agreement, the fluctuations in the fair value of the trading securities 
mostly offset the fair value fluctuations in the embedded derivative of the reinsurance agreement with the net difference reported 
as a realized gain or loss.  The release of this embedded derivative liability increased net income by approximately $31 million in the 
first quarter of 2009.  Since the rescission, this line item is affected by market conditions as we now have trading securities that are 
no longer supporting an embedded derivative liability due to the rescission causing us to release that liability.  Consequently, we 
may experience more volatility in the fluctuation of this component of realized gain or loss in the future.  During 2009, the value of 
these trading securities increased due to changes in interest rates.  For more information, see “Reinsurance” below and Note 9.  

106 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Operating Realized Gain (Loss) 

Details underlying operating realized gain (loss) (in millions) were as follows: 

Indexed Annuity Net Derivatives Results  
Change in fair value of S&P 500 call options  
Change in fair value of embedded derivatives  
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA,   
   DSI and DFEL  
      Total indexed annuity net derivatives results  

GLB  

Pre-DAC amount (1) 
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA,   
   DSI and DFEL:  
      Retrospective unlocking (2) 
      Amortization, excluding unlocking  
         Total GLB  
Total Operating Realized Gain (Loss)  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 114    $ 
 (111)   

 84    $ 
 (82)  

 (204)  
 203   

 (2)   
 1    

 (2)  
 -   

 1    
 -    

-35%  
36%  

0%  
NM  

 99    

 70   

 69   

41%  

 34    
 (65)   
 68    
 69     $ 

 20   
 (36)  
 54   
 54    $ 

 12   
 (43)  
 38   
 38   

$ 

70%  
-81%  
26%  
28%  

NM
141%

NM
NM

1%

67%
16%
42%
42%

(1)  DAC refers to the associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL. 
(2)  Related primarily to the emergence of gross profits.   

Operating realized gain (loss) includes the following: 

Indexed Annuity Net Derivatives Results  

Indexed annuity net derivatives results represent the net difference between the change in the fair value of the S&P 500 call options 
that we hold and the change in the fair value of the embedded derivative liabilities of our indexed annuity products.  The change in 
the fair value of the liability for the embedded derivative represents the amount that is credited to the indexed annuity contract. 

GLB 

Our GWB, GIB and 4LATER® features have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves.  We calculate 
the value of the embedded derivative reserve and the benefit reserve based on the specific characteristics of each GLB feature.  For 
our GLBs that meet the definition of an embedded derivative under the Derivatives and Hedging Topic of the FASB ASC, we 
record them at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income 
(Loss).  In bifurcating the embedded derivative, we attribute to the embedded derivative the portion of total fees collected from the 
contract holder that relates to the GLB riders (the “attributed fees”).  These attributed fees represent the present value of future 
claims expected to be paid for the GLB at the inception of the contract (the “net valuation premium”) plus a margin that a 
theoretical market participant would include for risk/profit (the “risk/profit margin”). 

We include the risk/profit margin portion of the GLB attributed rider fees in operating realized gain (loss) and include the net 
valuation premium of the GLB attributed rider fees in excluded realized gain (loss).  For our Retirement Solutions – Annuities and 
Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution segments, the excess of total fees collected from the contract holders over the GLB 
attributed rider fees is reported in insurance fees. 

Realized Gain (Loss) Related to Certain Investments 

See “Consolidated Investments – Realized Gain (Loss) Related to Certain Investments” below. 

107 

  
 
 
 
                             
                        
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Realized Gain (Loss) Related to Certain Derivative Instruments, Including Those Associated With Our Consolidated 
VIEs, and Trading Securities 

Realized gain (loss) related to certain derivative instruments, including those associated with our consolidated VIEs and trading 
securities represents changes in the fair values of certain derivative investments (including the credit default swaps and contingent 
forwards associated with consolidated VIEs), total return swaps (embedded derivatives that are theoretically included in our various 
modified coinsurance and coinsurance with funds withheld reinsurance arrangements that have contractual returns related to 
various assets and liabilities associated with these arrangements) and trading securities.   

See Note 4 for information about our consolidated VIEs. 

GLB Net Derivatives Results and GDB Derivatives Results 

Details underlying GLB net derivatives results and GDB derivative results (in millions) were as follows:  

GLB Net Derivatives Results  
Net valuation premium, net of reinsurance  
Change in reserves hedged:  
   Prospective unlocking - assumption changes  
   Prospective unlocking - model refinements  
   Other  
Change in market value of derivative assets  
      Hedge program effectiveness (ineffectiveness)  
Change in reserves not hedged (NPR component)  
Change in derivative assets not hedged (NPR   
   component)  
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA,   
   DSI and DFEL:  
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes  
      Retrospective unlocking (1) 
      Amortization, excluding unlocking  
Loss from the initial adoption of new accounting  
   standards, after-DAC (2)(3) 
         Total GLB net derivatives results  

GDB Derivatives Results  
Change in fair value of derivatives  
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA,   
   DSI and DFEL:  
      Retrospective unlocking (1) 
      Amortization, excluding unlocking  
         Total GDB derivatives results  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

  Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 116    $ 

 115    $ 

 80   

1%  

44%

 51    
 -    
 203   
 (363)   
 (109)   
 14    

 (258)  
 (9)  
 3,064   
 (2,934)  
 (137)  
 (546)  

 164   
 -    
 (3,365)  
 3,377   
 176   
 536   

120%  
100%  
-93%  
88%  
20%  
103%  

NM
NM
191%
NM
NM
NM

 (5)   

 15   

 (20)  

NM  

175%

 (15)   
 (8)   
 -    

 -    
 (176)  
 227   

 (46)  
 252   
 (546)  

 -    
 (7)    $ 

 -    
 (502)   $ 

 (33)  
 399   

NM  
95%  
-100%  

NM  
99%  

100%
NM
142%

100%
NM

 (60)   

 (226)  

 75   

73%  

NM

 (31)   
 39    
 (52)    $ 

 (93)  
 118   
 (201)   $ 

 25   
 (42)  
 58   

67%  
-67%  
74%  

NM
NM
NM

$ 

$ 

(1)  Related primarily to the emergence of gross profits.  
(2)  This new accounting guidance was included in the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC. 
(3)  DAC refers to the associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL. 

108 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
                        
                        
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
GLB Net Derivatives Results 

Our GLB net derivatives results are comprised of the net valuation premium, the change in the GLB embedded derivative reserves 
and the change in the fair value of the derivative instruments we own to hedge them, including the cost of purchasing the hedging 
instruments. 

Our GWB, GIB and 4LATER® features have elements of both benefit reserves and embedded derivative reserves.  We calculate 
the value of the embedded derivative reserve and the benefit reserve based on the specific characteristics of each GLB feature.  We 
record the embedded derivative reserve on our GLBs at fair value on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  We use derivative 
instruments to hedge our exposure to the risks and earnings volatility that result from changes in the GLB embedded derivatives 
reserves.  The change in fair value of these derivative instruments is designed to generally offset the change in embedded derivative 
reserves.  In the table above, we have presented the components of our GLB results, which can be volatile especially when sudden 
and significant changes in equity markets and/or interest rates occur.  When we assess the effectiveness of our hedge program, we 
exclude the effect of the change in the component of the embedded derivative reserves related to the required NPR.  We do not 
attempt to hedge the change in the NPR component of the liability.  As of December 31, 2010, the net effect of the NPR resulted 
in a $19 million increase in the liability for our GLB embedded derivative reserves.  The NPR factors affect the discount rate used 
in the calculation of the GLB embedded derivative reserve.  Our methodology for calculating the NPR component of the 
embedded derivative reserve utilizes an extrapolated 30-year NPR spread curve applied to a series of expected cash flows over the 
expected life of the embedded derivative.  Our cash flows consist of both expected fees to be received from contract holders and 
benefits to be paid, and these cash flows are different on a pre- and post- NPR basis.  We utilize a model based on our holding 
company’s credit default swap (“CDS”) spreads adjusted for items, such as the liquidity of our holding company CDS.  Because the 
guaranteed benefit liabilities are contained within our insurance subsidiaries, we apply items, such as the effect of our insurance 
subsidiaries’ claims-paying ratings compared to holding company credit risk and the over-collateralization of insurance liabilities, in 
order to determine factors that are representative of a theoretical market participant’s view of the NPR of the specific liability 
within our insurance subsidiaries.   

Details underlying the NPR component and associated effect to our GLB embedded derivative reserves (dollars in millions) were 
as follows: 

As of 

As of 

December 31,  September 30,   

2010  

2010  

As of 
June 30, 
2010  

As of 

   March 31, 

2010  

As of 
   December 31, 
2009  

10-year CDS spread 
NPR factor related to 10-year CDS spread 
Unadjusted embedded derivative liability 

  $ 

1.98%       
0.17%       
 389      $ 

2.55%        
0.30%       
 1,556      $ 

2.94%   
0.40%   
 1,786    $ 

1.64%       
0.11%       
 461      $ 

1.68%  
0.08%  
 643   

Estimating what the absolute amount of the NPR effect will be period to period is difficult due to the utilization of all cash flows 
and the shape of the spread curve.  Currently, we estimate that if the NPR factors as of December 31, 2010, were to have been 
zero along all points on the spread curve, then the NPR offset to the unadjusted liability would have resulted in an unfavorable 
effect to net income of approximately $60 million, pre-DAC and tax.  Alternatively, if the NPR factors were 20 basis points higher 
along all points on the spread curve as of December 31, 2010, then there would have been a favorable effect to net income of 
approximately $50 million, pre-DAC and tax.  In the preceding two sentences, “DAC” refers to the associated amortization of 
DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL.  Changing market conditions could cause this relationship to deviate significantly in future periods.  
Sensitivity within this range is primarily a result of volatility in our CDS spreads and the slope of the CDS spread term structure. 

For additional information on our guaranteed benefits, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Derivatives – Guaranteed 
Living Benefits” above.   

GDB Derivatives Results 

Our GDB derivatives results represent the change in the fair value of the derivative instruments we own to hedge the change in 
our benefit ratio unlocking, excluding our expected cost of the hedging instruments.   

109 

  
 
 
 
 
 
                    
  
     
    
  
     
  
                    
                    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
 
 
 
 
Indexed Annuity Forward-Starting Option 

Details underlying indexed annuity forward-starting option (in millions) were as follows:  

Indexed Annuity Forward-Starting Option  
Pre-DAC amounts: (1) 
   Prospective unlocking - assumption changes  
   Other  
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA,   
   DSI and DFEL  
Gain from the initial adoption of new accounting  
   standards, after-DAC (1)(2) 
      Total  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 2     $ 
 28    

 -    $ 
 7   

 (12)   

 (3)  

 -    
 18     $ 

 -   
 4    $ 

 -    
 (7)   

 4    

 10   
 7    

NM  
300%  

NM  

NM  
NM  

NM
200%

NM

-100%
-43%

(1)  DAC refers to the associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL. 
(2)  This new accounting guidance was included in the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC. 

The liability for the forward-starting option reflects changes in the fair value of embedded derivative liabilities related to index call 
options we may purchase in the future to hedge contract holder index allocations applicable to future reset periods for our indexed 
annuity products accounted for under the Derivatives and Hedging and the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topics of 
the FASB ASC.  These fair values represent an estimate of the cost of the options we will purchase in the future, discounted back 
to the date of the balance sheet, using current market indications of volatility and interest rates, which can vary significantly from 
period to period due to a number of factors and therefore can provide results that are not indicative of the underlying trends. 

110 

  
 
 
 
                             
                        
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
 
Details underlying our consolidated investment balances (in millions) were as follows: 

CONSOLIDATED INVESTMENTS 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

Percentage of 
Total Investments 
As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 68,030    $ 
 584    
 68,614   
 197    
 2,596    
 6,752    
 202    
 2,865    
 1,076    
 750    
 288    
 83,340    $ 

 60,818   
 -   
 60,818   
 278   
 2,505   
 7,178   
 174   
 2,898   
 1,010   
 696   
 361   
 75,918   

81.6%   
0.7%   
82.3%   
0.2%   
3.1%   
8.1%   
0.3%   
3.5%   
1.3%   
0.9%   
0.3%   
100.0%   

80.1%  
0.0%  
80.1%  
0.4%  
3.3%  
9.5%  
0.2%  
3.8%  
1.3%  
0.9%  
0.5%  
100.0%  

Investments 
AFS securities: 
   Fixed maturity 
   VIEs' fixed maturity 
      Total fixed maturity 
   Equity 
Trading securities 
Mortgage loans on real estate 
Real estate 
Policy loans 
Derivative investments 
Alternative investments 
Other investments 
         Total investments 

Investment Objective 

Invested assets are an integral part of our operations.  We follow a balanced approach to investing for both current income and 
prudent risk management, with an emphasis on generating sufficient current income, net of income tax, to meet our obligations to 
customers, as well as other general liabilities.  This balanced approach requires the evaluation of expected return and risk of each 
asset class utilized, while still meeting our income objectives.  This approach is important to our asset-liability management because 
decisions can be made based upon both the economic and current investment income considerations affecting assets and liabilities.  
For a discussion on our risk management process, see “Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.” 

Investment Portfolio Composition and Diversification 

Fundamental to our investment policy is diversification across asset classes.  Our investment portfolio, excluding cash and invested 
cash, is composed of fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real estate, real estate (either wholly-owned or in joint ventures) 
and other long-term investments.  We purchase investments for our segmented portfolios that have yield, duration and other 
characteristics that take into account the liabilities of the products being supported.   

We have the ability to maintain our investment holdings throughout credit cycles because of our capital position, the long-term 
nature of our liabilities and the matching of our portfolios of investment assets with the liabilities of our various products.  

Fixed Maturity and Equity Securities Portfolios 

Fixed maturity securities and equity securities consist of portfolios classified as AFS and trading.  Mortgage-backed and private 
securities are included in both AFS and trading portfolios. 

Details underlying our fixed maturity and equity securities portfolios by industry classification (in millions) are presented in the 
tables below.  These tables agree in total with the presentation of AFS securities in Note 5; however, the categories below represent 
a more detailed breakout of the AFS portfolio; therefore, the investment classifications listed below do not agree to the investment 
categories provided in Note 5. 

111 

  
 
 
 
                 
    
  
    
  
  
               
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
               
 
  
               
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$ 

Fixed Maturity AFS Securities  
Industry corporate bonds:  
  Financial services  
  Basic industry  
  Capital goods  
  Communications  
  Consumer cyclical  
  Consumer non-cyclical  
  Energy  
  Technology  
  Transportation  
   Industrial other  
   Utilities  
Corporate asset-backed securities ("ABS"):  
   CDOs  
   Commercial real estate ("CRE") CDOs  
   Credit card  
   Home equity  
   Manufactured housing  
   Auto loan  
   Other  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities ("CMBS"):  
   Non-agency backed  
Collateralized mortgage and other obligations ("CMOs"):     
  Agency backed  
  Non-agency backed  
Mortgage pass through securities ("MPTS"):  
  Agency backed  
  Non-agency backed  
Municipals:  
  Taxable  
  Tax-exempt  
Government and government agencies:  
   United States  
  Foreign  
Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities  
     Total fixed maturity AFS securities  

As of December 31, 2010 

   Unrealized         

Amortized 
Cost 

   Unrealized     Losses 
   Gains 

Fair 
   and OTTI     Value 

% 
Fair 
   Value 

 8,377    $ 
 2,478   
 3,425   
 3,050   
 2,772   
 7,259   
 4,533   
 1,414   
 1,379   
 884   
 9,800   

 438     $ 
 203    
 243    
 251    
 185    
 628    
 428    
 108    
 116    
 53    
 708    

 148    $ 
 20   
 45   
 32   
 47   
 20   
 17   
 9   
 3   
 10   
 62   

 8,667   
 2,661   
 3,623   
 3,269   
 2,910   
 7,867   
 4,944   
 1,513   
 1,492   
 927   
 10,446   

 128   
 46   
 831   
 1,002   
 110   
 162   
 211   

 2,144   

 3,975   
 1,718   

 2,978   
 2    

 3,219   
 3    

 22    
 -    
 33    
 6    
 3    
 2    
 21    

 95    

 308    
 16    

 106    
 -    

 27    
 -    

 931   
 1,438   
 1,476   
 65,745   

 120    
 94    
 56    
 4,270    

 8   
 14   
 4   
 268   
 4   
 -    
 1   

 142   
 32   
 860   
 740   
 109   
 164   
 231   

 186   

 2,053   

 1   
 259   

 5   
 -    

 94   
 -    

 2   
 7   
 135   
 1,401   

 4,282   
 1,475   

 3,079   
 2   

 3,152   
 3   

 1,049   
 1,525   
 1,397   
 68,614   

 197   
 68,811   
 2,596   
 71,407   

12.7%
3.9%
5.3%
4.8%
4.2%
11.5%
7.2%
2.2%
2.2%
1.4%
15.2%

0.2%
0.0%
1.3%
1.1%
0.2%
0.2%
0.3%

3.0%

6.2%
2.1%

4.5%
0.0%

4.6%
0.0%

1.5%
2.2%
2.0%
100.0%

Equity AFS Securities  
        Total AFS securities  
Trading Securities (1) 
           Total AFS and trading securities  

 179    
 65,924   
 2,340    
 68,264    $ 

 25    
 4,295    
 297    
 4,592     $ 

 7    
 1,408   
 41    
 1,449    $ 

$ 

(1)  Certain of our trading securities support our modified coinsurance (“Modco”) arrangements and the investment results are 

passed directly to the reinsurers.  Refer to the “Trading Securities” section for further details. 

112 

  
 
 
                  
                  
    
       
  
                  
  
  
                  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Fixed Maturity AFS Securities  
Industry corporate bonds:  
   Financial services  
   Basic industry  
   Capital goods  
   Communications  
   Consumer cyclical  
   Consumer non-cyclical  
   Energy  
   Technology  
   Transportation  
   Industrial other  
   Utilities  
ABS:  
   CDOs and CLNs  
   CRE CDOs  
   Credit card  
   Home equity  
   Manufactured housing  
   Auto loan  
   Other  
CMBS:  
   Non-agency backed  
CMOs:  
   Agency backed  
   Non-agency backed  
MPTS:  
   Agency backed  
   Non-agency backed  
Municipals:  
   Taxable  
   Tax-exempt  
Government and government agencies:  
   United States  
   Foreign  
Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities  
      Total fixed maturity AFS securities  

Equity AFS Securities  
         Total AFS securities  
Trading Securities (1) 
           Total AFS and trading securities  

As of December 31, 2009 

   Unrealized         

Amortized 
Cost 

   Unrealized     Losses 
   Gains 

Fair 
   and OTTI     Value 

% 
Fair 
   Value 

$ 

 8,242    $ 
 2,304   
 2,995   
 2,817   
 2,589   
 5,568   
 4,251   
 1,121   
 1,224   
 709   
 8,941   

 248     $ 
 116    
 149    
 200    
 141    
 380    
 290    
 76    
 85    
 35    
 415    

 735   
 54   
 265   
 1,099   
 122   
 220   
 230   

 2,436   

 4,494   
 1,697   

 2,912   
 69   

 1,900   
 35   

 11    
 -    
 9    
 1    
 1    
 5    
 12    

 49    

 252    
 5    

 64    
 -    

 13    
 -    

 963   
 1,345   
 1,420   
 60,757   

 85    
 53    
 36    
 2,731    

 341    $ 
 57   
 26   
 51   
 66   
 16   
 22   
 4   
 15   
 11   
 81   

 296   
 24   
 9   
 428   
 11   
 -    
 3   

 8,149   
 2,363   
 3,118   
 2,966   
 2,664   
 5,932   
 4,519   
 1,193   
 1,294   
 733   
 9,275   

 450   
 30   
 265   
 672   
 112   
 225   
 239   

 354   

 2,131   

 23   
 454   

 14   
 8   

 53   
 -    

 14   
 39   
 250   
 2,670   

 4,723   
 1,248   

 2,962   
 61   

 1,860   
 35   

 1,034   
 1,359   
 1,206   
 60,818   

 278   
 61,096   
 2,505   
 63,601   

 382    
 61,139   
 2,342    
 63,481    $ 

 21    
 2,752    
 243    
 2,995     $ 

 125    
 2,795   
 80    
 2,875    $ 

$ 

13.3%
3.9%
5.1%
4.9%
4.4%
9.8%
7.4%
2.0%
2.1%
1.2%
15.2%

0.7%
0.0%
0.4%
1.1%
0.2%
0.4%
0.4%

3.5%

7.8%
2.1%

4.9%
0.1%

3.1%
0.1%

1.7%
2.2%
2.0%
100.0%

(1)  Certain of our trading securities support our Modco arrangements and the investment results are passed directly to the 

reinsurers.  Refer to the “Trading Securities” section for further details. 

113 

  
 
 
               
                  
    
       
  
                  
  
  
                  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
AFS Securities 

The general intent of the AFS accounting guidance is to reflect stockholders’ equity as if unrealized gains and losses were actually 
recognized, and it is necessary that we consider all related accounting adjustments that would occur upon such a hypothetical 
recognition of unrealized gains and losses.  Such related balance sheet effects include adjustments to the balances of DAC, VOBA, 
DFEL, other contract holder funds and deferred income taxes.  Adjustments to each of these balances are charged or credited to 
accumulated OCI.  For instance, DAC is adjusted upon the recognition of unrealized gains or losses because the amortization of 
DAC is based upon an assumed emergence of gross profits on certain insurance business.  Deferred income tax balances are also 
adjusted because unrealized gains or losses do not affect actual taxes currently paid.   

The quality of our AFS fixed maturity securities portfolio, as measured at estimated fair value and by the percentage of fixed 
maturity securities invested in various ratings categories, relative to the entire fixed maturity AFS security portfolio (in millions) was 
as follows: 

Rating Agency 
Equivalent 
Designation 

NAIC 
Designation    
Investment Grade Securities 
  Aaa / Aa / A 
  Baa 
   Total investment grade securities 

1  
2  

As of December 31, 2010 
Fair 
   Value 

   % of 
   Total 

   Amortized    
Cost 

As of December 31, 2009 
Fair 
   Value 

   % of 
   Total 

   Amortized    
Cost 

   $ 

 40,573    $ 
 21,032   
 61,605   

 42,769   
 22,286   
 65,055   

62.3%    $ 
32.5%   
94.8%   

 35,041    $ 
 20,294   
 55,335   

 35,924   
 20,725   
 56,649   

Below Investment Grade Securities    

3  
4  
5  
6  

  Ba 
  B 
  Caa and lower 
  In or near default 

   Total below investment grade securities 
      Total fixed maturity AFS securities 

$ 

Total securities below investment 
   grade as a percentage of total 
   fixed maturity AFS securities 

 2,620   
 796   
 476   
 248   
 4,140   
 65,745    $ 

 2,403   
 665   
 325   
 166   
 3,559   
 68,614   

3.5%   
1.0%   
0.5%   
0.2%   
5.2%   
100.0%    $ 

 3,221   
 1,470   
 426   
 305   
 5,422   
 60,757    $ 

 2,695   
 948   
 265   
 261   
 4,169   
 60,818   

6.3%   

5.2%   

8.9%   

6.9%  

59.0%
34.1%
93.1%

4.5%
1.6%
0.4%
0.4%
6.9%
100.0%

Comparisons between the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (“NAIC”) ratings and rating agency designations are 
published by the NAIC.  The NAIC assigns securities quality ratings and uniform valuations, which are used by insurers when 
preparing their annual statements.  The NAIC ratings are similar to the rating agency designations of the Nationally Recognized 
Statistical Rating Organizations for marketable bonds.  NAIC ratings 1 and 2 include bonds generally considered investment grade 
(rated Baa3 or higher by Moody’s, or rated BBB- or higher by S&P and Fitch), by such ratings organizations.  However, securities 
rated NAIC 1 and NAIC 2 could be below investment grade by the rating agencies, which is a result of the changes in the RBC 
rules for residential mortgage-backed securities (“RMBS”) that were effective December 31, 2010, for statutory reporting.  NAIC 
ratings 3 through 6 include bonds generally considered below investment grade (rated Ba1 or lower by Moody’s, or rated BB+ or 
lower by S&P and Fitch).  

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, 79.8% and 80.3%, respectively, of the total publicly traded and private securities in an 
unrealized loss status were rated as investment grade.  See Note 5 for maturity date information for our fixed maturity investment 
portfolio.  Our gross unrealized losses on AFS securities as of December 31, 2010, decreased $1.4 billion.  This change was 
attributable to a decline in overall market yields, which was driven, in part, by improved credit fundamentals.  As more fully 
described in Note 1, we regularly review our investment holdings for OTTI.  We believe the unrealized loss position as of 
December 31, 2010, does not represent OTTI as we do not intend to sell these debt securities, it is not more likely than not that we 
will be required to sell the debt securities before recovery of their amortized cost basis, the estimated future cash flows are equal to 
or greater than the amortized cost basis of the debt securities, or we have the ability and intent to hold the equity securities for a 
period of time sufficient for recovery.  For further information on our AFS securities unrealized losses, see “Additional Details on 
our Unrealized Losses on AFS Securities” below. 

114 

  
 
 
 
 
             
 
  
  
 
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Selected information for certain AFS securities in a gross unrealized loss position (dollars in millions) was as follows: 

Gross   

   Unrealized     Years 

As of December 31, 2010 
   Estimated    Estimated   
   Average    
Years 
until 
  Recovery    
29  

  until Call   
or  

   Maturity 
1 to 42 

Fair 
Value 

Losses 
and 
   OTTI 

$ 

 379    $ 

 186   

Subordination Level 
Current 
18.7% 

   Origination 
16.3% 

 771   

 135   

1 to 56 

31  

N/A 

    N/A 

CMBS 
Hybrid and redeemable 
   preferred securities 

As provided in the table above, many of the securities in these categories are long-dated with some of the preferred securities being 
perpetual.  This is purposeful as it matches the long-term nature of our liabilities associated with our life insurance and annuity 
products.  See “Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk” where we present information related to 
maturities of securities and the expected cash flows for rate sensitive liabilities and maturities of our holding company debt, which 
also demonstrates the long-term nature of the cash flows associated with these items.  Because of this relationship, we do not 
believe it will be necessary to sell these securities before they recover or mature.  For these securities, the estimated range and 
average period until recovery is the call or maturity period.  It is difficult to predict or project when the securities will recover as it 
is dependent upon a number of factors including the overall economic climate.  We do not believe it is necessary to impair these 
securities as long as the expected future cash flows are projected to be sufficient to recover the amortized cost of these securities.  

The actual range and period until recovery could vary significantly depending on a variety of factors, many of which are out of our 
control.  There are several items that could affect the length of the period until recovery, such as the pace of economic recovery, 
level of delinquencies, performance of the underlying collateral, changes in market interest rates, exposures to various industry or 
geographic conditions, market behavior and other market conditions. 

We concluded that it is not more likely than not that we will be required to sell the fixed maturity AFS securities before recovery of 
their amortized cost basis, that the estimated future cash flows are equal to or greater than the amortized cost basis of the debt 
securities, and that we have the ability to hold the equity AFS securities for a period of time sufficient for recovery.  This 
conclusion is consistent with our asset-liability management process.  Management considers the following as part of the 
evaluation: 

(cid:2)  The current economic environment and market conditions; 
(cid:2)  Our business strategy and current business plans; 
(cid:2)  The nature and type of security, including expected maturities and exposure to general credit, liquidity, market and interest rate 

risk;  

(cid:2)  Our analysis of data from financial models and other internal and industry sources to evaluate the current effectiveness of our 

hedging and overall risk management strategies;  

(cid:2)  The current and expected timing of contractual maturities of our assets and liabilities, expectations of prepayments on 

investments and expectations for surrenders and withdrawals of life insurance policies and annuity contracts;  

(cid:2)  The capital risk limits approved by management; and 
(cid:2)  Our current financial condition and liquidity demands. 

To determine the recoverability of a debt security, we consider the facts and circumstances surrounding the underlying issuer 
including, but not limited to, the following: 

(cid:2)  Historic and implied volatility of the security; 
(cid:2)  Length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than amortized cost;  
(cid:2)  Adverse conditions specifically related to the security or to specific conditions in an industry or geographic area;  
(cid:2)  Failure, if any, of the issuer of the security to make scheduled payments; and 
(cid:2)  Recoveries or additional declines in fair value subsequent to the balance sheet date.  

As reported on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, we had $86.1 billion of investments and cash, which exceeded the liabilities for 
our future obligations under insurance policies and contracts, net of amounts recoverable from reinsurers, which totaled $77.4 
billion as of December 31, 2010.  If it were necessary to liquidate securities prior to maturity or call to meet cash flow needs, we 
would first look to those securities that are in an unrealized gain position, which had a fair value of $56.2 billion, excluding 
consolidated VIEs in the amount of $584 million, as of December 31, 2010, rather than selling securities in an unrealized loss 

115 

  
 
 
           
 
           
     
  
  
       
  
           
     
  
       
  
           
     
  
  
  
       
  
           
  
 
 
  
 
           
 
  
   
 
     
  
     
  
  
 
  
  
  
       
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
position.  The amount of cash that we have on hand at any point of time takes into account our liquidity needs in the future, other 
sources of cash, such as the maturities of investments, interest and dividends we earn on our investments and the on-going cash 
flows from new and existing business.   

See “AFS Securities – Evaluation for Recovery of Amortized Cost” in Note 1 and Note 5 for additional discussion. 

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the estimated fair value for all private securities was $8.4 billion and $8.0 billion, representing 
approximately 10% and 11%, respectively, of total invested assets. 

For information regarding our VIEs’ fixed maturity securities, see Note 1 and Note 4.  For discussion of our investments in CLNs 
as of December 31, 2009, see Note 1. 

Trading Securities 

Trading securities, which in certain cases support reinsurance funds withheld and our Modco reinsurance agreements, are carried at 
estimated fair value and changes in estimated fair value are recorded in net income as they occur.  Investment results for these 
certain portfolios, including gains and losses from sales, are passed directly to the reinsurers through the contractual terms of the 
reinsurance arrangements.  Offsetting these amounts in certain cases are corresponding changes in fair value of the embedded 
derivative liability associated with the underlying reinsurance arrangement.  See Notes 1 and 9 for more information regarding our 
accounting for Modco. 

Mortgage-Backed Securities (“MBS”) (Included in AFS and Trading Securities) 

Our fixed maturity securities include MBS.  These securities are subject to risks associated with variable prepayments.  This may 
result in differences between the actual cash flow and maturity of these securities than that expected at the time of purchase.  
Securities that have an amortized cost greater than par and are backed by mortgages that prepay faster than expected will incur a 
reduction in yield or a loss.  Those securities with an amortized cost lower than par that prepay faster than expected will generate 
an increase in yield or a gain.  In addition, we may incur reinvestment risks if market yields are lower than the book yields earned 
on the securities.  Prepayments occurring slower than expected have the opposite effect.  We may incur reinvestment risks if 
market yields are higher than the book yields earned on the securities and we are forced to sell the securities.  The degree to which 
a security is susceptible to either gains or losses is influenced by:  the difference between its amortized cost and par; the relative 
sensitivity of the underlying mortgages backing the assets to prepayment in a changing interest rate environment; and the 
repayment priority of the securities in the overall securitization structure.  

We limit the extent of our risk on MBS by prudently limiting exposure to the asset class, by generally avoiding the purchase of 
securities with a cost that significantly exceeds par, by purchasing securities backed by stable collateral and by concentrating on 
securities with enhanced priority in their trust structure.  Such securities with reduced risk typically have a lower yield (but higher 
liquidity) than higher-risk MBS.  At selected times, higher-risk securities may be purchased if they do not compromise the safety of 
the general portfolio.  As of December 31, 2010, we did not have a significant amount of higher-risk, trust structured MBS.  A 
significant amount of assets in our MBS portfolio are either guaranteed by U.S. government-sponsored enterprises or are 
supported in the securitization structure by junior securities enabling the assets to achieve high investment grade status. 

Our exposure to subprime mortgage lending is limited to investments in banks and other financial institutions that may be affected 
by subprime lending and direct investments in ABS CDOs, ABS and RMBS.  Mortgage-related ABS are backed by home equity 
loans and RMBS are backed by residential mortgages.  These securities are backed by loans that are characterized by borrowers of 
differing levels of creditworthiness:  prime; Alt-A; and subprime.  Prime lending is the origination of residential mortgage loans to 
customers with excellent credit profiles.  Alt-A lending is the origination of residential mortgage loans to customers who have 
prime credit profiles but lack documentation to substantiate income.  Subprime lending is the origination of loans to customers 
with weak or impaired credit profiles.   

The slowing U.S. housing market, increased interest rates for non-prime borrowers and relaxed underwriting standards from 2003 
to 2007 have led to higher delinquency rates for residential mortgage loans and home equity loans.  We expect delinquency rates 
and loss rates on residential mortgages and home equity loans to increase in the future; however, we continue to expect to receive 
payments in accordance with contractual terms for a significant amount of our securities, largely due to the seniority of the claims 
on the collateral of the securities that we own.  The tranches of the securities will experience losses according to their seniority level 
with the least senior (or most junior), typically the unrated residual tranche, taking the initial loss.  The credit ratings of our 
securities reflect the seniority of the securities that we own.  Our RMBS had a market value of $9.1 billion and an unrealized gain of 
$169 million, or 2%, as of December 31, 2010. 

116 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The market value of AFS securities and trading securities backed by subprime loans was $474 million and represented less than 1% 
of our total investment portfolio as of December 31, 2010.  AFS securities represented $461 million, or 97%, and trading securities 
represented $13 million, or 3%, of the subprime exposure as of December 31, 2010.  AFS securities and trading securities rated A 
or above represented 53% of the subprime investments and $244 million in market value of our subprime investments was backed 
by loans originating in 2005 and forward.  The tables below summarize our investments in AFS securities backed by pools of 
residential mortgages (in millions): 

Type  
CMOs and MPTS  
ABS home equity  
   Total by type (1) 

Rating  
AAA  
AA  
A  
BBB  
BB and below  
   Total by rating (1)(2) 

Origination Year  
2004 and prior  
2005   
2006   
2007  
2008  
2009  
2010  
   Total by origination year (1) 

Total AFS securities  

Total AFS RMBS as a percentage of  
   total AFS securities  

Total prime/non-agency, Alt-A and subprime   
   as a percentage of total AFS securities  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

Fair Value as of December 31, 2010 

Prime 
Agency 

   Prime/ 
   Non- 
   Agency 

   Alt-A 

   Subprime   

Total 

 7,361    $ 
 5    
 7,366    $ 

 1,000     $ 
 -    
 1,000     $ 

 477    $ 
 274   
 751    $ 

 -    $ 

 461   
 461    $ 

 8,838 
 740 
 9,578 

 7,349    $ 
 -    
 17   
 -    
 -    
 7,366    $ 

 2,389    $ 
 860   
 267   
 1,151   
 290   
 1,367   
 1,042   
 7,366    $ 

 255     $ 
 31    
 9    
 48    
 657    
 1,000     $ 

 273     $ 
 185    
 196    
 346    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 1,000     $ 

 123    $ 
 89   
 54   
 7   
 478   
 751    $ 

 280    $ 
 224   
 198   
 49   
 -    
 -    
 -    
 751    $ 

 191    $ 
 31   
 16   
 44   
 179   
 461    $ 

 221    $ 
 177   
 62   
 -   
 -   
 1   
 -   
 461    $ 

 7,918 
 151 
 96 
 99 
 1,314 
 9,578 

 3,163 
 1,446 
 723 
 1,546 
 290 
 1,368 
 1,042 
 9,578 

   $ 

 68,811 

13.9%

3.2%

(1)  Does not include the fair value of trading securities totaling $279 million, which support our Modco reinsurance agreements 
because investment results for these agreements are passed directly to the reinsurers.  The $279 million in trading securities 
consisted of $250 million prime, $16 million Alt-A and $13 million subprime.   

(2)  For the table above, credit ratings shown in the document are based on ratings provided by the major credit rating agencies 
(Fitch, Moody’s and S&P) or are based on internal ratings for those securities where external ratings are not available.  For 
securities where the ratings assigned by the major rating agencies are not equivalent, the second highest of the three ratings 
assigned is used. 

117 

  
 
 
             
             
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
    
             
     
  
     
  
  
     
             
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
 
Amortized Cost as of December 31, 2010 
   Prime/ 
   Non- 
   Agency 

   Subprime   

   Alt-A 

Prime 
Agency 

Total 

Type  
CMOs and MPTS  
ABS home equity  
   Total by type (1) 

Rating  
AAA  
AA  
A  
BBB  
BB and below  
   Total by rating (1)(2) 

Origination Year  
2004 and prior  
2005   
2006   
2007  
2008  
2009  
2010  
   Total by origination year (1) 

Total AFS securities  

Total AFS RMBS as a percentage of  
   total AFS securities  

Total prime/non-agency, Alt-A and subprime    
   as a percentage of total AFS securities  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 6,954    $ 
 5    
 6,959    $ 

 1,135     $ 
 -    
 1,135     $ 

 584    $ 
 352   
 936    $ 

 -    $ 

 645   
 645    $ 

 8,673 
 1,002 
 9,675 

 6,944    $ 
 -    
 15   
 -    
 -    
 6,959    $ 

 2,236    $ 
 804   
 246   
 1,043   
 268   
 1,331   
 1,031   
 6,959    $ 

 256     $ 
 37    
 10    
 53    
 779    
 1,135     $ 

 289     $ 
 221    
 219    
 406    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 1,135     $ 

 131    $ 
 102   
 61   
 7   
 635   
 936    $ 

 314    $ 
 275   
 273   
 74   
 -    
 -    
 -    
 936    $ 

 200    $ 
 34   
 24   
 61   
 326   
 645    $ 

 274    $ 
 239   
 130   
 -   
 -   
 2   
 -   
 645    $ 

 7,531 
 173 
 110 
 121 
 1,740 
 9,675 

 3,113 
 1,539 
 868 
 1,523 
 268 
 1,333 
 1,031 
 9,675 

   $ 

 65,924 

14.7%

4.1%

(1)  Does not include the amortized cost of trading securities totaling $279 million, which support our Modco reinsurance 

agreements because investment results for these agreements are passed directly to the reinsurers.  The $279 million in trading 
securities consisted of $245 million prime, $19 million Alt-A and $15 million subprime.   

(2)  For the table above, credit ratings shown in the document are based on ratings provided by the major credit rating agencies 
(Fitch, Moody’s and S&P) or are based on internal ratings for those securities where external ratings are not available.  For 
securities where the ratings assigned by the major rating agencies are not equivalent, the second highest of the three ratings 
assigned is used.   

None of these investments included any direct investments in subprime lenders or mortgages.  We are not aware of material 
exposure to subprime loans in our alternative asset portfolio. 

118 

  
 
 
               
               
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
               
     
  
     
  
  
     
               
     
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
     
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
     
     
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
  
 
 
The following summarizes our investments in AFS securities backed by pools of consumer loan ABS (in millions): 

Credit Card (1) 

As of December 31, 2010 
Auto Loans 

Total 

Fair 
Value 

   Amortized   
Cost  

Fair 
Value 

   Amortized   
Cost 

Fair 
Value 

   Amortized 
Cost 

$ 

$ 

 838     $ 
 22    
 860     $ 

 809     $ 
 22    
 831     $ 

 164     $ 
 -    
 164     $ 

 162    $ 
 -    
 162    $ 

 1,002    $ 
 22   
 1,024    $ 

 971 
 22 
 993 

   $ 

 68,811    $ 

 65,924 

1.5%  

1.5%

Rating  
AAA  
BBB  
   Total by rating (1)(2)(3) 

Total AFS securities  

Total by rating as a percentage   
   of total AFS securities  

(1) 

Includes amortized cost of $570 million ABS credit card assets that were reclassified from the ABS CLN assets as a result of 
adopting ASU 2009-17 as of January 1, 2010.  See Note 4 for additional information. 

(2)  For the table above, credit ratings shown in the document are based on ratings provided by the major credit rating agencies 
(Fitch, Moody’s and S&P) or are based on internal ratings for those securities where external ratings are not available.  For 
securities where the ratings assigned by the major rating agencies are not equivalent, the second highest of the three ratings 
assigned is used.   

(3)  Does not include the fair value of trading securities totaling $3 million, which support our Modco reinsurance agreements 
because investment results for these agreements are passed directly to the reinsurers.  The $3 million in trading securities 
consisted of credit card securities.  

119 

  
 
 
            
  
            
  
  
            
           
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
     
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
     
  
    
  
    
    
  
     
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
     
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
 
The following summarizes our investments in AFS securities backed by pools of commercial mortgages (in millions): 

As of December 31, 2010 

Multiple Property 
Fair 
Value 

  Amortized    
   Cost 

Single Property 
Fair 
   Value 

  Amortized    
   Cost 

CRE CDOs 

Total 

Fair 
   Value 

  Amortized   
   Cost 

Fair 
   Value 

  Amortized 
   Cost 

Type   
CMBS  
CRE CDOs  
   Total by type (1) 

Rating  
AAA  
AA  
A  
BBB  
BB and below  
   Total by rating (1)(2) 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 1,983 
 - 
 1,983 

 $ 

 $ 

 2,035 
 - 
 2,035 

 $ 

 $ 

 1,348    $ 
 259   
 140   
 96   
 140   
 1,983    $ 

 1,268    $ 
 257   
 146   
 100   
 264   
 2,035    $ 

$ 

Origination Year  
2004 and prior  
2005   
2006   
2007   
2010   
   Total by origination year (1)  $ 

 1,249 
 378 
 150 
 154 
 52 
 1,983 

 $ 

 $ 

 1,239 
 367 
 205 
 170 
 54 
 2,035 

 $ 

 $ 

 70 
 - 
 70 

 25 
 9 
 12 
 5 
 19 
 70 

 40 
 28 
 2 
 - 
 - 
 70 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 109    $ 
 -      
 109    $ 

 24    $ 
 10      
 13      
 6      
 56      
 109    $ 

 41    $ 
 60      
 8      
 -      
 -      
 109    $ 

 - 
 32 
 32 

 - 
 - 
 5 
 14 
 13 
 32 

 8 
 12 
 12 
 - 
 - 
 32 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

Total AFS securities  

Total AFS CMBS as  
   a percentage of total   
   AFS securities  

 -  $ 

 46  
 46   $ 

 2,053  $ 
 32 
 2,085  $ 

 2,144 
 46 
 2,190 

 -  $ 
 - 
 5 
 18  
 23  
 46   $ 

 1,373  $ 
 268 
 157 
 115 
 172 
 2,085  $ 

 9  $ 
 14  
 23  
 - 
 - 
 46   $ 

 1,297  $ 
 418 
 164 
 154 
 52 
 2,085  $ 

 1,292 
 267 
 164 
 124 
 343 
 2,190 

 1,289 
 441 
 236 
 170 
 54 
 2,190 

  $ 

 68,811  $ 

 65,924 

3.0%   

3.3%

(1)  Does not include the fair value of trading securities totaling $70 million, which support our Modco reinsurance agreements 
because investment results for these agreements are passed directly to the reinsurers.  The $70 million in trading securities 
consisted of $67 million CMBS and $3 million CRE CDOs.   

(2)  For the table above, credit ratings shown in the document are based on ratings provided by the major credit rating agencies 
(Fitch, Moody’s and S&P) or are based on internal ratings for those securities where external ratings are not available.  For 
securities where the ratings assigned by the major rating agencies are not equivalent, the second highest of the three ratings 
assigned is used.   

120 

  
 
 
               
               
  
  
  
               
              
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
   
   
   
  
  
              
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
   
  
  
               
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
   
   
   
  
  
  
   
   
   
   
  
  
  
   
   
   
   
  
  
  
   
   
   
   
  
  
  
   
     
     
     
   
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
 
Monoline insurers provide guarantees on debt for issuers, often in the form of credit wraps, which enhance the credit of the issuer. 
Monoline insurers guarantee the timely repayment of bond principal and interest when a bond issuer defaults and generally provide 
credit enhancement for bond issues such as municipal bonds and private placements as well as other types and structures of 
securities.  Our direct exposure represents our bond holdings of the actual Monoline insurers.  Our insured bonds represent our 
holdings in bonds of other issuers that are insured by Monoline insurers. 

The following summarizes our exposure to Monoline insurers (in millions): 

As of December 31, 2010 

Direct  

   Insured  
Exposure (1)     Bonds (2) 

   Total 
   Amortized     Unrealized    

   Total 

Cost 

   Gain 

   Total 
   Unrealized     Total 
Fair 
   and OTTI     Value 

Loss 

Monoline Name  
AMBAC  
ASSURED GUARANTY LTD  
FGIC  
FSA  
MBIA  
MGIC  
PMI GROUP INC  
RADIAN GROUP INC  
XL CAPITAL LTD  
   Total by Monoline insurer (3) 

Total AFS securities  

Total by Monoline insurer as a   
   percentage of total AFS securities  

  $ 

  $ 

 -      $ 

 30     
 -     
 -     
 12     
 -     
 24     
 16     
 72     
 154      $ 

 222     $ 
 -    
 78    
 44    
 142    
 5    
 -    
 -    
 63    
 554     $ 

 222    $ 
 30   
 78   
 44   
 154   
 5    
 24   
 16   
 135   
 708    $ 

 4     $ 
 -    
 1    
 1    
 13    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 1    
 20     $ 

 45    $ 
 18   
 18   
 1   
 13   
 1   
 6   
 1   
 10   
 113    $ 

 181 
 12 
 61 
 44 
 154 
 4 
 18 
 15 
 126 
 615 

   $ 

 65,924    $ 

 4,295     $ 

 1,408    $ 

 68,811 

1.1%   

0.5%   

8.0%  

0.9%

(1)  Additional direct exposure through credit default swaps with a notional value totaling $20 million is excluded from this table. 
(2)  Additional indirect insured exposure through structured securities is excluded from this table. 
(3)  Does not include the fair value of trading securities totaling $30 million, which support our Modco reinsurance agreements 
because investment results for these agreements are passed directly to the reinsurers.  The $30 million in trading securities 
consisted of $11 million of direct exposure and $19 million of insured exposure.  This table also excludes insured exposure 
totaling $10 million for a guaranteed investment tax credit partnership. 

Additional Details on our Unrealized Losses on AFS Securities 

When considering unrealized gain and loss information, it is important to recognize that the information relates to the status of 
securities at a particular point in time and may not be indicative of the status of our investment portfolios subsequent to the 
balance sheet date.  Further, because the timing of the recognition of realized investment gains and losses through the selection of 
which securities are sold is largely at management’s discretion, it is important to consider the information provided below within 
the context of the overall unrealized gain or loss position of our investment portfolios.  These are important considerations that 
should be included in any evaluation of the potential effect of unrealized loss securities on our future earnings.   

121 

  
 
 
 
           
           
       
           
  
    
       
       
           
       
           
           
  
           
  
       
    
     
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
       
    
     
       
    
     
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
       
    
     
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
We have no concentrations of issuers or guarantors of fixed maturity and equity securities.  The composition by industry categories 
of securities subject to enhanced analysis and monitoring for potential changes in unrealized loss status (in millions) for our 
securities that we believe were most at risk of impairment, was as follows: 

Fair 
Value 

% 
Fair 
   Value 

As of December 31, 2010 

   Amortized     Amortized    

Loss 

Loss 

% 

   Unrealized     Unrealized 

% 

Cost 

Cost 

 11    
 150    
 67    
 38    
 17    
 42    
 12    
 5    

3.2%   $ 
43.8%  
19.6%  
11.1%  
5.0%  
12.3%  
3.5%  
1.5%  

 83    
 184    
 98    
 63    
 34    
 52    
 13    
 6    

   and OTTI     and OTTI 
37.7%
17.8%
16.2%
13.1%
9.0%
5.2%
0.5%
0.5%

 72   
 34   
 31   
 25   
 17   
 10   
 1   
 1   

15.6%   $ 
34.5%  
18.4%  
11.8%  
6.4%  
9.8%  
2.4%  
1.1%  

 342    

100.0%   $ 

 533    

100.0%   $ 

 191   

100.0%

 68,811    

   $ 

 65,924    

   $ 

 1,408   

0.5%   

0.8%   

13.6%  

$ 

$ 

$ 

CMBS 
CMOs 
Banking 
Diversified manufacturing 
ABS 
Property and casualty insurers 
Gaming 
Industrial - other 
   Total securities subject to  
      enhanced analysis 
      and monitoring 

Total AFS securities 

Total securities subject to  
   enhanced analysis and  
   monitoring as a percentage  
   of total AFS securities 

In addition, as discussed in Note 1, we perform detailed analysis of our AFS securities, including those presented above as well as 
other AFS securities.  For selected information on these AFS securities in a gross unrealized loss position backed by pools of 
residential and commercial mortgages as of December 31, 2010, see Note 5. 

122 

  
 
 
              
          
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
  
             
    
  
       
  
             
  
  
             
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
$ 

$ 

$ 

CMOs 
ABS 
Banking 
Property and casualty insurers 
CMBS 
Non-captive diversified 
Non-agency 
Financial - other 
Industrial - other 
Gaming 
Airlines 
Electric 
Retailers 
Refining 
Chemicals 
Real estate investment trusts 
Lodging 
   Total securities subject  
      to enhanced analysis  
      and monitoring 

Total AFS securities 

Total securities subject to  
   enhanced analysis and  
   monitoring as a percentage  
   of total AFS securities 

Fair 
Value 

% 
Fair 
   Value 

As of December 31, 2009 

   Amortized     Amortized    

Loss 

Loss 

% 

   Unrealized     Unrealized 

% 

Cost 

Cost 

 175    
 31    
 98    
 42    
 3    
 57    
 1    
 29    
 4    
 21    
 2    
 2    
 1    
 5    
 3    
 1    
 2    

36.8%   $ 
6.5%  
20.6%  
8.8%  
0.6%  
12.0%  
0.2%  
6.1%  
0.8%  
4.4%  
0.4%  
0.4%  
0.2%  
1.0%  
0.6%  
0.2%  
0.4%  

 280    
 91    
 137    
 70    
 30    
 63    
 4    
 31    
 6    
 22    
 3    
 3    
 1    
 5    
 3    
 1    
 2    

   and OTTI     and OTTI 
38.1%
21.8%
14.2%
10.2%
9.8%
2.2%
1.1%
0.7%
0.7%
0.4%
0.4%
0.4%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%

 105   
 60   
 39   
 28   
 27   
 6   
 3   
 2   
 2   
 1   
 1   
 1   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   

37.3%   $ 
12.1%  
18.2%  
9.3%  
4.0%  
8.4%  
0.5%  
4.1%  
0.8%  
2.9%  
0.4%  
0.4%  
0.1%  
0.7%  
0.4%  
0.1%  
0.3%  

 477    

100.0%   $ 

 752    

100.0%   $ 

 275   

100.0%

 61,096    

   $ 

 61,139    

   $ 

 2,795   

0.8%   

1.2%   

9.8%  

123 

  
 
 
              
              
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
  
              
    
  
       
  
              
  
  
            
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
 
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
 
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
The composition by industry categories of all securities in unrealized loss status (in millions), was as follows: 

ABS 
CMOs 
Banking 
CMBS 
Local authorities 
Property and casualty insurers 
Electric 
Diversified manufacturing 
Media - non-cable 
Life 
Retailers 
Gaming 
Paper 
Entertainment 
Industries with unrealized losses 
   less than $10 million 
      Total by industry 

Total AFS securities 

Total by industry as a  
   percentage of total AFS securities 

Fair 
Value 

% 
Fair 
   Value 

As of December 31, 2010 

   Amortized     Amortized    

Loss 

Loss 

% 

   Unrealized     Unrealized 

% 

Cost 

Cost 

$ 

 843    
 1,164    
 1,495    
 379    
 1,933    
 360    
 760    
 267    
 238    
 287    
 172    
 153    
 130    
 193    

7.0%   $ 
9.7%  
12.4%  
3.2%  
16.1%  
3.0%  
6.3%  
2.2%  
2.0%  
2.4%  
1.4%  
1.3%  
1.1%  
1.6%  

 1,142    
 1,419    
 1,693    
 565    
 2,028    
 409    
 806    
 301    
 263    
 304    
 187    
 165    
 142    
 204    

   and OTTI     and OTTI 
21.1%
18.1%
14.1%
13.2%
6.7%
3.5%
3.3%
2.4%
1.8%
1.2%
1.1%
0.9%
0.9%
0.8%

 299   
 255   
 198   
 186   
 95   
 49   
 46   
 34   
 25   
 17   
 15   
 12   
 12   
 11   

8.5%   $ 
10.6%  
12.6%  
4.2%  
15.1%  
3.0%  
6.0%  
2.2%  
2.0%  
2.3%  
1.4%  
1.2%  
1.1%  
1.5%  

 3,641    
 12,015    

 68,811    

$ 

$ 

30.3%  
100.0%   $ 

 3,795    
 13,423    

28.3%  
100.0%   $ 

 154   
 1,408   

10.9%
100.0%

   $ 

 65,924    

   $ 

 1,408   

17.5%   

20.4%   

100.0%  

124 

  
 
 
 
           
       
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
  
           
    
  
       
  
          
  
  
          
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
           
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
Fair 
Value 

% 
Fair 
   Value 

As of December 31, 2009 

   Amortized     Amortized    

Loss 

Loss 

% 

   Unrealized     Unrealized 

% 

Cost 

Cost 

$ 

 1,290   
 1,973   
 1,797   
 809   
 621   
 986   
 927   
 277   
 217   
 260   
 434   
 211   
 298   
 194   
 210   
 283   
 102   
 174   
 299   
 362   
 310   
 337   
 115   
 248   
 829   
 156   
 152   

7.8%   $ 
12.0%  
10.8%  
4.9%  
3.7%  
5.9%  
5.6%  
1.7%  
1.3%  
1.6%  
2.6%  
1.3%  
1.8%  
1.2%  
1.3%  
1.7%  
0.6%  
1.0%  
1.8%  
2.2%  
1.9%  
2.0%  
0.7%  
1.5%  
5.0%  
0.9%  
0.9%  

 2,061   
 2,462   
 2,266   
 1,163   
 709   
 1,037   
 970   
 318   
 257   
 292   
 461   
 237   
 322   
 217   
 230   
 302   
 121   
 192   
 314   
 376   
 324   
 350   
 128   
 261   
 841   
 167   
 163   

   and OTTI     and OTTI 
27.6%
17.5%
16.8%
12.7%
3.1%
1.8%
1.5%
1.5%
1.4%
1.1%
1.0%
0.9%
0.9%
0.8%
0.7%
0.7%
0.7%
0.6%
0.5%
0.5%
0.5%
0.5%
0.5%
0.5%
0.4%
0.4%
0.4%

 771   
 489   
 469   
 354   
 88   
 51   
 43   
 41   
 40   
 32   
 27   
 26   
 24   
 23   
 20   
 19   
 19   
 18   
 15   
 14   
 14   
 13   
 13   
 13   
 12   
 11   
 11   

10.6%   $ 
12.8%  
11.8%  
6.0%  
3.7%  
5.3%  
5.0%  
1.6%  
1.3%  
1.5%  
2.4%  
1.2%  
1.7%  
1.1%  
1.2%  
1.6%  
0.6%  
1.0%  
1.6%  
1.9%  
1.7%  
1.8%  
0.7%  
1.3%  
4.3%  
0.9%  
0.8%  

ABS 
Banking 
CMOs 
CMBS 
Property and casualty insurers 
Electric 
Local authorities 
Media - non-cable 
Paper 
Financial - other 
Real estate investment trusts 
Non-captive diversified 
Life 
Gaming 
Entertainment 
Owned no guarantee 
Non-agency 
Sovereigns 
Pipelines 
Municipal 
Diversified manufacturing 
Distributors 
Non-captive consumer 
Metals and mining 
Conventional 30-year 
Industrial - other 
Retailers 
Industries with unrealized losses 
   less than $10 million 
     Total by industry 

Total AFS securities 

 2,718   
 16,589   

 61,096   

$ 

$ 

16.3%  
100.0%   $ 

 2,843   
 19,384   

14.6%  
100.0%   $ 

 125   
 2,795   

4.5%
100.0%

   $ 

 61,139   

   $ 

 2,795   

Total by industry as a  
   percentage of total AFS securities 

27.2%   

31.7%   

100.0%  

Unrealized Loss on Below Investment Grade AFS Fixed Maturity Securities 

Gross unrealized losses on below investment grade AFS fixed maturity securities represented 47.4% and 47.5% of total gross 
unrealized losses on all AFS securities as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Generally, below investment grade fixed 
maturity securities are more likely than investment grade fixed maturity securities to develop credit concerns.  The remaining 52.6% 
and 52.5% of the gross unrealized losses as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively, related to investment grade AFS 
securities.  The ratios of estimated fair value to amortized cost reflected in the table below were not necessarily indicative of the 
market value to amortized cost relationships for the securities throughout the entire time that the securities have been in an 
unrealized loss position nor are they necessarily indicative of these ratios subsequent to December 31, 2010. 

125 

  
 
 
           
       
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
  
           
    
  
       
  
           
  
  
          
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
 
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Details underlying fixed maturity securities below investment grade and in an unrealized loss position (in millions) were as follows: 

Aging Category  
90 days or less 

   Total 90 days or less 

91 days to 180 days 

   Total 91 to 180 days  

181 days to 270 days 

   Total 181 days to 270 days  

271 days to 1 year 

   Total 271 days to 1 year 

Greater than 1 year 

   Total greater than 1 year 
      Total below investment grade and in  
         an unrealized loss position 

Total AFS securities 

Total below investment grade and in an  
   unrealized loss position as a percentage  
   of total AFS securities 

   Ratio of 
   Amortized 
      Cost to 
Fair 
     Fair Value       Value 
   Above 70% 
  $ 
   40% to 70%       
   Below 40% 

As of December 31, 2010 

   Amortized    
Cost 

   Unrealized 

Loss 
   and OTTI 
 34   
 50   
 9   
 93   

 422    $ 
 128   
 11   
 561   

 388     $ 
 78    
 2    
 468    

   Above 70% 
   40% to 70%       

   Above 70% 
   40% to 70%       

   Above 70% 
   40% to 70%       

   Above 70% 
   40% to 70%       
   Below 40% 

 62    
 26    
 88    

 57    
 1    
 58    

 129    
 43    
 172    

 1,307    
 258    
 21    
 1,586    

 77   
 42   
 119   

 62   
 3   
 65   

 160   
 72   
 232   

 1,496   
 441   
 125   
 2,062   

 15   
 16   
 31   

 5   
 2   
 7   

 31   
 29   
 60   

 189   
 183   
 104   
 476   

    $ 

 2,372     $ 

 3,039    $ 

 667   

    $ 

 68,811    $ 

 65,924    $ 

 1,408   

3.4%   

4.6%   

47.4%  

126 

  
 
 
              
  
  
              
       
  
    
  
              
    
  
  
  
             
  
  
            
     
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
            
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
             
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
             
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
             
  
  
             
     
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
         
  
    
  
    
  
     
 
     
  
     
  
         
  
    
  
    
  
     
  
         
  
    
  
    
  
     
  
       
  
  
Aging Category  
90 days or less 

   Total 90 days or less 

91 days to 180 days 

   Total 91 to 180 days  

181 days to 270 days 

   Total 181 days to 270 days  

271 days to 1 year 

   Total 271 days to 1 year 

Greater than 1 year 

   Total greater than 1 year 
      Total below investment grade and in  
         an unrealized loss position 

Total AFS securities 

Total below investment grade and in an  
   unrealized loss position as a percentage  
   of total AFS securities 

Mortgage Loans on Real Estate 

   Ratio of 
   Amortized 
      Cost to 
Fair 
     Fair Value       Value 
   Above 70% 
  $ 
   40% to 70%       
   Below 40% 

As of December 31, 2009 

   Amortized    
Cost 

   Unrealized 

Loss 
   and OTTI 
 19   
 144   
 32   
 195   

 211    $ 
 307   
 44   
 562   

 192     $ 
 163    
 12    
 367    

   Above 70% 
   Below 40% 

   Above 70% 
   Below 40% 

   Above 70% 
   40% to 70%       
   Below 40% 

   Above 70% 
   40% to 70%       
   Below 40% 

 32    
 2    
 34    

 18    
 -    
 18    

 51    
 18    
 3    
 72    

 1,776    
 802    
 61    
 2,639    

 33   
 6   
 39   

 25   
 1   
 26   

 60   
 30   
 13   
 103   

 2,023   
 1,403   
 303   
 3,729   

 1   
 4   
 5   

 7   
 1   
 8   

 9   
 12   
 10   
 31   

 247   
 601   
 242   
 1,090   

    $ 

 3,130     $ 

 4,459    $ 

 1,329   

    $ 

 61,096    $ 

 61,139    $ 

 2,795   

5.1%   

7.3%   

47.5%  

The following tables summarize key information on mortgage loans on real estate (in millions): 

Credit Quality Indicator  
Current  
Delinquent and in foreclosure (1) 
   Total mortgage loans on real estate  

As of December 31, 2010 
Carrying    
Value 

% 

   As of December 31, 2009   
   Carrying    
   Value 

% 

$ 

$ 

 6,699   
 53   
 6,752   

99.2%     $ 
0.8%       
100.0%     $ 

 7,142   
 36   
 7,178   

99.5%  
0.5%  
100.0%  

(1)  As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, there were 10 and 8 mortgage loans that were delinquent and in foreclosure, respectively. 

127 

  
 
 
              
  
  
              
       
  
    
  
              
    
  
  
  
             
  
  
            
     
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
            
     
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
            
     
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
             
  
  
             
     
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
  
             
  
  
             
     
  
  
     
 
       
  
  
     
  
         
  
    
  
    
  
     
 
     
  
     
  
         
  
    
  
    
  
     
  
         
  
    
  
    
  
     
  
       
  
  
 
 
 
              
             
  
  
  
               
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
 
By Segment 
Retirement Solutions:  
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution  
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
Other Operations 
      Total mortgage loans on real estate 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

   $ 

 1,172       $ 
 920         

 1,193   
 925   

 3,856         
 285         
 519         
 6,752       $ 

 4,185   
 310   
 565   
 7,178   

   $ 

As of  

December 31,        

2010  

Allowance for Losses 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Additions 
   Charge-offs, net of recoveries 

   $ 

      Balance as of end-of-year 

   $ 

 22            
 18            
 (27)           

 13            

Property Type 
Office building 
Industrial 
Retail 
Apartment 
Hotel/Motel 
Mixed use 
Other commercial 
   Total 

Geographic Region 
Pacific 
South Atlantic 
Mountain 
West South Central 
East North Central 
East South Central 
Middle Atlantic 
West North Central 
New England 
   Total 

As of December 31, 2010               
Carrying 
Value 

% 

   State Exposure 

As of December 31, 2010 
Carrying 
Value 

% 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 2,296    
 1,804    
 1,593    
 664    
 166    
 130    
 99    
 6,752    

 1,841    
 1,677    
 619    
 619    
 613    
 433    
 429    
 381    
 140    
 6,752    

 1,451   
 586   
 421   
 329   
 309   
 301   
 287   
 255   

 250   
 230   
 201   
 200   
 188   
 184   
 155   
 153   
 134   
 118   
 113   
 103   
 784   
 6,752   

21.4%
8.6%
6.2%
4.9%
4.6%
4.5%
4.3%
3.8%

3.7%
3.4%
3.0%
3.0%
2.8%
2.7%
2.3%
2.3%
2.0%
1.7%
1.7%
1.5%
11.6%
100.0%

$ 

34.0%   CA 
26.7%   TX 
23.6%   MD 
9.8%   VA 
2.5%   FL 
1.9%   TN 
1.5%   WA 
100.0%   NC 

   AZ 
   GA 
   PA 
   IL 

27.2%   NV 
24.8%   OH 
9.2%   MN 
9.2%   IN 
9.1%   NJ 
6.4%   SC 
6.4%   MA 
5.6%   OR 
2.1%   Other states under 2% 

100.0%  

   Total 

$ 

128 

  
 
 
           
  
  
           
  
   
  
     
  
     
  
  
        
          
  
     
     
  
      
  
  
     
     
     
 
           
  
         
  
           
  
           
  
         
  
        
          
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
              
              
  
  
             
  
  
              
  
             
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
              
    
  
  
  
              
    
  
  
  
              
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
As of December 31, 2010   
Principal 
Amount 

% 

As of December 31, 2010 
Principal 
Amount 

% 

Origination Year 
2004 and prior 
2005 
2006 
2007 
2008 
2009 
2010 

   Total 

$ 

$ 

 3,016    
 822    
 678    
 945    
 812    
 151    
 321    
 6,745    

   Future Principal Payments    
$ 

44.7%   2011 
12.2%   2012 
10.1%   2013 
14.0%   2014 
12.0%   2015  
2.2%   2016 and thereafter 
4.8%  

   Total 

100.0%  

 286   
 333   
 403   
 443   
 658   
 4,622   
 6,745   

4.2%
4.9%
6.0%
6.6%
9.8%
68.5%
100.0%

$ 

As discussed in “Current Market Conditions,” the global financial markets and credit market conditions experienced a period of 
extreme volatility and disruption that began in the second half of 2007 and continued and substantially increased throughout 2008 
that led to a decrease in the overall liquidity and availability of capital in the mortgage loan market, and in particular a decrease in 
activity by securitization lenders.  These conditions and the overall economic downturn put pressure on the fundamentals of 
mortgage loans through rising vacancies, falling rents and falling property values.  

See Note 5 for information regarding our loan-to-value and debt-service coverage ratios. 

There were nine impaired mortgage loans, or less than 1% of the total dollar amount of mortgage loans as of both December 31, 
2010 and 2009.  The carrying value on the mortgage loans that were two or more payments delinquent as of December 31, 2010, 
was $48 million, or 1% of total mortgage loans.  The total principal and interest past due on the mortgage loans that were two or 
more payments delinquent as of December 31, 2010, was $5 million.  The carrying value on the mortgage loans that were two or 
more payments delinquent as of December 31, 2009, was $36 million, or less than 1% of total mortgage loans.  The total principal 
and interest past due on the mortgage loans that were two or more payments delinquent as of December 31, 2009, was $2 million.  
See Note 1 for more information regarding our accounting policy relating to the impairment of mortgage loans. 

Alternative Investments 

The carrying value of our consolidated alternative investments by business segment (in millions), which consisted primarily of 
investments in limited partnerships, was as follows: 

Retirement Solutions:  
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution  
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
Other Operations 
      Total alternative investments 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 95     $ 
 71    

 546    
 30    
 8    
 750     $ 

 85   
 65   

 485   
 32   
 29   
 696   

129 

  
 
 
              
           
              
  
  
  
           
  
  
              
  
  
           
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
          
    
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
           
  
           
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Income (loss) derived from our consolidated alternative investments by business segment (in millions) was as follows: 

Retirement Solutions:   
   Annuities  
   Defined Contribution   
Insurance Solutions:  
   Life Insurance  
   Group Protection  
Other Operations  
      Total alternative investments (1) 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2009  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 14    $ 
 10   

 63   
 5    
 1    
 93    $ 

 3     $ 
 2    

 (66)   
 1    
 5    
 (55)    $ 

 (7)  
 (8)  

 (16)  
 (2)  
 (1)  
 (34)  

NM
NM

195%
NM
-80%
269%

143%
125%

NM
150%
NM
-62%

(1) 

Includes net investment income on the alternative investments supporting the required statutory surplus of our insurance 
businesses. 

The increase in our investment income on alternative investments presented in the table above when comparing 2010 to 2009 was 
due primarily to the unfavorable effect of audit adjustments in 2009 related to completion of 2008 calendar-year financial statement 
audits of the investees within our portfolio and overall improvement in the equity markets in 2010 specifically benefiting our hedge 
fund, venture capital and energy limited partnership holdings. 

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, alternative investments included investments in approximately 95 and 99 different 
partnerships, respectively, and the portfolio represented less than 1% of our overall invested assets.  The partnerships do not 
represent off-balance sheet financing and generally involve several third-party partners.  Some of our partnerships contain capital 
calls, which require us to contribute capital upon notification by the general partner.  These capital calls are contemplated during 
the initial investment decision and are planned for well in advance of the call date.  The capital calls are not material in size and are 
not material to our liquidity.  Alternative investments are accounted for using the equity method of accounting and are included in 
other investments on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 

As discussed in “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Investments – Valuation of Alternative Investments,” we update the 
carrying value of our alternative investment portfolio whenever audited financial statements of the investees for the preceding year 
become available.  Net investment income (loss) derived from our consolidated alternative investments by segment (in millions) 
related to the effect of preceding year audit adjustments recorded during the indicated year at the investee was as follows: 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total 

For the Years Ended 
December 31, 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 2    $ 
 1   

 14   
 1   
 18    $ 

 (3)   
 (3)   

 (65)   
 (1)   
 (72)   

130 

  
 
 
 
                     
                     
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
           
  
           
  
           
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
Income (loss), after-tax, derived from our consolidated alternative investments by class (in millions) related to the effect of 
preceding year audit adjustments recorded during the indicated year at the investee was as follows: 

Venture capital 
Real estate 
Oil and gas 
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI, and DFEL 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
   Total 

For the Years Ended 
December 31, 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 13    $ 
 (2)  
 7   
 (6)  
 (4)  
 8    $ 

 (49)  
 (12)  
 (11)  
 26   
 16   
 (30)  

We believe the December 31, 2008, audit adjustments recorded during 2009 for each of the asset classes, which were more 
significant than those recorded in 2010 or 2008, related primarily to the adoption of Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures 
Topic of the FASB ASC and refinements to the valuation techniques or models used by the investees within our portfolio, which 
was impacted by the continued deterioration of the financial markets.  During 2008, there was extreme volatility and disruption 
that affected the equity and credit markets and made it challenging to arrive at certain assumptions utilized in the investee 
company’s valuation methodologies, which, in turn, determined the fair value of their respective portfolio companies.  Specifically, 
our understanding is that subjective assumptions such as forward-looking growth projections, discount rates utilized to present 
value expected future cash flows generated from the portfolio companies, among other items, were the focus of heavy debate and 
ultimately the net asset values of these particular investee companies were revised to reflect the downward revised valuations. 

Non-Income Producing Investments 

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the carrying amount of fixed maturity securities, mortgage loans on real estate and real estate 
that were non-income producing was $17 million and $38 million, respectively.  

Net Investment Income 

Details underlying net investment income (in millions) and our investment yield were as follows: 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

Net Investment Income  
Fixed maturity AFS securities  
VIEs' fixed maturity AFS securities  
Equity AFS securities  
Trading securities  
Mortgage loans on real estate  
Real estate  
Standby real estate equity commitments  
Policy loans  
Invested cash  
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment  
   and bond makewhole premiums (1) 
Alternative investments (2) 
Consent fees  
Other investments  
      Investment income  
Investment expense  

$ 

 3,694    $ 
 14        
 6    
 157   
 424   
 24    
 1    
 169   
 7    

 3,474    $ 
 -    
 8   
 159   
 462   
 18   
 1   
 172   
 15   

 67    
 93    
 8    
 (3)   
 4,661   
 (120)   

 24   
 (55)  
 5   
 9   
 4,292   
 (114)  

 3,337   
 -    
 26   
 166   
 475   
 20   
 3    
 179   
 52   

 29   
 (34)  
 5    
 (3)   
 4,255   
 (125)  

         Net investment income  

$ 

 4,541    $ 

 4,178    $ 

 4,130   

6%
NM
-25%
-1%
-8%
33%
0%
-2%
-53%

179%
269%
60%
NM
9%
-5%

9%

4%
NM
-69%
-4%
-3%
-10%
-67%
-4%
-71%

-17%
-62%
0%
NM
1%
9%

1%

(1)  See “Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for additional information. 
(2)  See “Alternative Investments” above for additional information. 
131 

  
 
 
 
           
  
           
  
           
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
                    
                        
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Interest Rate Yield 
Fixed maturity securities, mortgage  
   loans on real estate and other, 
   net of investment expenses 
Commercial mortgage loan  
   prepayment and bond  
   makewhole premiums 
Alternative investments 
Consent fees 
      Net investment income yield  
         on invested assets 

Average invested assets at amortized cost 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

   Basis Point Change 

5.63%  

5.81%   

5.90%  

 (18)  

0.09%  
0.12%  
0.01%  

0.03%   
-0.08%   
0.01%   

0.04%  
-0.05%  
0.01%  

 6   
 20   
 -   

 (9)

 (1)
 (3)
 - 

5.85%  

5.77%   

5.90%  

 8   

 (13)

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  
 70,024   
 72,359    $ 
 77,584    $ 

$ 

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

7%  

3%

We earn investment income on our general account assets supporting fixed annuity, term life, whole life, UL, interest-sensitive 
whole life and fixed portion of defined contribution and VUL products.  The profitability of our fixed annuity and life insurance 
products is affected by our ability to achieve target spreads, or margins, between the interest income earned on the general account 
assets and the interest credited to the contract holder on our average fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable.  
Net investment income and the interest rate yield table each include commercial mortgage loan prepayments and bond makewhole 
premiums, alternative investments and contingent interest and standby real estate equity commitments.  These items can vary 
significantly from period to period due to a number of factors and therefore can provide results that are not indicative of the 
underlying trends. 

The increase in net investment income when comparing 2010 to 2009 was attributable to more favorable investment income on 
surplus and alternative investments, higher prepayment and bond makewhole premiums (see “Alternative Investments” above and 
“Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums” below for more information) and higher invested 
assets driven primarily by favorable net flows on fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable and to a lesser extent 
issuances of common stock and debt. 

Standby Real Estate Equity Commitments 

Historically, we have entered into standby commitments, which obligated us to purchase real estate at a specified cost if a third-
party sale does not occur within approximately one year after construction is completed.  These commitments were used by a 
developer to obtain a construction loan from an outside lender on favorable terms.  In return for issuing the commitment, we 
received an annual fee and a percentage of the profit when the property is sold.  Our expectation is that we will be obligated to 
fund those commitments that remain outstanding.   

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, we had standby real estate equity commitments totaling $53 million and $220 million, 
respectively.  During 2010, we funded commitments of $142 million and recorded a loss of $8 million.  During 2009, we recorded a 
$69 million estimated allowance for loss on projects due to our belief that our requirement to fund the projects in accordance with 
the standby equity commitments would result in a probable future loss.  Certain of these commitments were funded during 2010 
and the allowance for loss related to these commitments was $13 million as of December 31, 2010. 

During 2009, we suspended the practice of entering into new standby real estate commitments.  

132 

  
 
 
                 
  
  
  
  
  
                 
  
                 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
        
        
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial Mortgage Loan Prepayment and Bond Makewhole Premiums 

Prepayment and makewhole premiums are collected when borrowers elect to call or prepay their debt prior to the stated maturity.  
A prepayment or makewhole premium allows investors to attain the same yield as if the borrower made all scheduled interest 
payments until maturity.  These premiums are designed to make investors indifferent to prepayment. 

The increase in prepayment and makewhole premiums when comparing 2010 to 2009 was attributable primarily to a decline in 
interest rates coupled with improvements in the capital markets and real estate financing environment, which resulted in more 
refinancing activity and more prepayment income. 

Realized Gain (Loss) Related to Certain Investments 

The detail of the realized gain (loss) related to certain investments (in millions) was as follows: 

Fixed maturity AFS securities: 
   Gross gains 
   Gross losses 
Equity AFS securities: 
   Gross gains 
   Gross losses 
Gain (loss) on other investments 
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI, and  
   DFEL and changes in other contract holder funds 
      Total realized gain (loss) related to certain 
         investments 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 107      $ 
 (248) 

 161 
   $ 
 (709)      

 60     
 (1,119)   

-34%   
65%   

 9  
 (3) 
 (53) 

 6        
 (27)      
 (130)      

 1     
 (163)   
 37     

50%   
89%   
59%   

168%
37%

NM
83%
NM

 8  

 161 

 256     

-95%   

-37%

$ 

 (180) 

 $ 

 (538)   $ 

 (928)  

67%   

42%

Amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL and changes in other contract holder funds reflect an assumption for an expected level 
of credit-related investment losses.  When actual credit-related investment losses are realized, we recognize a true-up to our DAC, 
VOBA, DSI and DFEL amortization and changes in other contract holder funds within realized loss reflecting the incremental 
effect of actual versus expected credit-related investment losses.  These actual to expected amortization adjustments could create 
volatility in net realized gains and losses.  The write-down for impairments includes both credit-related and interest-rate related 
impairments. 

Realized gains and losses generally originate from asset sales to reposition the portfolio or to respond to product experience.  
During 2010 and 2009, we sold securities for gains and losses.  In the process of evaluating whether a security with an unrealized 
loss reflects declines that are other-than-temporary, we consider our ability and intent to sell the security prior to a recovery of 
value.  However, subsequent decisions on securities sales are made within the context of overall risk monitoring, assessing value 
relative to other comparable securities and overall portfolio maintenance.  Although our portfolio managers may, at a given point 
in time, believe that the preferred course of action is to hold securities with unrealized losses that are considered temporary until 
such losses are recovered, the dynamic nature of portfolio management may result in a subsequent decision to sell.  These 
subsequent decisions are consistent with the classification of our investment portfolio as AFS.  We expect to continue to manage 
all non-trading invested assets within our portfolios in a manner that is consistent with the AFS classification.  

We consider economic factors and circumstances within countries and industries where recent write-downs have occurred in our 
assessment of the status of securities we own of similarly situated issuers.  While it is possible for realized or unrealized losses on a 
particular investment to affect other investments, our risk management has been designed to identify correlation risks and other 
risks inherent in managing an investment portfolio.  Once identified, strategies and procedures are developed to effectively monitor 
and manage these risks.  The areas of risk correlation that we pay particular attention to are risks that may be correlated within 
specific financial and business markets, risks within specific industries and risks associated with related parties. 

When the detailed analysis by our credit analysts and investment portfolio managers leads us to the conclusion that a security’s 
decline in fair value is other-than-temporary, the security is written down to estimated recovery value.  In instances where declines 
are considered temporary, the security will continue to be carefully monitored.  See “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” 
for additional information on our portfolio management strategy. 

133 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
               
               
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
   
  
       
    
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
 
    
       
    
  
  
    
     
  
 
    
       
    
  
 
 
 
 
Details underlying write-downs taken as a result of OTTI (in millions) were as follows: 

Fixed Maturity Securities 
Corporate bonds 
MBS: 
   CMOs 
   CMBS 
ABS CDOs 
Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities 
      Total fixed maturity securities 

Equity Securities 
Banking securities 
Insurance securities 
Other financial services securities 
Other securities 
      Total equity securities 
         Gross OTTI recognized in net income (loss) 
         Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI 
            and DFEL 
               Net OTTI recognized in net income (loss), 
                 pre-tax 

Portion of OTTI Recognized in OCI 
Gross OTTI recognized in OCI 
Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
   Net portion of OTTI recognized in OCI, pre-tax 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 (90)     $ 

 (214)    $ 

 (551)   

58%  

61%

 (65)       
 (41)       
 (1)       
 (5)       

 (202)  

 (250)      
 -        
 (39)      
 (67)      
 (570)  

 (303)   
 (1)   
 (1)   
 (50)   
 (906)   

 -   
 -    
 (3)   
 -    
 (3)   
 (205)  

 (10)  
 (8)   
 (3)   
 (6)   
 (27)  
 (597)  

 (131)   
 (1)   
 (24)   
 (7)   
 (163)   
 (1,069)  

74%  
NM  
97%  
93%  
65%  

100%  
100%  
0%  
100%  
89%  
66%  

 53 

 205 

 218    

-74%  

17%
100%
NM
-34%
37%

92%
NM
88%
14%
83%
44%

-6%

$ 

 (152)   $ 

 (392)   $ 

 (851)    

61%   

54%

$ 

$ 

 98    $ 
 (10)  
 88    $ 

 357    $ 
 (82)   
 275    $ 

 -    
 -    
 -    

-73%   
88%   
-68%   

NM
NM
NM

When comparing 2010 to 2009, the decrease in write-downs for OTTI on our AFS securities was attributable primarily to overall 
improvement in the credit markets as compared to the prior year.  Losses in 2010 were attributable primarily to certain corporate 
bond holdings within the entertainment, banking and diversified manufacturing sectors, as well as deteriorating fundamentals 
within the commercial and residential real estate market that affected select RMBS and CMBS holdings. 

The $303 million of impairments taken during 2010 were split between $205 million of primarily credit related impairments and 
$98 million of non-credit related impairments.  The credit-related impairments were largely attributable to our RMBS and 
mortgage-related ABS holdings that have suffered from continued deterioration in housing fundamentals.  The non-credit related 
impairments were incurred due to declines in values of securities for which we do not have an intent to sell or it is not more likely 
than not that we will sell the securities before recovery. 

REINSURANCE 

Our insurance companies cede insurance to other companies.  The portion of risks exceeding each of our insurance companies’ 
retention limits is reinsured with other insurers.  We seek reinsurance coverage within the businesses that sell life insurance to limit 
our exposure to mortality losses and enhance our capital management.  We utilize inter-company reinsurance agreements to 
manage our statutory capital position as well as our hedge program for variable annuity guarantees.  These inter-company 
agreements do not have an effect on our consolidated financial statements. 

Portions of our deferred annuity business have been reinsured on a modified coinsurance basis with other companies to limit our 
exposure to interest rate risks.  As of December 31, 2010, the reserves associated with these reinsurance arrangements totaled $935 
million.  To cover products other than life insurance, we acquire other insurance coverage with retentions and limits that 
management believes are appropriate for the circumstances.  The consolidated financial statements included in “Item 8. Financial 
Statements and Supplementary Data” reflect premiums, benefits and DAC, net of insurance ceded.  Our insurance companies 
remain liable if their reinsurers are unable to meet contractual obligations under applicable reinsurance agreements.  

134 

  
 
 
                    
                    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
       
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                 
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
       
   
  
  
  
  
     
     
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
                    
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
Our amounts recoverable from reinsurers represent receivables from and reserves ceded to reinsurers.  As of December 31, 2010 
and 2009, the amounts recoverable from reinsurers were $6.5 billion and $6.4 billion, respectively.  We obtain reinsurance from a 
diverse group of reinsurers, and we monitor concentration and financial strength ratings of our principal reinsurers.  Swiss Re 
represents our largest exposure.  In 2001, we sold our reinsurance business to Swiss Re primarily through indemnity reinsurance 
arrangements.  Because we are not relieved of our liability to the ceding companies for this business, the liabilities and obligations 
associated with the reinsured policies remain on our Consolidated Balance Sheets with a corresponding reinsurance receivable from 
Swiss Re, which totaled $3.0 billion as of December 31, 2010 and 2009.  Swiss Re has funded a trust with a balance of $1.7 billion 
as of December 31, 2010, to support this business.  As a result of Swiss Re’s S&P financial strength rating dropping below AA-, 
Swiss Re funded an additional trust during the fourth quarter of 2009 with a balance of approximately $1.5 billion as of December 
31, 2010, to support this business.  In addition to various remedies that we would have in the event of a default by Swiss Re, we 
continue to hold assets in support of certain of the transferred reserves.  These assets consist of those reported as trading securities 
and certain mortgage loans.  Our liabilities for funds withheld and embedded derivatives included $1.1 billion and $78 million, 
respectively, as of December 31, 2010, related to the business sold to Swiss Re.   

We sold a block of disability income business to Swiss Re as part of several indemnity reinsurance transactions executed in 2001, as 
discussed above.  On January 24, 2009, an award of rescission was declared related to an ongoing dispute between us and Swiss Re 
for this treaty, which requires us to be fully responsible for all claims incurred and liabilities supporting this block as if the 
reinsurance treaty never existed.  We completed a review of the adequacy of the reserves supporting the liabilities during the fourth 
quarter of 2009.  See Note 14 for a discussion of the effects of the rescission. 

During the third quarter of 2006, one of our reinsurers, Scottish Re Group Ltd (“Scottish Re”), received rating downgrades from 
various rating agencies.  Of the $578 million of fixed annuity business that we reinsure with Scottish Re, approximately 83% is 
reinsured through the use of modified coinsurance treaties, in which we possess the investments that support the reserves ceded to 
Scottish Re.  For our annuity business ceded on a coinsurance basis, Scottish Re had previously established an irrevocable 
investment trust supporting the reserves for the benefit of LNC.  In addition to fixed annuities, we have approximately $161 
million of policy liabilities on the life insurance business that we have reinsured with Scottish Re.  Scottish Re continues to perform 
under its contractual responsibilities to us.  We continue to evaluate the effect of these rating downgrades with respect to our 
existing exposures to Scottish Re.  Based on current information, we do not believe that Scottish Re’s rating downgrades will have 
a material adverse effect on our results of operations, liquidity or financial condition. 

See Note 9 for further information regarding reinsurance transactions. 

For factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk 
Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above. 

REVIEW OF CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL CONDITION 

Liquidity and Capital Resources 

Sources of Liquidity and Cash Flow 

Liquidity refers to the ability of an enterprise to generate adequate amounts of cash from its normal operations to meet cash 
requirements with a prudent margin of safety.  Our principal sources of cash flow from operating activities are insurance premiums 
and fees and investment income, while sources of cash flows from investing activities result from maturities and sales of invested 
assets.  Our operating activities provided cash of $1.7 billion, $937 million and $1.3 billion in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  
When considering our liquidity and cash flow, it is important to distinguish between the needs of our insurance subsidiaries and the 
needs of the holding company, LNC.  As a holding company with no operations of its own, LNC derives its cash primarily from its 
operating subsidiaries.  

The sources of liquidity of the holding company are principally comprised of dividends and interest payments from subsidiaries, 
augmented by holding company short-term investments, bank lines of credit and the ongoing availability of long-term public 
financing under an SEC-filed shelf registration statement.  These sources of liquidity and cash flow support the general corporate 
needs of the holding company, including its common and preferred stock dividends, interest and debt service, funding of callable 
securities, securities repurchases, acquisitions and investment in core businesses.  Our cash flows associated with collateral received 
from and posted with counterparties change as the market value of the underlying derivative contract changes.  As the value of a 
derivative asset declines (or increases), the collateral required to be posted by our counterparties would also decline (or increase).  
Likewise, when the value of a derivative liability declines (or increases), the collateral we are required to post for our counterparties’ 
benefit would also decline (or increase).  During 2010, our payables for collateral on derivative investments increased by $183 
million, which was attributable primarily to increased notional amounts.  For additional information, see “Credit Risk” in Note 6.  

135 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Details underlying the primary sources of our holding company cash flows (in millions) were as follows: 

Dividends from Subsidiaries  
The Lincoln National Life Insurance Company ("LNL")   $ 
Lincoln Financial Media (1) 
First Penn-Pacific  
Lincoln UK  
Delaware Investments (2) 
Lincoln Barbados  
Other  
Loan Repayments and Interest from Subsidiary  
LNL interest on inter-company notes (3) 

Other Cash Flow and Liquidity Items  
Net proceeds on common stock issuance  
Lincoln UK sale proceeds  
Increase (decrease) in commercial paper, net  
Net capital received from (paid for taxes on)   
   stock option exercises and restricted stock  

$ 

$ 

$ 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

 684    $ 
 -    
 -    
 -    
 390   
 -    
 28    

 405    $ 
 2   
 50   
 -   
 10   
 300   
 -   

 400   
 659   
 50   
 24   
 51   
 -    
 54   

 83    
 1,185    $ 

 83   
 850    $ 

 83   
 1,321   

 368    $ 
 18    
 1    

 652    $ 
 307   
 (216)  

 -    
 387    $ 

 (1)  
 742    $ 

 -    
 -    
 50   

 15   
 65   

69%  
-100%  
-100%  
NM  
NM  
-100%  
NM  

0%  
39%  

-44%  
-94%  
100%

100%  
-48%  

1%
-100%
0%
-100%
-80%
NM
-100%

0%
-36%

NM
NM
NM

NM
NM

(1)  During May of 2009, Lincoln Financial Media became a subsidiary of LNL.  For 2008, amount includes proceeds on the sale 

of certain discontinued media operations.  For more information, see Note 3. 

(2)  For 2010, amount includes proceeds on the sale of Delaware.  For more information, see Note 3.   
(3)  Primarily represents interest on the holding company’s $1.3 billion in surplus note investments in LNL.  

The table above focuses on significant and recurring cash flow items and excludes the effects of certain financing activities, namely 
the periodic issuance and retirement of debt and cash flows related to our inter-company cash management program (discussed 
below).  Taxes have been eliminated from the analysis due to a tax sharing agreement among our primary subsidiaries resulting in a 
modest effect on net cash flows at the holding company.  Also excluded from this analysis is the modest amount of investment 
income on short-term investments of the holding company.  See “Part IV – Item 15(a)(2) Financial Statement Schedules – 
Schedule II – Condensed Financial Information of Registrant” for the parent company cash flow statement.   

Dividends from Subsidiaries 

Our insurance subsidiaries are subject to certain insurance department regulatory restrictions as to the transfer of funds and 
payment of dividends to the holding company.  Under Indiana laws and regulations, our Indiana insurance subsidiaries, including 
our primary insurance subsidiary, LNL, may pay dividends to LNC without prior approval of the Indiana Insurance Commissioner 
(the “Commissioner”) only from unassigned surplus or must receive prior approval of the Commissioner to pay a dividend if such 
dividend, along with all other dividends paid within the preceding 12 consecutive months, would exceed the statutory limitation.  
The current statutory limitation is the greater of 10% of the insurer’s contract holders’ surplus, as shown on its last annual 
statement on file with the Commissioner or the insurer’s statutory net gain from operations for the previous 12 months, but in no 
event to exceed statutory unassigned surplus.  As discussed in “Part I – Item 1. Business – Regulatory – Insurance Regulation” 
above, we may not consider the benefit from the statutory accounting principles relating to our insurance subsidiaries’ deferred tax 
assets in calculating available dividends.  Indiana law gives the Commissioner broad discretion to disapprove requests for dividends 
in excess of these limits.  New York, the state of domicile of our other major insurance subsidiary, Lincoln Life & Annuity 
Company of New York, has similar restrictions, except that in New York it is the lesser of 10% of surplus to contract holders as of 
the immediately preceding calendar year or net gain from operations for the immediately preceding calendar year, not including 
realized capital gains. 

We expect our domestic insurance subsidiaries could pay dividends of approximately $630 million in 2011 without prior approval 
from the respective state commissioners.  The amount of surplus that our insurance subsidiaries could pay as dividends is 
constrained by the amount of surplus we hold to maintain our ratings, to provide an additional layer of margin for risk protection 
and for future investment in our businesses.   

136 

  
 
 
                     
                     
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
                 
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
                     
 
 
 
 
 
We maintain an investment portfolio of various holdings, types and maturities.  These investments are subject to general credit, 
liquidity, market and interest rate risks.  An extended disruption in the credit and capital markets could adversely affect LNC and 
its subsidiaries’ ability to access sources of liquidity, and there can be no assurance that additional financing will be available to us 
on favorable terms, or at all, in the current market environment.  In addition, further OTTI could reduce our statutory surplus, 
leading to lower RBC ratios and potentially reducing future dividend capacity from our insurance subsidiaries. 

Subsidiaries’ Statutory Reserving and Surplus 

The RBC ratio is an important factor in the determination of the credit and financial strength ratings of LNC and its subsidiaries, 
as a reduction in our insurance subsidiaries’ surplus may affect their RBC ratios and dividend-paying capacity.  For a discussion of 
RBC ratios, see “Part I – Item 1. Business – Regulatory – Insurance Regulation – Risk-Based Capital.”    

Statutory reserves established for variable annuity contracts and riders are sensitive to changes in the equity markets and are 
affected by the level of account values relative to the level of any guarantees, product design and reinsurance arrangements.  As a 
result, the relationship between reserve changes and equity market performance is non-linear during any given reporting period. 
 Market conditions greatly influence the ultimate capital required due to its effect on the valuation of reserves and derivative assets 
hedging these reserves.  For example, if the level of the S&P 500 had been 10% lower as of December 31, 2010, we estimate that 
our RBC ratios would have declined by approximately 5% to 15% of RBC.  Likewise, if the level of the S&P 500 had been 10% 
higher as of December 31, 2010, we estimate that our capital would have increased by approximately 5% to 15% of RBC.  
However, the magnitude of such sensitivities could vary significantly depending on a variety of factors, including, but not limited 
to, contract holder activity, hedge positions, changes in interest rates and the rate or volatility of market movements.   

Changes in equity markets may also affect the capital position of our captive reinsurance subsidiaries based on their hedge position 
at the time.  We may decide to reallocate available capital between our insurance subsidiaries and captives, which would result in 
different RBC ratios for our insurance subsidiaries.  In addition, changes in the equity markets can affect the value of our variable 
annuity separate accounts.  When the market value of our separate account assets increases, the statutory surplus within our 
insurance subsidiaries also increases.  Contrarily, when the market value of our separate account assets decreases, the statutory 
surplus within our insurance subsidiaries may also decrease, which may affect RBC ratios, and in the case of our separate account 
assets becoming less than the related product liabilities, we must allocate additional capital to fund the difference.  

We continue to analyze the use of existing captive reinsurance structures, as well as additional third-party reinsurance arrangements, 
and our current hedging strategies relative to managing the effects of equity markets and interest rates on the statutory reserves, 
statutory capital and the dividend capacity of our life insurance subsidiaries.   

For discussion of our strategies to lessen the burden of increased AG38 and XXX statutory reserves associated with certain UL 
products and other products with secondary guarantees subject to these statutory reserving requirements on our insurance 
subsidiaries, see “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance – Income (Loss) from Operations – 
Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain.” 

Financing Activities 

Although our subsidiaries currently generate adequate cash flow to meet the needs of our normal operations, periodically we may 
issue debt or equity securities to maintain ratings and increase liquidity, as well as to fund internal growth, acquisitions and the 
retirement of our debt and equity securities.   

We currently have an effective shelf registration statement, which allows us to issue, in unlimited amounts, securities, including 
debt securities, preferred stock, common stock, warrants, stock purchase contracts, stock purchase units, depository shares and 
trust preferred securities of our affiliated trusts.   

On June 18, 2010, we closed on the issuance and sale of 14,137,615 shares of our common stock at a price to the public of $27.25 
per share and also completed the issuance and sale of $250 million aggregate principal amount of our 4.30% senior notes due 2015.  
We used the proceeds of these offerings along with cash at the holding company to redeem our Series B preferred stock that we 
had issued to the U.S. Treasury in connection with our participation in the CPP on June 30, 2010.  As a result of redeeming the 
preferred stock, we accelerated the remaining accretion of the preferred stock issuance discount of $131 million and recorded a 
corresponding charge to retained earnings and income (loss) available to common stockholders in the calculation of earnings (loss) 
per common share.   

In addition, we completed the issuance and sale of $500 million aggregate principal amount of our 7.00% senior notes due 2040, 
and we used the net proceeds from this offering as part of a long-term financing solution supporting the life reserves of certain UL 
products of our insurance subsidiaries.  See “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance – Income 
(Loss) from Operations – Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain” for more information.  The net proceeds from these 
offerings were $1.1 billion.  For more information about our debt issuances, see Note 13. 

137 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
On January 4, 2010, we closed on the sale of Delaware and received net of tax proceeds of approximately $405 million.  On 
October 1, 2009, we closed on the sale of Lincoln UK and received net of tax proceeds of $307 million.  As a result of post-closing 
adjustments related to this transaction, we received additional consideration of $18 million, net of tax, during the second quarter of 
2010.  For more information on the disposition of these businesses, see “Acquisitions and Dispositions” and Note 3.   

Details underlying debt and financing activities (in millions) were as follows: 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

    Change            

Beginning   
Balance 

in Fair 
    Ending 
Value 
Issuance     Repayments    Hedges     Changes (1)     Balance 

     Maturities     
and  

      Other 

Short-Term Debt  
Commercial paper (2) 
Current maturities of long-term debt (3) 
Other short-term debt (4) 
      Total short-term debt  

Long-Term Debt  
Senior notes  
Bank borrowing  
Federal Home Loan Bank of  
   Indianapolis ("FHLBI") advance  
Junior subordinated debentures  
   issued to affiliated trusts  
Capital securities  
      Total long-term debt  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 99     $ 
 250   
 1    
 350    $ 

 -      $ 
 -          
 -         
 -       $ 

 -     $ 

 (250)   
 -    
 (250)    $ 

 -       $ 
 -          
 -          
 -       $ 

 1     $ 

 250    
 -    
 251     $ 

 100 
 250 
 1 
 351 

 2,960    $ 
 200   

 749      $ 
 -          

 -      $ 
 -     

 1       $ 
 -          

 (246)    $ 
 -    

 3,464 
 200 

 250   

 -          

 -     

 -          

 -    

 250 

 155   
 1,485   
 5,050    $ 

 -          
 -          
 749      $ 

 (155)   
 -     
 (155)    $ 

 -          
 -          
 1       $ 

 -    
 -    
 (246)    $ 

 - 
 1,485 
 5,399 

(1) 

Includes the net increase (decrease) in commercial paper, non-cash reclassification of long-term debt to current maturities of 
long-term debt, accretion of discounts and (amortization) of premiums.  

(2)  During 2010, we had an average of $100 million outstanding, a maximum amount outstanding of $117 million at any time and 

a weighted average interest rate of 0.41%. 

(3)  As of December 31, 2010, consisted of a 6.20% fixed rate senior note that matures in less than one year.  As of December 31, 
2009, we reported $250 million in short-term debt that consisted of a floating rate senior note that matured on March 12, 2010 
(see below for discussion of our funding the maturity of this note). 

(4)  Consisted of advances from the FHLBI with a maturity of less than one year when made.  During 2010, we had an average 

and maximum amount outstanding of $1 million and a weighted average interest rate of 0.56%. 

On December 15, 2010, we redeemed the aggregate principal amount of our junior subordinated debentures issued to affiliated 
trusts of $155 million.  For more information, see our Form 8-K filed on November 18, 2010, and Note 13. 

On March 12, 2010, we funded the maturity of a $250 million floating rate senior note with the majority of our proceeds from our 
$300 million 6.25% senior offering in December 2009.  Within the next two years, we have a $250 million 6.20% fixed rate senior 
note maturing on December 15, 2011, and a $300 million 5.65% fixed rate senior note maturing on August 27, 2012.  The specific 
resources or combination of resources that we will use to meet these maturities will depend upon, among other things, the financial 
market conditions present at the time of maturity.  As of December 31, 2010, the holding company had $582 million in cash and 
cash equivalents; however, as discussed below, it had a $174 million receivable under the inter-company cash management 
program, partially offset by commercial paper outstanding of $100 million. 

We have not accounted for repurchase agreements, securities lending transactions, or other transactions involving the transfer of 
financial assets with an obligation to repurchase the transferred assets as sales and do have any other transactions involving the 
transfer of financial assets with an obligation to repurchase the transferred assets.  For information about our collateralized 
financing transactions on our investments, see “Payables for Collateral on Investments” in Note 5. 

138 

  
 
 
 
                  
                  
    
  
    
       
  
    
    
                     
  
  
  
    
        
  
   
  
  
                  
     
    
   
                     
  
    
  
    
          
    
    
          
    
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
         
    
  
         
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
         
    
  
         
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
         
    
  
         
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
Details underlying our credit facilities with a group of domestic and foreign banks (in millions) were as follows:  

Credit Facilities  
Credit facility with the FHLBI (1) 
364-day revolving credit facility  
Four-year revolving credit facility  
Ten-year LOC facility  
   Total  

As of December 31, 2010 

Expiration     Maximum     Borrowings 
   Available  Outstanding 

Date 

LOCs 
Issued 

N/A 
Jun-2011 
Jun-2014 
Dec-2019 

   $ 

   $ 

 630       $ 
 500         
 1,500         
 550         
 3,180       $ 

 350   
 -    
 -    
 -    
 350    $ 

N/A  
 -   
 1,498   
 550   
 2,048   

(1)  We are allowed to borrow up to 20 times the amount of our common stock investment in the FHLBI.  All borrowings from 

the FHLBI are required to be secured by certain investments owned by LNL.  Our borrowing capacity under this credit facility 
does not have an expiration date and continues while our investment in the FHLBI common stock remains outstanding as 
long as LNL maintains a satisfactory level of creditworthiness and does not incur a material adverse change in its financial, 
business, regulatory or other areas that would materially affect its operations and viability.  As of December 31, 2010, we had a 
$250 million floating-rate term loan outstanding under the facility (classified within long-term debt on our Consolidated 
Balance Sheets) due June 20, 2017, which may be prepaid at any time.  We also borrowed $100 million under the facility 
(classified within payables for collateral on investments on our Consolidated Balance Sheets) at a rate of 0.65% that is due May 
25, 2011. 

Effective June 9, 2010, we entered into two revolving credit facilities with a syndicate of banks.  One agreement (the “Four-Year 
Agreement”) allows for issuance of LOCs, as well as borrowings to finance any draws under the LOCs.  The Four-Year Agreement 
is unsecured and has a commitment termination date of June 9, 2014.  The Four-Year Agreement must be used primarily to 
provide LOCs in support of certain life insurance reserves.  The second agreement (the “364-Day Agreement,” and together with 
the “Four-Year Agreement” the “credit facility”) allows for borrowing or issuance of LOCs and may be used for general corporate 
purposes.  The 364-Day Agreement is unsecured and has a commitment termination date of June 8, 2011.  LOCs issued under the 
credit facility may remain outstanding for one year following the applicable commitment termination date of each agreement.  The 
LOCs support inter-company reinsurance transactions and specific treaties associated with our business sold through reinsurance.  
LOCs are used primarily to satisfy the state regulatory requirements of our domestic insurance companies for which reserve credit 
is provided by our affiliated reinsurance companies, as discussed above in “Results of Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – 
Life Insurance – Income (Loss) from Operations – Strategies to Address Statutory Reserve Strain,” and our domestic clients of the 
business sold through reinsurance. 

The credit facility contains customary terms and conditions, including covenants restricting our ability to incur liens, merge or 
consolidate with another entity where we are not the surviving entity and dispose of all or substantially all of our assets.  The credit 
facility also includes financial covenants including:  maintenance of a minimum consolidated net worth (as defined in the facility) 
equal to the sum of $9.2 billion plus fifty percent (50%) of the aggregate net proceeds of equity issuances received by us in 
accordance with the terms of the credit facility (other than net proceeds used to repay investments to the U.S. Treasury under the 
CPP); and a debt-to-capital ratio as defined in accordance with the credit facility not to exceed 0.35 to 1.00.  Further, the credit 
facility contains customary events of default, subject to certain materiality thresholds and grace periods for certain of those events 
of default.  The events of default include payment defaults, covenant defaults, material inaccuracies in representations and 
warranties, certain cross-defaults, bankruptcy and liquidation proceedings and other customary defaults.  Upon an event of default, 
the credit facility provides that, among other things, the commitments may be terminated and the loans then outstanding may be 
declared due and payable.  As of December 31, 2010, we were in compliance with all such covenants. 

On December 31, 2009, LNC and certain of its subsidiaries entered into a reimbursement agreement with a third-party lender.  
Under this agreement, the lender issued a $550 million 10-year irrevocable LOC for the benefit of our primary insurance subsidiary, 
LNL.  The LOC supports an inter-company reinsurance agreement on term life insurance business.  Pursuant to the terms of the 
reimbursement agreement, in the event amounts are drawn under the LOC by LNL, certain of our subsidiaries would be obligated 
to reimburse the lender for the amount of any such drawn amount (including interest thereon).  Neither LNC nor LNL is liable to 
the lender to reimburse any drawn amounts (or interest thereon); however, LNC has agreed, pursuant to the terms of a fee letter 
with the lender, to be liable with certain of our subsidiaries for the payment of LOC fees.  For more information, see “Results of 
Insurance Solutions – Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance – Income (Loss) from Operations – Strategies to Address Statutory 
Reserve Strain” and our Form 8-K filed on January 7, 2010. 

If current debt ratings and claims-paying ratings were downgraded in the future, terms in our derivative agreements may be 
triggered, which could negatively affect overall liquidity.  For the majority of our counterparties, there is a termination event should 

139 

  
 
 
            
  
  
  
            
  
            
  
  
  
    
         
  
    
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
the long-term senior debt ratings of LNC drop below BBB-/Baa3 (S&P/Moody’s).  Our long-term senior debt held a rating of A-
/Baa2 (S&P/Moody’s) as of December 31, 2010.  In addition, contractual selling agreements with intermediaries could be 
negatively affected, which could have an adverse effect on overall sales of annuities, life insurance and investment products.  See 
“Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – A decrease in the capital and surplus of our insurance subsidiaries may result in a downgrade to 
our credit and insurer financial strength ratings” and “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – A downgrade in our financial strength or 
credit ratings could limit our ability to market products, increase the number or value of policies being surrendered and/or hurt our 
relationships with creditors” for more information.  See “Part I – Item 1. Business – Ratings” for additional information on our 
current bond ratings.  

Management monitors the covenants associated with LNC’s capital securities.  If we fail to meet capital adequacy or net income 
and stockholders’ equity levels (also referred to as “trigger events”), terms in the agreements may be triggered, which would require 
us to make interest payments in accordance with an alternative coupon satisfaction mechanism (“ACSM”).  This would require us 
to use commercially reasonable efforts to pay interest in full on the capital securities with the net proceeds from sales of our 
common stock and warrants to purchase our common stock with an exercise price greater than the market price.  We would have 
to utilize the ACSM until the trigger events above no longer existed.  If we were required to utilize the ACSM and were successful 
in selling sufficient shares of common stock or warrants to satisfy the interest payment, we would dilute the current holders of our 
common stock.  Furthermore, while a trigger event is occurring and if we do not pay accrued interest in full, we may not, among 
other things, pay dividends on or repurchase our capital stock.  We have not triggered either the net income test or the overall 
stockholders’ equity test looking forward to the quarters ending March 31, 2011, and June 30, 2011.  For more information, see 
“Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – We will be required to pay interest on our capital securities with proceeds from the issuance of 
qualifying securities if we fail to achieve capital adequacy or net income and stockholders’ equity levels.” 

Alternative Sources of Liquidity 

In order to manage our capital more efficiently, we have an inter-company cash management program where certain subsidiaries 
can lend to or borrow from the holding company to meet short-term borrowing needs.  The cash management program is 
essentially a series of demand loans, which are permitted under applicable insurance laws, among LNC and its affiliates that reduces 
overall borrowing costs by allowing LNC and its subsidiaries to access internal resources instead of incurring third-party 
transaction costs.  For our Indiana-domiciled insurance subsidiaries, the borrowing and lending limit is currently the lesser of 3% 
of the insurance company’s admitted assets and 25% of its surplus, in both cases, as of its most recent year end. 

The holding company did not borrow from the cash management program during 2010.  There was no balance as of December 31, 
2010.  In addition, the holding company had an outstanding receivable of $174 million from certain subsidiaries resulting from 
funds borrowed by the subsidiaries in excess of amounts placed by those subsidiaries in the inter-company cash management 
account as of December 31, 2010.  Any increase (decrease) in either of these holding company cash management program payable 
balances results in an immediate and equal increase (decrease) to holding company cash and cash equivalents.  

Our insurance subsidiaries, by virtue of their general account fixed income investment holdings, can access liquidity through 
securities lending programs and repurchase agreements.  As of December 31, 2010, our insurance subsidiaries had securities with a 
carrying value of $199 million out on loan under the securities lending program and $280 million carrying value subject to reverse-
repurchase agreements.  The cash received in our securities lending program is typically invested in cash equivalents, short-term 
investments or fixed maturity securities. 

For factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk 
Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above. 

Divestitures 

For a discussion of our divestitures, see “Part I – Item 1. Business – Acquisitions and Dispositions,” “Acquisitions and 
Dispositions” and Note 3. 

Uses of Capital 

Our principal uses of cash are to pay policy claims and benefits, operating expenses, commissions and taxes, to purchase new 
investments, to purchase reinsurance, to fund policy surrenders and withdrawals, to pay dividends to our stockholders and to 
repurchase our stock and debt securities.  

Return of Capital to Common Stockholders  

One of the Company’s primary goals is to provide a return to our common stockholders through share price accretion, dividends 
and stock repurchases.  In determining dividends, the Board takes into consideration items such as current and expected earnings, 
capital needs, rating agency considerations and requirements for financial flexibility.   

140 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Details underlying this activity (in millions, except per share data), were as follows: 

For the Years Ended December 31,      Change Over Prior Year 
2008  
2010  

2009  

2010  

2009  

Common dividends to stockholders 
Repurchase and cancellation of common stock 
   warrants 
Repurchase of common stock 

      Total cash returned to stockholders 

Number of shares issued 
Average price per share 

Number of shares repurchased 
Average price per share 

$ 

 12    $ 

 62     $ 

 429   

-81%  

-86%

 48   
 25   

 -    
 -    

 85    $ 

 62     $ 

 14.138   
 26.09    $ 

 46.000   
 14.34     $ 

 -    
 476   

 905   

 -    
 -    

 1.048   
 23.87    $ 

 -    
 -     $ 

 9.091   
 52.31   

$ 

$ 

$ 

NM  
NM  

37%  

-70%  
86%  

NM  
NM  

NM
-100%

-93%

NM
NM

-100%
-100%

Note:  Average price per share is calculated using whole dollars instead of dollars rounded to millions. 

On September 22, 2010, the U.S. Treasury closed an underwritten secondary public offering of 13,049,451 warrants issued in 
connection with our participation in the CPP, each representing the right to purchase one share of our common stock, no par 
value per share.  The warrants have an exercise price of $10.91, subject to adjustment, and expire on July 10, 2019, and are listed on 
the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “LNC WS.”  We did not receive any of the proceeds of the warrant offering; 
however, we paid $48 million to purchase 2,899,159 warrants at auction, which were subsequently canceled. 

On November 11, 2010, our Board of Directors approved an increase of the dividend on our common stock from $0.01 to $0.05 
per share.  Additionally, on November 11, 2010, we announced our plan to repurchase up to $125 million of common stock under 
our security repurchase authorization.  During 2010, we repurchased 1,048,289 shares at an average price of $23.87 for a total cost 
of $25 million.   

Other Uses of Capital 

In addition to the amounts in the table above in “Return of Capital to Common Stockholders,” other uses of holding company 
cash flow (in millions) were as follows: 

Debt service (interest paid) 
Capital contribution to subsidiaries 
   Total 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

   Change Over Prior Year 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 281    $ 
 125   
 406    $ 

 241    $ 

 1,260   
 1,501    $ 

 280   
 -    
 280   

17%  
-90%  
-73%  

-14%
NM
NM

The above table focuses on significant and recurring cash flow items and excludes the effects of certain financing activities, namely 
the periodic retirement of debt and cash flows related to our inter-company cash management account.  Taxes have been 
eliminated from the analysis due to a tax sharing agreement among our primary subsidiaries resulting in a modest effect on net cash 
flows at the holding company. 

141 

  
 
 
                 
                 
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Contractual Obligations 

Details underlying our future estimated cash payments for our contractual obligations (in millions) as of December 31, 2010, were 
as follows: 

Future contract benefits and other  
   contract holder obligations (1) 
Short-term debt  
Long-term debt (2) 
Reverse repurchase agreements  
Operating leases  
Stadium naming rights (3) 
Outsourcing arrangements (4) 
Retirement and other plans (5) 

      Totals  

Less 
Than 
1 Year 

1 - 3 
   Years 

3 - 5 
   Years 

More 
   Than 
   5 Years 

   Total 

$ 

 14,974    $ 
 351   
 250   
 281   
 40   
 6    
 12   
 86   

 28,470    $ 
 -    
 500   
 -    
 66    
 14    
 5    
 180   

 24,818    $ 
 -   
 750   
 -   
 41   
 14   
 3   
 182   

 83,848    $   152,110 
 351 
 5,614 
 281 
 211 
 88 
 20 
 917 

 -   
 4,114   
 -   
 64   
 54   
 -   
 469   

$ 

 16,000    $ 

 29,235    $ 

 25,808    $ 

 88,549    $   159,592 

(1) 

(2) 

(3) 
(4) 
(5) 

Includes various investment-type products with contractually scheduled maturities including single premium immediate 
annuities, group pension annuities, guaranteed interest contracts, structured settlements, pension closeouts and certain annuity 
contracts.  Future contract benefits and other contract holder obligations also include benefit and claim liabilities, of which a 
significant portion represents policies and contracts that do not have stated contractual maturity dates and may not result in 
any future payment obligation.  For these policies and contracts, we are not currently making payments and will not make 
payments in the future until the occurrence of an insurable event, such as death or disability; or the occurrence of a payment 
triggering event, such as a surrender of a policy or contract, which is outside of our control.  We have made significant 
assumptions to determine the estimated undiscounted cash flows of these policies and contracts, which include mortality, 
morbidity, future lapse rates and interest crediting rates.  Future contract benefits and other contract holder obligations have 
been calculated using a discount rate of 6%.  Due to the significance of the assumptions used, the amounts presented could 
materially differ from actual results.   
Includes the maturities of the principal amounts of long-term debt, but excludes other items such as unamortized premiums 
and discounts and fair value hedges, which are included in long-term debt on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  
Includes a maximum annual increase related to the Consumer Price Index. 
Includes an information technology agreement and certain other outsourcing arrangements. 
Includes anticipated funding for benefit payments for our retirement and postretirement plans through 2020 and known 
payments under deferred compensation arrangements.  

In addition to the contractual commitments outlined in the table above, we periodically fund the employees’ defined benefit plans, 
discussed in “Defined Benefit Contributions” below. 

Due to the uncertainty with respect to the timing of future cash flows associated with our unrecognized tax benefits as of 
December 31, 2010, we are unable to make reasonably reliable estimates of the period of cash settlement with the respective taxing 
authority.  Therefore, $401 million of unrecognized tax benefits and its associated interest have been excluded from the contractual 
obligations table above.  See Note 7 for additional information. 

142 

  
 
 
 
            
  
     
  
    
  
  
     
            
  
  
     
  
            
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
Contingencies and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements  

We do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements that are reasonably likely to have a material effect on our financial condition, 
results of operations, liquidity or capital resources.  Details underlying our contingent commitments and off-balance sheet 
arrangements (in millions) as of December 31, 2010, were as follows: 

Amount of Commitment Expiring per Period 
After 
   5 Years 

3 - 5 
   Years 

1 - 3 
   Years 

Less Than   
1 Year 

      Total 
      Amount 
   Committed 

Bank lines of credit  
Investment commitments  
Standby commitments to purchase real  
   estate upon completion and leasing (1) 
Media commitments (2) 
      Total  

$ 

$ 

 500    $ 
 616   

 -    $ 

 189   

 1,500    $ 
 49   

 830      $ 
 -         

 2,830   
 854   

 53    
 15    
 1,184    $ 

 -   
 16   
 205    $ 

 -    
 -    
 1,549    $ 

 -         
 -         
 830      $ 

 53   
 31   
 3,768   

(1)  See “Consolidated Investments – Standby Real Estate Equity Commitments” above for additional information. 
(2)  Consists primarily of employment contracts and rating service contracts. 

Defined Benefit Contributions 

We contributed $31 million, $11 million and $14 million in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, to U.S. pension plans; less than $1 
million, $44 million and $2 million in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, to our U.K. pension plan; and $15 million, $16 million and 
$15 million in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, to our postretirement plan that provides medical, dental and life insurance 
benefits.  Our U.S. defined benefit pension plans were frozen as of December 31, 2007, or earlier; and our non-U.S. defined 
benefit pension plan was frozen as of September 30, 2009.  For our frozen plans, there are no new participants and no future 
accruals of benefits from the date of the freeze.   

Based on our calculations, we do not expect to be required to make any contributions to our qualified pension plans in 2011 under 
applicable pension law; however, we analyze and review opportunities to make contributions in excess of those required under 
applicable pension law.  Such excess contributions will be made from time to time if, based on our analysis, we believe that the 
excess contributions serve the best interests of both the Company and of plan participants.  

We expect to fund approximately $10 million to our nonqualified U.S. defined benefit plan and $10 million to our postretirement 
benefit plans during 2011.  These amounts include anticipated benefit payments for nonqualified plans.   

The majority of contributions and benefit payments are made by our insurance subsidiaries with little holding company cash flow 
affects.  See Note 18 for additional information.  

Significant Trends in Sources and Uses of Cash Flow 

As stated above, LNC’s cash flow, as a holding company, is largely dependent upon the dividend capacity of its insurance company 
subsidiaries as well as their ability to advance funds to it through inter-company borrowing arrangements, which may be affected 
by factors influencing the insurance subsidiaries’ RBC and statutory earnings performance.  We currently expect to be able to meet 
the holding company’s ongoing cash needs and to have sufficient capital to offer downside protection in the event that the capital 
and credit markets experience another period of extreme volatility and disruption.  A decline in capital market conditions, which 
reduces our insurance subsidiaries’ statutory surplus and RBC, may require them to retain more capital and may pressure our 
subsidiaries’ dividends to the holding company, which may lead us to take steps to preserve or raise additional capital.  For factors 
that could affect our expectations for liquidity and capital, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors.” 

143 

  
 
  
 
            
 
            
  
  
 
            
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
          
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Factors Affecting Our Business 

OTHER MATTERS 

In general, our businesses are subject to a changing social, economic, legal, legislative and regulatory environment.  Some of the 
changes include initiatives to require more reserves to be carried by our insurance subsidiaries.  Although the eventual effect on us 
of the changing environment in which we operate remains uncertain, these factors and others could have a material effect on our 
results of operations, liquidity and capital resources.  For factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those set 
forth in this section, see “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors” and “Forward-Looking Statements – Cautionary Language” above. 

Recent Accounting Pronouncements 

See Note 2 for a discussion of recent accounting pronouncements that have been implemented during the periods presented or 
that have been issued and are to be implemented in the future. 

Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk  

We analyze and manage the risks arising from market exposures of financial instruments, as well as other risks, in an integrated 
asset-liability management process that takes diversification into account.  By aggregating the potential effect of market and other 
risks on the entire enterprise, we estimate, review and in some cases manage the risk to our earnings and shareholder value.   We 
have exposures to several market risks including interest rate risk, foreign currency exchange risk, equity market risk, default risk, 
basis  risk  and credit  risk.   The exposures  of  financial  instruments to  market  risks, and  the  related  risk management  process,  are 
most  important  to  our  Retirement  Solutions  and  Insurance  Solutions  businesses,  where  most  of  the  invested  assets  support 
accumulation and investment-oriented insurance products.  As an important element of our integrated asset-liability management 
process, we use derivatives to minimize the effects of changes in interest levels, the shape of the yield curve, currency movements 
and volatility.  In this context, derivatives are designated as a hedge and serve to minimize interest rate risk by mitigating the effect 
of significant increases in interest rates on our earnings.  Additional market exposures exist in our other general account insurance 
products and in our debt structure and derivatives positions.  Our primary sources of market risk are:   substantial, relatively rapid 
and  sustained  increases  or  decreases  in  interest  rates;  fluctuations  in  currency  exchange  rates;  or  a  sharp  drop  in  equity  market 
values.  These market risks are discussed in detail in the following pages and should be read in conjunction with, our consolidated 
financial statements and the accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements (“Notes”) presented in “Part II – Item 8.  
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data,” as well as “Part II – Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial 
Condition and Results of Operations (“MD&A”).” 

Interest Rate Risk   

With respect to accumulation and investment-oriented products, we seek to earn a stable and profitable spread, or margin, between 
investment income we earn on our invested assets and interest credited to account values of our contract holders.  If we have 
adverse experience on investments that cannot be passed on to customers, our spreads are reduced.  Provided investment yields 
and default experience continue to gradually return to levels that are more typical from a long-term perspective, we do not view the 
near term risk to spreads over the next twelve months to be material.  The combination of a probable range of interest rate changes 
over the next twelve months, asset-liability management strategies, flexibility in adjusting policy crediting rate levels and protection 
afforded by policy surrender charges and other switching costs all work together to mitigate this risk.  The interest rate scenarios of 
concern are those in which there is a substantial, relatively prolonged decrease in interest rates that is sustained over a long period 
or a rapid increase in interest rates.  

144 

  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Significant Interest Rate Exposures 

The following provides a general measure of our significant interest rate risk; amounts are shown by year of maturity and include 
amortization of premiums and discounts; interest rate cap agreements notional amounts are shown by amount outstanding (dollars 
in millions) as of December 31, 2010:  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

Rate Sensitive Assets  
Fixed interest rate securities  
Average interest rate  
Variable interest rate securities   $ 
Average interest rate  
Mortgage loans  
Average interest rate  
Rate Sensitive Liabilities  
Investment type   
   insurance contracts (1) 
Average interest rate (1) 
Debt   
Average interest rate  
Rate Sensitive Derivative   
   Financial Instruments  
Interest rate and foreign  
   currency swaps:  
      Pay variable/receive fixed   $ 
      Average pay rate  
      Average receive rate  
      Pay fixed/receive variable   $ 
      Average pay rate  
      Average receive rate  
Interest rate cap agreements:  
      Contractual notional  
      Average strike rate (2) 
      Forward CMT curve (3) 
Interest rate futures:  
      2-year treasury notes   
         contractual notional  
      5-year treasury notes  
         contractual notional  
      10-year treasury notes  
         contractual notional  
      Treasury bonds  
         contractual notional  

$ 

$ 

2011  

2012  

2013  

2014  

2015  

Thereafter 

Total 

   Estimated 
  Fair Value 

 2,446    $ 
6.1%  

 2,764    $ 
5.8%  

 70    $ 

0.6%  
 286    $ 
7.6%  

 47    $ 

7.5%  
 332    $ 
6.9%  

 3,391    $ 
5.7%  
 132    $ 
5.1%  
 403    $ 
6.2%  

 3,486    $ 
6.1%  
 236    $ 
3.6%  
 443    $ 
6.2%  

 2,912    $ 
5.4%  

 89    $ 

7.4%  
 659    $ 
6.1%  

 48,992    $ 
5.8%  
 4,540    $ 
4.5%  
 4,622    $ 
6.3%  

 63,991    $ 
5.8%  
 5,114    $ 
4.5%  
 6,745    $ 
6.3%  

 67,021 

 4,187 

 7,183 

 1,411    $ 
6.1%  
 351    $ 
4.6%  

 1,518    $ 
5.9%  
 300    $ 
5.7%  

 1,852    $ 
5.8%  
 200    $ 
2.0%  

 2,225    $ 
5.9%  
 500    $ 
4.8%  

 1,752    $ 
5.5%  
 250    $ 
4.3%  

 19,329    $ 
5.7%  
 4,114    $ 
6.5%  

 28,087    $ 
5.7%  
 5,715    $ 
5.9%  

 29,166 

 5,876 

 24    $ 

0.7%  
4.5%  
 203    $ 
4.0%  
0.3%  

 150    $ 
7.0%  
3.4%  

 300    $ 
4.2%  
5.7%  
 583    $ 
3.4%  
0.3%  

 45    $ 

1.0%  
5.6%  
 473    $ 
2.8%  
0.3%  

 500    $ 
2.5%  
4.8%  
 503    $ 
3.4%  
0.3%  

 85    $ 

1.0%  
2.9%  
 214    $ 
4.4%  
0.3%  

 5,085    $ 
0.8%  
4.0%  
 2,691    $ 
4.6%  
0.6%  

 6,039    $ 
1.1%  
4.2%  
 4,667    $ 
4.1%  
0.5%  

 -    $ 

 -    $ 

 -    $ 

 -    $ 

0.0%  
0.0%  

0.0%  
0.0%  

0.0%  
0.0%  

0.0%  
0.0%  

 8,050    $ 
7.8%  
5.0%  

 8,200    $ 
7.8%  
5.0%  

 740    $ 

 -    $ 

 -    $ 

 -    $ 

 -    $ 

 -    $ 

 740    $ 

 341   

 247   

 924   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 -   

 341   

 247   

 924   

 (106)

 (362)

 51 

 - 

 - 

 - 

 - 

(1)  The information shown is for our fixed maturity securities and mortgage loans on real estate that support these insurance 

contracts.  

(2)  The indexes are the seven-year constant maturity swap.  
(3)  The constant maturity treasury (“CMT”) curve is the seven-year CMT forward curve.  

145 

  
 
 
 
                 
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
                  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The following provides the principal amounts and estimated fair values of assets, liabilities and derivatives (in millions) having 
significant interest rate risks as of December 31, 2009: 

Fixed interest rate securities  
Variable interest rate securities  
Mortgage loans on real estate  
Investment type insurance contracts (1) 
Debt   
Interest rate and foreign currency swaps  

Principal     Estimated    
     Fair Value      
Amount 

$ 

 58,767      $ 
 6,019        
 7,172       
 26,538        
 5,368       
 7,228        

 58,984 
 4,337 
 7,316 
 26,319 
 5,108 
 (253)    

(1)  The information shown is for our fixed maturity securities and mortgage loans on real estate that support these insurance 

contracts.  

Interest Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Falling Rates 

In periods of declining interest rates, we have to reinvest the cash we receive as interest or return of principal on our investments 
in lower yielding instruments.  Moreover, borrowers may prepay fixed income securities, commercial mortgages and mortgage-
backed securities in our general accounts in order to borrow at lower market rates, which exacerbate this risk.  Because we are 
entitled to reset the interest rates on our fixed rate annuities only at limited, pre-established intervals, and because many of our 
contracts have guaranteed minimum interest or crediting rates, our spreads could decrease and potentially become negative.   

Prolonged historically low rates are not healthy for our business fundamentals.  However, we have recognized this threat and have 
been proactive in our investment strategies, product designs, crediting rate strategies and overall asset-liability practices to mitigate 
the risk of unfavorable consequences in this type of environment.  For some time now, new products have been sold with low 
minimum crediting floors, and we apply disciplined asset-liability management standards, such as locking in spreads on these 
products at the time of issue.  In addition, interest rates have recently been on the rise. 

The following summarizes solely a hypothetical significant unfavorable stress scenario to earnings if new money rates, currently 
averaging approximately 50 to 75 basis points below our portfolio yields, remain in place through 2012 as opposed to a scenario 
that we would expect to occur.  This scenario is simply an illustration of the sensitivity to our earnings if such a stress scenario were 
to happen: 

(cid:2) 

(cid:2) 

Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance – The stress on earnings has been mitigated by proactive strategies to lock in long-
dated and high-yielding assets.  We executed on strategies which allowed us to effectively pre-buy assets in anticipation of 
future flows and maturing securities.  We have also taken actions on crediting rates.  We estimate the spread compression 
would have no effect on 2011 earnings and would unfavorably affect earnings by approximately $15 million during 2012 and 
$30 million during 2013.  We pursue proactive strategies to lock-in long-dated and high-yielding assets to manage this risk.  
Our methodology assumes that new money rates grade from current levels to a long-term yield assumption over time.  During 
the third quarter of 2010, we lowered our new money investment yield assumption to reflect the then current new money rates 
and to approximate the forward curve for interest rates relevant at such time.  The result was a drop in the current new money 
investment rate followed by a gradual annual recovery over eight years to a rate of 6.31%, 54 basis points below our previous 
ultimate long-term assumption of 6.85%.  As a result, we recorded a prospective unlocking, as discussed in “Critical 
Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” and “Results of Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance” in 
the MD&A.  

(cid:2)  Retirement Solutions – The earnings drag from spread compression is modest and largely concentrated in our Defined 

Contribution segment, which is a function of this segment having higher guaranteed crediting rates and recurring premiums.  
We estimate that this scenario would have an approximate unfavorable earnings effect in a range of $0 to $5 million during 
2011, $0 to $5 million during 2012 and $5 million to $10 million during 2013.  Since we currently have the ability to manage 
spread compression through credit rate actions, our Annuities business is not currently sensitive to spread compression so 
there is very little effect estimated.  The risk for our Annuities business is sensitivity to sharp rising rates and we manage this 
risk by selling market value adjusted product and through purchase of derivative protection. 
Insurance Solutions – Group Protection – The earnings effect is minimal as we reviewed the discount rate assumptions 
associated with our long-term disability claim reserves during the third quarter of 2010, which resulted in lowering the discount 
rate by 25 basis points and decreasing income from operations by $2 million.  Spread compression would unfavorably affect 
annualized earnings by up to $5 million during 2011. 

(cid:2)  Other Operations – We may also be affected by sensitivity to our exposures in our institutional pension and disability run-off 

blocks of business that are sensitive to interest rates and could contribute to an effect. 

146 

  
 
 
  
   
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
The estimates above are based upon a hypothetical stressed scenario and are only representative of the effects of new money rates 
remaining in place through 2012 keeping all else equal and does not give consideration to the aggregate effect of other factors, 
including but not limited to:  contract holder activity; hedge positions; changing equity markets; shifts in implied volatilities; and 
changes in other capital market sectors.  In addition, the scenario only illustrated the effect to spreads and certain unlocking and 
reserve changes.  Minimum guaranteed rates on annuity and universal life (“UL”) policies generally range from 0.6% to 5.0%.  
Other potential effects of the scenario were not considered in the analysis.  See “Part I – Item 1A. Risk Factors – Changes in 
interest rates and sustained low interest rates may cause interest rate spreads to decrease and changes in interest rates may also 
result in increased contract withdrawals” for additional information on interest rates.   

The following provides detail on the percentage differences between the December 31, 2010, interest rates being credited to 
contract holders based on fourth quarter of 2010 declared rates and the respective minimum guaranteed policy rate (dollars in 
millions), broken out by contract holder account values reported within the Retirement Solutions and Insurance Solutions 
businesses: 

Retirement Solutions 
      Defined 

Account Values 
     Insurance          
     Solutions -          
Life  

Annuities    Contribution  Insurance (1)     Total 

%  

   Account 
   Values 

Excess of Crediting Rates over Contract Minimums  
Discretionary rate setting products (2)(3) 
   No difference  
   up to 0.10%  
   0.11% to 0.20%  
   0.21% to 0.30%  
   0.31% to 0.40%  
   0.41% to 0.50%  
   0.51% to 0.60%  
   0.61% to 0.70%  
   0.71% to 0.80%  
   0.81% to 0.90%  
   0.91% to 1.00%  
   1.01% to 1.50%  
   1.51% to 2.00%  
   2.01% to 2.50%  
   2.51% to 3.00%  
   3.01% and above  
      Total discretionary rate setting products   
Other contracts (4) 
         Total account values  

$ 

$ 

Percentage of discretionary rate setting product account  
   values at minimum guaranteed rates  

 4,823      $ 
 66     
 22     
 252     
 16     
 39     
 64     
 13     
 41     
 10     
 33     
 537     
 329     
 206     
 43     
 8      
 6,502     
 14,450     
 20,952      $ 

   $ 

    $ 

 8,891 
 29 
 7         
 23 
 1         
 2         
 -         

 176 

 -         
 -         

 275 
 92 
 6         

 22,707 
 567 
 153 
 186 
 390 
 700 
 698 
 437 
 304 
 272 
 137 
 440 
 51 

 148 
 18 
 19 
 9,687 
 3,092 
 12,779 

 -     

 110 

 -     

 27,152 

 -     

    $ 

 27,152 

   $ 

 36,421   
 662   
 182   
 461   
 407   
 741   
 762   
 626   
 345   
 282   
 445   
 1,069   
 386   
 354   
 171   
 27   
 43,341   
 17,542   
 60,883   

74.2%     

91.8%         

83.6%      

84.0%  

59.7%
1.1%
0.3%
0.8%
0.7%
1.2%
1.3%
1.0%
0.6%
0.5%
0.7%
1.8%
0.6%
0.6%
0.3%
0.0%
71.2%
28.8%
100.0%

(1)  Excludes policy loans. 
(2)  Contracts currently within new money rate bands are grouped according to the corresponding portfolio rate band in which 

they will fall upon their first anniversary.  

(3)  The average crediting rates in excess of average minimum guaranteed rates for our Annuities, Defined Contribution and Life 

(4) 

Insurance segments were 32 basis points, 10 basis points and 11 basis points, respectively. 
Includes multi-year guarantee annuities, indexed annuities, modified guarantee annuities, single premium immediate annuities, 
dollar cost averaging contracts and indexed-based rate setting products for our Defined Contribution segment.  The average 
crediting rates in excess of average minimum guaranteed rates for indexed-based rate setting products within our Defined 
Contribution segment was 36 basis points, and 47% of account values were already at their minimum guaranteed rates. 

147 

  
 
 
 
                  
                  
  
  
        
  
  
  
  
                  
  
  
                     
  
  
     
        
  
                    
  
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
  
  
    
    
    
          
     
    
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
      
  
  
  
  
      
  
    
    
    
          
     
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The maturity structure and call provisions of the related portfolios are structured to afford protection against erosion of investment 
portfolio yields during periods of declining interest rates.  We devote extensive effort to evaluating the risks associated with falling 
interest rates by simulating asset and liability cash flows for a wide range of interest rate scenarios.  We seek to manage these 
exposures by maintaining a suitable maturity structure and by limiting our exposure to call risk in each respective investment 
portfolio. 

Interest Rate Risk on Fixed Insurance Businesses – Rising Rates 

For both annuities and UL, a rapid rise in interest rates poses risks of deteriorating spreads and high surrenders.  The portfolios 
supporting these products have fixed-rate assets laddered over maturities generally ranging from 1 to 10 years or more.  
Accordingly, the earned rate on each portfolio lags behind changes in market yields.  As rates rise, the lag may be increased by 
slowing mortgage-backed securities prepayments.  The greater and faster the rise in interest rates, the more the earned rate will tend 
to lag behind market rates.  If we set renewal crediting rates to earn the desired spread, the gap between our renewal crediting rates 
and competitors’ new money rates may be wide enough to cause increased surrenders that could cause us to liquidate a portion of 
our portfolio to fund these surrenders.  If we credit more competitive renewal rates to limit surrenders, our spreads will narrow.  
We devote extensive effort to evaluating these risks by simulating asset and liability cash flows for a wide range of interest rate 
scenarios.  Such analysis has led to adjustments in the target maturity structure and to hedging the risk of rising rates by buying out-
of-the-money interest rate cap agreements and swaptions.  With these instruments in place, the potential adverse effect of a rapid 
and sustained rise in rates is kept within our risk tolerances.   

Debt   

We manage the timing of maturities and the mixture of fixed-rate and floating-rate debt as part of the process of integrated 
management of interest rate risk for the entire enterprise.  See Note 13 for additional information on our debt. 

Derivatives 

We have entered into derivative transactions to hedge our exposure to rapid changes in interest rates.  The derivative programs are 
used to help us achieve somewhat stable margins while providing competitive crediting rates to contract holders during periods 
when interest rates are changing.  Such derivatives include interest rate swap agreements, interest rate futures, interest rate cap 
agreements, forward-starting interest rate swaps, consumer price index swaps, interest rate cap corridors and treasury locks.  See 
Note 6 for additional information on our derivatives used to hedge our exposure to changes in interest rates. 

In addition to continuing existing programs, we may use derivative instruments in other strategies to limit risk and enhance returns, 
particularly in the management of investment spread businesses.  We have established policies, guidelines and internal control 
procedures for the use of derivatives as tools to enhance management of the overall portfolio of risks assumed in our operations.  
Annually, our Board of Directors reviews our derivatives policy. 

Foreign Currency Exchange Risk  

Foreign Currency Denominated Investments 

We invest in foreign currency securities for incremental return and risk diversification relative to United States Dollar-
Denominated securities.  We use foreign currency swaps and foreign currency forwards to hedge some of the foreign exchange risk 
related to our investment in securities denominated in foreign currencies.  The currency risk is hedged using foreign currency 
derivatives of the same currency as the bonds.  See Note 6 for additional information on our foreign currency swaps and foreign 
currency forwards used to hedge our exposure to foreign currency exchange risk. 

148 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
The following provides our principal or notional amount in U.S. dollar equivalents (in millions) as of December 31, 2010, by 
expected maturity for our foreign currency denominated investments and foreign currency swaps: 

2011  

2012  

2013  

2014  

2015  

  Thereafter     Total 

   Estimated 
  Fair Value 

Currencies 
British pound 
   Interest rate 
Canadian dollar 
   Interest rate 
New Zealand dollar 
   Interest rate 
Euro 
   Interest rate 
Australian dollar 
   Interest rate 
      Total currencies 
Derivatives 
Foreign currency swaps 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -    $ 

 -     $ 

 66    $ 

 66    $ 

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%  

0.00%   

6.20%  

6.20%  

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 33    $ 

 -     $ 

 10    $ 

 43    $ 

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%   

6.10%  

0.00%   

5.60%  

6.00%  

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -    $ 

 34     $ 

 -    $ 

 34    $ 

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%  

3.70%   

0.00%  

3.70%  

 70 

 45 

 35 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 70    $ 

 -     $ 

 92    $ 

 162    $ 

 163 

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%   

4.80%  

0.00%   

5.00%  

4.90%  

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -    $ 

 -     $ 

 38    $ 

 38    $ 

 34 

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%   

0.00%  

0.00%   

7.40%  

7.40%  

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 103    $ 

 34     $ 

 206    $ 

 343    $ 

 347 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 -     $ 

 94    $ 

 30     $ 

 216    $ 

 340    $ 

 30 

The following provides our principal or notional amount in U.S. dollar equivalents of our foreign currency denominated 
investments and foreign currency swaps (in millions):  

As of December 31, 2009   
Principal/   
Notional     Estimated   
Amount     Fair Value   

$ 

$ 

$ 

 69    $ 
 41   
 31   
 173   
 33   
 347    $ 

 69    
 41    
 32    
 167    
 28    
 337    

 340    $ 

 14    

Currencies 
British pound 
Canadian dollar 
New Zealand dollar 
Euro 
Australian dollar 
   Total currencies 

Derivatives 
Foreign currency swaps 

Equity Market Risk  

Our revenues, assets, liabilities and derivatives are exposed to equity market risk.  Due to the use of our reversion to the mean 
(“RTM”) process and our hedging strategies, we expect that, in general, short-term fluctuations in the equity markets should not 
have a significant effect on our quarterly earnings from unlocking of assumptions for deferred acquisition costs (“DAC”), value of 
business acquired (“VOBA”), deferred sales inducements (“DSI”) and deferred front-end sales loads (“DFEL”).  However, 
earnings are affected by equity market movements on account values and assets under management and the related fees we earn on 
those assets.  Refer to “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” in the MD&A for further 
discussion on the effects of equity markets on our RTM. 

Fee Revenues   

The fees earned from variable annuities and variable life insurance products are exposed to the risk of a decline in equity market 
values.  These fees are generally a fixed percentage of the market value of assets under management.  In a severe equity market 
decline, fee income could be reduced by not only reduced market valuations but also by customer withdrawals and redemptions.  
Such withdrawals and redemptions from equity funds and accounts might be partially offset by transfers to our fixed-income 
accounts and the transfer of funds to us from our competitors’ customers. 

149 

  
 
 
        
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
    
  
   
        
  
  
  
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
   
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
 
        
        
  
  
  
        
        
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
 
  
 
 
Assets  

While we invest in equity assets with the expectation of achieving higher returns than would be available in our core fixed-income 
investments, the returns on and values of these equity investments are subject to somewhat greater market risk than our fixed-
income investments.  These investments, however, add diversification benefits to our fixed-income investments.  The following 
provides the sensitivity of price changes (in millions) to our equity assets owned and equity derivatives:  

Equity Assets 
Domestic equities 
Foreign equities 
   Subtotal 
Real estate 
Other equity interests 
      Total 

As of December 31, 2010 
   10% Fair 

Carrying 
Value 

   Estimated     Value 
   Fair Value     Increase 

   As of December 31, 2009 

   10% Fair 
   Value 
   Decrease 

   Carrying 
   Value 

   Estimated 
   Fair Value 

$ 

$ 

 154    $ 
 45   
 199   
 202   
 935   
 1,336    $ 

 154    $ 
 45    
 199   
 215   
 945   
 1,359    $ 

 169    $ 
 50   
 219   
 237   
 1,040   
 1,496    $ 

 139    $ 
 41   
 180   
 194   
 851   
 1,225    $ 

 219    $ 
 61   
 280   
 174   
 888   
 1,342    $ 

 219 
 61 
 280 
 195 
 898 
 1,373 

As of December 31, 2010 

   As of December 31, 2009 

Notional     Estimated   

10% Fair    
Value 

Value 

   Fair Value     Increase 

10% Fair    
Value 
   Decrease    

   Notional     Estimated 
   Fair Value 

Value 

Equity Derivatives (1) 
Equity futures  
Total return swaps  
Put options  
Call options (Based on S&P 500)  
   Total  

$ 

$ 

 907    $ 
 100   
 5,602   
 4,083   
 10,692    $ 

 -     $ 
 -    
 1,151   
 301   
 1,452    $ 

 (37)   $ 
 11   
 1,060   
 385   
 1,419    $ 

 37    $ 
 (11)  
 1,268   
 217   
 1,511    $ 

 1,147    $ 
 156   
 4,093   
 3,440   
 8,836    $ 

 -  
 -  
 935 
 215 
 1,150 

(1)  Assumes a plus or minus 10% change in underlying indexes.  Estimated fair value does not reflect daily settlement of futures 

or monthly settlement of total return swaps.  

Liabilities 

We have exposure to changes in our stock price through stock appreciation rights (“SARs”) issued in 2007 through 2010.  See 
Note 6 and Note 20 for additional information on our SARs and the related call options used to hedge the expected increase in 
liabilities from SARs granted on our stock.  

Derivatives Hedging Equity Market Risk 

We have entered into derivative transactions to hedge our exposure to equity market fluctuations.  Such derivatives include over-
the-counter equity call options, equity collars, variance swaps, total return swaps, put options, equity futures and call options.  See 
Note 6 for additional information on our derivatives used to hedge our exposure to equity market fluctuations. 

Effect of Equity Market Sensitivity 

Due to the use of our RTM process and our hedging strategies as described in “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” in the 
MD&A, we expect that, in general, short-term fluctuations in the equity markets should not have a significant effect on our 
quarterly earnings from unlocking of assumptions for DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL, as we do not unlock our long-term equity 
market assumptions based upon short-term fluctuations in the equity markets.  However, there is an effect to earnings from the 
effects of equity market movements on account values and assets under management and the related asset-based fees we earn on 
those assets net of related expenses we incur based upon the level of assets.   

150 

  
 
 
 
       
     
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
        
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
      
      
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
      
  
      
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
The following table presents our estimate of the effect on income (loss) from operations (in millions), from the change in asset-
based fees and related expenses, if the level of the Standard & Poor’s (“S&P”) 500 Index® (“S&P 500”) were to decrease to 800 
over 6 months after December 31, 2010, and remain at that level through the next 6 months, excluding any effect related to sales, 
prospective unlocking, persistency, hedge program performance or customer behavior caused by the equity market change: 

Segment 
Retirement Solutions - Annuities 
Retirement Solutions - Defined Contribution 

S&P 500     
at 800 (1)    

$ 

 (138)   
 (18)   

(1)  The baseline for these effects assumes 9% annual separate account growth beginning on January 1, 2011.  The baseline is then 
compared to a scenario of the S&P 500 at the 800 level, which assumes the index moves to the level as noted above and grows 
at 9% annually thereafter.  The difference between the baseline and S&P 500 at the 800 level scenario is presented. 

Refer to “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL” in the MD&A for discussion on the effects 
of equity markets on our RTM. 

The effect on earnings summarized above is an expected effect for the next twelve months.  The effect of quarterly equity market 
changes upon fee revenues and asset-based expenses will not be fully recognized in the current quarter because fee revenues are 
earned and related expenses are incurred based upon daily variable account values.  The difference between the current period 
average daily variable account values compared to the end of period variable account values affects fee revenues in subsequent 
periods.  Additionally, the effect on earnings may not necessarily be symmetrical with comparable increases in the equity markets.  
This discussion concerning the estimated effects of ongoing equity market volatility on the fees we earn from account values and 
assets under management is intended to be illustrative.  Actual effects may vary depending on a variety of factors, many of which 
are outside of our control, such as changing customer behaviors that might result in changes in the mix of our business between 
variable and fixed annuity contracts, switching among investment alternatives available within variable products, changes in sales 
production levels or changes in policy persistency.  For purposes of this guidance, the change in account values is assumed to 
correlate with the change in the relevant index.   

Default Risk 

Our portfolio of invested assets was $83.3 billion and $75.9 billion as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Of this total, 
$53.5 billion and $47.1 billion consisted of corporate bonds and $6.8 billion and $7.2 billion consisted of commercial mortgages as 
of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  We manage the risk of adverse default experience on these investments by applying 
disciplined credit evaluation and underwriting standards, prudently limiting allocations to lower-quality, higher-yielding investments 
and diversifying exposures by issuer, industry, region and property type.  For each counterparty or borrowing entity and its 
affiliates, our exposures from all transactions are aggregated and managed in relation to formal limits set by rating quality.  
Additional diversification limits, such as limits per industry, are also applied.  We remain exposed to occasional adverse cyclical 
economic downturns during which default rates may be significantly higher than the long-term historical average used in pricing.   

We depend on the ability of derivative product dealers and their guarantors to honor their obligations to pay the contract amounts 
under various derivatives agreements.  In order to minimize the risk of default losses, we diversify our exposures among several 
dealers and limit the amount of exposure to each in accordance with the credit rating of each dealer or its guarantor.  We generally 
limit our selection of counterparties that are obligated under these derivative contracts to those with an A credit rating or above.   

Credit-Related Derivatives 

We use credit-related derivatives to minimize our exposure to credit-related events and we also sell credit default swaps to offer 
credit protection to our contract holders and investors.  See Note 6 for additional information.  

151 

  
 
 
  
  
  
   
  
  
 
 
 
   
 
  
  
 
Credit Risk   

Through the use of derivative instruments, we are exposed to both credit risk (our counterparty fails to make payment) and market 
risk (the value of the instrument falls).  When the fair value of a derivative contract is positive, this generally indicates that the 
counterparty owes us and, therefore, creates a credit risk for us equal to the extent of the fair value gain in the derivative.  When 
the fair value of a derivative contract is negative, this generally indicates we owe the counterparty and therefore we have no credit 
risk, but have been affected by market risk.  We minimize the credit risk in derivative instruments by entering into transactions with 
high quality counterparties with minimum credit ratings that are reviewed regularly by us, by limiting the amount of credit exposure 
to any one counterparty and by requiring certain counterparties to post collateral if our credit risk exceeds certain limits.  We also 
maintain a policy of requiring all derivative contracts to be governed by an International Swaps and Derivatives Association 
(“ISDA”) Master Agreement.  We do not believe that the credit or market risks associated with derivative instruments are material 
to any insurance subsidiary or to us. 

We have derivative positions with counterparties.  Assuming zero recovery value, our exposure is the positive market value of the 
derivative positions with a counterparty, less collateral, that would be lost if the counterparty were to default.  As of December 31, 
2010 and 2009, our counterparty risk exposure, net of collateral, was $184 million and $292 million, respectively.  As of December 
31, 2010, we had exposure to 17 counterparties, with a maximum exposure of $43 million, net of collateral, to a single 
counterparty.  The credit risk associated with such agreements is minimized by purchasing such agreements from financial 
institutions with long-standing, superior performance records.  For the majority of our counterparties, there is a termination event 
should the long-term senior debt ratings of Lincoln National Corporation drop below BBB-/Baa3 (S&P/Moody’s).  Additionally, 
we maintain a policy of requiring all derivative contracts to be governed by an ISDA Master Agreement.  

Our fair value of counterparty exposure (in millions) was as follows: 

Rating 
AAA 
AA 
A 
BBB 
   Total  

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 7     $ 
 26    
 146    
 5    
 184     $ 

 -    
 202   
 82   
 8    
 292   

152 

  
 
 
 
 
 
     
  
     
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Item 8.  Financial Statements and Supplementary Data 

MANAGEMENT REPORT ON INTERNAL CONTROL OVER FINANCIAL REPORTING 

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for Lincoln National 
Corporation to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of our financial reporting and the preparation of financial 
statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles.  Internal control over financial 
reporting includes those policies and procedures that: (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately 
and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of our assets; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as 
necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with United States of America generally accepted accounting 
principles, and that our receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and 
directors; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or 
disposition of our assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.   

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Projections 
of any evaluation of internal control over financial reporting effectiveness to future periods are subject to risks.  Over time, 
controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or deterioration in the degree of compliance with policies or 
procedures.   

Management assessed our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, the end of our fiscal year.  
Management based its assessment on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of 
Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.  Management’s assessment included evaluation of such elements as the 
design and operating effectiveness of key financial reporting controls, process documentation, accounting policies, and our overall 
control environment.   

Based on the assessment, management has concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of the end 
of the fiscal year to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial 
statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with United States of America generally accepted accounting principles.   

The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, has been audited by Ernst & Young 
LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report which is included immediately below. 

153 

  
 
 
  
  
  
    
  
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm 

The Board of Directors and Shareholders of  
Lincoln National Corporation  

We have audited Lincoln National Corporation’s (the “Corporation”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 
2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring 
Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria).  The Corporation’s management is responsible for maintaining 
effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial 
reporting included in the accompanying Management Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting.  Our responsibility is 
to express an opinion on the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.  

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  
Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control 
over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.  Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control 
over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating 
effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in 
the circumstances.  We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.   

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability 
of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with United States of 
America generally accepted accounting principles.  A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies 
and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions 
and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to 
permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with United States of America generally accepted accounting principles, 
and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and 
directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized 
acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.  

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, 
projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because 
of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. 

In our opinion, Lincoln National Corporation maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting 
as of December 31, 2010, based on the COSO criteria.  

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the 
consolidated balance sheets of Lincoln National Corporation as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated 
statements of income (loss), stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 
2010 and our report dated February 25, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.  

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP 
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 
February 25, 2011 

154 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm 

The Board of Directors and Shareholders of  
Lincoln National Corporation  

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Lincoln National Corporation (the “Corporation”) as of 
December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated statements of income (loss), stockholders' equity, and cash flows for 
each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2010.  Our audits also included the financial statement schedules listed in 
the Index at 15(a)(2).  These financial statements and schedules are the responsibility of the Corporation's management.  Our 
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and schedules based on our audits.  

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  
Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements 
are free of material misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in 
the financial statements.  An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by 
management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable 
basis for our opinion. 

In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position 
of Lincoln National Corporation at December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the consolidated results of its operations and its cash flows 
for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2010, in conformity with United States of America generally accepted 
accounting principles.  Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedules, when considered in relation to the basic 
financial statements taken as a whole, present fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein. 

As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, in 2010 the Corporation changed its method of accounting for the 
consolidation of variable interest entities.  Also, as discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, in 2009 the 
Corporation changed its method of accounting for the recognition and presentation of other-than-temporary impairments.  

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), 
Lincoln National Corporation's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2010, based on criteria established in 
Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and 
our report dated February 25, 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.  

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP 
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 
February 25, 2011 

155 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS 
(in millions, except share data) 

ASSETS 
Investments: 
   Available-for-sale securities, at fair value: 
      Fixed maturity securities (amortized cost:  2010 - $65,175; 2009 - $60,757) 
      Variable interest entities' fixed maturity securities (amortized cost:  2010 - $570) 
      Equity securities (cost:  2010 - $179; 2009 - $382) 
   Trading securities 
   Mortgage loans on real estate 
   Real estate 
   Policy loans 
   Derivative investments 
   Other investments 
         Total investments 
Cash and invested cash 
Deferred acquisition costs and value of business acquired 
Premiums and fees receivable 
Accrued investment income 
Reinsurance recoverables 
Goodwill 
Other assets 
Separate account assets 
               Total assets 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY 
Liabilities 
Future contract benefits 
Other contract holder funds 
Short-term debt 
Long-term debt 
Reinsurance related embedded derivatives 
Funds withheld reinsurance liabilities 
Deferred gain on business sold through reinsurance 
Payables for collateral on investments 
Variable interest entities' liabilities 
Other liabilities 
Separate account liabilities 
            Total liabilities 
Contingencies and Commitments (See Note 14) 
Stockholders' Equity 
Preferred stock - 10,000,000 shares authorized: 
   Series A preferred stock - 10,914 and 11,497 shares issued and outstanding 
      as of December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2009, respectively 
   Series B preferred stock - 950,000 shares outstanding as of December 31, 2009 
Common stock - 800,000,000 shares authorized; 315,718,554 and 302,223,281 shares 
   issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2009, respectively 
Retained earnings 
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) 
            Total stockholders' equity 
               Total liabilities and stockholders' equity 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 
156 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

 68,030 
 584 
 197 
 2,596 
 6,752 
 202 
 2,865 
 1,076 
 1,038 
 83,340 
 2,741 
 8,930 
 335 
 933 
 6,527 
 3,019 
 3,369 
 84,630 
$   193,824 

$ 

 16,339 
 67,599 
 351 
 5,399 
 102 
 1,149 
 468 
 1,659 
 132 
 3,190 
 84,630 
 181,018 

$ 

 60,818 
 - 
 278 
 2,505 
 7,178 
 174 
 2,898 
 1,010 
 1,057 
 75,918 
 4,025 
 9,510 
 321 
 889 
 6,426 
 3,013 
 3,831 
 73,500 
$   177,433 

$ 

 15,958 
 64,147 
 350 
 5,050 
 31 
 1,261 
 543 
 1,907 
 - 
 2,986 
 73,500 
    165,733 

 - 
 - 

 - 
 806 

 8,124 
 3,934 
 748 
 12,806 
$   193,824 

 7,840 
 3,316 
 (262)
 11,700 
$   177,433 

  
 
                                          
                                         
  
     
  
    
     
  
    
     
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                                         
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME (LOSS) 
(in millions, except per share data) 

Revenues 
Insurance premiums 
Insurance fees 
Net investment income 
Realized gain (loss): 
   Total other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities 
   Portion of loss recognized in other comprehensive income  
      Net other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities  
         recognized in earnings 
      Realized gain (loss), excluding other-than-temporary 
         impairment losses on securities 
            Total realized gain (loss) 
Amortization of deferred gain on business sold through reinsurance 
Other revenues and fees 
      Total revenues 
Benefits and Expenses 
Interest credited 
Benefits 
Underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses 
Interest and debt expense 
Impairment of intangibles  
   Total benefits and expenses 
      Income (loss) from continuing operations before taxes 
      Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
         Income (loss) from continuing operations 
         Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of federal  
            income taxes 
              Net income (loss) 
              Preferred stock dividends and accretion of discount 
                Net income (loss) available to common stockholders 

Earnings (Loss) Per Common Share - Basic 
Income (loss) from continuing operations 
Income (loss) from discontinued operations 
   Net income (loss) 

Earnings (Loss) Per Common Share - Diluted 
Income (loss) from continuing operations 
Income (loss) from discontinued operations 
   Net income (loss) 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 $ 

 2,176 
 3,234 
 4,541 

 (240)
 88 

 2,064 
 2,922 
 4,178 

 (667)
 275 

 2,018 
 3,067 
 4,130 

 (851)
 - 

 (152)

 (392)

 (851)

 75 
 (77)
 75 
 458 
 10,407 

 2,485 
 3,330 
 3,067 
 291 
 -  
 9,173 
 1,234 
 283 
 951 

 29 
 980 
 (167)
 813 

 2.53 
 0.09 
 2.62 

 2.45 
 0.09 
 2.54 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 (754)
 (1,146)
 76 
 405 
 8,499 

 2,463 
 2,836 
 2,794 
 197 
 730 
 9,020 
 (521)
 (106)
 (415)

 (70)
 (485)
 (35)
 (520)

 (1.60)
 (0.25)
 (1.85)

 (1.60)
 (0.25)
 (1.85)

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 316 
 (535)
 76  
 468 
 9,224 

 2,502 
 3,059 
 3,138 
 281 
 381 
 9,361 
 (137)
 (127)
 (10)

 67 
 57 
 - 
 57 

 (0.04)
 0.26 
 0.22 

 (0.04)
 0.26 
 0.22 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 
157 

  
 
                                               
                                               
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
 
   
  
 
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
                                       
  
 
   
  
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
                                               
  
 
   
  
 
  
 
   
  
 
  
   
  
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY 
(in millions, except per share data) 

Preferred Stock 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
Issuance (redemption) of Series B preferred stock 
Accretion of discount on Series B preferred stock 
   Balance as of end-of-year 

Common Stock 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
Issuance of common stock 
Issuance (repurchase and cancellation) of common stock warrants 
Stock compensation/issued for benefit plans 
Deferred compensation payable in stock 
Effect of amendment to deferred compensation plans 
Retirement of common stock/cancellation of shares 
   Balance as of end-of-year 

Retained Earnings 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
Cumulative effect from adoption of new accounting standards 
Comprehensive income (loss) 
Less other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax 
   Net income (loss) 
Retirement of common stock 
Dividends declared:  Common (2010 - $0.080; 2009 - $0.040; 2008 - $1.455) 
Dividends on preferred stock 
Accretion of discount on Series B preferred stock 
   Balance as of end-of-year 

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
Cumulative effect from adoption of new accounting standards 
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax 
   Balance as of end-of-year 
      Total stockholders' equity as of end-of-year 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2010  
2008  
2009  

$ 

 $ 

 806  
 (950)
 144  
 -  

 7,840  
 368  
 (48)
 18  
 -  
 (29)
 (25)
 8,124  

 3,316  
 (169)
 1,809  
 829  
 980  
 -  
 (26)
 (23)
 (144)
 3,934  

$ 

 - 
 794 
 12 
 806 

 7,035 
 652 
 156 
 (8)
 5 
 - 
 - 
 7,840 

 3,745 
 102 
 2,158 
 2,643 
 (485)
 - 
 (11)
 (23)
 (12)
 3,316 

 (262)
 181  
 829  
 748  
 12,806 

$ 

 (2,803)
 (102)
 2,643 
 (262)
 11,700 

 $ 

$ 

 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 

 7,200 
 - 
 - 
 78 
 6 
 - 
 (249)
 7,035 

 4,293 
 (4)
 (2,971)
 (3,028)
 57 
 (227)
 (374)
 - 
 - 
 3,745 

 225 
 - 
 (3,028)
 (2,803)
 7,977 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 
158 

  
 
                                
                          
   
 
  
  
             
   
   
   
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
 
   
  
 
   
  
 
   
  
  
   
  
  
   
  
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS 
(in millions) 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities 
Net income (loss) 
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities: 
   Deferred acquisition costs, value of business acquired, deferred sales inducements 
      and deferred front-end loads deferrals and interest, net of amortization 
   Trading securities purchases, sales and maturities, net 
   Change in premiums and fees receivable 
   Change in accrued investment income 
   Change in future contract benefits and other contract holder funds 
   Change in reinsurance related assets and liabilities 
   Change in federal income tax accruals 
   Realized (gain) loss  
   (Gain) loss on early extinguishment of debt 
   Amortization of deferred gain on business sold through reinsurance 
   Impairment of intangibles 
   (Gain) loss on disposal of discontinued operations 
   Other 
      Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities 

Cash Flows from Investing Activities 
Purchases of available-for-sale securities 
Sales of available-for-sale securities 
Maturities of available-for-sale securities 
Purchases of other investments 
Sales or maturities of other investments 
Increase (decrease) in payables for collateral on investments 
Proceeds from sale of subsidiaries/businesses, net of cash disposed  
Other 
      Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities 

Cash Flows from Financing Activities 
Payment of long-term debt, including current maturities 
Issuance of long-term debt, net of issuance costs 
Increase (decrease) in commercial paper, net 
Deposits of fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable 
Withdrawals of fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable  
Transfers to and from separate accounts, net 
Payment of funding agreements 
Common stock issued for benefit plans and excess tax benefits 
Issuance (redemption) of Series B preferred stock and issuance (repurchase and  
   cancellation) of associated common stock warrants 
Issuance of common stock 
Repurchase of common stock 
Dividends paid to common and preferred stockholders 
      Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities 
Net increase (decrease) in cash and invested cash, including discontinued operations 
Cash and invested cash, including discontinued operations, as of beginning-of-year 
   Cash and invested cash, including discontinued operations, as of end-of-year 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 980    $ 

 (485)   $ 

 57  

 (246)  
 47    
 (14)  
 (44)  
 643   
 22    
 414   
 77    
 5    
 (75)  
 -   
 (66)  
 (23)  
 1,720   

 (13,057)  
 3,118   
 4,652   
 (3,581)  
 3,239   
 (248)  
 321   
 (74)  
 (5,630)  

 (405)  
 749   
 1    
 11,080   
 (5,305)  
 (2,957)  
 -   
 1    

 (316)  
 (3)  
 128   
 (75)  
 (463)  
 77   
 9   
 1,146   
 (64)  
 (76)  
 730   
 219   
 110   
 937   

 (13,532)  
 3,818   
 3,330   
 (4,261)  
 4,340   
 (1,799)  
 327   
 (75)  
 (7,852)  

 (522)  
 788   
 (216)  
 11,378   
 (5,530)  
 (2,248)  
 -   
 -   

 (998)  
 368    
 (25)  
 (42)  
 2,467   
 (1,443)  
 4,184   
 2,741    $ 

 950   
 652   
 -   
 (79)  
 5,173   
 (1,742)  
 5,926   
 4,184    $ 

$ 

 (262) 
 205  
 69  
 11  
 1,071 
 (346) 
 (504) 
 535  
 -  
 (76) 
 381  
 12  
 106  
 1,259 

 (6,800)
 2,285 
 3,881 
 (3,510)
 3,613 
 2,571 
 648  
 (117) 
 2,571 

 (300) 
 450  
 50  
 9,840 
 (5,998)
 (2,204)
 (550) 
 49  

 -  
 -  
 (476) 
 (430) 
 431  
 4,261 
 1,665 
 5,926 

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 
159 

  
 
                                      
                                      
  
  
    
  
     
  
     
    
  
     
  
     
    
  
     
  
     
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
    
  
     
  
     
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS 

1.  Nature of Operations, Basis of Presentation and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies 

Nature of Operations  

Lincoln National Corporation and its majority-owned subsidiaries (“LNC” or the “Company,” which also may be referred to as 
“we,” “our” or “us”) operate multiple insurance businesses through four business segments.  See Note 23 for additional details.  
The collective group of businesses uses “Lincoln Financial Group” as its marketing identity.  Through our business segments, we 
sell a wide range of wealth protection, accumulation and retirement income products.  These products include institutional and/or 
retail fixed and indexed annuities, variable annuities, universal life insurance (“UL”), variable universal life insurance (“VUL”), 
linked-benefit UL, term life insurance, mutual funds and group life, disability and dental. 

Basis of Presentation  

The accompanying consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with United States of America generally accepted 
accounting principles (“GAAP”).  Certain GAAP policies, which significantly affect the determination of financial position, results 
of operations and cash flows, are summarized below. 

Certain amounts reported in prior years’ consolidated financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the presentation 
adopted in the current year.  These reclassifications had no effect on net income or stockholders’ equity of the prior years. 

Summary of Significant Accounting Policies  

Principles of Consolidation 

The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of LNC and all other entities in which we have a 
controlling financial interest and any variable interest entities (“VIEs”) in which we are the primary beneficiary.  See Note 4 below 
for additional details.  Entities in which we do not have a controlling financial interest and do not exercise significant management 
influence over the operating and financing decisions are reported using the equity method.  The carrying value of our investments 
that we account for using the equity method on our Consolidated Balance Sheets and equity in earnings on our Consolidated 
Statements of Income (Loss) is not material.  All material inter-company accounts and transactions have been eliminated in 
consolidation.   

Our involvement with VIEs is primarily to obtain financing to either invest in assets that allow us to gain exposure to a broadly 
diversified pool of corporate issuers or to support our UL business with secondary guarantees.  The factors used to determine 
whether or not we are the primary beneficiary and must consolidate a VIE in which we hold a variable interest changed effective 
January 1, 2010, upon the adoption of new accounting guidance.  See “Consolidations Topic” in Note 2 for details.  Beginning 
January 1, 2010, we continuously analyze the primary beneficiary of our VIEs, to determine whether we are the primary beneficiary, 
by applying a qualitative approach to identify the variable interest that has the power to direct activities that most significantly 
impact the economic performance of the VIE and the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive returns that could 
potentially be significant to the VIE. 

Accounting Estimates and Assumptions 

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions 
affecting the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the 
financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses for the reporting period.  Those estimates are inherently 
subject to change and actual results could differ from those estimates.  Included among the material (or potentially material) 
reported amounts and disclosures that require extensive use of estimates are:  fair value of certain invested assets and derivatives, 
asset valuation allowances, deferred acquisition costs (“DAC”), value of business acquired (“VOBA”), deferred sales inducements 
(“DSI”), goodwill, future contract benefits, other contract holder funds which includes deferred front-end loads (“DFEL”), 
pension plans, income taxes and the potential effects of resolving litigated matters. 

Business Combinations 

For all business combination transactions occurring after January 1, 2009, we use the acquisition method of accounting, and 
accordingly generally, recognize the fair values of assets acquired, liabilities assumed and any noncontrolling interests.  For all 
business combination transactions initiated after June 30, 2001, but before January 1, 2009, the purchase method of accounting has 
been used, and accordingly, the assets and liabilities of the acquired company have been recorded at their estimated fair values as of 
the merger date.  The allocation of fair values may be subject to adjustment after the initial allocation for up to a one-year period as 

160 

   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
more information relative to the fair values as of the acquisition date becomes available.  The consolidated financial statements 
include the results of operations of any acquired company since the acquisition date. 

Fair Value Measurement 

Our measurement of fair value is based on assumptions used by market participants in pricing the asset or liability, which may 
include inherent risk, restrictions on the sale or use of an asset or non-performance risk, which would include our own credit risk.  
Our estimate of an exchange price is the price in an orderly transaction between market participants to sell the asset or transfer the 
liability (“exit price”) in the principal market, or the most advantageous market in the absence of a principal market, for that asset 
or liability, as opposed to the price that would be paid to acquire the asset or receive a liability (“entry price”).  Pursuant to the Fair 
Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards 
CodificationTM (“ASC”), we categorize our financial instruments carried at fair value into a three-level fair value hierarchy, based on 
the priority of inputs to the respective valuation technique.  The three-level hierarchy for fair value measurement is defined as 
follows: 

(cid:2)  Level 1 – inputs to the valuation methodology are quoted prices available in active markets for identical investments as of the 

reporting date, except for large holdings subject to “blockage discounts” that are excluded;  

(cid:2)  Level 2 – inputs to the valuation methodology are other than quoted prices in active markets, that are either directly or 

indirectly observable as of the reporting date, and fair value can be determined through the use of models or other valuation 
methodologies; and 

(cid:2)  Level 3 – inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable inputs in situations where there is little or no market activity 
for the asset or liability, and we make estimates and assumptions related to the pricing of the asset or liability, including 
assumptions regarding risk. 

In certain cases, the inputs used to measure fair value may fall into different levels of the fair value hierarchy.  In such cases, an 
investment’s level within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value 
measurement.  Our assessment of the significance of a particular input to the fair value measurement in its entirety requires 
judgment and considers factors specific to the investment.  

When a determination is made to classify an asset or liability within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, the determination is based 
upon the significance of the unobservable inputs to the overall fair value measurement.  Because certain securities trade in less 
liquid or illiquid markets with limited or no pricing information, the determination of fair value for these securities is inherently 
more difficult.  However, Level 3 fair value investments may include, in addition to the unobservable or Level 3 inputs, observable 
components, which are components that are actively quoted or can be validated to market-based sources. 

Available-For-Sale Securities – Fair Valuation Methodologies and Associated Inputs 

Securities classified as available-for-sale (“AFS”) consist of fixed maturity and equity securities and are stated at fair value with 
unrealized gains and losses included within accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (“OCI”), net of associated DAC, 
VOBA, DSI, other contract holder funds and deferred income taxes.  See Notes 5 and 15 for additional details. 

We measure the fair value of our securities classified as AFS based on assumptions used by market participants in pricing the 
security.  The most appropriate valuation methodology is selected based on the specific characteristics of the fixed maturity or 
equity security, and we consistently apply the valuation methodology to measure the security’s fair value.  Our fair value 
measurement is based on a market approach, which utilizes prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions 
involving identical or comparable securities.  Sources of inputs to the market approach include third-party pricing services, 
independent broker quotations or pricing matrices.  We do not adjust prices received from third parties; however, we do analyze 
the third-party pricing services’ valuation methodologies and related inputs and perform additional evaluation to determine the 
appropriate level within the fair value hierarchy. 

We use observable and unobservable inputs in our valuation methodologies.  Observable inputs include benchmark yields, 
reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, issuer spreads, two-sided markets, benchmark securities, bids, offers and reference data.  In 
addition, market indicators, industry and economic events are monitored and further market data is acquired if certain triggers are 
met.  For certain security types, additional inputs may be used, or some of the inputs described above may not be applicable.  For 
broker-quoted only securities, quotes from market makers or broker-dealers are obtained from sources recognized to be market 
participants.  In order to validate the pricing information and broker-dealer quotes, we employ, where possible, procedures that 
include comparisons with similar observable positions, comparisons with subsequent sales, discussions with senior business leaders 
and brokers and observations of general market movements for those security classes.  For those securities trading in less liquid or 
illiquid markets with limited or no pricing information, we use unobservable inputs in order to measure the fair value of these 
securities.  In cases where this information is not available, such as for privately placed securities, fair value is estimated using an 

161 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
internal pricing matrix.  This matrix relies on management’s judgment concerning the discount rate used in calculating expected 
future cash flows, credit quality, industry sector performance and expected maturity. 

The observable and unobservable inputs to our valuation methodologies are based on a set of standard inputs that we generally use 
to evaluate all of our AFS securities.  Depending on the type of security or the daily market activity, standard inputs may be 
prioritized differently or may not be available for all AFS securities on any given day.   

The following summarizes our fair valuation methodologies and associated inputs, which are particular to the specified security 
type and are in addition to the defined standard inputs to our valuation methodologies for all of our AFS securities discussed 
above: 

(cid:2)  Corporate bonds and U.S. Government bonds – We also use Trade Reporting and Compliance EngineTM reported tables for 

our corporate bonds and vendor trading platform data for our U.S. Government bonds.   

(cid:2)  Mortgage- and asset-backed securities – We also utilize additional inputs which include new issues data, monthly payment 

information and monthly collateral performance, including prepayments, severity, delinquencies, step-down features and over 
collateralization features for each of our mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”), which include collateralized mortgage 
obligations (“CMOs”), mortgage pass through securities backed by residential mortgages (“MPTS”) and MBS backed by 
commercial mortgages (“CMBS”), and for our asset-backed securities (“ABS”) collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”). 
State and municipal bonds – We also use additional inputs which include information from the Municipal Securities Rule 
Making Board, as well as material event notices, new issue data, issuer financial statements and Municipal Market Data 
benchmark yields for our state and municipal bonds. 

(cid:2) 

(cid:2)  Hybrid and redeemable preferred and equity securities – We also utilize additional inputs of exchange prices (underlying and 

common stock of the same issuer) for our hybrid and redeemable preferred and equity securities, including banking, insurance, 
other financial services and other securities. 

AFS Securities – Evaluation for Recovery of Amortized Cost 

We regularly review our AFS securities for declines in fair value that we determine to be other-than-temporary.  For an equity 
security, if we do not have the ability and intent to hold the security for a sufficient period of time to allow for a recovery in value, 
we conclude that an other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) has occurred and the amortized cost of the equity security is 
written down to the current fair value, with a corresponding charge to realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income (Loss).  When assessing our ability and intent to hold the equity security to recovery, we consider, among other things, the 
severity and duration of the decline in fair value of the equity security as well as the cause of the decline, a fundamental analysis of 
the liquidity, and business prospects and overall financial condition of the issuer.  

For our fixed maturity AFS securities, we generally consider the following to determine that our unrealized losses are not OTTI: 

(cid:2)  The estimated range and average period until recovery; 
(cid:2)  The estimated range and average holding period to maturity; 
(cid:2)  Remaining payment terms of the security; 
(cid:2)  Current delinquencies and nonperforming assets of underlying collateral; 
(cid:2)  Expected future default rates; 
(cid:2)  Collateral value by vintage, geographic region, industry concentration or property type;  
(cid:2) 
(cid:2)  Contractual and regulatory cash obligations. 

Subordination levels or other credit enhancements as of the balance sheet date as compared to origination; and 

For a debt security, if we intend to sell a security or it is more likely than not we will be required to sell a debt security before 
recovery of its amortized cost basis and the fair value of the debt security is below amortized cost, we conclude that an OTTI has 
occurred and the amortized cost is written down to current fair value, with a corresponding charge to realized gain (loss) on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  If we do not intend to sell a debt security or it is not more likely than not we will be 
required to sell a debt security before recovery of its amortized cost basis but the present value of the cash flows expected to be 
collected is less than the amortized cost of the debt security (referred to as the credit loss), we conclude that an OTTI has occurred 
and the amortized cost is written down to the estimated recovery value with a corresponding charge to realized gain (loss) on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), as this amount is deemed the credit portion of the OTTI.  The remainder of the 
decline to fair value is recorded in OCI to unrealized OTTI on AFS securities on our Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ 
Equity, as this amount is considered a noncredit (i.e., recoverable) impairment. 

When assessing our intent to sell a debt security or if it is more likely than not we will be required to sell a debt security before 
recovery of its cost basis, we evaluate facts and circumstances such as, but not limited to, decisions to reposition our security 
portfolio, sale of securities to meet cash flow needs and sales of securities to capitalize on favorable pricing.  In order to determine 

162 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
the amount of the credit loss for a debt security, we calculate the recovery value by performing a discounted cash flow analysis 
based on the current cash flows and future cash flows we expect to recover.  The discount rate is the effective interest rate implicit 
in the underlying debt security.  The effective interest rate is the original yield or the coupon if the debt security was previously 
impaired.  See the discussion below for additional information on the methodology and significant inputs, by security type, which 
we use to determine the amount of a credit loss. 

Our conclusion that it is not more likely than not that we will be required to sell the fixed maturity AFS securities before recovery 
of their amortized cost basis, the estimated future cash flows are equal to or greater than the amortized cost basis of the debt 
securities, or we have the ability to hold the equity AFS securities for a period of time sufficient for recovery is based upon our 
asset-liability management process.  Management considers the following as part of the evaluation: 

(cid:2)  The current economic environment and market conditions; 
(cid:2)  Our business strategy and current business plans; 
(cid:2)  The nature and type of security, including expected maturities and exposure to general credit, liquidity, market and interest rate 

risk;  

(cid:2)  Our analysis of data from financial models and other internal and industry sources to evaluate the current effectiveness of our 

hedging and overall risk management strategies;  

(cid:2)  The current and expected timing of contractual maturities of our assets and liabilities, expectations of prepayments on 

investments and expectations for surrenders and withdrawals of life insurance policies and annuity contracts;  

(cid:2)  The capital risk limits approved by management; and 
(cid:2)  Our current financial condition and liquidity demands. 

To determine the recovery period of a debt security, we consider the facts and circumstances surrounding the underlying issuer 
including, but not limited to, the following: 

(cid:2)  Historic and implied volatility of the security; 
(cid:2)  Length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than amortized cost;  
(cid:2)  Adverse conditions specifically related to the security or to specific conditions in an industry or geographic area;  
(cid:2)  Failure, if any, of the issuer of the security to make scheduled payments; and 
(cid:2)  Recoveries or additional declines in fair value subsequent to the balance sheet date.  

In periods subsequent to the recognition of an OTTI, the AFS security is accounted for as if it had been purchased on the 
measurement date of the OTTI.  Therefore, for the fixed maturity AFS security, the original discount or reduced premium is 
reflected in net investment income over the contractual term of the investment in a manner that produces a constant effective 
yield. 

To determine recovery value of a corporate bond or ABS CDOs, we perform additional analysis related to the underlying issuer 
including, but not limited to, the following: 

(cid:2)  Fundamentals of the issuer to determine what we would recover if they were to file bankruptcy versus the price at which the 

market is trading; 

(cid:2)  Fundamentals of the industry in which the issuer operates; 
(cid:2)  Earnings multiples for the given industry or sector of an industry that the underlying issuer operates within, divided by the 

outstanding debt to determine an expected recovery value of the security in the case of a liquidation; 

(cid:2)  Expected cash flows of the issuer (e.g., whether the issuer has cash flows in excess of what is required to fund its operations); 
(cid:2)  Expectations regarding defaults and recovery rates; 
(cid:2)  Changes to the rating of the security by a rating agency; and 
(cid:2)  Additional market information (e.g., if there has been a replacement of the corporate debt security). 

Each quarter we review the cash flows for the MBS to determine whether or not they are sufficient to provide for the 
recovery of our amortized cost.  We revise our cash flow projections only for those securities that are at most risk for 
impairment based on current credit enhancement and trends in the underlying collateral performance.  To determine recovery 
value of a MBS, we perform additional analysis related to the underlying issuer including, but not limited to, the following: 

(cid:2)  Discounted cash flow analysis based on the current cash flows and future cash flows we expect to recover; 
(cid:2)  Level of creditworthiness of the home equity loans that back a CMO, residential mortgages that back a MPTS or commercial 

mortgages that back a CMBS; 
Susceptibility to fair value fluctuations for changes in the interest rate environment; 
Susceptibility to reinvestment risks, in cases where market yields are lower than the securities’ book yield earned; 

(cid:2) 
(cid:2) 

163 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(cid:2) 
Susceptibility to reinvestment risks, in cases where market yields are higher than the book yields earned on a security;  
(cid:2)  Expectations of sale of such a security where market yields are higher than the book yields earned on a security; and  
(cid:2) 

Susceptibility to variability of prepayments. 

When evaluating MBS and mortgage-related ABS, we consider a number of pool-specific factors as well as market level factors 
when determining whether or not the impairment on the security is temporary or other-than-temporary.  The most important 
factor is the performance of the underlying collateral in the security and the trends of that performance in the prior periods.  We 
use this information about the collateral to forecast the timing and rate of mortgage loan defaults, including making projections for 
loans that are already delinquent and for those loans that are currently performing but may become delinquent in the future.  Other 
factors used in this analysis include type of underlying collateral (e.g., prime, Alt-A or subprime), geographic distribution of 
underlying loans and timing of liquidations by state.  Once default rates and timing assumptions are determined, we then make 
assumptions regarding the severity of a default if it were to occur.  Factors that impact the severity assumption include expectations 
for future home price appreciation or depreciation, loan size, first lien versus second lien, existence of loan level private mortgage 
insurance, type of occupancy and geographic distribution of loans.  Once default and severity assumptions are determined for the 
security in question, cash flows for the underlying collateral are projected including expected defaults and prepayments.  These cash 
flows on the collateral are then translated to cash flows on our tranche based on the cash flow waterfall of the entire capital security 
structure.  If this analysis indicates the entire principal on a particular security will not be returned, the security is reviewed for 
OTTI by comparing the expected cash flows to amortized cost.  To the extent that the security has already been impaired or was 
purchased at a discount, such that the amortized cost of the security is less than or equal to the present value of cash flows 
expected to be collected, no impairment is required.   

Otherwise, if the amortized cost of the security is greater than the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected, and the 
security was not purchased at a discount greater than the expected principal loss, then impairment is recognized. 

We further monitor the cash flows of all of our AFS securities backed by pools on an ongoing basis.  We also perform detailed 
analysis on all of our subprime, Alt-A, non-agency residential MBS and on a significant percentage of our AFS securities backed by 
pools of commercial mortgages.  The detailed analysis includes revising projected cash flows by updating the cash flows for actual 
cash received and applying assumptions with respect to expected defaults, foreclosures and recoveries in the future.  These revised 
projected cash flows are then compared to the amount of credit enhancement (subordination) in the structure to determine 
whether the amortized cost of the security is recoverable.  If it is not recoverable, we record an impairment of the security.   

Trading Securities 

Trading securities consist of fixed maturity and equity securities in designated portfolios, some of which support modified 
coinsurance (“Modco”) and coinsurance with funds withheld (“CFW”) reinsurance arrangements.  Investment results for the 
portfolios that support Modco and CFW reinsurance arrangements, including gains and losses from sales, are passed directly to the 
reinsurers pursuant to contractual terms of the reinsurance arrangements.  Trading securities are carried at fair value and changes in 
fair value and changes in the fair value of embedded derivative liabilities associated with the underlying reinsurance arrangements, 
are recorded in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) as they occur.   

Alternative Investments  

Alternative investments, which consist primarily of investments in Limited Partnerships (“LPs”), are included in other investments 
on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  We account for our investments in LPs using the equity method to determine the carrying 
value.  Recognition of alternative investment income is delayed due to the availability of the related financial statements, which are 
generally obtained from the partnerships’ general partners.  As a result, our venture capital, real estate and oil and gas portfolios are 
generally on a three-month delay and our hedge funds are on a one-month delay.  In addition, the impact of audit adjustments 
related to completion of calendar-year financial statement audits of the investees are typically received during the second quarter of 
each calendar year.  Accordingly, our investment income from alternative investments for any calendar-year period may not include 
the complete impact of the change in the underlying net assets for the partnership for that calendar-year period.   

Payables for Collateral on Investments 

When we enter into collateralized financing transactions on our investments, a liability is recorded equal to the cash collateral 
received.  This liability is included within payables for collateral on investments on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  Income and 
expenses associated with these transactions are recorded as investment income and investment expenses within net investment 
income on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  Changes in payables for collateral on investments are reflected within 
cash flows from investing activities on our Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows. 

164 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage Loans on Real Estate 

Mortgage loans on real estate are carried at unpaid principal balances adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of 
discounts and are net of valuation allowances.  Interest income is accrued on the principal balance of the loan based on the loan’s 
contractual interest rate.  Premiums and discounts are amortized using the effective yield method over the life of the loan.  Interest 
income and amortization of premiums and discounts are reported in net investment income on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income (Loss) along with mortgage loan fees, which are recorded as they are incurred. 

Our commercial loan portfolio is comprised of long-term loans secured by existing commercial real estate.  As such, it does not 
exhibit risk characteristics unique to mezzanine, construction, residential, agricultural, land or other types of real estate loans.  We 
believe all of the loans in our portfolio share three primary risks:  borrower creditworthiness; sustainability of the cash flow of the 
property; and market risk; therefore, our methods for monitoring and assessing credit risk are consistent for our entire portfolio.  
Loans are considered impaired when it is probable that, based upon current information and events, we will be unable to collect all 
amounts due under the contractual terms of the loan agreement.  When we determine that a loan is impaired, a valuation allowance 
is established for the excess carrying value of the loan over its estimated value.  The loan’s estimated value is based on:  the present 
value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate; the loan’s observable market price; or the fair 
value of the loan’s collateral.  Valuation allowances are maintained at a level we believe is adequate to absorb estimated probable 
credit losses of each specific loan.  Our periodic evaluation of the adequacy of the allowance for losses is based on our past loan 
loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay 
(including the timing of future payments), the estimated value of the underlying collateral, composition of the loan portfolio, 
current economic conditions and other relevant factors.  Trends in market vacancy and rental rates are incorporated into the 
analysis that we perform for monitored loans and may contribute to the establishment of (or an increase or decrease in) an 
allowance for credit losses.  In addition, we review each loan individually in our commercial mortgage loan portfolio on an annual 
basis to identify emerging risks.  We focus on properties that experienced a reduction in debt-service coverage or that have 
significant exposure to tenants with deteriorating credit profiles.  Where warranted, we establish or increase loss reserves for a 
specific loan based upon this analysis.  Our process for determining past due or delinquency status begins when a payment date is 
missed, at which time the borrower is contacted.  After the grace period expiration that may last up to 10 days, we send a default 
notice.  The default notice generally provides a short time period to cure the default. Our policy is to report loans that are 60 or 
more days past due, which equates to two or more payments missed, as delinquent.  We do not accrue interest on loans 90 days 
past due, and any interest received on these loans is either applied to the principal or recorded in net investment income on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) when received, depending on the assessment of the collectibility of the loan.  We 
resume accruing interest once a loan complies with all of its original terms or restructured terms.  Mortgage loans deemed 
uncollectible are charged against the allowance for losses, and subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance for losses.  
All mortgage loans that are impaired have an established allowance for credit losses.  Changes in valuation allowances are reported 
in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

We measure and assess the credit quality of our mortgage loans by using loan-to-value and debt-service coverage ratios.  The loan-
to-value ratio compares the principal amount of the loan to the fair value at origination of the underlying property collateralizing 
the loan and is commonly expressed as a percentage.  Loan-to-value ratios greater than 100% indicate that the principal amount is 
greater than the collateral value.  Therefore, all else being equal, a lower loan-to-value ratio generally indicates a higher quality loan.  
The debt-service coverage ratio compares a property’s net operating income to its debt-service payments.  Debt-service coverage 
ratios of less than 1.0 indicate that property operations do not generate enough income to cover its current debt payments.  
Therefore, all else being equal, a higher debt-service coverage ratio generally indicates a higher quality loan.  

Policy Loans  

Policy loans represent loans we issue to contract holders that use the cash surrender value of their life insurance policy as collateral.  
Policy loans are carried at unpaid principal balances.   

Real Estate 

Real estate includes both real estate held for the production of income and real estate held-for-sale.  Real estate held for the 
production of income is carried at cost less accumulated depreciation.  Depreciation is calculated on a straight-line basis over the 
estimated useful life of the asset.  We periodically review properties held for the production of income for impairment.  Properties 
whose carrying values are greater than their projected undiscounted cash flows are written down to estimated fair value, with 
impairment losses reported in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  The estimated fair value of 
real estate is generally computed using the present value of expected future cash flows from the real estate discounted at a rate 
commensurate with the underlying risks.  Real estate classified as held-for-sale is stated at the lower of depreciated cost or fair value 
less expected disposition costs at the time classified as held-for-sale.  Real estate is not depreciated while it is classified as held-for-
sale.  Also, valuation allowances for losses are established, as appropriate, for real estate held-for-sale and any changes to the 
valuation allowances are reported in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  Real estate acquired 
through foreclosure proceedings is recorded at fair value at the settlement date.   

165 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative Instruments 

We hedge certain portions of our exposure to interest rate risk, foreign currency exchange risk, equity market risk and credit risk by 
entering into derivative transactions.  All of our derivative instruments are recognized as either assets or liabilities on our 
Consolidated Balance Sheets at estimated fair value.  We categorized derivatives into a three-level hierarchy, based on the priority 
of the inputs to the respective valuation technique as discussed above in “Fair Value Measurement.”  The accounting for changes 
in the estimated fair value of a derivative instrument depends on whether it has been designated and qualifies as part of a hedging 
relationship, and further, on the type of hedging relationship.  For those derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as 
hedging instruments, we must designate the hedging instrument based upon the exposure being hedged: as a cash flow hedge, a fair 
value hedge or a hedge of a net investment in a foreign subsidiary.   

For derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as a cash flow hedge, the effective portion of the gain or loss on the 
derivative instrument is reported as a component of accumulated OCI and reclassified into net income in the same period or 
periods during which the hedged transaction affects net income.  The remaining gain or loss on the derivative instrument in excess 
of the cumulative change in the present value of designated future cash flows of the hedged item (hedge ineffectiveness), if any, is 
recognized in net income during the period of change.  For derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as a fair value 
hedge, the gain or loss on the derivative instrument, as well as the offsetting gain or loss on the hedged item attributable to the 
hedged risk are recognized in net income during the period of change in estimated fair values.  For derivative instruments that are 
designated and qualify as a hedge of a net investment in a foreign subsidiary, the gain or loss on the derivative instrument is 
reported as a component of accumulated OCI and reclassified into net income at the time of the sale of the foreign subsidiary.  For 
derivative instruments not designated as hedging instruments but that are economic hedges, the gain or loss is recognized in net 
income.  See Note 6 for details of where the gain or loss recognized in net income is reported on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income (Loss). 

We purchase and issue financial instruments and products that contain embedded derivative instruments.  When it is determined 
that the embedded derivative possesses economic characteristics that are not clearly and closely related to the economic 
characteristics of the host contract, and a separate instrument with the same terms would qualify as a derivative instrument, the 
embedded derivative is bifurcated from the host for measurement purposes.  The embedded derivative, which is reported with the 
host instrument in the Consolidated Balance Sheets, is carried at fair value with changes in fair value recognized in net income 
during the period of change.  See Note 6 for additional discussion of our derivative instruments, including details of where the gain 
or loss recognized in net income is reported on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

We employ several different methods for determining the fair value of our derivative instruments.  The fair value of our derivative 
contracts are measured based on current settlement values, which are based on quoted market prices, industry standard models that 
are commercially available and broker quotes.  These techniques project cash flows of the derivatives using current and implied 
future market conditions.  We calculate the present value of the cash flows to measure the current fair market value of the 
derivative.  

Cash and Cash Equivalents 

Cash and invested cash is carried at cost and includes all highly liquid debt instruments purchased with a maturity of three months 
or less.   

DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 

Commissions and other costs of acquiring UL insurance, VUL insurance, traditional life insurance, annuities and other investment 
contracts, which vary with and are related primarily to the production of new business, have been deferred (i.e., DAC) to the extent 
recoverable.  VOBA is an intangible asset that reflects the estimated fair value of in-force contracts in a life insurance company 
acquisition and represents the portion of the purchase price that is allocated to the value of the right to receive future cash flows 
from the business in force at the acquisition date.  Bonus credits and excess interest for dollar cost averaging contracts are 
considered DSI, and the unamortized balance is reported in other assets on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  Contract sales 
charges that are collected in the early years of an insurance contract are deferred (referred to as “DFEL”), and the unamortized 
balance is reported in other contract holder funds on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  

Both DAC and VOBA amortization is reported within underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  DSI amortization is reported in interest credited on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income (Loss).  The amortization of DFEL is reported within insurance fees on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  
The methodology for determining the amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL varies by product type.  For all insurance 
contracts, amortization is based on assumptions consistent with those used in the development of the underlying contract adjusted 
for emerging experience and expected trends.   

166 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Acquisition costs for UL and VUL insurance and investment-type products, which include fixed and variable deferred annuities, 
are generally amortized over the lives of the policies in relation to the incidence of estimated gross profits (“EGPs”) from 
surrender charges, investment, mortality net of reinsurance ceded and expense margins and actual realized gain (loss) on 
investments.  Contract lives for UL and VUL policies are estimated to be 40 years and 30 years, respectively, based on the expected 
lives of the contracts.  Contract lives for fixed and variable deferred annuities are generally between 12 and 30 years, while some of 
our fixed multi-year guarantee products have amortization periods equal to the guarantee period.  The front-end load annuity 
product has an assumed life of 25 years.  Longer lives are assigned to those blocks that have demonstrated favorable lapse 
experience.   

Acquisition costs for all traditional contracts, including traditional life insurance, which include individual whole life, group 
business and term life insurance contracts, are amortized over periods of 7 to 30 years on either a straight-line basis or as a level 
percent of premium of the related policies depending on the block of business.  There is currently no DAC, VOBA, DSI or DFEL 
balance or related amortization for fixed and variable payout annuities. 

The carrying amounts of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL are adjusted for the effects of realized and unrealized gains and losses on 
securities classified as AFS and certain derivatives and embedded derivatives.  Amortization expense of DAC, VOBA, DSI and 
DFEL reflects an assumption for an expected level of credit-related investment losses.  When actual credit-related investment 
losses are realized, we recognize a true-up to our DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL amortization within realized gain (loss) on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) reflecting the incremental effect of actual versus expected credit-related investment 
losses.  These actual to expected amortization adjustments can create volatility from period to period in realized gain (loss).   

On a quarterly basis, we may record an adjustment to the amounts included within our Consolidated Balance Sheets for DAC, 
VOBA, DSI and DFEL with an offsetting benefit or charge to revenue or expense for the effect of the difference between future 
EGPs used in the prior quarter and the emergence of actual and updated future EGPs in the current quarter (“retrospective 
unlocking”).  In addition, in the third quarter of each year, we conduct our annual comprehensive review of the assumptions and 
the projection models used for our estimates of future gross profits underlying the amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
and the calculations of the embedded derivatives and reserves for life insurance and annuity products with living benefit and death 
benefit guarantees.  These assumptions include investment margins, mortality, retention, rider utilization and maintenance expenses 
(costs associated with maintaining records relating to insurance and individual and group annuity contracts and with the processing 
of premium collections, deposits, withdrawals and commissions).  Based on our review, the cumulative balances of DAC, VOBA, 
DSI and DFEL, included on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, are adjusted with an offsetting benefit or charge to revenue or 
amortization expense to reflect such change (“prospective unlocking – assumption changes”).  We may have prospective unlocking 
in other quarters as we become aware of information that warrants updating prospective assumptions outside of our annual 
comprehensive review.  We may also identify and implement actuarial modeling refinements (“prospective unlocking – model 
refinements”) that result in increases or decreases to the carrying values of DAC, VOBA, DSI, DFEL, embedded derivatives and 
reserves for life insurance and annuity products with living benefit and death benefit guarantees.  The primary distinction between 
retrospective and prospective unlocking is that retrospective unlocking is driven by the difference between actual gross profits 
compared to EGPs each period, while prospective unlocking is driven by changes in assumptions or projection models related to 
our expectations of future EGPs. 

DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL are reviewed periodically to ensure that the unamortized portion does not exceed the expected 
recoverable amounts.  

Reinsurance 

Our insurance companies enter into reinsurance agreements with other companies in the normal course of business.  Assets and 
liabilities and premiums and benefits from certain reinsurance contracts that grant statutory surplus relief to other insurance 
companies are netted on our Consolidated Balance Sheets and Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), respectively, because 
there is a right of offset.  All other reinsurance agreements are reported on a gross basis on our Consolidated Balance Sheets as an 
asset for amounts recoverable from reinsurers or as a component of other liabilities for amounts, such as premiums, owed to the 
reinsurers, with the exception of Modco agreements for which the right of offset also exists.  Reinsurance premiums and benefits 
paid or provided are accounted for on bases consistent with those used in accounting for the original policies issued and the terms 
of the reinsurance contracts.  Premiums, benefits and DAC are reported net of insurance ceded.   

Goodwill 

We recognize the excess of the purchase price, plus the fair value of any noncontrolling interest in the acquiree, over the fair value 
of identifiable net assets acquired as goodwill.  Goodwill is not amortized, but is reviewed at least annually for indications of value 
impairment, with consideration given to financial performance and other relevant factors.  In addition, certain events, including a 
significant adverse change in legal factors or the business climate, an adverse action or assessment by a regulator or unanticipated 
competition, would cause us to review the carrying amounts of goodwill for impairment.  We are required to perform a two-step 
test in our evaluation of the carrying value of goodwill for impairment.  In Step 1 of the evaluation, the fair value of each reporting 
167 

  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
unit is determined and compared to the carrying value of the reporting unit.  If the fair value is greater than the carrying value, then 
the carrying value is deemed to be sufficient and Step 2 is not required.  If the fair value estimate is less than the carrying value, it is 
an indicator that impairment may exist and Step 2 is required to be performed.  In Step 2, the implied fair value of the reporting 
unit’s goodwill is determined by assigning the reporting unit’s fair value as determined in Step 1 to all of its net assets (recognized 
and unrecognized) as if the reporting unit had been acquired in a business combination at the date of the impairment test.  If the 
implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill is lower than its carrying amount, goodwill is impaired and written down to its 
fair value, and a charge is reported in impairment of intangibles on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).   

Specifically Identifiable Intangible Assets 

Specifically identifiable intangible assets, net of accumulated amortization, are reported in other assets on our Consolidated Balance 
Sheets.  The carrying values of specifically identifiable intangible assets are reviewed at least annually for indicators of impairment 
in value that are other-than-temporary, including unexpected or adverse changes in the following:  the economic or competitive 
environments in which the company operates; profitability analyses; cash flow analyses; and the fair value of the relevant business 
operation.  If there was an indication of impairment, then the cash flow method would be used to measure the impairment, and the 
carrying value would be adjusted as necessary and reported in impairment of intangibles on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income (Loss). 

Sales force intangibles are attributable to the value of the new business distribution system for certain life insurance products 
within the Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment acquired through business combinations.  These assets are amortized on a 
straight-line basis over their useful life of 25 years. 

Specifically identifiable intangible assets also include Federal Communications Commission (“FCC”) licenses and other agreements 
reported within Other Operations.  The FCC licenses are not amortized.   

Other Long-Lived Assets 

Property and equipment owned for company use is included in other assets on our Consolidated Balance Sheets and is carried at 
cost less allowances for depreciation.  Provisions for depreciation of investment real estate and property and equipment owned for 
company use are computed principally on the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, which include 
buildings, computer hardware and software and other property and equipment. 

We periodically review the carrying value of our long-lived assets, including property and equipment, for impairment whenever 
events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be fully recoverable.  For long-lived assets to be 
held and used, impairments are recognized when the carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable and exceeds its fair 
value.  The carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected 
to result from the use and eventual disposition of the asset.  An impairment loss is measured as the amount by which the carrying 
amount of a long-lived asset exceeds its fair value. 

Long-lived assets to be disposed of by abandonment or in an exchange for a similar productive long-lived asset are classified as 
held-for-use until they are disposed. 

Long-lived assets to be sold are classified as held-for-sale and are no longer depreciated.  Certain criteria have to be met in order 
for the long-lived asset to be classified as held-for-sale, including that a sale is probable and expected to occur within one year.  
Long-lived assets classified as held-for-sale are recorded at the lower of their carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell. 

Separate Account Assets and Liabilities 

We maintain separate account assets, which are reported at fair value.  The related liabilities are reported at an amount equivalent to 
the separate account assets.  Investment risks associated with market value changes are borne by the contract holders, except to the 
extent of minimum guarantees made by the Company with respect to certain accounts.  See Note 11 for additional information 
regarding arrangements with contractual guarantees. 

We issue variable annuity contracts through our separate accounts for which investment income and investment gains and losses 
accrue directly to, and investment risk is borne by, the contract holder (traditional variable annuities).  We also issue variable 
annuity and life contracts through separate accounts that include various types of guaranteed death benefit (“GDB”), guaranteed 
withdrawal benefit (“GWB”) and guaranteed income benefit (“GIB”) features.  The GDB features include those where we 
contractually guarantee to the contract holder either:  return of no less than total deposits made to the contract less any partial 
withdrawals (“return of net deposits”); total deposits made to the contract less any partial withdrawals plus a minimum return 
(“minimum return”); or the highest contract value on any contract anniversary date through age 80 minus any payments or 
withdrawals following the contract anniversary (“anniversary contract value”).   

168 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As discussed in Note 6, certain features of these guarantees are accounted for as embedded derivative reserves, whereas other 
guarantees are accounted for as benefit reserves.  Other guarantees contain characteristics of both and are accounted for under an 
approach that calculates the value of the embedded derivative reserve and the benefit reserve based on the specific characteristics 
of each guaranteed living benefit (“GLB”) feature.  We use derivative instruments to hedge our exposure to the risks and earnings 
volatility that result from the embedded derivatives for living benefits in certain of our variable annuity products.  The change in 
fair value of these instruments tends to move in the opposite direction of the change in the value of the associated reserves.  The 
net impact of these changes is reported as a component of realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) in 
a category referred to as GLBs. 

The “market consistent scenarios” used in the determination of the fair value of the GWB liability are similar to those used by an 
investment bank to value derivatives for which the pricing is not transparent and the aftermarket is nonexistent or illiquid.  In our 
calculation, risk-neutral Monte-Carlo simulations resulting in over 10 million scenarios are utilized to value the entire block of 
guarantees.  The market consistent scenario assumptions, as of each valuation date, are those we view to be appropriate for a 
hypothetical market participant.  The market consistent inputs include assumptions for the capital markets (e.g., implied volatilities, 
correlation among indices, risk-free swap curve, etc.), policyholder behavior (e.g., policy lapse, benefit utilization, mortality, etc.), 
risk margins, administrative expenses and a margin for profit.  We believe these assumptions are consistent with those that would 
be used by a market participant; however, as the related markets develop we will continue to reassess our assumptions.  It is 
possible that different valuation techniques and assumptions could produce a materially different estimate of fair value. 

Future Contract Benefits and Other Contract Holder Funds 

Future contract benefits represent liability reserves that we have established and carry based on estimates of how much we will 
need to pay for future benefits and claims.  Other contract holder funds represent liabilities for account values, dividends payable, 
premium deposit funds, undistributed earnings on participating business and other contract holder funds as well the carrying value 
of DFEL discussed above. 

The liabilities for future contract benefits and claim reserves for UL and VUL insurance policies consist of contract account 
balances that accrue to the benefit of the contract holders, excluding surrender charges.  The liabilities for future insurance contract 
benefits and claim reserves for traditional life policies are computed using assumptions for investment yields, mortality and 
withdrawals based principally on generally accepted actuarial methods and assumptions at the time of contract issue.  Investment 
yield assumptions for traditional direct individual life reserves for all contracts range from 2.25% to 7.75% depending on the time 
of contract issue.  The investment yield assumptions for immediate and deferred paid-up annuities range from 1.00% to 13.50%.  
These investment yield assumptions are intended to represent an estimation of the interest rate experience for the period that these 
contract benefits are payable. 

The liabilities for future claim reserves for variable annuity products containing GDB features are calculated by estimating the 
present value of total expected benefit payments over the life of the contract divided by the present value of total expected 
assessments over the life of the contract (“benefit ratio”) multiplied by the cumulative assessments recorded from the contract 
inception through the balance sheet date less the cumulative GDB payments plus interest on the reserves.  The change in the 
reserve for a period is the benefit ratio multiplied by the assessments recorded for the period less GDB claims paid in the period 
plus interest.  If experience or assumption changes result in a new benefit ratio, the reserves are adjusted to reflect the changes in a 
manner similar to the unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DFEL and DSI.   

With respect to our future contract benefits and other contract holder funds, we continually review:  overall reserve position, 
reserving techniques and reinsurance arrangements.  As experience develops and new information becomes known, liabilities are 
adjusted as deemed necessary.  The effects of changes in estimates are included in the operating results for the period in which 
such changes occur. 

The business written or assumed by us includes participating life insurance contracts, under which the contract holder is entitled to 
share in the earnings of such contracts via receipt of dividends.  The dividend scale for participating policies is reviewed annually 
and may be adjusted to reflect recent experience and future expectations. 

UL and VUL products with secondary guarantees represented approximately 40% of permanent life insurance in force as of 
December 31, 2010, and approximately 52% of sales for these products in 2010.  Liabilities for the secondary guarantees on UL-
type products are calculated by multiplying the benefit ratio by the cumulative assessments recorded from contract inception 
through the balance sheet date less the cumulative secondary guarantee benefit payments plus interest.  If experience or assumption 
changes result in a new benefit ratio, the reserves are adjusted to reflect the changes in a manner similar to the unlocking of DAC, 
VOBA, DFEL and DSI.  The accounting for secondary guarantee benefits impacts, and is impacted by, EGPs used to calculate 
amortization of DAC, VOBA, DFEL and DSI. 

Future contract benefits on our Consolidated Balance Sheets include GLB features and remaining guaranteed interest and similar 
contracts that are carried at fair value, which represents approximate surrender value including an estimate for our nonperformance 
169 

  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
risk.  Our Lincoln SmartSecurity® Advantage GWB feature, GIB and 4LATER® features have elements of both insurance benefits 
and embedded derivatives.  We weight these features and their associated reserves accordingly based on their hybrid nature.  We 
classify these items in Level 3 within the hierarchy levels described above in “Fair Value Measurement.” 

The fair value of our indexed annuity contracts is based on their approximate surrender values. 

Borrowed Funds 

LNC’s short-term borrowings are defined as borrowings with contractual or expected maturities of one year or less.  Long-term 
borrowings have contractual or expected maturities greater than one year. 

Deferred Gain on Business Sold Through Reinsurance 

Our reinsurance operations were acquired by Swiss Re Life & Health America, Inc. (“Swiss Re”) in December 2001 through a 
series of indemnity reinsurance transactions.  We are recognizing the gain related to these transactions at the rate that earnings on 
the reinsured business are expected to emerge, over a period of 15 years from the date of sale. 

Commitments and Contingencies 

Contingencies arising from environmental remediation costs, regulatory judgments, claims, assessments, guarantees, litigation, 
recourse reserves, fines, penalties and other sources are recorded when deemed probable and reasonably estimable. 

Insurance Fees 

Insurance fees for investment and interest-sensitive life insurance contracts consist of asset-based fees, cost of insurance charges, 
percent of premium charges, contract administration charges and surrender charges that are assessed against contract holder 
account balances.  Investment products consist primarily of individual and group variable and fixed deferred annuities.  Interest-
sensitive life insurance products include UL insurance, VUL insurance and other interest-sensitive life insurance policies.  These 
products include life insurance sold to individuals, corporate-owned life insurance and bank-owned life insurance.   

In bifurcating the embedded derivative of our GLB features on our variable annuity products, we attribute to the embedded 
derivative the portion of total fees collected from the contract holder that relate to the GLB riders (the “attributed fees”), which 
are not reported within insurance fees on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  These attributed fees represent the 
present value of future claims expected to be paid for the GLB at the inception of the contract plus a margin that a theoretical 
market participant would include for risk/profit and are reported within realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of 
Income (Loss). 

The timing of revenue recognition as it relates to fees assessed on investment contracts is determined based on the nature of such 
fees.  Asset-based fees, cost of insurance and contract administration charges are assessed on a daily or monthly basis and 
recognized as revenue when assessed and earned.  Percent of premium charges are assessed at the time of premium payment and 
recognized as revenue when assessed and earned.  Certain amounts assessed that represent compensation for services to be 
provided in future periods are reported as unearned revenue and recognized in income over the periods benefited.  Surrender 
charges are recognized upon surrender of a contract by the contract holder in accordance with contractual terms. 

For investment and interest-sensitive life insurance contracts, the amounts collected from contract holders are considered deposits 
and are not included in revenue. 

Insurance Premiums 

Our insurance premiums for traditional life insurance and group insurance products are recognized as revenue when due from the 
contract holder.  Our traditional life insurance products include those products with fixed and guaranteed premiums and benefits 
and consist primarily of whole life insurance, limited-payment life insurance, term life insurance and certain annuities with life 
contingencies.  Our group non-medical insurance products consist primarily of term life, disability and dental. 

Net Investment Income 

Dividends and interest income, recorded in net investment income, are recognized when earned.  Amortization of premiums and 
accretion of discounts on investments in debt securities are reflected in net investment income over the contractual terms of the 
investments in a manner that produces a constant effective yield.   

For ABS and MBS, included in the trading and AFS fixed maturity securities portfolios, we recognize income using a constant 
effective yield based on anticipated prepayments and the estimated economic life of the securities.  When actual prepayments differ 
170 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
significantly from originally anticipated prepayments, the retrospective effective yield is recalculated to reflect actual payments to 
date and a catch up adjustment is recorded in the current period.  In addition, the new effective yield, which reflects anticipated 
future payments, is used prospectively.  Any adjustments resulting from changes in effective yield are reflected in net investment 
income on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

Realized Gain (Loss) 

Realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) includes realized gains and losses from the sale of 
investments, write-downs for other-than-temporary impairments of investments, certain derivative and embedded derivative gains 
and losses, gains and losses on the sale of subsidiaries and businesses and net gains and losses on reinsurance embedded derivative 
and trading securities.  Realized gains and losses on the sale of investments are determined using the specific identification method.  
Realized gain (loss) is recognized in net income, net of associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL.  Realized gain 
(loss) is also net of allocations of investment gains and losses to certain contract holders and certain funds withheld on reinsurance 
arrangements for which we have a contractual obligation.   

Other Revenues and Fees 

Other revenues and fees consists primarily of fees attributable to broker-dealer services recorded as earned at the time of sale, 
changes in the market value of our seed capital investments and communications sales recognized as earned, net of agency and 
representative commissions.   

Interest Credited 

Interest credited includes interest credited to contract holder account balances.  Interest crediting rates associated with funds 
invested in the general account of LNC’s insurance subsidiaries during 2008 through 2010 ranged from 3.00% to 9.00%. 

Benefits 

Benefits for UL and other interest-sensitive life insurance products include benefit claims incurred during the period in excess of 
contract account balances.  Benefits also include the change in reserves for life insurance products with secondary guarantee 
benefits and annuity products with guaranteed death benefits.  For traditional life, group health and disability income products, 
benefits are recognized when incurred in a manner consistent with the related premium recognition policies.   

Pension and Other Postretirement Benefit Plans 

Pursuant to the accounting rules for our obligations to employees and agents under our various pension and other postretirement 
benefit plans, we are required to make a number of assumptions to estimate related liabilities and expenses.  We use assumptions 
for the weighted-average discount rate and expected return on plan assets to estimate pension expense.  The discount rate 
assumptions are determined using an analysis of current market information and the projected benefit flows associated with these 
plans.  The expected long-term rate of return on plan assets is based on historical and projected future rates of return on the funds 
invested in the plan.  The calculation of our accumulated postretirement benefit obligation also uses an assumption of weighted-
average annual rate of increase in the per capita cost of covered benefits, which reflects a health care cost trend rate.  See Note 18 
for additional information.   

Stock-Based Compensation 

In general, we expense the fair value of stock awards included in our incentive compensation plans.  As of the date our stock 
awards are approved, the fair value of stock options is determined using a Black-Scholes options valuation methodology, and the 
fair value of other stock awards is based upon the market value of the stock.  The fair value of the awards is expensed over the 
performance or service period, which generally corresponds to the vesting period, and is recognized as an increase to common 
stock in stockholders’ equity.  We classify certain stock awards as liabilities.  For these awards, the settlement value is classified as a 
liability on our consolidated balance sheet and the liability is marked-to-market through net income at the end of each reporting 
period.  Stock-based compensation expense is reflected in underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  See Note 20 for additional information. 

Interest and Debt Expenses 

Interest expense on our short-term and long-term debt is recognized as due and any associated premiums, discounts, and costs are 
amortized (accreted) over the term of the related borrowing utilizing the effective interest method.  In addition, gains or losses 
related to certain derivative instruments associated with debt are recognized in interest expense during the period of the change. 

171 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
Income Taxes 

We file a U.S. consolidated income tax return that includes all of our eligible subsidiaries.  Ineligible subsidiaries file separate 
individual corporate tax returns.  Subsidiaries operating outside of the U.S. are taxed, and income tax expense is recorded based on 
applicable foreign statutes.  Deferred income taxes are recognized, based on enacted rates, when assets and liabilities have different 
values for financial statement and tax reporting purposes.  A valuation allowance is recorded to the extent required to reduce the 
deferred tax asset to an amount that we expect, more likely than not, will be realized.  See Note 7 for additional information.   

Discontinued Operations 

The results of operations of a component of the Company that either has been disposed of or is classified as held-for-sale are 
reported in income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of federal income taxes, for all periods presented if the operations and 
cash flows of the component have been or will be eliminated from our ongoing operations as a result of the disposal transaction 
and we will not have any significant continuing involvement in the operations.  

Foreign Currency Translation 

The balance sheet accounts and income statement items of foreign subsidiaries, reported in functional currencies other than the 
U.S. dollar are translated at the current and average exchange rates for the year, respectively.  Resulting translation adjustments and 
other translation adjustments for foreign currency transactions that affect cash flows are reported in accumulated OCI, a 
component of stockholders’ equity. 

Earnings Per Share 

Basic earnings per share (“EPS”) is computed by dividing earnings available to common shareholders by the average common 
shares outstanding.  Diluted EPS is computed assuming the conversion or exercise of dilutive convertible preferred securities, 
nonvested stock, stock options, performance share units, warrants and non-employee directors’ deferred compensation shares 
outstanding during the year.   

In addition, effective April 30, 2010, we amended our deferred compensation plans, with the exception of the non-employee 
directors’ deferred compensation plan, to allow participants the option to diversify from LNC stock to other investment 
alternatives.  When calculating our weighted-average dilutive shares, we presume the investment option will be settled in cash and 
exclude these shares from our calculation, unless the effect of settlement in shares would be more dilutive to our diluted EPS 
calculation.  Our non-employee directors’ deferred compensation plan was not amended; therefore, participants who select LNC 
stock for measuring the investment return attributable to their deferral amounts will be paid out in LNC stock, and the obligation 
to satisfy it is dilutive.   

For any period where a loss from continuing operations is experienced, shares used in the diluted EPS calculation represent basic 
shares because using diluted shares would be anti-dilutive to the calculation. 

2.  New Accounting Standards 

Adoption of New Accounting Standards 

Compensation – Retirement Benefits Topic 

In March 2007, the FASB amended the Compensation – Retirement Benefits Topic of the FASB ASC requiring an employer to 
recognize a postretirement benefit liability related to a collateral assignment split-dollar life insurance arrangement, if the employer 
has agreed to maintain a life insurance policy during the employee’s retirement.  In addition, based on the split-dollar arrangement, 
an asset is recognized by the employer for the estimated future cash flows to which the employer is entitled.  Effective January 1, 
2008, we adopted this new accounting guidance by recording a $4 million cumulative effect adjustment to the opening balance of 
retained earnings, offset by an increase to our liability for postretirement benefits.  We also recorded notes receivable for the 
amounts due to us from participants under the split-dollar arrangements.  The recording of the notes receivable did not have a 
material effect on our consolidated financial condition or results of operations.   

Consolidations Topic 

In June 2009, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2009-17, “Improvements to Financial Reporting by 
Enterprises Involved with Variable Interest Entities” (“ASU 2009-17”), which amended the consolidation guidance for VIEs.  
Primarily, the quantitative analysis previously required under the Consolidations Topic of the FASB ASC was eliminated and 
replaced with a qualitative approach for identifying the variable interest that has the power to direct the activities that most 
significantly impact the economic performance of the VIE and the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive returns that 

172 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
could potentially be significant to the VIE.  In addition, variable interest holders are required to perform an ongoing reassessment 
of the primary beneficiary of the VIE.  Upon adoption of ASU 2009-17, an entity was required to reconsider prior consolidation 
assessments for VIEs in which the entity continues to hold a variable interest.  In February 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-
10, “Amendments for Certain Investment Funds” (“ASU 2010-10”), which deferred application of the guidance in ASU 2009-17 
for reporting entities with interests in an entity that applies the specialized accounting guidance for investment companies.  

Effective January 1, 2010, we adopted the amendments in ASU 2009-17 and ASU 2010-10, and accordingly reconsidered our 
involvement with all our VIEs and the primary beneficiary of the VIEs.  In accordance with ASU 2009-17, we are the primary 
beneficiary of the VIEs associated with our investments in Credit-Linked Notes (“CLN”), and as such, we consolidated all of the 
assets and liabilities of these VIEs and recorded a cumulative effect adjustment of $169 million, after-tax, to the beginning balance 
of retained earnings as of January 1, 2010.  The following summarizes the increases or (decreases) recorded effective January 1, 
2010, to the categories (in millions) on our Consolidated Balance Sheets for this cumulative effect adjustment: 

Assets 
AFS securities, at fair value: 
   Fixed maturity securities - ABS CLNs 
   VIEs' fixed maturity securities 
            Total assets 

Liabilities 
VIEs' liabilities: 
   Derivative instruments 
   Federal income tax  
      Total VIEs' liabilities 
Other liabilities - deferred income taxes 
         Total liabilities 

Stockholders' Equity 
Retained earnings  
Accumulated OCI - unrealized gain (loss) on AFS securities 
         Total stockholders' equity 
            Total liabilities and stockholders' equity 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 (322)  
 565   
 243   

 225   
 (91)  
 134   
 97   
 231   

 (169)  
 181   
 12   
 243   

In addition, we considered our investments in LPs and other alternative investments, and concluded these investments are within 
the scope of the deferral in ASU 2010-10, and as such they are not subject to the amended consolidation guidance in ASU 2009-17.  
As a result, we will continue to account for our alternative investments consistent with the accounting policy in Note 1.  See Note 4 
for more detail regarding the consolidation of our VIEs. 

Derivatives and Hedging Topic 

In March 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-11, “Scope Exception Related to Embedded Credit Derivatives” (“ASU 2010-
11”), to clarify the scope exception when evaluating an embedded credit derivative, which may potentially require separate 
accounting.  Specifically, ASU 2010-11 states that only an embedded credit derivative feature related to the transfer of credit risk 
that is solely in the form of subordination of one financial instrument to another is not subject to further analysis as a potential 
embedded derivative under the Derivatives and Hedging Topic of the FASB ASC.  Embedded credit derivatives, which no longer 
qualify for the scope exception, are subject to a bifurcation analysis.  The fair value option may be elected for investments within 
the scope of ASU 2010-11 on an instrument-by-instrument basis.  If the fair value option is not elected, preexisting contracts 
acquired, issued or subject to a remeasurement event on or after January 1, 2007 are within the scope of ASU 2010-11.  We 
adopted ASU 2010-11 at the beginning of the interim reporting period ended September 30, 2010.  The adoption did not have a 
material impact on our consolidated financial condition and results of operations. 

Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic 

In January 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-06, “Improving Disclosures about Fair Value Measurements” (“ASU 2010-06”), 
which requires additional disclosure related to the three-level fair value hierarchy.  Entities are required to disclose significant 
transfers in and out of Levels 1 and 2 of the fair value hierarchy, and separately present information related to purchases, sales, 
issuances and settlements in the reconciliation of fair value measurements classified as Level 3.  In addition, ASU 2010-06 amended 

173 

  
 
 
 
    
  
    
  
  
                       
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
                       
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
the fair value disclosure requirement for pension and postretirement benefit plan assets to require this disclosure at the investment 
class level.  We adopted the amendments in ASU 2010-06 effective January 1, 2010, and have prospectively included the required 
disclosures in Note 18 related to benefit plans and Note 22 related to Levels 1 and 2 of the fair value hierarchy.  The disclosures 
related to purchases, sales, issuances and settlements for Level 3 fair value measurements are effective for reporting periods 
beginning after December 15, 2010, and as such, these disclosures will be included in the Notes to Consolidated Financial 
Statements effective January 1, 2011. 

Investments – Debt and Equity Securities Topic 

In April 2009, the FASB replaced the guidance in the Investments – Debt and Equity Securities Topic of the FASB ASC related to 
OTTI.  Under this new accounting guidance, management’s assertion that it has the intent and ability to hold an impaired debt 
security until recovery was replaced by the requirement for management to assert if it either has the intent to sell the debt security 
or if it is more likely than not the entity will be required to sell the debt security before recovery of its amortized cost basis.  Our 
accounting policy for OTTI, included in Note 1, reflects these changes to the accounting guidance adopted by FASB.   

As permitted by the transition guidance, we early adopted these amendments to the Investments – Debt and Equity Securities 
Topic effective January 1, 2009, by recording an increase of $102 million to the opening balance of retained earnings with a 
corresponding decrease to accumulated OCI on our Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity to reclassify the noncredit 
portion of previously other-than-temporarily impaired debt securities held as of January 1, 2009.  The following summarizes the 
components (in millions) for this cumulative effect adjustment: 

Unrealized   
OTTI 
on 
 AFS 

Net 
   Unrealized   
Loss 
on AFS 

Increase in amortized cost of fixed maturity AFS securities 
Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI, and DFEL 
Income tax 
   Net cumulative effect adjustment 

Securities    Securities   
$ 

 34    $ 
 (7)   
 (9)   
 18    $ 

$ 

Total 

 199   
 (42)  
 (55)  
 102   

 165    $ 
 (35)   
 (46)   
 84    $ 

The cumulative effect adjustment was calculated for all debt securities held as of January 1, 2009, for which an OTTI was 
previously recognized, and for which we did not intend to sell the security and it was not more likely than not that we would be 
required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost, by comparing the present value of cash flows expected to be 
received as of January 1, 2009, to the amortized cost basis of the debt securities.  The discount rate used to calculate the present 
value of the cash flows expected to be collected was the rate for each respective debt security in effect before recognizing any 
OTTI.  In addition, because the carrying amounts of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL are adjusted for the effects of realized and 
unrealized gains and losses on fixed maturity AFS securities, we recognized a true-up to our DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
balances for this cumulative effect adjustment. 

The following summarizes the increase to the amortized cost of our fixed maturity AFS securities (in millions) as of January 1, 
2009, resulting from the recognition of the cumulative effect adjustment: 

Corporate bonds 
CMOs 
CDOs 
   Total fixed maturity AFS securities 

$ 

$ 

 131   
 65   
 3   
 199   

The impact of this adoption to both basic and diluted per share amounts for the year ended December 31, 2009, was an increase of 
$0.98 per share. 

In addition, we include on the face of our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) the total OTTI recognized in realized loss, 
with an offset for the amount of noncredit impairments recognized in accumulated OCI.  We disclose the amount of OTTI 
recognized in accumulated OCI in Note 15, and the enhanced disclosures related to OTTI are included in Note 5. 

174 

  
 
 
 
  
 
                       
  
     
  
                       
     
  
                       
  
  
     
  
                       
  
  
  
  
  
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
Receivables Topic 

In July 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-20, “Disclosures about the Credit Quality of Financing Receivables and the 
Allowance for Credit Losses” (“ASU 2010-20”), in order to enhance and expand the financial statement disclosures.  These 
amendments are intended to provide more information regarding the nature of the risk associated with financing receivables and 
how the assessment of the risk is used to estimate the allowance for credit losses.  In addition, expanded disclosures provide more 
information regarding changes recognized during the reporting period to the allowance for credit losses.  Comparative disclosures 
are not required for earlier reporting periods ending prior to the initial adoption date, and the amendments in ASU 2010-20 are 
effective in phases over two reporting periods.  We adopted the amendments related to information required as of the end of the 
reporting period for the reporting period ending December 31, 2010, and have included the required disclosures in Notes 1 and 5.  
Disclosures that provide information about the activity during a reporting period, primarily the allowance for credit losses and 
modifications of financing receivables, are effective for interim and annual reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 
2010, and will be included in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements beginning with the reporting period ending March 31, 
2011. 

Transfers and Servicing Topic 

In June 2009, the FASB issued ASU No. 2009-16, “Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets” (“ASU 2009-16”), which, among 
other things, eliminated the concept of a qualifying special-purpose entity (“SPE”) and removed the scope exception for a 
qualifying SPE from the Consolidations Topic of the FASB ASC.  As a result, previously unconsolidated qualifying SPEs were 
required to be re-evaluated for consolidation by the sponsor or transferor.  We adopted ASU 2009-16 effective January 1, 2010.  
The adoption did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial condition and results of operations.   See 
“Consolidations Topic” above for additional information and Note 4 for further discussion of the accounting treatment of our 
VIEs. 

Future Adoption of New Accounting Standards 

Financial Services – Insurance Industry Topic 

In April 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-15, “How Investments Held through Separate Accounts Affect an Insurer’s 
Consolidation Analysis of Those Investments” (“ASU 2010-15”), to clarify a consolidation issue for insurance entities that hold a 
controlling interest in an investment fund either partially or completely through separate accounts.  ASU 2010-15 concludes that an 
insurance entity would not be required to consider interests held in separate accounts when determining whether or not to 
consolidate an investment fund, unless the separate account interest is held for the benefit of a related party.  If an investment fund 
is consolidated, the portion of the assets representing interests held in separate accounts would be recorded as a separate account 
asset with a corresponding separate account liability.  The remaining investment fund assets would be consolidated in the insurance 
entity’s general accounts.  ASU 2010-15 will be applied retrospectively for fiscal years and interim periods within those fiscal years 
beginning after December 15, 2010, with early application permitted.  We will adopt ASU 2010-15 as of the beginning of the 
reporting period ending March 31, 2011, and do not expect the adoption will have a material impact on our consolidated financial 
condition and results of operations. 

In October 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-26, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Acquiring or Renewing Insurance 
Contracts” (“ASU 2010-26”), which clarifies the types of costs incurred by an insurance entity that can be capitalized in the 
acquisition of insurance contracts.  Only those costs incurred which result directly from and are essential to the successful 
acquisition of new or renewal insurance contracts may be capitalized.  Incremental costs related to unsuccessful attempts to acquire 
insurance contracts must be expensed as incurred. Under ASU 2010-26, the capitalization criteria in the direct-response advertising 
guidance of the Other Assets and Deferred Costs Topic of the FASB ASC must be met in order to capitalize advertising costs.  
The amendments are effective for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2011.  Early adoption is permitted, 
and an entity may elect to apply the guidance prospectively or retrospectively.  We will adopt the provisions of ASU 2010-26 
effective January 1, 2012, and are currently evaluating the impact of the adoption on our consolidated financial condition and 
results of operations. 

Intangibles – Goodwill and Other Topic 

In December 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-28, “When to Perform Step 2 of the Goodwill Impairment Test for Reporting 
Units with Zero or Negative Carrying Amounts” (“ASU 2010-28”).  Generally, reporting units with zero or negative carrying 
amounts will pass Step 1 of the goodwill impairment test as the fair value will exceed carrying value; therefore, goodwill impairment 
is not assessed under Step 2.  ASU 2010-28 modifies Step 1 of the goodwill impairment test for reporting units with zero or 
negative carrying amounts, and requires these reporting units to perform Step 2 of the impairment test to determine if it is more 
likely than not that goodwill impairment exists.  The amendments are effective for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after 
December 15, 2010, and early adoption is not permitted.  Upon adoption of this ASU, all reporting units within scope must be 
evaluated under the new accounting guidance, and any resulting impairment will be recognized as a cumulative-effect adjustment to 
175 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
the opening balance of retained earnings in the period of adoption.  Impairments identified after the period of adoption must be 
recognized in earnings.  We will adopt the amendments in ASU 2010-28 effective as of the beginning of the reporting period 
ending March 31, 2011, and do not expect the adoption will have a material impact on our consolidated financial condition and 
result of operations. 

3.  Acquisitions and Dispositions  

Acquisitions 

Newton County Loan & Savings, FSB (“NCLS”) 

On January 8, 2009, the Office of Thrift Supervision approved our application to become a savings and loan holding company and 
our acquisition of NCLS, a federally regulated savings bank located in Indiana.  We contributed $10 million to the capital of NCLS.  
We closed on our purchase of NCLS on January 15, 2009, which did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial 
condition or results of operations.  

Dispositions 

Discontinued Investment Management Operations 

On August 18, 2009, we entered into a purchase and sale agreement with Macquarie Bank Limited (“MBL”), pursuant to which we 
agreed to sell to MBL all of the outstanding capital stock of Delaware Management Holdings, Inc. (“Delaware”), our subsidiary, 
which provided investment products and services to individuals and institutions.  This transaction closed on January 4, 2010, with 
net of tax proceeds of approximately $405 million.  

In addition, certain of our subsidiaries, including The Lincoln National Life Insurance Company (“LNL”), our primary insurance 
subsidiary, entered into investment advisory agreements with Delaware, pursuant to which Delaware will continue to manage the 
majority of the general account insurance assets of the subsidiaries.  The investment advisory agreements have 10-year terms, and 
we may terminate them without cause, subject to a purchase price adjustment of up to $75 million, the amount of which is 
dependent on the timing of any termination and which agreements are terminated.  The amount of the potential adjustment will 
decline on a pro rata basis over the 10-year term of the advisory agreements.   

Accordingly, in the periods prior to closing, the assets and liabilities of this business were classified as held-for-sale and reported 
within other assets and other liabilities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  The major classes of assets and liabilities held-for-sale 
(in millions) were as follows: 

Assets 
Cash and invested cash 
Premiums and fees receivable 
Goodwill 
Other assets 
   Total assets held-for-sale 

Liabilities 
Other liabilities 
   Total liabilities held-for-sale 

As of  
December 31,   
2009  

   $ 

   $ 

   $ 
   $ 

 159      
 39       
 248      
 61       
 507      

 116      
 116      

176 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                   
  
     
                   
                   
  
     
        
     
     
     
     
        
     
We have reclassified the results of operations of Delaware into income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of federal income 
taxes, for all periods presented on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), and selected amounts (in millions) were as 
follows: 

Discontinued Operations Before Disposal 
Revenues: 
   Investment advisory fees - external 
   Investment advisory fees - internal 
   Other revenues and fees 
   Gain (loss) on sale of business 
      Total revenues 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before disposal, 
   before federal income taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
      Income (loss) from discontinued operations before disposal 

Disposal 
Gain (loss) on disposal, before federal income taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
      Gain (loss) on disposal 
         Income (loss) from discontinued operations 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 -    $ 
 -   
 -   
 4   
 4    $ 

 207    $ 
 84    
 91    
 9    
 391    $ 

 (13)   $ 
 (2)   
 (11)  

 37   
 13   
 24   
 13    $ 

 37     $ 
 18    
 19    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 19     $ 

 268   
 82   
 87   
 9   
 446   

 53   
 19   
 34   

 -   
 -   
 -   
 34   

The income (loss) from discontinued operations for the year ended December 31, 2010, included final cash received toward the 
purchase price for certain institutional taxable fixed income business sold during the fourth quarter 2007, and also reflected stock 
compensation expense attributable to the acceleration of vesting of equity awards for certain Delaware employees upon the sale of 
Delaware. 

Discontinued Lincoln UK Operations 

On June 15, 2009, we entered into a share purchase agreement with SLF of Canada UK Limited (“SLF”) and Sun Life Assurance 
Company of Canada, as the guarantor, pursuant to which we agreed to sell to SLF all of the outstanding capital stock of Lincoln 
National (UK) plc (“Lincoln UK”), our subsidiary, which focused primarily on providing life and retirement income products in 
the United Kingdom.  This transaction closed on October 1, 2009, and we retained Lincoln UK’s pension plan assets and liabilities. 

177 

  
 
 
 
                            
  
                       
 
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
We have reclassified the results of operations of Lincoln UK into income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of federal 
income taxes, for all periods presented on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), and selected amounts (in millions) were 
as follows: 

Discontinued Operations Before Disposal 
Revenues: 
   Insurance premiums 
   Insurance fees 
   Net investment income 
   Realized gain (loss) 
      Total revenues 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before disposal, 
   before federal income taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
      Income (loss) from discontinued operations before disposal 

Disposal 
Gain (loss) on disposal, before federal income taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
      Gain (loss) on disposal 
         Income (loss) from discontinued operations 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 -     $ 
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -     $ 

 -     $ 
 -    
 -    

 41     $ 
 99    
 43    
 (1)   
 182     $ 

 38     $ 
 13    
 25    

 29   
 13   
 16   
 16    $ 

 (219)  
 (105)  
 (114)  
 (89)   $ 

 78   
 172   
 78   
 (10)  
 318   

 58   
 20   
 38   

 -   
 -   
 -   
 38   

The income (loss) from discontinued operations for the year ended December 31, 2010, related to an unfavorable tax return true-
up from the prior year, partially offset by the estimated transaction cost being lower than anticipated.  In addition, the income (loss) 
from discontinued operations for the year ended December 31, 2010, included additional consideration received attributable to a 
post-closing adjustment of the purchase price based upon a final actuarial appraisal of the value of the business as set forth in the 
share purchase agreement, partially offset by the items mentioned above.   

Discontinued Media Operations 

During the fourth quarter of 2007, we entered into definitive agreements to sell our Charlotte radio and television broadcasting 
businesses.  The Charlotte radio broadcasting sale closed on January 31, 2008, and the television broadcasting sale closed on March 
31, 2008.  

178 

  
 
 
                            
  
                       
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
The results of operations of these businesses were reclassified into income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of federal 
income taxes, on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), and selected amounts (in millions) were as follows: 

   For the  
Year Ended    
December 31,   
2008  

   $ 

 22     

   $ 

   $ 

 8     
 3      
 5      

 (12)     
 (2)     
 (10)     
 (5)     

Discontinued Operations Before Disposal 
Communications revenues, net of agency commissions 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before disposal,  
   before federal income taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
      Income (loss) from discontinued operations before disposal 

Disposal 
Gain (loss) on disposal, before federal income taxes 
Federal income tax expense (benefit) 
      Gain (loss) on disposal 
         Income (loss) from discontinued operations 

4.  Variable Interest Entities 

Consolidated VIEs 

In 2006 and 2007, LNL issued two funding agreements and used the proceeds to invest in the Class 1 Notes of two CLN 
structures, which represent special purpose trusts combining asset-backed securities with credit default swaps to produce multi-
class structured securities.  The CLN structures also include subordinated Class 2 Notes, which are held by third parties, and, 
together with the Class 1 Notes, represent 100% of the outstanding notes of the CLN structures.  The entities that issued the 
CLNs are financed by the note holders, and, as such, the note holders participate in the expected losses and residual returns of the 
entities.  Because the note holders do not have voting rights or similar rights, we determined the entities issuing the CLNs are 
VIEs, and as a note holder, our interest represented a variable interest.  As of December 31, 2009, these VIEs were not 
consolidated because under the authoritative accounting guidance at that time, we were not the primary beneficiary of the VIEs 
because the Class 2 Notes absorbed the majority of the expected losses of the CLN structures.  The carrying value of the CLNs as 
of December 31, 2009, was recognized as a fixed maturity security within AFS on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, and the 
funding agreements issued by LNL were reported in other contract holder funds on our Consolidated Balance Sheets as of 
December 31, 2010 and 2009.   

179 

  
 
 
                            
    
                            
                            
                       
  
   
       
   
       
     
     
     
       
   
     
     
     
 
 
 
Effective January 1, 2010, we adopted the new accounting guidance noted above and evaluated the primary beneficiary of the CLN 
structures using qualitative factors.  Based on our evaluation, we concluded that the ability to actively manage the reference 
portfolio underlying the credit default swaps is the most significant activity impacting the performance of the CLN structures, 
because the subordination and participation in credit losses may change.  We concluded that we have the power to direct this 
activity.  In addition, we receive returns from the CLN structures and may absorb losses that could potentially be significant to the 
CLN structures.  As such, we concluded that we are the primary beneficiary of the VIEs associated with the CLNs.  We 
consolidated all of the assets and liabilities of the CLN structures through a cumulative effect adjustment to the beginning balance 
of retained earnings as of January 1, 2010, and recognized the results of operations of these VIEs on our consolidated financial 
statements beginning in the first quarter of 2010.  See “Consolidations Topic” in Note 2 for more detail regarding the effect of the 
adoption.  Asset and liability information (dollars in millions) for these consolidated VIEs included on our Consolidated Balance 
Sheets as of December 31, 2010, was as follows: 

Assets  
Fixed maturity corporate asset-backed credit card loan securities (1) 

Liabilities  
Derivative instruments not designated and not qualifying as hedging instruments:  
   Credit default swaps (2) 
   Contingent forwards (2) 
      Total derivative instruments not designated and not qualifying as hedging  
         instruments  
Federal income tax (2) 
            Total liabilities  

(1)  Reported in VIEs' fixed maturity securities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 
(2)  Reported in VIEs' liabilities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 

For details related to the fixed maturity AFS securities for these VIEs, see Note 5. 

  Number 
of 

     Notional     Carrying 

Instruments     Amounts    

Value 

N/A      $ 

 -    $ 

 584 

 2       $ 
 2        

 600    $ 
 -   

 215 
 (6) 

 4        
N/A       
 4       $ 

 600   
 -   
 600    $ 

 209 
 (77)
 132 

The credit default swaps create variability in the CLN structures and expose the note holders to the credit risk of the referenced 
portfolio.  The contingent forwards transfer a portion of the loss in the underlying fixed maturity corporate asset-backed credit 
card loan securities back to the counterparty after credit losses reach our attachment point. 

The gains (losses) for these consolidated VIEs (in millions) recorded on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) were as 
follows: 

Derivative Instruments Not Designated and Not Qualifying as Hedging Instruments  
Credit default swaps (1) 
Contingent forwards (1) 

   Total derivative instruments not designated and not qualifying as hedging instruments  

(1)  Reported in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

For the  
Year Ended 
December 31, 
2010  

   $ 

   $ 

 25      
 (9)     

 16      

180 

  
 
 
                        
         
  
     
                        
 
                        
       
          
  
     
 
  
                             
        
          
  
     
        
          
  
     
        
          
  
     
  
  
     
  
        
          
  
     
     
  
     
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
                       
   
  
                       
   
  
                      
   
  
                 
  
   
  
     
     
  
     
     
 
The following summarizes information regarding the CLN structures (dollars in millions) as of December 31, 2010: 

Original attachment point (subordination) 
Current attachment point (subordination) 
Maturity 
Current rating of tranche  
Current rating of underlying collateral pool  
Number of defaults in underlying collateral pool 
Number of entities  
Number of countries  

Amount and Date of Issuance    

$400 

   December   

2006 
5.50  %   
4.17  %   
12/20/2016   
B-  
Aa1-B3  
 2   
 123   
 19   

$200 
April 
2007 
2.05  % 
1.48  % 
3/20/2017 
Ba2 
Aaa-B1 
 2 
 99  
 22  

There has been no event of default on the CLNs themselves.  Based upon our analysis, the remaining subordination as represented 
by the attachment point should be sufficient to absorb future credit losses, subject to changing market conditions.  Similar to other 
debt market instruments, our maximum principal loss is limited to our original investment as of December 31, 2010. 

As described more fully in Note 1, we regularly review our investment holdings for OTTIs.  Based upon this review, we believe 
that the fixed maturity corporate asset-backed credit card loan securities were not other-than-temporarily impaired as of December 
31, 2010.   

The following summarizes the exposure of the CLN structures’ underlying collateral by industry and rating as of December 31, 
2010: 

Industry 
Telecommunications 
Financial intermediaries 
Oil and gas 
Utilities 
Chemicals and plastics 
Drugs 
Retailers (except food  
   and drug) 
Industrial equipment 
Sovereign 
Food products 
Conglomerates 
Forest products 
Other industry < 3%  
   (28 industries) 
      Total by industry 

CC 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 

0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 
0.0 % 

0.3 % 
0.3 % 

   Total 

11.2 % 
11.1 % 
6.3 % 
4.5 % 
3.9 % 
3.7 % 

3.5 % 
3.3 % 
3.2 % 
3.2 % 
3.2 % 
3.0 % 

39.9 % 
100.0 % 

AAA 

0.0  %    
0.4  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.3  %    

0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    

AA 
0.0  % 
4.0  % 
1.0  % 
0.0  % 
0.0  % 
2.2  % 

0.0  % 
0.0  % 
0.6  % 
0.3  % 
2.7  % 
0.0  % 

   BBB 

A 
6.4  %    
6.2  %    
1.2  %    
3.1  %    
2.4  %    
1.2  %    

0.6  %    
3.0  %    
1.6  %    
1.8  %    
0.5  %    
0.0  %    

3.7  % 
0.5  % 
4.1  % 
1.4  % 
1.2  % 
0.0  % 

1.8  % 
0.3  % 
1.0  % 
1.1  % 
0.0  % 
1.6  % 

BB 
1.1  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.3  %    
0.0  %    

1.1  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
0.0  %    
1.4  %    

B 
0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    

0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    
0.0 %    

0.0  %    
0.7  %    

2.0  % 
12.8  % 

15.4  %    
43.4  % 

17.3  % 
34.0  % 

3.5  %    
7.4  % 

1.4 %    
1.4 %    

181 

  
 
 
                    
                    
  
  
     
                    
     
                 
  
  
  
 
  
    
  
     
  
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Unconsolidated VIEs 

Effective December 31, 2010, we issued a $500 million long-term senior note in exchange for a corporate bond AFS security of 
like principal and duration from a non-affiliated VIE whose primary activities are to acquire, hold and issue notes and loans, as well 
as pay and collect interest on the notes and loans.  We have concluded that we are not the primary beneficiary of this VIE because 
we do not have power over the activities that most significantly affect its economic performance.  In addition, the terms of the 
senior note provide us with a set-off right to the corporate bond AFS security we purchased from the VIE; therefore, neither 
appears on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  We assigned the corporate bond AFS security to one of our subsidiaries and issued a 
guarantee to our subsidiary for the timely payment of the corporate bond’s principle.   

Through our investment activities, we make passive investments in structured securities issued by VIEs for which we are not the 
manager.  These structured securities include our MBS, which include CMOs, MPTS and CMBS and our ABS CDOs.  We 
have not provided financial or other support with respect to these VIEs other than our original investment.  We have determined 
that we are not the primary beneficiary of these VIEs due to the relative size of our investment in comparison to the principal 
amount of the structured securities issued by the VIEs and the level of credit subordination which reduces our obligation to absorb 
losses or right to receive benefits.  Our maximum exposure to loss on these structured securities is limited to the amortized cost for 
these investments.  We recognize our variable interest in these VIEs at fair value on our consolidated financial statements.  For 
information about these structured securities, see Note 5.    

5.  Investments  

AFS Securities 

Pursuant to the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC, we have categorized AFS securities into a 
three-level hierarchy, based on the priority of the inputs to the respective valuation technique.  The fair value hierarchy gives the 
highest priority to quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1) and the lowest priority to unobservable 
inputs (Level 3), as described in Note 1, which also includes additional disclosures regarding our fair value measurements.  

The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains, losses and OTTI and fair value of AFS securities (in millions) were as follows: 

Fixed Maturity Securities 
Corporate bonds 
U.S. Government bonds 
Foreign government bonds 
MBS: 
   CMOs 
   MPTS 
   CMBS 
ABS CDOs 
State and municipal bonds 
Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities 
VIEs' fixed maturity securities 
      Total fixed maturity securities 

Equity Securities 
Banking securities 
Insurance securities 
Other financial services securities 
Other securities 
      Total equity securities 
         Total AFS securities  

Amortized   
Cost 

As of December 31, 2010 
Gross Unrealized 

   Gains 

   Losses 

   OTTI 

Fair 
   Value 

$ 

 48,863    $ 
 150   
 473   

 3,571    $ 
 17   
 38   

 607     $ 
 2    
 3    

 87    $ 
 -   
 -   

 51,740 
 165 
 508 

 5,693   
 2,980   
 2,144   
 174   
 3,222   
 1,476   
 570   
 65,745   

 324   
 106   
 95   
 22   
 27   
 56   
 14   
 4,270   

 114    
 5    
 180    
 13    
 94    
 135    
 -    
 1,153    

 146   
 -   
 6   
 9   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 248   

 5,757 
 3,081 
 2,053 
 174 
 3,155 
 1,397 
 584 
 68,614 

 61   
 33   
 18   
 67   
 179   
 65,924    $ 

 -    
 4    
 14   
 7    
 25   
 4,295    $ 

 3    
 -    
 -    
 4    
 7    
 1,160     $ 

$ 

 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 248    $ 

 58 
 37 
 32 
 70 
 197 
 68,811 

182 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                          
 
                           
  
                            
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                            
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Fixed Maturity Securities 
Corporate bonds 
U.S. Government bonds 
Foreign government bonds 
MBS: 
   CMOs 
   MPTS 
   CMBS 
ABS: 
   CDOs 
   CLNs 
State and municipal bonds 
Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities 
      Total fixed maturity securities 

Equity Securities 
Banking securities 
Insurance securities 
Other financial services securities 
Other securities 
      Total equity securities 
         Total AFS securities  

Amortized   
Cost 

As of December 31, 2009 
Gross Unrealized 

   Gains 

   Losses 

   OTTI 

Fair 
   Value 

$ 

 44,289    $ 
 186   
 488   

 2,260     $ 
 13    
 26    

 1,117    $ 
 4   
 9   

 71    $ 
 -   
 -   

 45,361 
 195 
 505 

 6,112   
 3,028   
 2,436   

 189   
 600   
 2,009   
 1,420   
 60,757   

 258    
 64    
 49    

 11    
 -    
 14    
 36    
 2,731    

 307   
 26   
 354   

 33   
 278   
 55   
 250   
 2,433   

 157   
 -   
 -   

 9   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 237   

 5,906 
 3,066 
 2,131 

 158 
 322 
 1,968 
 1,206 
 60,818 

 266   
 44   
 22   
 50   
 382   
 61,139    $ 

 -    
 2    
 12    
 7    
 21    
 2,752     $ 

 119   
 -    
 6   
 -    
 125   
 2,558    $ 

$ 

 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 237    $ 

 147 
 46 
 28 
 57 
 278 
 61,096 

The amortized cost and fair value of fixed maturity AFS securities by contractual maturities (in millions) were as follows: 

Due in one year or less 
Due after one year through five years 
Due after five years through ten years 
Due after ten years 
   Subtotal 
MBS 
CDOs 
      Total fixed maturity AFS securities  

As of December 31, 2010 
Amortized   
Cost 

Fair 
   Value 

$ 

$ 

 2,393    $ 
 12,084   
 19,793   
 20,484   
 54,754   
 10,817   
 174    
 65,745    $ 

 2,441 
 12,922 
 21,137 
 21,049 
 57,549 
 10,891 
 174 
 68,614 

Actual maturities may differ from contractual maturities because issuers may have the right to call or pre-pay obligations. 

183 

  
 
 
                          
 
                           
  
                            
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
     
  
    
  
    
 
     
  
     
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
     
  
    
  
    
 
     
  
     
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                            
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                    
  
                   
  
                 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The fair value and gross unrealized losses, including the portion of OTTI recognized in OCI, of AFS securities (dollars in millions), 
aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, 
were as follows: 

Less Than or Equal 
to Twelve Months 

Gross      
   Unrealized   

Fair 
Value 

  Losses and    
   OTTI 

Fair 
   Value 

As of December 31, 2010 
Greater Than 
Twelve Months 

Total 

Gross   

Gross   

  Unrealized  
  Losses and    
   OTTI 

Fair 
   Value 

   Unrealized 
  Losses and 
   OTTI 

Fixed Maturity Securities 
Corporate bonds 
U.S. Government bonds 
Foreign government bonds 
MBS: 
   CMOs 
   MPTS 
   CMBS 
ABS CDOs 
State and municipal bonds 
Hybrid and redeemable  
   preferred securities 
      Total fixed maturity securities 

Equity Securities 
Banking securities 
Other securities 
      Total equity securities 
         Total AFS securities 

$ 

 5,271    $ 
 28   
 19   

 297    $ 
 2    
 -    

 2,007    $ 
 2   
 9   

 397    $ 
 -   
 3   

 7,278    $ 
 30   
 28   

 465   
 190   
 75   
 -    
 1,889   

 203   
 8,140   

 121   
 5    
 8    
 -    
 84    

 10    
 527   

 748   
 2   
 304   
 147   
 27   

 568   
 3,814   

 139   
 -    
 178   
 22   
 10   

 125   
 874   

 1,213   
 192   
 379   
 147   
 1,916   

 771   
 11,954   

 135 
 1,401 

 57   
 3   
 60   
 8,200    $ 

$ 

 3    
 4    
 7    
 534    $ 

 -    
 -    
 -   
 3,814    $ 

 -    
 -    
 -   
 874    $ 

 57   
 3   
 60   
 12,014    $ 

 694 
 2 
 3 

 260 
 5 
 186 
 22 
 94 

 3 
 4 
 7 
 1,408 

 1,237 

Total number of AFS securities in an unrealized loss position 

184 

  
 
 
                            
                       
  
 
  
                       
  
 
                       
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
                       
  
  
  
                       
                       
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                            
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                       
    
  
    
  
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
Less Than or Equal 
to Twelve Months 

Gross      
   Unrealized  

Fair 
Value 

  Losses and    
   OTTI 

Fair 
   Value 

As of December 31, 2009 
Greater Than 
Twelve Months 

Total 

Gross      
  Unrealized   
  Losses and    
   OTTI 

Fair 
   Value 

Gross   

   Unrealized 
  Losses and 
   OTTI 

$ 

 4,375    $ 
 44   
 34   

 236    $ 
 4   
 -   

 5,795    $ 
 3   
 46   

 952    $ 
 -    
 9    

 10,170    $ 
 47   
 80   

 1,188 
 4 
 9 

 404   
 1,293   
 153   

 9    
 -    
 1,203   

 105   
 7,620   

 159   
 14   
 13   

 7    
 -    
 46    

 5    
 484    

 929   
 81   
 656   

 128   
 322   
 54   

 305   
 12    
 341   

 35    
 278   
 9    

 1,333   
 1,374   
 809   

 137   
 322   
 1,257   

 464 
 26 
 354 

 42 
 278 
 55 

 819   
 8,833   

 245   
 2,186   

 924   
 16,453   

 250 
 2,670 

 124   
 4    
 128   
 7,748    $ 

$ 

 119    
 6    
 125    
 609     $ 

 -    
 -    
 -    
 8,833    $ 

 -    
 -    
 -    
 2,186    $ 

 124   
 4   
 128   
 16,581    $ 

 119 
 6 
 125 
 2,795 

 1,735 

Fixed Maturity Securities 
Corporate bonds 
U.S. Government bonds 
Foreign government bonds 
MBS: 
   CMOs 
   MPTS 
   CMBS 
ABS: 
   CDOs 
   CLNs 
State and municipal bonds 
Hybrid and redeemable  
   preferred securities 
      Total fixed maturity securities 

Equity Securities 
Banking securities 
Other financial services securities 
      Total equity securities 
         Total AFS securities 

Total number of AFS securities in an unrealized loss position 

For information regarding our investments in VIEs, see Note 4. 

185 

  
 
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
  
                            
  
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
                       
  
  
  
                       
                       
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                            
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                       
    
  
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
 
We perform detailed analysis on the AFS securities backed by pools of residential and commercial mortgages that are most at risk 
of impairment based on factors discussed in Note 1.  Selected information for these securities in a gross unrealized loss position (in 
millions) was as follows: 

As of December 31, 2010 
Fair 
   Value 

Amortized    
Cost 

   Unrealized 
Loss 

Total 
AFS securities backed by pools of residential mortgages 
AFS securities backed by pools of commercial mortgages 
   Total 

Subject to Detailed Analysis 
AFS securities backed by pools of residential mortgages 
AFS securities backed by pools of commercial mortgages 
   Total 

Total 
AFS securities backed by pools of residential mortgages 
AFS securities backed by pools of commercial mortgages 
   Total 

Subject to Detailed Analysis 
AFS securities backed by pools of residential mortgages 
AFS securities backed by pools of commercial mortgages 
   Total 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 2,539    $ 
 611   
 3,150    $ 

 2,006    $ 
 410   
 2,416    $ 

 2,303    $ 
 185   
 2,488    $ 

 1,776    $ 
 76   
 1,852    $ 

 533 
 201 
 734 

 527 
 109 
 636 

As of December 31, 2009 
Fair 
   Value 

Amortized    
Cost 

   Unrealized 
Loss 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 4,316    $ 
 1,220   
 5,536    $ 

 3,388    $ 
 841   
 4,229    $ 

 928 
 379 
 1,307 

 2,858    $ 
 311   
 3,169    $ 

 1,948    $ 
 164   
 2,112    $ 

 910 
 147 
 1,057 

For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, we recorded OTTI for AFS securities backed by pools of residential and 
commercial mortgages of $163 million and $538 million, pre-tax, respectively, and before associated amortization expense for 
DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL, of which $19 million and $234 million, respectively, was recognized in OCI and $144 million and 
$304 million, respectively, was recognized in net income (loss).  

The fair value, gross unrealized losses, the portion of OTTI recognized in OCI (in millions) and number of AFS securities where 
the fair value had declined and remained below amortized cost by greater than 20% were as follows: 

Less than six months 
Six months or greater, but less than nine months 
Nine months or greater, but less than twelve months 
Twelve months or greater 
   Total 

As of December 31, 2010 

   Number  

Fair 
Value 

Gross Unrealized 

   Losses 

   OTTI 

$ 

$ 

 170    $ 
 60   
 42   
 929   
 1,201    $ 

 73     $ 
 22    
 17    
 520   
 632    $ 

 5   
 -   
 1   
 184   
 190   

of  
   Securities (1) 
 41    
 13    
 13    
 224    
 291    

186 

  
 
 
              
             
             
  
    
  
     
  
     
 
  
  
             
    
  
     
  
     
    
  
     
  
     
 
  
  
 
              
              
              
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
              
     
  
     
  
     
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
 
 
 
                 
   
                 
     
  
  
  
  
     
                 
  
  
                 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Less than six months 
Six months or greater, but less than nine months 
Nine months or greater, but less than twelve months 
Twelve months or greater 
   Total 

As of December 31, 2009 

   Number  

Fair 
Value 

Gross Unrealized 

   Losses 

   OTTI 

$ 

$ 

 434    $ 
 118   
 427   
 1,800   
 2,779    $ 

 130    $ 
 61   
 165   
 1,426   
 1,782    $ 

 4   
 -   
 100   
 124   
 228   

of  
   Securities (1) 
 81    
 25    
 96    
 310    
 512    

(1)  We may reflect a security in more than one aging category based on various purchase dates.   

We regularly review our investment holdings for OTTI.  Our gross unrealized losses on AFS securities as of December 31, 2010, 
decreased $1.4 billion in comparison to December 31, 2009.  This change was attributable to a decline in overall market yields, 
which was driven, in part, by improved credit fundamentals (i.e., market improvement and narrowing credit spreads).  As discussed 
further below, we believe the unrealized loss position as of December 31, 2010, does not represent OTTI as we did not intend to 
sell these fixed maturity AFS securities, it is not more likely than not that we will be required to sell the fixed maturity AFS 
securities before recovery of their amortized cost basis, the estimated future cash flows were equal to or greater than the amortized 
cost basis of the debt securities, or we had the ability and intent to hold the equity AFS securities for a period of time sufficient for 
recovery.   

Based upon this evaluation as of December 31, 2010, management believed we had the ability to generate adequate amounts of 
cash from our normal operations (e.g., insurance premiums and fees and investment income) to meet cash requirements with a 
prudent margin of safety without requiring the sale of our temporarily-impaired securities.  

As of December 31, 2010, the unrealized losses associated with our corporate bond securities were attributable primarily to 
securities that were backed by commercial loans and individual issuer companies.  For our corporate bond securities with 
commercial loans as the underlying collateral, we evaluated the projected credit losses in the underlying collateral and concluded 
that we had sufficient subordination or other credit enhancement when compared with our estimate of credit losses for the 
individual security and we expected to recover the entire amortized cost for each security.  For individual issuers, we performed 
detailed analysis of the financial performance of the issuer and determined that we expected to recover the entire amortized cost 
for each security. 

As of December 31, 2010, the unrealized losses associated with our MBS and ABS CDOs were attributable primarily to collateral 
losses and credit spreads.  We assessed for credit impairment using a cash flow model as discussed above.  The key assumptions 
included default rates, severities and prepayment rates.  We estimated losses for a security by forecasting the underlying loans in 
each transaction.  The forecasted loan performance was used to project cash flows to the various tranches in the structure, as 
applicable.  Our forecasted cash flows also considered, as applicable, independent industry analyst reports and forecasts, sector 
credit ratings and other independent market data.  Based upon our assessment of the expected credit losses of the security given 
the performance of the underlying collateral compared to our subordination or other credit enhancement, we expected to recover 
the entire amortized cost basis of each security. 

As of December 31, 2010, the unrealized losses associated with our hybrid and redeemable preferred securities were attributable 
primarily to wider credit spreads caused by illiquidity in the market and subordination within the capital structure, as well as credit 
risk of specific issuers.  For our hybrid and redeemable preferred securities, we evaluated the financial performance of the issuer 
based upon credit performance and investment ratings and determined we expected to recover the entire amortized cost of each 
security. 

187 

  
 
 
                 
   
                 
     
  
  
  
  
     
                 
  
  
                 
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes in the amount of credit loss of OTTI recognized in net income (loss) where the portion related to other factors was 
recognized in OCI (in millions) on fixed maturity AFS securities were as follows: 

Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Cumulative effect from adoption of new accounting standard 
   Increases attributable to: 
      Credit losses on securities for which an OTTI was not previously recognized 
      Credit losses on securities for which an OTTI was previously recognized 
   Decreases attributable to: 
      Securities sold 
         Balance as of end-of-year 

For the 
Years Ended 
December 31, 

2010 

2009  

$ 

 268    $ 
 -   

 14   
 65   

 (28)  
 319    $ 

$ 

 - 
 31 

 267 
 - 

 (30)
 268 

During the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, we recorded credit losses on securities for which an OTTI was not 
previously recognized as we determined the cash flows expected to be collected would not be sufficient to recover the entire 
amortized cost basis of the debt security.  The credit losses we recorded on securities for which an OTTI was not previously 
recognized were attributable primarily to one or a combination of the following reasons: 

(cid:2)  Failure of the issuer of the security to make scheduled payments; 
(cid:2)  Deterioration of creditworthiness of the issuer; 
(cid:2)  Deterioration of conditions specifically related to the security; 
(cid:2)  Deterioration of fundamentals of the industry in which the issuer operates;  
(cid:2)  Deterioration of fundamentals in the economy including, but not limited to, higher unemployment and lower housing prices; 

and 

(cid:2)  Deterioration of the rating of the security by a rating agency. 

We recognize the OTTI attributed to the noncredit portion as a separate component in OCI referred to as unrealized OTTI on 
AFS securities.   

Details of the amount of credit loss of OTTI recognized in net income (loss) where the portion related to other factors was 
recognized in OCI (in millions), were as follows: 

Corporate bonds 
MBS: 
   CMOs 
   CMBS 
      Total 

As of December 31, 2010 

Gross Unrealized 

Amortized   
Cost 

Gains 

  Losses and   
   OTTI 

Fair 
Value 

   OTTI in 
Credit 
Losses 

$ 

 204    $ 

 3    $ 

 76     $ 

 131    $ 

 60 

 509   
 6    
 719    $ 

$ 

 2   
 -   
 5    $ 

 126   
 5    
 207    $ 

 385   
 1   
 517    $ 

 258 
 1 
 319 

188 

  
 
 
                          
                          
                          
                          
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
             
             
  
  
  
  
             
  
  
             
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Trading Securities 

Trading securities at fair value (in millions) consisted of the following: 

Fixed Maturity Securities 
Corporate bonds 
U.S. Government bonds 
Foreign government bonds 
MBS: 
   CMOs 
   MPTS 
   CMBS 
ABS CDOs 
State and municipal bonds 
Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities 
      Total fixed maturity securities 

Equity Securities 
Other securities 
      Total equity securities 
         Total trading securities 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

 1,801    $ 
 362   
 29   

 1,769 
 370 
 30 

 131   
 124   
 67   
 5   
 24   
 51   
 2,594   

 131 
 61 
 81 
 -  
 20 
 41 
 2,503 

 2   
 2   
 2,596    $ 

 2  
 2  
 2,505 

$ 

The portion of the market adjustment for losses that relate to trading securities still held as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, 
was $93 million, $137 million and $192 million, respectively. 

Mortgage Loans on Real Estate 

Mortgage loans on real estate principally involve commercial real estate.  The commercial loans are geographically diversified 
throughout the U.S. with the largest concentrations in California and Texas, which accounted for approximately 30% and 29% of 
mortgage loans as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. 

The following provides the current and past due composition of our mortgage loans on real estate (in millions): 

Current 
60 to 90 days past due 
Greater than 90 days past due 
Valuation allowance associated with impaired mortgage loans 
Unamortized premium (discount) 
   Total carrying value 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 6,697     $ 
 8   
 40   
 (13)   
 20    
 6,752     $ 

 7,136 
 7 
 29 
 (22)
 28 
 7,178 

The number of impaired mortgage loans, each of which had an associated specific valuation allowance, and the carrying value of 
impaired mortgage loans (dollars in millions) were as follows: 

Number of impaired mortgage loans 

Principal balance of impaired mortgage loans 
Valuation allowance associated with impaired mortgage loans 
   Carrying value of impaired mortgage loans 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

 9   

 75    $ 
 (13)  
 62    $ 

 9 

 56 
 (22)
 34 

$ 

$ 

189 

  
 
 
 
 
                                
                           
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                                
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
                 
                 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                 
                 
 
  
  
  
  
The average carrying value on the impaired mortgage loans (in millions) was as follows: 

Average carrying value for impaired loans 
Interest income recognized on impaired mortgage loans 
Amount of interest income collected on impaired mortgage loans 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 54    $ 
 3   
 3   

 33    $ 
 1   
 1   

 - 
 - 
 - 

As described in Note 1, we use the loan-to-value and debt-service coverage ratios as credit quality indicators for our mortgage 
loans, which were as follows (dollars in millions): 

As of December 31, 2010 

As of December 31, 2009 

   Debt- 
   Service 
   Coverage 
Ratio 
1.62  
1.40  
0.85  
1.06  

%  
 72.1 %   
 22.0 %   
 2.7  %   
 3.2  %   
 100.0 %   

Principal 
Amount 
$ 

 4,863    
 1,484    
 179    
 219    
 6,745    

$ 

Loan-to-Value 
Less than 65% 
65% to 74% 
75% to 100% 
Greater than 100% 
   Total mortgage loans 

Alternative Investments  

   Principal 
   Amount 
   $ 

 4,834   
 1,986   
 208   
 144   
 7,172   

   $ 

   Debt- 
   Service 
   Coverage 
Ratio 
1.67  
1.39  
0.86  
0.73  

%  
 67.4 %   
 27.7 %   
 2.9 %   
 2.0 %   
 100.0 %   

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, alternative investments included investments in approximately 95 and 99 different 
partnerships, respectively, and the portfolio represented less than 1% of our overall invested assets. 

Net Investment Income 

The major categories of net investment income (in millions) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) were as follows: 

Fixed maturity AFS securities 
VIEs' fixed maturity AFS securities 
Equity AFS securities 
Trading securities 
Mortgage loans on real estate 
Real estate 
Standby real estate equity commitments 
Policy loans 
Invested cash 
Commercial mortgage loan prepayment 
   and bond makewhole premiums 
Alternative investments 
Consent fees 
Other investments 
      Investment income 
Investment expense 
         Net investment income 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 3,694    $ 
 14   
 6   
 157   
 424   
 24   
 1   
 169   
 7   

 67   
 93   
 8   
 (3)  
 4,661   
 (120)  
 4,541    $ 

 3,474    $ 
 -   
 8   
 159   
 462   
 18   
 1   
 172   
 15   

 24   
 (55)  
 5   
 9   
 4,292   
 (114)  
 4,178    $ 

 3,337 
 - 
 26 
 166 
 475 
 20 
 3 
 179 
 52 

 29 
 (34)
 5 
 (3)
 4,255 
 (125)
 4,130 

190 

  
 
 
 
                 
                 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
        
  
        
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
        
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
        
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
                   
                   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Realized Gain (Loss) Related to Certain Investments  

The detail of the realized gain (loss) related to certain investments (in millions) was as follows: 

Fixed maturity AFS securities: 
   Gross gains 
   Gross losses 
Equity AFS securities: 
   Gross gains 
   Gross losses 
Gain (loss) on other investments 
Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL  
   and changes in other contract holder funds 
      Total realized gain (loss) related to certain investments 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 107 
 (248)

 161 
 (709)

$ 

 60 
 (1,119)

 9 
 (3)
 (53)

 8 
 (180)

$ 

$ 

 6 
 (27)
 (130)

 161 
 (538)

$ 

 1 
 (163)
 37 

 256 
 (928)

Details underlying write-downs taken as a result of OTTI (in millions) that were recognized in net income (loss) and included in 
realized gain (loss) on AFS securities above, and the portion of OTTI recognized in OCI (in millions) were as follows: 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 (90)   $ 

 (214)   $ 

 (551)

 (65)  
 (41)  
 (1)   
 (5)   
 (202)  

 -    
 -    
 (3)   
 -    
 (3)   
 (205)  

 53        
 (152)   $ 

 (250)  
 -   
 (39)  
 (67)  
 (570)  

 (303)
 (1)
 (1)
 (50)
 (906)

 (10)  
 (8)  
 (3)  
 (6)  
 (27)  
 (597)  
 205 
 (392)   $ 

 (131)
 (1)
 (24)
 (7)
 (163)
 (1,069)
 218 
 (851)

 98     $ 
 (10)  
 88     $ 

 357    $ 
 (82)  
 275    $ 

 - 
 - 
 - 

$ 

$ 

$ 

OTTI Recognized in Net Income (Loss) 
Fixed maturity securities: 
   Corporate bonds 
   MBS: 
      CMOs 
      CMBS 
   ABS CDOs 
   Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities 
         Total fixed maturity securities 

Equity securities: 
   Banking securities 
   Insurance securities 
   Other financial services securities 
   Other securities 
         Total equity securities 
            Gross OTTI recognized in net income (loss) 
           Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
             Net OTTI recognized in net income (loss), pre-tax 

Portion of OTTI Recognized in OCI 
Gross OTTI recognized in OCI 
Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
   Net portion of OTTI recognized in OCI, pre-tax 

191 

  
 
 
 
 
                       
                  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                                
                                
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
                          
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
Determination of Credit Losses on Corporate Bonds and ABS CDOs 

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, we reviewed our corporate bond and ABS CDO portfolios for potential shortfall in 
contractual principal and interest based on numerous subjective and objective inputs.  The factors used to determine the amount of 
credit loss for each individual security, include, but are not limited to, near term risk, substantial discrepancy between book and 
market value, sector or company-specific volatility, negative operating trends and trading levels wider than peers. 

Credit ratings express opinions about the credit quality of a security.  Securities rated investment grade, that is those rated BBB- or 
higher by Standard & Poor’s (“S&P”) Rating Services or Baa3 or higher by Moody’s Investors Service (“Moody’s”), are generally 
considered by the rating agencies and market participants to be low credit risk.  As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, 95% and 94%, 
respectively, of the fair value of our corporate bond portfolio was rated investment grade.  As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the 
portion of our corporate bond portfolio rated below investment grade had an amortized cost of $2.6 billion and $3.1 billion and a 
fair value of $2.4 billion and $2.7 billion, respectively.  As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, 91% and 89%, respectively, of the fair 
value of our ABS CDO portfolio was rated investment grade.  As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the portion of our ABS CDO 
portfolio rated below investment grade had an amortized cost of $24 million and $20 million and fair value of $16 million and $18 
million, respectively.  Based upon the analysis discussed above, we believed as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, that we would 
recover the amortized cost of each investment grade corporate bond and ABS CDO security. 

For securities where we recorded an OTTI recognized in net income (loss) for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, the 
recovery as a percentage of amortized cost was 80% and 72% for corporate bonds, respectively, and 0% and 33% for ABS CDOs, 
respectively.  

Determination of Credit Losses on MBS 

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, default rates were projected by considering underlying MBS loan performance and collateral 
type.  Projected default rates on existing delinquencies vary between 25% to 100% depending on loan type and severity of 
delinquency status.  In addition, we estimate the potential contributions of currently performing loans that may become delinquent 
in the future based on the change in delinquencies and loan liquidations experienced in the recent history.  Finally, we develop a 
default rate timing curve by aggregating the defaults for all loans (delinquent loans, foreclosure and real estate owned and new 
delinquencies from currently performing loans) in the pool to project the future expected cash flows.   

We use certain available loan characteristics such as lien status, loan sizes and occupancy to estimate the loss severity of loans.  
Second lien loans are assigned 100% severity, if defaulted.  For first lien loans, we assume a minimum of 30% severity with higher 
severity assumed for investor properties and further housing price depreciation. 

Payables for Collateral on Investments 

The carrying values of the payables for collateral on investments (in millions) included on our Consolidated Balance Sheets and the 
fair value of the related investments or collateral consisted of the following: 

As of December 31, 2010    As of December 31, 2009 
Carrying 
Value 

Fair 
   Value 

Fair 
   Value 

   Carrying 

Value 

Collateral payable held for derivative investments (1) 
Securities pledged under securities lending agreements (2) 
Securities pledged under reverse repurchase agreements (3) 
Securities pledged for Term Asset-Backed Securities   
   Loan Facility ("TALF") (4) 
Securities pledged for Federal Home Loan Bank of  
   Indianapolis Securities ("FHLBI") (5) 
      Total payables for collateral on investments  

$ 

 800     $ 
 199    
 280    

 800    $ 
 192   
 294   

 617    $ 
 501   
 344   

 280    

 318   

 345   

 617 
 479 
 359 

 386 

 100    
 1,659     $ 

 110   
 1,714    $ 

 100   
 1,907    $ 

 111 
 1,952 

$ 

(1)  We obtain collateral based upon contractual provisions with our counterparties.  These agreements take into consideration the 
counterparties’ credit rating as compared to ours, the fair value of the derivative investments and specified thresholds that 
once exceeded result in the receipt of cash that is typically invested in cash and invested cash.  See Note 6 for details about 
maximum collateral potentially required to post on our credit default swaps. 

192 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                    
                    
  
  
                    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
     
  
 
  
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
     
  
 
  
  
 
(2)  Our pledged securities under securities lending agreements are included in fixed maturity AFS securities on our Consolidated 
Balance Sheets.  We generally obtain collateral in an amount equal to 102% and 105% of the fair value of the domestic and 
foreign securities, respectively.  We value collateral daily and obtain additional collateral when deemed appropriate.  The cash 
received in our securities lending program is typically invested in cash and invested cash or fixed maturity AFS securities. 
(3)  Our pledged securities under reverse repurchase agreements are included in fixed maturity AFS securities on our Consolidated 
Balance Sheets.  We obtain collateral in an amount equal to 95% of the fair value of the securities, and our agreements with 
third parties contain contractual provisions to allow for additional collateral to be obtained when necessary.  The cash received 
in our reverse repurchase program is typically invested in fixed maturity AFS securities. 

(4)  Our pledged securities for TALF are included in fixed maturity AFS securities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  We obtain 
collateral in an amount that has typically averaged 90% of the fair value of the TALF securities.  The cash received in these 
transactions is invested in fixed maturity AFS securities. 

(5)  Our pledged securities for FHLBI are included in fixed maturity AFS securities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  We 

generally obtain collateral in an amount equal to 85% to 95% of the fair value of the FHLBI securities.  The cash received in 
these transactions is typically invested in cash and invested cash or fixed maturity AFS securities. 

Increase (decrease) in payables for collateral on investments (in millions) included on the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows 
consisted of the following: 

Collateral payable held for derivative investments 
Securities pledged under securities lending agreements 
Securities pledged under reverse repurchase agreements 
Securities pledged for TALF 
Securities pledged for FHLBI 
   Total increase (decrease) in payables for collateral on investments 

Investment Commitments 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 183    $ 
 (302)  
 (64)   
 (65)   
 -    
 (248)   $ 

 (2,192)   $ 
 74   
 (126)  
 345   
 100   
 (1,799)   $ 

 2,809 
 (228)
 (10)
 - 
 - 
 2,571 

As of December 31, 2010, our investment commitments were $907 million, which included $292 million of LPs, $53 million of 
standby commitments to purchase real estate upon completion and leasing, $359 million of private placements and $203 million of 
mortgage loans. 

Concentrations of Financial Instruments 

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, our most significant investments in one issuer were our investments in securities issued by the 
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation with a fair value of $5.0 billion and $4.8 billion, or 6% of our invested assets portfolio, 
respectively, and our investments in securities issued by Fannie Mae with a fair value of $2.9 billion and $3.0 billion, or 3% and 4% 
of our invested assets portfolio, respectively.  These investments are included in corporate bonds in the tables above. 

As of December 31, 2010, our most significant investments in one industry were our investment securities in the electric industry 
with a fair value of $6.7 billion, or 8% of our invested assets portfolio, and our investment securities in the CMO industry with a 
fair value of $6.5 billion, or 8% of our invested assets portfolio.  As of December 31, 2009, our most significant investment in one 
industry was our investment securities in the CMO industry with a fair value of $6.9 billion, or 9% of the invested assets portfolio.  
We utilized the industry classifications to obtain the concentration of financial instruments amount; as such, this amount will not 
agree to the AFS securities table above. 

193 

  
 
 
 
                       
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
6.  Derivative Instruments 

Types of Derivative Instruments and Derivative Strategies 

We maintain an overall risk management strategy that incorporates the use of derivative instruments to minimize significant 
unplanned fluctuations in earnings that are caused by interest rate risk, foreign currency exchange risk, equity market risk, default 
risk, basis risk and credit risk.  We assess these risks by continually identifying and monitoring changes in interest rate exposure, 
foreign currency exposure, equity market exposure and credit exposure that may adversely impact expected future cash flows and 
by evaluating hedging opportunities.  Derivative instruments that are used as part of our interest rate risk management strategy 
include interest rate swap agreements, interest rate cap agreements, interest rate futures, forward-starting interest rate swaps, 
consumer price index swaps, interest rate cap corridors, treasury locks and reverse treasury locks.  Derivative instruments that are 
used as part of our foreign currency risk management strategy include foreign currency swaps, currency futures and foreign 
currency forwards.  Call options based on our stock, call options based on the S&P 500 Index® (“S&P 500”), total return swaps, 
variance swaps, equity collars, put options and equity futures are used as part of our equity market risk management strategy.  We 
also use credit default swaps as part of our credit risk management strategy.     

We evaluate and recognize our derivative instruments in accordance with the Derivatives and Hedging Topic of the FASB ASC.  
As of December 31, 2010, we had derivative instruments that were designated and qualifying as cash flow hedges and fair value 
hedges.  We also had embedded derivatives that were economic hedges, but were not designed to meet the requirements for hedge 
accounting treatment.  See Note 1 for a detailed discussion of the accounting treatment for derivative instruments. 

Our derivative instruments are monitored by our Asset Liability Management Committee and our Equity Risk Management 
Committee as part of those committees’ oversight of our derivative activities.  Our committees are responsible for implementing 
various hedging strategies that are developed through their analysis of financial simulation models and other internal and industry 
sources.  The resulting hedging strategies are incorporated into our overall risk management strategies.   

We use a hedging strategy designed to mitigate the risk and income statement volatility caused by changes in the equity markets, 
interest rates and volatility associated with living benefit guarantees offered in our variable annuity products, including the Lincoln 
SmartSecurity® Advantage GWB feature, the 4LATER® Advantage GIB feature and the i4LIFE® Advantage GIB feature.  See 
“GLB Reserves Embedded Derivatives” below for further details. 

See Note 22 for additional disclosures related to the fair value of our financial instruments and see Note 4 for derivative 
instruments related to our consolidated VIEs. 

194 

  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
We have derivative instruments with off-balance-sheet risks whose notional or contract amounts exceed the credit exposure.  
Outstanding derivative instruments with off-balance-sheet risks (dollars in millions) were as follows: 

   Number           

of 

    Notional 
Instruments    Amounts 

As of December 31, 2010 
Asset Carrying 
 or Fair Value 

(Liability) Carrying 
 or Fair Value 

   Gain 

Loss 

   Gain 

Loss 

Derivative Instruments   
   Designated and Qualifying  
   as Hedging Instruments  
Cash flow hedges:  
   Interest rate swap agreements (1) 
   Forward-starting interest rate swaps  (1)    
   Foreign currency swaps (1) 
   Reverse treasury locks  (1) 
      Total cash flow hedges  
Fair value hedges:  
   Interest rate swap agreements (2) 
      Total fair value hedges  
         Total derivative instruments   
            designated and qualifying as   
            hedging instruments  
Derivative Instruments Not   
   Designated and Not Qualifying  
   as Hedging Instruments  
Interest rate cap agreements (1) 
Interest rate futures (1) 
Equity futures (1) 
Interest rate swap agreements (1) 
Credit default swaps (3) 
Total return swaps (1) 
Put options (1) 
Call options (based on S&P 500) (1) 
Variance swaps (1) 
Currency futures (1) 
Consumer price index swaps (1) 
Interest rate cap corridors (1) 
Embedded derivatives:  
   Deferred compensation plans (3) 
   Indexed annuity contracts (4) 
   GLB reserves (4) 
   Reinsurance related  (5) 
   AFS securities  (1) 
         Total derivative instruments not  
            designated and not qualifying as      
            hedging instruments  
               Total derivative instruments  

 151      $ 
 2        
 13        
 5        
 171        

 926    $ 
 150   
 340   
 1,000   
 2,416   

 24     $ 
 1    
 43    
 11    
 79    

 (71)   $ 
 -    
 (13)  
 (5)   
 (89)  

 11        
 11        

 1,675   
 1,675   

 106    
 106    

 (51)  
 (51)  

 -    $ 
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   

 -   
 -   

 - 
 -  
 - 
 -  
 -  

 (55) 
 (55) 

 182        

 4,091   

 185    

 (140)  

 -   

 (55) 

 3        
 15,881        
 13,375        
 81        
 9        
 9        
 145        
 544        
 50        
 1,589        
 100        
 73        

 6        
 132,260        
 305,962        
 -        
 1        

 150   
 2,251   
 907   
 7,955   
 145   
 900   
 5,602   
 4,083   
 30    
 219   
 55    
 8,050   

 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 34    
 -    
 -    
 1,151    
 301    
 46    
 -    
 -    
 52    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 15    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 (511)  
 -    
 (21)  
 -    
 -    
 (34)  
 -    
 (2)  
 -   

 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    

 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   

 -   
 -   
 518   
 -   
 -   

 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 (16) 
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 - 
 - 

 (363) 
 (497) 
 (926) 
 (102) 
 -  

 470,088        
 470,270      $ 

 30,347   
 34,438    $ 

 1,599    
 1,784     $ 

 (568)  
 (708)   $ 

 518   
 518    $ 

 (1,904) 
 (1,959) 

195 

  
 
 
                                        
  
                                        
  
  
                                  
  
  
  
                          
     
   
  
  
  
  
       
  
       
  
  
  
       
  
    
  
  
       
  
       
  
  
  
       
  
    
  
  
       
  
       
  
  
  
       
  
    
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
       
   
 
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
       
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
   Number           

of 

    Notional 
Instruments    Amounts 

As of December 31, 2009 
Asset Carrying 
 or Fair Value 

(Liability) Carrying 
 or Fair Value 

   Gain 

Loss 

   Gain 

Loss 

Derivative Instruments   
   Designated and Qualifying  
   as Hedging Instruments  
Cash flow hedges:  
   Interest rate swap agreements (1) 
   Foreign currency swaps (1) 
      Total cash flow hedges  
Fair value hedges:  
   Interest rate swap agreements (2) 
   Equity collars (1) 
      Total fair value hedges  
         Total derivative instruments   
            designated and qualifying as   
            hedging instruments  
Derivative Instruments Not   
   Designated and Not Qualifying  
   as Hedging Instruments  
Interest rate cap agreements (1) 
Interest rate futures (1) 
Equity futures (1) 
Interest rate swap agreements (1) 
Foreign currency forwards (1) 
Credit default swaps (3) 
Total return swaps (1) 
Put options (1) 
Call options (based on LNC stock) (1) 
Call options (based on S&P 500) (1) 
Variance swaps (1) 
Currency futures (1) 
Embedded derivatives:  
   Deferred compensation plans (3) 
   Indexed annuity contracts (4) 
   GLB reserves (4) 
   Reinsurance related  (5) 
   AFS securities (1) 
         Total derivative instruments not  
            designated and not qualifying as        
            hedging instruments  
              Total derivative instruments  

 85      $ 
 13     
 98     

 620    $ 
 340   
 960   

 24    $ 
 33   
 57   

 (45)   $ 
 (19)  
 (64)  

 1     
 1     
 2     

 375   
 49   
 424   

 54   
 135   
 189   

 -    
 -    
 -    

 -    $ 
 -   
 -   

 -   
 -   
 -   

 - 
 - 
 - 

 (54)
 - 
 (54)

 100     

 1,384   

 246   

 (64)  

 -   

 (54)

 20     
 19,073     
 21,149     
 81     
 19     
 14     
 2     
 114     
 1     
 559     
 36     
 3,664     

 6     
 108,119     
 261,309     
 -     
 2     

 1,000   
 2,333   
 1,147   
 6,232   
 1,016   
 220    
 156   
 4,093   
 9   
 3,440   
 26   
 505   

 -   
 -   
 -    
 -   
 -   

 -    
 -    
 -    
 63   
 12   
 -    
 -   
 934   
 -   
 215   
 66   
 -   

 -   
 -   
 -    
 -   
 19   

 -    
 -    
 -    
 (349)  
 (110)  
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 (22)  
 -    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    

 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   

 -   
 -   
 308   
 -   
 -   

 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 (65)
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 

 (332)
 (419)
 (984)
 (31)
 - 

 414,168     
 414,268      $ 

 20,177   
 21,561    $ 

 1,309   
 1,555    $ 

 (481)  
 (545)   $ 

 308   
 308    $ 

 (1,831)
 (1,885)

(1)  Reported in derivative investments on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 
(2)  The asset is reported in derivative investments and the liability in long-term debt on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 
(3)  Reported in other liabilities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 
(4)  Reported in future contract benefits on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 
(5)  Reported in reinsurance related embedded derivatives on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 

196 

  
 
 
                                        
  
                                        
  
  
                                        
  
  
  
                               
     
   
  
  
  
  
       
  
       
 
  
  
       
  
    
  
  
       
  
       
 
  
  
       
  
    
  
  
       
  
       
 
  
  
       
  
    
    
          
 
    
 
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
    
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
    
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The maturity of the notional amounts of derivative instruments (in millions) was as follows: 

Remaining Life as of December 31, 2010 

Less Than    
1 Year  

1 – 5 
   Years 

6 – 10 
   Years 

11 – 30 
   Years 

   Over 30 
   Years 

   Total 

Derivative Instruments  
   Designated and Qualifying  
   as Hedging Instruments 
Cash flow hedges: 
   Interest rate swap agreements 
   Forward-starting interest rate swaps  
   Foreign currency swaps 
   Reverse treasury locks  
         Total cash flow hedges 
Fair value hedges: 
   Interest rate swap agreements 
         Total fair value hedges 
            Total derivative instruments  
               designated and qualifying as  
               hedging instruments 
Derivative Instruments Not  
   Designated and Not Qualifying  
   as Hedging Instruments 
Interest rate cap agreements 
Interest rate futures 
Equity futures 
Interest rate swap agreements 
Credit default swaps 
Total return swaps 
Put options 
Call options (based on S&P 500) 
Variance swaps 
Currency futures 
Consumer price index swaps 
Interest rate cap corridors 
            Total derivative instruments  
               not designated and not  
               qualifying as hedging  
               instruments 
                Total derivative instruments  
                  with notional amounts 

$ 

 24    $ 
 -    
 -    
 -    
 24   

 84     $ 
 -    
 124   
 850   
 1,058   

 264    $ 
 50   
 135   
 150   
 599   

 540    $ 
 100   
 81   
 -    
 721   

 14    $ 
 -   
 -   
 -   
 14   

 -    
 -    

 800   
 800   

 -    
 -    

 875   
 875   

 -   
 -   

 926 
 150 
 340 
 1,000 
 2,416 

 1,675 
 1,675 

 24   

 1,858   

 599   

 1,596   

 14   

 4,091 

 150   
 2,251   
 907   
 203   
 -    
 650   
 -    
 3,311   
 -    
 219   
 4   
 -    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 1,819   
 40    
 250   
 1,589   
 772   
 4    
 -    
 15    
 -    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 1,719   
 105   
 -   
 4,013   
 -   
 26   
 -   
 15   
 8,050   

 -    
 -    
 -    
 4,214   
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 -    
 19   
 -    

 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 2   
 -   

 150 
 2,251 
 907 
 7,955 
 145 
 900 
 5,602 
 4,083 
 30 
 219 
 55 
 8,050 

 7,695   

 4,489   

 13,928   

 4,233   

 2   

 30,347 

$ 

 7,719    $ 

 6,347    $ 

 14,527    $ 

 5,829    $ 

 16    $ 

 34,438 

197 

  
 
 
                            
                         
  
  
  
  
  
                            
  
  
     
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
    
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
 
    
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
The change in our unrealized gain (loss) on derivative instruments in accumulated OCI (in millions) was as follows: 

Unrealized Gain (Loss) on Derivative Instruments  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Other comprehensive income (loss):  
   Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the year:  
      Cash flow hedges:  
         Interest rate swap agreements  
         Forward-starting interest rate swaps  
         Foreign currency swaps  
         Treasury locks  
      Fair value hedges:  
         Interest rate swap agreements  
         Equity collars  
      Net investment in a foreign subsidiary  
      AFS securities embedded derivatives  
   Change in foreign exchange rate adjustment  
   Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL  
   Income tax benefit (expense)  
   Less:  
      Reclassification adjustment for gains (losses) included in net income (loss):  
         Cash flow hedges:  
            Interest rate swap agreements (1) 
            Foreign currency swaps (1) 
            Treasury locks (2) 
         Fair value hedges:  
            Interest rate swap agreements (2) 
      Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL  
      Income tax benefit (expense)  
              Balance as of end-of-year  

For the Years Ended 
December 31, 

2010  

2009  

$ 

 11    $ 

 127 

 (24)  
 1   
 14   
 (24)  

 4   
 -   
 -   
 2   
 4   
 (4)  
 9   

 4   
 2   
 4   

 4   
 (1)  
 (5)  
 (15)   $ 

$ 

 30 
 - 
 (52)
 - 

 4 
 (28)
 (74)
 - 
 - 
 22 
 (13)

 4 
 - 
 - 

 4 
 - 
 (3)
 11 

(1)  The OCI offset is reported within net investment income on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 
(2)  The OCI offset is reported within interest and debt expense on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

198 

  
 
 
 
                             
                             
                             
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The gains (losses) on derivative instruments (in millions) recorded within income (loss) from continuing operations on our 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) were as follows: 

Derivative Instruments Designated and   
   Qualifying as Hedging Instruments  
Cash flow hedges:  
   Interest rate swap agreements (1) 
   Forward-starting interest rate swaps (1) 
   Foreign currency swaps (1) 
      Total cash flow hedges  
Fair value hedges:  
   Interest rate swap agreements (2) 
   Equity collars (3) 
      Total fair value hedges  
         Total derivative instruments designated  
             and qualifying as hedging instruments  
Derivative Instruments Not Designated and  
   Not Qualifying as Hedging Instruments  
Interest rate cap agreements (3) 
Interest rate futures (3) 
Equity futures (3) 
Interest rate swap agreements (3) 
Foreign currency forwards (1) 
Credit default swaps - fees (1) 
Credit default swaps - marked-to-market (3) 
Total return swaps (4) 
Put options (3) 
Call options (based on LNC stock) (3) 
Call options (based on S&P 500) (3) 
Variance swaps (3) 
Currency futures (3) 

Consumer price index swaps (3) 
Interest rate cap corridors (1) 
Embedded derivatives:  
   Deferred compensation plans (4) 
   Indexed annuity contracts (3) 
   GLB reserves (3) 
   Reinsurance related (3) 
   AFS securities (1) 
         Total derivative instruments not designated   
            and not qualifying as hedging instruments  
              Total derivative instruments  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 4     $ 
 (1)   
 2    
 5    

 3    $ 
 -   
 1   
 4   

 42    
 15    
 57    

 62    

 17   
 1   
 18   

 22   

 -    
 183        
 (248)      
 (8)   
 43        
 1        
 7    
 (118)  
 (217)  
 -    
 114       
 (34)  
 (13)  

 (1)   
 5       

 (34)  
 (81)  
 268    
 (71)  
 2    

 -   
 (693)      
 (683)      
 (860)  
 (98)      

 1 
 (37)  
 35   
 (664)  
 -   
 84 
 (116)  
 (7)  

 -   
 - 

 (63)  
 (75)  
 2,228   
 (62)  
 -   

 (3)
 - 
 (1)
 (4)

 6 
 (18)
 (12)

 (16)

 (1)
 708 
 174 
 1,167 
 - 
 1 
 (51)
 (69)
 1,082 
 (8)
 (214)
 268 
 - 

 - 
 - 

 43 
 196 
 (2,625)
 251 
 - 

 (202)  
 (140)   $ 

 (1,010)  

 (988)   $ 

 922 
 906 

$ 

(1)  Reported in net investment income on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 
(2)  Reported in interest and debt expense on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 
(3)  Reported in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 
(4)  Reported in underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

The location in the Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) where the gains (losses) are recorded for each of the derivative 
instruments discussed below is specified in the table above. 

199 

  
 
 
                            
                 
        
   
  
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
       
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
Derivative Instruments Designated and Qualifying as Cash Flow Hedges  

Gains (losses) (in millions) on derivative instruments designated and qualifying as cash flow hedges were as follows:  

Ineffective portion recognized in realized gain (loss) 
Gain (loss) recognized as a component of OCI with the offset  
  to net investment income 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 -     $ 

 (1)   $ 

 6   

 4   

 1 

 2 

As of December 31, 2010, $19 million of the deferred net losses on derivative instruments in accumulated OCI were expected to 
be reclassified to earnings during the next twelve months.  This reclassification would be due primarily to the interest rate variances 
related to the interest rate swap agreements. 

For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, there were no material reclassifications to earnings due to hedged firm 
commitments no longer deemed probable or due to hedged forecasted transactions that had not occurred by the end of the 
originally specified time period. 

Interest Rate Swap Agreements 

We use a portion of our interest rate swap agreements to hedge the interest rate risk of our exposure to floating rate bond coupon 
payments, replicating a fixed rate bond.  An interest rate swap is a contractual agreement to exchange payments at one or more 
times based on the actual or expected price level, performance or value of one or more underlying interest rates.  We are required 
to pay the counterparty the stream of variable interest payments based on the coupon payments from the hedged bonds, and in 
turn, receive a fixed payment from the counterparty at a predetermined interest rate.  The gains or losses on interest rate swaps 
hedging our interest rate exposure on floating rate bond coupon payments are reclassified from accumulated OCI to net income 
(loss) as the related bond interest is accrued.   

In addition, we use interest rate swap agreements to hedge our exposure to fixed rate bond coupon payments and the change in 
underlying asset values as interest rates fluctuate. 

As of December 31, 2010, the latest maturity date for which we were hedging our exposure to the variability in future cash flows 
for these instruments was June 2042. 

Forward-Starting Interest Rate Swaps 

We use forward-starting interest rate swaps to hedge our exposure to interest rate fluctuations related to the forecasted purchase of 
certain AFS securities.  The gains or losses resulting from the swap agreements are recorded in OCI.  The gains or losses are 
reclassified from accumulated OCI to earnings over the life of the assets once the assets are purchased.  

Foreign Currency Swaps 

We use foreign currency swaps, which are traded over-the-counter, to hedge some of the foreign exchange risk of investments in 
fixed maturity securities denominated in foreign currencies.  A foreign currency swap is a contractual agreement to exchange the 
currencies of two different countries at a specified rate of exchange in the future.  The gains or losses on foreign currency swaps 
hedging foreign exchange risk exposure on foreign currency bond coupon payments are reclassified from accumulated OCI to net 
income (loss) as the related bond interest is accrued.   

As of December 31, 2010, the latest maturity date for which we were hedging our exposure to the variability in future cash flows 
for these instruments was July 2022. 

Reverse Treasury Locks 

We use reverse treasury locks to hedge the interest rate exposure related to the purchase of fixed rate securities or the anticipated 
future cash flows of floating rate fixed maturity securities due to changes in interest rates.  These derivatives are primarily 
structured to hedge interest rate risk inherent in the assumptions used to price certain liabilities.  The gains or losses resulting from 
the reverse treasury locks are recorded in OCI and are reclassified from accumulated OCI to earnings over the life of the assets 
once the assets are purchased. 

200 

  
 
 
 
                       
                  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Derivative Instruments Designated and Qualifying as Fair Value Hedges  

Gains (losses) (in millions) on derivative instruments designated and qualifying as fair value hedges were as follows: 

Ineffective portion recognized in realized gain (loss) 
Gain (loss) recognized as a component of OCI with the offset  
   to interest expense 

Interest Rate Swap Agreements 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 1     $ 

 1    $ 

 (18)

 4    

 4   

 4 

We used a portion of our interest rate swap agreements to hedge the risk of paying a higher fixed rate of interest on junior 
subordinated debentures issued to affiliated trusts, which were redeemed during 2010, and on senior debt than would be paid on 
long-term debt based on current interest rates in the marketplace.  We are required to pay the counterparty a stream of variable 
interest payments based on the referenced index, and in turn, we receive a fixed payment from the counterparty at a predetermined 
interest rate.  The net receipts or payments earned or owed from these interest rate swap agreements are recorded as an adjustment 
to the interest expense for the debt being hedged in the period it occurs.  The changes in fair value of the interest rate swap 
agreements are recorded as an offsetting adjustment to derivative investments and long-term debt on our Consolidated Balance 
Sheets.   

Equity Collars 

We used an equity collar on four million shares of our Bank of America (“BOA”) stock holdings.  The equity collar was structured 
such that we purchased a put option on the BOA stock and simultaneously sold a call option with the identical maturity date as the 
put option.  This structure effectively protected us from a price decline in the stock while allowing us to participate in some of the 
upside if the BOA stock appreciated over the time of the transaction.  With the equity collar in place, we were able to pledge the 
BOA stock as collateral, which then allowed us to advance a substantial portion of the stock’s value, effectively monetizing the 
stock for liquidity purposes.  On the scheduled settlement date, September 7, 2010, we settled the equity collar by delivering four 
million shares of BOA stock, which resulted in a $15 million gain, reported within realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated 
Statements of Income (Loss).   

Derivative Instruments Designated and Qualifying as a Hedge in a Net Investment in a Foreign Subsidiary  

We used foreign currency forwards to hedge a portion of our net investment in our former foreign subsidiary, Lincoln UK.  The 
foreign currency forwards obligated us to deliver a specified amount of currency at a future date at a specified exchange rate.  The 
foreign currency forwards outstanding as of December 31, 2008, were terminated on February 5, 2009.  The gain on the 
termination of the foreign currency forwards of $38 million was recorded in OCI.  During 2009, we entered into foreign currency 
forwards to hedge a significant portion of the foreign currency fluctuations associated with the expected proceeds from the sale of 
Lincoln UK.  The loss upon the termination of these foreign currency contracts of $12 million was also recorded in OCI, and, 
subsequently, the OCI amounts above were recorded in income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of federal income taxes 
on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) when the derivative instrument was terminated.  

Derivative Instruments Not Designated and Not Qualifying as Hedging Instruments 

We use various other derivative instruments for risk management and income generation purposes that either do not qualify for 
hedge accounting treatment or have not currently been designated by us for hedge accounting treatment. 

Interest Rate Cap Agreements 

We use interest rate cap agreements to provide a level of protection from the effect of rising interest rates for our annuity business, 
within our Retirement Solutions – Annuities and Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution segments.  Interest rate cap 
agreements entitle us to receive quarterly payments from the counterparties on specified future reset dates, contingent on future 
interest rates.  For each cap, the amount of such quarterly payments, if any, is determined by the excess of a market interest rate 
over a specified cap rate, multiplied by the notional amount divided by four.  Our interest rate cap agreements provide an 
economic hedge of our annuity business.     

201 

  
 
 
 
                       
                  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
Interest Rate Futures and Equity Futures 

We use interest rate futures and equity futures contracts to hedge the liability exposure on certain options in variable annuity 
products.  These futures contracts require payment between our counterparty and us on a daily basis for changes in the futures 
index price. 

Interest Rate Swap Agreements 

We use interest rate swap agreements to hedge the liability exposure on certain options in variable annuity products. 

Foreign Currency Forwards 

We used foreign currency forward contracts to hedge dividends received from our former subsidiary, Lincoln UK.  The foreign 
currency forward contracts obligated us to deliver a specified amount of currency at a future date and a specified exchange rate. 

Credit Default Swaps 

We buy credit default swaps to hedge against a drop in bond prices due to credit concerns of certain bond issuers.  A credit default 
swap allows us to put the bond back to the counterparty at par upon a default event by the bond issuer.  A default event is defined 
as bankruptcy, failure to pay, obligation acceleration or restructuring.     

We sold credit default swaps to offer credit protection to contract holders and investors.  The credit default swaps hedge the 
contract holders and investors against a drop in bond prices due to credit concerns of certain bond issuers.  A credit default swap 
allows the investor to put the bond back to us at par upon a default event by the bond issuer.  A default event is defined as 
bankruptcy, failure to pay, obligation acceleration or restructuring.   

Information related to our open credit default swap liabilities for which we are the seller (dollars in millions) was as follows: 

As of December 31, 2010 

Reason      Nature  

for  

of   

     Credit  
     Rating of       Number 
   Underlying     

of  

Fair  

Maturity  

   Entering  

   Recourse     Obligation (1)   Instruments     Value (2) 

   Maximum 
   Potential 
   Payout 

12/20/2012 (3) 

12/20/2016 (4) 

03/20/2017 (4) 

  (5) 

  (5) 

  (5) 

  (6) 

  (6) 

  (6) 

      BBB+ 

BBB 

      BBB- 

 4      $ 

 3        

 2        
 9      $ 

 -     $ 

 (12)   

 (4)   
 (16)    $ 

 40 

 65 

 40 
 145 

As of December 31, 2009 

  Credit  

Reason      Nature  

for  

of   

     Rating of       Number 
   Underlying     

of  

Fair  

Maturity  

   Entering  

   Recourse     Obligation (1)   Instruments     Value (2) 

   Maximum 
   Potential 
   Payout 

03/20/2010 (3) 

06/20/2010 (3) 

12/20/2012 (3) 

12/20/2016 (4) 

03/20/2017 (4) 

  (7) 

  (7) 

  (5) 

  (5) 

  (5) 

  (6) 

  (6) 

  (6) 

  (6) 

  (6) 

A- 

A  

      BBB+ 

B- 

BB+ 

 1      $ 

 1        

 4        

 2        

 6        
 14      $ 

 -     $ 

 -    

 -    

 (19)   

 (46)   
 (65)    $ 

 10 

 10 

 40 

 48 

 112 
 220 

(1)  Represents average credit ratings based on the midpoint of the applicable ratings among Moody’s, S&P and Fitch Ratings, as 

scaled to the corresponding S&P ratings. 

(2)  Broker quotes are used to determine the market value of credit default swaps. 
(3)  These credit default swaps were sold to our contract holders, prior to 2007, where we determined there was a spread versus 

premium mismatch. 

202 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
   
 
  
  
   
    
  
        
   
  
  
  
   
 
        
   
   
 
  
     
  
  
    
  
  
     
    
  
  
  
    
  
   
 
  
  
   
       
      
 
   
 
  
  
   
  
    
  
           
  
    
   
 
           
   
 
  
     
  
  
     
    
  
  
     
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
     
    
  
  
  
     
    
  
   
 
  
  
   
       
      
 
(4)  These credit default swaps were sold to a counter-party of the consolidated VIEs as discussed in Note 1. 
(5)  Credit default swap was entered into in order to generate income by providing default protection in return for a quarterly 

payment. 

(6)  Seller does not have the right to demand indemnification or compensation from third parties in case of a loss (payment) on the 

contract.  

(7)  Credit default swap was entered into in order to generate income by providing protection on a highly rated basket of securities 

in return for a quarterly payment.  

Details underlying the associated collateral of our open credit default swaps for which we are the seller, if credit risk related 
contingent features were triggered (in millions) are as follows: 

Maximum potential payout 
Less: 
   Counterparty thresholds 
      Maximum collateral potentially required to post 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

 145    $ 

 220  

 10   
 135    $ 

 30  
 190  

$ 

Certain of our credit default swap agreements contain contractual provisions that allow for the netting of collateral with our 
counterparties related to all of our collateralized financing transactions that we have outstanding.  If these netting agreements were 
not in place, we would have been required to post approximately $6 million as of December 31, 2010, after considering the fair 
values of the associated investments counterparties’ credit ratings as compared to ours and specified thresholds that once exceeded 
result in the payment of cash.   

Total Return Swaps 

We use total return swaps to hedge a portion of the liability related to our deferred compensation plans.  We receive the total 
return on a portfolio of indexes and pay a floating rate of interest.   

Put Options 

We use put options to hedge the liability exposure on certain options in variable annuity products.  Put options are contracts that 
require counterparties to pay us at a specified future date the amount, if any, by which a specified equity index is less than the strike 
rate stated in the agreement, applied to a notional amount.  

Call Options (Based on LNC Stock) 

We use call options on our stock to hedge the expected increase in liabilities arising from SARs granted on our stock.     

Call Options (Based on S&P 500) 

We use indexed annuity contracts to permit the holder to elect an interest rate return or an equity market component, where 
interest credited to the contracts is linked to the performance of the S&P 500.  Contract holders may elect to rebalance index 
options at renewal dates, either annually or biannually.  As of each renewal date, we have the opportunity to re-price the indexed 
component by establishing participation rates, subject to minimum guarantees.  We purchase call options that are highly correlated 
to the portfolio allocation decisions of our contract holders, such that we are economically hedged with respect to equity returns 
for the current reset period.  The mark-to-market of the options held generally offsets the change in value of the embedded 
derivative within the indexed annuity.   

Variance Swaps 

We use variance swaps to hedge the liability exposure on certain options in variable annuity products.  Variance swaps are contracts 
entered into at no cost and whose payoff is the difference between the realized variance rate of an underlying index and the fixed 
variance rate determined as of inception. 

Currency Futures 

We use currency futures to hedge foreign exchange risk associated with certain options in variable annuity products.  Currency 
futures exchange one currency for another at a specified date in the future at a specified exchange rate.   

203 

  
 
 
 
                       
                       
  
    
  
    
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer Price Index Swaps 

We use consumer price index swaps to hedge the liability exposure on certain options in fixed/indexed annuity products.  
Consumer price index swaps are contracts entered into at no cost and whose payoff is the difference between the consumer price 
index inflation rate and the fixed rate determined as of inception. 

Interest Rate Cap Corridors 

We use interest rate cap corridors to provide a level of protection from the effect of rising interest rates for our annuity business, 
within our Retirement Solutions – Annuities and Retirement Solutions – Defined Contribution segments.  Interest rate cap 
corridors involve purchasing an interest rate cap at a specific cap rate and selling an interest rate cap with a higher cap rate.  For 
each corridor, the amount of quarterly payments, if any, is determined by the rate at which the underlying index rate resets above 
the original capped rate.  The corridor limits the benefit the purchaser can receive as the related interest rate index rises above the 
higher capped rate.  There is no additional liability to us other than the purchase price associated with the interest rate cap corridor.  
Our interest rate cap corridors provide an economic hedge of our annuity business.   

Deferred Compensation Plans Embedded Derivatives 

We have certain deferred compensation plans that have embedded derivative instruments.  The liability related to these plans varies 
based on the investment options selected by the participants.  The liability related to certain investment options selected by the 
participants is marked-to-market through net income (loss). 

Indexed Annuity Contracts Embedded Derivatives 

We distribute indexed annuity contracts that permit the holder to elect an interest rate return or an equity market component, 
where interest credited to the contracts is linked to the performance of the S&P 500.  This feature represents an embedded 
derivative under the Derivatives and Hedging Topic of the FASB ASC.  Contract holders may elect to rebalance index options at 
renewal dates, either annually or biannually.  As of each renewal date, we have the opportunity to re-price the indexed component 
by establishing participation rates, subject to minimum guarantees.  We purchase S&P 500 call options that are highly correlated to 
the portfolio allocation decisions of our contract holders, such that we are economically hedged with respect to equity returns for 
the current reset period.  The mark-to-market of the options held generally offsets the change in value of the embedded derivative 
within the indexed annuity.  

GLB Reserves Embedded Derivatives 

We have certain GLB variable annuity products with GWB and GIB features that are embedded derivatives.  Certain features of 
these guarantees, notably our GIB, 4LATER® and Lincoln Lifetime IncomeSMAdvantage features, have elements of both insurance 
benefits accounted for under the Financial Services – Insurance – Claim Costs and Liabilities for Future Policy Benefits Subtopic 
of the FASB ASC (“benefit reserves”) and embedded derivatives accounted for under the Derivatives and Hedging and the Fair 
Value Measurements and Disclosures Topics of the FASB ASC (“embedded derivative reserves”).  We calculate the value of the 
embedded derivative reserve and the benefit reserve based on the specific characteristics of each GLB feature.  As of December 
31, 2010, we had $30.3 billion of account values that were attributable to variable annuities with a GWB feature and $11.4 billion of 
account values that were attributable to variable annuities with a GIB feature.  

We use a hedging strategy designed to mitigate the risk and income statement volatility caused by changes in the equity markets, 
interest rates and volatility associated with GWB and GIB features.  The hedging strategy is designed such that changes in the value 
of the hedge contracts due to changes in equity markets, interest rates and implied volatilities move in the opposite direction of 
changes in embedded derivative reserves of the GWB and GIB caused by those same factors.  As part of our current hedging 
program, equity markets, interest rates and volatility in market conditions are monitored on a daily basis. We rebalance our hedge 
positions based upon changes in these factors as needed.  While we actively manage our hedge positions, these hedge positions 
may not be totally effective in offsetting changes in the embedded derivative reserve due to, among other things, differences in 
timing between when a market exposure changes and corresponding changes to the hedge positions, extreme swings in the equity 
markets and interest rates, market volatility, contract holder behavior, divergence between the performance of the underlying funds 
and the hedging indices, divergence between the actual and expected performance of the hedge instruments and our ability to 
purchase hedging instruments at prices consistent with our desired risk and return trade-off.   

204 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
Reinsurance Related Embedded Derivatives 

We have certain modified coinsurance arrangements and coinsurance with funds withheld reinsurance arrangements with 
embedded derivatives related to the withheld assets of the related funds.  These derivatives are considered total return swaps with 
contractual returns that are attributable to various assets and liabilities associated with these reinsurance arrangements.  Changes in 
the estimated fair value of these derivatives as they occur are recorded through net income (loss).  Offsetting these amounts are 
corresponding changes in the estimated fair value of trading securities in portfolios that support these arrangements.  During the 
first quarter of 2009, the portion of the embedded derivative liability related to the funds withheld reinsurance agreement on our 
disability income business was released due to the rescission of the underlying reinsurance agreement.  See Note 14 for information 
regarding the rescission of the underlying reinsurance agreement. 

AFS Securities Embedded Derivatives 

We own various debt securities that either contain call options to exchange the debt security for other specified securities of the 
borrower, usually common stock, or contain call options to receive the return on equity-like indexes.  The change in fair value of 
these embedded derivatives flows through net income (loss). 

Credit Risk 

We are exposed to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by our counterparties on various derivative contracts and reflect 
assumptions regarding the credit or nonperformance risk.  The nonperformance risk is based upon assumptions for each 
counterparty’s credit spread over the estimated weighted average life of the counterparty exposure less collateral held.  As of 
December 31, 2010, the nonperformance risk adjustment was $10 million.  The credit risk associated with such agreements is 
minimized by purchasing such agreements from financial institutions with long-standing, superior performance records.  
Additionally, we maintain a policy of requiring all derivative contracts to be governed by an International Swaps and Derivatives 
Association (“ISDA”) Master Agreement.  We are required to maintain minimum ratings as a matter of routine practice in 
negotiating ISDA agreements.  Under some ISDA agreements, our insurance subsidiaries have agreed to maintain certain financial 
strength or claims-paying ratings.  A downgrade below these levels could result in termination of the derivatives contract, at which 
time any amounts payable by us would be dependent on the market value of the underlying derivative contract.  In certain 
transactions, we and the counterparty have entered into a collateral support agreement requiring either party to post collateral when 
net exposures exceed pre-determined thresholds.  These thresholds vary by counterparty and credit rating.  We do not believe the 
inclusion of termination or collateralization events pose any material threat to the liquidity position of any insurance subsidiary of 
the Company.  The amount of such exposure is essentially the net replacement cost or market value less collateral held for such 
agreements with each counterparty if the net market value is in our favor.  As of December 31, 2010, the exposure was $184 
million.   

The amounts recognized (in millions) by S&P credit rating of counterparty, for which we had the right to reclaim cash collateral or 
were obligated to return cash collateral, were as follows: 

S&P 
Credit  
Rating of 
Counterparty 

AAA 
AA 
AA- 
A+ 
A 

   As of December 31, 2010     As of December 31, 2009 
   Collateral      Collateral      Collateral      Collateral  
   Posted by 
   Posted by 
LNC 
   Counter- 
(Held by 
   Counter- 
   Party) 

   (Held by 
   (Held by     Counter- 
   LNC) 

   Posted by 
LNC 

   Posted by 
   Counter- 

   (Held by 

Party) 

LNC) 

Party 

Party 

   $ 

   $ 

 1    $ 
 99   
 65   
 548   
 436   
 1,149    $ 

 -     $ 
 -    
 -    
 (76)   
 (223)   
 (299)    $ 

 3    $ 

 140   
 272   
 171   
 331   
 917    $ 

 -  
 -  
 (17) 
 (13) 
 (240)
 (270)

205 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
7.  Federal Income Taxes 

The federal income tax expense (benefit) on continuing operations (in millions) was as follows: 

Current 
Deferred 
   Federal income tax expense (benefit) 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 (244)    $ 
 527   
 283    $ 

 (751)   $ 
 645   
 (106)   $ 

 452 
 (579)
 (127)

A reconciliation of the effective tax rate differences (in millions) was as follows: 

Tax rate times pre-tax income 
Effect of: 
   Tax-preferred investment income 
   Tax credits 
   Goodwill 
   Prior year tax return adjustment 
   Other items 
      Federal income tax expense (benefit) 

Effective tax rate 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 432    $ 

 (182)   $ 

 (48)  

 (105)   
 (42)   
 -    
 (12)   
 10    
 283    $ 

 (92)  
 (46)  
 238   
 (60)  
 36   
 (106)   $ 

23  %  

20  %   

 (81)  
 (25)  
 58   
 (35)  
 4    
 (127)  

N/M 

$ 

The effective tax rate is a ratio of tax expense over pre-tax income (loss).  Because the pre-tax loss of $137 million resulted in a tax 
benefit of $127 million in 2008, the effective tax rate was not meaningful.  The effective tax rate on pre-tax income (loss) from 
continuing operations was lower than the prevailing corporate federal income tax rate.  Included in tax-preferred investment 
income was a separate account dividends-received deduction benefit of $94 million, $77 million and $81 million for the years ended 
December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, exclusive of any prior years’ tax return adjustment. 

The federal income tax asset (liability) (in millions), which is included in other liabilities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, was as 
follows: 

Current 
Deferred 
   Total federal income tax asset (liability) 

   As of December 31, 
2009  

2010  

$ 

$ 

 (77)    $ 

 (1,326)   
 (1,403)    $ 

 (191)  
 (351)  
 (542)  

206 

  
 
 
 
                       
  
                   
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                     
  
                     
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
                   
  
                   
  
  
  
  
Significant components of our deferred tax assets and liabilities (in millions) were as follows: 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

Deferred Tax Assets 
Future contract benefits and other contract holder funds  $ 
Deferred gain on business sold through reinsurance 
Net unrealized loss on AFS securities 
Reinsurance related embedded derivative asset 
Investments 
Compensation and benefit plans 
Net operating loss 
Net capital loss 
VIE 
Other 
   Total deferred tax assets 
Deferred Tax Liabilities 
DAC 
VOBA 
Net unrealized gain on AFS securities 
Net unrealized gain on trading securities 
Intangibles 
Other 
   Total deferred tax liabilities 
      Net deferred tax asset (liability) 

$ 

 1,210    $ 
 160   
 -    
 22   
 591   
 272   
 -    
 97   
 77   
 108   
 2,537   

 1,977   
 483   
 1,014   
 90   
 165   
 134   
 3,863   
 (1,326)   $ 

 1,731   
 172    
 8    
 11    
 191    
 280    
 37    
 112    
 -    
 126    
 2,668   

 1,949   
 734    
 -    
 57    
 178    
 101    
 3,019   
 (351)  

The application of GAAP requires us to evaluate the recoverability of our deferred tax assets and establish a valuation allowance if 
necessary, to reduce our deferred tax asset to an amount that is more likely than not to be realizable.  Considerable judgment and 
the use of estimates are required in determining whether a valuation allowance is necessary, and if so, the amount of such valuation 
allowance.  In evaluating the need for a valuation allowance, we consider many factors, including: the nature and character of the 
deferred tax assets and liabilities; taxable income in prior carryback years; future reversals of temporary differences; the length of 
time carryovers can be utilized; and any tax planning strategies we would employ to avoid a tax benefit from expiring 
unused.  Although realization is not assured, management believes as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, it is more likely than not 
that the deferred tax assets, including our capital loss deferred tax asset, will be realized. 

As of December 31, 2010, LNC had net capital loss carryforwards of $276 million which will expire in 2014.  LNC believes that it 
is more likely than not that the capital losses will be fully utilized within the allowable carryforward period. 

207 

  
 
 
 
                          
  
                          
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, $223 million and $224 million of our unrecognized tax benefits presented below, if 
recognized, would have impacted our income tax expense and our effective tax rate.  We anticipate a change to our unrecognized 
tax benefits during 2011 in the range of zero to $134 million.  A reconciliation of the unrecognized tax benefits (in millions) was as 
follows: 

Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Increases for prior year tax positions 
   Decreases for prior year tax positions 
   Increases for current year tax positions 
   Decreases for current year tax positions 
   Decreases for settlements with taxing authorities 
   Decreases for lapse of statute of limitations 
      Balance as of end-of-year 

For the 
 Years Ended 
December 31, 

2010  

2009  

$ 

$ 

 336    $ 
 2    
 (7)   
 9    
 (8)   
 (10)   
 (4)   
 318    $ 

 302   
 29   
 (1)   
 13   
 (7)  
 -   
 -    
 336   

We recognize interest and penalties accrued, if any, related to unrecognized tax benefits as a component of tax expense.  For the 
years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, we recognized interest and penalty expense related to uncertain tax positions of $7 
million, $12 million and $2 million, respectively.  We had accrued interest and penalty expense related to the unrecognized tax 
benefits of $93 million and $86 million as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.   

In the normal course of business, we are subject to examination by taxing authorities throughout the U.S. and the U.K.  At any 
given time, we may be under examination by state, local or non-U.S. income tax authorities.  During the third quarter of 2008, the 
Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) completed its examination for tax years 2003 and 2004 resulting in a proposed assessment.  
During the second quarter of 2010, the IRS completed its examination for tax years 2005 and 2006 resulting in a proposed 
assessment.  Also, during the second quarter of 2010, the IRS completed its examination of tax year 2006 for the former Jefferson-
Pilot Corporation (“JP”) and its subsidiaries.  We believe a portion of the assessments is inconsistent with the existing law and are 
protesting it through the established IRS appeals process.  We do not anticipate that any adjustments that might result from such 
audits would be material to our consolidated results of operations or financial condition.  We are currently under audit by the IRS 
for years 2007 and 2008.  The JP subsidiaries acquired in the April 2006 merger are subject to a separate IRS examination cycle.  
For the former JP subsidiaries, JP Life Insurance Company and JP Financial Insurance Company, the IRS is examining the tax 
years ended April 1, 2007, and July 1, 2007, respectively. 

208 

  
 
 
                          
  
                     
 
                     
 
                     
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
8.  DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 

During the fourth quarter of 2008, we recorded a decrease to income (loss) from continuing operations totaling $263 million or 
$1.01 per diluted share, for a reversion to the mean prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL as a result of 
significant and sustained declines in the equity markets during 2008.  During 2010 and 2009, we did not have a reversion to the 
mean prospective unlocking of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL.  The pre-tax impact for these items is included within the 
prospective unlocking line items in the changes in DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL tables below. 

Changes in DAC (in millions) were as follows: 

Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Transfer of business to a third party 
   Deferrals 
   Amortization, net of interest: 
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes 
      Prospective unlocking - model refinements 
      Retrospective unlocking  
      Other amortization, net of interest 
   Adjustment related to realized (gains) losses 
   Adjustment related to unrealized (gains) losses  
         Balance as of end-of-year 

Changes in VOBA (in millions) were as follows: 

Balance as of beginning-of-year  
   Transfer of business to a third party  
   Deferrals  
   Amortization:  
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes  
      Prospective unlocking - model refinements  
      Retrospective unlocking   
      Other amortization  
   Accretion of interest (1) 
   Adjustment related to realized (gains) losses  
   Adjustment related to unrealized (gains) losses   
         Balance as of end-of-year  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 7,424    $ 
 -    
 1,641   

 7,640    $ 
 (37)  
 1,621   

 5,999 
 -  
 1,814 

 (31)   
 145    
 41    
 (930)   
 (50)   
 (688)   
 7,552    $ 

 (15)  
 -    
 19   
 (746)  
 148   
 (1,206)  
 7,424    $ 

 (368)
 44  
 (136)
 (672)
 (203)
 1,162 
 7,640 

$ 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 2,086    $ 
 -    
 26    

 3,762    $ 
 (255)  
 30   

 2,809 
 -  
 40  

 (41)   
 (7)   
 11    
 (361)   
 89    
 (8)   
 (417)   
 1,378    $ 

 (20)  
 -   
 (44)  
 (349)  
 102   
 43   
 (1,183)  
 2,086    $ 

 (7) 
 6  
 (38)
 (335)
 116 
 98  
 1,073 
 3,762 

$ 

(1)  The interest accrual rates utilized to calculate the accretion of interest ranged from 3.50% to 7.25%. 

Estimated future amortization of VOBA, net of interest (in millions), as of December 31, 2010, was as follows: 

2011  
2012  
2013  
2014  
2015  

$ 

 213   
 187   
 166   
 140   
 126   

209 

  
 
 
 
 
                       
  
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                             
  
                             
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
Changes in DSI (in millions) were as follows: 

Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Deferrals 
   Amortization, net of interest: 
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes 
      Retrospective unlocking  
      Other amortization, net of interest 
   Adjustment related to realized (gains) losses 
   Adjustment related to unrealized (gains) losses 
        Balance as of end-of-year 

Changes in DFEL (in millions) were as follows: 

Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Transfer of business to a third party 
   Deferrals 
   Amortization, net of interest: 
      Prospective unlocking - assumption changes 
      Prospective unlocking - model refinements 
      Retrospective unlocking  
      Other amortization, net of interest 
   Adjustment related to realized (gains) losses 
   Adjustment related to unrealized (gains) losses 
        Balance as of end-of-year 

9.  Reinsurance 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 323    $ 
 66    

 263    $ 
 76   

 (3)   
 7    
 (58)   
 (8)   
 (41)   
 286    $ 

 -   
 5   
 (33)  
 13   
 (1)  
 323    $ 

$ 

 279 
 96  

 (37) 
 (7) 
 (22) 
 (46) 
 -  
 263  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

   $ 

 1,338 
 -    
 546   

 1,019    $ 
 (11)  
 497   

 804 
 -  
 427 

 (57)   
 56    
 (23)   
 (173)   
 (8)   
 (177)   
 1,502    $ 

 (22)  
 -    
 (16)  
 (129)  
 (1)  
 1   
 1,338    $ 

 (37)
 25 
 (42)
 (141)
 (17)
 -  
 1,019  

$ 

The following summarizes reinsurance amounts (in millions) recorded on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss), 
excluding amounts attributable to the indemnity reinsurance transaction with Swiss Re: 

Direct insurance premiums and fees  
Reinsurance assumed 
Reinsurance ceded 
   Total insurance premiums and fees, net 

Direct insurance benefits  
Reinsurance recoveries netted against benefits 
   Total benefits, net 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 6,599 
 13  
 (1,202)
 5,410 

 4,423 
 (1,093)
 3,330 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 6,124 
 10  
 (1,148)
 4,986 

 3,893 
 (1,057)
 2,836 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 $ 

 6,071  
 18  
 (1,004) 
 5,085  

 4,134  
 (1,075) 
 3,059  

Our insurance companies cede insurance to other companies.  The portion of risks exceeding each company’s retention limit is 
reinsured with other insurers.  We seek reinsurance coverage within the businesses that sell life insurance and annuities in order to 
limit our exposure to mortality losses and enhance our capital management.  

210 

  
 
 
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
                              
  
                        
  
  
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
  
    
    
 
Under our reinsurance program, we reinsure approximately 40% to 45% of the mortality risk on newly issued non-term life 
insurance contracts and approximately 35% of total mortality risk including term insurance contracts.  Our policy for this program 
is to retain no more than $10 million on a single insured life issued on fixed, VUL and term life insurance contracts.  The retention 
per single insured life for corporate-owned life insurance is $2 million.  Portions of our deferred annuity business have been 
reinsured on a Modco basis with other companies to limit our exposure to interest rate risks.  As of December 31, 2010, the 
reserves associated with these reinsurance arrangements totaled $935 million.  To cover products other than life insurance, we 
acquire other reinsurance coverages with retentions and limits.  

We obtain reinsurance from a diverse group of reinsurers, and we monitor concentration as well as financial strength ratings of our 
principal reinsurers.  Our reinsurance operations were acquired by Swiss Re in December 2001, through a series of indemnity   
reinsurance transactions.  Swiss Re represents our largest reinsurance exposure.  Under the indemnity reinsurance agreements, 
Swiss Re reinsured certain of our liabilities and obligations.  As we are not relieved of our legal liability to the ceding companies, the 
liabilities and obligations associated with the reinsured contracts remain on our Consolidated Balance Sheets with a corresponding 
reinsurance receivable from Swiss Re, which totaled $3.0 billion as of December 31, 2010.  Swiss Re has funded a trust, with a 
balance of $1.7 billion as of December 31, 2010, to support this business.  As a result of Swiss Re’s S&P financial strength rating 
dropping below AA-, Swiss Re funded an additional trust during the fourth quarter of 2009 with a balance of approximately $1.5 
billion as of December 31, 2010, to support this business.  In addition to various remedies that we would have in the event of a 
default by Swiss Re, we continue to hold assets in support of certain of the transferred reserves.  These assets are reported within 
trading securities or mortgage loans on real estate on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  Our liabilities for funds withheld and 
embedded derivatives as of December 31, 2010, included $1.1 billion and $78 million, respectively, related to the business reinsured 
by Swiss Re. 

We recorded the gain related to the indemnity reinsurance transactions on the business sold to Swiss Re as a deferred gain on 
business sold through reinsurance on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  The deferred gain is being amortized into income at the 
rate that earnings on the reinsured business are expected to emerge, over a period of 15 years from the date of sale.  During 2010, 
2009 and 2008, we amortized $49 million, $50 million and $50 million, after-tax, respectively, of deferred gain on business sold 
through reinsurance.   

See Note 14 for discussion of the rescission of indemnity reinsurance for disability income business that occurred during the year 
ended December 31, 2009. 

10.  Goodwill and Specifically Identifiable Intangible Assets 

The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill (in millions) by reportable segment were as follows: 

Acquisition   Cumulative 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

Balance 
As of 

Impairment       

Acquisition 
As of 
Beginning-  Beginning-  Accounting 

   of-Year 

      of-Year 

  Dispositions     Balance 

and 
  Adjustments  Impairment      Other 

     As of End- 
      of-Year 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
Other Operations 
      Total goodwill 

   $ 

 1,040      $ 
 20        

 (600)     $ 
 -        

 2,188        
 274        
 335        
 3,857      $ 

 -          
 -          
 (244)         
 (844)       $ 

   $ 

 -       $ 
 -         

 -         
 -         
 -         
 -       $ 

 -        $ 
 -          

 -          
 -          
 -          
 -        $ 

 -      $ 
 -        

 440 
 20 

 -        
 -        
 6        
 6      $ 

 2,188 
 274 
 97 
 3,019 

211 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                          
  
                          
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
                          
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                          
  
  
                          
  
  
     
                          
       
         
        
         
          
         
     
       
          
          
          
          
         
     
     
     
Acquisition   Cumulative 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2009 

Balance 
As of 

Impairment       

Acquisition 
As of 
Beginning-  Beginning-  Accounting 

   of-Year 

      of-Year 

  Dispositions     Balance 

and 
  Adjustments  Impairment      Other 

     As of End- 
      of-Year 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
Other Operations 
      Total goodwill 

   $ 

 1,040       $ 
 20         

 -       $ 
 -         

 -       $ 
 -         

 (600)      $ 
 -          

 -      $ 
 -        

 440 
 20 

 2,188         
 274         
 338         
 3,860       $ 

 -         
 -         
 (164)        
 (164)     $ 

   $ 

 -         
 -         
 1         
 1       $ 

 -          
 -          
 (80)        
 (680)      $ 

 -        
 -        
 (4)       
 (4)     $ 

 2,188 
 274 
 91 
 3,013 

Included in the acquisition accounting adjustments above were adjustments related to income tax deductions recognized when 
stock options attributable to mergers were exercised or the release of unrecognized tax benefits acquired through mergers.  

We perform a Step 1 goodwill impairment analysis on all of our reporting units at least annually on October 1.  The Step 1 analysis 
for the reporting units within our Insurance Solutions and Retirement Solutions businesses utilizes primarily a discounted cash flow 
valuation technique (“income approach”), although limited available market data is also considered.  In determining the estimated 
fair value, we consider discounted cash flow calculations, the level of our own share price and assumptions that market participants 
would make in valuing the reporting unit.  This analysis requires us to make judgments about revenues, earnings projections, capital 
market assumptions and discount rates.  For our Media reporting unit, we primarily use discounted cash flow calculations to 
determine the implied fair value.  

As of October 1, 2010, all of our reporting units passed the Step 1 analysis, and although Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance 
carrying value of the net assets was within the estimated fair value range, we deemed it necessary to validate the carrying value of 
goodwill through a Step 2 analysis.  In our Step 2 analysis of Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance, we estimated the implied fair 
value of the reporting unit’s goodwill, including assigning the reporting unit’s fair value determined in Step 1 to all of its net assets 
(recognized and unrecognized) as if the reporting unit were acquired in a business combination as of October 1, 2010, and 
determined there was no impairment due to the implied fair value of goodwill being in excess of the carrying value of goodwill.   

As of October 1, 2009 and 2008, all of our reporting units passed the Step 1 analysis, except for our Media reporting unit, which 
required a Step 2 analysis to be completed.  We utilized very detailed forecasts of cash flows and market observable inputs in 
determining a fair value of the net assets for each of the reporting units similar to what would be estimated in a business 
combination between market participants.  The implied fair value of goodwill for our Media reporting unit was lower than its 
carrying amount; therefore, goodwill was impaired and written down to its fair value for this reporting unit.  The 2009 and 2008 
impairment recorded in Other Operations for our Media business was a result of declines in current and forecasted advertising 
revenue for the entire radio market.  Our impairment tests showed the implied fair value of our Media reporting unit was lower 
than its carrying amount; therefore, we recorded non-cash impairments of goodwill of $80 million for 2009 and $164 million for 
2008 and specifically identifiable intangible assets of $50 million and $217 million for the corresponding periods, respectively. 

As of March 31, 2009, we performed a Step 1 goodwill impairment analysis on all of our reporting units as a result of our 
performing an interim test due to volatile capital markets that provided indicators that a potential impairment could be present.  All 
of our reporting units passed the Step 1 analysis, except for our Retirement Solutions – Annuities reporting unit, which required a 
Step 2 analysis to be completed.  Based upon our Step 2 analysis, we recorded goodwill impairment for the Retirement Solutions – 
Annuities reporting unit in the first quarter of 2009 for $600 million, which was attributable primarily to higher discount rates 
driven by higher debt costs and equity market volatility, deterioration in sales and declines in equity markets.  There were no 
indicators of impairment as of December 31, 2009, due primarily to the continued improvement in the equity markets and lower 
discount rates. 

For our acquisition of NCLS, during 2009, we impaired the estimated goodwill that arose from the acquisition after considering the 
expected financial performance and other relevant factors of this business. 

212 

  
 
 
                          
  
                          
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
                          
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                          
  
  
                     
  
  
     
                     
       
         
         
         
          
         
     
       
         
         
         
          
         
     
     
     
 
 
 
 
 
 
The gross carrying amounts and accumulated amortization (in millions) for each major specifically identifiable intangible asset class 
by reportable segment were as follows:  

Insurance Solutions - Life Insurance:  
   Sales force  
Retirement Solutions - Defined Contribution:  
   Mutual fund contract rights (1)(2) 
Other Operations:  
   FCC licenses (1)(3) 
   Other  
      Total  

As of December 31, 

2010  

2009  

Gross 
Carrying 
Amount 

      Gross 

  Accumulated     Carrying 
  Amortization     Amount 

  Accumulated 
  Amortization 

$ 

 100      $ 

 19      $ 

 100      $ 

 15      

 2       

 -       

 2        

 - 

 118       
 4         
 224      $ 

 -       
 3        
 22       $ 

 118        
 4        
 224      $ 

 - 
 3      
 18      

$ 

(1)  No amortization recorded as the intangible asset has indefinite life. 
(2)  We recorded mutual fund contract rights impairment of $1 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. 
(3)  We recorded FCC licenses impairment of $49 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. 

Future estimated amortization of specifically identifiable intangible assets (in millions) as of December 31, 2010, was as follows: 

2011  
2012  
2013  
2014  
2015  

$ 

 4    
 4    
 4    
 4    
 4    

See Note 3 for goodwill assets included within discontinued operations. 

11.  Guaranteed Benefit Features  

Information on the GDB features outstanding (dollars in millions) was as follows (our variable contracts with guarantees may offer 
more than one type of guarantee in each contract; therefore, the amounts listed are not mutually exclusive): 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

Return of Net Deposits  
Total account value  
Net amount at risk (1) 
Average attained age of contract holders  
Minimum Return  
Total account value (2) 
Net amount at risk (1) 
Average attained age of contract holders  
Guaranteed minimum return  
Anniversary Contract Value  
Total account value  
Net amount at risk (1) 
Average attained age of contract holders  

$ 

 52,211    $ 
 816   
   58 years    

 44,712 
 1,888 
   57 years  

$ 

 187    $ 
 46   
   70 years    
5  % 

 203 
 65 
   69 years  
5 % 

$ 

 23,483    $ 
 2,183   
   66 years    

 21,431 
 4,021 
   65 years  

213 

  
 
 
                           
  
  
                           
    
  
  
                           
          
     
  
  
  
                      
  
                           
  
     
          
          
          
     
     
          
          
          
     
  
 
     
          
          
          
     
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
                  
  
                     
  
  
    
      
    
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
      
    
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
  
      
  
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
(1)  Represents the amount of death benefit in excess of the account balance.  The decrease in net amount at risk when comparing 
December 31, 2010, to December 31, 2009, was attributable primarily to the rise in equity markets and associated increase in 
the account values. 

(2)  The decrease in total account value when comparing December 31, 2010, to December 31, 2009, was attributable primarily to 

an increase in contract surrender rates. 

The determination of GDB liabilities is based on models that involve a range of scenarios and assumptions, including those 
regarding expected market rates of return and volatility, contract surrender rates and mortality experience.  The following 
summarizes the balances of and changes in the liabilities for GDB (in millions), which were recorded in future contract benefits on 
our Consolidated Balance Sheets: 

Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Changes in reserves 
   Benefits paid 
      Balance as of end-of-year 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

$ 

$ 

 71     $ 
 57    
 (84)  
 44     $ 

 277     $ 
 (33)   
 (173)   

 71     $ 

 38 
 312 
 (73)
 277 

Account balances of variable annuity contracts with guarantees (in millions) were invested in separate account investment options 
as follows: 

Asset Type 
Domestic equity 
International equity 
Bonds 
Money market 
   Total 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 35,659    $ 
 14,172   
 15,913   
 5,725   
 71,469    $ 

 32,489   
 12,379   
 9,942   
 6,373   
 61,183   

Percent of total variable annuity separate account values 

98 %   

97  %   

Future contract benefits also include reserves for our products with secondary guarantees for our products sold through our 
Insurance Solutions – Life Insurance segment.  These UL and VUL products with secondary guarantees represented approximately 
40% of permanent life insurance in force as of December 31, 2010, and approximately 52% of total sales for these products for the 
year ended December 31, 2010. 

12.  Other Contract Holder Funds 

Details of other contract holder funds (in millions) were as follows: 

Fixed account values, including the fixed portion of variable 
   and other contract holder funds 
DFEL 
Contract holder dividends payable 
Premium deposit funds 
Undistributed earnings on participating business 
      Total other contract holder funds 

 As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 65,380    $ 
 1,502   
 484   
 148   
 85   
 67,599    $ 

 62,158   
 1,338   
 493   
 102   
 56   
 64,147   

As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, participating policies comprised approximately 1.00% of the face amount of insurance in 
force, and dividend expenses were $82 million, $89 million and $92 million for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, 
respectively. 

214 

  
 
 
 
 
                     
                     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
              
       
  
                       
  
  
    
  
  
    
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
                       
  
                       
  
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
13.  Short-Term and Long-Term Debt 

Details underlying short-term and long-term debt (in millions) were as follows: 

Short-Term Debt  
Commercial paper (1) 
Current maturities of long-term debt  
Other short-term debt  
      Total short-term debt  

Long-Term Debt, Excluding Current Portion  
Senior notes:  
   6.20% notes, due 2011  
   5.65% notes, due 2012  
   LIBOR + 175 bps loan, due 2013  
   4.75% notes, due 2014  
   4.75% notes, due 2014  
   4.30% notes, due 2015 (2) 
   LIBOR + 3 bps notes, due 2017  
   7.00% notes, due 2018  
   8.75% notes, due 2019 (3) 
   6.25% notes, due 2020 (4) 
   6.15% notes, due 2036  
   6.30% notes, due 2037  
   7.00% notes, due 2040 (5) 
      Total senior notes  

Junior subordinated debentures issued to affiliated trusts:  
   Lincoln Capital VI - 6.75% Series F, due 2052 (6) 
      Total junior subordinated debentures issued to affiliated trusts  

Capital securities:  
   6.75%, due 2066  
   7.00%, due 2066 (7) 
   6.05%, due 2067 (8) 
      Total capital securities  
Unamortized premiums (discounts)  
Fair value hedge on interest rate swap agreements  
      Total unamortized premiums (discounts) and fair value hedge   
        on interest rate swap agreements  
           Total long-term debt  

$ 

$ 

$ 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

 100    $ 
 250   
 1    
 351    $ 

 99  
 250  
 1  
 350  

 -     $ 

 300   
 200   
 300   
 200   
 250   
 250   
 200   
 500   
 300   
 500   
 375   
 500   
 3,875   

 -    
 -    

 275   
 723   
 491   
 1,489   
 (20)  
 55    

 250  
 300  
 200  
 300  
 200  
 -  
 250  
 200  
 500  
 300  
 500  
 375  
 -  
 3,375  

 155  
 155  

 275  
 723  
 491  
 1,489  
 (23) 
 54  

 35    
 5,399    $ 

 31  
 5,050  

$ 

(1)  The weighted-average interest rate of commercial paper was 0.41% and 1.59% as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, 

respectively. 

(2)  On June 18, 2010, we issued 4.30% fixed rate senior notes due 2015 (“2015 Notes”), with a principal balance of $250 million.  
We have the option to repurchase the outstanding 2015 Notes by paying the greater of 100% of the principal amount of the 
2015 Notes to be redeemed or the make-whole amount (as defined in the 2015 Notes), plus in each case any accrued and 
unpaid interest as of the date of redemption. 

(3)  On June 22, 2009, we issued 8.75% fixed rate senior notes due 2019.  We have the option to repurchase the outstanding notes 
by paying the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed and (ii) the make-whole amount, plus in 
each case any accrued and unpaid interest as of the date of redemption.  The make-whole amount is equal to the sum of the 
present values of the remaining scheduled payments on the senior notes, discounted to the date of redemption on a semi-
annual basis, at a rate equal to the sum of the applicable treasury rate (as defined in the senior notes) plus 50 basis points. 

215 

  
 
 
 
                                   
  
                             
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
 
  
   
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
  
 
(4)  On December 11, 2009, we issued 6.25% fixed rate senior notes due 2020.  We have the option to repurchase the outstanding 
notes by paying the greater of (i) 100% of the principal amount of the notes to be redeemed and (ii) the make-whole amount, 
plus in each case any accrued and unpaid interest as of the date of redemption.  The make-whole amount is equal to the sum 
of the present values of the remaining scheduled payments on the senior notes, discounted to the date of redemption on a 
semi-annual basis, at a rate equal to the sum of the applicable treasury rate (as defined in the senior notes) plus 45 basis points.  
(5)  On June 18, 2010, we issued 7.00% fixed rate senior notes due 2040 (“2040 Notes”), with a principal balance of $500 million.  
We have the option to repurchase the outstanding 2040 Notes by paying the greater of 100% of the principal amount of the 
2040 Notes to be redeemed or the make-whole amount (as defined in the 2040 Notes), plus in each case any accrued and 
unpaid interest as of the date of redemption. 

(6)  During the fourth quarter of 2010, we repurchased all of our 6.75% junior subordinated debentures due 2052.  See below for 

the details of the loss on extinguishment of debt.  

(7)  During the first quarter of 2009, we repurchased $78 million of our 7% capital securities due 2066.  The results of the 

extinguishment of debt were favorable by a ratio of 25 cents to one dollar. 

(8)  During the first quarter of 2009, we repurchased $9 million of our 6.05% capital securities due 2067.  The results of the 

extinguishment of debt were favorable by a ratio of 23 cents to one dollar. 

Details underlying the recognition of a gain (loss) on the extinguishment of debt (in millions) reported within interest and debt 
expense on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) were as follows: 

Principal balance outstanding prior to payoff 
Unamortized debt issuance costs and discounts prior to payoff 
Amount paid to retire 

   Gain (loss) on extinguishment of debt, pre-tax 

For the Years 
Ended December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 155    $ 
 (5)   
 (155)  

 (5)    $ 

 87    
 (1)   
 (22)   

 64    

Future principal payments due on long-term debt (in millions) as of December 31, 2010, were as follows: 

2011  
2012  
2013  
2014  
2015  
Thereafter 
   Total 

  As Of 
$ 

 250 
 300 
 200 
 500 
 250 
 4,114 
 5,614 

$ 

For our long-term debt outstanding, unsecured senior debt, which consists of senior notes, fixed rate notes and other notes with 
varying interest rates, ranks highest in priority, followed by capital securities. 

216 

  
 
 
 
                    
  
                    
  
                    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                    
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Credit Facilities and Letters of Credit (“LOCs”) 

Credit facilities and LOC debt programs (in millions) were as follows: 

Credit Facilities  
Credit facility with the FHLBI (1) 

364-day revolving credit facility  
Four-year revolving credit facility  
Ten-year LOC facility  
   Total  

LOCs issued  

   As of December 31, 2010 
Expiration     Maximum  Borrowings 
   Available  Outstanding 

Date 

N/A 

   $ 

 630       $ 

Jun-2011    
Jun-2014    
Dec-2019    

   $ 

 500         
 1,500        
 550         
 3,180      $ 

 350 

 -    
 -  
 -  
 350 

     $ 

 2,048 

(1)  Our borrowing capacity under this credit facility does not have an expiration date and continues while our investment in the 
FHLBI common stock remains outstanding.  We have pledged securities, included in fixed maturity AFS securities on our 
Consolidated Balance Sheets, that are associated with this credit facility. 

Credit facilities allow for borrowing or issuances of LOCs.   

Effective June 9, 2010, we entered into two revolving credit facilities with a syndicate of banks.  One agreement (the “Four-Year 
Agreement”) allows for issuance of LOCs, as well as borrowings to finance any draws under the LOCs.  The Four-Year Agreement 
is unsecured and has a commitment termination date of June 9, 2014.  The Four-Year Agreement must be used primarily to 
provide LOCs in support of certain life insurance reserves.  The second agreement (the “364-Day Agreement,” and together with 
the “Four-Year Agreement” the “credit facility”) allows for borrowing or issuance of LOCs and may be used for general corporate 
purposes.  The 364-Day Agreement is unsecured and has a commitment termination date of June 8, 2011.  LOCs issued under the 
credit facility may remain outstanding for one year following the applicable commitment termination date of each agreement.  The 
LOCs support inter-company reinsurance transactions and specific treaties associated with our business sold through reinsurance.  
LOCs are used primarily to satisfy the state regulatory requirements of our domestic insurance companies for which reserve credit 
is provided by our affiliated reinsurance companies. 

The credit facility contains customary terms and conditions, including covenants restricting our ability to incur liens, merge or 
consolidate with another entity where we are not the surviving entity and dispose of all or substantially all of our assets.  The credit 
facility also includes financial covenants including:  maintenance of a minimum consolidated net worth (as defined in the facility) 
equal to the sum of $9.2 billion plus fifty percent (50%) of the aggregate net proceeds of equity issuances received by us in 
accordance with the terms of the credit facility (other than net proceeds used to repay investments to the U.S. Department of the 
Treasury (“U.S. Treasury”) under the Capital Purchase Program (“CPP”); and a debt-to-capital ratio as defined in accordance with 
the credit facility not to exceed 0.35 to 1.00.  Further, the credit facility contains customary events of default, subject to certain 
materiality thresholds and grace periods for certain of those events of default.  The events of default include payment defaults, 
covenant defaults, material inaccuracies in representations and warranties, certain cross-defaults, bankruptcy and liquidation 
proceedings and other customary defaults.  Upon an event of default, the credit facility provides that, among other things, the 
commitments may be terminated and the loans then outstanding may be declared due and payable.  As of December 31, 2010, we 
were in compliance with all such covenants. 

Shelf Registration 

We currently have an effective shelf registration statement, which allows us to issue, in unlimited amounts, securities, including 
debt securities, preferred stock, common stock, warrants, stock purchase contracts, stock purchase units and trust preferred 
securities of our affiliated trusts.  

217 

  
 
 
 
                  
  
    
                
  
                
  
  
  
     
         
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Certain Debt Covenants on Capital Securities 

Our $1.5 billion in principal amount of capital securities outstanding contain certain covenants that require us to make interest 
payments in accordance with an alternative coupon satisfaction mechanism (“ACSM”) if we determine that one of the following 
trigger events exists as of the 30th day prior to an interest payment date (“determination date”): 

(cid:2)  LNL’s risk-based capital ratio is less than 175% (based on the most recent annual financial statement filed with the State of 

(cid:2) 

Indiana); or 
(i) The sum of our consolidated net income for the four trailing fiscal quarters ending on the quarter that is two quarters prior 
to the most recently completed quarter prior to the determination date is zero or negative; and (ii) our consolidated 
stockholders’ equity (excluding accumulated other comprehensive income and any increase in stockholders’ equity resulting 
from the issuance of preferred stock during a quarter), or “adjusted stockholders’ equity,” as of (x) the most recently 
completed quarter and (y) the end of the quarter that is two quarters before the most recently completed quarter, has declined 
by 10% or more as compared to the quarter that is 10 fiscal quarters prior to the last completed quarter, or the “benchmark 
quarter.”  

The ACSM would generally require us to use commercially reasonable efforts to satisfy our obligation to pay interest in full on the 
capital securities with the net proceeds from sales of our common stock and warrants to purchase our common stock with an 
exercise price greater than the market price.  We would have to utilize the ACSM until the trigger events no longer existed.  Our 
failure to pay interest pursuant to the ACSM will not result in an event of default with respect to the capital securities nor will a 
nonpayment of interest unless it lasts for 10 consecutive years, although such breaches may result in monetary damages to the 
holders of the capital securities. 

14.  Contingencies and Commitments 

Contingencies 

Regulatory and Litigation Matters 

Regulatory bodies, such as state insurance departments, the SEC, Financial Industry Regulatory Authority and other regulatory 
bodies regularly make inquiries and conduct examinations or investigations concerning our compliance with, among other things, 
insurance laws, securities laws and laws governing the activities of broker-dealers.  

In the ordinary course of its business, LNC and its subsidiaries are involved in various pending or threatened legal proceedings, 
including purported class actions, arising from the conduct of business.  In some instances, these proceedings include claims for 
unspecified or substantial punitive damages and similar types of relief in addition to amounts for alleged contractual liability or 
requests for equitable relief.  After consultation with legal counsel and a review of available facts, it is management’s opinion that 
these proceedings, after consideration of any reserves and rights to indemnification, ultimately will be resolved without materially 
affecting the consolidated financial position of LNC.  However, given the large and indeterminate amounts sought in certain of 
these proceedings and the inherent difficulty in predicting the outcome of such legal proceedings, it is possible that an adverse 
outcome in certain matters could be material to our operating results for any particular reporting period.  

Transamerica Investment Management, LLC and Transamerica Investments Services, Inc. v. Delaware Management Holdings, Inc. (dba Delaware 
Investments), Delaware Investment Advisers and certain individuals, was filed in the San Francisco County Superior Court on April 28, 2005.  
The plaintiffs sought compensatory and punitive damages, alleging breach of fiduciary duty, breach of duty of loyalty, breach of 
contract, breach of the implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing, unfair competition, interference with prospective economic 
advantage, conversion, unjust enrichment, conspiracy and declaratory judgment, in connection with Delaware Investment Advisers’ 
hiring of certain portfolio management personnel from the plaintiffs.  As part of the purchase and sale agreement for Delaware 
described in Note 3, we agreed to retain control of and responsibility for this litigation.  We reached a global settlement with 
Transamerica resolving all litigation between the parties and took a charge of $40 million, after-tax, related to this litigation.  A 
notice of dismissal was entered in the case on January 24, 2011.   

Commitments  

Rescission of Indemnity Reinsurance for Disability Income Business 

Included in the business sold to Swiss Re through indemnity reinsurance in 2001 was disability income business.  In response to 
the rescission award of a panel of arbitrators on January 24, 2009, of the underlying reinsurance agreement with Swiss Re, we 
recorded an adjustment to write down our reinsurance recoverable and the corresponding funds withheld liability, and we released 
the embedded derivative liability related to the funds withheld nature of the reinsurance agreement, as discussed below.  The 

218 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
rescission resulted in our being responsible for paying claims on the business and maintaining sufficient reserves to support the 
liabilities. 

For the year ended December 31, 2009, an unfavorable adjustment of $97 million, after-tax, was reflected in segment income from 
operations within Other Operations, comprised of increases of $129 million to benefits, $15 million to interest credited and $5 
million to underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses, partially offset by a tax benefit of $52 million.  In addition, 
during 2009 the embedded derivative liability release discussed above increased net income by approximately $31 million.  The 
combined adjustments reduced net income by approximately $66 million, after-tax.  As a result of the rescission, we reduced our 
reinsurance recoverables by approximately $900 million related to the reserves for the disability income business and reduced our 
funds withheld liability by approximately $840 million. 

Leases  

Certain subsidiaries of ours lease their home office properties.  In 2006, we exercised the right and option to extend the Fort 
Wayne lease for two extended terms such that the lease shall expire in 2019.  We retain our right and option to exercise the 
remaining four extended terms of five years each in accordance with the lease agreement.  These agreements also provide us with 
the right of first refusal to purchase the properties at a price defined in the agreements and the option to purchase the leased 
properties at fair market value on the last day of any renewal period.  In 2007, we exercised the right and option to extend the 
Hartford lease for one extended term such that the lease shall expire in 2013.  During 2007, we moved our corporate headquarters 
to Radnor, Pennsylvania from Philadelphia, Pennsylvania and entered into a new 13-year lease for office space. 

Total rental expense on operating leases for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, was $46 million, $55 million and 
$62 million, respectively.  Future minimum rental commitments (in millions) as of December 31, 2010, were as follows: 

2011  
2012  
2013  
2014  
2015  

$ 

 40   
 36   
 30   
 23   
 18   

Information Technology Commitment  

In February 2004, we completed renegotiations and extended our contract with IBM Global Services for information technology 
services for the Fort Wayne operations through February 2010.  Following the original termination date of this agreement, we 
exercised contractual rights to extend this agreement through February 2012.  Annual costs are dependent on usage but are 
expected to be approximately $9 million. 

Football Stadium Naming Rights Commitment  

In 2002, we entered into an agreement with the Philadelphia Eagles to name the Eagles’ new stadium Lincoln Financial Field.  In 
exchange for the naming rights, we agreed to pay $140 million over a 20-year period through annual payments to the Philadelphia 
Eagles, which average approximately $7 million per year.  The total amount includes a maximum annual increase related to the 
Consumer Price Index.  This future commitment has not been recorded as a liability on our Consolidated Balance Sheets as it is 
being accounted for in a manner consistent with the accounting for operating leases under the Leases Topic of the FASB ASC. 

Media Commitments 

Lincoln Financial Media has future commitments of approximately $31 million through 2015 related primarily to employment 
contracts and rating service contracts. 

Vulnerability from Concentrations  

As of December 31, 2010, we did not have a concentration of:  business transactions with a particular customer or lender; sources 
of supply of labor or services used in the business; or a market or geographic area in which business is conducted that makes us 
vulnerable to an event that is at least reasonably possible to occur in the near term and which could cause a severe impact to our 
financial position.   

Although we do not have any significant concentration of customers, our American Legacy Variable Annuity (“ALVA”) product 
offered in our Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment is significant to this segment.  The ALVA product accounted for 25%, 
28% and 37% of Retirement Solutions – Annuities’ variable annuity product deposits in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and 

219 

  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
represented approximately 58%, 61% and 62% of our total Retirement Solutions – Annuities’ variable annuity product account 
values as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.  In addition, fund choices for certain of our other variable annuity 
products offered in our Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment include American Fund Insurance SeriesSM (“AFIS”) funds.  For 
the Retirement Solutions – Annuities segment, AFIS funds accounted for 29%, 33% and 44% of variable annuity product deposits 
in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, and represented 66%, 69% and 70% of the segment’s total variable annuity product account 
values as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. 

Standby Real Estate Equity Commitments 

Historically, we have entered into standby commitments, which obligated us to purchase real estate at a specified cost if a third-
party sale did not occur within approximately one year after construction was completed.  These commitments were used by a 
developer to obtain a construction loan from an outside lender on favorable terms.  In return for issuing the commitment, we 
received an annual fee and a percentage of the profit when the property was sold.  Our expectation is that we will be obligated to 
fund those commitments that remain outstanding.   

As of December 31, 2010, and December 31, 2009, we had standby real estate equity commitments totaling $53 million and $220 
million, respectively.  During 2010, we funded commitments of $142 million and recorded a loss of $8 million reported within 
realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  

During 2009, we suspended entering into new standby real estate commitments.  

Other Contingency Matters  

State guaranty funds assess insurance companies to cover losses to contract holders of insolvent or rehabilitated companies.  
Mandatory assessments may be partially recovered through a reduction in future premium taxes in some states.  We have accrued 
for expected assessments net of estimated future premium tax deductions of $13 million and $14 million as of December 31, 2010 
and 2009, respectively. 

15.  Shares and Stockholders’ Equity 

Common and Preferred Shares 

The changes in our preferred and common stock (number of shares) were as follows: 

Series A Preferred Stock  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Conversion of convertible preferred stock (1) 
   Balance as of end-of-year  

Series B Preferred Stock  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Issuance (redemption) of Series B preferred stock  
   Balance as of end-of-year  

Common Stock  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Stock issued   
Conversion of convertible preferred stock (1) 
Stock compensation/issued for benefit plans  
Retirement/cancellation of shares  
   Balance as of end-of-year  

Common Stock as of End-of-Period  
Assuming conversion of preferred stock  
Diluted basis  

(1)    Represents the conversion of Series A preferred stock into common stock. 

220 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

 11,497  
 (583) 
 10,914  

 950,000  
 (950,000) 

 -  

 11,565 
 (68)
 11,497 

 - 
 950,000 

 950,000 

 11,960 
 (395)
 11,565 

 - 
 - 

 - 

 302,223,281  
 14,137,615  
 9,328  
 414,712  
 (1,066,382) 
 315,718,554  

  255,869,859 
   46,000,000 
 1,088 
 436,100 
 (83,766)
  302,223,281 

 264,233,303 
 - 
 6,320 
 945,048 
 (9,314,812)
 255,869,859 

 315,893,178  
 324,043,137  

  302,407,233 
  311,846,021 

 256,054,899 
 257,690,111 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
                    
                   
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Our common, Series A and Series B preferred stocks are without par value. 

Average Shares 

A reconciliation of the denominator (number of shares) in the calculations of basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share 
was as follows: 

Weighted-average shares, as used in basic calculation  
Shares to cover exercise of outstanding warrants  
Shares to cover conversion of preferred stock  
Shares to cover non-vested stock  
Average stock options outstanding during the year  
Assumed acquisition of shares with assumed  
   proceeds from exercising outstanding warrants  
Assumed acquisition of shares with assumed  
   proceeds and benefits from exercising stock  
   options (at average market price for the year)  
Shares repurchaseable from measured but  
   unrecognized stock option expense  
Average deferred compensation shares  
      Weighted-average shares, as used in diluted calculation  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  
 257,498,535 
  280,031,363 
 310,005,264  
 6,209,013 
 12,260,236  
 - 
 186,578 
 184,687 
 178,720  
 309,648 
 550,700 
 616,314  
 6,479,521 
 401,369 
 707,704  

 (5,148,473) 

   (2,945,429)

 - 

 (464,813) 

 (275,543)

 (6,351,278)

 (139,673) 
 1,198,468  
 319,213,747  

 (85,511)
 1,564,954 
  285,635,603 

 (43,148)
 1,310,954 
 259,390,810 

In the event the average market price of LNC common stock exceeds the issue price of stock options, such options would be 
dilutive to our EPS and will be shown in the table above.  As a result of a loss from continuing operations for the years ended 
December 31, 2009 and 2008, shares used in the EPS calculation represent basic shares, since using diluted shares would have been 
anti-dilutive to the calculation. 

For participants in our deferred compensation plans, with the exception of the non-employee directors’ deferred compensation 
plan, who select LNC stock for measuring the investment return attributable to their deferral amounts, the effect of settling this 
obligation in LNC stock is more dilutive than the presumption to settle in cash.  Therefore, the numerator used in our diluted EPS 
calculation was adjusted down by $1 million, for the removal of the favorable mark-to-market adjustment included in net income 
attributable to these deferred units of LNC stock for the year ended December 31, 2010. 

The income used in the calculation of our diluted EPS is our net income (loss), reduced by preferred stock dividends and accretion 
of discount.  These amounts are presented on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

Common Stock Issued 

On June 22, 2009, we closed on the issuance and sale of 40,000,000 shares of common stock and on June 25, 2009, we closed on 
the issuance and sale of 6,000,000 shares of common stock, both at a price of $15.00 per share. 

On June 18, 2010, we closed on the issuance and sale of 14,137,615 shares of common stock at a price of $27.25 per share. 

Series B Preferred Stock Issuance and Redemption 

On July 10, 2009, in connection with the Troubled Asset Relief Program (“TARP”) CPP, established as part of the Emergency 
Economic Stabilization Act of 2008, we issued and sold to the U.S. Treasury 950,000 shares of Series B preferred stock together 
with a related warrant to purchase up to 13,049,451 shares of our common stock for an aggregate purchase price of $950 million. 

On June 30, 2010, we repurchased from the U.S. Treasury all of the Series B preferred stock.  The repurchase of the Series B 
preferred stock resulted in a $131 million reduction to retained earnings and was deducted from income (loss) available to common 
stockholders in our calculation of EPS, representing the write-off of unamortized discount on the Series B preferred stock at 
liquidation.  In addition, the annual dividends payable on the Series B preferred stock were eliminated as of June 30, 2010.  

221 

  
 
 
 
 
                      
                      
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
On September 22, 2010, the U.S. Treasury closed an underwritten secondary public offering of the above-mentioned 13,049,451 
warrants.  The warrants, each representing the right to purchase one share of our common stock, no par value per share, have an 
exercise price of $10.91, subject to adjustment in accordance with the terms of the TARP CPP, and expire on July 10, 2019, and are 
listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “LNC WS.”  We did not receive any of the proceeds of the warrant 
offering; however, we paid $48 million, reported within common stock on our Consolidated Balance Sheets, to purchase 2,899,159 
warrants at auction, which were subsequently canceled. 

Upon issuance, the fair values of the Series B preferred stock and the associated warrants were computed as if the instruments were 
issued on a stand alone basis.  The fair value of the Series B preferred stock was estimated based on a five-year holding period and 
cash flows discounted at a rate of 10%, resulting in a fair value estimate of approximately $777 million. We used a binomial lattice 
model to estimate the fair value of the warrants, resulting in a stand alone fair value of approximately $152 million.  The relative 
fair value of each security to the total combined fair value of both securities was 83.6% for the preferred stock and 16.4% for the 
common stock warrants.  The most significant and unobservable assumption in this valuation was our share price volatility.  We 
used a long-term realized volatility of our stock of 73.17%. 

The individual fair values were used to record the Series B preferred stock and associated warrants on a relative fair value basis of 
$794 million and $156 million, respectively.  The warrants were recorded to common stock.  The Series B preferred stock amount 
was recorded at the liquidation value of $1,000 per share or $950 million, net of discount of $156 million.  The discount was 
amortized over a five-year period from the date of issuance, using the effective yield method and recorded as a direct reduction to 
retained earnings and deducted from income (loss) available to common stockholders in the calculation of EPS.  The accretion of 
discount totaled $12 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.  

222 

  
 
 
 
Accumulated OCI 

The following summarizes the components and changes in accumulated OCI (in millions): 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2009  

2008  

2010  

Unrealized Gain (Loss) on AFS Securities 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Cumulative effect from adoption of new accounting standards 
   Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the year 
   Change in foreign currency exchange rate adjustment 
   Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI and other contract holder funds 
   Income tax benefit (expense)  
   Less: 
      Reclassification adjustment for gains (losses) included in net income (loss) 
      Reclassification adjustment for gains (losses) on derivatives included in net income (loss) 
      Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
      Income tax benefit (expense)  
         Balance as of end-of-year 

Unrealized OTTI on AFS Securities 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   (Increases) attributable to: 
      Cumulative effect from adoption of new accounting standards 
      Gross OTTI recognized in OCI during the year 
      Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
      Income tax benefit (expense)  
   Decreases attributable to: 
      Sales, maturities or other settlements of AFS securities 
      Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
      Income tax benefit (expense)  
         Balance as of end-of-year 

Unrealized Gain (Loss) on Derivative Instruments 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Unrealized holding gains (losses) arising during the year 
   Change in foreign currency exchange rate adjustment 
   Change in DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
   Income tax benefit (expense)  
   Less: 
      Reclassification adjustment for gains (losses) included in net income (loss) 
      Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL 
      Income tax benefit (expense)  
         Balance as of end-of-year 

Foreign Currency Translation Adjustment 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Foreign currency translation adjustment arising during the year 
   Income tax benefit (expense)  
      Balance as of end-of-year 

Funded Status of Employee Benefit Plans 
Balance as of beginning-of-year 
   Adjustment arising during the year 
   Income tax benefit (expense)  
      Balance as of end-of-year 

223 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 49     $ 
 181    
 2,528   
 (6)  
 (1,196)  
 (478)   

 (2,654)   $ 
 (84)  
 6,204   
 26   
 (2,371)  
 (1,366)  

 (135)   
 135    
 9    
 (3)  
 1,072    $ 

 (569)  
 (45)  
 161   
 159   
 49    $ 

 86 
 - 
 (7,835)
 (66)
 2,602 
 1,859 

 (1,221)
 (112)
 256 
 377 
 (2,654)

 (115)   $ 

 -    $ 

 -   
 (98)  
 10   
 30   

 (18)  
 (357)  
 82   
 96   

 87   
 (20)  
 (23)  
 (129)   $ 

 154   
 (29)  
 (43)  
 (115)   $ 

 11     $ 
 (27)   
 4    
 (4)  
 9    

 14    
 (1)  
 (5)  
 (15)   $ 

 3    $ 
 (3)  
 1   
 1    $ 

 127    $ 
 (120)  
 -   
 22   
 (13)  

 8   
 -   
 (3)  
 11    $ 

 6    $ 
 (2)  
 (1)  
 3    $ 

 (210)    $ 
 45    
 (16)  
 (181)   $ 

 (282)   $ 
 111   
 (39)  
 (210)   $ 

 - 

 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 

 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 

 53 
 (1)
 1 
 (36)
 37 

 (112)
 - 
 39 
 127 

 175 
 (263)
 94 
 6 

 (89)
 (316)
 123 
 (282)

  
 
 
 
                               
                         
  
  
   
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
16.  Realized (Gain) Loss 

Details underlying realized gain (loss) (in millions) reported on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) were as follows: 

Total realized gain (loss) related to certain investments (1) 
Realized gain (loss) related to certain derivative instruments,  
   including those associated with our consolidated VIEs, and  
   trading securities (2) 
Indexed annuity net derivative results: (3) 
   Gross gain (loss)   
   Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL  
Guaranteed living benefits: (4) 
   Gross gain (loss)  
   Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL  
Guaranteed death benefits: (5) 
   Gross gain (loss)  
   Associated amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL  
Realized gain (loss) on sale of subsidiaries/businesses  
      Total realized gain (loss)  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

$ 

 (180)    $ 

 (538)    $ 

 (928)

 75 

 36 

 (109)

 34 
 (15)     

 8 
 (4)     

 115 
 (54)     

 (483)     
 35 

 (59)     
 7 
 - 

$ 

 (77)    $ 

 (227)     
 26 
 1 
 (1,146)    $ 

 13 
 (6)

 793 
 (356)

 75 
 (17)
 - 
 (535)

(1)  See “Realized Gain (Loss) Related to Certain Investments” section in Note 5. 
(2)  Represents changes in the fair values of certain derivative investments (including the credit default swaps and contingent 

forwards associated with our consolidated VIEs), total return swaps (embedded derivatives that are theoretically included in 
our various modified coinsurance and coinsurance with funds withheld reinsurance arrangements that have contractual returns 
related to various assets and liabilities associated with these arrangements) and trading securities. 

(3)  Represents the net difference between the change in the fair value of the S&P 500 call options that we hold and the change in 
the fair value of the embedded derivative liabilities of our indexed annuity products along with changes in the fair value of 
embedded derivative liabilities related to index call options we may purchase in the future to hedge contract holder index 
allocations applicable to future reset periods for our indexed annuity products.  The year ended December 31, 2008, included a 
$10 million gain from the initial impact of adopting the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC. 
(4)  Represents the net difference in the change in embedded derivative reserves of our GLB products and the change in the fair 
value of the derivative instruments we own to hedge, including the cost of purchasing the hedging instruments.  The year 
ended December 31, 2008, included a $34 million loss from the initial impact of adopting the Fair Value Measurements and 
Disclosures Topic of the FASB ASC. 

(5)  Represents the change in the fair value of the derivatives used to hedge our GDB riders. 

17.  Underwriting, Acquisition, Insurance, Restructuring and Other Expenses 

Details underlying underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses (in millions) were as follows: 

Commissions 
General and administrative expenses 
Expenses associated with reserve financing and unrelated LOCs 
DAC and VOBA deferrals and interest, net of amortization 
Broker-dealer expenses 
Other intangibles amortization 
Media expenses 
Taxes, licenses and fees 
Merger-related expenses 
Restructuring charges (recoveries) for expense initiatives 

   Total 

224 

$ 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

 1,616    $ 
 1,412   
 34   
 (583)  
 320   
 4    
 59   
 197   
 9    
 (1)   

 1,533    $ 
 1,287   
 7   
 (598)  
 290   
 4   
 53   
 167   
 17   
 34   

 1,676 
 1,271 
 3  
 (464) 
 331 
 4  
 60  
 197 
 52  
 8  

$ 

 3,067    $ 

 2,794    $ 

 3,138 

  
 
 
 
                           
                      
  
  
 
    
    
 
    
    
 
    
    
 
    
    
 
    
    
 
 
    
    
 
    
 
    
  
    
    
  
  
    
    
  
    
    
 
 
 
 
           
 
 
 
 
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
All merger-related and restructuring charges are included in underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses primarily 
within Other Operations on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) in the year incurred. 

2008 Restructuring Plan  

Starting in December 2008, we implemented a restructuring plan in response to the economic downturn and sustained market 
volatility, which focused on reducing expenses.  Our cumulative pre-tax charges amounted to $41 million for severance, benefits 
and related costs associated with the plan for workforce reduction and other restructuring actions. 

18.  Pension, Postretirement Health Care and Life Insurance Benefit Plans 

We maintain U.S. qualified funded defined benefit pension plans in which many of our U.S. employees and agents are participants.  
We also maintain non-qualified, unfunded defined benefit pension plans for certain U.S. employees and agents, certain former 
employees of JP and certain former employees of CIGNA Corporation.  In addition, for certain former employees we have 
supplemental retirement plans that provide defined benefit pension benefits in excess of limits imposed by federal tax law.  All of 
our U.S. defined benefit pension plans were frozen as of December 31, 2007, or earlier.  For our frozen plans, there are no new 
participants and no future accruals of benefits from the date of the freeze.  Our non-U.S. defined benefit pension plan was frozen 
as of September 30, 2009, as a result of the sale of Lincoln National UK. 

The eligibility requirements for each plan are described in each plan document and vary for each plan based on completion of a 
specified period of continuous service and date of hire, subject to age limitations.  The frozen pension plan benefits are calculated 
either on a traditional or cash balance formula.  Those formulas are based upon years of credited service and eligible earnings as 
defined in each plan document.  The traditional formula provides benefits stated in terms of a single life annuity payable at age 65.  
The cash balance formula provides benefits stated as a lump sum hypothetical account balance.  That account balance equals the 
sum of the employee’s accumulated annual benefit credits plus interest credits.  Benefit credits, which are based on years of service 
and base salary plus bonus, ceased as of the date the plan was frozen.  Interest Credits continue until the participant’s benefit is 
paid. 

We also sponsor a voluntary employees’ beneficiary association (“VEBA”) trust that provides postretirement medical, dental and 
life insurance benefits to retired full-time U.S. employees and agents who, depending on the plan, have worked for us for 10 years 
and attained age 55 (age 60 for agents).  VEBAs are a special type of tax-exempt trust used to provide benefits that are subject to 
preferential tax treatment under the Internal Revenue Code.  Medical and dental benefits are available to spouses and other eligible 
dependents of retired employees and agents.  Retirees may be required to contribute toward the cost of these benefits.  Eligibility 
and the amount of required contribution for these benefits varies based upon a variety of factors including years of service and year 
of retirement.  Effective January 1, 2008, the postretirement plan providing benefits to former employees of JP was amended such 
that only employees who had attained age 55 with a minimum of 10 years of service by December 31, 2007, and who later retire on 
or after age 60 with 15 years of service will be eligible to receive life insurance benefits when they retire. 

225 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations, Funded Status and Assumptions  

Information (in millions) with respect to our benefit plans’ assets and obligations was as follows: 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

Change in Plan Assets  
Fair value as of beginning-of-year  
Actual return on plan assets  
Company and participant contributions  
Benefits paid  
Medicare Part D subsidy  
Foreign exchange translation  
   Fair value as of end-of-year  

Change in Benefit Obligation  
Balance as of beginning-of-year  
Service cost (1) 
Interest cost  
Company and participant contributions  
Curtailments  
Actuarial (gains) losses  
Benefits paid  
Medicare Part D subsidy  
Foreign exchange translation  
   Balance as of end-of-year  
      Funded status of the plans   

Amounts Recognized on the   
   Consolidated Balance Sheets  
Other assets   
Other liabilities   
   Net amount recognized   

Amounts Recognized in   
   Accumulated OCI, Net of Tax  
Net (gain) loss  
Prior service credit  
   Net amount recognized   

Rate of Increase in Compensation  
Retiree Life Insurance Plan  
All other plans  

Weighted-Average Assumptions  
Benefit obligations:  
   Weighted-average discount rate  
   Expected return on plan assets  
Net periodic benefit cost:  
   Weighted-average discount rate  
   Expected return on plan assets  

As of or for the Years Ended December 31, 

2010  

2009  

2010  

2009  

2010  

2009  

U.S. 
Pension Benefits 

Non-U.S. 
Pension Benefits 

Other  

   Postretirement Benefits 

 842    $ 
 118   
 31   
 (73)  
 -    
 -    
 918   

 1,050   
 3    
 61   
 -    
 -    
 52   
 (73)  
 -    
 -    
 1,093   
 (175)   $ 

 730     $ 
 176   
 11    
 (75)  
 -    
 -   
 842   

 1,054   
 3    
 62    
 -    
 -    
 6    
 (75)   
 -    
 -    
 1,050   
 (208)    $ 

 307    $ 
 29   
 -    
 (12)  
 -    
 (10)  
 314   

 289   
 -    
 16   
 -    
 -    
 (12)  
 (12)  
 -    
 (10)  
 271   
 43    $ 

 232    $ 
 18    
 44    
 (12)  
 -    
 25    
 307   

 238   
 1    
 16    
 -    
 (3)   
 21    
 (12)  
 -    
 28    
 289   
 18     $ 

 34    $ 
 2   
 15   
 (15)  
 1   
 -   
 37   

 151   
 3   
 9   
 6   
 -   
 -   
 (15)  
 1   
 -   
 155   
 (118)   $ 

 32 
 2 
 16 
 (18)
 2 
 - 
 34 

 141 
 3 
 8 
 5 
 - 
 10 
 (18)
 2 
 - 
 151 
 (117)

 15    $ 

 (190)  
 (175)   $ 

 12     $ 

 (220)   
 (208)    $ 

 43    $ 
 -    
 43    $ 

 18     $ 
 -    
 18     $ 

 -    $ 

 (118)  
 (118)   $ 

 - 
 (117)
 (117)

 153 

   $ 
 -        
 153    $ 

 164      $ 
 -        
 164    $ 

 30      $ 
 -        
 30    $ 

 48      $ 
 -        
 48     $ 

   $ 
 2 
 (4)      
 (2)   $ 

 2 
 (4)
 (2)

N/A   
N/A   

N/A   
N/A   

N/A   
N/A   

N/A   
N/A   

4.00  %  
N/A  

4.00  %
N/A

5.50  %  
8.00  %  

6.00  %  
8.00  %  

6.00  %  
8.00  %   

6.00  %   
8.00  %   

5.70  %  
5.40  %  

5.80  %  
5.80  %  

5.80  %   
5.80  %   

5.50  %   
5.50  %   

5.00  %  
6.50  %  

6.00  %  
6.50  %  

6.00 % 
6.50 % 

6.00 % 
6.50 % 

(1)  Amounts for our U.S. pension plans in 2010 and 2009, represent general and administrative expenses. 

226 

  
 
 
 
                             
                             
  
  
  
  
  
                            
  
  
                       
  
    
     
    
  
 
    
  
 
    
 
  
    
     
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
   
  
 
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
 
     
       
 
     
       
     
  
    
     
    
  
  
    
     
    
 
  
    
     
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
     
    
  
  
    
     
    
 
  
    
     
    
  
    
     
    
  
  
    
     
    
 
  
    
     
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
     
    
  
  
    
     
    
 
  
    
     
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Consistent with our benefit plans’ year end, we use December 31 as the measurement date.  

The discount rate was determined based on a corporate yield curve as of December 31, 2010, and projected benefit obligation cash 
flows for the U.S. pension plans.  We reevaluate this assumption each plan year.  For 2011, our discount rate for the U.S. pension 
plans will be 5.50%, and 5.70% for the non-U.S. plan.  

The expected return on plan assets was determined based on historical and expected future returns of the various asset categories, 
using the plans’ target plan allocation.  We reevaluate this assumption each plan year.  For 2011, our expected return on plan assets 
is 8.00% for the U.S. plans and 5.40% for the non-U.S. plan.  The approximate expected return on plan assets by asset class for the 
pension plans is as follows:  

U.S. Plans 
Fixed maturity securities 
Common stock: 
   Domestic large cap equity 
   International equity 
Cash and invested assets 

Non-U.S. Plans 
Fixed maturity securities 
Equity securities 
Cash and invested assets 

5.73  %  

9.88  %  
8.48  %  
0.00  %  

4.75  %  
7.40  %  
3.70  %  

The calculation of the accumulated other postretirement benefit obligation assumes a weighted-average annual rate of increase in 
the per capita cost of covered benefits (i.e., health care cost trend rate) as follows:   

Pre-65 health care cost trend rate 
Post-65 health care cost trend rate 
Ultimate trend rate 
Year that the rate reaches the ultimate trend rate 

2010  

As of or for the 
Years Ended December 31, 
2009  
10.00  %   
13.00  %   
5.00  %   
2020    

9.50  %  
9.50  %  
5.00  %  
2020   

2008  
10.00  %  
12.00  %  
5.00  %  
2019   

We expect the health care cost trend rate for 2011 to be 9.00% for both the pre-65 and the post-65 population.  A one-percentage 
point increase in assumed health care cost trend rates would have increased the accumulated postretirement benefit obligation by 
$4 million and total service and interest cost components by $1 million.  A one-percentage point decrease in assumed health care 
cost trend rates would have decreased the accumulated postretirement benefit obligation by $7 million and total service and interest 
cost components by $1 million. 

Information for our pension plans with an accumulated benefit obligation in excess of plan assets (in millions) was as follows: 

U.S. Plan 
Accumulated benefit obligation 
Projected benefit obligation 
Fair value of plan assets 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

 1,072    $ 
 1,072   
 881   

 1,028   
 1,028   
 808   

227 

  
 
 
 
 
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
 
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
 
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
 
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
 
 
                       
  
                       
  
                       
  
  
  
 
 
 
                       
  
                   
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
Components of Net Periodic Benefit Cost  

The components of net periodic benefit cost for our pension plans’ and other postretirement plans’ expense (recovery) (in 
millions) were as follows:  

For the Years Ended December 31, 

2010  

2009  
Pension Benefits 

2008  

2010  

2009  
Other Postretirement Benefits 

2008  

U.S. Plans  
Service cost (1) 
Interest cost  
Expected return on plan assets  
Amortization of prior service cost  
Recognized net actuarial loss (gain)  
   Net periodic benefit expense   
      (recovery)  

$ 

 3    $ 
 61   
 (65)  
 -    
 15   

 3     $ 
 62    
 (55)   
 -    
 28    

 -     $ 

 62    
 (77)   
 -    
 4    

 3    $ 
 9   
 (2)  
 (1)  
 1   

 3    $ 
 8   
 (2)  
 (1)  
 (2)  

 3 
 8 
 (2)
 (1)
 3 

$ 

 14    $ 

 38     $ 

 (11)    $ 

 10    $ 

 6    $ 

 11 

$ 

Non-U.S. Plans  
Service cost  
Interest cost  
Expected return on plan assets  
Amortization of prior service cost  
Recognized net actuarial loss (gain)  
   Net periodic benefit expense (recovery)   $ 

 -     $ 

 16   
 (16)  
 -    
 1   
 1    $ 

 1     $ 
 16    
 (15)   
 1    
 1    
 4     $ 

 2   
 19   
 (19)  
 -    
 3   
 5   

(1)  Amounts for our pension plans in 2010, 2009 and 2008, represent general and administrative expenses. 

We expect our 2011 U.S. pension plans’ expense to be approximately $3 million.  In addition, we retained the Lincoln UK 
pension plan after the sale of this business, and we expect our related pension income for 2011 to be approximately $1 million 
when assuming an average exchange rate of 1.55 pounds sterling to U.S. dollars, which will be reflected within Other Operations. 

For 2011, the estimated amount of amortization from accumulated OCI into net periodic benefit expense related to net actuarial 
loss or gain is expected to be an approximate $13 million loss for our pension plans and less than $1 million gain for our other 
postretirement plans.  

Plan Assets  

Our pension plans’ asset target allocations by asset category based on estimated fair values were as follows: 

U.S. Plans 
Fixed maturity securities 
Common stock: 
   Domestic equity 
   International equity 
Cash and invested assets 

Non-U.S. Plans 
Fixed maturity securities 
Equity securities 
Cash and invested assets 

For the Years Ended 
December 31, 

2010  

2009  

50  % 

50  %  

35  % 
15  % 
0  % 

65  %   
15  %   
20  %   

35  %  
15  %  
0  %  

70  %   
30  %   
0  %   

228 

  
 
 
 
 
                       
                        
  
  
  
  
  
                       
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
 
 
 
 
  
 
                   
 
                       
  
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
                       
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
     
The investment objectives for the assets related to our pension plans are to: 

(cid:2)  Maintain sufficient liquidity to pay obligations of the plans as they come due; 
(cid:2)  Minimize the effect of a single investment loss and large losses to the plans through prudent risk/reward diversification 

consistent with sound fiduciary standards; 
(cid:2)  Maintain an appropriate asset allocation policy; 
(cid:2)  Earn a return commensurate with the level of risk assumed through the asset allocation policy; and 
(cid:2)  Control costs of administering and managing the plans' investment operations. 

Investments can be made in various asset classes and styles, including, but not limited to: domestic and international equity, fixed 
income securities, derivatives, and other asset classes the investment managers deem prudent.  Our plans follow a strategic asset 
allocation policy that strives to systemically increase the percentage of assets in liability-matching fixed income investments as 
funding levels increase.  

We currently target asset weightings as follows: domestic equity allocations (35%) are split into large cap (25%), small cap (5%) and 
hedge funds (5%).  Fixed maturity securities represents core fixed income investments. The performance of the pension trust assets 
are monitored on a quarterly basis relative to the plan’s objectives.   

Our U.S. pension plans’ assets have been combined into a master retirement trust where a variety of qualified managers, including 
manager of managers, are expected to have returns that exceed the median of similar funds over three-year periods, above an 
appropriate index over five-year periods and meet real return standards over ten-year periods.  Managers are monitored for 
adherence to approved investment policy guidelines and managers not meeting these criteria are subject to additional due diligence 
review, corrective action or possible termination. 

Fair Value of Plan Assets 

See “Fair Value Measurement” in Note 1 for discussion of how we categorize our pension plans’ assets, into a three-level fair value 
hierarchy. 

The following summarizes our fair value measurements of pension plans’ assets (in millions) on a recurring basis by the three-level 
fair value hierarchy: 

As of December 31, 2010 

   Quoted 
 Prices  
in Active  

Markets for   Significant   Significant  

Identical 
 Assets  
(Level 1) 

   Observable  Unobservable    Total 
Fair 
    Value 

Inputs  
    (Level 2)       (Level 3) 

Inputs  

U.S. Pension Plans Asset Class 
Fixed maturity securities: 
   Corporate bonds 
   U.S. Government bonds 
   Foreign government bonds 
   MBS: 
      CMOs 
      CMBS 
   ABS 
Common stock 
Cash and invested assets 
         Total  

   $ 

   $ 

   $ 

 -  
 -  
 -  

 -  
 -  
 -  
 116 
 -  
 116 

   $ 

 266      $ 
 103     
 17     

 2     
 5     
 1     
 310     
 58     
 762      $ 

 -  
 -  
 22 

 -  
 -  
 -  
 18 
 -  
 40 

   $ 

   $ 

 266 
 103 
 39  

 2  
 5  
 1  
 444 
 58  
 918 

229 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                          
  
  
                     
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                     
  
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                     
 
  
    
  
   
  
  
                     
 
  
  
                     
  
  
                     
  
   
    
   
  
                     
  
  
  
    
         
   
    
         
  
  
    
         
   
    
         
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
 
     
    
  
 
     
 
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
As of December 31, 2009 

   Quoted 
 Prices  
in Active  

Markets for   Significant   Significant  

Identical 
 Assets  
(Level 1) 

   Observable  Unobservable    Total 
Fair 
    Value 

Inputs  
    (Level 2)       (Level 3) 

Inputs  

U.S. Pension Plans Asset Class 
Fixed maturity securities: 
  Corporate bonds 
  U.S. Government bonds 
  Foreign government bonds 
  MBS: 
     CMOs 
      CMBS 
   ABS 
   State and municipal bonds 
Common stock 
Cash and invested assets 
         Total  

   $ 

   $ 

 -       $ 
 -         
 -         

 -         
 -         
 -         
 -         
 126        
 -         
 126      $ 

 334     $ 
 32    
 12    

 6    
 11     
 3     
 7     
 295     
 13     
 713      $ 

 1       $ 
 -         
 1         

 -         
 -         
 1         
 -         
 -         
 -         
 3       $ 

 335    
 32    
 13    

 6    
 11    
 4    
 7    
 421    
 13    
 842    

As of December 31, 2010 

   Quoted 
 Prices  
in Active  

Markets for   Significant   Significant  

Identical 
 Assets  
(Level 1) 

   Observable  Unobservable    Total 
Fair 
    Value 

Inputs  
    (Level 2)       (Level 3) 

Inputs  

Non-U.S. Pension Plans Asset Class   
Fixed maturity securities: 
  Corporate bonds 
  U.S. Government bonds 
  Foreign government bonds 
  ABS 
Common stock 
Cash and invested assets 
      Total  

   $ 

   $ 

 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  

   $ 

   $ 

 22      $ 
 2     
 166     
 2     
 101     
 21     
 314      $ 

 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  

   $ 

   $ 

 22  
 2  
 166  
 2  
 101  
 21  
 314  

230 

  
 
 
                          
  
  
                          
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                          
  
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                          
 
  
    
  
   
  
  
                    
 
  
  
                    
  
  
                    
  
   
    
   
  
                    
  
  
  
    
         
  
    
         
  
  
    
         
  
    
         
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
         
  
    
         
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                          
  
  
                          
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                          
  
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                          
 
  
    
  
   
  
  
                          
 
  
  
                          
  
  
                    
  
   
    
   
  
                    
  
  
    
         
  
    
         
  
  
    
         
  
    
         
  
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
     
  
     
As of December 31, 2009 

   Quoted 
 Prices  
in Active  

Markets for   Significant   Significant  

Identical 
 Assets  
(Level 1) 

   Observable  Unobservable    Total 
Fair 
    Value 

Inputs  
    (Level 2)       (Level 3) 

Inputs  

Non-U.S. Pension Plans Asset Class   
Fixed maturity securities: 
   Corporate bonds 
   Foreign government bonds 
Common stock 
      Total  

   $ 

   $ 

 -       $ 
 -         
 -         
   $ 
 -  

 101     $ 
 123    
 83     
 307     $ 

 -    $ 
 -   
 -   
 -  

  $ 

 101   
 123   
 83   
 307   

The following summarizes changes to our U.S. pension plan assets (in millions) classified within Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy 
as reported above: 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

      Transfers 

Return on Assets 
Sold 

   Held 

Beginning    
Fair 
Value 

at 
Year 
End 

   During 

the  
Year 

In or 
   Out 
of 

   Purchases, 
      Sales and       
   Settlements,     Level 3, 
      Net 

      Net 

   Ending 

Fair 
   Value 

Fixed maturity securities: 
   Corporate bonds 
   Foreign government bonds 
   ABS 
   Common stock 
         Total 

$ 

$ 

 1     $ 
 1    
 1    
 -    
 3     $ 

 -     $ 
 3    
 -    
 -    
 3     $ 

 -       $ 
 -      
 -      
 -      
 -       $ 

 (1)       $ 
 18         
 (1)         
 18         
 34       $ 

 -    $ 
 -   
 -   
 -   
 -    $ 

 - 
 22 
 - 
 18 
 40 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2009 

      Transfers 

Return on Assets 
Sold 

   Held 

Beginning    
Fair 
Value 

at 
Year 
End 

   During 

the  
Year 

In or 
   Out 
of 

   Purchases, 
      Sales and       
   Settlements,     Level 3, 
      Net 

      Net 

   Ending 

Fair 
   Value 

Fixed maturity securities: 
   Corporate bonds 
   Foreign government bonds 
   MBS: 
      CMOs 
      CMBS 
   ABS 
         Total 

$ 

$ 

 8     $ 
 -    

 1    
 2    
 1    
 12     $ 

 -     $ 
 -    

 -    
 -    
 -    
 -     $ 

 -       $ 
 -         

 -         
 -         
 -         
 -       $ 

 (2)      $ 
 1         

 (1)        
 -         
 -         
 (2)      $ 

 (5)   $ 
 -   

 -   
 (2)  
 -   
 (7)   $ 

 1 
 1 

 - 
 - 
 1 
 3 

231 

  
 
 
                          
  
  
                          
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                          
  
   
  
    
  
   
  
  
                          
 
  
    
  
   
  
  
                     
 
  
  
                     
  
  
                     
  
   
    
   
  
                     
  
  
    
         
   
    
 
    
  
  
    
         
   
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                            
                            
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
                            
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
                            
  
  
  
  
                            
                            
  
  
  
                            
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
    
          
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                       
                       
  
  
  
     
  
  
  
                       
  
  
     
  
     
  
  
                            
  
  
  
  
                            
                            
  
  
  
                            
  
  
     
  
    
  
     
          
          
  
     
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
        
        
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Valuation Methodologies and Associated Inputs for Pension Plans’ Assets  

The fair value measurements of our pension plans’ assets are based on assumptions used by market participants in pricing the 
security.  The most appropriate valuation methodology is selected based on the specific characteristics of the security, and the 
valuation methodology is consistently applied to measure the security’s fair value.  The fair value measurement is based on a market 
approach, which utilizes prices and other relevant information generated by market transactions involving identical or comparable 
securities.  Sources of inputs to the market approach include third-party pricing services, independent broker quotations or pricing 
matrices.  Both observable and unobservable inputs are used in the valuation methodologies.  Observable inputs include 
benchmark yields, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, issuer spreads, two-sided markets, benchmark securities, bids, offers and 
reference data.  In addition, market indicators, industry and economic events are monitored and further market data is acquired if 
certain triggers are met.  For certain security types, additional inputs may be used, or some of the inputs described above may not 
be applicable.  For broker-quoted only securities, quotes from market makers or broker-dealers are obtained from sources 
recognized to be market participants.  In order to validate the pricing information and broker-dealer quotes, procedures are 
employed, where possible, that include comparisons with similar observable positions, comparisons with subsequent sales, 
discussions with brokers and observations of general market movements for those security classes.  For those securities trading in 
less liquid or illiquid markets with limited or no pricing information, unobservable inputs are used in order to measure the fair 
value of these securities.  In cases where this information is not available, such as for privately placed securities, fair value is 
estimated using an internal pricing matrix.  This matrix relies on judgment concerning the discount rate used in calculating expected 
future cash flows, credit quality, industry sector performance and expected maturity. 

Prices received from third parties are not adjusted; however, the third-party pricing services’ valuation methodologies and related 
inputs are evaluated and additional evaluation is performed to determine the appropriate level within the fair value hierarchy. 

The observable and unobservable inputs to the valuation methodologies are based on general standard inputs.  The standard inputs 
used in order of priority are benchmark yields, reported trades, broker/dealer quotes, issuer spreads, two-sided markets, 
benchmark securities, bids, offers and reference data.  Depending on the type of security or the daily market activity, standard 
inputs may be prioritized differently or may not be available for all securities on any given day.   

Cash and invested cash is carried at cost, which approximates fair value.  This category includes highly liquid debt instruments 
purchased with a maturity of three months or less.  Due to the nature of these assets, we believe these assets should be classified as 
Level 2. 

Plan Cash Flows 

It is our practice to make contributions to the qualified pension plans to comply with minimum funding requirements of the 
Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended and with guidance issued there under.  In accordance with such 
practice, no contributions were required for the years ended December 31, 2010 or 2009.  Based on our calculations, we do not 
expect to be required to make any contributions to our qualified pension plans in 2011 under applicable pension law.   

For our nonqualified pension plans, we fund the benefits as they become due to retirees.  The amount expected to be contributed 
to the nonqualified pension plans during 2011 is $10 million. 

We expect the following benefit payments (in millions): 

U.S. Other Postretirement Plans 

U.S. 

     U.S. 

Pension Plans 
Qualified    Nonqualified    Qualified    
    Non-U.S.   
    Defined     Reflecting 
    Benefit 
   Medicare 
    Pension    
    Plans 

Defined       Defined 
Benefit 
     Benefit 
Pension       Pension 

Part D 
   Subsidy 

     Plans 

Plans 

   Medicare 
   Part D 
   Subsidy 

   Not 
   Reflecting 
   Medicare 
   Part D 
   Subsidy 
 12 
 13 
 13 
 13 
 14 
 74 

 (2)   $ 
 (2)  
 (2)  
 (2)  
 (3)  
 (14)  

2011  
2012  
2013  
2014  
2015  
Following five years thereafter 

$ 

 63      $ 
 67        
 65        
 64        
 65        
 329       

 10    $ 
 10   
 10       
 10       
 11       
 45       

 13    $ 
 13   
 15   
 16   
 16   
 95   

 10     $ 
 11    
 11    
 11    
 11    
 60    

232 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                           
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
                       
  
  
  
                       
  
  
                       
                       
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
19.  Defined Contribution and Deferred Compensation Plans 

Defined Contribution Plans 

We sponsor contributory defined contribution plans for eligible employees and agents, which includes money purchase plans.  We 
make contributions and matching contributions to each of the active plans in accordance with the plan document and various 
limitations under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.  For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 
and 2008, expenses for these plans were $62 million, $63 million and $65 million respectively.   

Deferred Compensation Plans 

We sponsor six separate non-qualified, unfunded, deferred compensation plans for various groups:  employees; agents and non-
employee directors. 

The investment earnings expenses for certain investment options within the respective plans are hedged by total return swaps.  
Participant's account values increase or decrease due to investment earnings driven by market fluctuation.  Our expenses increase 
or decrease in direct proportion to the market's change for the participants’ investment options.  The total return swaps allow us to 
minimize the investment earnings expenses.  Presented below for the respective plans we have netted the investment earnings due 
to market fluctuation with the results of the total return swaps.  For further discussion on our total return swaps related to our 
deferred compensation plans, see Note 6. 

Information (in millions) with respect to these plans was as follows: 

Total liabilities (1) 
Investment held to fund liabilities (2) 

(1)  Reported in other liabilities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 
(2)  Reported in other assets on our Consolidated Balance Sheets. 

The Deferred Compensation Plan for Employees 

As of December 31,
2009  
2010  

$ 

 363     $ 
 130    

 332   
 118   

Eligible participants in this plan may elect to defer payment of a portion of their compensation as defined by the plan.  Plan 
participants may select from a menu of “phantom” investment options (identical to those offered under our qualified defined 
contribution plans) used as investment measures for calculating the investment return notionally credited to their deferrals.  Under 
the terms of the plan, we agree to pay out amounts based upon the aggregate performance of the investment measures selected by 
the participant.  We make matching contributions to these plans based upon amounts placed into the deferred compensation plans 
by individuals after participants have exceeded applicable limits of the Internal Revenue Code.  The amount of our contribution is 
calculated in accordance with the plan document, which is similar to our qualified defined contribution plans.  Expenses (income) 
(in millions) for this plan were as follows: 

Employer matching contributions  
Increase (decrease) in measurement of liabilities, net of total  
   return swap  
      Total plan expenses (income)  

$ 

$ 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

 6     $ 

 4    $ 

 5 

 1    
 7     $ 

 (5)  
 (1)   $ 

 21 
 26 

233 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
                        
 
       
  
                        
  
       
  
    
  
  
  
    
  
 
 
 
 
                        
  
                        
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
Deferred Compensation Plan for Agents 

We sponsor three deferred compensation plans for certain eligible agents.  Eligible participants in this plan may elect to defer 
payment of a portion of their compensation as defined by the plan.  The plan’s participants may select from a menu of “phantom” 
investment options (identical to those offered under our qualified defined contribution plans) used as investment measures for 
calculating the investment return notionally credited to their deferrals.  Under the terms of this plan, we agree to pay out amounts 
based upon the aggregate performance of the investment measures selected by the participant.  We make matching contributions 
to these plans based upon amounts placed into the deferred compensation plans by individuals after participants have exceeded 
applicable limits of the Internal Revenue Code.  The amount of our contribution is calculated in accordance with the plan 
document, which is similar to our qualified defined contribution plans.  Expenses (in millions) for these plans were as follows: 

Employer matching contributions  
Increase (decrease) in measurement of liabilities, net of total  
   return swap  
      Total plan expenses  

Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors 

For the Years Ended December 31,
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 3      $ 

 1      $ 

 3        
 6     $ 

 3        
 4     $ 

 2 

 - 
 2 

The plan allows for non-employee directors to defer a portion of their annual retainers and, in addition, we credit deferred stock 
units annually.  The menu of “phantom” investment options is identical to those offered in the employees’ plan.  For the years 
ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, expenses for this plan were $2 million, $1 million and less than $1 million, respectively.   

The terms of the plan for non-employee directors provide that plan participants who select our stock as the measure for their 
investment return will receive shares of our stock in settlement of this portion of their accounts at the time of distribution.  In 
addition, participants are precluded from diversifying any portion of their deferred compensation plan account that has been 
credited to the stock unit fund.  Consequently, changes in value of our stock do not affect the expenses associated with this portion 
of the deferred compensation plan.  

Deferred Compensation Plan for Former JP Agents 

Eligible former agents of JP may participate in this deferred compensation plan. Eligible agents are allowed to defer commissions 
and bonuses and specify where these deferral commissions will be invested in selected notional mutual funds.  Agents participate in 
the plan with the understanding that the return on these funds cannot be received until a specified age or in the event of a 
significant lifestyle change.  The funded amount is rebalanced to match the funds that have been elected under the agent deferred 
compensation plan.  The plan obligation increases with contributions, deferrals and investment income, and decreases with 
withdrawals and investment losses.  The plan’s assets increase with investment gains and decrease with investment losses and 
payouts of death benefits.  For the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, expenses (income) for this plan were $2 
million, $1 million and ($2) million, respectively.  

Our defined contribution and deferred compensation plans or portions thereof that were part of the Delaware sale are not 
reflected within the amounts reported above.  See Note 3 for additional information regarding the sale of Delaware. 

234 

  
 
 
 
 
                    
 
  
                    
  
  
  
  
       
       
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
20.  Stock-Based Incentive Compensation Plans 

LNC Stock-Based Incentive Plans  

We sponsor various incentive plans for our employees and directors, and for the employees and agents of our subsidiaries that 
provide for the issuance of stock options, performance shares (performance-vested shares as opposed to time-vested shares), 
SARS, restricted stock units, and restricted stock awards (“nonvested stock”).  We have a policy of issuing new shares to satisfy 
option exercises. 

Total compensation expense (in millions) for all of our stock-based incentive compensation plans was as follows: 

Stock options 
Performance shares 
SARs 
Restricted stock units and nonvested stock 

   Total 

Recognized tax benefit 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

$ 

 5     $ 
 (1)   
 -    
 12    

 16     $ 

 6    $ 
 (2)  
 -    
 9   

 13    $ 

 6     $ 

 5    $ 

 10   
 (3)   
 4   
 9   

 20   

 7   

Total unrecognized compensation expense (in millions) for all of our stock-based incentive compensation plans was as follows: 

2010  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2009  

2008  

Stock options 
Performance shares 
SARs 
Restricted stock units and nonvested  
   stock 
      Total unrecognized stock-based  
         incentive compensation expense 

   Weighted-   
   Average    
   Period 

   Expense 

   Weighted-   
   Average    
   Period 

   Expense 

   Weighted- 
   Average 
   Period 

 1.8    $ 
 -   
 3.7   

 6    
 -    
 2    

 1.7    $ 
 1.0   
 4.1   

 6   
 3   
 1   

Expense 
$ 

 4    
 -    
 1    

 19    

 1.9   

 13    

 2.2   

 16   

$ 

 24    

  $ 

 21    

   $ 

 26   

 1.7 
 1.9 
 3.9 

 1.4 

In the first quarter of 2010, a performance period from 2010-2012 was approved for certain of our executive officers by the 
Compensation Committee.  The award for executive officers participating in this performance period consisted of LNC stock 
options representing approximately 34% and LNC restricted stock units representing approximately 66% of the total award.  LNC 
stock options granted for this performance period vest ratably over the three-year period, based solely on a service condition.  
Under the 2010-2012 plan, a total of 301,524 LNC stock options and 575,353 LNC restricted stock units were granted.  In 
addition, while we were under TARP CPP, we complied with enhanced compensation restrictions for certain executives and 
employees.  These compensation restrictions ceased to apply after our repurchase of the Series B preferred shares from the U.S. 
Treasury as discussed in Note 15. 

In the first quarter of 2009, a performance period from 2009-2011 was approved for our executive officers by the Compensation 
Committee.  The award for executive officers participating in this performance period consisted of LNC restricted stock units 
representing approximately 27%, LNC stock options representing approximately 40% and performance cash awards representing 
approximately 33% of the total award. LNC stock options granted for this performance period vest ratably over the three-year 
period, based solely on a service condition.  Under the 2009-2011 plan, a total of 609,175 LNC stock options and 902,269 LNC 
restricted stock units were granted.  In addition, while we were under TARP CPP, we complied with enhanced compensation 
restrictions for certain executives and employees. These compensation restrictions ceased to apply after our repurchase of the 
Series B preferred shares from the U.S. Treasury as discussed in Note 15. 

235 

  
 
 
 
 
 
                    
  
                    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
                    
                    
  
  
                    
  
  
  
                    
  
  
  
                    
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
 
    
  
 
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
  
 
    
  
 
  
    
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
In the first quarter of 2008, a performance period from 2008-2010 was approved for our executive officers by the Compensation 
Committee.  Executive officers participating in the 2008-2010 performance period received one-half of their award in LNC stock 
options with 10-year terms, with the remainder of the award in a combination of performance shares and cash.  LNC stock options 
granted for this performance period vest ratably over the three-year period.  All awards granted during this period vest solely based 
on meeting service conditions.  Depending on performance results for this period, the ultimate payout of performance shares and 
cash could range from zero to 200% of the target award.  Under the 2008 long-term incentive compensation program, a total of 
1,564,800 LNC stock options were granted and 218,308 LNC performance shares were awarded. 

The option price assumptions used for our stock option incentive plans were as follows: 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

Dividend yield  
Expected volatility  
Risk-free interest rate  
Expected life (in years)  
Weighted-average fair value per option granted (1) 

 1.3  %   
 72.5  %   
  2.7-3.3  %   
 7.1   
 16.91    $ 

 1.8 %   
 78.7 %   
  1.5-3.2  %   
 5.8    
 9.47     $ 

 3.2 % 
 19.0 % 
  2.0-3.2 % 
 5.8 
 7.54 

$ 

(1)  Determined using a Black-Scholes options valuation methodology.   

Expected volatility is measured based on the historical volatility of the LNC stock price for the award’s expected life.  The expected 
life of the options granted represents the weighted-average period of time from the grant date to the exercise date. 

Information with respect to our incentive plans involving stock options with performance conditions (aggregate intrinsic value 
shown in millions) was as follows: 

    Weighted-    

   Weighted-       Average 
   Average 
   Exercise 

    Remaining     Aggregate 
Intrinsic 
  Contractual   
Value 
     Term 

Price 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2009  
Granted - original  
Exercised (includes shares tendered)  
Forfeited or expired  
   Outstanding as of December 31, 2010  

Shares 
 2,280,865    $ 
 96,639   
 (9,950)  
 (418,631)  
 1,948,923    $ 

 49.83       
 28.19       
 20.96       
 49.24       
 49.03       

 4.57      $ 

Vested or expected to vest as of December 31, 2010 (1) 

 1,514,579    $ 

 49.95       

 4.19      $ 

Exercisable as of December 31, 2010  

 1,493,153    $ 

 49.91       

 4.11      $ 

(1) 

Includes estimated forfeitures. 

 1 

 1 

 1 

The total fair value of options vested during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, was $9 million, $1 million and $6 
million, respectively.  The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, was 
zero, zero and $1 million, respectively.   

236 

  
 
 
 
               
  
                  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
                     
  
  
  
  
    
  
                     
  
   
  
  
                     
  
  
                     
  
  
                     
  
   
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
 
 
Information with respect to our incentive plans involving stock options with service conditions (aggregate intrinsic value shown in 
millions) was as follows: 

    Weighted-    

   Weighted-       Average 
   Average 
   Exercise 

    Remaining     Aggregate 
Intrinsic 
  Contractual   
Value 
     Term 

Price 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2009  
Granted - original  
Exercised (includes shares tendered)  
Forfeited or expired  
   Outstanding as of December 31, 2010  

Shares 
 8,625,471    $ 
 237,674   
 (74,736)  
 (1,032,926)  
 7,755,483    $ 

 46.81       
 25.95       
 24.21       
 41.40       
 47.20       

 3.09      $ 

Vested or expected to vest as of December 31, 2010 (1) 

 7,555,946    $ 

 47.83       

 2.96      $ 

Exercisable as of December 31, 2010  

 7,247,782    $ 

 49.05       

 2.69      $ 

(1) 

Includes estimated forfeitures. 

 6 

 4 

 2 

The total fair value of options vested during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, was $4 million, $8 million and $6 
million, respectively.  The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, was 
zero, zero and $41 million, respectively.   

Information with respect to our performance shares was as follows: 

     Weighted-    
      Average 
   Grant-Date   
     Fair Value  
 47.18      
 56.09      
 42.28      

Shares 
 326,495      $ 
 (115,800)  
 210,695   

 $ 

Nonvested as of December 31, 2009 
Forfeited 
   Nonvested as of December 31, 2010 

Stock Appreciation Rights  

Under our incentive compensation plan, we issue SARs to certain planners and advisors who have full-time contracts with us.  The 
SARs under this program are rights on our stock that are cash settled and become exercisable in increments of 25% over the four-
year period following the SARs grant date.  SARs are granted with an exercise price equal to the fair market value of our stock at 
the date of grant and, unless cancelled earlier due to certain terminations of employment, expire five years from the date of grant.  
Generally, such SARs are transferable only upon death.   

We recognize compensation expense for SARs based on the fair value method using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model.  
Compensation expense and the related liability are recognized on a straight-line basis over the vesting period of the SARs.  The 
SARs liability is marked-to-market through net income, which causes volatility in net income (loss) as a result of changes in the 
market value of our stock and reported within underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses on our Consolidated 
Statements of Income (Loss).  We have hedged a portion of this volatility by purchasing call options on LNC stock.  Call options 
hedging vested SARs are also marked-to-market through net income.  See Note 6 for further information on our call options on 
LNC stock.  The SARs liability as of December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, was $1 million, $1 million and zero, respectively, and 
reported within other liabilities on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.   

237 

  
 
 
                     
  
  
  
  
    
  
                     
  
   
  
  
                     
  
  
                  
  
  
                     
  
   
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
 
 
 
 
                    
  
                    
  
   
                    
  
                    
  
    
 
 
 
The option price assumptions used for our SARs plan were as follows: 

Dividend yield 
Expected volatility 
Risk-free interest rate 
Expected life (in years) 
Weighted-average fair value per SAR granted 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

 2.4  %   
 38.2  %   
 1.8  %   
 5.0   
 7.81    $ 

 0.2 %   
    106.0 %   
 2.4 %  
 5.0   
 12.47    $ 

 1.2  % 
 37.0  % 
 3.3  % 
 5.0 
 15.26 

$ 

Expected volatility is measured based on the implied volatility of the LNC stock price for the award’s expected life.  The expected 
life of the award granted represents the period of time from the grant date to the end of the contractual term.  

Information with respect to our SARs plan (aggregate intrinsic value shown in millions) was as follows: 

    Weighted-          

   Weighted-       Average 
   Average 
   Exercise 

    Remaining      Aggregate 
  Contractual     Intrinsic 
     Term 

     Value 

Price 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2009  
Granted - original  
Exercised (includes shares tendered)  
Forfeited or expired  
   Outstanding as of December 31, 2010  

Shares 
 766,569    $ 
 99,000   
 (5,417)  
 (144,521)  
 715,631    $ 

 49.13      
 28.20      
 16.24      
 46.31      
 47.02      

 2.03      $ 

Vested or expected to vest as of December 31, 2010 (1) 

 697,580    $ 

 47.53      

 2.00      $ 

Exercisable as of December 31, 2010  

 502,881    $ 

 53.67      

 1.51      $ 

(1) 

Includes estimated forfeitures. 

 1 

 1 

 - 

The payment for SARs exercised during the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008, was zero, zero and $1 million, 
respectively. 

Restricted Stock Units 

We award restricted stock units under the incentive compensation plan, generally subject to a three-year vesting period.  
Information with respect to our restricted stock units was as follows: 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2009 
Granted 
Vested 
Forfeited 
   Outstanding as of December 31, 2010 

     Weighted-    
      Average 
   Grant-Date   
     Fair Value  
 20.78     
 25.33     
 24.41     
 22.98     
 23.38     

Shares 
 1,025,924      $ 
 692,569         
 (64,218)        
 (90,347)        
 1,563,928      $ 

238 

  
 
 
                    
  
                    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
                  
  
  
  
  
  
                     
  
    
  
  
                     
  
  
                     
  
  
                     
  
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
 
 
 
 
 
                 
  
                 
  
   
                 
  
                    
  
Nonvested Stock   

We have awarded nonvested stock under the incentive compensation plan, generally subject to a three-year vesting period.  
Information with respect to our nonvested stock was as follows:  

     Weighted-    
      Average 
   Grant-Date   
     Fair Value  
 68.15    
 68.34    
 67.08    
 -    

Shares 
 205,643      $ 
 (181,508)        
 (24,135)        
 -      $ 

Nonvested as of December 31, 2009 
Vested 
Forfeited 
   Nonvested as of December 31, 2010 

21.  Statutory Information and Restrictions  

The Company’s domestic life insurance subsidiaries prepare financial statements in accordance with statutory accounting principles 
(“SAP”) prescribed or permitted by the insurance departments of their states of domicile, which may vary materially from GAAP.  
Prescribed SAP includes the Accounting Practices and Procedures Manual of the National Association of Insurance 
Commissioners (“NAIC”) as well as state laws, regulations and administrative rules.  Permitted SAP encompasses all accounting 
practices not so prescribed.  The principal differences between statutory financial statements and financial statements prepared in 
accordance with GAAP are that statutory financial statements do not reflect DAC, some bond portfolios may be carried at 
amortized cost, assets and liabilities are presented net of reinsurance, contract holder liabilities are generally valued using more 
conservative assumptions and certain assets are non-admitted. 

Our insurance subsidiaries are subject to the applicable laws and regulations of their respective states.  Changes in these laws and 
regulations could change capital levels or capital requirements for our insurance subsidiaries. 

Statutory capital and surplus; net gain (loss) from operations, after-tax;  net income (loss) and dividends to LNC Parent Company 
amounts (in millions) below consists of all or a combination of the following entities: LNL, First Penn-Pacific Life Insurance 
Company, Lincoln Reinsurance Company of South Carolina, Lincoln Reinsurance Company of South Carolina II, Lincoln Life & 
Annuity Company of New York (“LLANY”), Lincoln Financial Group South Carolina Reinsurance Company, Lincoln 
Reinsurance Company of Vermont I and Lincoln Reinsurance Company of Vermont II. 

U.S. capital and surplus 

U.S. net gain (loss) from operations, after-tax 
U.S. net income (loss) 
U.S. dividends to LNC Parent Company 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

 6,955    $ 

 6,524   

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 557     $ 
 432    
 684    

 913    $ 
 (4)   
 455   

 561   
 (234)  
 450   

The increase in statutory net income (loss) for the year ended December 31, 2010, from that of 2009 was primarily due to a 
significant decrease in realized losses on investments due to improving market conditions throughout 2010. 

The increase in statutory net income (loss) for the year ended December 31, 2009, from that of 2008 was primarily due to the 
improved market conditions in 2009.  The new statutory reserving standard (commonly called “VACARVM”) that was developed 
by the NAIC replaced current statutory reserve practices for variable annuities with guaranteed benefits, such as GWBs, and was 
effective December 31, 2009.  The actual effect of adoption was relatively neutral to RBC ratios and future dividend capacity of our 
insurance subsidiaries with a slight decrease in statutory reserves offset by a higher capital requirement.  We utilize captive 
reinsurance structures, as well as third-party reinsurance arrangements, to lessen the negative effect on statutory capital and 
dividend capacity in our life insurance subsidiaries.   

239 

  
 
 
 
 
                 
  
                 
  
   
                 
  
                 
  
 
  
 
 
 
                    
  
                    
  
  
 
                    
  
                 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
The states of domicile of the Company’s insurance subsidiaries have adopted certain prescribed accounting practices that differ 
from those found in NAIC SAP.  These prescribed practices are the use of continuous Commissioners Annuity Reserve Valuation 
Method (“CARVM”) in the calculation of reserves as prescribed by the state of New York and the calculation of reserves on 
universal life policies based on the Indiana universal life method as prescribed by the state of Indiana.  The insurance subsidiaries 
also have several accounting practices permitted by the states of domicile that differ from those found in NAIC SAP.  Specifically, 
these are accounting for the lesser of the face amount of all amounts outstanding under an LOC and the value of the Valuation of 
Life Insurance Policies Model Regulation (“XXX”) additional statutory reserves as an admitted asset and a form of surplus as of 
December 31, 2009; and the use of a more conservative valuation interest rate on certain annuities as of December 31, 2010 and 
2009. 

The effects on statutory surplus compared to NAIC statutory surplus from the use of these prescribed and permitted practices (in 
millions) were as follows: 

Calculation of reserves using the Indiana universal life method 
Calculation of reserves using continuous CARVM 
Conservative valuation rate on certain variable annuities 
Lesser of LOC and XXX additional reserve as surplus 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

$ 

 314     $ 
 (5)   
 (15)   
 457    

 328   
 (6)   
 (11)  
 412   

Our insurance subsidiaries are subject to certain insurance department regulatory restrictions as to the transfer of funds and 
payment of dividends to the holding company.  Under Indiana laws and regulations, our Indiana insurance subsidiaries, including 
our primary insurance subsidiary, LNL, may pay dividends to LNC without prior approval of the Indiana Insurance Commissioner 
(the “Commissioner”), only from unassigned surplus and must receive prior approval of the Commissioner to pay a dividend if 
such dividend, along with all other dividends paid within the preceding twelve consecutive months, would exceed the statutory 
limitation.  The current statutory limitation is the greater of 10% of the insurer’s contract holders’ surplus or statutory net gain 
from operations for the previous calendar twelve-month period (both shown on the last annual statement on file with the 
Commissioner), but in no event to exceed statutory unassigned surplus.  As discussed above, we may not consider the benefit from 
the statutory accounting principles relating to our insurance subsidiaries’ deferred tax assets in calculating available dividends.  
Indiana law gives the Commissioner broad discretion to disapprove requests for dividends in excess of these limits.  New York, the 
state of domicile of our other major insurance subsidiary, LLANY, has similar restrictions, except that in New York it is the lesser 
of 10% of surplus to contract holders as of the immediately preceding calendar year-end or net gain from operations for the 
immediately preceding calendar year, not including realized capital gains.  We expect our domestic insurance subsidiaries could pay 
dividends of approximately $630 million in 2011 without prior approval from the respective state commissioners. 

All payments of principal and interest on the surplus notes must be approved by the respective Commissioner of Insurance. 

240 

  
 
 
 
                 
  
                 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
22.  Fair Value of Financial Instruments 

The carrying values and estimated fair values of our financial instruments (in millions) were as follows: 

Assets  
AFS securities:  
   Fixed maturity securities  
   VIEs' fixed maturity securities  
   Equity securities  
Trading securities  
Mortgage loans on real estate  
Derivative investments  
Other investments  
Cash and invested cash  
Separate account assets  

Liabilities  
Future contract benefits:  
   Indexed annuity contracts embedded derivatives  
   GLB reserves embedded derivatives  
Other contract holder funds:  
   Remaining guaranteed interest and similar contracts  
   Account values of certain investment contracts  

Short-term debt (1) 
Long-term debt  
Reinsurance related embedded derivatives  
VIEs' liabilities - derivative instruments  
Other liabilities:  
   Deferred compensation plans embedded derivatives  
   Credit default swaps  

As of December 31,  

2010  

2009  

Carrying 
Value 

Fair 
   Value 

   Carrying 
   Value 

Fair 
   Value 

$ 

 68,030    $ 
 584   
 197   
 2,596   
 6,752   
 1,076   
 1,038   
 2,741   
 84,630   

 68,030    $ 
 584    
 197    
 2,596    
 7,183    
 1,076    
 1,038    
 2,741    
 84,630   

 60,818    $ 
 -   
 278   
 2,505   
 7,178   
 1,010   
 1,057   
 4,025   
 73,500   

 60,818 
 - 
 278 
 2,505 
 7,316 
 1,010 
 1,057 
 4,025 
 73,500 

 (497)  
 (408)  

 (497)   
 (408)   

 (419)  
 (676)  

 (419)
 (676)

 (1,119)  
 (26,130)  

 (1,119)  
    (27,142)  

 (940)  
    (24,114)  

 (940)
    (24,323)

 (351)  
 (5,399)  
 (102)  
 (209)  

 (364)   
 (5,512)  
 (102)   
 (209)   

 (350)  
 (5,050)  
 (31)  
 -   

 (363)  
 (16)  

 (363)   
 (16)   

 (332)  
 (65)  

 (349)
 (4,759)
 (31)
 - 

 (332)
 (65)

(1)  The difference between the carrying value and fair value of short-term debt as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, related to 

current maturities of long-term debt.  

241 

  
 
 
 
                          
   
                         
   
  
                        
  
  
                        
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                             
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Valuation Methodologies and Associated Inputs for Financial Instruments Not Carried at Fair Value 

The following discussion outlines the methodologies and assumptions used to determine the fair value of our financial instruments 
not carried at fair value on our Consolidated Balance Sheets.  Considerable judgment is required to develop these assumptions used 
to measure fair value.  Accordingly, the estimates shown are not necessarily indicative of the amounts that would be realized in a 
one-time, current market exchange of all of our financial instruments.  

Mortgage Loans on Real Estate 

The fair value of mortgage loans on real estate is established using a discounted cash flow method based on credit rating, maturity 
and future income.  The ratings for mortgages in good standing are based on property type, location, market conditions, 
occupancy, debt-service coverage, loan-to-value, quality of tenancy, borrower and payment record.  The fair value for impaired 
mortgage loans is based on the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, the loan’s 
market price or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent.   

Other Investments 

The carrying value of our assets classified as other investments approximates their fair value.  Other investments include LPs and 
other privately held investments that are accounted for using the equity method of accounting. 

Other Contract Holder Funds 

Other contract holder funds include remaining guaranteed interest and similar contracts and account values of certain investment 
contracts.  The fair value for the remaining guaranteed interest and similar contracts is estimated using discounted cash flow 
calculations as of the balance sheet date.  These calculations are based on interest rates currently offered on similar contracts with 
maturities that are consistent with those remaining for the contracts being valued.  As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, the 
remaining guaranteed interest and similar contracts carrying value approximates fair value.  The fair value of the account values of 
certain investment contracts is based on their approximate surrender value as of the balance sheet date. 

Short-term and Long-term Debt   

The fair value of long-term debt is based on quoted market prices or estimated using discounted cash flow analysis determined in 
conjunction with our incremental borrowing rate as of the balance sheet date for similar types of borrowing arrangements where 
quoted prices are not available.  For short-term debt, excluding current maturities of long-term debt, the carrying value 
approximates fair value.   

Financial Instruments Carried at Fair Value 

We did not have any assets or liabilities measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis as of December 31, 2010, or December 31, 
2009, and we noted no changes in our valuation methodologies between these periods.  

242 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The following summarizes our financial instruments carried at fair value (in millions) on a recurring basis by the fair value hierarchy 
levels described above: 

Assets 
Investments: 
   Fixed maturity AFS securities: 
      Corporate bonds 
      U.S. Government bonds 
      Foreign government bonds 
      MBS: 
         CMOs 
         MPTS 
         CMBS 
      ABS CDOs 
      State and municipal bonds 
      Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities 
      VIEs' fixed maturity securities 
   Equity AFS securities: 
      Banking securities 
      Insurance securities 
      Other financial services securities 
      Other securities 
   Trading securities 
   Derivative investments 
Cash and invested cash 
Separate account assets 
            Total assets 

Liabilities 
Future contract benefits: 
   Indexed annuity contracts embedded derivatives 
   GLB reserves embedded derivatives 
Long-term debt - interest rate swap agreements 
Reinsurance related embedded derivatives 
VIEs' liabilities - derivative instruments 
Other liabilities: 
   Deferred compensation plans embedded derivatives 
   Credit default swaps 
            Total liabilities 

As of December 31, 2010 

   Quoted 
 Prices 
in Active 
Markets for 

  Significant       Significant            

   Identical 
 Assets 
   (Level 1) 

   Observable  Unobservable     Total 
Fair 
      Inputs 
      Value 
      (Level 2) 

Inputs 
      (Level 3) 

   $ 

 60       $ 
 160         
 -          

 49,864      $ 

 3     
 395     

 1,816       $ 
 2         
 113         

 51,740 
 165 
 508 

 -          
 -          
 -          
 -          
 -          
 18         
 -          

 -          
 3          
 -          
 34         
 2          
 -          
 -          
 -          

 5,734     
 2,985     
 1,944     
 2     
 3,155     
 1,260     
 584     

 58     
 -      
 8     
 2     
 2,518     
 (419)    
 2,741     
 84,630     

   $ 

 277       $   155,464      $ 

 23         
 96         
 109         
 172         
 -         
 119         
 -         

 5,757 
 3,081 
 2,053 
 174 
 3,155 
 1,397 
 584 

 -         
 34         
 24         
 34         
 76         
 1,495         
 -         
 -         

 58 
 37 
 32 
 70 
 2,596 
 1,076 
 2,741 
 84,630 
 4,113       $   159,854 

   $ 

   $ 

 -        $ 
 -          
 -          
 -          
 -          

 -          
 -          
 -        $ 

 -      $ 
 -      
 (55)    
 (102)    
 -      

 (497)      $ 
 (408)        
 -         
 -         
 (209)        

 (497)
 (408)
 (55)
 (102)
 (209)

 -     
 -     
 (157)     $ 

 (363)        
 (16)        
 (1,493)      $ 

 (363)
 (16)
 (1,650)

243 

  
 
 
                              
  
                              
        
  
        
  
        
  
                         
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                              
  
          
          
        
  
                         
                              
                         
  
     
     
                              
       
          
    
    
          
       
          
   
    
          
       
          
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
       
          
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
       
          
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
                              
       
          
    
    
          
       
          
   
    
          
       
          
   
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
       
          
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
Assets 
Investments: 
   Fixed maturity AFS securities: 
     Corporate bonds 
     U.S. Government bonds 
     Foreign government bonds 
     MBS: 
         CMOs 
         MPTS 
         CMBS 
      ABS: 
         CDOs 
         CLNs 
      State and municipal bonds 
      Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities 
   Equity AFS securities: 
      Banking securities 
      Insurance securities 
      Other financial services securities 
      Other securities 
   Trading securities 
   Derivative investments 
Cash and invested cash 
Separate account assets 
           Total assets 

Liabilities 
Future contract benefits: 
   Indexed annuity contracts embedded derivatives 
   GLB reserves embedded derivatives 
Long-term debt - interest rate swap agreements 
Reinsurance related embedded derivatives 
Other liabilities: 
   Deferred compensation plans embedded derivatives 
   Credit default swaps 
           Total liabilities 

As of December 31, 2009 

   Quoted 
 Prices 
   in Active 
Markets for 

  Significant       Significant            

   Identical 
 Assets 
   (Level 1) 

   Observable  Unobservable     Total 
Fair 
      Inputs 
      Value 
      (Level 2) 

Inputs 
      (Level 3) 

   $ 

 57       $ 
 158         
 -         

 43,234      $ 
 34      
 413      

 2,070       $ 
 3         
 92         

 45,361 
 195 
 505 

 -          
 -          
 -          

 5,871     
 2,965     
 1,872     

 -          
 -          
 -          
 15          

 23          
 3          
 -          
 34          
 3         
 -         
 -         
 -         

 5      
 -      
 1,968     
 1,035     

 124      
 -      
 6      
 -      
 2,411     
 (358)    
 4,025     
 73,500     

   $ 

 293       $   137,105      $ 

 35         
 101         
 259         

 153         
 322         
 -         
 156         

 5,906 
 3,066 
 2,131 

 158 
 322 
 1,968 
 1,206 

 -         
 43         
 22         
 23         
 91         
 1,368         
 -         
 -         

 147 
 46 
 28 
 57 
 2,505 
 1,010 
 4,025 
 73,500 
 4,738       $   142,136 

   $ 

   $ 

 -       $ 
 -         
 -          
 -         

 -         
 -         
 -       $ 

 -       $ 
 -      
 (54)    
 (31)    

 (419)      $ 
 (676)        
 -         
 -         

 (419)
 (676)
 (54)
 (31)

 -      
 -      
 (85)     $ 

 (332)        
 (65)        
 (1,492)      $ 

 (332)
 (65)
 (1,577)

244 

  
 
 
                             
  
  
                             
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                             
  
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                             
  
          
          
        
  
                        
                        
                        
  
     
     
                        
       
         
    
    
          
       
         
    
    
          
       
         
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
          
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
           
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
           
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
          
    
    
          
     
          
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
          
    
    
          
     
  
     
  
The following summarizes changes to our financial instruments carried at fair value (in millions) and classified within Level 3 of the 
fair value hierarchy.  This summary excludes any impact of amortization of DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL.  The gains and losses 
below may include changes in fair value due in part to observable inputs that are a component of the valuation methodology. 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

$ 

Investments: (3) 
   Fixed maturity AFS securities:  
      Corporate bonds  
      U.S. Government bonds  
      Foreign government bonds  
      MBS:  
         CMOs  
         MPTS  
         CMBS  
      ABS:  
         CDOs  
         CLNs  
      Hybrid and redeemable   
         preferred securities  
   Equity AFS securities:  
      Insurance securities  
      Other financial services securities  
      Other securities  
   Trading securities  
   Derivative investments  
Future contract benefits: (4) 
   Indexed annuity contracts embedded   
      derivatives  
   GLB reserves embedded derivatives  
VIEs' liabilities - derivative   
   instruments (5) 
Other liabilities:  
   Deferred compensation plans embedded    
      derivatives (6) 
   Credit default swaps (7) 
            Total, net  

$ 

Items 

   Included 

in 
   Net 

Income 

Beginning 
Fair 
Value 

      Transfers  

in  

      Sales, 

   Gains  
   (Losses)      Issuances, 
   Maturities, 
   Settlements,    
      Calls, 
      Net 

   OCI  
and  

   Other (1) 

In or  
   Out  
of  

      Level 3,  
      Net (2) 

 $ 

 2,070 
 3 
 92 

 35 
 101 
 259 

 153 
 322 

 156 

 43 
 22 
 23 
 91 
 1,368 

 (419)
 (676)

 -  

 (42) 
 -  
 -  

 (5) 
 -  
 (47) 

 1  
 -  

 3  

 -  
 -  
 -  
 3  
 (151) 

 (81) 
 268 

 16  

 $ 

 56      $ 
 -         
 8         

 (218)    $ 
 (4)   
 (4)   

 6         
 3         
 87         

 30         
 278         

 (9)   
 (8)   
 (72)   

 (12)   
 -    

 (26)        

 (14)   

 2         
 7         
 (1)        
 (10)        
 7         

 (11)   
 (5)   
 12    
 (7)   
 271    

 -         
 -         

 3    
 -    

 (50)
 3 
 17 

 (4)
 - 
 (118)

 - 
 (600)

 - 

 - 
 - 
 - 
 (1)
 - 

 - 
 - 

   Ending 

Fair 
   Value 

$ 

 1,816 
 2 
 113 

 23 
 96 
 109 

 172 
 - 

 119 

 34 
 24 
 34 
 76 
 1,495 

 (497)
 (408)

 -         

 -    

 (225)

 (209)

 (332)
 (65) 
 3,246 

 $ 

 (34) 
 7  
 (62) 

 $ 

 -         
 -         
 447      $ 

 3    
 42    
 (33)    $ 

 - 
 - 
 (978)

 (363)
 (16)
 2,620 

$ 

245 

  
 
 
 
                                 
                            
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
                            
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                            
    
  
  
  
  
                            
  
                            
  
  
                            
  
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
 
    
 
    
        
   
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
  
    
    
  
  
For the Year Ended December 31, 2009 

Items 

   Included 

in 
   Net 

Income 

Beginning 
Fair 
Value 

      Transfers  

in  

      Sales, 

   Gains  
   (Losses)      Issuances, 
   Maturities, 
   Settlements,    
      Calls, 
      Net 

   OCI  
and  

   Other (1) 

In or  
   Out  
of  

      Level 3,  
      Net (2) 

   Ending 

Fair 
   Value 

$ 

Investments: (3) 
   Fixed maturity AFS securities:  
      Corporate bonds  
      U.S. Government bonds  
      Foreign government bonds  
      MBS:  
         CMOs  
         MPTS  
         CMBS  
      ABS:  
         CDOs  
         CLNs  
      State and municipal bonds  
      Hybrid and redeemable   
         preferred securities  
   Equity AFS securities:  
      Insurance securities  
      Other financial services securities  
      Other securities  
   Trading securities  
   Derivative investments  
Future contract benefits: (4) 
   Indexed annuity contracts embedded  
      derivatives  
   GLB reserves embedded derivatives  
Other liabilities:  
   Deferred compensation plans embedded      
      derivatives (6) 
   Credit default swaps (7) 
            Total, net  

$ 

 2,335    $ 
 3   
 60   

 (46)    $ 
 -    
 1    

 321        $ 
 -       
 2       

 (239)       $ 
 -          
 10          

 (301)   $ 
 -   
 19   

 2,070 
 3 
 92 

 161   
 18   
 244   

 151   
 50   
 125   

 (8)   
 -    
 1    

 (35)   
 -    
 -    

 35       
 1       
 59       

 61       
 272       
 -       

 (12)         
 97          
 (45)         

 (22)         
 -          
 69          

 (141)  
 (15)  
 -   

 (2)  
 -   
 (194)  

 117   

 (21)   

 49       

 2          

 9   

 51   
 20   
 23   
 81   
 2,147   

 (7)   
 (3)   
 2    
 34    
 (712)   

 20       
 7       
 (1)      
 -       
 (135)      

 (21)         
 (2)         
 (1)         
 (7)         
 68          

 -   
 -   
 -   
 (17)  
 -   

 35 
 101 
 259 

 153 
 322 
 - 

 156 

 43 
 22 
 23 
 91 
 1,368 

 (252)  
 (2,904)  

 (75)   
 2,228   

 -       
 -       

 (92)         
 -          

 -   
 -   

 (419)
 (676)

 (336)  
 (51)  
 2,043    $ 

 (63)   
 (37)   
 1,259    $ 

 -       
 -       
 691        $ 

 67          
 23          
 (105)       $ 

 -   
 -   
 (642)   $ 

 (332)
 (65)
 3,246 

246 

  
 
 
                                 
                                 
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
                                 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                                 
    
  
  
  
  
                            
  
                            
  
  
                            
  
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
     
    
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
     
    
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
     
    
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
  
    
  
     
    
    
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
For the Year Ended December 31, 2008 

Items 

   Included 

in 
   Net 

Income 

Beginning 
Fair 
Value 

      Transfers  

in  

      Sales, 

   Gains  
   (Losses)      Issuances, 
   Maturities, 
   Settlements,    
      Calls, 
      Net 

   OCI  
and  

   Other (1) 

In or  
   Out  
of  

      Level 3,  
      Net (2) 

   Ending 

Fair 
   Value 

 2,529     $ 
 3    
 80    

 (153)   $ 
 -    
 -    

 (444)       $ 
 -          
 (12)         

 425    $ 
 -   
 -   

 2,335 
 3 
 60 

 (22)      $ 
 -          
 (8)         

 (12)        
 1          
 26         

 (29)  
 (25)  
 42   

 47         
 -          
 (32)        

 -   
 (250)  
 14   

 (53)         
 (10)         
 (200)         

 (86)         
 (360)         
 (2)         

 (42)         

 38         

 9   

 -          
 (19)         
 (1)         
 3          
 -          
 30          

 1          
 68         
 10         
 8          
 (14)        
 147         

 -   
 -   
 -   
 -   
 12   
 -   

 161 
 18 
 244 

 151 
 50 
 125 

 117 

 - 
 51 
 20 
 23 
 81 
 2,147 

 276    
 52    
 375    

 188    
 660    
 145    

 112    

 -    
 3    
 34    
 17    
 112    
 767    

 (21)  
 -    
 1    

 2    
 -    
 -    

 -    

 (1)   
 (1)   
 (23)  
 (5)   
 (29)  
 1,203   

 (389)  
 (279)  

 196   
 (2,625)  

 -          
 -          

 (59)        
 -          

 -   
 -   

 (252)
 (2,904)

 (410)  
 -    
 4,275     $ 

 43   
 (51)  
 (1,464)   $ 

 -          
 -          
 (1,196)       $ 

 31         
 -          
 230       $ 

 -   
 -   
 198    $ 

 (336)
 (51)
 2,043 

$ 

Investments: (3) 
   Fixed maturity AFS securities:  
      Corporate bonds  
      U.S. Government bonds  
      Foreign government bonds  
      MBS:  
         CMOs  
         MPTS  
         CMBS  
      ABS:  
         CDOs  
         CLNs  
      State and municipal bonds  
      Hybrid and redeemable   
         preferred securities  
   Equity AFS securities:  
      Banking securities  
      Insurance securities  
      Other financial services securities  
      Other securities  
   Trading securities  
   Derivative investments  
Future contract benefits: (4) 
   Indexed annuity contracts embedded  
      derivatives  
   GLB reserves embedded derivatives   
Other liabilities:  
   Deferred compensation plans embedded      
      derivatives (6) 
   Credit default swaps (7) 
            Total, net  

$ 

(1)  The changes in fair value of the interest rate swaps are offset by an adjustment to derivative investments.  See “Derivatives 

Instruments Designated and Qualifying as Fair Value Hedges” section in Note 6. 

(2)  Transfers in or out of Level 3 for AFS and trading securities are displayed at amortized cost as of the beginning-of-period.  For 
AFS and trading securities, the difference between beginning-of-year amortized cost and beginning-of-year fair value was 
included in OCI and earnings, respectively, in prior years. 

(3)  Amortization and accretion of premiums and discounts are included in net investment income on our Consolidated 

Statements of Income (Loss).  Gains (losses) from sales, maturities, settlements and calls and OTTI are included in realized 
gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  

(4)  Gains (losses) from sales, maturities, settlements and calls are included in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements 

of Income (Loss). 

(5)  The changes in fair value of the credit default swaps and contingency forwards are included in realized gain (loss) on our 

Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

(6)  Deferrals and subsequent changes in fair value for the participants’ investment options are reported in underwriting, 

acquisition, insurance and other expenses on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss). 

(7)  Gains (losses) from sales, maturities, settlements and calls are included in net investment income on our Consolidated 

Statements of Income (Loss). 

247 

  
 
 
                                 
                                 
  
  
     
  
  
  
  
                                 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                                 
    
  
  
  
  
                                 
  
                            
  
  
                            
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
    
  
     
          
           
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
The following summarizes changes in unrealized gains (losses) included in net income, excluding any impact of amortization of 
DAC, VOBA, DSI and DFEL and changes in future contract benefits, related to financial instruments carried at fair value  
classified within Level 3 that we still held (in millions): 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2009 

2008 

2010 

Investments: (1) 
   Trading securities  
   Derivative investments  
Future contract benefits: (1) 
   Indexed annuity contracts embedded derivatives   
   GLB reserves embedded derivatives   
VIEs' liabilities - derivative instruments (1) 
Other liabilities:  
   Deferred compensation plans embedded derivatives (2) 
   Credit default swaps (3) 
      Total, net   

$ 

 -     $ 

 32     $ 

 (162)  

 (486)  

 44   
 419   
 16   

 (17)  
 2,405    
 -    

 (24)  
 1,114   

 23   
 (2,484)  
 -   

 (34)  
 (12)  
 271    $ 

 (63)  
 (14)  
 1,857     $ 

 43   
 (51)  
 (1,379)  

$ 

(1) 
(2) 
(3) 

Included in realized gain (loss) on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).   
Included in underwriting, acquisition, insurance and other expenses on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).  
Included in net investment income on our Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss).   

The following provides the components of the transfers in and out of Level 3 (in millions) as reported above: 

For the Year Ended 
December 31, 2010 
   Transfers 
   Out of 
   Level 3 

Transfers 
In to 
Level 3 

   Total 

Investments: 
   Fixed maturity AFS securities: 
      Corporate bonds 
      U.S. Government bonds 
      Foreign government bonds 
      MBS: 
         CMOs 
         CMBS 
      ABS CLNs 
   Trading securities 
Future contract benefits: 
   VIEs' liabilities - derivative instruments 
            Total, net  

$ 

 147    $ 
 3    
 17   

 (197)   $ 
 -    
 -    

 -    
 3    
 -    
 -    

 (4)   
 (121)  
 (600)  
 (1)   

 (50)  
 3   
 17   

 (4)  
 (118)  
 (600)  
 (1)  

 (225)  
 (55)   $ 

 -    
 (923)   $ 

 (225)  
 (978)  

$ 

Transfers in and out of Level 3 are generally the result of observable market information on a security no longer being available or 
becoming available to our pricing vendors.  For the year ended December 31, 2010, our corporate bonds and CMBS transfers in 
and out were attributable primarily to the securities’ observable market information being available or no longer being available, 
respectively, and the ABS CLNs transfer out of Level 3 and VIEs’ liabilities – derivative instruments transfer into Level 3 are 
related to new accounting guidance that is discussed in Note 4.  For the year ended December 31, 2010, there were no significant 
transfers between Level 1 and 2 of the fair value hierarchy. 

248 

  
 
 
                             
  
                        
  
  
 
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
                                
  
                                
  
                                
     
  
  
                                
     
  
  
                                
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
 
23.  Segment Information  

We provide products and services in two operating businesses and report results through four business segments as follows: 

Business 
Retirement Solutions 

  Corresponding Segments 
  Annuities 
  Defined Contribution 

Insurance Solutions 

  Life Insurance 
  Group Protection 

We also have Other Operations, which includes the financial data for operations that are not directly related to the business 
segments.  Our reporting segments reflect the manner by which our chief operating decision makers view and manage the business.  
The following is a brief description of these segments and Other Operations.   

Retirement Solutions 

The Retirement Solutions business provides its products through two segments:  Annuities and Defined Contribution.  The 
Annuities segment provides tax-deferred investment growth and lifetime income opportunities for its clients by offering individual 
fixed annuities, including indexed annuities and variable annuities.  The Defined Contribution segment provides employer-
sponsored variable and fixed annuities, defined benefit, individual retirement accounts and mutual-fund based programs in the 
retirement plan marketplaces.  

Insurance Solutions 

The Insurance Solutions business provides its products through two segments:  Life Insurance and Group Protection.  The Life 
Insurance segment offers wealth protection and transfer opportunities through term insurance, a linked-benefit product (which is a 
UL policy linked with riders that provide for long-term care costs) and both single and survivorship versions of UL and VUL, 
including corporate-owned UL and VUL insurance and bank-owned UL and VUL insurance products.  The Group Protection 
segment offers group life, disability and dental insurance to employers, and its products are marketed primarily through a national 
distribution system of regional group offices.  These offices develop business through employee benefit brokers, third-party 
administrators and other employee benefit firms.  

Other Operations 

Other Operations includes investments related to the excess capital in our insurance subsidiaries; investments in media properties 
and other corporate investments; benefit plan net liability; the unamortized deferred gain on indemnity reinsurance related to the 
sale of reinsurance to Swiss Re in 2001; the results of certain disability income business due to the rescission of a reinsurance 
agreement with Swiss Re; the Institutional Pension business, which is a closed-block of pension business, the majority of which 
was sold on a group annuity basis, and is currently in run-off; and debt costs.  We are actively managing our remaining radio station 
clusters to maximize performance and future value. 

Segment operating revenues and income (loss) from operations are internal measures used by our management and Board of 
Directors to evaluate and assess the results of our segments.  Income (loss) from operations is GAAP net income excluding the 
after-tax effects of the following items, as applicable: 

(cid:2)  Realized gains and losses associated with the following (“excluded realized gain (loss)”):  

Sale or disposal of securities;  
Impairments of securities; 

(cid:5) 
(cid:5) 
(cid:5)  Change in the fair value of derivative instruments, embedded derivatives within certain reinsurance arrangements and our 

trading securities; 

(cid:5)  Change in the fair value of the derivatives we own to hedge our GDB riders within our variable annuities;  
(cid:5)  Change in the GLB embedded derivative reserves, net of the change in the fair value of the derivatives we own to hedge 

the changes in the embedded derivative reserves; and 

(cid:5)  Changes in the fair value of the embedded derivative liabilities related to index call options we may purchase in the future 
to hedge contract holder index allocations applicable to future reset periods for our indexed annuity products accounted 
for under the Derivatives and Hedging and the Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures Topics of the FASB ASC. 
(cid:2)  Change in reserves accounted for under the Financial Services – Insurance – Claim Costs and Liabilities for Future Policy 
Benefits Subtopic of the FASB ASC resulting from benefit ratio unlocking on our GDB and GLB riders (“benefit ratio 
unlocking”); 
Income (loss) from the initial adoption of new accounting standards; 

(cid:2) 

249 

  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income (loss) from reserve changes (net of related amortization) on business sold through reinsurance; 

(cid:2) 
(cid:2)  Gain (loss) on early extinguishment of debt; 
(cid:2)  Losses from the impairment of intangible assets; and 
(cid:2) 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations. 

Operating revenues represent GAAP revenues excluding the pre-tax effects of the following items, as applicable: 

(cid:2)  Excluded realized gain (loss); 
(cid:2)  Amortization of DFEL arising from changes in GDB and GLB benefit ratio unlocking; 
(cid:2)  Amortization of deferred gains arising from the reserve changes on business sold through reinsurance; and 
(cid:2)  Revenue adjustments from the initial adoption of new accounting standards. 

We use our prevailing corporate federal income tax rate of 35% while taking into account any permanent differences for events 
recognized differently in our financial statements and federal income tax returns when reconciling our non-GAAP measures to the 
most comparable GAAP measure.  Operating revenues and income (loss) from operations do not replace revenues and net income 
as the GAAP measures of our consolidated results of operations. 

Segment information (in millions) was as follows: 

Revenues 
Operating revenues: 
   Retirement Solutions: 
      Annuities 
      Defined Contribution 
         Total Retirement Solutions 
   Insurance Solutions: 
      Life Insurance 
      Group Protection 
         Total Insurance Solutions 
   Other Operations 

Excluded realized gain (loss), pre-tax 
Amortization of deferred gains from reserve changes 
   on business sold through reinsurance, pre-tax  
Amortization of DFEL associated with 
   benefit ratio unlocking, pre-tax  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 2,654    $ 
 988   
 3,642   

 2,301    $ 
 926    
 3,227   

 2,438   
 932   
 3,370   

 4,590   
 1,831   
 6,421   
 487   

 (146)  

 3    

 -    

 4,295   
 1,713   
 6,008   
 465    

 (1,200)  

 3    

 (4)   

 4,261   
 1,640   
 5,901   
 532   

 (573)  

 3   

 (9)  

     Total revenues 

$ 

 10,407    $ 

 8,499    $ 

 9,224   

250 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
                             
  
                              
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
Net Income (Loss) 
Income (loss) from operations: 
   Retirement Solutions: 
      Annuities 
      Defined Contribution 
         Total Retirement Solutions 
   Insurance Solutions: 
      Life Insurance 
      Group Protection 
         Total Insurance Solutions 
   Other Operations 
Excluded realized gain (loss), after-tax 
Gain (loss) on early extinguishment of debt, after-tax 
Income (expense) from reserve changes (net of related  
   amortization) on business sold through reinsurance, after-tax 
Impairment of intangibles, after-tax  
Benefit ratio unlocking, after-tax 
      Income (loss) from continuing operations, after-tax 
      Income (loss) from discontinued operations, after-tax 
            Net income (loss) 

Net Investment Income 
Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
         Total net investment income 

Amortization of DAC and VOBA, Net of Interest 
Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
         Total amortization of DAC and VOBA, net of interest 

251 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

$ 

 484    $ 
 154   
 638   

 353     $ 
 133    
 486    

 513   
 72    
 585   
 (186)  
 (95)  
 (3)   

 569    
 124    
 693    
 (237)   
 (780)   
 42    

 2    
 -    
 10    
 951   
 29    
 980    $ 

 2    
 (710)   
 89    
 (415)   
 (70)   
 (485)    $ 

$ 

 193   
 123   
 316   

 541   
 104   
 645   
 (183)  
 (373)  
 -   

 2   
 (297)  
 (120)  
 (10)  
 67   
 57   

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 1,119    $ 
 769   
 1,888   

 1,037     $ 
 732    
 1,769    

 972   
 695   
 1,667   

 2,186   
 141   
 2,327   
 326   
 4,541    $ 

 1,975    
 127    
 2,102    
 307    
 4,178     $ 

 1,988   
 117   
 2,105   
 358   
 4,130   

$ 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 

 421    $ 
 79    
 500   

 360     $ 
 75    
 435    

 676   
 128   
 804   

 538   
 46    
 584   
 1,084    $ 

 571    
 47    
 618    
 1,053     $ 

 551   
 35   
 586   
 1,390   

  
 
 
                              
  
                              
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                       
  
                       
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Federal Income Tax Expense (Benefit) 
Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
Excluded realized gain (loss) 
Gain (loss) on early extinguishment of debt 
Reserve changes (net of related amortization) 
   on business sold through reinsurance 
Impairment of intangibles  
Benefit ratio unlocking 
         Total federal income tax expense (benefit) 

Assets 
Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution  
      Total Retirement Solutions  
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance  
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 

         Total assets 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

 102    $ 
 60   
 162   

 41    $ 
 50   
 91   

 236   
 38   
 274   
 (107)  
 (51)  
 (2)  

 245   
 67   
 312   
 (143)  
 (420)  
 23   

 1   
 -    
 6   
 283    $ 

 1    
 (16)  
 46   
 (106)   $ 

$ 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

 (55)  
 29   
 (26)  

 267   
 56   
 323   
 (89)  
 (200)  
 -   

 1   
 (71)  
 (65)  
 (127)  

$ 

 91,435    $ 
 28,562   
    119,997   

 80,289   
 26,687   
    106,976   

 56,713   
 3,254   
 59,967   
 13,860   

 52,820   
 2,845   
 55,665   
 14,792   

$   193,824    $   177,433   

252 

  
 
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
                            
  
                            
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
    
 
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
24.  Supplemental Disclosures of Cash Flow Data 

The following summarizes our supplemental cash flow data (in millions): 

Interest paid 
Income taxes paid (received) 
Significant non-cash investing and financing transactions: 
   Business combinations: 
      Fair value of assets acquired (includes cash and invested cash) 
         Liabilities assumed 

   Business dispositions: 
      Assets disposed (includes cash and invested cash) 
      Liabilities disposed 
      Foreign currency awards released 
      Cash received  
         Realized gain (loss) on disposal 
         Estimated gain on net assets held-for-sale in 2007 
            Gain (loss) on dispositions 

   Sale of subsidiaries/businesses: 
      Proceeds from sale of subsidiaries/businesses 
      Assets disposed (includes cash and invested cash) 
         Gain (loss) on sale of subsidiaries/businesses 

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  
2010  

$ 

$ 
$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

 282     $ 
 (107)  

 244    $ 
 (189)  

 283 
 418 

 -     $ 
 -     $ 

 7    $ 
 7    $ 

 - 
 - 

 (509)   $ 
 116    
 -    
 459    
 66    
 -    
 66     $ 

 (8,044)   $ 
 7,457   
 54   
 314   
 (219)  
 -   
 (219)   $ 

 4     $ 
 -    
 4     $ 

 15    $ 
 (5)  
 10    $ 

 (732)
 127 
 - 
 647 
 42 
 (54)
 (12)

 10 
 (1)
 9 

253 

  
 
 
 
                             
                         
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
25.  Quarterly Results of Operations (Unaudited)  

The unaudited quarterly results of operations (in millions, except per share data) were as follows: 

2010  
Total revenues  
Total benefits and expenses  
Income (loss) from continuing operations 
Income (loss) from discontinued operations,  
   net of federal income taxes 
Net income (loss) 
Earnings (loss) per common share - basic: 
   Income (loss) from continuing operations 
   Income (loss) from discontinued operations 
   Net income (loss) 
Earnings (loss) per common share - diluted:  
   Income (loss) from continuing operations 
   Income (loss) from discontinued operations 
   Net income (loss) 

2009  
Total revenues  
Total benefits and expenses  
Income (loss) from continuing operations 
Income (loss) from discontinued operations,  
   net of federal income taxes 
Net income (loss) 
Earnings (loss) per common share - basic: 
   Income (loss) from continuing operations 
   Income (loss) from discontinued operations 
   Net income (loss) 
Earnings (loss) per common share - diluted:  
   Income (loss) from continuing operations 
   Income (loss) from discontinued operations 
   Net income (loss) 

For the Three Months Ended 

March 31, 

June 30, 

   September 30,    December 31, 

$ 

 2,527    $ 
 2,179   
 255   

 2,605    $ 
 2,275   
 252   

 2,613     $ 
 2,310    
 248    

 2,662 
 2,409 
 196 

 28   
 283   

 0.79   
 0.09   
 0.88   

 0.76   
 0.09   
 0.85   

 3   
 255   

 0.34   
 0.01   
 0.35   

 0.32   
 0.01   
 0.33   

 (2)   
 246    

 0.79    
 (0.01)  
 0.78   

 0.76   
 (0.01)  
 0.75   

 - 
 196 

 0.62 
 - 
 0.62 

 0.60 
 - 
 0.60 

$ 

 2,132    $ 
 2,795   
 (587)  

 1,882    $ 
 1,936   
 (7)  

 2,082    $ 
 2,020   
 81   

 2,403 
 2,269 
 98 

 8    
 (579)  

 (2.30)  
 0.03   
 (2.27)  

 (2.30)  
 0.03   
 (2.27)  

 (154)  
 (161)  

 (0.03)  
 (0.59)  
 (0.62)  

 (0.03)  
 (0.59)  
 (0.62)  

 72   
 153   

 0.21    
 0.24    
 0.45    

 0.21    
 0.23    
 0.44    

 4 
 102 

 0.27 
 0.01 
 0.28 

 0.26 
 0.01 
 0.27 

254 

  
 
 
 
                          
                     
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Item 9.  Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure  

None. 

Item 9A.  Controls and Procedures  

(a)  Conclusions Regarding Disclosure Controls and Procedures  

We maintain disclosure controls and procedures, which are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the 
reports we file or submit under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), is recorded, processed, 
summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms, and that 
such information is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management, including our Chief Executive Officer and 
Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.  As of the end of the period required 
by this report, we, under the supervision and with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, 
conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) of the 
Exchange Act).  Based on that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that our 
disclosure controls and procedures are effective in timely alerting them to material information relating to us and our consolidated 
subsidiaries required to be disclosed in our periodic reports under the Exchange Act.  

(b)  Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting  

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting is included on page 153 of “Item 8.  Financial Statements and 
Supplementary Data” and is incorporated herein by reference.  

A control system, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance that the control system’s 
objectives will be met.  Further, because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide 
absolute assurance that misstatements due to error or fraud will not occur or that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, 
within the company have been detected.  Projections of any evaluation of controls’ effectiveness to future periods are subject to 
risks.  Over time, controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or deterioration in the degree of compliance 
with policies or procedures.  

(c)  Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting  

There was no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as that term is defined in rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under 
the Exchange Act) that occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2010, that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely 
to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting. 

Item 9B.  Other Information  

(1)  On February 23, 2011, David A. Stonecipher notified the Board of Directors (the “Board”) of Lincoln National Corporation 
(the “Company” or “LNC”) that he has decided to retire from the Board effective as of March 31, 2011.  Mr. Stonecipher’s 
decision is part of his retirement planning and not due to any disagreement with the Company or the Board on any matter relating 
to the Company’s operations, policies or practices. 

(2)  On February 23, 2011, the Board approved an amendment to LNC’s Amended and Restated Bylaws (the “Bylaws”), effective 
March 31, 2011, to modify the language in Article II, Section 1 to decrease the number of authorized board members from twelve 
to eleven as a result of the retirement of Mr. Stonecipher on such date.  The foregoing is a summary of the amendment to the 
Bylaws and is qualified by the Amended and Restated Bylaws effective March 31, 2011, a copy of which is included as Exhibit 3.2 
to this Form 10-K and is incorporated into this Item 9B by reference. 

Item 10.  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance  

PART III 

Information for this item relating to officers of LNC is incorporated by reference to “Part I – Executive Officers of the 
Registrant.”  Information for this item relating to directors of LNC is incorporated by reference to the sections captioned 
“GOVERNANCE OF THE COMPANY – Our Corporate Governance Guidelines,” “GOVERNANCE OF THE COMPANY 
– Director Nomination Process,” “THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND COMMITTEES – Current Committee Membership 
and Meetings Held During 2011,” “THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND COMMITTEES – Audit Committee,” “ITEM 1 – 
Election of Directors,” “SECTION 16(a) BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP REPORTING COMPLIANCE” and “GENERAL – 
Shareholder Proposals” of LNC’s Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting scheduled for May 26, 2011.  

255 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
We have adopted a code of ethics, which we refer to as our “Code of Conduct,” that applies, among others, to our principal 
executive officer, principal financial officer, principal accounting officer or controller and other persons performing similar 
functions.  The Code of Conduct is posted on our Internet website (www.lincolnfinancial.com).  LNC will provide to any person 
without charge, upon request, a copy of such code.  Requests for the Code of Conduct should be directed to:  Corporate Secretary, 
Lincoln National Corporation, 150 N. Radnor Chester Road, Suite A305, Radnor, PA 19087.  We intend to disclose any 
amendment to or waiver from the provisions of our Code of Conduct that applies to our directors and executive officers on our 
website, www.lincolnfinancial.com.  

Item 11.  Executive Compensation  

Information for this item is incorporated by reference to the sections captioned “EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION,” 
“COMPENSATION OF DIRECTORS” and “COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER 
PARTICIPATION” of LNC’s Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting scheduled for May 26, 2011. 

Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters  

Information for this item is incorporated by reference to the section captioned “SECURITY OWNERSHIP” of LNC’s Proxy 
Statement for the Annual Meeting scheduled for May 26, 2011. 

Securities Authorized for Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans 

The table below provides information as of December 31, 2010, regarding securities authorized for issuance under LNC’s equity 
compensation plans.  See Note 20 to the Consolidated Financial Statements included in “Part II – Item 8. Financial Statements and 
Supplementary Data” of this Form 10-K for a brief description of our equity compensation plans. 

Number of 
securities to be
issued upon 
exercise of 
outstanding 
options, 
warrants 
and rights 
(a) 

  Weighted- 

average 
exercise 
price of 
outstanding 
options, 
warrants 
and rights 
(b) 

Number of   
securities remaining   
available for future  
issuance under  
equity compensation  
plans (excluding  
securities reflected  
in column (a))  
(c) 

Plan Category 
Equity compensation plans approved by shareholders 
Equity compensation plans not approved by shareholders 
   Total  

 7,256,313  (1)(2) $

 - 
 7,256,313 

$

 48.19 
-
 48.19 

 10,713,933  (3) 

-
 10,713,933 

(1) This amount excludes outstanding stock options assumed in connection with our acquisition of Jefferson-Pilot (“JP”) as 

follows:  

(cid:120)

(cid:120)

Shares of 4,766,627 to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options as of December 31, 2010, under the JP Long-Term 
Stock Incentive Plan with a weighted-average exercise price of $46.53; and 
Shares of 167,122 to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options as of December 31, 2010, under the JP Non-Employee 
Directors Stock Option Plan with a weighted-average exercise price of $58.97. 

(2) This amount includes the following: 

(cid:120) Outstanding options of 2,789,319;  
(cid:120) Outstanding long-term incentive awards of 1,768,847, of which 1,347,457 represent options with performance conditions and 
421,390 represent the number of performance shares based on the maximum amounts potentially payable under the awards in 
stock options and shares (including potential dividend equivalents).  The long-term incentive awards have not been earned as 
of December 31, 2010.  The number of options and shares, if any, to be issued pursuant to such awards will be determined 
based on our, and in some cases, our subsidiaries performance over the applicable three-year performance period (target 
amounts are set forth in Note 20 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statement, included in Part II – Item 8 of the Form 
10-K for the year end December 31, 2010.  Since the shares that may be received in payment of the awards have no exercise 

256 

 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
              
  
 
           
  
 
 
           
  
 
 
           
  
 
              
  
 
              
  
 
 
           
  
 
              
  
 
              
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
 
 
price, they are not included in the weighted-average exercise price calculation in column (b) above.  The long-term incentive 
awards are all issued under the LNC 2009 Amended and Restated Incentive Compensation Plan (“ICP”);  

(cid:2)  Outstanding restricted stock units of 1,563,928; and 
(cid:2)  Outstanding deferred stock units of 1,134,219, which are not included in Note 20 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial 

Statements, included in Part II – Item 8 of the Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010.   

(3) 

Includes up to 10,356,432 securities available for issuance in connection with restricted stock, restricted stock units, 
performance stock units, deferred stock, and deferred stock unit awards under the ICP.  Shares that may be issued in payment 
of awards, other than options and stock appreciation rights, granted between May 12, 2005, and May 13, 2009, reduce the 
number of securities remaining available for future issuance under equity compensation plans at a ratio of 3.25-to-1.  Shares 
that may be issued in payment of awards, other than options and stock appreciation rights, granted after May 13, 2009, reduce 
the number of securities remaining available for future issuance under equity compensation plans at a ratio of 1.63-to-1.  
Shares that may be issued in payment of awards granted prior to May 12, 2005, and grants for options and stock appreciation 
rights, reduce the number of securities remaining available for future issuance under equity compensation plans on a 1-for-1 
basis.  Also includes up to 357,501 securities available for issuance in connection with deferred stock units under the Deferred 
Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors. 

Item 13.  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence  

Information for this item is incorporated by reference to the sections captioned “RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS” and 
“GOVERNANCE OF THE COMPANY – Director Independence” of LNC’s Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting 
scheduled for May 26, 2011.  

Item 14.  Principal Accounting Fees and Services  

Information for this item is incorporated by reference to the sections captioned “ITEM 2 – RATIFICATION OF THE 
APPOINTMENT OF THE INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM – Independent Registered 
Public Accounting Firm Fees and Services” and “ITEM 2 – RATIFICATION OF THE APPOINTMENT OF THE 
INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM – Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policy” of LNC’s Proxy 
Statement for the Annual Meeting scheduled for May 26, 2011. 

257 

  
 
 
 
  
  
  
Item 15.  Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules 

(a)  (1) Financial Statements  

PART IV  

The following Consolidated Financial Statements of Lincoln National Corporation are included in Part II – Item 8:  

Management Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting  

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm  

Consolidated Balance Sheets – December 31, 2010 and 2009 

Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) – Years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity – Years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows – Years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008 

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 

(a)  (2) Financial Statement Schedules  

The Financial Statement Schedules are listed in the Index to Financial Statement Schedules on page FS-1, which is incorporated 
herein by reference.  

(a)  (3) Listing of Exhibits  

The Exhibits are listed in the Index to Exhibits beginning on page E-1, which is incorporated herein by reference.  

(c) The Financial Statement Schedules for Lincoln National Corporation begin on page FS-2, which are incorporated herein by 
reference. 

258 

  
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, LNC has duly caused this report to be 
signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.  

SIGNATURES 

   Date:  February 25, 2011 

   LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 

By:                                /s/ Randal J. Freitag                                    

Randal J. Freitag 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons 
on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on February 25, 2011. 

Signature 

/s/ Dennis R. Glass 
Dennis R. Glass 

/s/ Randal J. Freitag  
Randal J. Freitag 

/s/ Douglas N. Miller 
Douglas N. Miller 

/s/ William J. Avery 
William J. Avery 

/s/ William H. Cunningham 
William H. Cunningham 

/s/ George W. Henderson, III 
George W. Henderson, III 

/s/ Eric G. Johnson 
Eric G. Johnson 

/s/ Gary C. Kelly 
Gary C. Kelly 

/s/ M. Leanne Lachman 
M. Leanne Lachman 

/s/ Michael F. Mee 
Michael F. Mee 

/s/ William Porter Payne 
William Porter Payne 

/s/ Patrick S. Pittard 
Patrick S. Pittard 

/s/ David A. Stonecipher 
David A. Stonecipher 

/s/ Isaiah Tidwell 
Isaiah Tidwell 

259 

Title 

President, Chief Executive Officer and Director 
(Principal Executive Officer) 

Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 
(Principal Financial Officer) 

Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer 
(Principal Accounting Officer) 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

  
 
 
  
       
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
[This page intentionally left blank]

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Index to Financial Statement Schedules 

  I  – Summary of Investments – Other than Investments in Related Parties 
 II  – Condensed Financial Information of Registrant 
III  – Supplementary Insurance Information 
IV  – Reinsurance 
 V  – Valuation and Qualifying Accounts 

FS-2  
FS-3  
FS-6  
FS-8  
FS-9  

All other schedules for which provision is made in the applicable accounting regulation of the Securities and Exchange 
Commission are not required under the related instructions, are inapplicable, or the required information is included in the 
consolidated financial statements, and therefore omitted.  See “Part II – Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of 
Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” on page 49 for more detail on items 
contained within these schedules. 

FS-1 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION  
SCHEDULE I – CONSOLIDATED SUMMARY OF INVESTMENTS – OTHER THAN INVESTMENTS IN  
RELATED PARTIES 
(in millions) 

Column A  

   Column B    Column C    Column D 

Type of Investment  
Available-For-Sale Fixed Maturity Securities (1) 
Bonds:  
   U.S. government and government agencies and authorities  
   States, municipalities and political subdivisions  
   Mortgage-backed securities  
   Foreign governments  
   Public utilities  
   Convertibles and bonds with warrants attached  
   All other corporate bonds  
Hybrid and redeemable preferred securities  
Variable interest entities  
      Total available-for-sale fixed maturity securities   

Available-For-Sale Equity Securities (1) 
Common stocks:  
   Banks, trusts and insurance companies  
   Industrial, miscellaneous and all other  
   Nonredeemable preferred securities  
      Total available-for-sale equity securities   
Trading securities  
Mortgage loans on real estate  
Real estate  
Policy loans  
Derivative instruments  
Other investments  

         Total investments  

As of December 31, 2010 
Fair 
   Value 

   Carrying 
   Value 

Cost 

   $ 

 150     $ 

 165    $ 

 3,222   
 10,817   
 473    
 9,799   
 15    
 39,223   
 1,476   
 570    
 65,745   

 133    
 7    
 39    
 179    
 2,340   
 6,752   
 202    
 2,865   
 1,435   
 1,038   

 3,155   
 10,890   
 508   
 10,446   
 11   
 41,458   
 1,397   
 584   
 68,614   

 137   
 3   
 57   
 197   
 2,596   
 7,183   
N/A  
N/A  
 1,076   
 1,038   

 165 
 3,155 
 10,890 
 508 
 10,446 
 11 
 41,458 
 1,397 
 584 
 68,614 

 137 
 3 
 57 
 197 
 2,596 
 6,752 
 202 
 2,865 
 1,076 
 1,038 

   $ 

 80,556   

   $ 

 83,340 

(1) 

Investments deemed to have declines in value that are other-than-temporary are written down or reserved for to reduce the 
carrying value to their estimated realizable value. 

FS-2 

  
 
                        
 
                       
  
 
  
  
 
    
  
    
  
    
 
    
  
    
  
    
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
SCHEDULE II – CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF REGISTRANT 
BALANCE SHEETS 
(Parent Company Only) (in millions, except share data) 

As of December 31, 
2009  
2010  

 15,485    $ 
 55   
 135   
 582   
 2,759   
 257   
 19,273    $ 

 14,374 
 189 
 238 
 990 
 1,576 
 126 
 17,493 

 16    $ 
 350   
 5,649   
 -   
 452   
 6,467   

 9 
 349 
 4,802 
 97 
 536 
 5,793 

 -   
 -   
 8,124   
 3,934   
 748   
 12,806   
 19,273    $ 

 - 
 806 
 7,840 
 3,316 
 (262)
 11,700 
 17,493 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

ASSETS  
Investments in subsidiaries (1) 
Derivative investments  
Other investments    
Cash and invested cash  
Loans and accrued interest to subsidiaries (1) 
Other assets  
         Total assets  

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY  
Liabilities  
Common and preferred dividends payable  
Short-term debt  
Long-term debt  
Loans from subsidiaries (1) 
Other liabilities  
      Total liabilities  

Contingencies and Commitments  

Stockholders' Equity  
Preferred stock - 10,000,000 shares authorized:  
   Series A preferred stock  
   Series B preferred stock  
Common stock - 800,000,000 shares authorized  
Retained earnings  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)  
      Total stockholders' equity  
         Total liabilities and stockholders' equity  

(1)  Eliminated in consolidation.  

FS-3 

  
 
                           
                      
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
SCHEDULE II – CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF REGISTRANT (Continued)  
STATEMENTS OF INCOME  
 (Parent Company Only) (in millions) 

Revenues  
Dividends from subsidiaries (1) 
Interest from subsidiaries (1) 
Net investment income  
Realized gain (loss) on investments  
Other revenue  
   Total revenues  
Expenses  
Operating and administrative  
Interest - subsidiaries (1) 
Interest - other  
   Total expenses  
      Income (loss) before federal income taxes, equity in income (loss) of   
         subsidiaries, less dividends  
      Federal income tax expense (benefit)  
         Income (loss) before equity in income (loss) of subsidiaries, less dividends  
         Equity in income (loss) of subsidiaries, less dividends  
            Net income (loss)  

(1)  Eliminated in consolidation.  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

$ 

$ 

 712     $ 
 99    
 -    
 (4)   
 5    
 812    

 99    
 6    
 290    
 395    

 767    $ 
 94   
 (5)  
 1   
 1   
 858   

 26   
 8   
 195   
 229   

 417    
 (106)   
 523    
 457    
 980     $ 

 629   
 (50)  
 679   
 (1,164)  

 (485)   $ 

 1,238 
 121 
 17 
 (156)
 - 
 1,220 

 52 
 25 
 280 
 357 

 863 
 (136)
 999 
 (942)
 57 

FS-4 

  
 
                               
                         
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
SCHEDULE II – CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF REGISTRANT (Continued)  
STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS  
(Parent Company Only) (in millions) 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities  
Net income (loss)  
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by   
   (used in) operating activities:  
      Equity in income (loss) of subsidiaries greater than distributions (1) 
      Realized (gain) loss on investments  
      Change in fair value of equity collar  
      Change in federal income tax accruals  
      (Gain) loss on early extinguishment of debt  
      Other  
         Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities  

Cash Flows from Investing Activities  
Purchases of investments  
Sales of investments  
Capital contribution to subsidiaries (1) 
Proceeds from sale of subsidiaries  
         Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities  

Cash Flows from Financing Activities  
Payment of long-term debt, including current maturities  
Issuance of long-term debt, net of issuance costs  
Increase (decrease) in commercial paper, net  
Increase (decrease) in loans from subsidiaries, net (1) 
Increase (decrease) in loans to subsidiaries, net (1) 
Common stock issued for benefit plans  
Issuance (redemption) of Series B preferred stock and issuance (repurchase   
   and cancellation) of associated common stock warrants  
Issuance of common stock  
Repurchase of common stock  
Dividends paid to common and preferred stockholders  
         Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities  
            Net increase (decrease) in cash and invested cash  
            Cash and invested cash as of beginning-of-year  
              Cash and invested cash as of end-of-year  

(1)  Eliminated in consolidation.  

For the Years Ended December 31, 
2008  
2009  

2010  

$ 

 980     $ 

 (485)   $ 

 57 

 (457)  
 4    
 -    
 (190)  
 5    
 48    
 390    

 -    
 -    
 (125)  
 459    
 334    

 (405)  
 749    
 1    
 (97)  
 (683)  
 -    

 1,164   
 (1)  
 3   
 (69)  
 (64)  
 49   
 597   

 (50)  
 37   
 (1,313)  
 320   
 (1,006)  

 (522)  
 788   
 (216)  
 (291)  
 -   
 -   

 942 
 156 
 109 
 (240)
 - 
 (33)
 991 

 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 

 (300)
 200 
 50 
 61 
 (299)
 49 

 (998)  
 368    
 (25)  
 (42)  
 (1,132)  
 (408)  
 990    
 582     $ 

 950   
 652   
 -   
 (79)  
 1,282   
 873   
 117   
 990    $ 

 - 
 - 
 (476)
 (430)
 (1,145)
 (154)
 271 
 117 

$ 

FS-5 

  
 
                               
                         
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
SCHEDULE III – CONSOLIDATED SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION 
 (in millions) 

Column A 

   Column B    Column C      Column D      Column E    Column F 

Segment 

   DAC and 

VOBA 

   Benefits     Premiums (1)   

   Insurance 
   Premiums 

   Future 
   Contract 

    Other 
     Contract 
    Unearned       Holder 
Funds 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solution 
Other Operations 
         Total 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
         Total 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
         Total 

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

   $ 

 2,250    $ 
 360   
 2,610   

 1,198       $ 
 2          
 1,200          

 -        $ 
 -       
 -       

 20,643    $ 
 12,773   
 33,416   

 6,145   
 175   
 6,320   
 -    
 8,930    $ 

 7,554          
 1,607          
 9,161          
 5,978          
 16,339       $ 

 -       
 -       
 -       
 -       
 -        $ 

 32,436   
 269   
 32,705   
 1,478   
 67,599    $ 

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2009 

   $ 

   $ 

   $ 

   $ 

 2,381    $ 
 538   
 2,919   

 1,439       $ 
 3          
 1,442          

 -        $ 
 -       
 -       

 19,566    $ 
 12,240   
 31,806   

 89 
 - 
 89 

 6,432   
 159   
 6,591   
 -    
 9,510    $ 

 7,105          
 1,446          
 8,551          
 5,965          
 15,958       $ 

 -       
 -       
 -       
 -       
 -        $ 

 30,616   
 193   
 30,809   
 1,532   
 64,147    $ 

 392 
 1,579 
 1,971 
 4 
 2,064 

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2008 

 2,977    $ 
 883   
 3,860   

 3,958       $ 
 25          
 3,983          

 -        $ 
 -       
 -       

 17,220    $ 
 11,628   
 28,848   

 7,396   
 146   
 7,542   
 -    
 11,402    $ 

 6,820          
 1,378          
 8,198          
 6,690          
 18,871       $ 

   $ 

 -       
 -       
 -       
 -       
 -        $ 

 29,559   
 149   
 29,708   
 1,575   
 60,131    $ 

 53 
 - 
 53 

 439 
 1,682 
 2,121 
 2 
 2,176 

 136 
 - 
 136 

 360 
 1,518 
 1,878 
 4 
 2,018 

(1)  Unearned premiums are included in Column E, other contract holder funds. 

FS-6 

  
 
                          
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
        
  
  
  
  
                       
  
  
  
      
  
     
  
                       
  
                       
  
  
  
  
  
  
        
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
                       
  
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                            
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
                            
  
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                       
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
                       
  
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
          
     
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
SCHEDULE III – CONSOLIDATED SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION (Continued) 
(in millions) 

Column A 

    Column G      Column H      Column I       Column J       Column K 

Net 

   Investment 

    Benefits 

and 
  Interest 

  Amortization       
      of DAC 

      Other 
     Operating       Premiums 

and 

Segment 

Income 

    Credited 

      VOBA 

   Expenses (2)     Written 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
         Total 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contribution 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
         Total 

Retirement Solutions: 
   Annuities 
   Defined Contributions 
      Total Retirement Solutions 
Insurance Solutions: 
   Life Insurance 
   Group Protection 
      Total Insurance Solutions 
Other Operations 
         Total 

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

     $ 

 1,119      $ 
 769         
 1,888         

 884       $ 
 440         
 1,324         

 421       $ 
 79         
 500         

 749       $ 
 253      
 1,002      

 2,186         
 141         
 2,327         
 326         
 4,541      $ 

 2,933         
 1,300         
 4,233         
 258         
 5,815       $ 

 538         
 46         
 584         
 -          
 1,084       $ 

 370      
 376      
 746      
 526      
 2,274       $ 

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2009 

 1,037      $ 
 732         
 1,769         

 783       $ 
 433         
 1,216         

 360       $ 
 75         
 435         

 632       $ 
 227      
 859      

 1,975         
 127         
 2,102         
 307         
 4,178      $ 

 2,558         
 1,120         
 3,678         
 405         
 5,299       $ 

 571         
 47         
 618         
 -         
 1,053       $ 

 352      
 355      
 707      
 372      
 1,938       $ 

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2008 

 972      $ 
 695         
 1,667         

 1,150       $ 
 443         
 1,593         

 676       $ 
 128         
 804         

 646       $ 
 212      
 858      

     $ 

     $ 

     $ 

     $ 

 1,988         
 117         
 2,105         
 358         
 4,130      $ 

 2,575         
 1,109         
 3,684         
 284         
 5,561       $ 

 551         
 35         
 586         
 -          
 1,390       $ 

 327      
 336      
 663      
 508      
 2,029       $ 

     $ 

 - 
 - 
 - 

 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  

 -  
 -  
 -  

 -  
 - 
 - 
 - 
 - 

 -  
 -  
 -  

 -  
 -  
 -  
 -  
 - 

(2)  Excludes impairment of intangibles of $730 million and $381 million for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, 

respectively.  The allocation of expenses between investments and other operations is based on a number of assumptions and 
estimates.  Results would change if different methods were applied. 

FS-7 

  
 
                            
    
  
  
  
        
  
                       
    
   
        
  
                      
     
    
                       
    
  
  
      
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                       
    
    
    
          
         
         
     
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
          
         
         
     
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
                            
    
    
          
         
          
     
    
                            
    
    
    
          
         
          
     
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
          
         
          
     
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
                       
    
    
          
         
         
     
    
                       
    
    
    
          
         
         
     
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
    
          
         
         
     
    
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
    
  
  
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
SCHEDULE IV – CONSOLIDATED REINSURANCE 
(in millions) 

Column A  

Description  

Individual life insurance in force  
Premiums:  
   Life insurance and annuities (1) 
   Accident and health insurance  
      Total premiums  

Individual life insurance in force  
Premiums:  
   Life insurance and annuities (1) 
   Accident and health insurance  

      Total premiums  

Individual life insurance in force  
Premiums:  
   Life insurance and annuities (1) 
   Accident and health insurance  
      Total premiums  

   Column B       Column C       Column D       Column E      Column F    
      Assumed       
from 
      Other 

  Percentage 
  of Amount 
     Assumed 

      Ceded 

      Net 

to 

Gross 
Amount 

      Other 
   Companies  Companies 

   Amount 

to Net 

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

   $   842,300      $   337,800      $ 

 3,000       $   507,500     

 0.6 %   

 5,458        
 1,141        
 6,599      $ 

 1,170         
 32         
 1,202       $ 

 13         
 -         
 13       $ 

 4,301     
 1,109     
 5,410        

   $ 

 0.3 %   
 0.0 %   

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2009 

   $   799,900       $   342,600      $ 

 3,000       $   460,300     

 0.7 %   

 5,025         
 1,099         

 1,126         
 22         

 10         
 -         

 3,909     
 1,077     

 0.3 %   
 0.0 %   

   $ 

 6,124       $ 

 1,148       $ 

 10       $ 

 4,986        

As of or for the Year Ended December 31, 2008 

   $   765,400       $   346,900      $ 

 3,700       $   422,200     

 0.9 %   

 4,996         
 1,075         
 6,071      $ 

 982         
 22         
 1,004       $ 

 18         
 -         
 18       $ 

 4,032     
 1,053     
 5,085        

   $ 

 0.4 %   
 0.0 %   

(1) 

Includes insurance fees on universal life and other interest-sensitive products.  

FS-8 

  
 
                          
  
 
  
                     
  
 
     
     
     
 
                     
  
  
  
    
  
                      
  
  
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
    
  
     
                      
  
  
  
    
         
         
          
    
     
  
  
  
  
     
                      
  
    
         
         
          
       
     
                           
  
  
  
    
          
         
          
    
     
  
  
  
  
     
                           
  
    
          
         
          
       
     
                           
  
  
  
    
          
         
          
    
     
  
  
  
  
     
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION 
SCHEDULE V – CONSOLIDATED VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS  
(in millions) 

Column A 

     Column B      

Column C 
Additions 

     Column D       Column E 

      Charged 
   to Other 

   Balance at  Charged to  
   Beginning- 
      of-Year 

   Costs 
   Expenses (1) 

      Balance 
   Accounts -  Deductions -      at End- 
   of-Year 
   Describe (2) 

   Describe 

Description 

Deducted from asset accounts: 
   Reserve for mortgage loans on real estate 

      $ 

 22      $ 

 18       $ 

 -       $ 

 (27)      $ 

 13 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2010 

Deducted from asset accounts: 
   Reserve for mortgage loans on real estate 

      $ 

 -       $ 

 35       $ 

 -       $ 

 (13)      $ 

 22 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2009 

Deducted from asset accounts: 
   Reserve for mortgage loans on real estate 

      $ 

 -       $ 

 -       $ 

 -       $ 

 -       $ 

 - 

For the Year Ended December 31, 2008 

(1)  Excludes charges for the direct write-off assets.  
(2)  Deductions reflect sales, foreclosures of the underlying holdings or change in reserves. 

FS-9 

  
 
                  
          
        
 
        
  
        
  
                  
        
 
                  
                   
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                   
     
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                   
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                   
     
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                       
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
                       
     
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
        
  
 
INDEX TO EXHIBITS 

2.1 

2.2 

Stock Purchase Agreement between Lincoln Financial Media Company and Raycom Holdings, LLC is incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 2.3 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2007.*** 

Purchase and Sale Agreement By and Among LNC, Lincoln National Investment Companies, Inc. and Macquarie Bank 
Limited, dated as of August 18, 2009 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to LNC’s Quarterly Report on Form 
10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended September 30, 2009.*** 

3.1 

LNC Restated Articles of Incorporation are incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-
6028) filed with the SEC on August 17, 2010. 

3.2  Amended and Restated Bylaws of LNC (effective March 31, 2011) are filed herewith.   

4.1 

4.2 

4.3 

4.4 

4.5 

Indenture of LNC, dated as of September 15, 1994, between LNC and The Bank of New York, as trustee, is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c) to LNC’s Registration Statement on Form S-3/A (File No. 33-55379) filed 
with the SEC on September 15, 1994. 

First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of November 1, 2006, to Indenture dated as of September 15, 1994 is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2006. 

Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of May 1, 1996, between LNC and The Bank of New York Trust Company, 
N.A. (successor in interest to J.P. Morgan Trust Company and The First National Bank of Chicago) is incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 4(j) to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2001. 

First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of August 14, 1998, to Junior Subordinated Indenture dated as of May 1, 1996 is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on August 27, 1998. 

Second Supplemental Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated April 20, 2006, to Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as 
of May 1, 1996, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on 
April 20, 2006. 

4.6  Third Supplemental Junior Subordinated Indenture dated May 17, 2006, to Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of 

May 1, 1996, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on 
May 17, 2006. 

4.7 

4.8 

Fourth Supplemental Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of November 1, 2006, to Junior Subordinated Indenture, 
dated May 1, 1996, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.9 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year 
ended December 31, 2006. 

Fifth Supplemental Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of March 13, 2007, to Junior Subordinated Indenture, 
dated May 1, 1996, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC 
on March 13, 2007. 

4.9 

Senior Indenture, dated as of March 10, 2009, between LNC and the Bank of New York Mellon, is incorporated by 
reference to LNC’s Form S-3ASR (File No. 333-157822) filed with the SEC on March 10, 2009. 

4.10 

Junior Subordinated Indenture, dated as of March 10, 2009, between LNC and the Bank of New York Mellon, is 
incorporated by reference to LNC’s Form S-3ASR (File No. 333-157822) filed with the SEC on March 10, 2009. 

4.11 

Indenture, dated as of November 21, 1995, between Jefferson-Pilot Corporation and U.S. National Bank Association 
(as successor in interest to Wachovia Bank, National Association), is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 to LNC’s 
Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended June 30, 2006. 

4.12  Third Supplemental Indenture, dated as of January 27, 2004, to Indenture dated as of November 21, 1995, is 

incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.8 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended June 30, 2006.  

4.13  Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of January 27, 2004, to Indenture dated as of November 21, 1995, is 

incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.9 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended June 30, 2006. 

E-1 

  
 
 
    
 
 
   
   
    
    
    
    
    
    
 
    
  
   
    
4.14  Fifth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of April 3, 2006, to Indenture, dated as of November 21, 1995, incorporated by 

reference to Exhibit 10.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on April 3, 2006. 

4.15 

Sixth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of March 1, 2007, to Indenture dated as of November 21, 1995, is incorporated 
by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended March 31, 2007. 

4.16  Form of 7% Notes due March 15, 2018 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) 

filed with the SEC on March 24, 1998. 

4.17  Form of 6.20% Note dated December 7, 2001 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File 

No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on December 11, 2001. 

4.18  Form of 6.75% Trust Preferred Security Certificate is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K 

(File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on September 16, 2003. 

4.19  Form of 6.75% Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debentures, Series F is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 

4.3 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on September 16, 2003. 

4.20  Form of 4.75% Note due February 15, 2014 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 

1-6028) filed with the SEC on February 4, 2004. 

4.21  Form of 7% Capital Securities due 2066 of LNC is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File 

NO. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on May 17, 2006. 

4.22  Form of 6.75% Capital Securities due 2066 of Lincoln Financial Corporation is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 

4.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on April 20, 2006. 

4.23  Form of Floating Rate Senior Note due April 6, 2009 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K 

(File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on April 7, 2006. 

4.24  Form of 6.15% Senior Note due April 6, 2036 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File 

No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on April 7, 2006. 

4.25  Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated September 11, 2003, among LNC, as Depositor, Bank One Trust 

Company, National Association, as Property Trustee, Bank One Delaware, Inc., as Delaware Trustee, and the 
Administrative Trustees named therein is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed 
with the SEC on September 16, 2003. 

4.26  Guarantee Agreement, dated September 11, 2003, between LNC, as Guarantor, and Bank One Trust Company, 

National Association, as Guarantee Trustee is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 
1-6028) filed with the SEC on September 16, 2003. 

4.27  Form of 6.05% Capital Securities due 2067 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-

6028) filed with the SEC on March 13, 2007. 

4.28  Form of Floating Rate Senior Notes due 2010 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 

1-6028) filed with the SEC on March 13, 2007. 

4.29  Form of 5.65% Senior Notes due 2012 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-

6028) filed with the SEC on August 27, 2007. 

4.30  Form of 6.30% Senior Notes due 2037 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-

6028) filed with the SEC on October 9, 2007. 

4.31  Form of 8.75% Senior Notes due 2019 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-

6028) filed with the SEC on June 22, 2009. 

4.32  Form of 6.25% Senior Notes due 2020 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-

6028) filed with the SEC on December 11, 2009. 

E-2 

  
 
    
   
   
   
   
   
    
    
    
    
    
   
   
    
    
    
 
 
 
 
4.33  Form of 4.30% Senior Notes due 2015 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) 

filed with the SEC on June 18, 2010. 

4.34  Form of 7.00% Senior Notes due 2040 incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) 

filed with the SEC on June 18, 2010. 

4.35  First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of April 3, 2006, among Lincoln JP Holdings, L.P. and JPMorgan Chase Bank, 

N.A., as trustee, to the Indenture, dated as of January 15, 1997, among Jefferson-Pilot and JPMorgan Chase Bank, 
N.A., as trustee, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC 
on April 3, 2006. 

10.1  LNC 2009 Amended and Restated Incentive Compensation Plan (as amended and restated on May 14, 2009) is 

incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4 to LNC’s Proxy Statement (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on April 9, 
2009.* 

10.2  Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement under the LNC Amended and Restated Incentive Compensation 

Plan, adopted February 7, 2008 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for 
the quarter ended March 31, 2008.* 

10.3  Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File 

No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended March 31, 2008.* 

10.4  Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement under the LNC Amended and Restated Incentive Compensation 

Plan, adopted May 2008, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with 
the SEC on May 6, 2008.* 

10.5  Form of Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement under the LNC 2009 Amended and Restated Incentive 

Compensation Plan, adopted November 2009, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File 
No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on November 6, 2009.* 

10.6  LNC Stock Option Plan for Non-Employee Directors is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 5 to LNC’s Proxy 

Statement (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on April 4, 2007.* 

10.7  Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement for the LNC Stock Option Plan for Non-Employee Directors is incorporated 

by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on May 10, 2007.* 

10.8 

2007 Non-Employee Director Fees (revised to include fee for non-Executive Chairman) (unchanged for 2010) is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended September 30, 
2007.* 

10.9 

2011 Non-Employee Director Fees (revised to include fee for non-Executive Chairman) is incorporated by reference 
to Exhibit 10.1 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended September 30, 2010.* 

10.10  Form of Restricted Stock Award Agreement (2007) is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to LNC’s Form 10-Q 

(File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended September 30, 2007.* 

10.11  Amended and Restated LNC Supplemental Retirement Plan is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to LNC’s 

Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2007.* 

10.12  2009 Severance Plan for Officers of LNC is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-

6028) filed with the SEC on March 19, 2009.* 

10.13  Severance Plan for Officers of LNC is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) 

filed with the SEC on November 6, 2009.* 

10.14  Amended and Restated Salary Continuation Plan for Executives of LNC and Affiliates is incorporated by reference to 

Exhibit 10.13 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2007.* 

10.15  The LNC Outside Directors’ Value Sharing Plan, last amended March 8, 2001, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 

10(e) to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2001.* 

E-3 

  
 
    
   
   
   
   
    
 
 
 
 
    
    
    
   
    
    
  
   
    
10.16  LNC Deferred Compensation and Supplemental/Excess Retirement Plan, as amended and restated effective 

December 31, 2010 is filed herewith.* 

10.17  LNC 1993 Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors, as last amended May 10, 2001, is incorporated by reference to 

Exhibit 10(g), to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2001.* 

10.18  Amendment No. 2 to the LNC 1993 Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors (effective February 1, 2006) is 

incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on January 13, 
2006.* 

10.19  Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (For Non-Employee Directors) under the LNC 1993 Stock Plan for Non-

Employee Directors is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(z) to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year 
ended December 31, 2004.* 

10.20  Amendment of outstanding Non-Qualified Option Agreements (for Non-Employee Directors) under the LNC 1993 
Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-
6028) filed with the SEC on January 12, 2006.* 

10.21  LNC Executives’ Severance Benefit Plan (effective August 7, 2008) is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to 

LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended June 30, 2008.* 

10.22  Amended and Restated LNC Excess Retirement Plan is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to LNC’s Form 10-

K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2007.* 

10.23  LNC Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors, as amended and restated November 5, 2008 is 

incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File NO. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 
2008.* 

10.24  Form of LNC Restricted Stock Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(b) to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 

1-6028) filed with the SEC on January 20, 2005.* 

10.25  Form of LNC Stock Option Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(c) to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-

6028) filed with the SEC on January 20, 2005.* 

10.26  Form of 2008-2010 Performance Cycle Agreement under the LNC Amended and Restated Incentive Compensation 

Plan, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on 
February 13, 2008.* 

10.27  Description of Special 2008 Annual Incentive Payout Arrangement with Terrance J. Mullen, Former President of 

Lincoln Financial Distributors, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for 
the quarter ended March 31, 2008.* 

10.28  2009 Executive compensation Matters dated March 30, 2009 is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to LNC’s 

Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended March 31, 2009.* 

10.29  Agreement, Waiver and General Release between Elizabeth L. Reeves and LNC is incorporated by reference to  

Exhibit 10.2 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended June 30, 2008.* 

10.30  Form of 2008 Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement under the LNC Amended and Restated Incentive 

Compensation Plan is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the 
SEC on February 13, 2008.* 

10.31  LNC Employees’ Supplemental Pension Benefit Plan is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(e) to LNC’s Form 8-K 

(File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on January 20, 2005.* 

10.32  Description of resolution dated January 13, 2005 amending the LNC Employees’ Supplemental Pension benefit Plan 

incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(d) to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No 1-6028) for the quarter ended March 31, 
2005.* 

10.33  Form of Indemnification between LNC and each director incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to LNC’s Form 

10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended September 30, 2009.* 

E-4 

  
 
    
   
   
 
    
    
    
    
    
   
 
    
    
    
   
    
10.34  Form of Stock Option Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) 

filed with the SEC on April 18, 2006.* 

10.35  Form of nonqualified LNC restricted stock award agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to LNC’s 

Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on April 7, 2006.* 

10.36  LNC Domestic Relocation Policy Home Sale Assistance Plan, effective as of September 6, 2007, is incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.35 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2009.* 

10.37 

Jefferson Pilot Corporation Long Term Stock Incentive Plan, as amended in February 2005, is incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10(iii) of Jefferson-Pilot’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-5955) for the year ended December 31, 2004.* 

10.38 

Jefferson Pilot Corporation Non-Employee Directors’ Stock Option Plan, as amended in February 2005, is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(iv) of Jefferson-Pilot’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-5955) for the year ended 
December 31, 2004.* 

10.39 

Jefferson Pilot Corporation Non-Employee Directors’ Stock Option Plan, as last amended in 1999, is incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10(vii) of Jefferson-Pilot’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-5955) for the year ended December 31, 1998.* 

10.40 

Jefferson Pilot Corporation forms of stock option terms for non-employee directors are incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 10(xi) of Jefferson-Pilot’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-5955) for the year ended December 31, 2004 and to Exhibit 
10.2 of Jefferson-Pilot’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on February 17, 2006.* 

10.41 

Jefferson Pilot Corporation forms of stock option terms for officers are incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(xi) of 
Jefferson-Pilot’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-5955) for the year ended December 31, 2004 and to Exhibit 10.1 of  Jefferson-
Pilot’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on February 17, 2006.* 

10.42 

Jefferson-Pilot Deferred Fee Plan for Non-Employee Directors, as amended and restated November 5, 2008 is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.55 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 
2008.* 

10.43  Lease and Agreement dated August 1, 1984, with respect to LNL’s offices located at Clinton Street and Harrison 

Street, Fort Wayne, Indiana is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(n) to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for 
the year ended December 31, 1995. 

10.44  First Amendment of Lease, dated as of June 16, 2006, between Trona Cogeneration Corporation and The Lincoln 
National Life Insurance Company, is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-
6028) for the quarter ended June 30, 2006. 

10.45  Agreement of Lease dated February 17, 1998, with respect to LNL’s offices located at 350 Church Street, Hartford, 
Connecticut is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10(q) to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended 
December 31, 1997. 

10.46  Stock and Asset Purchase Agreement by and among LNC, The Lincoln National Life Insurance Company, Lincoln 
National Reinsurance Company (Barbados) Limited and Swiss Re Life & Health America Inc. dated July 27, 2001 is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the Commission on August 
1, 2001. Omitted schedules and exhibits listed in the Agreement will be furnished to the Commission upon request. 

10.47  Credit Agreement, dated as of June 9, 2010, among Lincoln National Corporation, as an Account Party and Guarantor, 
the Subsidiary Account Parties, as additional Account Parties, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. as administrative agent, J.P. 
Morgan Securities Inc. and Banc of America Securities LLC, as joint lead arrangers and joint bookrunners, Bank of 
America, N.A., as syndication agent, U.S. Bank National Association and Wells Fargo Bank, National Association as 
documentation agents, and the other lenders named therein, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to LNC’s Form 
8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on June 10, 2010. 

10.48  364-Day Credit Agreement, dated as of June 9, 2010, among Lincoln National Corporation, as an Account Party and 

Guarantor, the Subsidiary Account Parties, as additional Account Parties, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. as 
administrative agent, J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. and Banc of America Securities LLC, as joint lead arrangers and joint 
bookrunners, Bank of America, N.A., as syndication agent, U.S. Bank National Association and Wells Fargo Bank, 
National Association as documentation agents, and the other lenders named therein, incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 10.2 to LNC’s Form 8-K (File No. 1-6028) filed with the SEC on June 10, 2010. 

E-5 

  
 
    
   
   
   
   
   
    
    
    
   
   
   
  
  
   
10.49  Master Confirmation Agreement and related Supplemental Confirmation, dated March 14, 2007, and Trade 
Notification, dated March 16, 2007, relating to LNC’s Accelerated Stock Repurchase with Citibank, N.A. is 
incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to LNC’s Form 10-Q (File No. 1-6028) for the quarter ended March 31, 
2007.** 

10.50 

Indemnity Reinsurance Agreement, dated as of January 1, 1998, between Connecticut General Life Insurance Company 
and Lincoln Life & Annuity Company of New York is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.67 to LNC’s Form 10-
K (File No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2008.***   

10.51  Coinsurance Agreement, dated as of October 1, 1998, AETNA Life Insurance and Annuity Company and Lincoln Life 

& Annuity Company of New York is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.68 to LNC’s Form 10-K (File No. 1-
6028) for the year ended December 31, 2008.*** 

10.52 

Investment Advisory Agreement, dated as of January 4, 2010, between The Lincoln National Life Insurance Company 
and Delaware Investment Advisers is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.58 to LNC’s for 10-K (File No. 1-6028) 
for the year ended December 31, 2009.** 

10.53 

Investment Advisory Agreement, dated as of January 4, 2010, between Lincoln Life & Annuity Company of New York 
and Delaware Investment Advisers is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.59 to LNC’s for 10-K (File No. 1-6028) 
for the year ended December 31, 2009.** 

10.54  Reimbursement Agreement, dated December 31, 2009, between Lincoln Reinsurance Company of Vermont I, Lincoln 
Financial Holdings, LLC II and Credit Suisse AG is incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.60 to LNC’s for 10-K (File 
No. 1-6028) for the year ended December 31, 2009.** 

12  Historical Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges. 

21 

Subsidiaries List. 

23 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm. 

31.1  Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. 

31.2  Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. 

32.1  Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of 

the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. 

32.2  Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of 

the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. 

99.1  Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 31 C.F.R. Section 30.15. 

99.2  Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 31 C.F.R. Section 30.15. 

101  Attached as Exhibit 101 to this report are the following Interactive Data Files formatted in XBRL (Extensible Business 

Reporting Language):  (i) Consolidated Balance Sheets for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009; (ii) 
Consolidated Statements of Income (Loss) for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008; (iii) Consolidated 
Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008; (iv) the Consolidated 
Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2010, 2009 and 2008; (v) Notes to the Consolidated 
Financial Statements; and (vi) Financial Statement Schedules.  Users of this data are advised pursuant to Rule 401 of 
Regulation S-T that the information contained in the XBRL documents is unaudited and these are not the official 
publicly filed financial statements of Lincoln National Corporation. 

In accordance with Rule 402 of Regulation S-T, the XBRL related information in this report shall not be deemed filed for 
purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or otherwise subject to the liability of that section, 
and shall not be incorporated by reference into any registration statement or other document filed under the Securities Act of 
1933, as amended, except as shall be expressly set forth by specific reference in such filing. 

E-6 

  
 
    
   
  
 
  
  
    
    
    
    
   
   
   
 
 
 
 
* This exhibit is a management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.  
** Portions of the exhibit have been redacted and are subject to a confidential treatment request filed with the Secretary of the 
Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) pursuant to Rule 24b-2 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. 
*** Schedules to the agreement have been omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(2) of Regulation S-K.  LNC will furnish 
supplementally a copy of the schedule to the SEC, upon request.  

We will furnish to the SEC, upon request, a copy of any of our long-term debt agreements not otherwise filed with the 
SEC. 

NOTE:  This is an abbreviated version of the Lincoln National Corporation 10-K.  Copies of these exhibits are available 
electronically at www.sec.gov or www.lincolnfinancial.com, or by writing to the Corporate Secretary at Lincoln National 
Corporation, 150 N. Radnor Chester Road, Suite A305, Radnor, PA 19087. 

E-7 

  
 
 
 
LINCOLN NATIONAL CORPORATION AND SUBSIDIARIES 
HISTORICAL RATIO OF EARNINGS TO FIXED CHARGES 

(dollars in millions) 

Exhibit 12 

Income (loss) from continuing operations before taxes  
Sub-total of fixed charges  
   Sub-total of adjusted income (loss)  
Interest on annuities and financial products  
      Adjusted income (loss) base  

Fixed Charges  
Interest and debt expense (1) 
Interest expense related to uncertain tax positions  
Portion of rent expense representing interest  
   Sub-total of fixed charges excluding interest on   
      annuities and financial products  
Interest on annuities and financial products  
         Total fixed charges  

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

Ratio of sub-total of adjusted income (loss) to sub-total  
   of fixed charges excluding interest on annuities and   
   financial products (2) 
Ratio of adjusted income (loss) base to total fixed  
   charges (2) 

2010  

For the Years Ended December 31,
2007  
2008  
2009  

 1,234    $ 
 307   
 1,541   
 2,496   
 4,037    $ 

 (521)   $ 
 292    
 (229)  
 2,512   
 2,283    $ 

 (137)   $ 
 303    
 166    
 2,532   
 2,698    $ 

 1,675    $ 
 325   
 2,000   
 2,519   
 4,519    $ 

2006  

 1,631 
 242 
 1,873 
 2,260 
 4,133 

 286    $ 
 7    
 14   

 261     $ 
 13    
 18    

 281     $ 
 2    
 20    

 284    $ 
 21   
 20   

 223 
 - 
 19 

 307   
 2,496   
 2,803    $ 

 292    
 2,512   
 2,804    $ 

 303    
 2,532   
 2,835    $ 

 325   
 2,519   
 2,844    $ 

 242 
 2,260 
 2,502 

 5.02   

 1.44   

NM   

NM   

NM   

 6.15   

 7.74 

NM   

 1.59   

 1.65 

(1) 

Interest and debt expense excludes a $5 million loss, $64 million gain and $5 million gain related to the early retirement of debt 
in 2010, 2009 and 2006, respectively. 

(2)  The ratios of earnings to fixed charges for the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, indicated a less than one-to-one 

coverage and are therefore not presented.  Additional earnings of $521 million and $137 million would have been required for 
the years ended December 31, 2009 and 2008, respectively, to achieve ratios of one-to-one coverage. 

 
  
                        
 
                        
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
                             
  
  
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
    
  
  
  
  
  
  
   
  
   
  
   
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
Exhibit 23  

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM 

We consent to the incorporation by reference in the following registration statements of Lincoln National Corporation and in the 
related prospectuses listed below:   

1.  Forms S-3  

a.  No. 333-157822 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation automatic shelf registration for certain securities, 
b.  Nos. 333-133086 and 333-159314 pertaining to the Jefferson-Pilot Corporation Long Term Stock Incentive Plan, 
c.  Nos. 333-131943 and 333-163672 pertaining to The Lincoln National Life Insurance Company Agents’ Savings 

and Profit-Sharing Plan,  

d.  Nos. 333-142871 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation Amended and Restated Incentive 

Compensation Plan and 333-159290 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation 2009 Amended and Restated 
Incentive Compensation Plan,  

e.  Nos. 333-84728, 333-84728-01, 333-84728-02, 333-84728-03 and 333-84728-04 pertaining to the Lincoln 

National Corporation shelf registration for certain securities, 

f.  No. 333-32667 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation 1997 Incentive Compensation Plan,  and  
g.  Nos. 333-146213, 33-51415, and 333-165504 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation Executive Deferred 

Compensation Plan for Agents;  

2.  Form S-4 (No. 333-130226) pertaining to the proposed business combination with Jefferson-Pilot Corporation; 
3.  Forms S-8   

a.  No. 333-155385 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation Deferred Compensation and 

Supplemental/Excess Retirement Plan, 

b.  No. 333-142872 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation Stock Option Plan for Non-Employee 

Directors, 

c.  No. 333-133039 pertaining to various Jefferson-Pilot Corporation benefit plans, 
d.  Nos. 333-143796 and 333-126452 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation Executive Deferred 

Compensation Plan for Employees,  

e.  Nos. 333-126020 and 333-161989 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation Employees’ Savings and 

Retirement Plan,  

f.  Nos. 333-143795 and 333-121069 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation Deferred Compensation Plan 

for Non-Employee Directors,  

g.  No. 033-58113 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation 1993 Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors,  
h.  No. 333-105344 pertaining to the Lincoln National Corporation 1993 Stock Plan for Non-Employee Directors; 

of our reports dated February 25, 2011, with respect to the consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules of 
Lincoln National Corporation and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting of Lincoln National Corporation, 
included in this Annual Report (Form 10-K) for the year ended December 31, 2010.  

/s/ Ernst & Young LLP 
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania 
February 25, 2011 

  
  
 
 
 
  
 
Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the 
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

______________ 

Exhibit 31.1  

I, Dennis R. Glass, President and Chief Executive Officer, certify that: 

1. 

2. 

3. 

4. 

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Lincoln National Corporation; 

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact 
necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not 
misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; 

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all 
material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods 
presented in this report; 

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and 
procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as 
defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have: 

a) 

Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed 
under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated 
subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is 
being prepared; 

b)  Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be 
designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the 
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; 

c) 

Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our 
conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by 
this report based on such evaluation; and 

d)  Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the 
registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has 
materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; 
and  

5. 

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over 
financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons 
performing the equivalent functions): 

a) 

b) 

All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial 
reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and 
report financial information; and 

Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the 
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting. 

Dated:  February 25, 2011  

            /s/ Dennis R. Glass________ 
Name:  Dennis R. Glass 
Title:  President and Chief Executive Officer 

  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the  
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

______________ 

Exhibit 31.2  

I, Randal J. Freitag, Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, certify that: 

1. 

2. 

3. 

4. 

I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of Lincoln National Corporation;  

Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a  
material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, 
not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; 

Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report,  
fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the  
registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; 

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and 
procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as 
defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have: 

a) 

Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed 
under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated 
subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is 
being prepared; 

b)  Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be 
designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the 
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; 

c) 

Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our 
conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by 
this report based on such evaluation; and 

d)  Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the 
registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has 
materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; 
and  

5. 

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over 
financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons 
performing the equivalent functions): 

a) 

b) 

All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial 
reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and 
report financial information; and 

Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the 
registrant’s internal control over financial reporting. 

Dated:  February 25, 2011  

            /s/ Randal J. Freitag________ 
Name:  Randal J. Freitag 
Title:  Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 

  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350,  
As Adopted Pursuant to Section 906  
Of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

______________ 

Exhibit 32.1  

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350, the undersigned officer of Lincoln National Corporation (the “Company”), hereby certifies that the 
Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010, (the “Report”) fully complies with the 
requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d), as applicable, of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and that the information contained in 
the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.  

Dated:  February 25, 2011  

            /s/ Dennis R. Glass________ 
Name:  Dennis R. Glass 
Title:  President and Chief Executive Officer 

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350 and is not being filed as part of the Report or as a 
separate disclosure document.  

A signed original of this written statement required under Section 906 has been provided to the Company and will be retained by 
the Company and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request.  

  
  
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350,  
As Adopted Pursuant to Section 906  
Of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 

______________ 

Exhibit 32.2  

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350, the undersigned officer of Lincoln National Corporation (the “Company”), hereby certifies that the 
Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010, (the “Report”) fully complies with the 
requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d), as applicable, of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and that the information contained in 
the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.  

Dated:  February 25, 2011  

            /s/ Randal J. Freitag________ 
Name:  Randal J. Freitag 
Title:  Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 

The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350 and is not being filed as part of the Report or as a 
separate disclosure document.  

A signed original of this written statement required under Section 906 has been provided to the Company and will be retained by 
the Company and furnished to the Securities and Exchange Commission or its staff upon request. 

 
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
Exhibit 99.1 

Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to 31 C.F.R. Section 30.15 

I, Dennis R. Glass, certify, based on my knowledge, that: 

(i)  The compensation committee of Lincoln National Corporation (“LNC”) discussed, reviewed, and evaluated with the 
senior risk officers, the senior executive officer (SEO) compensation plans and employee compensation plans and the risks these 
plans pose to LNC; 

(ii) During the 2010 TARP Period, the compensation committee of LNC identified and limited any features of the SEO 
compensation plans that could lead SEOs to take unnecessary and excessive risks that could threaten the value of LNC and has 
identified any features of the employee compensation plans that pose risks to LNC and limited those features to ensure that LNC 
is not unnecessarily exposed to risks; 

(iii) During the 2010 TARP Period, the compensation committee reviewed the terms of each employee compensation plan 

and identified any features of the plan that could encourage the manipulation of reported earnings of LNC to enhance the 
compensation of an employee and has limited any such features; 

(iv) The compensation committee of LNC will certify that the reviews of the SEO compensation plans and employee 

compensation plans, required under (i) and (iii) above, occurred during the 2010 TARP Period; 

(v) The compensation committee of LNC will provide a narrative description to the extent necessary of how it limited, 

during the 2010 TARP Period, the features in: (A) SEO compensation plans that could lead SEOs to take unnecessary and 
excessive risks that could threaten the value of LNC; (B) Employee compensation plans that unnecessarily expose LNC to risks; 
and (C) Employee compensation plans that could encourage the manipulation of reported earnings of LNC to enhance the 
compensation of an employee; 

(vi)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC required that bonus payments to SEOs or any of the next twenty most highly 

compensated employees, as defined in the regulations and guidance established under section 111 of the Emergency Economic 
Stimulus Act of 2008 (“ESSA”) (bonus payments), be subject to a recovery or ‘‘clawback’’ provision if the bonus payments were 
based on materially inaccurate financial statements or any other materially inaccurate performance metric criteria; 

(vii)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC prohibited any golden parachute payment, as defined in the regulations and 

guidance established under section 111 of EESA, to an SEO or any of the next five most highly compensated employees; 

(viii)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC limited bonus payments to its applicable employees in accordance with section 

111 of EESA and the regulations and guidance established thereunder; 

(ix)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC and its employees complied with the excessive or luxury expenditures policy, as 

defined in the regulations and guidance established under section 111 of EESA; and any expenses that, pursuant to the policy, 
required approval of the board of directors, a committee of the board of directors, an SEO, or an executive officer with a similar 
level of responsibility, were properly approved; 

(x) As the 2010 TARP Period for LNC ended on June 30, 2010, LNC is not required to include a non-binding shareholder 

resolution in compliance with Section 111 of ESSA regarding the disclosures provided under the Federal securities laws related to 
SEO compensation paid or accrued during 2010; 

(xi)  LNC will disclose the amount, nature, and justification for the offering, during the 2010 TARP Period, of any 

perquisites, as defined in the regulations and guidance established under section 111 of EESA, whose total value exceeds $25,000 
for any employee who is subject to the bonus payment limitations identified in paragraph (viii); 

(xii) LNC will disclose whether LNC, the board of directors of LNC, or the compensation committee of LNC has 

engaged, during the 2010 TARP Period, a compensation consultant; and the services the compensation consultant or any affiliate 
of the compensation consultant provided during this period; 

(xiii) LNC has prohibited the payment of any gross-ups, as defined in the regulations and guidance established under 

section 111 of EESA, to the SEOs and the next twenty most highly compensated employees during the 2010 TARP Period; 

(xiv) During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC substantially complied with all other requirements related to employee 

compensation that are provided in the agreement between LNC and Treasury, including any amendments; 

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(xv)  As the 2010 TARP Period for LNC ended on June 30, 2010, LNC is not required to submit to Treasury a complete 
and accurate list of the SEOs and the twenty next most highly compensated for the current fiscal year, with the non-SEOs ranked 
in descending order of level of annual compensation, with name, title, and employer of each SEO and most highly compensated 
employee identified; and  

(xvi) I understand that a knowing and willful false or fraudulent statement made in connection with this certification may 

be punished by fine, imprisonment, or both. 

Dated:  February 25, 2011  

__________/s/ Dennis R. Glass__________ 
Name:  Dennis R. Glass  
Title:  President and Chief Executive Officer 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit 99.2 

Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 31 C.F.R. Section 30.15 

I, Randal J. Freitag, certify, based on my knowledge, that: 

(i)  The compensation committee of Lincoln National Corporation (“LNC”) discussed, reviewed, and evaluated with the 
senior risk officers, the senior executive officer (SEO) compensation plans and employee compensation plans and the risks these 
plans pose to LNC; 

(ii) During the 2010 TARP Period, the compensation committee of LNC identified and limited any features of the SEO 
compensation plans that could lead SEOs to take unnecessary and excessive risks that could threaten the value of LNC and has 
identified any features of the employee compensation plans that pose risks to LNC and limited those features to ensure that LNC 
is not unnecessarily exposed to risks; 

(iii) During the 2010 TARP Period, the compensation committee reviewed the terms of each employee compensation plan 

and identified any features of the plan that could encourage the manipulation of reported earnings of LNC to enhance the 
compensation of an employee and has limited any such features; 

(iv) The compensation committee of LNC will certify that the reviews of the SEO compensation plans and employee 

compensation plans, required under (i) and (iii) above, occurred during the 2010 TARP Period; 

(v) The compensation committee of LNC will provide a narrative description to the extent necessary of how it limited, 

during the 2010 TARP Period, the features in: (A) SEO compensation plans that could lead SEOs to take unnecessary and 
excessive risks that could threaten the value of LNC; (B) Employee compensation plans that unnecessarily expose LNC to risks; 
and (C) Employee compensation plans that could encourage the manipulation of reported earnings of LNC to enhance the 
compensation of an employee; 

(vi)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC required that bonus payments to SEOs or any of the next twenty most highly 

compensated employees, as defined in the regulations and guidance established under section 111 of the Emergency Economic 
Stimulus Act of 2008 (“ESSA”) (bonus payments), be subject to a recovery or ‘‘clawback’’ provision if the bonus payments were 
based on materially inaccurate financial statements or any other materially inaccurate performance metric criteria; 

(vii)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC prohibited any golden parachute payment, as defined in the regulations and 

guidance established under section 111 of EESA, to an SEO or any of the next five most highly compensated employees; 

(viii)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC limited bonus payments to its applicable employees in accordance with section 

111 of EESA and the regulations and guidance established thereunder; 

(ix)  During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC and its employees complied with the excessive or luxury expenditures policy, as 

defined in the regulations and guidance established under section 111 of EESA; and any expenses that, pursuant to the policy, 
required approval of the board of directors, a committee of the board of directors, an SEO, or an executive officer with a similar 
level of responsibility, were properly approved; 

(x) As the 2010 TARP Period for LNC ended on June 30, 2010, LNC is not required to include a non-binding shareholder 

resolution in compliance with Section 111 of ESSA regarding the disclosures provided under the Federal securities laws related to 
SEO compensation paid or accrued during 2010; 

(xi)  LNC will disclose the amount, nature, and justification for the offering, during the 2010 TARP Period, of any 

perquisites, as defined in the regulations and guidance established under section 111 of EESA, whose total value exceeds $25,000 
for any employee who is subject to the bonus payment limitations identified in paragraph (viii); 

(xii) LNC will disclose whether LNC, the board of directors of LNC, or the compensation committee of LNC has 

engaged, during the 2010 TARP Period, a compensation consultant; and the services the compensation consultant or any affiliate 
of the compensation consultant provided during this period; 

(xiii) LNC has prohibited the payment of any gross-ups, as defined in the regulations and guidance established under 

section 111 of EESA, to the SEOs and the next twenty most highly compensated employees during the 2010 TARP Period; 

(xiv) During the 2010 TARP Period, LNC substantially complied with all other requirements related to employee 

compensation that are provided in the agreement between LNC and Treasury, including any amendments; 

 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(xv)  As the 2010 TARP Period for LNC ended on June 30, 2010, LNC is not required to submit to Treasury a complete 
and accurate list of the SEOs and the twenty next most highly compensated for the current fiscal year, with the non-SEOs ranked 
in descending order of level of annual compensation, with name, title, and employer of each SEO and most highly compensated 
employee identified; and  

(xvi) I understand that a knowing and willful false or fraudulent statement made in connection with this certification may 

be punished by fine, imprisonment, or both. 

Dated:  February 25, 2011 

_______________/s/ Randal J. Freitag_______________ 
Name:  Randal J. Freitag 
Title:  Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comparison of Five-Year Cumulative Total Return 

The following represents a five-year comparison of the annual performance of our cumulative total shareholder return (change in 
the year-end stock price plus reinvested dividends), based on a hypothetical investment of $100 (invested on December 31, 2005, 
with dividends reinvested through December 31, 2010), with the Standard & Poor’s (“S&P”) 500 Index® and the S&P Life/Health 
Index.  Returns of the S&P Life/Health Index have been weighted according to their respective aggregate market capitalization at 
the beginning of each period shown on the graph. 

Comparison of Five-Year Cumulative Total Return

$250.00 

$200.00 

$150.00 

$100.00 

$50.00 

$-

Lincoln National Corporation

S&P 500 Index®

S&P Life/Health Index

2005

2006

2007

2008

2009

2010

Lincoln National Corporation
S&P 500 Index®
S&P Life/Health Index

As of December 31,

$   

2005
100.00
100.00
100.00

$   

2006
128.58
115.79
116.41

$   

2007
115.39
121.95
129.20

2008

2009

2010

$    

38.82
77.38
66.78

$    

51.90
97.44
76.98

$    

58.10
111.89
96.26

There can be no assurance that our stock performance will continue in the future with the same or similar trends depicted in the 
preceding graph.  We will not make or endorse any predictions as to future stock performance.  Pursuant to Securities and 
Exchange Commission (“SEC”) rules, the Comparison of Five-Year Cumulative Total Return graph shall not be considered 
“soliciting material” or to be “filed” with the SEC, except to the extent we specifically request that such information be treated as 
soliciting material or specifically incorporate such information by reference into a document filed with the SEC under the Securities 
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, or under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. 

  
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
    
    
      
      
    
    
    
    
      
      
      
 
 
Board of Directors as of April 1, 2011 

William J. Avery  
Retired Chairman and CEO 
Crown Cork & Seal Company, Inc. 

William H. Cunningham 
Professor  
The University of Texas at Austin 

Dennis R. Glass 
President & CEO 
Lincoln National Corporation 

George W. Henderson, III 
Retired Chairman and CEO 
Burlington Industries, Inc. 

Eric G. Johnson  
President and CEO  
Baldwin Richardson Foods Company  

Gary C. Kelly 
Chairman, President and CEO  
Southwest Airlines, Co.  

M. Leanne Lachman  
President  
Lachman Associates LLC  

Michael F. Mee  
Retired EVP and CFO  
Bristol-Myers Squibb Company 

William Porter Payne 
Executive Management 
Gleacher & Company Inc. 

Patrick S. Pittard 
Distinguished Executive in Residence 
Terry Business School, University of Georgia 

Isaiah Tidwell 
Retired EVP and Georgia Wealth Management Director 
Wachovia Bank, N.A. 

  
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
   Corporate Headquarters  
Lincoln National Corporation  
150 N. Radnor Chester Road  
Radnor, PA 19087-5238  

Internet Information  
Information on LNC’s financial results and its products and services as well as SEC filings are available on the Internet at 
www.lincolnfinancial.com. 

Stock Listings   
LNC’s common stock is traded on the New York and Chicago stock exchanges under the symbol LNC.   

Inquiries   
Analysts and institutional investors should contact:  
James P. Sjoreen  
Vice President – Investor Relations  
Lincoln National Corporation  
150 N. Radnor Chester Road, Suite A305  
Radnor, PA 19087 
E-mail: investorrelations@LFG.com  

Annual Meeting of Shareholders   
The annual meeting of shareholders will be held at The Ritz-Carlton Hotel, 10 Avenue of the Arts, Philadelphia, PA 19102, at        
9 a.m. (local time) on Thursday, May 26, 2011. 

Shareholder Services   
General inquiries or concerns about LNC shareholder services may be directed to shareholder services at 1-800-237-2920 or by 
email at shareholderservices@LFG.com.  Questions that are specific in nature, such as transfer of stock, change of address or 
general inquiries regarding stock or dividend matters, should be directed to the transfer agent and registrar.  

Transfer Agent and Registrar  
For regular mailings use: 
BNY Mellon Shareowner Services 
P.O. Box 358015 
Pittsburgh, PA 15252-8015 
1-866-541-9693 
website: www.bnymellon.com 

For registered or overnight mailings use: 
BNY Mellon Shareowner Services 
480 Washington Blvd. 
Jersey City, NJ 07310-1900 

Dividend Reinvestment Program/Direct Stock Purchase Plan   
LNC has a Dividend Reinvestment and Cash Investment Plan.  For further information, write to BNY Mellon Shareowner 
Services at the addresses noted above.  

Direct Deposit of Dividends   
Quarterly dividends can be electronically deposited to shareholders’ checking or savings accounts on the dividend payment date.  
Telephone inquiries may be directed to BNY Mellon Shareowner Services at 1-866-541-9693.  

Dividend Payment Schedule   
Dividends on LNC common stock are paid February 1, May 1, August 1 and November 1.  

Lincoln Financial Group is a registered service mark of LNC. 

  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
Lincoln National Corporation
150 N. Radnor-Chester Road
Radnor, PA 19087

Lincoln Financial Group is the  
marketing name for Lincoln National  
Corporation and its affiliates.

LFG-AR-CVR001